10-K 1 corp10k2014.htm FORM 10-K CORP 10K 2014



UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549
FORM 10-K
Annual report pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of
The Securities Exchange Act of 1934
For the fiscal year ended
 
Commission file
December 31, 2014
 
number 1-5805
JPMorgan Chase & Co.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
Delaware
 
13-2624428
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
 
(I.R.S. employer
identification no.)
 
 
 
270 Park Avenue, New York, New York
 
10017
(Address of principal executive offices)
 
(Zip code)
 
 
 
Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: (212) 270-6000
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Title of each class
 
Name of each exchange on which registered
Common stock
 
The New York Stock Exchange
 
 
The London Stock Exchange
 
 
The Tokyo Stock Exchange
Warrants, each to purchase one share of Common Stock
 
The New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, each representing a one-four hundredth interest in a share of 5.50% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series O
 
The New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, each representing a one-four hundredth interest in a share of 5.45% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series P
 
The New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, each representing a one-four hundredth interest in a share of 6.70% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series T
 
The New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, each representing a one-four hundredth interest in a share of 6.30% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series W
 
The New York Stock Exchange
Guarantee of 6.70% Capital Securities, Series CC, of JPMorgan Chase Capital XXIX
 
The New York Stock Exchange
Alerian MLP Index ETNs due May 24, 2024
 
NYSE Arca, Inc.
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. ý Yes o No
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. o Yes ý No
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. ý Yes o No
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Website, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). ý Yes o No
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K (§229.405 of this chapter) is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. ý
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
ý Large accelerated filer
o Accelerated filer 
o Non-accelerated filer
(Do not check if a smaller reporting company)
o Smaller reporting company
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). o Yes ý No
The aggregate market value of JPMorgan Chase & Co. common stock held by non-affiliates as of June 30, 2014: $215,577,956,743
Number of shares of common stock outstanding as of January 31, 2015: 3,728,312,555
Documents incorporated by reference: Portions of the registrant’s Proxy Statement for the annual meeting of stockholders to be held on May 19, 2015, are incorporated by reference in this Form 10-K in response to Items 10, 11, 12, 13 and 14 of Part III.






Form 10-K Index
 
Page
1
 
1
 
1
 
1
 
1
 
314–318
 
62, 307, 314
 
319
 
110–127, 238–257,
320–325
 
128–130, 258–261,
326–327
 
276, 328
 
329
8–17
17
17-18
18
18
 
 
 
 
 

18–19
19
19
19
20
20
20
21
 
 
 
 
 
22
23

23
23
23
 
 
 
 
 
24–27




Part I


ITEM 1: BUSINESS
Overview
JPMorgan Chase & Co., (“JPMorgan Chase” or the “Firm”) a financial holding company incorporated under Delaware law in 1968, is a leading global financial services firm and one of the largest banking institutions in the United States of America (“U.S.”), with operations worldwide; the Firm had $2.6 trillion in assets and $232.1 billion in stockholders’ equity as of December 31, 2014. The Firm is a leader in investment banking, financial services for consumers and small businesses, commercial banking, financial transaction processing and asset management. Under the J.P. Morgan and Chase brands, the Firm serves millions of customers in the U.S. and many of the world’s most prominent corporate, institutional and government clients.
JPMorgan Chase’s principal bank subsidiaries are JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association (“JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.”), a national banking association with U.S. branches in 23 states, and Chase Bank USA, National Association (“Chase Bank USA, N.A.”), a national banking association that is the Firm’s credit card–issuing bank. JPMorgan Chase’s principal nonbank subsidiary is J.P. Morgan Securities LLC (“JPMorgan Securities”), the Firm’s U.S. investment banking firm. The bank and nonbank subsidiaries of JPMorgan Chase operate nationally as well as through overseas branches and subsidiaries, representative offices and subsidiary foreign banks. One of the Firm’s principal operating subsidiaries in the United Kingdom (“U.K.”) is J.P. Morgan Securities plc, a subsidiary of JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.
The Firm’s website is www.jpmorganchase.com. JPMorgan Chase makes available free of charge, through its website, annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, and any amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or Section 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as soon as reasonably practicable after it electronically files such material with, or furnishes such material to, the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”). The Firm has adopted, and posted on its website, a Code of Ethics for its Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer, Chief Accounting Officer and other finance professionals of the Firm.
Business segments
JPMorgan Chase’s activities are organized, for management reporting purposes, into four major reportable business segments, as well as a Corporate segment. The Firm’s consumer business is the Consumer & Community Banking segment. The Corporate & Investment Bank, Commercial Banking, and Asset Management segments comprise the Firm’s wholesale businesses.
 
A description of the Firm’s business segments and the products and services they provide to their respective client bases is provided in the “Business segment results” section of Management’s discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations (“MD&A”), beginning on page 64 and in Note 33.
Competition
JPMorgan Chase and its subsidiaries and affiliates operate in a highly competitive environment. Competitors include other banks, brokerage firms, investment banking companies, merchant banks, hedge funds, commodity trading companies, private equity firms, insurance companies, mutual fund companies, investment managers, credit card companies, mortgage banking companies, trust companies, securities processing companies, automobile financing companies, leasing companies, e-commerce and other Internet-based companies, and a variety of other financial services and advisory companies. JPMorgan Chase’s businesses generally compete on the basis of the quality and range of their products and services, transaction execution, innovation and price. Competition also varies based on the types of clients, customers, industries and geographies served. With respect to some of its geographies and products, JPMorgan Chase competes globally; with respect to others, the Firm competes on a national or regional basis. The Firm’s ability to compete also depends on its ability to attract and retain professional and other personnel, and on its reputation.
The financial services industry has experienced consolidation and convergence in recent years, as financial institutions involved in a broad range of financial products and services have merged and, in some cases, failed. This consolidation is expected to continue. Consolidation could result in competitors of JPMorgan Chase gaining greater capital and other resources, such as a broader range of products and services and geographic diversity. It is likely that competition will become even more intense as the Firm’s businesses continue to compete with other financial institutions that may have a stronger local presence in certain geographies or that operate under different rules and regulatory regimes than the Firm.
Supervision and regulation
The Firm is subject to regulation under state and federal laws in the U.S., as well as the applicable laws of each of the various jurisdictions outside the U.S. in which the Firm does business.
As a result of rule-making following the enactment of the Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”) and other regulatory reforms enacted and proposed in the U.S. and abroad, the Firm is currently experiencing a period of unprecedented change in regulation and such changes could have a significant impact on how the Firm conducts business. The Firm continues to work diligently in assessing the regulatory changes it is facing, and is devoting substantial resources to implementing all the new regulations, while, at the same time, best meeting the needs and expectations of its


 
 
1

Part I

customers, clients and shareholders. The combined effect of numerous rule-makings by multiple governmental agencies and regulators, and the potential conflicts or inconsistencies among such rules, present challenges and risks to the Firm’s business and operations. Given the current status of the regulatory developments, the Firm cannot currently quantify the possible effects on its business and operations of all of the significant changes that are currently underway. For more information, see Risk Factors on pages 8–17.
Financial holding company:
Consolidated supervision by the Federal Reserve. As a bank holding company (“BHC”) and a financial holding company, JPMorgan Chase is subject to comprehensive consolidated supervision, regulation and examination by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “Federal Reserve”). The Federal Reserve acts as an “umbrella regulator” and certain of JPMorgan Chase’s subsidiaries are regulated directly by additional authorities based on the particular activities of those subsidiaries. For example, JPMorgan Chase’s national bank subsidiaries, such as JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., and Chase Bank USA, N.A., are subject to supervision and regulation by the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (“OCC”) and, with respect to certain matters, by the Federal Reserve and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (the “FDIC”). Non-bank subsidiaries, such as the Firm’s U.S. broker-dealers, are subject to supervision and regulation by the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”), and with respect to certain futures-related and swaps-related activities, by the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (“CFTC”). See Securities and broker-dealer regulation, Investment management regulation and Derivatives regulation below.
As a result of the Dodd-Frank Act, JPMorgan Chase is, or will become, subject to (among other things) significantly revised and expanded regulation and supervision, additional limitations on the way it conducts its businesses, and heightened capital and liquidity requirements. In addition, the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (“CFPB”), which was created by the Dodd-Frank Act, has rulemaking, enforcement and examination authority over JPMorgan Chase and its subsidiaries with respect to federal consumer protection laws.
Scope of permissible business activities. The Bank Holding Company Act generally restricts BHCs from engaging in business activities other than the business of banking and certain closely related activities. Financial holding companies generally can engage in a broader range of financial activities than are otherwise permissible for BHCs, as long as they continue to meet the eligibility requirements for financial holding companies (including requirements that the financial holding company and each of its U.S. depository institution subsidiaries maintain their status as “well capitalized” and “well managed”). The broader range of permissible activities for financial holding companies includes underwriting, dealing and making markets in
 
securities, and making merchant banking investments in non-financial companies.
The Federal Reserve has the authority to limit a financial holding company’s ability to conduct activities that would otherwise be permissible if the financial holding company or any of its depositary institution subsidiaries ceases to meet the applicable eligibility requirements. The Federal Reserve may also impose corrective capital and/or managerial requirements on the financial holding company and may require divestiture of the holding company’s depository institutions if the deficiencies persist. Federal regulations also provide that if any depository institution controlled by a financial holding company fails to maintain a satisfactory rating under the Community Reinvestment Act, the Federal Reserve must prohibit the financial holding company and its subsidiaries from engaging in any activities other than those permissible for bank holding companies. In addition, a financial holding company must obtain Federal Reserve approval before engaging in certain banking and other financial activities both in the U.S. and internationally, as further described under Regulation of acquisitions below.
Activities restrictions under the Volcker Rule. Section 619 of the Dodd-Frank Act (the “Volcker Rule”) prohibits banking entities, including the Firm, from engaging in certain “proprietary trading” activities, subject to exceptions for underwriting, market-making, risk-mitigating hedging and certain other activities. In addition, the Volcker Rule limits the sponsorship, and investment in, “covered funds” (as defined by the Rule) and imposes limits on certain transactions between the Firm and its sponsored funds (see Investment management regulation below). The Volcker Rule requires banking entities to establish comprehensive compliance programs designed to help ensure and monitor compliance with the restrictions under the Volcker Rule, including, in order to distinguish permissible from impermissible risk-taking activities, the measurement and monitoring of seven metrics. The Firm has taken significant steps to comply with the Volcker Rule. However, given the complexity of the new framework, and the fact that many provisions of the Rule still require further regulatory guidance, the full impact of the Volcker Rule is still uncertain and will ultimately depend on the interpretation and implementation by the five regulatory agencies responsible for its oversight.
Capital and liquidity requirements. The Federal Reserve establishes capital and leverage requirements for the Firm and evaluates its compliance with such capital requirements. The OCC establishes similar capital and leverage requirements for the Firm’s national banking subsidiaries. For more information about the applicable requirements relating to risk-based capital and leverage in the U.S. under the Basel Committee’s most recent capital framework (“Basel III”), see Regulatory capital on pages 146–153 and Note 28. It is likely that the banking supervisors will continue to refine and enhance the Basel III capital framework for financial institutions. Recent proposals being contemplated by the Basel Committee


2
 
 


include, among others, revisions to market risk capital for trading books, credit risk capital calculations, the measurement methodology to calculate counterparty credit risk and revisions to the securitization framework. After a proposal is finalized by the Basel Committee, U.S. banking regulators would then need to propose requirements applicable to U.S. financial institutions. Under Basel III, bank holding companies and banks are required to measure their liquidity against two specific liquidity tests: the liquidity coverage ratio (“LCR”) and the net stable funding ratio (“NSFR”). For additional information on these ratios, see Liquidity Risk Management on pages 156–160.
Stress tests. Pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, the Federal Reserve has adopted supervisory stress tests for large bank holding companies, including JPMorgan Chase, which form part of the Federal Reserve’s annual Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review (“CCAR”) framework. Under the framework, the Firm must conduct semi-annual company-run stress tests, and, in addition, must submit an annual capital plan to the Federal Reserve, taking into account the results of separate stress tests designed by the Firm and the Federal Reserve. In reviewing the Firm’s capital plan, the Federal Reserve will consider both quantitative and qualitative factors. Qualitative assessments will include (among other things) the comprehensiveness of the plan, the assumptions and analysis underlying the plan, and the extent to which the Firm has satisfied certain supervisory matters related to the Firm’s processes and analyses. Moreover, the Firm is required to receive a notice of non-objection from the Federal Reserve before taking capital actions, such as paying dividends, implementing common equity repurchase programs or redeeming or repurchasing capital instruments. The OCC requires JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. to perform separate, similar annual stress tests. The Firm publishes on its website each year, in July, the results of its mid-year stress tests under the Firm’s internally-developed “severely adverse” scenario and, in March, the results of its (and its two primary subsidiary banks) annual CCAR stress tests under the Federal Reserve’s “severely adverse” scenario. Commencing with the 2016 CCAR, the annual CCAR submission will be due April 5th. Results will be published by the Federal Reserve by June 30th, with disclosures of results by BHCs to follow within 15 days. Also commencing in 2016, the mid-cycle capital stress test submissions will be due October 5th and BHCs will publish results by November 4th.
For additional information on the Firm’s CCAR, see Regulatory capital on pages 146–153.
Enhanced prudential standards. The Dodd-Frank Act established a new oversight body, the Financial Stability Oversight Council (“FSOC”), which (among other things) recommends prudential standards, reporting and disclosure requirements to the Federal Reserve for systemically important financial institutions. BHCs with $50 billion or more in total consolidated assets, such as JPMorgan Chase, became automatically subject to the heightened prudential standards. The Federal Reserve has adopted several rules to
 
implement certain of the heightened prudential standards contemplated by the Dodd-Frank Act, including final rules relating to risk management and corporate governance of subject bank holding companies. Beginning January 1, 2015, the rules require BHCs with $50 billion or more in total consolidated assets to comply with enhanced liquidity and overall risk management standards, including a buffer of highly liquid assets based on projected funding needs for 30 days, and increased involvement by boards of directors in risk management. Several additional proposed rules are still being considered, including rules relating to single-counterparty credit limits and an “early remediation” framework to address financial distress or material management weaknesses.
Risk reporting. In January 2013, the Basel Committee issued new regulations relating to risk aggregation and reporting. Under these regulations, the banking institution’s risk governance framework must encompass risk-data aggregation and reporting, and data aggregation must be highly automated and allow for minimal manual intervention. The regulations also impose higher standards for the accuracy, comprehensiveness, granularity and timely distribution of data reporting, and call for regular supervisory review of the banking institution’s risk aggregation and reporting. Global systemically important banks (“G-SIBs”) will be required to comply with these new standards by January 1, 2016.
Orderly liquidation authority and other financial stability measures. As a BHC with assets of $50 billion or more, the Firm is required to submit annually to the Federal Reserve and the FDIC a plan for resolution under the Bankruptcy Code in the event of material distress or failure (a “resolution plan”). The FDIC also requires each insured depositary institution with $50 billion or more in assets to provide a resolution plan. For more information about the Firm’s resolution plan, see Risk Factors on pages 8–17. In addition, under the Dodd-Frank Act, certain financial companies, including JPMorgan Chase and certain of its subsidiaries, can be subjected to resolution under a new “orderly liquidation authority.” The U.S. Treasury Secretary, in consultation with the President of the United States, must first make certain extraordinary financial distress and systemic risk determinations, and action must be recommended by the FDIC and the Federal Reserve. Absent such actions, the Firm, as a BHC, would remain subject to resolution under the Bankruptcy Code. In December 2013, the FDIC released its “single point of entry” strategy for resolution of systemically important financial institutions under the orderly liquidation authority. This strategy seeks to keep operating subsidiaries of the BHC open and impose losses on shareholders and creditors of the holding company in receivership according to their statutory order of priority.
Regulators in the U.S. and abroad continue to be focused on measures to address “too big to fail,” and to provide safeguards so that, if a large financial institution does fail, it can be resolved without the use of public funds. Higher


 
 
3

Part I

capital surcharges on G-SIBs, requirements recently introduced by the Federal Reserve that certain large bank holding companies maintain a minimum amount of long-term debt to facilitate orderly resolution of those firms, and the recently adopted ISDA protocol relating to the “close-out” of derivatives transactions during the resolution of a large cross-border financial institution, are examples of initiatives to address “too big to fail.” For further information on the potential impact of the G-SIB framework and Total Loss Absorbing Capacity (“TLAC”), see Regulatory capital on pages 146–153, and on the ISDA close-out protocol, see Derivatives regulation below.
Holding company as source of strength for bank subsidiaries. JPMorgan Chase & Co. is required to serve as a source of financial strength for its depository institution subsidiaries and to commit resources to support those subsidiaries. This support may be required by the Federal Reserve at times when the Firm might otherwise determine not to provide it.
Regulation of acquisitions. Financial holding companies and bank holding companies are required to obtain the approval of the Federal Reserve before they may acquire more than 5% of the voting shares of an unaffiliated bank. In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act restricts acquisitions by financial companies if, as a result of the acquisition, the total liabilities of the financial company would exceed 10% of the total liabilities of all financial companies. This could have the effect of allowing a non-U.S. financial company to grow to hold significantly more than 10% of the U.S. market without exceeding the concentration limit. In addition, under the Dodd-Frank Act, the Firm must provide written notice to the Federal Reserve prior to acquiring direct or indirect ownership or control of any voting shares of any company with over $10 billion in assets that is engaged in activities that are “financial in nature”.
JPMorgan Chase’s subsidiary banks:
The Firm’s two primary subsidiary banks, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and Chase Bank USA, N.A., are FDIC-insured national banks regulated by the OCC. As national banks, the activities of JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and Chase Bank USA, N.A. are limited to those specifically authorized under the National Bank Act and related interpretations by the OCC.
FDIC deposit insurance. The FDIC deposit insurance fund provides insurance coverage for certain deposits, which is funded through assessments on banks, such as JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and Chase Bank USA, N.A. Changes in the methodology of the calculation of such assessments, resulting from the enactment of the Dodd-Frank Act, significantly increased the assessments the Firm’s bank subsidiaries pay annually to the FDIC, and future FDIC rule-making could further increase such assessments.
FDIC powers upon a bank insolvency. Upon the insolvency of an insured depository institution, such as JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., the FDIC may be appointed the conservator or receiver under the Federal Deposit Insurance Act (“FDIA”). In addition, as noted above, where a systemically important financial institution, such as JPMorgan Chase & Co., is in
 
default or danger of default, the FDIC may be appointed receiver in order to conduct an orderly liquidation. In both cases, the FDIC has broad powers to transfer any assets and liabilities without the approval of the institution’s creditors.
Cross-guarantee. An FDIC-insured depository institution can be held liable for any loss incurred or expected to be incurred by the FDIC in connection with another FDIC-insured institution under common control with such institution being “in default” or “in danger of default” (commonly referred to as “cross-guarantee” liability). An FDIC cross-guarantee claim against a depository institution is generally superior in right of payment to claims of the holding company and its affiliates against such depository institution.
Prompt corrective action and early remediation. The Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 requires the relevant federal banking regulator to take “prompt corrective action” with respect to a depository institution if that institution does not meet certain capital adequacy standards. While these regulations apply only to banks, such as JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and Chase Bank USA, N.A., the Federal Reserve is authorized to take appropriate action against the parent BHC, such as JPMorgan Chase & Co., based on the undercapitalized status of any bank subsidiary. In certain instances, the BHC would be required to guarantee the performance of the capital restoration plan for its undercapitalized subsidiary.
OCC Heightened Standards. The OCC has released final regulations and guidelines establishing heightened standards for large banks. The guidelines establish minimum standards for the design and implementation of a risk governance framework for banks. While the bank may use certain components of the parent company’s risk governance framework, the framework must ensure that the bank’s risk profile is easily distinguished and separate from the parent for risk management purposes. The bank’s board or risk committee is responsible for approving the bank’s risk governance framework, providing active oversight of the bank’s risk-taking activities and holding management accountable for adhering to the risk governance framework.
Restrictions on transactions with affiliates. The bank subsidiaries of JPMorgan Chase are subject to certain restrictions imposed by federal law on extensions of credit to, and certain other transactions with, JPMorgan Chase and certain other affiliates, and on investments in stock or securities of JPMorgan Chase and affiliates. These restrictions prevent JPMorgan Chase and other affiliates from borrowing from a bank subsidiary unless the loans are secured in specified amounts and are subject to certain other limits. For more information, see Note 27. Under the Dodd-Frank Act, these restrictions were extended to derivatives and securities lending transactions. In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act’s Volcker Rule imposes similar restrictions on transactions between banking entities, such as JPMorgan Chase and its subsidiaries, and hedge funds or


4
 
 


private equity funds for which the banking entity serves as the investment manager, investment advisor or sponsor.
Dividend restrictions. Federal law imposes limitations on the payment of dividends by national banks, such as JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and Chase Bank USA, N.A. See Note 27 for the amount of dividends that the Firm’s principal bank subsidiaries could pay, at January 1, 2015, to their respective bank holding companies without the approval of their banking regulators.
In addition to the dividend restrictions described above, the OCC, the Federal Reserve and the FDIC have authority to prohibit or limit the payment of dividends by the banking organizations they supervise, including JPMorgan Chase and its bank and BHC subsidiaries, if, in the banking regulator’s opinion, payment of a dividend would constitute an unsafe or unsound practice in light of the financial condition of the banking organization.
Depositor preference. Under federal law, the claims of a receiver of an insured depository institution for administrative expense and the claims of holders of U.S. deposit liabilities (including the FDIC) have priority over the claims of other unsecured creditors of the institution, including public noteholders and depositors in non-U.S. offices. As a result, such persons could receive substantially less than the depositors in U.S. offices of the depository institution. The U.K. Prudential Regulation Authority (the “PRA”) has issued a proposal that may require the Firm to either obtain equal treatment for U.K. depositors or “subsidiarize” in the U.K. In September 2013, the FDIC issued a final rule, which clarifies that foreign deposits are considered deposits under the FDIA only if they are also payable in the U.S.
CFPB regulation and supervision, and other consumer regulations. The CFPB has rulemaking, enforcement and examination authority over JPMorgan Chase and its national bank subsidiaries, including JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and Chase Bank USA, N.A., with respect to federal consumer protection laws, including laws relating to fair lending and the prohibition under the Dodd-Frank Act of unfair, deceptive or abusive acts or practices in connection with the offer, sale or provision of consumer financial products and services. These laws include the Truth-in-Lending, Equal Credit Opportunity (“ECOA”), Fair Credit Reporting, Fair Debt Collection Practice, Electronic Funds Transfer, Credit Card Accountability, Responsibility and Disclosure (“CARD”) and Home Mortgage Disclosure Acts. The CFPB also has authority to impose new disclosure requirements for any consumer financial product or service. The CFPB has issued informal guidance on a variety of topics (such as the collection of consumer debts and credit card marketing practices) and has taken enforcement actions against certain financial institutions. Much of the CFPB’s initial rulemaking efforts have addressed mortgage related topics, including ability-to-repay and qualified mortgage standards, mortgage servicing standards, loan originator compensation standards, high-cost mortgage requirements, Home Mortgage Disclosure Act requirements, appraisal and
 
escrow standards and requirements for higher-priced mortgages. Other areas of recent focus include “add-on” products, matters involving consumer populations considered vulnerable by the CFPB (such as students), and the furnishing of credit scores to individuals. The CFPB has been focused on automobile dealer discretionary interest rate markups, and on holding the Firm and other purchasers of such contracts (“indirect lenders”) responsible under the ECOA for statistical disparities in markups charged by the dealers to borrowers of different races or ethnicities. The Firm has adopted programs to address these risks, including an active dealer education, monitoring and review programs.
The activities of JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and Chase Bank USA, N.A. as consumer lenders also are subject to regulation under various state statutes which are enforced by the respective state’s Attorney General.
Securities and broker-dealer regulation:
The Firm conducts securities underwriting, dealing and brokerage activities in the U.S. through J.P. Morgan Securities LLC and other broker-dealer subsidiaries, all of which are subject to regulations of the SEC, the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority and the New York Stock Exchange, among others. The Firm conducts similar securities activities outside the U.S. subject to local regulatory requirements. In the United Kingdom, those activities are conducted by J.P. Morgan Securities plc, which is regulated by the PRA (a subsidiary of the Bank of England which has responsibility for prudential regulation of banks and other systemically important institutions) and the Financial Conduct Authority (“FCA”) (which regulates prudential matters for other firms and conduct matters for all market participants). Broker-dealers are subject to laws and regulations covering all aspects of the securities business, including sales and trading practices, securities offerings, publication of research reports, use of customer’s funds, the financing of clients’ purchases, capital structure, record-keeping and retention, and the conduct of their directors, officers and employees. For information on the net capital of J.P. Morgan Securities LLC and J.P. Morgan Clearing Corp., and the applicable requirements relating to risk-based capital for J.P. Morgan Securities plc, see Regulatory capital on pages 146–153. Future rule-making mandated by the Dodd-Frank Act will involve (among other things) the standard of care applicable to broker-dealers when dealing with retail customers and additional requirements regarding securitization practices.
Investment management regulation:
The Firm’s investment management business is subject to significant regulation in numerous jurisdictions around the world relating to, among other things, the safeguarding of client assets, offerings of funds, marketing activities, transactions among affiliates and management of client funds. Certain of the Firm’s subsidiaries are registered with, and subject to oversight by, the SEC as investment advisers. As such, the Firm’s registered investment advisers are subject to the fiduciary and other obligations imposed


 
 
5

Part I

under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940 and the rules and regulations promulgated thereunder, as well as various states securities laws. The Firm’s asset management business continues to be affected by ongoing rule-making. In July 2013, the SEC adopted amendments to rules that govern money-market funds, requiring a floating net asset value for institutional prime money market funds. Many of the Volcker Rule regulations regarding “covered funds”, and their impact on the Firm’s asset management activities, particularly the seeding of foreign public funds and the criteria for establishing foreign public funds status, await further guidance from the regulators.
Derivatives regulation:
Under the Dodd-Frank Act, the Firm is subject to comprehensive regulation of its derivatives business. The regulations impose capital and margin requirements, require central clearing of standardized over-the-counter derivatives, require that they be traded on regulated exchanges or execution facilities, and provide for reporting of certain mandated information. In addition, the Act requires the registration of “swap dealers” and “major swap participants” with the CFTC and of “security-based swap dealers” and “major security-based swap participants” with the SEC. JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, J.P. Morgan Securities plc and J.P. Morgan Ventures Energy Corporation have registered with the CFTC as swap dealers, and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., J.P. Morgan Securities LLC and J.P. Morgan Securities plc have registered with the SEC as security-based swap dealers. As a result of such registration, these entities will be subject to, in addition to new capital requirements, new rules limiting the types of swap activities that may be engaged in by bank entities, a new margin regime for uncleared swaps, new rules regarding segregation of customer collateral, and business conduct and documentation standards with respect to other swaps counterparties, record-keeping and reporting obligations, and anti-fraud and anti-manipulation requirements related to their swaps activities. Further, some of the rules for derivatives apply extraterritorially to U.S. firms doing business with clients outside of the U.S.; however the full scope of the extra-territorial impact of the U.S. swaps regulation remains unclear. The effect of the rules issued under the Dodd-Frank Act will necessitate banking entities, such as the Firm, to modify the structure of their derivatives businesses and face increased operational and regulatory costs. In the European Union (the “EU”), the implementation of the European Market Infrastructure Regulation (“EMIR”) and the revision of the Markets in Financial Instruments Directive (“MiFID II”) will result in comparable, but not identical, changes to the European regulatory regime for derivatives. The combined effect of the U.S. and EU requirements, and the potential conflicts and inconsistencies between them, present challenges and risks to the structure and operating model of the Firm’s derivatives businesses.
The Firm, along with 17 other financial institutions, agreed in November 2014 to adhere to the Resolution Stay Protocol developed by the International Swaps and
 
Derivatives Association, Inc. in response to regulator concerns that the closeout of derivatives transactions during the resolution of a large cross-border financial institution could impede resolution efforts and potentially destabilize markets. The Resolution Stay Protocol provides for the contractual recognition of cross-border stays under various statutory resolution regimes and a contractual stay on certain cross-default rights.
In the U.S., two subsidiaries of the Firm are registered as futures commission merchants, and other subsidiaries are either registered with the CFTC as commodity pool operators and commodity trading advisors or exempt from such registration. These CFTC-registered subsidiaries are also members of the National Futures Association. The Firm’s financial commodities business is subject to regulation by the Federal Energy Regulatory Commission.
Data regulation:
The Firm and its subsidiaries also are subject to federal, state and international laws and regulations concerning the use and protection of certain customer, employee and other personal and confidential information, including those imposed by the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act and the Fair Credit Reporting Act, as well as the EU Data Protection Directive, among others. The Firm was the victim of a cyberattack in 2014 that compromised user contact information for certain customers. For more information relating to this cyberattack, see Operational Risk Management on pages 141–143.
The Bank Secrecy Act:
The Bank Secrecy Act (“BSA”) requires all financial institutions, including banks and securities broker-dealers, to, among other things, establish a risk-based system of internal controls reasonably designed to prevent money laundering and the financing of terrorism. The BSA includes a variety of record-keeping and reporting requirements (such as cash transaction and suspicious activity reporting), as well as due diligence/know-your-customer documentation requirements. The Firm has established a global anti-money laundering program in order to comply with BSA requirements. In January 2013, the Firm entered into Consent Orders with its banking regulators relating to the Firm’s Bank Secrecy Act/Anti-Money Laundering policies, procedures and controls; the Firm has taken significant steps to modify and enhance its processes and controls with respect to its Anti-Money Laundering procedures and to remediate the issues identified in the Consent Order.
Anti-Corruption:
The Firm is subject to laws and regulations in the jurisdictions in which it operates, such as the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act and the U.K. Bribery Act, relating to corrupt and illegal payments to government officials and others. The Firm has implemented policies, procedures, and internal controls that are designed to comply with such laws and regulations. Any failure with respect to the Firm’s programs in this area could subject the Firm to substantial liability and regulatory fines. For more information on a


6
 
 


current investigation relating to, among other things, the Firm's hiring of persons referred by government officials and clients, see Note 31.
Compensation practices:
The Firm’s compensation practices are subject to oversight by the Federal Reserve, as well as other agencies. The Federal Reserve has issued guidance jointly with the FDIC and the OCC that is designed to ensure that incentive compensation paid by banking organizations does not encourage imprudent risk-taking that threatens the organizations’ safety and soundness. In addition, under the Dodd-Frank Act, federal regulators, including the Federal Reserve, must issue regulations requiring covered financial institutions, including the Firm, to report the structure of all of their incentive-based compensation arrangements and prohibit incentive-based payment arrangements that encourage inappropriate risks by providing compensation that is excessive or that could lead to material financial loss to the entity. The Federal Reserve has conducted a review of the incentive compensation policies and practices of a number of large banking institutions, including the Firm, and the supervisory findings of such review are incorporated in the Firm’s supervisory ratings. In addition to the Federal Reserve, the Financial Stability Board has agreed standards covering compensation principles for banks. In Europe, the Fourth Capital Requirements Directive (CRD IV) includes compensation provisions. In the U.K., compensation standards are governed by the Remuneration Code of the PRA and the FCA. The implementation of the Federal Reserve’s and other banking regulators’ guidelines regarding compensation are expected to evolve over the next several years, and may affect the manner in which the Firm structures its compensation.
Significant international regulatory initiatives:
The EU operates a European Systemic Risk Board which monitors financial stability, together with a framework of European Supervisory Agencies which oversees the regulation of financial institutions across the 28 Member States. The EU has also created a Single Supervisory Mechanism for the euro-zone, under which the regulation of all banks in that zone will be under the auspices of the European Central Bank, together with a Single Resolution Mechanism and Single Resolution Board, having jurisdiction over bank resolution in the zone. In addition, the Group of Twenty Finance Ministers and Central Bank Governors (“G-20”) formed the FSB. At both G-20 and EU levels, various proposals are under consideration to address risks associated with global financial institutions. Some of the initiatives adopted include increased capital requirements for certain trading instruments or exposures and compensation limits on certain employees located in affected countries.
In the EU, there is an extensive and complex program of final and proposed regulatory enhancement which reflects, in part, the EU’s commitments to policies of the G-20 together with other plans specific to the EU. This program includes EMIR, which will require, among other things, the
 
central clearing of standardized derivatives and which will be phased in by 2015; and MiFID II, which gives effect to the G-20 commitment to trading of derivatives through central clearing houses and exchanges and also includes significantly enhanced requirements for pre- and post-trade transparency and a significant reconfiguration of the regulatory supervision of execution venues.
The EU is also currently considering or executing upon significant revisions to laws covering: depositary activities; credit rating activities; resolution of banks, investment firms and market infrastructures; anti-money-laundering controls; data security and privacy; and corporate governance in financial firms, together with implementation in the EU of the Basel III capital standards.
Following the issuance of the Report of the High Level Expert Group on Reforming the Structure of the EU Banking Sector (the “Liikanen Group”), the EU has proposed legislation providing for a proprietary trading ban and mandatory separation of other trading activities within certain banks, while various EU Member States have separately enacted similar measures. In the U.K., the Independent Commission on Banking (the “Vickers Commission”) proposed certain provisions, which have now been enacted by Parliament and upon which detailed implementing requirements are expected to be finalized during 2015, that mandate the separation (or “ring-fencing”) of deposit-taking activities from securities trading and other analogous activities within banks, subject to certain exemptions. The legislation includes the supplemental recommendation of the Parliamentary Commission on Banking Standards (the “Tyrie Commission”) that such ring-fences should be “electrified” by the imposition of mandatory forced separation on banking institutions that are deemed to test the limits of the safeguards. Parallel but distinct provisions have been enacted by the French and German governments, and others are under consideration in other countries. These measures may separately or taken together have significant implications for the Firm’s organizational structure in Europe, as well as its permitted activities and capital deployment in the EU.


 
 
7

Part I

Item 1A: RISK FACTORS
The following discussion sets forth the material risk factors that could affect JPMorgan Chase’s financial condition and operations. Readers should not consider any descriptions of such factors to be a complete set of all potential risks that could affect the Firm.
Regulatory Risk
JPMorgan Chase operates within a highly regulated industry, and the Firm’s businesses and results are significantly affected by the laws and regulations to which the Firm is subject.
As a global financial services firm, JPMorgan Chase is subject to extensive and comprehensive regulation under federal and state laws in the U.S. and the laws of the various jurisdictions outside the U.S. in which the Firm does business. These laws and regulations significantly affect the way that the Firm does business, and can restrict the scope of the Firm’s existing businesses, limit the Firm’s ability to expand the products and services that it offers or make its products and services more expensive for clients and customers.
The financial services industry continues to experience an unprecedented increase in regulations and supervision, and such changes could have a significant impact on how the Firm conducts business. Significant and comprehensive new legislation and regulations affecting the financial services industry have been adopted or proposed in recent years, both in the U.S. and globally. The Firm continues to make appropriate adjustments to its business and operations, legal entity structure and capital and liquidity management policies, procedures and controls to comply with these new laws and regulations. However, the cumulative effect of all of the new and proposed legislation and regulations on the Firm’s business, operations and profitability remains uncertain.
The recent legislative and regulatory developments, as well as future legislative or regulatory actions in the U.S. and in the other countries in which the Firm operates, and any required changes to the Firm’s business or operations resulting from such developments and actions, could result in a significant loss of revenue for the Firm, impose additional compliance and other costs on the Firm or otherwise reduce the Firm’s profitability, limit the products and services that the Firm offers or its ability to pursue business opportunities in which it might otherwise consider engaging, require the Firm to dispose of or curtail certain businesses, affect the value of assets that the Firm holds, require the Firm to increase its prices and therefore reduce demand for its products, or otherwise adversely affect the Firm’s businesses.
Non-U.S. regulations and initiatives may be inconsistent or may conflict with current or proposed regulations in the U.S., which could create increased compliance and other costs and adversely affect JPMorgan Chase’s business, operations or profitability.
 
There can be significant differences in the ways that similar regulatory initiatives affecting the financial services industry are implemented in different countries and regions in which JPMorgan Chase does business. For example, recent EU legislative and regulatory initiatives, including those relating to the resolution of financial institutions, the proposed separation of trading activities from core banking services, mandatory on-exchange trading, position limits and reporting rules for derivatives, conduct of business requirements and restrictions on compensation, could require the Firm to make significant modifications to its non-U.S. business, operations and legal entity structure in order to comply with these requirements. These differences in implemented or proposed non-U.S. regulations and initiatives may be inconsistent or may conflict with current or proposed regulations in the U.S., which could subject the Firm to increased compliance and legal costs, as well as higher operational, capital and liquidity costs, all of which could have an adverse effect on the Firm’s business, results of operations and profitability.
Expanded regulatory and governmental oversight of JPMorgan Chase’s businesses will continue to increase the Firm’s costs and risks.
The Firm’s businesses and operations are increasingly subject to heightened governmental and regulatory oversight and scrutiny. The Firm has paid significant fines (or has provided significant monetary and other relief) to resolve a number of investigations or enforcement actions by governmental agencies. In addition, the Firm continues to devote substantial resources to satisfying the requirements of regulatory consent orders and other settlements to which it is subject, including enhancing its procedures and controls, expanding its risk and control functions within its lines of business, investing in technology and hiring significant numbers of additional risk, control and compliance personnel, all of which have increased the Firm’s operational and compliance costs.
If the Firm fails to meet the requirements of the regulatory settlements to which it is subject, or more generally, to maintain risk and control procedures and processes that meet the heightened standards established by its regulators and other government agencies, it could be required to enter into further orders and settlements, pay additional fines, penalties or judgments, or accept material regulatory restrictions on its businesses. The extent of the Firm’s exposure to legal and regulatory matters may be unpredictable and could, in some cases, substantially exceed the amount of reserves that the Firm has established for such matters.
The Firm expects that it and the financial services industry as a whole will continue to be subject to heightened regulatory scrutiny and governmental investigations and enforcement actions and that violations of law will more frequently be met with formal and punitive enforcement action, including the imposition of significant monetary and other sanctions, rather than with informal supervisory action.


8
 
 


In addition, certain regulators have announced policies, or taken measures in connection with specific enforcement actions, which make it more likely that the Firm and other financial institutions may be required to admit wrongdoing in connection with settling such matters. Such admissions can lead to, among other things, greater exposure in civil litigation and reputational harm.
Finally, U.S. government officials have indicated and demonstrated a willingness to bring criminal actions against financial institutions, and have increasingly sought, and obtained, resolutions that include criminal pleas from those institutions. Such resolutions can have significant collateral consequences for a subject financial institution, including loss of customers and business and (absent the forbearance of, or the granting of waivers by, applicable regulators) the inability to offer certain products or services or operate certain businesses for a period of time.
Requirements for the orderly resolution of the Firm under the Dodd-Frank Act could require JPMorgan Chase to restructure or reorganize its businesses or make costly changes to its capital or funding structure.
Under Title I of the Dodd-Frank Act (“Title I”) and Federal Reserve and FDIC rules, the Firm is required to prepare and submit periodically to the Federal Reserve and the FDIC a detailed plan for the orderly resolution of JPMorgan Chase & Co. and certain of its subsidiaries under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code or other applicable insolvency laws in the event of future material financial distress or failure. In July 2014, the Firm submitted its third Title I resolution plan to the Federal Reserve and FDIC (the “2014 plan”). In August 2014, the Federal Reserve and the FDIC announced the completion of their reviews of the second round of Title I resolution plans submitted by eleven large, complex banking organizations (the “first wave filers”) in 2013, including the Firm’s Title I resolution plan submitted in 2013 (the “2013 plan”). Although the agencies noted some improvements from the original plans submitted by the first wave filers in 2012, the agencies also jointly identified specific shortcomings with the 2013 resolution plans, including the Firm’s 2013 plan, that will need to be addressed in 2015 submissions if not already addressed in the Firm’s 2014 plan. In addition, the FDIC board of directors determined under Title I that the 2013 resolution plans submitted by the first wave filers, including the Firm’s 2013 plan, are not credible and do not facilitate an orderly resolution under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code (although the Federal Reserve Board did not make such a determination). The Federal Reserve Board determined that the first wave filers must take immediate action to improve their resolvability and reflect those improvements in their 2015 submissions.
If the Federal Reserve Board and the FDIC were to jointly determine that the Firm’s Title I resolution plan, or any future update of that plan, is not credible, and the Firm is unable to remedy the identified deficiencies in a timely manner, the regulators may jointly impose more stringent capital, leverage or liquidity requirements on the Firm or
 
restrictions on growth, activities or operations of the Firm, and could require the Firm to restructure, reorganize or divest businesses, legal entities, operational systems and/or intercompany transactions in ways that could materially and adversely affect the Firm’s operations and strategy. In addition, in order to develop a Title I resolution plan that the Federal Reserve Board and FDIC determine is credible, the Firm may need to take actions to restructure intercompany and external activities, which could result in increased funding or operational costs.
In addition to the Firm’s plan for orderly resolution, the Firm’s resolution plan also recommends to the Federal Reserve and the FDIC its proposed optimal strategy to resolve the Firm under the special resolution procedure provided in Title II of the Dodd-Frank Act (“Title II”). The Firm’s recommendation for its optimal Title II strategy would involve a “single point of entry” recapitalization model in which the FDIC would use its power to create a “bridge entity” for JPMorgan Chase, transfer the systemically important and viable parts of the Firm’s business, principally the stock of JPMorgan Chase & Co.’s main operating subsidiaries and any intercompany claims against such subsidiaries, to the bridge entity, recapitalize those businesses by contributing some or all of such intercompany claims to the capital of such subsidiaries, and by exchanging debt claims against JPMorgan Chase & Co. for equity in the bridge entity. The Federal Reserve is also expected to propose rules regarding the minimum levels of unsecured long-term debt and other loss absorbing capacity that bank holding companies would be required to have issued and outstanding, as well as guidelines defining the terms of qualifying debt instruments, to ensure that adequate levels of debt are maintained at the holding company level for purposes of recapitalization. Issuing debt in the amounts that would be required under these proposed rules could lead to increased funding costs for the Firm. In addition, if the Firm were to be resolved under its recommended Title II strategy, no assurance can be given that the value of the stock of the bridge entity distributed to the holders of debt obligations of JPMorgan Chase & Co. would be sufficient to repay or satisfy all or part of the principal amount of, and interest on, the debt obligations for which such stock was exchanged.
Market Risk
JPMorgan Chase’s results of operations have been, and may continue to be, adversely affected by U.S. and international financial market and economic conditions.
JPMorgan Chase’s businesses are materially affected by economic and market conditions, including the liquidity of the global financial markets; the level and volatility of debt and equity prices, interest rates and currency and commodities prices; investor sentiment; events that reduce confidence in the financial markets; inflation and unemployment; the availability and cost of capital and credit; the economic effects of natural disasters, severe weather conditions, outbreaks of hostilities or terrorism; monetary policies and actions taken by the Federal Reserve


 
 
9

Part I

and other central banks; and the health of the U.S. and global economies. These conditions can affect the Firm’s businesses both directly and through their impact on the businesses and activities of the Firm’s clients and customers.
In the Firm’s underwriting and advisory businesses, the above-mentioned factors can affect the volume of transactions that the Firm executes for its clients and customers and, therefore, the revenue that the Firm receives from fees and commissions, as well as the willingness of other financial institutions and investors to participate in loan syndications or underwritings managed by the Firm.
The Firm generally maintains extensive market-making positions in the fixed income, currency, commodities, credit and equity markets to facilitate client demand and provide liquidity to clients. The revenue derived from these positions is affected by many factors, including the Firm’s success in effectively hedging its market and other risks; volatility in interest rates and equity, debt and commodities markets; interest rate and credit spreads; and the availability of liquidity in the capital markets, all of which are affected by global economic and market conditions. Certain of the Firm’s market-making positions could be adversely affected by the lack of pricing transparency or liquidity, which will be influenced by many of these factors. The Firm anticipates that revenue relating to its market-making businesses will continue to experience volatility, which will affect the Firm’s ability to realize returns from such activities and could adversely affect the Firm’s earnings.
The fees that the Firm earns for managing third-party assets are also dependent upon general economic conditions. For example, a higher level of U.S. or non-U.S. interest rates or a downturn in financial markets could affect the valuations of the third-party assets that the Firm manages or holds in custody, which, in turn, could affect the Firm’s revenue. Macroeconomic or market concerns may also prompt outflows from the Firm’s funds or accounts.
Changes in interest rates will affect the level of assets and liabilities held on the Firm’s balance sheet and the revenue that the Firm earns from net interest income. A low interest rate environment has and may continue to have an adverse effect on certain of the Firm’s businesses by compressing net interest margins, reducing the amounts that the Firm earns on its investment securities portfolio, or reducing the value of its mortgage servicing rights (“MSR”) asset, thereby reducing the Firm’s net interest income and other revenues. Conversely, increasing or high interest rates may result in increased funding costs, lower levels of commercial and residential loan originations and diminished returns on the available-for-sale investment securities portfolio (to the extent that the Firm is unable to reinvest contemporaneously in higher-yielding assets), thereby adversely affecting the Firm’s revenues and capital levels.
The Firm’s consumer businesses are particularly affected by U.S. domestic economic conditions, including U.S. interest
 
rates; the rate of unemployment; housing prices; the level of consumer confidence; changes in consumer spending; and the number of personal bankruptcies. If the current positive trends in the U.S. economy are not sustained, this could diminish demand for the products and services of the Firm’s consumer businesses, or increase the cost to provide such products and services. In addition, adverse economic conditions, such as declines in home prices or persistent high levels of unemployment, could lead to an increase in mortgage, credit card, auto, student and other loan delinquencies and higher net charge-offs, which can reduce the Firm’s earnings.
Widening of credit spreads makes it more expensive for the Firm to borrow on both a secured and unsecured basis. Credit spreads widen or narrow not only in response to Firm-specific events and circumstances, but also as a result of general economic and geopolitical events and conditions. Changes in the Firm’s credit spreads will impact, positively or negatively, the Firm’s earnings on liabilities that are recorded at fair value.
Sudden and significant volatility in the prices of securities and other assets (including loan and derivatives) may curtail the trading markets for such securities and assets, make it difficult to sell or hedge such securities and assets, adversely affect the Firm’s profitability, capital or liquidity, or increase the Firm’s funding costs. Sustained volatility in the financial markets may also negatively affect consumer or investor confidence, which could lead to lower client activity and decreased fee-based income for the Firm.
Credit Risk
The financial condition of JPMorgan Chase’s customers, clients and counterparties, particularly other financial institutions, could adversely affect the Firm.
Financial services institutions are interrelated as a result of market-making, trading, clearing, counterparty or other relationships. The Firm routinely executes transactions with counterparties in the financial services industry, including brokers and dealers, commercial banks, investment banks, mutual and hedge funds, investment managers and other institutional clients. Many of these transactions expose the Firm to credit risk and, in some cases, disputes and litigation in the event of a default by the counterparty or client. In recent years, the perceived interrelationship among financial institutions has also led to claims by other market participants and regulators that the Firm and other financial institutions have allegedly violated anti-trust or anti-competition laws by colluding to manipulate markets, prices or indices.
The Firm is a market leader in providing clearing and custodial services, and also acts as a clearing and custody bank in the securities and repurchase transaction market, including the U.S. tri-party repurchase transaction market. Many of these services expose the Firm to credit risk in the event of a default by the counterparty or client, a central counterparty (“CCP”) or another market participant.


10
 
 


As part of providing clearing services, the Firm is a member of a number of CCPs, and may be required to pay a portion of the losses incurred by such organizations as a result of the default of other members. As a clearing member, the Firm is also exposed to the risk of non-performance by its clients, which it seeks to mitigate through the maintenance of adequate collateral. In its role as custodian bank in the securities and repurchase transaction market, the Firm can be exposed to intra-day credit risk of its clients. If a client to which the Firm provides such services becomes bankrupt or insolvent, the Firm may become involved in disputes and litigation with various parties, including one or more CCPs, the client’s bankruptcy estate and other creditors, or involved in regulatory investigations. All of such events can increase the Firm’s operational and litigation costs and may result in losses if any collateral received by the Firm declines in value.
During periods of market stress or illiquidity, the Firm’s credit risk also may be further increased when the Firm cannot realize the fair value of the collateral held by it or when collateral is liquidated at prices that are not sufficient to recover the full amount of the loan, derivative or other exposure due to the Firm. Further, disputes with obligors as to the valuation of collateral could increase in times of significant market stress, volatility or illiquidity, and the Firm could suffer losses during such periods if it is unable to realize the fair value of collateral or manage declines in the value of collateral.
Concentration of credit and market risk could increase the potential for significant losses.
JPMorgan Chase has exposure to increased levels of risk when customers are engaged in similar business activities or activities in the same geographic region, or when they have similar economic features that would cause their ability to meet contractual obligations to be similarly affected by changes in economic conditions. As a result, the Firm regularly monitors various segments of its portfolio exposures to assess potential concentration risks. The Firm’s efforts to diversify or hedge its credit portfolio against concentration risks may not be successful.
In addition, disruptions in the liquidity or transparency of the financial markets may result in the Firm’s inability to sell, syndicate or realize the value of its positions, thereby leading to increased concentrations. The inability to reduce the Firm’s positions may not only increase the market and credit risks associated with such positions, but may also increase the level of risk-weighted assets on the Firm’s balance sheet, thereby increasing its capital requirements and funding costs, all of which could adversely affect the operations and profitability of the Firm’s businesses.
Liquidity Risk
If JPMorgan Chase does not effectively manage its liquidity, its business could suffer.
JPMorgan Chase’s liquidity is critical to its ability to operate its businesses. Some potential conditions that could impair the Firm’s liquidity include markets that become illiquid or
 
are otherwise experiencing disruption, unforeseen cash or capital requirements (including, among others, commitments that may be triggered to special purpose entities (“SPEs”) or other entities), difficulty in selling or inability to sell assets, unforeseen outflows of cash or collateral, and lack of market or customer confidence in the Firm or financial markets in general. These conditions may be caused by events over which the Firm has little or no control. The widespread crisis in investor confidence and resulting liquidity crisis experienced in 2008 and into early 2009 increased the Firm’s cost of funding and limited its access to some of its traditional sources of liquidity (such as securitized debt offerings backed by mortgages, credit card receivables and other assets) during that time, and there is no assurance that these severe conditions could not occur in the future.
If the Firm’s access to stable and low cost sources of funding, such as bank deposits, is reduced, the Firm may need to raise alternative funding which may be more expensive or of limited availability. In addition, regulations regarding the amount and types of securities that the Firm may use to satisfy applicable liquidity coverage ratio and net stable funding ratio requirements may also affect the Firm’s cost of funding.
As a holding company, JPMorgan Chase & Co. relies on the earnings of its subsidiaries for its cash flow and, consequently, its ability to pay dividends and satisfy its debt and other obligations. These payments by subsidiaries may take the form of dividends, loans or other payments. Several of JPMorgan Chase & Co.’s principal subsidiaries are subject to dividend distribution, capital adequacy or liquidity coverage requirements or other regulatory restrictions on their ability to provide such payments. Limitations in the payments that JPMorgan Chase & Co. receives from its subsidiaries could reduce its ability to pay dividends and satisfy its debt and other obligations.
Regulators in some countries in which the Firm has operations have proposed legislation or regulations requiring large banks to conduct certain businesses through separate subsidiaries in those countries, and to maintain independent capital and liquidity for such subsidiaries. If adopted, these requirements could hinder the Firm’s ability to efficiently manage its funding and liquidity in a centralized manner.
Reductions in JPMorgan Chase’s credit ratings may adversely affect its liquidity and cost of funding, as well as the value of debt obligations issued by the Firm.
JPMorgan Chase & Co. and certain of its principal subsidiaries are currently rated by credit rating agencies. Rating agencies evaluate both general and firm- and industry-specific factors when determining their credit ratings for a particular financial institution, including economic and geopolitical trends, regulatory developments, future profitability, risk management practices, legal expenses, assumptions surrounding government support and ratings differentials between bank holding companies and their bank subsidiaries. Although the Firm closely


 
 
11

Part I

monitors and manages, to the extent it is able, factors that could influence its credit ratings, there is no assurance that the Firm’s credit ratings will not be lowered in the future, or that any such downgrade would not occur at times of broader market instability when the Firm’s options for responding to events may be more limited and general investor confidence is low.
Furthermore, a reduction in the Firm’s credit ratings could reduce the Firm’s access to capital markets, materially increase the cost of issuing securities, trigger additional collateral or funding requirements, and decrease the number of investors and counterparties willing or permitted, contractually or otherwise, to do business with or lend to the Firm, thereby curtailing the Firm’s business operations and reducing its profitability. In addition, any such reduction in credit ratings may increase the credit spreads charged by the market for taking credit risk on JPMorgan Chase & Co. and its subsidiaries and, as a result, could adversely affect the value of debt and other obligations that JPMorgan Chase & Co. and its subsidiaries have issued or may issue in the future.
Legal Risk
JPMorgan Chase faces significant legal risks, both from regulatory investigations and proceedings and from private actions brought against the Firm.
JPMorgan Chase is named as a defendant or is otherwise involved in various legal proceedings, including class actions and other litigation or disputes with third parties. Actions currently pending against the Firm may result in judgments, settlements, fines, penalties or other results adverse to the Firm, which could materially and adversely affect the Firm’s business, financial condition or results of operations, or cause serious reputational harm to the Firm. As a participant in the financial services industry, it is likely that the Firm will continue to experience a high level of litigation related to its businesses and operations.
In addition, and as noted above, the Firm’s businesses and operations are also subject to heightened regulatory oversight and scrutiny, which may lead to additional regulatory investigations or enforcement actions. As the regulators and other government agencies continue to examine the operations of the Firm and its subsidiaries, there is no assurance that they will not pursue additional regulatory settlements or other enforcement actions against the Firm in the future. A single event may give rise to numerous and overlapping investigations and proceedings, either by multiple federal and state agencies and officials in the U.S. or, in some instances, regulators and other governmental officials in non-U.S. jurisdictions. These and other initiatives from U.S. and non-U.S. governmental authorities and officials may subject the Firm to further judgments, settlements, fines or penalties, or cause the Firm to be required to restructure its operations and activities or to cease offering certain products or services, all of which could harm the Firm’s reputation or lead to
 
higher operational costs, thereby reducing the Firm’s profitability.
Other Business Risks
JPMorgan Chase’s operations are subject to risk of loss from unfavorable economic, monetary and political developments in the U.S. and around the world.
JPMorgan Chase’s businesses and earnings are affected by the fiscal and other policies that are adopted by various U.S. and non-U.S. regulatory authorities and agencies. The Federal Reserve regulates the supply of money and credit in the U.S. and its policies determine in large part the cost of funds for lending and investing in the U.S. and the return earned on those loans and investments. Changes in Federal Reserve policies (as well as the fiscal and monetary policies of non-U.S. central banks or regulatory authorities and agencies, such as “pegging” the exchange rate of their currency to the currencies of others) are beyond the Firm’s control and may be difficult to predict, and consequently, unanticipated changes in these policies could have a negative impact on the Firm’s activities and results of operations.
The Firm’s businesses and revenue are also subject to risks inherent in investing and market-making in securities, loans and other obligations of companies worldwide. These risks include, among others, negative effects from slowing growth rates or recessionary economic conditions, or the risk of loss from unfavorable political, legal or other developments, including social or political instability, in the countries in which such companies operate, as well as the other risks and considerations as described further below.
Several of the Firm’s businesses engage in transactions with, or trade in obligations of, U.S. and non-U.S. governmental entities, including national, state, provincial, municipal and local authorities. These activities can expose the Firm to enhanced sovereign, credit-related, operational and reputational risks, including the risks that a governmental entity may default on or restructure its obligations or may claim that actions taken by government officials were beyond the legal authority of those officials, which could adversely affect the Firm’s financial condition and results of operations.
Further, various countries in which the Firm operates or invests, or in which the Firm may do so in the future, have in the past experienced severe economic disruptions particular to those countries or regions. The ongoing crisis in Russia and impact of sanctions, coupled with sharp oil price declines, a potential slowdown in the macroeconomic prospects in China, and concerns about potential economic weaknesses in the Eurozone (including the permanent resolution of the Greek “bailout” program), could undermine investor confidence and affect the operating environment in 2015. In some cases, concerns regarding the fiscal condition of one or more countries can cause a contraction of available credit and reduced activity among trading partners or create market volatility that could lead to “market contagion” affecting other countries in the same


12
 
 


region or beyond the region. Accordingly, it is possible that economic disruptions in certain countries, even in countries in which the Firm does not conduct business or have operations or engages in only limited activities, will adversely affect the Firm.
JPMorgan Chase’s operations in emerging markets may be hindered by local political, social and economic factors, and will be subject to additional compliance costs and risks.
Some of the countries in which JPMorgan Chase conducts its wholesale businesses have economies or markets that are less developed and more volatile, and may have legal and regulatory regimes that are less established or predictable, than the U.S. and other developed markets in which the Firm currently operates. Some of these countries have in the past experienced severe economic disruptions, including extreme currency fluctuations, high inflation, or low or negative growth, among other negative conditions, or have imposed restrictive monetary policies such as currency exchange controls and other laws and restrictions that adversely affect the local and regional business environment. In addition, these countries have historically been more susceptible to unfavorable political, social or economic developments which have in the past resulted in, and may in the future lead to, social unrest, general strikes and demonstrations, outbreaks of hostilities, overthrow of incumbent governments, terrorist attacks or other forms of internal discord, all of which can adversely affect the Firm’s operations or investments in such countries. Political, social or economic disruption or dislocation in certain countries or regions in which the Firm conducts its wholesale businesses can hinder the growth and profitability of those operations.
Less developed legal and regulatory systems in certain countries can also have adverse consequences on the Firm’s operations in those countries, including, among others, the absence of a statutory or regulatory basis or guidance for engaging in specific types of business or transactions; the promulgation of conflicting or ambiguous laws and regulations or the inconsistent application or interpretation of existing laws and regulations; uncertainty as to the enforceability of contractual obligations; difficulty in competing in economies in which the government controls or protects all or a portion of the local economy or specific businesses, or where graft or corruption may be pervasive; and the threat of arbitrary regulatory investigations, civil litigations or criminal prosecutions.
Revenue from international operations and trading in non-U.S. securities and other obligations may be subject to negative fluctuations as a result of the above considerations, as well as due to governmental actions including expropriation, nationalization, confiscation of assets, price controls, capital controls, exchange controls, and changes in laws and regulations. The impact of these fluctuations could be accentuated as some trading markets are smaller, less liquid and more volatile than larger markets. Also, any of the above-mentioned events or circumstances in one country can affect, and in the past
 
conditions of these types have affected, the Firm’s operations and investments in another country or countries, including the Firm’s operations in the U.S. As a result, any such unfavorable conditions or developments could have an adverse impact on the Firm’s business and results of operations.
Conducting business in countries with less developed legal and regulatory regimes often requires the Firm to devote significant additional resources to understanding, and monitoring changes in, local laws and regulations, as well as structuring its operations to comply with local laws and regulations and implementing and administering related internal policies and procedures. There can be no assurance that the Firm will always be successful in its efforts to conduct its business in compliance with laws and regulations in countries with less predictable legal and regulatory systems. In addition, the Firm can also incur higher costs, and face greater compliance risks, in structuring and operating its businesses outside the U.S. to comply with U.S. anti-corruption and anti-money laundering laws and regulations.
JPMorgan Chase relies on the integrity of its operating systems and employees, and those of third parties, and certain failures of such systems or misconduct by such employees could materially and adversely affect the Firm’s operations.
JPMorgan Chase’s businesses are dependent on the Firm’s ability to process, record and monitor an increasingly large number of complex transactions and to do so on a faster and more frequent basis. The Firm’s front- and back-office trading systems similarly rely on their access to, and on the functionality of, the operating systems maintained by third parties such as clearing and payment systems, central counterparties, securities exchanges and data processing and technology companies. If the Firm’s financial, accounting, trading or other data processing systems, or the operating systems of third parties on which the Firm’s businesses are dependent, are unable to meet these increasingly demanding standards, or if they fail or have other significant shortcomings, the Firm could be materially and adversely affected. The Firm is similarly dependent on its employees. The Firm could be materially and adversely affected if one or more of its employees causes a significant operational breakdown or failure, either as a result of human error or where an individual purposefully sabotages or fraudulently manipulates the Firm’s operations or systems. In addition, when the Firm changes processes or introduces new products and services and new remote connectivity solutions (including Internet and mobile banking services), the Firm may not fully appreciate or identify new operational risks that may arise from such changes. Any of these occurrences could diminish the Firm’s ability to operate one or more of its businesses, or result in potential liability to clients and customers, increased operating expenses, higher litigation costs (including fines and sanctions), reputational damage, regulatory


 
 
13

Part I

intervention or weaker competitive standing, any of which could materially and adversely affect the Firm.
Third parties with which the Firm does business, as well as retailers and other third parties with which the Firm’s customers do business, can also be sources of operational risk to the Firm, particularly where activities of customers are beyond the Firm’s security and control systems, such as through the use of the internet, personal smart phones and other mobile services. Security breaches affecting the Firm’s customers, or systems breakdowns or failures, security breaches or employee misconduct affecting such other third parties, may require the Firm to take steps to protect the integrity of its own operational systems or to safeguard confidential information of the Firm or its customers, thereby increasing the Firm’s operational costs and potentially diminish customer satisfaction.
If personal, confidential or proprietary information of customers or clients in the Firm’s possession were to be mishandled or misused, the Firm could suffer significant regulatory consequences, reputational damage and financial loss. Such mishandling or misuse could include circumstances where, for example, such information was erroneously provided to parties who are not permitted to have the information, either through the fault of the Firm’s systems, employees or counterparties, or where such information was intercepted or otherwise compromised by third parties.
The Firm may be subject to disruptions of its operating systems arising from events that are wholly or partially beyond the Firm’s control, which may include, for example, security breaches (as discussed further below); electrical or telecommunications outages; failures of computer servers or other damage to the Firm’s property or assets; natural disasters or severe weather conditions; health emergencies or pandemics; or events arising from local or larger-scale political events, including outbreaks of hostilities or terrorist acts. JPMorgan Chase maintains a global resiliency and crisis management program that is intended to ensure that the Firm has the ability to recover its critical business functions and supporting assets, including staff, technology and facilities, in the event of a business interruption. While the Firm believes that its current resiliency plans are both sufficient and adequate, there can be no assurance that such plans will fully mitigate all potential business continuity risks to the Firm or its customers and clients. Any failures or disruptions of the Firm’s systems or operations could give rise to losses in service to customers and clients, adversely affect the Firm’s business and results of operations by subjecting the Firm to losses or liability, or require the Firm to expend significant resources to correct the failure or disruption, as well as by exposing the Firm to litigation, regulatory fines or penalties or losses not covered by insurance.
A breach in the security of JPMorgan Chase’s systems could disrupt its businesses, result in the disclosure of confidential information, damage its reputation and
 
create significant financial and legal exposure for the Firm.
Although JPMorgan Chase devotes significant resources to maintain and regularly update its systems and processes that are designed to protect the security of the Firm’s computer systems, software, networks and other technology assets and the confidentiality, integrity and availability of information belonging to the Firm and its customers and clients, there is no assurance that all of the Firm’s security measures will provide absolute security. JPMorgan Chase and other companies have reported significant breaches in the security of their websites or other systems, some of which have involved sophisticated and targeted attacks intended to obtain unauthorized access to confidential information, destroy data, disrupt or degrade service, sabotage systems or cause other damage, including through the introduction of computer viruses or malware, cyberattacks and other means. A cyberattack against the Firm in 2014 resulted in customer and internal data of the Firm being compromised. The Firm is regularly targeted by unauthorized parties using malicious code and viruses, and has also experienced several significant distributed denial-of-service attacks from technically sophisticated and well-resourced third parties which were intended to disrupt online banking services.
Despite the Firm’s efforts to ensure the integrity of its systems, it is possible that the Firm may not be able to anticipate, detect or recognize threats to its systems or to implement effective preventive measures against all security breaches of these types, especially because the techniques used change frequently or are not recognized until launched, and because cyberattacks can originate from a wide variety of sources, including third parties outside the Firm such as persons who are associated with external service providers or who are or may be involved in organized crime or linked to terrorist organizations or hostile foreign governments. Those parties may also attempt to fraudulently induce employees, customers, third-party service providers or other users of the Firm’s systems to disclose sensitive information in order to gain access to the Firm’s data or that of its customers or clients. These risks may increase in the future as the Firm continues to increase its mobile-payment and other internet-based product offerings and expands its internal usage of web-based products and applications.
A successful penetration or circumvention of the security of the Firm’s systems could cause serious negative consequences for the Firm, including significant disruption of the Firm’s operations, misappropriation of confidential information of the Firm or that of its customers, or damage to computers or systems of the Firm and those of its customers and counterparties, and could result in violations of applicable privacy and other laws, financial loss to the Firm or to its customers, loss of confidence in the Firm’s security measures, customer dissatisfaction, significant litigation exposure and harm to the Firm’s reputation, all of which could have a material adverse effect on the Firm.


14
 
 


Risk Management
JPMorgan Chase’s framework for managing risks and its risk management procedures and practices may not be effective in identifying and mitigating every risk to the Firm, thereby resulting in losses.
JPMorgan Chase’s risk management framework seeks to mitigate risk and loss to the Firm. The Firm has established processes and procedures intended to identify, measure, monitor, report and analyze the types of risk to which the Firm is subject. However, as with any risk management framework, there are inherent limitations to the Firm’s risk management strategies because there may exist, or develop in the future, risks that the Firm has not appropriately anticipated or identified. Any lapse in the Firm’s risk management framework and governance structure or other inadequacies in the design or implementation of the Firm’s risk management framework, governance, procedures or practices could, individually or in the aggregate, cause unexpected losses for the Firm, materially and adversely affect the Firm’s financial condition and results of operations, require significant resources to remediate any risk management deficiency, attract heightened regulatory scrutiny, expose the Firm to regulatory investigations or legal proceedings, subject the Firm to fines, penalties or judgments, harm the Firm’s reputation, or otherwise cause a decline in investor confidence.
The Firm’s products, including loans, leases, lending commitments, derivatives, trading account assets and assets held-for-sale, as well as cash management and clearing activities, expose the Firm to credit risk. As one of the nation’s largest lenders, the Firm has exposures arising from its many different products and counterparties, and the credit quality of the Firm’s exposures can have a significant impact on its earnings. The Firm establishes allowances for probable credit losses inherent in its credit exposure, including unfunded lending-related commitments. The Firm also employs stress testing and other techniques to determine the capital and liquidity necessary to protect the Firm in the event of adverse economic or market events. These processes are critical to the Firm’s financial results and condition, and require difficult, subjective and complex judgments, including forecasts of how economic conditions might impair the ability of the Firm’s borrowers and counterparties to repay their loans or other obligations. As is the case with any such assessments, there is always the possibility that the Firm will fail to identify the proper factors or that the Firm will fail to accurately estimate the impact of factors that it identifies.
JPMorgan Chase’s market-making businesses may expose the Firm to unexpected market, credit and operational risks that could cause the Firm to suffer unexpected losses. Severe declines in asset values, unanticipated credit events, or unforeseen circumstances that may cause previously uncorrelated factors to become correlated (and vice versa) may create losses resulting from risks not appropriately taken into account in the development, structuring or
 
pricing of a financial instrument such as a derivative. Certain of the Firm’s derivative transactions require the physical settlement by delivery of securities or other obligations that the Firm does not own; if the Firm is unable to obtain such securities or obligations within the required timeframe for delivery, this could cause the Firm to forfeit payments otherwise due to it and could result in settlement delays, which could damage the Firm’s reputation and ability to transact future business. In addition, in situations where trades are not settled or confirmed on a timely basis, the Firm may be subject to heightened credit and operational risk, and in the event of a default, the Firm may be exposed to market and operational losses. In particular, disputes regarding the terms or the settlement procedures of derivative contracts could arise, which could force the Firm to incur unexpected costs, including transaction, legal and litigation costs, and impair the Firm’s ability to manage effectively its risk exposure from these products.
In a difficult or less liquid market environment, the Firm’s risk management strategies may not be effective because other market participants may be attempting to use the same or similar strategies to deal with the challenging market conditions. In such circumstances, it may be difficult for the Firm to reduce its risk positions due to the activity of such other market participants.
Many of the Firm’s risk management strategies or techniques have a basis in historical market behavior, and all such strategies and techniques are based to some degree on management’s subjective judgment. For example, many models used by the Firm are based on assumptions regarding correlations among prices of various asset classes or other market indicators. In times of market stress, or in the event of other unforeseen circumstances, previously uncorrelated indicators may become correlated, or conversely, previously correlated indicators may make unrelated movements. These sudden market movements or unanticipated or unidentified market or economic movements have in some circumstances limited and could again limit the effectiveness of the Firm’s risk management strategies, causing the Firm to incur losses.
Many of the models used by the Firm are subject to review not only by the Firm’s Model Risk function but also by the Firm’s regulators in order that the Firm may utilize such models in connection with the Firm’s calculations of market risk risk-weighted assets (“RWA”), credit risk RWA and operational risk RWA under the Advanced Approach of Basel III. The Firm may be subject to higher capital charges, which could adversely affect its financial results or limit its ability to expand its businesses, if such models do not receive approval by its regulators.
In addition, the Firm must comply with enhanced standards for the assessment and management of risks associated with vendors and other third parties that provide services to the Firm. These requirements apply to the Firm both under general guidance issued by its banking regulators and, more specifically, under certain of the consent orders to which the Firm is subject. The Firm has incurred and expects to


 
 
15

Part I

incur additional costs and expenses in connection with its initiatives to address the risks associated with oversight of its third party relationships. Failure by the Firm to appropriately assess and manage third party relationships, especially those involving significant banking functions, shared services or other critical activities, could result in potential liability to clients and customers, fines, penalties or judgments imposed by the Firm’s regulators, increased operating expenses and harm to the Firm’s reputation, any of which could materially and adversely affect the Firm.
Lapses in disclosure controls and procedures or internal control over financial reporting could materially and adversely affect the Firm’s operations, profitability or reputation.
There can be no assurance that the Firm’s disclosure controls and procedures will be effective in every circumstance or that a material weakness or significant deficiency in internal control over financial reporting will not occur. Any such lapses or deficiencies may materially and adversely affect the Firm’s business and results of operations or financial condition, restrict its ability to access the capital markets, require the Firm to expend significant resources to correct the lapses or deficiencies, expose the Firm to regulatory or legal proceedings, subject it to fines, penalties or judgments, harm the Firm’s reputation, or otherwise cause a decline in investor confidence.
Other Risks
The financial services industry is highly competitive, and JPMorgan Chase’s inability to compete successfully may adversely affect its results of operations.
JPMorgan Chase operates in a highly competitive environment, and the Firm expects that competition in the U.S. and global financial services industry will continue to be intense. Competitors of the Firm include other banks, brokerage firms, investment banking companies, merchant banks, hedge funds, commodity trading companies, private equity firms, insurance companies, mutual fund companies, investment managers, credit card companies, mortgage banking companies, trust companies, securities processing companies, automobile financing companies, leasing companies, e-commerce and other Internet-based companies, and a variety of other financial services and advisory companies. Technological advances and the growth of e-commerce have made it possible for non-depository institutions to offer products and services that traditionally were banking products, and for financial institutions and other companies to provide electronic and Internet-based financial solutions, including electronic securities trading and payment processing. The Firm’s businesses generally compete on the basis of the quality and variety of the Firm’s products and services, transaction execution, innovation, reputation and price. Ongoing or increased competition in any one or all of these areas may put downward pressure on prices for the Firm’s products and services or may cause the Firm to lose market share. Increased competition also
 
may require the Firm to make additional capital investments in its businesses in order to remain competitive. These investments may increase expense or may require the Firm to extend more of its capital on behalf of clients in order to execute larger, more competitive transactions. The Firm cannot provide assurance that the significant competition in the financial services industry will not materially and adversely affect its future results of operations.
Competitors of the Firm’s non-U.S. wholesale businesses are typically subject to different, and in some cases, less stringent, legislative and regulatory regimes. For example, the regulatory objectives underlying several provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act, including the prohibition on proprietary trading under the Volcker Rule, have not been embraced by governments and regulatory agencies outside the U.S. and may not be implemented into law in most countries. The more restrictive laws and regulations applicable to U.S. financial services institutions, such as JPMorgan Chase, can put the Firm at a competitive disadvantage to its non-U.S. competitors, including prohibiting the Firm from engaging in certain transactions, imposing higher capital requirements on the Firm, making the Firm’s pricing of certain transactions more expensive for clients or adversely affecting the Firm’s cost structure for providing certain products, all of which can reduce the revenue and profitability of the Firm’s wholesale businesses.
JPMorgan Chase’s ability to attract and retain qualified employees is critical to its success.
JPMorgan Chase’s employees are the Firm’s most important resource, and in many areas of the financial services industry, competition for qualified personnel is intense. The Firm endeavors to attract talented and diverse new employees and retain and motivate its existing employees. The Firm also seeks to retain a pipeline of senior employees with superior talent, augmented from time to time by external hires, to provide continuity of succession for the Firm’s Operating Committee, including the Chief Executive Officer position, and senior positions below the Operating Committee. The Firm regularly reviews candidates for senior management positions to assess whether they currently are ready for a next-level role. In addition, the Firm’s Board of Directors is deeply involved in succession planning, including review of the succession plans for the Chief Executive Officer and the members of the Operating Committee. If for any reason the Firm were unable to continue to attract or retain qualified employees, including successors to the Chief Executive Officer or members of the Operating Committee, the Firm’s performance, including its competitive position, could be materially and adversely affected.
JPMorgan Chase’s financial statements are based in part on assumptions and estimates which, if incorrect, could cause unexpected losses in the future.
Under accounting principles generally accepted in the U.S. (“U.S. GAAP”), JPMorgan Chase is required to use certain assumptions and estimates in preparing its financial


16
 
 


statements, including in determining allowances for credit losses and reserves related to litigation, among other items. Certain of the Firm’s financial instruments, including trading assets and liabilities, available-for-sale securities, certain loans, MSRs, structured notes and certain repurchase and resale agreements, among other items, require a determination of their fair value in order to prepare the Firm’s financial statements. Where quoted market prices are not available, the Firm may make fair value determinations based on internally developed models or other means which ultimately rely to some degree on management estimates and judgment. In addition, sudden illiquidity in markets or declines in prices of certain loans and securities may make it more difficult to value certain balance sheet items, which may lead to the possibility that such valuations will be subject to further change or adjustment. If assumptions or estimates underlying the Firm’s financial statements are incorrect, the Firm may experience material losses.
Damage to JPMorgan Chase’s reputation could damage its businesses.
Maintaining trust in JPMorgan Chase is critical to the Firm’s ability to attract and maintain customers, investors and employees. Damage to the Firm’s reputation can therefore cause significant harm to the Firm’s business and prospects. Harm to the Firm’s reputation can arise from numerous sources, including, among others, employee misconduct, security breaches, compliance failures, litigation or regulatory outcomes or governmental investigations. The Firm’s reputation could also be harmed by the failure of an affiliate, joint-venturer or merchant banking portfolio company, or a vendor or other third party with which the Firm does business, to comply with laws or regulations. In addition, a failure or perceived failure to deliver appropriate standards of service and quality, to treat customers and clients fairly, or to handle or use confidential information of customers or clients appropriately or in compliance with applicable privacy laws and regulations can result in customer dissatisfaction, litigation and heightened regulatory scrutiny, all of which can lead to lost revenue, higher operating costs and harm to the Firm’s reputation. Adverse publicity or negative information posted on social media websites regarding the Firm, whether or not true, may result in harm to the Firm’s prospects. Actions by the financial services industry generally or by certain members of or individuals in the industry can also affect the Firm’s reputation. For example, the role played by financial services firms during the financial crisis, including concerns that consumers have been treated unfairly by financial institutions, has damaged the reputation of the industry as a whole. Should any of these or other events or factors that can undermine the Firm’s reputation occur, there is no assurance that the additional costs and expenses that the Firm may need to incur to address the issues giving rise to the reputational harm could not adversely affect the Firm’s earnings and results of operations, or that damage to the Firm’s reputation will not impair the Firm’s ability to retain its existing or attract new customers, investors and employees.
 
Management of potential conflicts of interests has become increasingly complex as the Firm continues to expand its business activities through more numerous transactions, obligations and interests with and among the Firm’s clients. The failure or perceived failure to adequately address conflicts of interest could affect the willingness of clients to deal with the Firm, or give rise to litigation or enforcement actions, as well as cause serious reputational harm to the Firm.
ITEM 1B: UNRESOLVED SEC STAFF COMMENTS
None.
ITEM 2: PROPERTIES
JPMorgan Chase’s headquarters is located in New York City at 270 Park Avenue, a 50-story office building owned by JPMorgan Chase. This location contains 1.3 million square feet of space.
In total, JPMorgan Chase owned or leased 10.5 million square feet of commercial office and retail space in New York City at December 31, 2014. JPMorgan Chase and its subsidiaries also own or lease significant administrative and operational facilities in Columbus/Westerville, Ohio (3.7 million square feet); Chicago, Illinois (3.4 million square feet); Wilmington/Newark, Delaware (2.2 million square feet); Houston, Texas (2.2 million square feet); Dallas/Fort Worth, Texas (2.0 million square feet); Phoenix/Tempe, Arizona (1.8 million square feet); Jersey City, New Jersey (1.2 million square feet); as well as owning or leasing 5,602 retail branches in 23 states. At December 31, 2014, the Firm occupied a total of 65.5 million square feet of space in the U.S.
At December 31, 2014, the Firm also owned or leased 5.5 million square feet of space in Europe, the Middle East and Africa. In the U.K., at December 31, 2014, JPMorgan Chase owned or leased 4.5 million square feet of space, including 1.4 million square feet at 25 Bank Street, the European headquarters of the Corporate & Investment Bank.
In 2008, JPMorgan Chase acquired a 999-year leasehold interest in land at London’s Canary Wharf. JPMorgan Chase has a building agreement in place through October 30, 2016, to develop the Canary Wharf site for future use.
JPMorgan Chase and its subsidiaries also occupy offices and other administrative and operational facilities in the Asia/Pacific region, Latin America and Canada under ownership and leasehold agreements aggregating 5.8 million square feet of space at December 31, 2014. This includes leases for administrative and operational facilities in India (2.0 million square feet).
The properties occupied by JPMorgan Chase are used across all of the Firm’s business segments and for corporate purposes. JPMorgan Chase continues to evaluate its current and projected space requirements and may determine from time to time that certain of its premises and facilities are no longer necessary for its operations. There is no assurance that the Firm will be able to dispose of any such excess


 
 
17

Parts I and II

premises or that it will not incur charges in connection with such dispositions. Such disposition costs may be material to the Firm’s results of operations in a given period. For information on occupancy expense, see the Consolidated Results of Operations on pages 68–71.
ITEM 3: LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
For a description of the Firm’s material legal proceedings, see Note 31.
ITEM 4: MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES
Not applicable.


 
Part II
ITEM 5: MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES
Market for registrant’s common equity
The outstanding shares of JPMorgan Chase common stock are listed and traded on the New York Stock Exchange, the London Stock Exchange and the Tokyo Stock Exchange. For the quarterly high and low prices of and cash dividends declared on JPMorgan Chase’s common stock for the last two years, see the section entitled “Supplementary information – Selected quarterly financial data (unaudited)” on pages 307–308. For a comparison of the cumulative total return for JPMorgan Chase common stock with the comparable total return of the S&P 500 Index, the KBW Bank Index and the S&P Financial Index over the five-year period ended December 31, 2014, see “Five-year stock performance”, on page 63.
For information on the common dividend payout ratio, see Capital actions in the Capital Management section of Management’s discussion and analysis on page 154. For a discussion of restrictions on dividend payments, see Note 22 and Note 27. At January 31, 2015, there were 205,115 holders of record of JPMorgan Chase common stock. For information regarding securities authorized for issuance under the Firm’s employee stock-based compensation plans, see Part III, Item 12 on page 23.
Repurchases under the common equity repurchase program
For information regarding repurchases under the Firm’s common equity repurchase program, see Capital actions in the Capital Management section of Management’s discussion and analysis on page 154.


18
 
 


Shares repurchased, on a settlement-date basis, pursuant to the common equity repurchase program during 2014 were as follows.
Year ended December 31, 2014
 
Total shares of common stock repurchased
 
Average price paid per share of common stock(a)
 
Aggregate repurchases of common equity (in millions)(a)
 
Dollar value
of remaining
authorized
repurchase
(in millions)(a)
First quarter
 
6,733,494

 
$
57.31

 
$
386

 
$
8,258

Second quarter
 
24,769,261

 
55.53

 
1,375

 
6,883

Third quarter
 
25,503,377

 
58.37

 
1,489

 
5,394

October
 
9,527,323

 
57.92

 
552

 
4,842

November
 
6,180,664

 
60.71

 
375

 
4,467

December
 
9,538,119

 
61.08

 
583

 
3,884

Fourth quarter
 
25,246,106

 
59.80

 
1,510

 
3,884

Year-to-date
 
82,252,238

 
$
57.87

 
$
4,760

 
$
3,884

(a)
Excludes commissions cost.



Repurchases under the stock-based incentive plans
Participants in the Firm’s stock-based incentive plans may have shares of common stock withheld to cover income taxes. Shares withheld to pay income taxes are repurchased pursuant to the terms of the applicable plan and not under the Firm’s repurchase program. Shares repurchased, on a settlement-date basis, pursuant to these plans during 2014 were as follows.
Year ended
December 31, 2014
Total shares of common stock
repurchased
 
Average price
paid per share of common stock
First quarter
1,245

 
$
57.99

Second quarter

 

Third quarter

 

Fourth quarter

 

Year-to-date
1,245

 
$
57.99



 
ITEM 6: SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA
For five-year selected financial data, see “Five-year summary of consolidated financial highlights (unaudited)” on page 62.
ITEM 7: MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
Management’s discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations, entitled “Management’s discussion and analysis,” appears on pages 64–169. Such information should be read in conjunction with the Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes thereto, which appear on pages 172–306.
ITEM 7A: QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK
For a discussion of the quantitative and qualitative disclosures about market risk, see the Market Risk Management section of Management’s discussion and analysis on pages 131–136.


 
 
19

Part II

ITEM 8: FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA
The Consolidated Financial Statements, together with the Notes thereto and the report thereon dated February 24, 2015, of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, the Firm’s independent registered public accounting firm, appear on pages 171–306.
Supplementary financial data for each full quarter within the two years ended December 31, 2014, are included on pages 307–308 in the table entitled “Selected quarterly financial data (unaudited).” Also included is a “Glossary of terms’’ on pages 309–313.
ITEM 9: CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE
None.


 
ITEM 9A: CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES
In May 2013, the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO) issued its updated “Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013)”. The 2013 framework, which provides guidance for designing, implementing and conducting internal control and assessing its effectiveness, updates the original COSO framework, which was published in 1992. The Firm used the 2013 COSO framework to assess the effectiveness of the Firm’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014. See “Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting” on page 170.
As of the end of the period covered by this report, an evaluation was carried out under the supervision and with the participation of the Firm’s management, including its Chairman and Chief Executive Officer and its Chief Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of its disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934). Based on that evaluation, the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Financial Officer concluded that these disclosure controls and procedures were effective. See Exhibits 31.1 and 31.2 for the Certification statements issued by the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer.
The Firm is committed to maintaining high standards of internal control over financial reporting. Nevertheless, because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. In addition, in a firm as large and complex as JPMorgan Chase, lapses or deficiencies in internal controls may occur from time to time, and there can be no assurance that any such deficiencies will not result in significant deficiencies or material weaknesses in internal controls in the future. For further information, see “Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting” on page 170. There was no change in the Firm’s internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934) that occurred during the three months ended December 31, 2014, that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Firm’s internal control over financial reporting.


20
 
 


ITEM 9B: OTHER INFORMATION
Pursuant to Section 219 of the Iran Threat Reduction and Syria Human Rights Act of 2012, which added Section 13(r) to the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”), an issuer is required to disclose in its annual or quarterly reports, as applicable, whether it or any of its affiliates knowingly engaged in certain activities, transactions or dealings relating to Iran or with individuals or entities designated pursuant to certain Executive Orders. Disclosure is generally required even where the activities, transactions or dealings were conducted in compliance with applicable law. Except as set forth below, as of the date of this report, the Firm is not aware of any other activity, transaction or dealing by any of its affiliates during the year ended December 31, 2014 that requires disclosure under Section 219.
Carlson Wagonlit Travel (“CWT”), a business travel management firm in which JPMorgan Chase had invested through its merchant banking activities, may be deemed to be an affiliate of the Firm, as that term is defined in Exchange Act Rule 12b-2. CWT informed the Firm that, during the period January 1, 2014 through August 15, 2014 (the date on which the Firm sold its investment in CWT), CWT booked approximately 2 flights (of the approximately 37 million transactions it booked during the period) to Iran on Iran Air for passengers, including employees of foreign governments and/or non-governmental organizations. Both flights originated outside of the U.S. from countries that permit travel to Iran, and none of such passengers were persons designated under Executive Orders 13224 or 13382 or were employees of foreign governments that are targets of U.S. sanctions. CWT and the Firm believe that this activity is permissible pursuant to certain exemptions from U.S. sanctions for travel-related transactions under the International Emergency Economic Powers Act, as amended. CWT had approximately $5,000 in gross revenues attributable to these transactions.
 
In addition, during 2014, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. processed one payment from Iran Air on behalf of a U.S. client into such client’s account at JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. Iran Air is designated pursuant to Executive Order 13382. This transaction was authorized by and conducted pursuant to a license from the Treasury Department’s Office of Foreign Assets Control (“OFAC”). JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. charged a fee of US$ 3.50 for this transaction. Iran Air overpaid such U.S. client when it made the initial payment to the client. Therefore, upon its U.S. client’s request, the Firm transferred the overpayment back to Iran Air in the fourth quarter of 2014 and charged a fee of US$ 5.50 for the transfer. As with the initial transaction, the transfer of the overpayment to Iran Air was authorized by and conducted pursuant to an OFAC license. JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. has no current intention to continue such activities but may in the future engage in similar transactions for its clients to the extent permitted by U.S. law.



 
 
21

Part III




ITEM 10: DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE
Executive officers of the registrant(a) 
 
Age
 
Name
(at December 31, 2014)
Positions and offices
James Dimon
58
Chairman of the Board, Chief Executive Officer and President.
Ashley Bacon
45
Chief Risk Officer since June 2013. He had been Deputy Chief Risk Officer since June 2012, prior to which he had been Global Head of Market Risk for the Investment Bank (now part of Corporate & Investment Bank).
Stephen M. Cutler
53
General Counsel.
John L. Donnelly
58
Head of Human Resources since January 2009.
Mary Callahan Erdoes
47
Chief Executive Officer of Asset Management since September 2009.
Marianne Lake
45
Chief Financial Officer since January 1, 2013, prior to which she had been Chief Financial Officer of Consumer & Community Banking since 2009. She previously had served as Global Controller of the Investment Bank (now part of Corporate & Investment Bank) from 2007 to 2009.
Douglas B. Petno
49
Chief Executive Officer of Commercial Banking since January 2012. He had been Chief Operating Officer of Commercial Banking since October 2010, prior to which he had been Global Head of Natural Resources in the Investment Bank (now part of Corporate & Investment Bank).
Daniel E. Pinto
52
Chief Executive Officer of the Corporate & Investment Bank since March 2014 and Chief Executive Officer of Europe, the Middle East and Africa since June 2011. He had been Co-Chief Executive Officer of the Corporate & Investment Bank from July 2012 until March 2014, prior to which he had been head or co-head of the Global Fixed Income business from November 2009 until July 2012. He was Global Head of Emerging Markets from 2006 until 2009, and was also responsible for the Global Credit Trading & Syndicate business from 2008 until 2009.
Gordon A. Smith
56
Chief Executive Officer of Consumer & Community Banking since December 2012 prior to which he had been Co-Chief Executive Officer since July 2012. He had been Chief Executive Officer of Card Services since 2007 and of the Auto Finance and Student Lending businesses since 2011.
Matthew E. Zames
44
Chief Operating Officer since April 2013 and head of Mortgage Banking Capital Markets since January 2012. He had been Co-Chief Operating Officer from July 2012 until April 2013. He had been Chief Investment Officer from May until September 2012, co-head of the Global Fixed Income business from November 2009 until May 2012 and co-head of Mortgage Banking Capital Markets from July 2011 until January 2012, prior to which he had served in a number of senior Investment Banking Fixed Income management roles.
(a) All of the executive officers listed in this table are currently members of the Firm’s Operating Committee.
Unless otherwise noted, during the five fiscal years ended December 31, 2014, all of JPMorgan Chase’s above-named executive officers have continuously held senior-level positions with JPMorgan Chase. There are no family relationships among the foregoing executive officers. Information to be provided in Items 10, 11, 12, 13 and 14 of the Form 10-K and not otherwise included herein is incorporated by reference to the Firm’s definitive proxy statement for its 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders to be held on May 19, 2015, which will be filed with the SEC within 120 days of the end of the Firm’s fiscal year ended December 31, 2014.

22
 
 


ITEM 11: EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
See Item 10.
 


ITEM 12: SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS
For security ownership of certain beneficial owners and management, see Item 10.
The following table sets forth the total number of shares available for issuance under JPMorgan Chase’s employee stock-based incentive plans (including shares available for issuance to nonemployee directors). The Firm is not authorized to grant stock-based incentive awards to nonemployees, other than to nonemployee directors.
December 31, 2014
Number of shares to be issued upon exercise of outstanding options/SARs
 
Weighted-average
exercise price of
outstanding
options/SARs
 
Number of shares remaining available for future issuance under stock compensation plans
Plan category
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Employee stock-based incentive plans approved by shareholders
59,194,831

 
 
$
45.00

 
 
266,037,974

(a) 
Total
59,194,831

 
 
$
45.00

 
 
266,037,974

 
(a)
Represents future shares available under the shareholder-approved Long-Term Incentive Plan, as amended and restated effective May 17, 2011.
All future shares will be issued under the shareholder-approved Long-Term Incentive Plan, as amended and restated effective May 17, 2011. For further discussion, see Note 10.
ITEM 13: CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE
See Item 10.
ITEM 14: PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES
See Item 10.


 
 
23

Part IV



ITEM 15: EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES
Exhibits, financial statement schedules
1
 
Financial statements
 
 
The Consolidated Financial Statements, the Notes thereto and the report of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm thereon listed in Item 8 are set forth commencing on page 171.
 
 
 
2
 
Financial statement schedules
 
 
 
3
 
Exhibits
 
 
 
3.1
 
Restated Certificate of Incorporation of JPMorgan Chase & Co., effective April 5, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) filed April 7, 2006).
 
 
 
3.2
 
Amendment to the Restated Certificate of Incorporation of JPMorgan Chase & Co., effective June 7, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Appendix F to the Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) filed April 10, 2013).
 
 
 
3.3
 
Certificate of Designations for Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series I (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) filed April 24, 2008).
 
 
 
3.4
 
Certificate of Designations for 5.50% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series O (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) filed August 27, 2012).
 
 
 
3.5
 
Certificate of Designations for 5.45% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series P (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) filed February 5, 2013).
 
 
 
3.6
 
Certificate of Designations for Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series Q (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) filed April 23, 2013).
 
 
 
 
3.7
 
Certificate of Designations for Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series R (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) filed July 29, 2013).
 
 
 
3.8
 
Certificate of Designations for Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series S (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) filed January 22, 2014).
 
 
 
3.9
 
Certificate of Designations for 6.70% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series T (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) filed January 30, 2014).
 
 
 
3.10
 
Certificate of Designations for Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series U (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) filed on March 10, 2014).
 
 
 
3.11
 
Certificate of Designations for Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series V (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) filed on June 9, 2014).
 
 
 
3.12
 
Certificate of Designations for 6.30% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series W (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) filed on June 23, 2014).
 
 
 
3.13
 
Certificate of Designations for Fixed-to-Floating Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series X (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) filed on September 23, 2014).
 
 
 
3.14
 
By-laws of JPMorgan Chase & Co., effective September 17, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) filed September 20, 2013).
 
 
 


24
 
 


4.1
 
Indenture, dated as of October 21, 2010, between JPMorgan Chase & Co. and Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas, as Trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No.1-5805) filed October 21, 2010).
 
 
 
4.2
 
Subordinated Indenture, dated as of March 14, 2014, between JPMorgan Chase & Co. and U.S. Bank Trust National Association, as Trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No.1-5805) filed March 14, 2014).
 
 
 
4.3
 
Indenture, dated as of May 25, 2001, between JPMorgan Chase & Co. and Bankers Trust Company (succeeded by Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas), as Trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4(a)(1) to the Registration Statement on Form S-3 of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 333-52826) filed June 13, 2001).
 
 
 
4.4
 
Form of Deposit Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to the Registration Statement on Form S-3 of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 333-191692) filed October 11, 2013).
 
 
 
4.5
 
Form of Warrant to purchase common stock (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to the Form 8-A of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) filed December 11, 2009).
 
 
 
Other instruments defining the rights of holders of long-term debt securities of JPMorgan Chase & Co. and its subsidiaries are omitted pursuant to Section (b)(4)(iii)(A) of Item 601 of Regulation S-K. JPMorgan Chase & Co. agrees to furnish copies of these instruments to the SEC upon request.
 
 
 
10.1
 
Deferred Compensation Plan for Non-Employee Directors of JPMorgan Chase & Co., as amended and restated July 2001 and as of December 31, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the year ended December 31, 2007).(a)
 
 
 
10.2
 
2005 Deferred Compensation Plan for Non-Employee Directors of JPMorgan Chase & Co., effective as of January 1, 2005 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the year ended December 31, 2007).(a)
 
 
 
 
10.3
 
2005 Deferred Compensation Program of JPMorgan Chase & Co., restated effective as of December 31, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the year ended December 31, 2008).(a)
 
 
 
10.4
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co. Long-Term Incentive Plan as amended and restated effective May 17, 2011 (incorporated by reference to Appendix C of the Schedule 14A of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) filed April 7, 2011).(a)
 
 
 
10.5
 
Key Executive Performance Plan of JPMorgan Chase & Co., as amended and restated effective January 1, 2014 (incorporated by reference to Appendix G of the Schedule 14A of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) filed April 10, 2013).(a)
 
 
 
10.6
 
Excess Retirement Plan of JPMorgan Chase & Co., restated and amended as of December 31, 2008, as amended (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the year ended December 31, 2009).(a)
 
 
 
10.7
 
1995 Stock Incentive Plan of J.P. Morgan & Co. Incorporated and Affiliated Companies, as amended, dated December 11, 1996 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.8 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the year ended December 31, 2008).(a)
 
 
 
10.8
 
Executive Retirement Plan of JPMorgan Chase & Co., as amended and restated December 31, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.9 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the year ended December 31, 2008).(a)
 
 
 
10.9
 
Bank One Corporation Stock Performance Plan, as amended and restated effective February 20, 2001 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.12 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the year ended December 31, 2008).(a)
 
 
 


 
 
25

Part IV


10.10
 
Bank One Corporation Supplemental Savings and Investment Plan, as amended and restated effective December 31, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.13 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the year ended December 31, 2008).(a)
 
 
 
10.11
 
Banc One Corporation Revised and Restated 1995 Stock Incentive Plan, effective April 17, 1995 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.15 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the year ended December 31, 2008).(a)
 
 
 
10.12
 
Form of JPMorgan Chase & Co. Long-Term Incentive Plan Award Agreement of January 22, 2008 stock appreciation rights (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.25 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the year ended December 31, 2007).(a)
 
 
 
10.13
 
Form of JPMorgan Chase & Co. Long-Term Incentive Plan Award Agreement of January 22, 2008 stock appreciation rights for James Dimon (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.27 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the year ended December 31, 2007).(a)
 
 
 
10.14
 
Form of JPMorgan Chase & Co. Long-Term Incentive Plan Terms and Conditions for stock appreciation rights, dated as of January 20, 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.20 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the year ended December 31, 2008).(a)
 
 
 
10.15
 
Form of JPMorgan Chase & Co. Long-Term Incentive Plan Terms and Conditions for Operating Committee member stock appreciation rights, dated as of January 20, 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.21 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the year ended December 31, 2008).(a)
 
 
 
10.16
 
Form of JPMorgan Chase & Co. Long-Term Incentive Plan Terms and Conditions for Operating Committee member stock appreciation rights, dated as of February 3, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.23 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the year ended December 31, 2009).(a)
 
 
 
10.17
 
Forms of JPMorgan Chase & Co. Long-Term Incentive Plan Terms and Conditions for stock appreciation rights and restricted stock units, dated as of January 18, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.25 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the year ended December 31, 2011).(a)
 
 
 
 
10.18
 
Forms of JPMorgan Chase & Co. Long-Term Incentive Plan Terms and Conditions for stock appreciation rights and restricted stock units for Operating Committee members, dated as of January 17, 2013 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.23 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the year ended December 31, 2012).(a)
 
 
 
10.19
 
Form of JPMorgan Chase & Co. Long-Term Incentive Plan Terms and Conditions for restricted stock units for Operating Committee members, dated January 22, 2014 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the quarter ended March 31, 2014).(a)
 
 
 
10.20
 
Form of JPMorgan Chase & Co. Terms and Conditions of Fixed Allowance (UK) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the quarter ended June 30, 2014).(a)
 
 
 
10.21
 
Form of JPMorgan Chase & Co. Performance-Based Incentive Compensation Plan, effective as of January 1, 2006, as amended (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.27 to the Annual Report on Form 10-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) for the year ended December 31, 2009).(a)
 
 
 
10.22
 
Deferred Prosecution Agreement dated January 6, 2014 between the U.S. Attorney’s Office for the Southern District of New York and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (File No. 1-5805) filed January 7, 2014).
 
 
 
12.1
 
Computation of ratio of earnings to fixed charges.(b)
 
 
 
12.2
 
Computation of ratio of earnings to fixed charges and preferred stock dividend requirements.(b)
 
 
 
21
 
List of subsidiaries of JPMorgan Chase & Co.(b)
 
 
 
22.1
 
Annual Report on Form 11-K of The JPMorgan Chase 401(k) Savings Plan for the year ended December 31, 2014 (to be filed pursuant to Rule 15d-21 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934).
 
 
 
23
 
Consent of independent registered public accounting firm.(b)
 
 
 
31.1
 
Certification.(b)
 
 
 
31.2
 
Certification.(b)
 
 
 
32
 
Certification pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.(c)
 
 
 


26
 
 


101.INS
 
XBRL Instance Document.(b)(d)
 
 
 
101.SCH
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema
Document.(b)
 
 
 
101.CAL
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document.(b)
 
 
 
101.DEF
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document.(b)
101.LAB
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document.(b)
 
 
 
101.PRE
 
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document.(b)
 
 
 
(a)
This exhibit is a management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement.
(b)
Filed herewith.
(c)
Furnished herewith. This exhibit shall not be deemed “filed” for purposes of Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, or otherwise subject to the liability of that Section. Such exhibit shall not be deemed incorporated into any filing under the Securities Act of 1933 or the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.
(d)
Pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T, includes the following financial information included in the Firm’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014, formatted in XBRL (eXtensible Business Reporting Language) interactive data files: (i) the Consolidated statements of income for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, (ii) the Consolidated statements of comprehensive income for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, (iii) the Consolidated balance sheets as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, (iv) the Consolidated statements of changes in stockholders’ equity for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, (v) the Consolidated statements of cash flows for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, and (vi) the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.


 
 
27


























Pages 28–60 not used



Table of contents




Financial:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
62
 
Five-Year Summary of Consolidated Financial Highlights
 
Audited financial statements:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
63
 
Five-Year Stock Performance
 
170
 
Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Management’s discussion and analysis:
 
171
 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
64
 
Introduction
 
172
 
Consolidated Financial Statements
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
65
 
Executive Overview
 
177
 
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
68
 
Consolidated Results of Operations
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
72
 
Consolidated Balance Sheets Analysis
 
 
 
 
74
 
Off–Balance Sheet Arrangements and Contractual Cash Obligations
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
76
 
Consolidated Cash Flows Analysis
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
77
 
Explanation and Reconciliation of the Firm’s Use of Non-GAAP Financial Measures
 
Supplementary information:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
79
 
Business Segment Results
 
307
 
Selected Quarterly Financial Data
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
105
 
Enterprise-wide Risk Management
 
309
 
Glossary of Terms
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
110
 
Credit Risk Management
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
131
 
Market Risk Management
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
137
 
Country Risk Management
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
139
 
Model Risk Management
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
140
 
Principal Risk Management
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
141
 
Operational Risk Management
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
144
 
Legal Risk Management & Compliance Risk Management
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
145
 
Fiduciary Risk Management
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
145
 
Reputation Risk Management
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
146
 
Capital Management
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
156
 
Liquidity Risk Management
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
161
 
Critical Accounting Estimates Used by the Firm
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
166
 
Accounting and Reporting Developments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
168
 
Nonexchange-Traded Commodity Derivative Contracts at Fair Value
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
169
 
Forward-Looking Statements
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
61

Financial

FIVE-YEAR SUMMARY OF CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS
(unaudited)
As of or for the year ended December 31,
 
 
 
 
 
 
(in millions, except per share, ratio, headcount data and where otherwise noted)
 
2014
2013
2012
2011
2010
Selected income statement data
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total net revenue
 
$
94,205

$
96,606

$
97,031

$
97,234

$
102,694

Total noninterest expense
 
61,274

70,467

64,729

62,911

61,196

Pre-provision profit
 
32,931

26,139

32,302

34,323

41,498

Provision for credit losses
 
3,139

225

3,385

7,574

16,639

Income before income tax expense
 
29,792

25,914

28,917

26,749

24,859

Income tax expense
 
8,030

7,991

7,633

7,773

7,489

Net income
 
$
21,762

$
17,923

$
21,284

$
18,976

$
17,370

Earnings per share data
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income: Basic
 
$
5.34

$
4.39

$
5.22

$
4.50

$
3.98

           Diluted
 
5.29

4.35

5.20

4.48

3.96

Average shares: Basic
 
3,763.5

3,782.4

3,809.4

3,900.4

3,956.3

              Diluted
 
3,797.5

3,814.9

3,822.2

3,920.3

3,976.9

Market and per common share data
 
 
 
 
 
 
Market capitalization
 
$
232,472

$
219,657

$
167,260

$
125,442

$
165,875

Common shares at period-end
 
3,714.8

3,756.1

3,804.0

3,772.7

3,910.3

Share price(a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
High
 
$
63.49

$
58.55

$
46.49

$
48.36

$
48.20

Low
 
52.97

44.20

30.83

27.85

35.16

Close
 
62.58

58.48

43.97

33.25

42.42

Book value per share
 
57.07

53.25

51.27

46.59

43.04

Tangible book value per share (“TBVPS”)(b)
 
44.69

40.81

38.75

33.69

30.18

Cash dividends declared per share
 
1.58

1.44

1.20

1.00

0.20

Selected ratios and metrics
 
 
 
 
 
 
Return on common equity (“ROE”)
 
10
%
9
%
11
%
11
%
10
%
Return on tangible common equity (“ROTCE”)(b)
 
13

11

15

15

15

Return on assets (“ROA”)
 
0.89

0.75

0.94

0.86

0.85

Overhead ratio
 
65

73

67

65

60

Loans-to-deposits ratio
 
56

57

61

64

74

High quality liquid assets (“HQLA“) (in billions)(c)
 
$
600

$
522

$
341

NA

NA

Common equity tier 1 (“CET1”) capital ratio(d)
 
10.2
%
10.7
%
11.0
%
10.1
%
9.8
%
Tier 1 capital ratio (d)
 
11.6

11.9

12.6

12.3

12.1

Total capital ratio(d)
 
13.1

14.4

15.3

15.4

15.5

Tier 1 leverage ratio(d)
 
7.6

7.1

7.1

6.8

7.0

Selected balance sheet data (period-end)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading assets
 
$
398,988

$
374,664

$
450,028

$
443,963

$
489,892

Securities(e)
 
348,004

354,003

371,152

364,793

316,336

Loans
 
757,336

738,418

733,796

723,720

692,927

Total assets
 
2,573,126

2,415,689

2,359,141

2,265,792

2,117,605

Deposits
 
1,363,427

1,287,765

1,193,593

1,127,806

930,369

Long-term debt(f)
 
276,836

267,889

249,024

256,775

270,653

Common stockholders’ equity
 
212,002

200,020

195,011

175,773

168,306

Total stockholders’ equity
 
232,065

211,178

204,069

183,573

176,106

Headcount
 
241,359

251,196

258,753

259,940

239,515

Credit quality metrics
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for credit losses
 
$
14,807

$
16,969

$
22,604

$
28,282

$
32,983

Allowance for loan losses to total retained loans
 
1.90
%
2.25
%
3.02
%
3.84
%
4.71
%
Allowance for loan losses to retained loans excluding purchased credit-impaired loans(g)
 
1.55

1.80

2.43

3.35

4.46

Nonperforming assets
 
$
7,967

$
9,706

$
11,906

$
11,315

$
16,682

Net charge-offs
 
4,759

5,802

9,063

12,237

23,673

Net charge-off rate
 
0.65
%
0.81
%
1.26
%
1.78
%
3.39
%
(a)
Share prices shown for JPMorgan Chase’s common stock are from the New York Stock Exchange. JPMorgan Chase’s common stock is also listed and traded on the London Stock Exchange and the Tokyo Stock Exchange.
(b)
TBVPS and ROTCE are non-GAAP financial measures. TBVPS represents the Firm’s tangible common equity divided by common shares at period-end. ROTCE measures the Firm’s annualized earnings as a percentage of tangible common equity. For further discussion of these measures, see Explanation and Reconciliation of the Firm’s Use of Non-GAAP Financial Measures on pages 77–78.
(c)
HQLA represents the Firm’s estimate of the amount of assets that qualify for inclusion in the liquidity coverage ratio under the final U.S. rule (“U.S. LCR”) as of December 31, 2014, and under the Basel III liquidity coverage ratio (“Basel III LCR”) for prior periods. The Firm did not begin estimating HQLA until December 31, 2012. For additional information, see HQLA on page 157.
(d)
Basel III Transitional rules became effective on January 1, 2014; prior period data is based on Basel I rules. As of December 31, 2014 the ratios presented are calculated under the Basel III Advanced Transitional Approach. CET1 capital under Basel III replaced Tier 1 common capital under Basel I. Prior to Basel III becoming effective on January 1, 2014, Tier 1 common capital under Basel I was a non-GAAP financial measure. See Regulatory capital on pages 146–153 for additional information on Basel III and non-GAAP financial measures of regulatory capital.
(e)
Included held-to-maturity securities of $49.3 billion and $24.0 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Held-to-maturity balances for the other periods were not material.
(f)
Included unsecured long-term debt of $207.5 billion, $199.4 billion, $200.6 billion, $231.3 billion and $238.2 billion respectively, as of December 31, of each year presented.
(g)
Excludes the impact of residential real estate purchased credit-impaired (“PCI”) loans. For further discussion, see Allowance for credit losses on pages 128–130.


62
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



FIVE-YEAR STOCK PERFORMANCE
The following table and graph compare the five-year cumulative total return for JPMorgan Chase & Co. (“JPMorgan Chase” or the “Firm”) common stock with the cumulative return of the S&P 500 Index, the KBW Bank Index and the S&P Financial Index. The S&P 500 Index is a commonly referenced U.S. equity benchmark consisting of leading companies from different economic sectors. The KBW Bank Index seeks to reflect the performance of banks and thrifts that are publicly traded in the U.S. and is composed of 24 leading national money center and regional banks and thrifts. The S&P Financial Index is an index of 85 financial companies, all of which are components of the S&P 500. The Firm is a component of all three industry indices.
The following table and graph assume simultaneous investments of $100 on December 31, 2009, in JPMorgan Chase common stock and in each of the above indices. The comparison assumes that all dividends are reinvested.
December 31,
(in dollars)
2009
 
2010
 
2011
 
2012
 
2013
 
2014
JPMorgan Chase
$
100.00

 
$
102.30

 
$
81.87

 
$
111.49

 
$
152.42

 
$
167.48

KBW Bank Index
100.00

 
123.36

 
94.75

 
125.91

 
173.45

 
189.69

S&P Financial Index
100.00

 
112.13

 
93.00

 
119.73

 
162.34

 
186.98

S&P 500 Index
100.00

 
115.06

 
117.48

 
136.27

 
180.39

 
205.07

 

JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
63

Management’s discussion and analysis

This section of JPMorgan Chase’s Annual Report for the year ended December 31, 2014 (“Annual Report”), provides Management’s discussion and analysis (“MD&A”) of the financial condition and results of operations of JPMorgan Chase. See the Glossary of Terms on pages 309–313 for definitions of terms used throughout this Annual Report. The MD&A included in this Annual Report contains statements that are forward-looking within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Such statements are based on the current beliefs and expectations of JPMorgan Chase’s management and are subject to significant risks and uncertainties. These risks and uncertainties could cause the Firm’s actual results to differ materially from those set forth in such forward-looking statements. Certain of such risks and uncertainties are described herein (see Forward-looking Statements on page 169) and in JPMorgan Chase’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014 (“2014 Form 10-K”), in Part I, Item 1A: Risk factors; reference is hereby made to both.


INTRODUCTION
JPMorgan Chase & Co., a financial holding company incorporated under Delaware law in 1968, is a leading global financial services firm and one of the largest banking institutions in the U.S., with operations worldwide; the Firm had $2.6 trillion in assets and $232.1 billion in stockholders’ equity as of December 31, 2014. The Firm is a leader in investment banking, financial services for consumers and small businesses, commercial banking, financial transaction processing and asset management. Under the J.P. Morgan and Chase brands, the Firm serves millions of customers in the U.S. and many of the world’s most prominent corporate, institutional and government clients.
JPMorgan Chase’s principal bank subsidiaries are JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association (“JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.”), a national banking association with U.S. branches in 23 states, and Chase Bank USA, National Association (“Chase Bank USA, N.A.”), a national banking association that is the Firm’s credit card–issuing bank. JPMorgan Chase’s principal nonbank subsidiary is J.P. Morgan Securities LLC (“JPMorgan Securities”), the Firm’s U.S. investment banking firm. The bank and nonbank subsidiaries of JPMorgan Chase operate nationally as well as through overseas branches and subsidiaries, representative offices and subsidiary foreign banks. One of the Firm’s principal operating subsidiaries in the U.K. is J.P. Morgan Securities plc, a subsidiary of JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.
 
JPMorgan Chase’s activities are organized, for management reporting purposes, into four major reportable business segments, as well as a Corporate segment. The Firm’s consumer business is the Consumer & Community Banking (“CCB”) segment. The Corporate & Investment Bank (“CIB”), Commercial Banking (“CB”), and Asset Management (“AM”) segments comprise the Firm’s wholesale businesses. For a description of the Firm’s business segments, and the products and services they provide to their respective client bases refer to Business Segment Results on pages 79–104, and Note 33.



64
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



EXECUTIVE OVERVIEW
This executive overview of the MD&A highlights selected information and may not contain all of the information that is important to readers of this Annual Report. For a complete description of events, trends and uncertainties, as well as the enterprise risks and critical accounting estimates affecting the Firm and its various lines of business, this Annual Report should be read in its entirety.
Financial performance of JPMorgan Chase
 
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions, except per share data and ratios)
2014
 
2013
 
Change
Selected income statement data
 
 
 
 
 
Total net revenue
$
94,205

 
$
96,606

 
(2
)%
Total noninterest expense
61,274

 
70,467

 
(13
)
Pre-provision profit
32,931

 
26,139

 
26

Provision for credit losses
3,139

 
225

 
    NM
Net income
21,762

 
17,923

 
21

Diluted earnings per share
5.29

 
4.35

 
22

Return on common equity
10
%
 
9
%
 
 
Capital ratios(a)
 
 
 
 
 
CET1
10.2

 
10.7

 
 
Tier 1 capital
11.6

 
11.9

 
 
(a)
Basel III Transitional rules became effective on January 1, 2014; December 31, 2013 data is based on Basel I rules. As of December 31, 2014 the ratios presented are calculated under the Basel III Advanced Transitional Approach. CET1 capital under Basel III replaced Tier 1 common capital under Basel I. Prior to Basel III becoming effective on January 1, 2014, Tier 1 common capital under Basel I was a non-GAAP financial measure. See Regulatory capital on pages 146–153 for additional information on Basel III and non-GAAP financial measures of regulatory capital.

Summary of 2014 Results
JPMorgan Chase reported record full-year 2014 net income of $21.8 billion, and record earnings per share of $5.29, on net revenue of $94.2 billion. Net income increased by $3.8 billion, or 21%, compared with net income of $17.9 billion, or $4.35 per share, in 2013. ROE for the year was 10%, compared with 9% for the prior year.
The increase in net income in 2014 was driven by lower noninterest expense, largely offset by higher provision for credit losses and lower net revenue. The decrease in noninterest expense was driven by lower legal expense as well as lower compensation expense.
The provision for credit losses increased from the prior year as result of a lower level of benefit from reductions in the consumer allowance for loan losses, partially offset by lower net charge-offs. The decrease in the consumer allowance for loan losses was predominantly the result of continued improvement in home prices and delinquencies in the residential real estate portfolio. The wholesale provision reflected a continued favorable credit environment.
Total firmwide allowance for credit losses was $14.8 billion resulting in a loan loss coverage ratio of 1.55%, excluding the purchase credit-impaired (“PCI”) portfolio, compared with 1.80% in the prior year. The Firm’s allowance for loan losses to nonperforming loans retained, excluding the PCI
 
portfolio and credit card, was 106% compared with 100% in 2013.
Firmwide, net charge-offs were $4.8 billion for the year, down $1.0 billion, or 18% from 2013. Nonperforming assets at year-end were $8.0 billion, down $1.7 billion, or 18%.
The Firm’s results reflected solid underlying performance across its four major reportable business segments, with continued strong lending and deposit growth. Consumer & Community Banking was #1 in deposit growth for the third consecutive year and Consumer & Business Banking within Consumer & Community Banking was #1 in customer satisfaction among the largest U.S. banks for the third consecutive year as measured by The American Customer Satisfaction Index (“ACSI”). Credit card sales volume (excluding Commercial Card) was up 11% for the year. The Corporate & Investment Bank maintained its #1 ranking in Global Investment Banking Fees and moved up to a #1 ranking in Europe, Middle East and Africa (“EMEA”), according to Dealogic. Commercial Banking loans increased to $149 billion, an 8% increase compared with the prior year. Commercial Banking also had record gross investment banking revenue of $2.0 billion, up 18% compared with the prior year. Asset Management achieved twenty-three consecutive quarters of positive net long-term client flows and increased average loan balances by 16% in 2014.
The Firm maintained its fortress balance sheet, ending the year with an estimated Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-in CET1 capital ratio of 10.2%, compared with 9.5% in the prior year. Total deposits increased to $1.4 trillion, up 6% from the prior year. Total stockholders’ equity was $232 billion at December 31, 2014. (The Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-in CET1 capital ratio is a non-GAAP financial measure, which the Firm uses along with the other capital measures, to assess and monitor its capital position. For further discussion of the Firm’s capital ratios, see Regulatory capital on pages 146–153.)
During 2014, the Firm continued to serve customers, corporate clients and the communities in which it does business. The Firm provided credit to and raised capital of $2.1 trillion for its clients during 2014; this included $19 billion lent to U.S. small businesses and $75 billion to nonprofit and government entities, including states, municipalities, hospitals and universities.
The discussion that follows highlights the performance of each business segment compared with the prior year and presents results on a managed basis. For more information about managed basis, as well as other non-GAAP financial measures used by management to evaluate the performance of each line of business, see pages 77–78.
Consumer & Community Banking net income was $9.2 billion, a decrease of 17% compared with the prior year, due to higher provision for credit losses and lower net revenue, partially offset by lower noninterest expense. Net interest income decreased, driven by spread compression and lower mortgage warehouse balances, largely offset by higher deposit balances in Consumer & Business Banking


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
65

Management’s discussion and analysis

and higher loan balances in Credit Card. Noninterest revenue decreased, driven by lower mortgage fees and related income. The provision for credit losses was $3.5 billion, compared with $335 million in the prior year. The current-year provision reflected a $1.3 billion reduction in the allowance for loan losses and total net charge-offs of $4.8 billion. Noninterest expense decreased from the prior year, driven by lower Mortgage Banking expense.
Corporate & Investment Bank net income was $6.9 billion, a decrease of 22% compared with the prior year, primarily reflecting lower revenue as well as higher noninterest expense. Banking revenues decreased from the prior year primarily due to lower Lending revenues, driven by mark to market losses on securities received from restructured loans, compared to gains in the prior year, partially offset by higher investment banking fees. Markets & Investor Services revenues increased slightly from the prior year as 2013 included losses from FVA/DVA, primarily driven by FVA implementation, while the current year reflected lower Fixed Income Markets revenue. Credit Adjustments & Other revenue was a loss of $272 million. Noninterest expense increased compared with the prior year driven by higher noncompensation expense, predominantly due to higher legal expense and investment in controls. This was partially offset by lower performance-based compensation expense.
Commercial Banking net income was $2.6 billion, flat compared with the prior year, reflecting lower net revenue and higher noninterest expense, predominantly offset by a lower provision for credit losses. Net interest income decreased from the prior year, reflecting yield compression, the absence of proceeds received in the prior year from a lending-related workout, and lower purchase discounts recognized on loan repayments, partially offset by higher loan balances. Noninterest revenue increased, reflecting higher investment banking revenue, largely offset by business simplification and lower lending fees. Noninterest expense increased from the prior year, largely reflecting higher investments in controls.
Asset Management net income was $2.2 billion, an increase of 3% from the prior year, reflecting higher net revenue and lower provision for credit losses, predominantly offset by higher noninterest expense. Noninterest revenue increased from the prior year, due to net client inflows and the effect of higher market levels, partially offset by lower valuations of seed capital investments. Noninterest expense increased from the prior year, as the business continues to invest in both infrastructure and controls.
Corporate net income was $864 million, an increase compared with a loss in the prior year. The current year included $821 million of legal expense, compared with $10.2 billion of legal expense, which included reserves for litigation and regulatory proceedings, in the prior year.






 
Business outlook
The following forward-looking statements are based on the current beliefs and expectations of JPMorgan Chase’s management and are subject to significant risks and uncertainties. These risks and uncertainties could cause the Firm’s actual results to differ materially from those set forth in such forward-looking statements. See Forward-Looking Statements on page 169 and the Risk Factors section on pages 8–17.
Over the past few years, the Firm has been adapting to the regulatory environment while continuing to serve its clients and customers, invest in its businesses, and deliver strong returns to its shareholders. The Firm’s initiatives include building a fortress control environment, de-risking and simplification of the organization, a disciplined approach to managing expense, evolving its capital assessment framework as well as rigorous optimization of the Firm’s balance sheet and funding.
The Firm has been devoting substantial resources to execute on its control agenda. The Oversight and Control function, established in 2012, has been working closely and extensively with the Firm’s other control disciplines, including Compliance, Risk Management, Legal, Internal Audit, and other functions, to address the Firm's control-related projects that are cross-line of business and that have significant regulatory impact or respond to regulatory actions. The Firm’s investment in the control agenda and investment in technology, are considered by management to be essential to the Firm’s future.
The Firm has substantially completed executing its business simplification agenda. In 2013, the Firm ceased originating student loans, exited certain high risk customers and became more selective about on-boarding certain customers. Following on these initiatives, in 2014, the Firm exited several non-core credit card co-branded relationships, sold the Retirement Plan Services business within AM, exited certain prepaid card businesses, reduced its offering of mortgage banking products, completed the sale of the CIB’s Global Special Opportunity Group investment portfolio, and the sale and liquidation of a significant part of CIB’s physical commodities business. In January 2015, the Firm completed the “spin out” of the One Equity Partners (“OEP”) private equity business (together with a sale of a portion of the OEP portfolio to a group of private equity firms). These actions will allow the Firm to focus on core activities for its core clients and reduce risk to the Firm. While it is anticipated that these exits will reduce revenues and expenses, they are not expected to have a meaningful impact on the Firm’s profitability.
The Firm’s simplification agenda, however, is more extensive than exiting businesses, products or clients that were non-core, not at scale or not returning the appropriate level of return. The Firm is also focused on operational and structural simplicity, and streamlining and centralizing certain operational functions and processes in order to attain more consistencies and efficiencies across the Firm. To that end, the Firm is working on simplifying its legal entity structure, simplifying its Global Technology function,


66
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



rationalizing its use of vendors, and optimizing its real estate location strategy.
As the Firm continues to experience an unprecedented increase in regulation and supervision, it continues to evolve its financial architecture to respond to this changing landscape. In 2014, the Firm exceeded the minimum capital levels required by the current rules and intends to continue to build capital in response to the higher Global Systemically Important Bank (“G-SIB”) capital surcharge proposed by U.S. banking regulators. In addition, the Firm is adapting its capital assessment framework to review businesses and client relationships against G-SIB and applicable capital requirements, and imposing internal limits on business activities to align or optimize the Firm's balance sheet and RWA with regulatory requirements in order to ensure that business activities generate appropriate levels of shareholder value.
The Firm intends to balance return of capital to shareholders with achieving higher capital ratios over time. The Firm expects the capital ratio calculated under the Basel III Standardized Approach to become its binding constraint by the end of 2015, or slightly thereafter. The Firm anticipates reaching Basel III Fully Phased-In Advanced and Standardized CET1 ratios of approximately 11% by the end of 2015 and is targeting a Basel III CET1 ratio of approximately 12% by the end of 2018, assuming a 4.5% G-SIB capital surcharge. If the Firm's G-SIB capital surcharge is lower than 4.5%, the Firm will adjust its Basel III CET1 target accordingly.
Likewise, the Firm will be evolving its funding framework to ensure it meets the current and proposed more stringent regulatory liquidity rules, including those relating to the availability of adequate Total Loss Absorbing Capacity (“TLAC”) at G-SIB organizations. The Firm estimated that it had, as of December 31, 2014, approximately 15% minimum TLAC as a percentage of Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-in RWA, excluding capital buffers currently in effect, based on its understanding of how the Financial Stability Board's proposal may be implemented in the U.S. While the precise composition and calibration of TLAC, as well as the conformance period, are yet to be defined by U.S. banking regulators, the Firm expects the requirement will lead to incremental debt issuance by the Firm and higher funding costs over the next few years.
The Firm expects it will continue to make appropriate adjustments to its businesses and operations in the year ahead in response to ongoing developments in the legal and regulatory, as well as business and economic, environment in which it operates. The Firm intends to take a disciplined approach to growing revenues and controlling expenses in light of its capital and liquidity constraints. The Firm’s deep client relationships and its investments in its businesses, including branch optimization, new card relationships, expansion into new markets, and hiring additional sales staff and client advisors, are expected to generate significant revenue growth over the next several years. At the same time, the Firm intends to leverage its scale and improve its operating efficiencies so that it can fund these growth initiatives, as well as maintain its control and
 
technology programs, without increasing its expenses. As a result, the Firm anticipates achieving a managed overhead ratio of approximately 55% over the next several years, including the impact of revenue growth.
2015 Business Outlook
JPMorgan Chase’s outlook for the full-year 2015 should be viewed against the backdrop of the global and U.S. economies, financial markets activity, the geopolitical environment, the competitive environment, client activity levels, and regulatory and legislative developments in the U.S. and other countries where the Firm does business. Each of these inter-related factors will affect the performance of the Firm and its lines of business.
Management expects core loan growth of approximately 10% in 2015. The Firm continues to experience charge-offs at levels lower than its through-the-cycle expectations; if favorable credit trends continue, management expects the Firm’s total net charge offs could remain low, at an amount modestly over $4 billion in 2015, and expects a reduction in the consumer allowance for loan losses over the next two years.
Firmwide adjusted expense in 2015 is expected to be approximately $57 billion, excluding Firmwide legal expenses and foreclosure-related matters.
In Consumer & Business Banking within CCB, management expects continued spread compression in the deposit margin and a modest decline in net interest income in the first quarter of 2015. In Mortgage Banking within CCB, management expects quarterly servicing expense to decline to below $500 million by the second quarter of 2015 as default volume continues to decline. In Card Services within CCB, management expects the revenue rate in 2015 to remain at the low end of the target range of 12% to 12.5%.
In CIB, Markets revenue in the first quarter of 2015 will be impacted by the Firm’s business simplification initiatives completed in 2014, resulting in a decline of approximately $500 million, or 10%, in Markets revenue and a decline of approximately $300 million in expense, compared to the prior year first quarter. Based on strong performance to date, particularly in January, management currently expects 2015 first quarter Markets revenue to be higher than the prior year first quarter, even with the negative impact of business simplification; however, Markets revenue actual results will depend on performance through the remainder of the quarter, which can be volatile.
Overall, the Firm expects the impact from its business simplification initiatives will be a reduction of approximately $1.6 billion in revenue and a corresponding reduction of approximately $1.6 billion in expense resulting in no meaningful impact on the Firm’s 2015 anticipated net income.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
67

Management’s discussion and analysis

CONSOLIDATED RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
The following section provides a comparative discussion of JPMorgan Chase’s Consolidated Results of Operations on a reported basis for the three-year period ended December 31, 2014. Factors that relate primarily to a single business segment are discussed in more detail within that business segment. For a discussion of the Critical Accounting Estimates Used by the Firm that affect the Consolidated Results of Operations, see pages 161–165.
Revenue
 
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31,
 
 
 
 
 
(in millions)
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Investment banking fees
$
6,542

 
$
6,354

 
$
5,808

Principal transactions(a)
10,531

 
10,141

 
5,536

Lending- and deposit-related fees
5,801

 
5,945

 
6,196

Asset management, administration and commissions
15,931

 
15,106

 
13,868

Securities gains
77

 
667

 
2,110

Mortgage fees and related income
3,563

 
5,205

 
8,687

Card income
6,020

 
6,022

 
5,658

Other income(b)
2,106

 
3,847

 
4,258

Noninterest revenue
50,571

 
53,287

 
52,121

Net interest income
43,634

 
43,319

 
44,910

Total net revenue
$
94,205

 
$
96,606

 
$
97,031

(a)
Included funding valuation adjustments ((“FVA”) effective 2013)) and debit valuation adjustments (“DVA”) on over-the-counter (“OTC”) derivatives and structured notes, measured at fair value. FVA and DVA gains/(losses) were $468 million and $(1.9) billion for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. DVA losses were ($930) million for the year ended December 31, 2012.
(b)
Included operating lease income of $1.7 billion, $1.5 billion and $1.3 billion for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

2014 compared with 2013
Total net revenue for 2014 was down by $2.4 billion, or 2%, compared with the prior year, predominantly due to lower mortgage fees and related income, and lower other income. The decrease was partially offset by higher asset management, administration and commissions revenue.
Investment banking fees increased compared with the prior year, due to higher advisory and equity underwriting fees, largely offset by lower debt underwriting fees. The increase in advisory fees was driven by the combined impact of a greater share of fees for completed transactions, and growth in industry-wide fee levels. The increase in equity underwriting fees was driven by higher industry-wide issuance. The decrease in debt underwriting fees was primarily related to lower bond underwriting compared with a stronger prior year, and lower loan syndication fees on lower industry-wide fee levels. Investment banking fee share and industry-wide data are sourced from Dealogic, an external vendor. For additional information on investment
 
banking fees, see CIB segment results on pages 92–96, CB segment results on pages 97–99, and Note 7.
Principal transactions revenue, which consists of revenue primarily from the Firm’s client-driven market-making and private equity investing activities, increased compared with the prior year as the prior year included a $1.5 billion loss related to the implementation of the FVA framework for OTC derivatives and structured notes. The increase was also due to higher private equity gains as a result of higher net gains on sales. The increase was partially offset by lower fixed income markets revenue in CIB, primarily driven by credit-related and rates products, as well as the impact of business simplification initiatives. For additional information on principal transactions revenue, see CIB and Corporate segment results on pages 92–96 and pages 103–104, respectively, and Note 7.
Lending- and deposit-related fees decreased compared with the prior year, reflecting the impact of business simplification initiatives and lower trade finance revenue in CIB. For additional information on lending- and deposit-related fees, see the segment results for CCB on pages 81–91, CIB on pages 92–96 and CB on pages 97–99.
Asset management, administration and commissions revenue increased compared with the prior year, reflecting higher asset management fees driven by net client inflows and the effect of higher market levels in AM and CCB. The increase was offset partially by lower commissions and other fee revenue in CCB as a result of the exit of a non-core product in the second half of 2013. For additional information on these fees and commissions, see the segment discussions of CCB on pages 81–91, AM on pages 100–102, and Note 7.
Securities gains decreased compared with the prior year, reflecting lower repositioning activity related to the Firm’s investment securities portfolio. For additional information, see the Corporate segment discussion on pages 103–104 and Note 12.
Mortgage fees and related income decreased compared with the prior year. The decrease was predominantly due to lower net production revenue driven by lower volumes due to higher levels of mortgage interest rates, and tighter margins. The decline in net production revenue was partially offset by a lower loss on the risk management of mortgage servicing rights (“MSRs”). For additional information, see the segment discussion of CCB on pages 85–87 and Note 17.
Card income remained relatively flat but included higher net interchange income on credit and debit cards due to growth in sales volume, offset by higher amortization of new account origination costs. For additional information on credit card income, see CCB segment results on pages 81–91.


68
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Other income decreased from the prior year, predominantly as a result of the absence of two significant items recorded in Corporate in 2013, namely: a $1.3 billion gain on the sale of Visa shares and a $493 million gain from the sale of One Chase Manhattan Plaza. Lower valuations of seed capital investments in AM and losses related to the exit of non-core portfolios in Card also contributed to the decrease. These items were partially offset by higher auto lease income as a result of growth in auto lease volume, and a benefit from a tax settlement.
Net interest income increased slightly from the prior year, predominantly reflecting higher yields on investment securities, the impact of lower interest expense, and higher average loan balances. The increase was partially offset by lower yields on loans due to the run-off of higher-yielding loans and new originations of lower-yielding loans, and lower average interest-earning trading asset balances. The Firm’s average interest-earning assets were $2.0 trillion, and the net interest yield on these assets, on a fully taxable-equivalent (“FTE”) basis, was 2.18%, a decrease of 5 basis points from the prior year.
2013 compared with 2012
Total net revenue for 2013 was down by $425 million, or less than 1%. The 2013 results were driven by lower mortgage fees and related income, net interest income, and securities gains, predominantly offset by higher principal transactions revenue, and asset management, administration and commissions revenue.
Investment banking fees increased compared with the prior year, reflecting higher equity and debt underwriting fees, partially offset by lower advisory fees. Equity and debt underwriting fees increased, driven by strong market issuance and greater share of fees in equity capital markets and loans. Advisory fees decreased, as industry-wide M&A fee levels declined. Investment banking fee share and industry-wide data are sourced from Dealogic, an external vendor.
Principal transactions revenue increased compared with the prior year, reflecting CIB’s strong equity markets revenue, partially offset by a $1.5 billion loss from implementing a FVA framework for OTC derivatives and structured notes in the fourth quarter of 2013, and a $452 million loss from DVA on structured notes and derivative liabilities (compared with a $930 million loss from DVA in the prior year). The prior year also included a $5.8 billion loss on the synthetic credit portfolio incurred by CIO in the six months ended June 30, 2012; a $449 million loss on the index credit derivative positions retained by CIO in the three months ended September 30, 2012; and additional modest losses incurred by CIB from the synthetic credit portfolio in the last six months of 2012. These losses were partially offset by a $665 million gain recognized in 2012 in Corporate, representing the recovery on a Bear Stearns-related subordinated loan.
 
Lending- and deposit-related fees decreased compared with the prior year, largely due to lower deposit-related fees in CCB, resulting from reductions in certain product and transaction fees.
Asset management, administration and commissions revenue increased from 2012, driven by higher investment management fees in AM due to net client inflows, the effect of higher market levels, and higher performance fees, and to higher investment sales revenue in CCB.
Securities gains decreased compared with the prior-year period, reflecting the results of repositioning the CIO available-for-sale (“AFS”) portfolio.
Mortgage fees and related income decreased in 2013 compared with 2012, reflecting lower Mortgage Banking net production and servicing revenue. The decrease in net production revenue was due to lower margins and volumes. The decrease in net servicing revenue was predominantly due to lower MSR risk management results.
Card income increased compared with the prior year period, driven by higher net interchange income on credit and debit cards and higher merchant servicing revenue due to growth in sales volume.
Other income decreased in 2013 compared with the prior year, predominantly reflecting lower revenues from significant items recorded in Corporate. In 2013, the Firm recognized a $1.3 billion gain on the sale of Visa shares, a $493 million gain from the sale of One Chase Manhattan Plaza, and a modest loss related to the redemption of TruPS. In 2012, the Firm recognized a $1.1 billion benefit from the Washington Mutual bankruptcy settlement and an $888 million extinguishment gain related to the redemption of TruPS. The net decrease was partially offset by higher revenue in CIB, largely from client-driven activity.
Net interest income decreased in 2013 compared with the prior year, primarily reflecting the impact of the runoff of higher yielding loans and originations of lower yielding loans, and lower trading-related net interest income. The decrease in net interest income was partially offset by lower long-term debt and other funding costs. The Firm’s average interest-earning assets were $2.0 trillion in 2013, and the net interest yield on those assets, on a FTE basis, was 2.23%, a decrease of 25 basis points from the prior year.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
69

Management’s discussion and analysis

Provision for credit losses
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31,
 
 
 
 
 
(in millions)
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Consumer, excluding credit card
$
419

 
$
(1,871
)
 
$
302

Credit card
3,079

 
2,179

 
3,444

Total consumer
3,498

 
308

 
3,746

Wholesale
(359
)
 
(83
)
 
(361
)
Total provision for credit losses
$
3,139

 
$
225

 
$
3,385

2014 compared with 2013
The provision for credit losses increased by $2.9 billion from the prior year as result of a lower benefit from reductions in the consumer allowance for loan losses, partially offset by lower net charge-offs. The consumer allowance release in 2014 was primarily related to the consumer, excluding credit card portfolio, and reflected the continued improvement in home prices and delinquencies in the residential real estate portfolio. The wholesale provision reflected a continued favorable credit environment. For a more detailed discussion of the credit portfolio and the allowance for credit losses, see the segment discussions of CCB on pages 81–91, CIB on pages 92–96 and CB on pages 97–99, and the Allowance for credit losses section on pages 128–130.
2013 compared with 2012
The provision for credit losses decreased by $3.2 billion compared with the prior year, due to a higher benefit from reductions in the allowance for loan losses, as well as lower net charge-offs partially due to incremental charge-offs recorded in 2012 in accordance with regulatory guidance on certain loans discharged under Chapter 7 bankruptcy. The consumer allowance release in 2013 reflected the improvement in home prices in the residential real estate portfolio and improvement in delinquencies in the residential real estate and credit card portfolios. The 2013 wholesale provision reflected a favorable credit environment and stable credit quality trends.
 
Noninterest expense
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions)
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Compensation expense
$
30,160

 
$
30,810

 
$
30,585

Noncompensation expense:
 
 
 
 
 
Occupancy
3,909

 
3,693

 
3,925

Technology, communications and equipment
5,804

 
5,425

 
5,224

Professional and outside services
7,705

 
7,641

 
7,429

Marketing
2,550

 
2,500

 
2,577

Other(a)(b)
11,146

 
20,398

 
14,989

Total noncompensation expense
31,114

 
39,657

 
34,144

Total noninterest expense
$
61,274

 
$
70,467

 
$
64,729

(a)
Included firmwide legal expense of $2.9 billion, $11.1 billion and $5.0 billion for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
(b)
Included FDIC-related expense of $1.0 billion, $1.5 billion and $1.7 billion for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
2014 compared with 2013
Total noninterest expense decreased by $9.2 billion, or 13%, from the prior year, driven by lower other expense (in particular, legal expense) and lower compensation expense.
Compensation expense decreased compared with the prior year, predominantly driven by lower headcount in CCB’s Mortgage Banking business, lower performance-based compensation expense in CIB, and lower postretirement benefit costs. The decrease was partially offset by investments in the businesses, including headcount, for controls.
Noncompensation expense decreased compared with the prior year, due to lower other expense, predominantly reflecting lower legal expense. Lower expense for foreclosure-related matters and lower production and servicing-related expense in CCB’s Mortgage Banking business, lower FDIC-related assessments, and lower amortization expense due to the completion of the amortization of certain intangibles, also contributed to the decline. The decrease was offset partially by investments in the businesses, including for controls, and costs related to business simplification initiatives across the Firm. For a further discussion of legal expense, see Note 31. For a discussion of amortization of intangibles, refer to Note 17.
2013 compared with 2012
Total noninterest expense was up by $5.7 billion, or 9%, compared with the prior year, predominantly due to higher legal expense.
Compensation expense increased in 2013 compared with the prior year, due to the impact of investments across the businesses, including front office sales and support staff, and costs related to the Firm’s control agenda; these were partially offset by lower compensation expense in CIB and in CCB’s Mortgage Banking business, reflecting the effect of lower servicing headcount.


70
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Noncompensation expense increased in 2013 from the prior year. The increase was due to higher other expense, reflecting $11.1 billion of firmwide legal expense, predominantly in Corporate, representing additional reserves for several litigation and regulatory proceedings, compared with $5.0 billion of expense in the prior year. Investments in the businesses, higher legal-related professional services expense, and costs related to the Firm’s control agenda also contributed to the increase. The increase was offset partially by lower mortgage servicing expense in CCB and lower occupancy expense for the Firm, which predominantly reflected the absence of charges recognized in 2012 related to vacating excess space.
Income tax expense
 
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31,
(in millions, except rate)
 
 
 
 
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Income before income tax expense
$
29,792

 
$
25,914

 
$
28,917

Income tax expense
8,030

 
7,991

 
7,633

Effective tax rate
27.0
%
 
30.8
%
 
26.4
%
 
2014 compared with 2013
The decrease in the effective tax rate from the prior year was largely attributable to the effect of the lower level of nondeductible legal-related penalties, partially offset by higher 2014 pretax income, in combination with changes in the mix of income and expense subject to U.S. federal, state and local income taxes, and lower tax benefits associated with tax adjustments and the settlement of tax audits. For additional information on income taxes, see Critical Accounting Estimates Used by the Firm on pages 161–165 and Note 26.
2013 compared with 2012
The increase in the effective tax rate compared with the prior year was predominantly due to the effect of higher nondeductible legal-related penalties in 2013. This was largely offset by the impact of lower pretax income, in combination with changes in the mix of income and expense subject to U.S. federal, state and local taxes, business tax credits, tax benefits associated with prior year tax adjustments and audit resolutions.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
71

Management’s discussion and analysis

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS ANALYSIS
Selected Consolidated balance sheets data
 
December 31, (in millions)
2014
 
2013
Change
Assets
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
$
27,831

 
$
39,771

(30
)%
Deposits with banks
484,477

 
316,051

53

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements
215,803

 
248,116

(13
)
Securities borrowed
110,435

 
111,465

(1
)
Trading assets:
 
 
 
 
Debt and equity instruments
320,013

 
308,905

4

Derivative receivables
78,975

 
65,759

20

Securities
348,004

 
354,003

(2
)
Loans
757,336

 
738,418

3

Allowance for loan losses
(14,185
)
 
(16,264
)
(13
)
Loans, net of allowance for loan losses
743,151

 
722,154

3

Accrued interest and accounts receivable
70,079

 
65,160

8

Premises and equipment
15,133

 
14,891

2

Goodwill
47,647

 
48,081

(1
)
Mortgage servicing rights
7,436

 
9,614

(23
)
Other intangible assets
1,192

 
1,618

(26
)
Other assets
102,950

 
110,101

(6
)
Total assets
$
2,573,126

 
$
2,415,689

7

Liabilities
 
 
 
 
Deposits
$
1,363,427

 
$
1,287,765

6

Federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements
192,101

 
181,163

6

Commercial paper
66,344

 
57,848

15

Other borrowed funds
30,222

 
27,994

8

Trading liabilities:
 
 
 
 
Debt and equity instruments
81,699

 
80,430

2

Derivative payables
71,116

 
57,314

24

Accounts payable and other liabilities
206,954

 
194,491

6

Beneficial interests issued by consolidated VIEs
52,362

 
49,617

6

Long-term debt
276,836

 
267,889

3

Total liabilities
2,341,061

 
2,204,511

6

Stockholders’ equity
232,065

 
211,178

10

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
$
2,573,126

 
$
2,415,689

7
 %

Consolidated balance sheets overview
JPMorgan Chase’s total assets and total liabilities increased by $157.4 billion and $136.6 billion, respectively, from December 31, 2013.
 
The following is a discussion of the significant changes in the Consolidated balance sheets from December 31, 2013.
Cash and due from banks and deposits with banks
The net increase was attributable to higher levels of excess funds primarily as a result of growth in deposits. The Firm’s excess funds were placed with various central banks, predominantly Federal Reserve Banks.
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements
The decrease in federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements was predominantly attributable to a shift in the deployment of the Firm’s excess cash by Treasury to deposits with banks and to client activity, including a decline in public deposits that require collateral.
Trading assets and liabilitiesdebt and equity instruments
The increase in trading assets and liabilities predominantly related to client-driven market-making activities in CIB was primarily driven by higher levels of debt securities and trading loans. For additional information, refer to Note 3.
Trading assets and liabilitiesderivative receivables and payables
The increase in both receivables and payables was predominantly due to client-driven market-making activities in CIB, specifically in interest rate derivatives as a result of market movements; commodity derivatives predominantly driven by the significant decline in oil prices; and foreign exchange derivatives reflecting the appreciation of the U.S. dollar against certain currencies. The increases were partially offset by a decline in equity derivatives. For additional information, refer to Derivative contracts on pages 125–127, and Notes 3 and 5.
Securities
The decrease was predominantly due to lower levels of non-U.S. residential mortgage-backed securities and U.S. Treasuries, partially offset by higher levels of obligations of U.S. states and municipalities and U.S. residential mortgage-backed securities. For additional information related to securities, refer to the discussion in the Corporate segment on pages 103–104, and Notes 3 and 12.
Loans and allowance for loan losses
The increase in loans was attributable to higher consumer and wholesale loans. The increase in consumer loans was due to prime mortgage originations in CCB and AM, as well as credit card, business banking and auto loan originations in CCB, partially offset by paydowns and charge-offs or liquidation of delinquent loans. The increase in wholesale loans was due to a favorable credit environment throughout 2014, which drove an increase in client activity.


72
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The decrease in the allowance for loan losses was driven by a reduction in the consumer allowance, predominantly as a result of continued improvement in home prices and delinquencies in the residential real estate portfolio. For a more detailed discussion of the loan portfolio and the allowance for loan losses, refer to Credit Risk Management on pages 110–111, and Notes 3, 4, 14 and 15.
Accrued interest and accounts receivable
The increase was due to higher receivables from security sales that did not settle, and higher client receivables related to client-driven market-making activities in CIB.
Mortgage servicing rights
For additional information on MSRs, see Note 17.
Other assets
The decrease was driven by several factors, including lower deferred tax assets; lower private equity investments due to sales, partially offset by unrealized gains; and lower real estate owned.
Deposits
The increase was attributable to higher consumer and wholesale deposits. The increase in consumer deposits reflected a continuing positive growth trend, resulting from strong customer retention, maturing of recent branch builds, and net new business. The increase in wholesale deposits was driven by client activity and business growth. For more information on consumer deposits, refer to the CCB segment discussion on pages 81–91; the Liquidity Risk Management discussion on pages 156–160; and Notes 3 and 19. For more information on wholesale client deposits, refer to the AM, CB and CIB segment discussions on pages 100–102, pages 97–99 and pages 92–96, respectively, and the Liquidity Risk Management discussion on pages 156–160.
Federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements
The increase in federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements was predominantly attributable to higher financing of the Firm’s trading assets-debt and equity instruments. The increase was partially offset by client activity in CIB. For additional information on the Firm’s Liquidity Risk Management, see pages 156–160.
 
Commercial paper
The increase was due to commercial paper issuances in the wholesale markets consistent with Treasury’s liquidity and short-term funding plans and, to a lesser extent, a higher volume of liability balances related to CIB’s liquidity management product whereby clients choose to sweep their deposits into commercial paper. For additional information on the Firm’s other borrowed funds, see Liquidity Risk Management on pages 156–160.
Accounts payable and other liabilities
The increase was attributable to higher client payables related to client short positions, and higher payables from security purchases that did not settle, both in CIB. The increase was partially offset by lower legal reserves, largely reflecting the settlement of legal and regulatory matters.
Beneficial interests issued by consolidated VIEs
The increase was predominantly due to net new consolidated credit card and municipal bond vehicles, partially offset by a reduction in conduit commercial paper issued to third parties and the deconsolidation of certain mortgage securitization trusts. For further information on Firm-sponsored VIEs and loan securitization trusts, see Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements on pages 74–75 and Note 16.
Long-term debt
The increase was due to net issuances, consistent with Treasury’s long-term funding plans. For additional information on the Firm’s long-term debt activities, see Liquidity Risk Management on pages 156–160.
Stockholders’ equity
The increase was due to net income and preferred stock issuances, partially offset by the declaration of cash dividends on common and preferred stock, and repurchases of common stock. For additional information on accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss) (“AOCI”), see Note 25; for the Firm’s capital actions, see Capital actions on page 154.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
73

Management’s discussion and analysis

OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS AND CONTRACTUAL CASH OBLIGATIONS

In the normal course of business, the Firm enters into various contractual obligations that may require future cash payments. Certain obligations are recognized on-balance sheet, while others are off-balance sheet under U.S. GAAP. The Firm is involved with several types of off–balance sheet arrangements, including through nonconsolidated special-purpose entities (“SPEs”), which are a type of VIE, and through lending-related financial instruments (e.g., commitments and guarantees).
Special-purpose entities
The most common type of VIE is an SPE. SPEs are commonly used in securitization transactions in order to isolate certain assets and distribute the cash flows from those assets to investors. SPEs are an important part of the financial markets, including the mortgage- and asset-backed securities and commercial paper markets, as they provide market liquidity by facilitating investors’ access to specific portfolios of assets and risks. SPEs may be organized as trusts, partnerships or corporations and are typically established for a single, discrete purpose. SPEs are not typically operating entities and usually have a limited life and no employees. The basic SPE structure involves a company selling assets to the SPE; the SPE funds the purchase of those assets by issuing securities to investors.
JPMorgan Chase uses SPEs as a source of liquidity for itself and its clients by securitizing financial assets, and by creating investment products for clients. The Firm is involved with SPEs through multi-seller conduits, investor intermediation activities, and loan securitizations. See Note 16 for further information on these types of SPEs.
The Firm holds capital, as deemed appropriate, against all SPE-related transactions and related exposures, such as derivative transactions and lending-related commitments and guarantees.
The Firm has no commitments to issue its own stock to support any SPE transaction, and its policies require that transactions with SPEs be conducted at arm’s length and reflect market pricing. Consistent with this policy, no JPMorgan Chase employee is permitted to invest in SPEs with which the Firm is involved where such investment would violate the Firm’s Code of Conduct. These rules prohibit employees from self-dealing and acting on behalf of the Firm in transactions with which they or their family have any significant financial interest.
Implications of a credit rating downgrade to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.
For certain liquidity commitments to SPEs, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. could be required to provide funding if its short-term credit rating were downgraded below specific levels, primarily “P-1”, “A-1” and “F1” for Moody’s, Standard &
 
Poor’s and Fitch, respectively. These liquidity commitments support the issuance of asset-backed commercial paper by Firm-administered consolidated SPEs. In the event of a short-term credit rating downgrade, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., absent other solutions, would be required to provide funding to the SPE, if the commercial paper could not be reissued as it matured. The aggregate amounts of commercial paper outstanding held by third parties as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, was $12.1 billion and $15.5 billion, respectively. The aggregate amounts of commercial paper outstanding could increase in future periods should clients of the Firm-administered consolidated SPEs draw down on certain unfunded lending-related commitments. These unfunded lending-related commitments were $9.9 billion and $9.2 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The Firm could facilitate the refinancing of some of the clients’ assets in order to reduce the funding obligation. For further information, see the discussion of Firm-administered multi-seller conduits in Note 16.
The Firm also acts as liquidity provider for certain municipal bond vehicles. The Firm’s obligation to perform as liquidity provider is conditional and is limited by certain termination events, which include bankruptcy or failure to pay by the municipal bond issuer or credit enhancement provider, an event of taxability on the municipal bonds or the immediate downgrade of the municipal bond to below investment grade. See Note 16 for additional information.
Off–balance sheet lending-related financial instruments, guarantees, and other commitments
JPMorgan Chase provides lending-related financial instruments (e.g., commitments and guarantees) to meet the financing needs of its customers. The contractual amount of these financial instruments represents the maximum possible credit risk to the Firm should the counterparty draw upon the commitment or the Firm be required to fulfill its obligation under the guarantee, and should the counterparty subsequently fail to perform according to the terms of the contract. Most of these commitments and guarantees expire without being drawn or a default occurring. As a result, the total contractual amount of these instruments is not, in the Firm’s view, representative of its actual future credit exposure or funding requirements. For further discussion of lending-related financial instruments, guarantees and other commitments, and the Firm’s accounting for them, see Lending-related commitments on page 125 and Note 29. For a discussion of liabilities associated with loan sales-and securitization-related indemnifications, see Note 29.



74
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Contractual cash obligations
The accompanying table summarizes, by remaining maturity, JPMorgan Chase’s significant contractual cash obligations at December 31, 2014. The contractual cash obligations included in the table below reflect the minimum contractual obligation under legally enforceable contracts with terms that are both fixed and determinable. Excluded from the below table are certain liabilities with variable cash flows and/or no obligation to return a stated amount of principal at the maturity.
 
The carrying amount of on-balance sheet obligations on the Consolidated balance sheets may differ from the minimum contractual amount of the obligations reported below. For a discussion of mortgage repurchase liabilities and other obligations, see Note 29.

Contractual cash obligations
 
 
 
 
 
By remaining maturity at December 31,
(in millions)
2014
2013
2015
2016-2017
2018-2019
After 2019
Total
Total
On-balance sheet obligations
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits(a)
$
1,345,919

$
8,200

$
3,318

$
4,160

$
1,361,597

$
1,286,587

Federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements
189,002

2,655

30

441

192,128

181,163

Commercial paper
66,344




66,344

57,848

Other borrowed funds(a)
15,734




15,734

15,655

Beneficial interests issued by consolidated VIEs(a)
27,833

12,860

6,125

3,382

50,200

47,621

Long-term debt(a)
33,982

86,620

61,468

80,818

262,888

256,739

Other(b)
3,494

1,217

1,022

2,622

8,355

7,720

Total on-balance sheet obligations
1,682,308

111,552

71,963

91,423

1,957,246

1,853,333

Off-balance sheet obligations
 
 
 
 
 
 
Unsettled reverse repurchase and securities borrowing agreements(c)
40,993




40,993

38,211

Contractual interest payments(d)
6,980

10,006

6,596

24,456

48,038

48,021

Operating leases(e)
1,722

3,216

2,402

5,101

12,441

14,266

Equity investment commitments(f)
454

92

50

512

1,108

2,119

Contractual purchases and capital expenditures
1,216

970

366

280

2,832

3,425

Obligations under affinity and co-brand programs
906

1,262

96

39

2,303

3,283

Other





11

Total off-balance sheet obligations
52,271

15,546

9,510

30,388

107,715

109,336

Total contractual cash obligations
$
1,734,579

$
127,098

$
81,473

$
121,811

$
2,064,961

$
1,962,669

(a)
Excludes structured notes where the Firm is not obligated to return a stated amount of principal at the maturity of the notes, but is obligated to return an amount based on the performance of the structured notes.
(b)
Primarily includes dividends declared on preferred and common stock, deferred annuity contracts, pension and postretirement obligations and insurance liabilities. Prior periods were revised to conform with the current presentation.
(c)
For further information, refer to unsettled reverse repurchase and securities borrowing agreements in Note 29.
(d)
Includes accrued interest and future contractual interest obligations. Excludes interest related to structured notes where the Firm’s payment obligation is based on the performance of certain benchmarks.
(e)
Includes noncancelable operating leases for premises and equipment used primarily for banking purposes and for energy-related tolling service agreements. Excludes the benefit of noncancelable sublease rentals of $2.2 billion and $2.6 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
(f)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, included unfunded commitments of $147 million and $215 million, respectively, to third-party private equity funds; and $961 million and $1.9 billion of unfunded commitments, respectively, to other equity investments.

JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
75

Management’s discussion and analysis

CONSOLIDATED CASH FLOWS ANALYSIS
(in millions)
 
Year ended December 31,
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Net cash provided by/(used in)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Operating activities
 
$
36,593

 
$
107,953

 
$
25,079

Investing activities
 
(165,636
)
 
(150,501
)
 
(119,825
)
Financing activities
 
118,228

 
28,324

 
87,707

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash
 
(1,125
)
 
272

 
1,160

Net decrease in cash and due from banks
 
$
(11,940
)
 
$
(13,952
)
 
$
(5,879
)
Operating activities
JPMorgan Chase’s operating assets and liabilities support the Firm’s capital markets and lending activities, including the origination or purchase of loans initially designated as held-for-sale. Operating assets and liabilities can vary significantly in the normal course of business due to the amount and timing of cash flows, which are affected by client-driven and risk management activities and market conditions. The Firm believes cash flows from operations, available cash balances and the Firm’s ability to generate cash through short- and long-term borrowings are sufficient to fund the Firm’s operating liquidity needs.
Cash provided by operating activities in 2014 predominantly resulted from net income after noncash operating adjustments and reflected higher net proceeds from loan securitizations and sales activities when compared with 2013. In 2013 cash provided reflected a decrease in trading assets from client-driven market-making activities in CIB, resulting in lower levels of debt securities. Cash used in 2013 for loans originated and purchased with an initial intent to sell was slightly higher than the cash proceeds received from sales and paydowns of loans and reflected significantly higher levels of activities over the prior-year period. Cash provided during 2012 resulted from a decrease in securities borrowed reflecting a shift in the deployment of excess cash to resale agreements as well as lower client activity in CIB; partially offset by a decrease in accounts payable and other liabilities predominantly due to lower CIB client balances.
 
Investing activities
The Firm’s investing activities predominantly include loans originated to be held for investment, the investment securities portfolio and other short-term interest-earning assets. Cash used in investing activities during 2014, 2013, and 2012 resulted from increases in deposits with banks, attributable to higher levels of excess funds; in 2014, cash was used for growth in wholesale and consumer loans, while in 2013 and 2012 cash used reflected growth in wholesale loans. Partially offsetting these cash outflows in 2014 and 2013 was a net decline in securities purchased under resale agreements due to a shift in the deployment of the Firm’s excess cash by Treasury, and a net decline in consumer loans in 2013 and 2012 from paydowns and portfolio runoff or liquidation of delinquent loans. In 2012, additional cash was used for securities purchased under resale agreements. All years reflected cash proceeds from net maturities and sales of investment securities.
Financing activities
The Firm’s financing activities includes cash from customer deposits, and cash proceeds from issuing long-term debt, and preferred and common stock. Cash provided by financing activities in 2014 predominantly resulted from higher consumer and wholesale deposits. The increase in consumer deposits reflected a continuing positive growth trend resulting from strong customer retention, maturing of recent branch builds, and net new business. The increase in wholesale deposits was driven by client activity and deposit growth. Cash provided in 2013 was driven by growth in both wholesale and consumer deposits, net proceeds from long-term borrowings, and net issuance of preferred stock; partially offset by a decrease in securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements, predominantly due to changes in the mix of the Firm’s funding sources. Cash provided in 2012 was due to growth in both consumer and wholesale deposits and an increase in federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements due to higher secured financings of the Firm’s assets. In all periods, cash proceeds were offset by repurchases of common stock and cash dividends on common and preferred stock.
* * *
For a further discussion of the activities affecting the Firm’s cash flows, see Balance Sheet Analysis on pages 72–73.



76
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



EXPLANATION AND RECONCILIATION OF THE FIRM’S USE OF NON-GAAP FINANCIAL MEASURES
The Firm prepares its Consolidated Financial Statements using U.S. GAAP; these financial statements appear on pages 172–176. That presentation, which is referred to as “reported” basis, provides the reader with an understanding of the Firm’s results that can be tracked consistently from year to year and enables a comparison of the Firm’s performance with other companies’ U.S. GAAP financial statements.
In addition to analyzing the Firm’s results on a reported basis, management reviews the Firm’s results and the results of the lines of business on a “managed” basis, which is a non-GAAP financial measure. The Firm’s definition of managed basis starts with the reported U.S. GAAP results and includes certain reclassifications to present total net revenue for the Firm (and each of the reportable business segments) on a FTE basis. Accordingly, revenue from investments that receive tax credits and tax-exempt securities is presented in the managed results on a basis
 
comparable to taxable investments and securities. This non-GAAP financial measure allows management to assess the comparability of revenue arising from both taxable and tax-exempt sources. The corresponding income tax impact related to tax-exempt items is recorded within income tax expense. These adjustments have no impact on net income as reported by the Firm as a whole or by the lines of business.
Management also uses certain non-GAAP financial measures at the business-segment level, because it believes these other non-GAAP financial measures provide information to investors about the underlying operational performance and trends of the particular business segment and, therefore, facilitate a comparison of the business segment with the performance of its competitors. Non- GAAP financial measures used by the Firm may not be comparable to similarly named non-GAAP financial measures used by other companies.

The following summary table provides a reconciliation from the Firm’s reported U.S. GAAP results to managed basis.
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Year ended
December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
Reported
Results
 
Fully taxable-equivalent adjustments(a)
 
Managed
basis
 
Reported
Results
 
Fully taxable-equivalent adjustments(a)
 
Managed
basis
 
Reported
Results
 
Fully taxable-equivalent adjustments(a)
 
Managed
basis
Other income
$
2,106

 
$
2,733

 
$
4,839

 
$
3,847

 
$
2,495

 
$
6,342

 
$
4,258

 
$
2,116

 
$
6,374

Total noninterest revenue
50,571

 
2,733

 
53,304

 
53,287

 
2,495

 
55,782

 
52,121

 
2,116

 
54,237

Net interest income
43,634

 
985

 
44,619

 
43,319

 
697

 
44,016

 
44,910

 
743

 
45,653

Total net revenue
94,205

 
3,718

 
97,923

 
96,606

 
3,192

 
99,798

 
97,031

 
2,859

 
99,890

Pre-provision profit
32,931

 
3,718

 
36,649

 
26,139

 
3,192

 
29,331

 
32,302

 
2,859

 
35,161

Income before income tax expense
29,792

 
3,718

 
33,510

 
25,914

 
3,192

 
29,106

 
28,917

 
2,859

 
31,776

Income tax expense
8,030

 
3,718

 
11,748

 
7,991

 
3,192

 
11,183

 
7,633

 
2,859

 
10,492

Overhead ratio
65
%
 
NM

 
63
%
 
73
%
 
NM

 
71
%
 
67
%
 
NM

 
65
%
(a)
Predominantly recognized in CIB and CB business segments and Corporate.

Calculation of certain U.S. GAAP and non-GAAP financial measures
Certain U.S. GAAP and non-GAAP financial measures are calculated as follows:
Book value per share (“BVPS”)
Common stockholders’ equity at period-end /
Common shares at period-end
Overhead ratio
Total noninterest expense / Total net revenue
Return on assets (“ROA”)
Reported net income / Total average assets
Return on common equity (“ROE”)
Net income* / Average common stockholders’ equity
Return on tangible common equity (“ROTCE”)
Net income* / Average tangible common equity
Tangible book value per share (“TBVPS”)
Tangible common equity at period-end / Common shares at period-end
* Represents net income applicable to common equity
 
Tangible common equity (“TCE”), ROTCE and TBVPS are each non-GAAP financial measures. TCE represents the Firm’s common stockholders’ equity (i.e., total stockholders’ equity less preferred stock) less goodwill and identifiable intangible assets (other than MSRs), net of related deferred tax liabilities. ROTCE measures the Firm’s earnings as a percentage of average TCE. TBVPS represents the Firm’s TCE at period-end divided by common shares at period-end. TCE, ROTCE, and TBVPS are meaningful to the Firm, as well as investors and analysts, in assessing the Firm’s use of equity.
Additionally, certain credit and capital metrics and ratios disclosed by the Firm are non-GAAP measures. For additional information on these non-GAAP measures, see Credit Risk Management on pages 110–111, and Regulatory capital on pages 146–153.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
77

Management’s discussion and analysis

Tangible common equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Period-end
 
Average
 
Dec 31,
2014
Dec 31,
2013
 
Year ended December 31,
(in millions, except per share and ratio data)
 
2014
2013
2012
Common stockholders’ equity
$
212,002

$
200,020

 
$
207,400

$
196,409

$
184,352

Less: Goodwill
47,647

48,081

 
48,029

48,102

48,176

Less: Certain identifiable intangible assets
1,192

1,618

 
1,378

1,950

2,833

Add: Deferred tax liabilities(a)
2,853

2,953

 
2,950

2,885

2,754

Tangible common equity
$
166,016

$
153,274

 
$
160,943

$
149,242

$
136,097

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Return on tangible common equity
NA

NA

 
13
%
11
%
15
%
Tangible book value per share
$
44.69

$
40.81

 
NA
NA
NA
(a)
Represents deferred tax liabilities related to tax-deductible goodwill and to identifiable intangibles created in nontaxable transactions, which are netted against goodwill and other intangibles when calculating TCE.

Core net interest income
In addition to reviewing net interest income on a managed basis, management also reviews core net interest income to assess the performance of its core lending, investing (including asset-liability management) and deposit-raising activities. These activities exclude the impact of CIB’s market-based activities. The core data presented below are non-GAAP financial measures due to the exclusion of CIB’s market-based net interest income and related assets. Management believes this exclusion provides investors and analysts another measure by which to analyze the non-market-related business trends of the Firm and provides a comparable measure to other financial institutions that are primarily focused on core lending, investing and deposit-raising activities.
Core net interest income data
 
 
Year ended December 31,
(in millions, except rates)
2014

2013

2012

Net interest income - managed
basis(a)(b)
$
44,619

$
44,016

$
45,653

Less: Market-based net interest income(c)
5,552

5,492

6,223

Core net interest income(a)(c)
$
39,067

$
38,524

$
39,430

 
 
 
 
Average interest-earning assets
$
2,049,093

$
1,970,231

$
1,842,417

Less: Average market-based earning assets
510,261

504,218

499,339

Core average interest-earning assets
$
1,538,832

$
1,466,013

$
1,343,078

 
 
 
 
Net interest yield on interest-earning assets - managed basis
2.18
%
2.23
%
2.48
%
Net interest yield on market-based activities(c)
1.09

1.09

1.25

Core net interest yield
  on core average
  interest-earning assets(c)
2.54
%
2.63
%
2.94
%
(a)
Interest includes the effect of related hedging derivatives. Taxable-equivalent amounts are used where applicable.
(b)
For a reconciliation of net interest income on a reported and managed basis, see reconciliation from the Firm’s reported U.S. GAAP results to managed basis on page 77.
(c)
Effective with the fourth quarter of 2014, the Firm changed the methodology it uses to allocate preferred stock dividends to the lines of business. Prior period amounts were revised to conform with the current allocation methodology. The Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets and consolidated results of operations were not affected by this reporting change. For further discussion please see Preferred stock dividend allocation reporting change on pages 79–80.
 
2014 compared with 2013
Core net interest income increased by $543 million in 2014 to $39.1 billion, and core average interest-earning assets increased by $72.8 billion to $1.5 trillion. The increase in net interest income in 2014 predominantly reflected higher yields on investment securities, the impact of lower interest expense, and higher average loan balances. The increase was partially offset by lower yields on loans due to the run-off of higher-yielding loans and new originations of lower-yielding loans. The increase in average interest-earning assets largely reflected the impact of higher average balance of deposits with banks. These changes in net interest income and interest-earning assets resulted in the core net interest yield decreasing by 9 basis points to 2.54% for 2014.
2013 compared with 2012
Core net interest income decreased by $906 million in 2013 to $38.5 billion, and core average interest-earning assets increased by $122.9 billion to $1.5 trillion. The decline in net interest income in 2013 primarily reflected the impact of the runoff of higher-yielding loans and originations of lower-yielding loans. The decrease in net interest income was partially offset by lower long-term debt and other funding costs. The increase in average interest-earning assets reflected the impact of higher deposits with banks. The core net interest yield decreased by 31 basis points to 2.63% in 2013, primarily reflecting the impact of a significant increase in deposits with banks and lower loan yields, partially offset by the impact of lower long-term debt yields and deposit rates.


78
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



BUSINESS SEGMENT RESULTS
The Firm is managed on a line of business basis. There are four major reportable business segments – Consumer & Community Banking, Corporate & Investment Bank, Commercial Banking and Asset Management. In addition, there is a Corporate segment.
 
The business segments are determined based on the products and services provided, or the type of customer served, and they reflect the manner in which financial information is currently evaluated by management. Results of these lines of business are presented on a managed basis. For a definition of managed basis, see Explanation and Reconciliation of the Firm’s use of non-GAAP financial measures, on pages 77–78.



Description of business segment reporting methodology
Results of the business segments are intended to reflect each segment as if it were essentially a stand-alone business. The management reporting process that derives business segment results allocates income and expense using market-based methodologies. The Firm continues to assess the assumptions, methodologies and reporting classifications used for segment reporting, and further refinements may be implemented in future periods.
Revenue sharing
When business segments join efforts to sell products and services to the Firm’s clients, the participating business segments agree to share revenue from those transactions. The segment results reflect these revenue-sharing agreements.
Funds transfer pricing
Funds transfer pricing is used to allocate interest income and expense to each business and transfer the primary interest rate risk exposures to the Treasury group within Corporate. The allocation process is unique to each business segment and considers the interest rate risk, liquidity risk and regulatory requirements of that segment as if it were operating independently, and as compared with its stand-alone peers. This process is overseen by senior management and reviewed by the Firm’s Asset-Liability Committee (“ALCO”).
 

Preferred stock dividend allocation reporting change
As part of its funds transfer pricing process, the Firm allocates substantially all of the cost of its outstanding preferred stock to its reportable business segments, while retaining the balance of the cost in Corporate. Prior to the fourth quarter of 2014, this cost was allocated to the Firm’s reportable business segments as interest expense, with an offset recorded as interest income in Corporate. Effective with the fourth quarter of 2014, this cost is no longer included in interest income and interest expense in the segments, but rather is now included in net income applicable to common equity to be consistent with the presentation of firmwide results. As a result of this reporting change, net interest income and net income in the reportable business segments increases; however, there was no impact to the segments’ return on common equity (“ROE”). The Firm’s net interest income, net income, Consolidated balance sheets and consolidated results of operations were not impacted by this reporting change, as preferred stock dividends have been and continue to be distributed from retained earnings and, accordingly, were never reported as a component of the Firm’s consolidated net interest income or net income. Prior period segment and core net interest income amounts throughout this Annual Report have been revised to conform with the current period presentation.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
79

Management’s discussion and analysis

The following chart depicts how preferred stock dividends were allocated to the business segments before and after the aforementioned methodology change.


 
Business segment capital allocation changes
Each business segment is allocated capital by taking into consideration stand-alone peer comparisons, regulatory capital requirements (as estimated under Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In) and economic risk measures. The amount of capital assigned to each business is referred to as equity. On at least an annual basis, the Firm assesses the level of capital required for each line of business as well as the assumptions and methodologies used to allocate capital to its lines of business and updates the equity allocations to its lines of business as refinements are implemented. For further information about these capital changes, see Line of business equity on page 153.
Expense allocation
Where business segments use services provided by support units within the Firm, or another business segment, the costs of those services are allocated to the respective business segments. The expense is generally allocated based on actual cost and upon usage of the services provided. In contrast, certain other expense related to certain corporate functions, or to certain technology and operations, are not allocated to the business segments and are retained in Corporate. Retained expense includes: parent company costs that would not be incurred if the segments were stand-alone businesses; adjustments to align certain corporate staff, technology and operations allocations with market prices; and other items not aligned with a particular business segment.


Segment Results – Managed Basis(a) 
The following table summarizes the business segment results for the periods indicated.
Year ended December 31,
Total net revenue
 
Total noninterest expense
 
Pre-provision profit/(loss)
(in millions)
2014

2013

2012

 
2014

2013

2012

 
2014

2013

2012

Consumer & Community Banking
$
44,368

$
46,537

$
50,278

 
$
25,609

$
27,842

$
28,827

 
$
18,759

$
18,695

$
21,451

Corporate & Investment Bank
34,633

34,786

34,762

 
23,273

21,744

21,850

 
11,360

13,042

12,912

Commercial Banking
6,882

7,092

6,912

 
2,695

2,610

2,389

 
4,187

4,482

4,523

Asset Management
12,028

11,405

10,010

 
8,538

8,016

7,104

 
3,490

3,389

2,906

Corporate
12

(22
)
(2,072
)
 
1,159

10,255

4,559

 
(1,147
)
(10,277
)
(6,631
)
Total
$
97,923

$
99,798

$
99,890

 
$
61,274

$
70,467

$
64,729

 
$
36,649

$
29,331

$
35,161


Year ended December 31,
Provision for credit losses
 
Net income/(loss)
 
Return on equity
(in millions, except ratios)
2014

2013

2012

 
2014

2013

2012

 
2014

2013

2012

Consumer & Community Banking
$
3,520

$
335

$
3,774

 
$
9,185

$
11,061

$
10,791

 
18
%
23
%
25
%
Corporate & Investment Bank
(161
)
(232
)
(479
)
 
6,925

8,887

8,672

 
10

15

18

Commercial Banking
(189
)
85

41

 
2,635

2,648

2,699

 
18

19

28

Asset Management
4

65

86

 
2,153

2,083

1,742

 
23

23

24

Corporate
(35
)
(28
)
(37
)
 
864

(6,756
)
(2,620
)
 
NM

NM

NM

Total
$
3,139

$
225

$
3,385

 
$
21,762

$
17,923

$
21,284

 
10
%
9
%
11
%
(a)
Effective with the fourth quarter of 2014, the Firm changed the methodology it uses to allocate preferred stock dividends to the lines of business. Prior period amounts for net revenue, pre-provision profit/(loss) and net income/(loss) for each of the business segments were revised to conform with the current allocation methodology. The Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets and consolidated results of operations were not affected by this reporting change. For further discussion please see Preferred stock dividend allocation reporting change in Business Segment Results on pages 79–80.


80
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



CONSUMER & COMMUNITY BANKING
Consumer & Community Banking serves consumers and businesses through personal service at bank branches and through ATMs, online, mobile and telephone banking. CCB is organized into Consumer & Business Banking, Mortgage Banking (including Mortgage Production, Mortgage Servicing and Real Estate Portfolios) and Card, Merchant Services & Auto (“Card”). Consumer & Business Banking offers deposit and investment products and services to consumers, and lending, deposit, and cash management and payment solutions to small businesses. Mortgage Banking includes mortgage origination and servicing activities, as well as portfolios comprised of residential mortgages and home equity loans, including the PCI portfolio acquired in the Washington Mutual transaction. Card issues credit cards to consumers and small businesses, provides payment services to corporate and public sector clients through its commercial card products, offers payment processing services to merchants, and provides auto and student loan services.
Selected income statement data
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions, except ratios)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Revenue
 
 
 
 
 
Lending- and deposit-related fees
$
3,039

 
$
2,983

 
$
3,121

Asset management, administration and commissions
2,096

 
2,116

 
2,093

Mortgage fees and related income
3,560

 
5,195

 
8,680

Card income
5,779

 
5,785

 
5,446

All other income
1,463

 
1,473

 
1,473

Noninterest revenue
15,937

 
17,552

 
20,813

Net interest income
28,431

 
28,985

 
29,465

Total net revenue
44,368


46,537

 
50,278

 
 
 
 
 
 
Provision for credit losses
3,520

 
335

 
3,774

 
 
 
 
 
 
Noninterest expense
 
 
 
 
 
Compensation expense
10,538

 
11,686

 
11,632

Noncompensation expense
15,071

 
16,156

 
17,195

Total noninterest expense
25,609

 
27,842

 
28,827

Income before income tax expense
15,239

 
18,360

 
17,677

Income tax expense
6,054

 
7,299

 
6,886

Net income
$
9,185

 
$
11,061

 
$
10,791

 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial ratios
 
 
 
 
 
Return on common equity
18
%
 
23
%
 
25
%
Overhead ratio
58

 
60

 
57

Note: As discussed on pages 79–80, effective with the fourth quarter of 2014 the Firm changed its methodology for allocating the cost of preferred stock to its reportable business segments. Prior periods have been revised to conform with the current period presentation.

 
Note: In the discussion and the tables which follow, CCB presents certain financial measures which exclude the impact of PCI loans; these are non-GAAP financial measures. For additional information, see Explanation and Reconciliation of the Firm’s Use of Non-GAAP Financial Measures.
2014 compared with 2013
Consumer & Community Banking net income was $9.2 billion, a decrease of $1.9 billion, or 17%, compared with the prior year, due to higher provision for credit losses and lower net revenue, partially offset by lower noninterest expense.
Net revenue was $44.4 billion, a decrease of $2.2 billion, or 5%, compared with the prior year. Net interest income was $28.4 billion, down $554 million, or 2%, driven by spread compression and lower mortgage warehouse balances, largely offset by higher deposit balances in Consumer & Business Banking and higher loan balances in Credit Card. Noninterest revenue was $16.0 billion, a decrease of $1.6 billion, or 9%, driven by lower mortgage fees and related income.
The provision for credit losses was $3.5 billion, compared with $335 million in the prior year. The current-year provision reflected a $1.3 billion reduction in the allowance for loan losses and total net charge-offs of $4.8 billion. The prior-year provision reflected a $5.5 billion reduction in the allowance for loan losses and total net charge-offs of $5.8 billion. For more information, including net charge-off amounts and rates, see Consumer Credit Portfolio.
Noninterest expense was $25.6 billion, a decrease of $2.2 billion, or 8%, from the prior year, driven by lower Mortgage Banking expense.
2013 compared with 2012
Consumer & Community Banking net income was $11.1 billion, an increase of $270 million, or 3%, compared with the prior year, due to lower provision for credit losses and lower noninterest expense, predominantly offset by lower net revenue.
Net revenue was $46.5 billion, a decrease of $3.7 billion, or 7%, compared with the prior year. Net interest income was $29.0 billion, down $480 million, or 2%, driven by lower deposit margins, lower loan balances due to net portfolio runoff and spread compression in Credit Card, largely offset by higher deposit balances. Noninterest revenue was $17.6 billion, a decrease of $3.3 billion, or 16%, driven by lower mortgage fees and related income, partially offset by higher card income.
The provision for credit losses was $335 million, compared with $3.8 billion in the prior year. The current-year provision reflected a $5.5 billion reduction in the allowance for loan losses and total net charge-offs of $5.8 billion. The prior-year provision reflected a $5.5 billion reduction in the allowance for loan losses and total net charge-offs of $9.3 billion, including $800 million of incremental charge-offs related to regulatory guidance. For more information, including net charge-off amounts and rates, see Consumer Credit Portfolio on pages 113–119.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
81

Management’s discussion and analysis

Noninterest expense was $27.8 billion, a decrease of $985 million, or 3%, from the prior year, driven by lower mortgage servicing expense, partially offset by investments in Chase Private Client expansion, higher non-MBS related legal expense in Mortgage Production, higher auto lease depreciation, and costs related to the control agenda.
Selected metrics
 
 
 
 
As of or for the year ended December 31,
 
 
 
 
 
(in millions, except headcount)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Selected balance sheet data (period-end)
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
$
455,634

 
$
452,929

 
$
467,282

Trading assets - loans(a)
8,423

 
6,832

 
18,801

Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Loans retained
396,288

 
393,351

 
402,963

Loans held-for-sale
3,416

 
940

 

Total loans
399,704

 
394,291

 
402,963

Deposits
502,520

 
464,412

 
438,517

Equity(b)
51,000

 
46,000

 
43,000

Selected balance sheet data (average)
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
$
447,750

 
$
456,468

 
$
467,641

Trading assets - loans(a)
8,040

 
15,603

 
17,573

Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Loans retained
389,967

 
392,797

 
408,559

Loans held-for-sale
917

 
209

 
433

Total loans
$
390,884

 
$
393,006

 
$
408,992

Deposits
486,919

 
453,304

 
413,948

Equity(b)
51,000

 
46,000

 
43,000

 
 
 
 
 
 
Headcount
137,186

 
151,333

 
164,391

(a)
Predominantly consists of prime mortgages originated with the intent to sell that are accounted for at fair value.
(b)
2014 includes $3.0 billion of capital held at the CCB level related to legacy mortgage servicing matters.
 
Selected metrics
 
 
As of or for the year ended December 31,
 
 
 
(in millions, except ratios and where otherwise noted)
2014
2013
2012
Credit data and quality statistics
 
 
Net charge-offs(a)(b)
$
4,773

$
5,826

$
9,280

Nonaccrual loans(c)(d)
6,401

7,455

9,114

Nonperforming assets(c)(d)(e)
6,872

8,109

9,791

Allowance for loan losses(a)
10,404

12,201

17,752

Net charge-off rate(a)(b)
1.22
%
1.48
%
2.27
%
Net charge-off rate, excluding PCI loans(b)
1.40

1.73

2.68

Allowance for loan losses to period-end loans retained
2.63

3.10

4.41

Allowance for loan losses to period-end loans retained, excluding PCI loans(f)
2.02

2.36

3.51

Allowance for loan losses to nonaccrual loans retained, excluding credit card(c)(f)
58

57

72

Nonaccrual loans to total period-end loans, excluding
credit card(e)
2.38

2.80

3.31

Nonaccrual loans to total period-end loans, excluding credit card and PCI loans(c)(e)
2.88

3.49

4.23

Business metrics
 
 
 
Number of:
 
 
 
Branches
5,602

5,630

5,614

ATMs(g)
18,056

20,290

19,062

Active online customers (in thousands)
36,396

33,742

31,114

Active mobile customers (in thousands)
19,084

15,629

12,359

(a)
Net charge-offs and the net charge-off rates excluded $533 million and $53 million of write-offs in the PCI portfolio for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. These write-offs decreased the allowance for loan losses for PCI loans. For further information on PCI write-offs, see Allowance for Credit Losses on pages 128–130.
(b)
Net charge-offs and net charge-off rates for the year ended December 31, 2012, included $800 million of charge-offs, recorded in accordance with regulatory guidance on certain loans discharged under Chapter 7 bankruptcy and not reaffirmed by the borrower (“Chapter 7 loans”) to be charged off to the net realizable value of the collateral and to be considered nonaccrual, regardless of their delinquency status. Excluding these charges-offs, net charge-offs for the year ended December 31, 2012, would have been $8.5 billion and excluding these charge-offs and PCI loans, the net charge-off rate for the year ended December 31, 2012, would have been 2.45%.
(c)
Excludes PCI loans. The Firm is recognizing interest income on each pool of PCI loans as they are all performing.
(d)
At December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, nonperforming assets excluded: (1) mortgage loans insured by U.S. government agencies of $7.8 billion, $8.4 billion and $10.6 billion, respectively, that are 90 or more days past due; (2) student loans insured by U.S. government agencies under the Federal Family Education Loan Program (“FFELP”) of $367 million, $428 million and $525 million respectively, that are 90 or more days past due; (3) real estate owned (“REO”) insured by U.S. government agencies of $462 million, $2.0 billion and $1.6 billion, respectively. These amounts have been excluded based upon the government guarantee.
(e)
Prior periods were revised to conform with the current presentation.
(f)
The allowance for loan losses for PCI loans of $3.3 billion, $4.2 billion and $5.7 billion at December 31, 2014, December 31, 2013, and December 31, 2012, respectively; these amounts were also excluded from the applicable ratios.
(g)
Includes eATMs, formerly Express Banking Kiosks (“EBK”). Prior periods were revised to conform with the current presentation.


82
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Consumer & Business Banking
Selected income statement data
 
 
 
 
As of or for the year ended December 31,
 
(in millions, except ratios)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Revenue
 
 
 
 
 
Lending- and deposit-related fees
$
3,010

 
$
2,942

 
$
3,068

Asset management, administration and commissions
2,025

 
1,815

 
1,638

Card income
1,605

 
1,495

 
1,353

All other income
534

 
492

 
498

Noninterest revenue
7,174

 
6,744

 
6,557

Net interest income
11,052

 
10,668

 
10,629

Total net revenue
18,226

 
17,412

 
17,186

 
 
 
 
 
 
Provision for credit losses
305

 
347

 
311

 
 
 
 
 
 
Noninterest expense
12,149

 
12,162

 
11,490

Income before income tax expense
5,772

 
4,903

 
5,385

Net income
$
3,443

 
$
2,943

 
$
3,224

Return on common equity
31
%
 
26
%
 
36
%
Overhead ratio
67

 
70

 
67

Equity (period-end and average)
$
11,000

 
$
11,000

 
$
9,000


2014 compared with 2013
Consumer & Business Banking net income was $3.4 billion, an increase of $500 million, or 17%, compared with the prior year, due to higher net revenue.
Net revenue was $18.2 billion, up 5% compared with the prior year. Net interest income was $11.1 billion, up $384 million, or 4% compared with the prior year, driven by higher deposit balances, largely offset by deposit spread compression. Noninterest revenue was $7.2 billion, up $430 million, or 6%, driven by higher investment revenue, reflecting record client investment assets, higher debit card revenue, reflecting an increase in transaction volume, and higher deposit-related fees as a result of an increase in customer accounts.
Noninterest expense was $12.1 billion, flat from the prior year, reflecting lower costs driven by efficiencies implemented in the business, offset by the increased cost of controls.
2013 compared with 2012
Consumer & Business Banking net income was $2.9 billion, a decrease of $281 million, or 9%, compared with the prior year, due to higher noninterest expense, partially offset by higher noninterest revenue.
Net revenue was $17.4 billion, up 1% compared with the prior year. Net interest income was $10.7 billion, flat compared with the prior year, driven by higher deposit balances, offset by lower deposit margin. Noninterest revenue was $6.7 billion, an increase of 3%, driven by higher investment sales revenue and debit card revenue, partially offset by lower deposit-related fees.
 
Noninterest expense was $12.2 billion, up 6% from the prior year, reflecting continued investments in the business, and costs related to the control agenda.
Selected metrics
 
 
 
 
As of or for the year ended December 31,
 
 
 
 
 
(in millions, except ratios)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Business metrics
 
 
 
 
 
Business banking origination volume
$
6,599

 
$
5,148

 
$
6,542

Period-end loans
21,200

 
19,416

 
18,883

Period-end deposits:
 
 
 
 
 
Checking
213,049

 
187,182

 
170,354

Savings
255,148

 
238,223

 
216,422

Time and other
21,349

 
26,022

 
31,753

Total period-end deposits
489,546

 
451,427

 
418,529

Average loans
20,152

 
18,844

 
18,104

Average deposits:
 
 
 
 
 
Checking
198,996

 
176,005

 
153,422

Savings
249,281

 
229,341

 
204,449

Time and other
24,057

 
29,227

 
34,224

Total average deposits
472,334

 
434,573

 
392,095

Deposit margin
2.21
%
 
2.32
%
 
2.57
%
Average assets
$
38,298

 
$
37,174

 
$
34,431

Selected metrics
 
 
 
 
As of or for the year ended December 31,
 
(in millions, except ratios and where otherwise noted)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Credit data and quality statistics
 
 
 
 
Net charge-offs
$
305

 
$
337

 
$
411

Net charge-off rate
1.51
%
 
1.79
%
 
2.27
%
Allowance for loan losses
$
703

 
$
707

 
$
698

Nonperforming assets
286

 
391

 
488

Retail branch business metrics
 
 
 
 
Net new investment assets
$
16,088

 
$
16,006

 
$
11,128

Client investment assets
213,459

 
188,840

 
158,502

% managed accounts
39
%
 
36
%
 
29
%
Number of:
 
 
 
 
 
Chase Private Client locations
2,514

 
2,149

 
1,218

Personal bankers
21,039

 
23,588

 
23,674

Sales specialists
3,994

 
5,740

 
6,076

Client advisors
3,090

 
3,044

 
2,963

Chase Private Clients
325,653

 
215,888

 
105,700

Accounts (in thousands)(a)
30,481

 
29,437

 
28,073

Households (in millions)
25.7

 
25.0

 
24.1

(a) Includes checking accounts and Chase Liquid® cards.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
83

Management’s discussion and analysis

Mortgage Banking
Selected Financial statement data
As of or for the year ended December 31,
 
 
 
 
 
(in millions, except ratios)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Revenue
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage fees and related income
$
3,560

 
$
5,195

 
$
8,680

All other income
37

 
283

 
475

Noninterest revenue
3,597

 
5,478

 
9,155

Net interest income
4,229

 
4,758

 
5,016

Total net revenue
7,826

 
10,236

 
14,171

 
 
 
 
 
 
Provision for credit losses
(217
)
 
(2,681
)
 
(490
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Noninterest expense
5,284

 
7,602

 
9,121

Income before income tax expense
2,759

 
5,315

 
5,540

Net income
$
1,668

 
$
3,211

 
$
3,468

 
 
 
 
 
 
Return on common equity
9
%
 
16
%
 
19
%
Overhead ratio
68

 
74

 
64

Equity (period-end and average)
$
18,000

 
$
19,500

 
$
17,500


2014 compared with 2013
Mortgage Banking net income was $1.7 billion, a decrease of $1.5 billion, or 48%, from the prior year, driven by a lower benefit from the provision for credit losses and lower net revenue, partially offset by lower noninterest expense.
Net revenue was $7.8 billion, a decrease of $2.4 billion, or 24%, compared with the prior year. Net interest income was $4.2 billion, a decrease of $529 million, or 11%, driven by spread compression and lower loan balances due to portfolio runoff and lower warehouse balances. Noninterest revenue was $3.6 billion, a decrease of $1.9 billion, or 34%, driven by lower mortgage fees and related income.
The provision for credit losses was a benefit of $217 million, compared with a benefit of $2.7 billion in the prior year. The current year reflected a $700 million reduction in the allowance for loan losses, reflecting continued improvement in home prices and delinquencies. The prior year included a $3.8 billion reduction in the allowance for loan losses. Net charge-offs were $483 million, compared with $1.1 billion in the prior year.
Noninterest expense was $5.3 billion, a decrease of $2.3 billion, or 30%, from the prior year, due to lower expense in production and servicing reflecting lower headcount-related expense, the absence of non-MBS related legal expense and lower expense on foreclosure-related matters.
 
2013 compared with 2012
Mortgage Banking net income was $3.2 billion, a decrease of $257 million, or 7%, compared with the prior year, driven by lower net revenue, predominantly offset by a higher benefit from the provision for credit losses and lower noninterest expense.
Net revenue was $10.2 billion, a decrease of $3.9 billion, or 28%, compared with the prior year. Net interest income was $4.8 billion, a decrease of $258 million, or 5%, driven by lower loan balances due to net portfolio runoff. Noninterest revenue was $5.5 billion, a decrease of $3.7 billion, driven by lower mortgage fees and related income.
The provision for credit losses was a benefit of $2.7 billion, compared with a benefit of $490 million in the prior year. The current year reflected a $3.8 billion reduction in the allowance for loan losses due to continued improvement in home prices and delinquencies. The prior year included a $3.9 billion reduction in the allowance for loan losses.
Noninterest expense was $7.6 billion, a decrease of $1.5 billion, or 17%, from the prior year, due to lower servicing expense, partially offset by higher non-MBS related legal expense in Mortgage Production.


84
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report


Functional results
Year ended December 31,
 
 
 
 
 
(in millions, except ratios)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Mortgage Production
 
 
 
 
 
Production revenue and other Income(a)
$
1,060

 
$
2,973

 
$
5,877

Production-related net interest income(a)
422

 
635

 
705

Production-related revenue, excluding repurchase (losses)/benefits
1,482

 
3,608

 
6,582

Production expense(b)
1,646

 
3,088

 
2,747

Income, excluding repurchase (losses)/benefits
(164
)
 
520

 
3,835

Repurchase (losses)/benefits
458

 
331

 
(272
)
Income before income tax expense
294

 
851

 
3,563

 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage Servicing
 
 
 
 
 
Loan servicing revenue and other income(a)
3,294

 
3,744

 
4,110

Servicing-related net interest income(a)
314

 
253

 
93

Servicing-related revenue
3,608

 
3,997

 
4,203

Changes in MSR asset fair value due to collection/realization of expected cash flows
(905
)
 
(1,094
)
 
(1,222
)
Net servicing-related revenue
2,703

 
2,903

 
2,981

Default servicing expense
1,406

 
2,069

 
3,707

Core servicing expense(b)
865

 
904

 
1,033

Servicing Expense
2,271

 
2,973

 
4,740

Income/(loss), excluding MSR risk management
432

 
(70
)
 
(1,759
)
MSR risk management, including related net interest income/(expense)
(28
)
 
(268
)
 
616

Income/(loss) before income tax expense/(benefit)
404

 
(338
)
 
(1,143
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real Estate Portfolios
 
 
 
 
 
Noninterest revenue
(282
)
 
(209
)
 
43

Net interest income
3,493

 
3,871

 
4,221

Total net revenue
3,211

 
3,662

 
4,264

 
 
 
 
 
 
Provision for credit losses
(223
)
 
(2,693
)
 
(509
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Noninterest expense
1,373

 
1,553

 
1,653

Income before income tax expense
2,061

 
4,802

 
3,120

Mortgage Banking income before income tax expense
$
2,759

 
$
5,315

 
$
5,540

Mortgage Banking net income
$
1,668

 
$
3,211

 
$
3,468

 
 
 
 
 
 
Overhead ratios
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage Production
85
%
 
78
%
 
43
%
Mortgage Servicing
85

 
113
 
132

Real Estate Portfolios
43

 
42

 
39

(a)
Prior periods were revised to conform with the current presentation.
(b)
Includes provision for credit losses.
 
2014 compared with 2013
Mortgage Production pretax income was $294 million, a decrease of $557 million, or 65%, from the prior year, reflecting lower revenue, largely offset by lower expense and higher benefit from repurchase losses. Mortgage production-related revenue, excluding repurchase losses, was $1.5 billion, a decrease of $2.1 billion, from the prior year, driven by lower volumes due to higher levels of mortgage interest rates and tighter margins. Production expense was $1.6 billion, a decrease of $1.4 billion, or 47%, from the prior year, driven by lower headcount-related expense and the absence of non-MBS related legal expense.
Mortgage Servicing pretax income was $404 million, compared with a loss of $338 million in the prior year, reflecting lower expenses and lower MSR risk management loss, partially offset by lower net revenue. Mortgage net servicing-related revenue was $2.7 billion, a decrease of $200 million, or 7%, from the prior year, driven by lower average third-party loans serviced and lower revenue from an exited non-core product, partially offset by lower MSR asset amortization expense as a result of lower MSR asset value. MSR risk management was a loss of $28 million, compared with a loss of $268 million in the prior year. See Note 17 for further information regarding changes in value of the MSR asset and related hedges. Servicing expense was $2.3 billion, a decrease of $702 million, or 24%, from the prior year, reflecting lower headcount-related expense and lower expense for foreclosure related matters.
Real Estate Portfolios pretax income was $2.1 billion, down $2.7 billion, or 57%, from the prior year, due to a lower benefit from the provision for credit losses and lower net revenue, partially offset by lower noninterest expense. Net revenue was $3.2 billion, a decrease of $451 million, or 12%, from the prior year, driven by lower net interest income as a result of spread compression and lower loan balances due to portfolio runoff. The provision for credit losses was a benefit of $223 million, compared with a benefit of $2.7 billion in the prior year. The current-year provision reflected a $700 million reduction in the allowance for loan losses, $400 million from the non credit-impaired allowance and $300 million from the purchased credit-impaired allowance, due to continued improvement in home prices and delinquencies. The prior-year provision reflected a $3.8 billion reduction in the allowance for loan losses, $2.3 billion from the non credit-impaired allowance and $1.5 billion from the purchased credit-impaired allowance. Net charge-offs were $477 million, compared with $1.1 billion in the prior year. See Consumer Credit Portfolio on pages 113–119 for the net charge-off amounts and rates. Noninterest expense was $1.4 billion, a decrease of $180 million, or 12%, compared with the prior year, driven by lower FDIC-related expense and lower foreclosed asset expense due to lower foreclosure inventory.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
85

Management’s discussion and analysis

2013 compared with 2012
Mortgage Production pretax income was $851 million, a decrease of $2.7 billion from the prior year, reflecting lower margins, lower volumes and higher legal expense, partially offset by a benefit in repurchase losses. Production-related revenue, excluding repurchase losses, was $3.6 billion, a decrease of $3.0 billion, or 45%, from the prior year, largely reflecting lower margins and lower volumes from rising rates. Production expense was $3.1 billion, an increase of $341 million, or 12%, from the prior year, due to higher non-MBS related legal expense and higher compensation-related expense. Repurchase losses for the current year reflected a benefit of $331 million, compared with repurchase losses of $272 million in the prior year. The current year reflected a reduction in the repurchase liability largely as a result of the settlement with the GSEs.
Mortgage Servicing pretax loss was $338 million, compared with a pretax loss of $1.1 billion in the prior year, driven by lower expense, partially offset by a MSR risk management loss. Mortgage net servicing-related revenue was $2.9 billion, a decrease of $78 million. MSR risk management was a loss of $268 million, compared with income of $616 million in the prior year, driven by the net impact of various changes in model inputs and assumptions. See Note 17 for further information regarding changes in value of the MSR asset and related hedges. Servicing expense was $3.0 billion, a decrease of $1.8 billion, or 37%, from the prior year, reflecting lower costs associated with the Independent Foreclosure Review and lower servicing headcount.
Real Estate Portfolios pretax income was $4.8 billion, up $1.7 billion from the prior year, or 54%, due to a higher benefit from the provision for credit losses, partially offset by lower net revenue. Net revenue was $3.7 billion, a decrease of $602 million, or 14%, from the prior year. This decrease was due to lower net interest income, resulting from lower loan balances due to net portfolio runoff, and lower noninterest revenue due to higher loan retention. The provision for credit losses was a benefit of $2.7 billion, compared with a benefit of $509 million in the prior year. The current-year provision reflected a $3.8 billion reduction in the allowance for loan losses, $2.3 billion from the non credit-impaired allowance and $1.5 billion from the purchased credit-impaired allowance, reflecting continued improvement in home prices and delinquencies. The prior-year provision included a $3.9 billion reduction in the allowance for loan losses from the non credit-impaired allowance. Net charge-offs were $1.1 billion, compared with $3.3 billion in the prior year. Prior-year total net charge-offs included $744 million of incremental charge-offs reported in accordance with regulatory guidance on certain loans discharged under Chapter 7 bankruptcy. Noninterest expense was $1.6 billion, a decrease of $100 million, or 6%, compared with the prior year, driven by lower foreclosed asset expense due to lower foreclosure inventory, largely offset by higher FDIC-related expense.
 
Mortgage Production and Mortgage Servicing
 
 
Selected metrics
 
As of or for the year ended December 31,
 
 
 
 
 
(in millions, except ratios)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Selected balance sheet data (Period-end)
 
 
 
 
 
Trading assets - loans(a)
$
8,423

 
$
6,832

 
$
18,801

Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Prime mortgage, including option ARMs(b)
$
13,557

 
$
15,136

 
$
17,290

Loans held-for-sale
314

 
614

 

Selected balance sheet data (average)
 
 
 
 
 
Trading assets - loans(a)
8,040

 
15,603

 
17,573

Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Prime mortgage, including option ARMs(b)
14,993

 
16,495

 
17,335

Loans held-for-sale
394

 
114

 

Average assets
42,456

 
57,131

 
59,837

Repurchase liability (period-end)
249

 
651

 
2,530

Credit data and quality statistics
 
 
 
 
 
Net charge-offs:
 
 
 
 
 
Prime mortgage, including option ARMs
6

 
12

 
19

Net charge-off rate:
 
 
 
 
 
Prime mortgage, including option ARMs
0.04
%
 
0.07
%
 
0.11
%
30+ day delinquency rate(c)
2.06

 
2.75

 
3.05

Nonperforming assets(d)(e)
$
389

 
$
519

 
$
599

(a)
Predominantly consists of prime mortgages originated with the intent to sell that are accounted for at fair value.
(b)
Predominantly represents prime mortgage loans repurchased from Government National Mortgage Association (“Ginnie Mae”) pools, which are insured by U.S. government agencies.
(c)
At December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, excluded mortgage loans insured by U.S. government agencies of $9.7 billion, $9.6 billion and $11.8 billion respectively, that are 30 or more days past due. These amounts have been excluded based upon the government guarantee. For further discussion, see Note 14 which summarizes loan delinquency information.
(d)
At December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, nonperforming assets excluded: (1) mortgage loans insured by U.S. government agencies of $7.8 billion, $8.4 billion and $10.6 billion respectively, that are 90 or more days past due; and (2) REO insured by U.S. government agencies of $462 million, $2.0 billion and $1.6 billion, respectively. These amounts have been excluded based upon the government guarantee.
(e)
Prior periods were revised to conform with the current presentation.


86
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report


Selected metrics
 
 
 
 
 
As of or for the year ended
December 31,
 
 
 
 
 
(in billions, except ratios)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Business metrics
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage origination volume by channel
 
 
 
 
 
Retail
$
29.5

 
$
77.0

 
$
101.4

Correspondent(a)
48.5

 
88.5

 
79.4

Total mortgage origination volume(b)
$
78.0

 
$
165.5

 
$
180.8

Mortgage application volume by channel
 
 
 
 
 
Retail
$
55.6

 
$
108.0

 
$
164.5

Correspondent(a)
63.2

 
89.2

 
101.2

Total mortgage application volume
$
118.8

 
$
197.2

 
$
265.7

Third-party mortgage loans serviced (period-end)
$
751.5

 
$
815.5

 
$
859.4

Third-party mortgage loans serviced (average)
784.6

 
837.3

 
847.0

MSR carrying value (period-end)
7.4

 
9.6

 
7.6

Ratio of MSR carrying value (period-end) to third-party mortgage loans serviced (period-end)
0.98
%
 
1.18
%
 
0.88
%
Ratio of loan servicing-related revenue to third-party mortgage loans serviced (average)
0.36

 
0.40

 
0.46

MSR revenue multiple(c)
2.72
x
 
2.95
x
 
1.91x

(a)
Includes rural housing loans sourced through correspondents, and prior to November 2013, through both brokers and correspondents, which are underwritten and closed with pre-funding loan approval from the U.S. Department of Agriculture Rural Development, which acts as the guarantor in the transaction.
(b)
Firmwide mortgage origination volume was $83.3 billion, $176.4 billion and $189.9 billion for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
(c)
Represents the ratio of MSR carrying value (period-end) to third-party mortgage loans serviced (period-end) divided by the ratio of loan servicing-related revenue to third-party mortgage loans serviced (average).
 
Real Estate Portfolios
 
 
Selected metrics
 
 
 
 
 
As of or for the year ended December 31,
 
 
 
 
 
(in millions)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Loans, excluding PCI
 
 
 
 
 
Period-end loans owned:
 
 
 
 
 
Home equity
$
50,899

 
$
57,863

 
$
67,385

Prime mortgage, including option ARMs
66,543

 
49,463

 
41,316

Subprime mortgage
5,083

 
7,104

 
8,255

Other
477

 
551

 
633

Total period-end loans owned
$
123,002

 
$
114,981

 
$
117,589

Average loans owned:
 
 
 
 
 
Home equity
$
54,410

 
$
62,369

 
$
72,674

Prime mortgage, including option ARMs
56,104

 
44,988

 
42,311

Subprime mortgage
6,257

 
7,687

 
8,947

Other
511

 
588

 
675

Total average loans owned
$
117,282

 
$
115,632

 
$
124,607

PCI loans
 
 
 
 
 
Period-end loans owned:
 
 
 
 
 
Home equity
$
17,095

 
$
18,927

 
$
20,971

Prime mortgage
10,220

 
12,038

 
13,674

Subprime mortgage
3,673

 
4,175

 
4,626

Option ARMs
15,708

 
17,915

 
20,466

Total period-end loans owned
$
46,696

 
$
53,055

 
$
59,737

Average loans owned:
 
 
 
 
 
Home equity
$
18,030

 
$
19,950

 
$
21,840

Prime mortgage
11,257

 
12,909

 
14,400

Subprime mortgage
3,921

 
4,416

 
4,777

Option ARMs
16,794

 
19,236

 
21,545

Total average loans owned
$
50,002

 
$
56,511

 
$
62,562

Total Real Estate Portfolios
 
 
 
 
 
Period-end loans owned:
 
 
 
 
 
Home equity
$
67,994

 
$
76,790

 
$
88,356

Prime mortgage, including option ARMs
92,471

 
79,416

 
75,456

Subprime mortgage
8,756

 
11,279

 
12,881

Other
477

 
551

 
633

Total period-end loans owned
$
169,698

 
$
168,036

 
$
177,326

Average loans owned:
 
 
 
 
 
Home equity
$
72,440

 
$
82,319

 
$
94,514

Prime mortgage, including option ARMs
84,155

 
77,133

 
78,256

Subprime mortgage
10,178

 
12,103

 
13,724

Other
511

 
588

 
675

Total average loans owned
$
167,284

 
$
172,143

 
$
187,169

Average assets
$
164,387

 
$
163,898

 
$
175,712

Home equity origination volume
3,102

 
2,124

 
1,420



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
87

Management’s discussion and analysis

Credit data and quality statistics
As of or for the year ended December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Net charge-offs/(recoveries), excluding PCI loans:(a)(b)
 
 
 
 
 
Home equity
$
473

 
$
966

 
$
2,385

Prime mortgage, including option ARMs
22

 
41

 
454

Subprime mortgage
(27
)
 
90

 
486

Other
9

 
10

 
16

Total net charge-offs/(recoveries), excluding PCI loans
$
477

 
$
1,107

 
$
3,341

Net charge-off/(recovery) rate, excluding PCI loans:(b)
 
 
 
 
 
Home equity
0.87
%
 
1.55
%
 
3.28
%
Prime mortgage, including option ARMs
0.04

 
0.09

 
1.07

Subprime mortgage
(0.43
)
 
1.17

 
5.43

Other
1.76

 
1.70

 
2.37

Total net charge-off/(recovery) rate, excluding PCI loans
0.41

 
0.96

 
2.68

Net charge-off/(recovery) rate – reported:(a)(b)
 
 
 
 
 
Home equity
0.65
%
 
1.17
%
 
2.52
%
Prime mortgage, including option ARMs
0.03

 
0.05

 
0.58

Subprime mortgage
(0.27
)
 
0.74

 
3.54

Other
1.76

 
1.70

 
2.37

Total net charge-off/(recovery) rate – reported
0.29

 
0.64

 
1.79

30+ day delinquency rate, excluding PCI loans(c)
2.67
%
 
3.66
%
 
5.03
%
Allowance for loan losses, excluding PCI loans
$
2,168

 
$
2,568

 
$
4,868

Allowance for PCI loans(a)
3,325

 
4,158

 
5,711

Allowance for loan losses
$
5,493

 
$
6,726

 
$
10,579

Nonperforming assets(d)
5,786

 
6,919

 
8,439

Allowance for loan losses to period-end loans retained
3.24
%
 
4.00
%
 
5.97
%
Allowance for loan losses to period-end loans retained, excluding PCI loans
1.76

 
2.23

 
4.14

(a)
Net charge-offs and the net charge-off rates excluded $533 million and $53 million of write-offs in the PCI portfolio for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. These write-offs decreased the allowance for loan losses for PCI loans. For further information on PCI write-offs, see Allowance for Credit Losses on pages 128–130.
(b)
Net charge-offs and net charge-off rates for the year ended December 31, 2012, included $744 million of charge-offs related to regulatory guidance. Excluding these charges-offs, net charge-offs for the year ended December 31, 2012, would have been $1.8 billion, $410 million and $416 million for the home equity, prime mortgage, including option ARMs, and subprime mortgage portfolios, respectively. Net charge-off rates for the same period, excluding these charge-offs and PCI loans, would have been 2.41%, 0.97% and 4.65% for the home equity, prime mortgage, including option ARMs, and subprime mortgage portfolios, respectively.
(c)
The 30+ day delinquency rate for PCI loans was 13.33% 15.31% and 20.14% at December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
(d)
Excludes PCI loans. The Firm is recognizing interest income on each pool of PCI loans as they are all performing.


 
Mortgage servicing-related matters
The financial crisis resulted in unprecedented levels of delinquencies and defaults of 1-4 family residential real estate loans. Such loans required varying degrees of loss mitigation activities. Foreclosure is usually a last resort, and accordingly, the Firm has made, and continues to make, significant efforts to help borrowers remain in their homes.
The Firm has entered into various Consent Orders and settlements with federal and state governmental agencies and private parties related to mortgage servicing, origination, and residential mortgage-backed securities activities. The requirements of these Consent Orders and settlements vary, but in the aggregate, include cash compensatory payments (in addition to fines) and/or “borrower relief,” which may include principal reduction, refinancing, short sale assistance, and other specified types of borrower relief. Other obligations required under certain Consent Orders and settlements, as well as under new regulatory requirements, include enhanced mortgage servicing and foreclosure standards and processes. The Firm has satisfied or is committed to satisfying these obligations within the mandated timeframes.
The mortgage servicing Consent Orders and settlements are subject to ongoing oversight by the Mortgage Compliance Committee of the Firm’s Board of Directors. In addition, certain of the Consent Orders and settlements are the subject of ongoing reporting to various regulators and independent overseers.
The Firm’s compliance with the Global Settlement and the RMBS Settlement are detailed in periodic reports published by the independent overseers.



88
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Card, Merchant Services & Auto
Selected income statement data
As of or for the year
ended December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Revenue
 
 
 
 
 
Card income
$
4,173

 
$
4,289

 
$
4,092

All other income
993

 
1,041

 
1,009

Noninterest revenue
5,166

 
5,330

 
5,101

Net interest income
13,150

 
13,559

 
13,820

Total net revenue
18,316


18,889


18,921

 
 
 
 
 
 
Provision for credit losses
3,432

 
2,669

 
3,953

 
 
 
 
 
 
Noninterest expense(a)
8,176

 
8,078

 
8,216

Income before income tax expense
6,708

 
8,142

 
6,752

Net income
$
4,074


$
4,907


$
4,099

 
 
 
 
 
 
Return on common equity
21
%
 
31
%
 
24
%
Overhead ratio
45

 
43

 
43

Equity (period-end and average)
$
19,000

 
$
15,500

 
$
16,500

(a)
Included operating lease depreciation expense of $1.2 billion, $972 million and $817 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
2014 compared with 2013
Card net income was $4.1 billion, a decrease of $833 million, or 17%, compared with the prior year, predominantly driven by higher provision for credit losses and lower net revenue.
Net revenue was $18.3 billion, down $573 million or 3% compared with the prior year. Net interest income was $13.2 billion, a decrease of $409 million, or 3%, from the prior year primarily driven by spread compression in Credit Card and Auto, partially offset by higher average loan balances. Noninterest revenue was $5.2 billion, down $164 million, or 3%, from the prior year. The decrease was primarily driven by higher amortization of new account origination costs and the impact of non-core portfolio exits, largely offset by higher auto lease income and net interchange income from higher sales volume.
The provision for credit losses was $3.4 billion, compared with $2.7 billion in the prior year. The current-year provision reflected lower net charge-offs and a $554 million reduction in the allowance for loan losses. The reduction in the allowance for loan losses was primarily related to a decrease in the asset-specific allowance resulting from increased granularity of the impairment estimates and lower balances related to credit card loans modified in TDRs, runoff in the student loan portfolio, and lower estimated losses in auto loans. The prior-year provision included a $1.7 billion reduction in the allowance for loan losses.
 
Noninterest expense was $8.2 billion, up $98 million, or 1% from the prior year primarily driven by higher auto lease depreciation expense and higher investment in controls, predominantly offset by lower intangible amortization and lower remediation costs.
2013 compared with 2012
Card net income was $4.9 billion, an increase of $808 million, or 20%, compared with the prior year, driven by lower provision for credit losses.
Net revenue was $18.9 billion, flat compared with the prior year. Net interest income was $13.6 billion, down $261 million, or 2%, from the prior year. The decrease was primarily driven by spread compression in Credit Card and Auto and lower average credit card loan balances, largely offset by the impact of lower revenue reversals associated with lower net charge-offs in Credit Card. Noninterest revenue was $5.3 billion, an increase of $229 million, or 4%, compared with the prior year primarily driven by higher net interchange income, auto lease income and merchant servicing revenue, largely offset by lower revenue from an exited non-core product and a gain on an investment security recognized in the prior year.
The provision for credit losses was $2.7 billion, compared with $4.0 billion in the prior year. The current-year provision reflected lower net charge-offs and a $1.7 billion reduction in the allowance for loan losses due to lower estimated losses reflecting improved delinquency trends and restructured loan performance. The prior-year provision included a $1.6 billion reduction in the allowance for loan losses. The Credit Card net charge-off rate was 3.14%, down from 3.95% in the prior year; and the 30+ day delinquency rate was 1.67%, down from 2.10% in the prior year. The Auto net charge-off rate was 0.31%, down from 0.39% in the prior year.
Noninterest expense was $8.1 billion, a decrease of $138 million, or 2%, from the prior year. This decrease was due to one-time expense items recognized in the prior year related to the exit of a non-core product and the write-off of intangible assets associated with a non-strategic relationship. The reduction in expenses was partially offset by increased auto lease depreciation and payments to customers required by a regulatory Consent Order during 2013.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
89

Management’s discussion and analysis

Selected metrics
As of or for the year
ended December 31,
(in millions, except ratios and where otherwise noted)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Selected balance sheet data (period-end)
 
 
 
 
 
Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Credit Card
$
131,048

 
$
127,791

 
$
127,993

Auto
54,536

 
52,757

 
49,913

Student
9,351

 
10,541

 
11,558

Total loans
$
194,935

 
$
191,089

 
$
189,464

Selected balance sheet data (average)
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
$
202,609

 
$
198,265

 
$
197,661

Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Credit Card
125,113

 
123,613

 
125,464

Auto
52,961

 
50,748

 
48,413

Student
9,987

 
11,049

 
12,507

Total loans
$
188,061

 
$
185,410

 
$
186,384

Business metrics
 
 
 
 
 
Credit Card, excluding Commercial Card
 
 
 
 
 
Sales volume (in billions)
$
465.6

 
$
419.5

 
$
381.1

New accounts opened
8.8

 
7.3

 
6.7

Open accounts
64.6

 
65.3

 
64.5

Accounts with sales activity
34.0

 
32.3

 
30.6

% of accounts acquired online
56
%
 
55
%
 
51
%
Merchant Services (Chase Paymentech Solutions)
 
 
 
 
 
Merchant processing volume (in billions)
$
847.9

 
$
750.1

 
$
655.2

Total transactions
 (in billions)
38.1

 
35.6

 
29.5

Auto
 
 
 
 
 
Origination volume
 (in billions)
27.5

 
26.1

 
23.4

The following are brief descriptions of selected business metrics within Card, Merchant Services & Auto.
Card Services includes the Credit Card and Merchant Services businesses.
Merchant Services processes transactions for merchants.
Total transactions – Number of transactions and authorizations processed for merchants.
Commercial Card provides a wide range of payment services to corporate and public sector clients worldwide through the commercial card products. Services include procurement, corporate travel and entertainment, expense management services, and business-to-business payment solutions.
Sales volume – Dollar amount of cardmember purchases, net of returns.
Open accounts – Cardmember accounts with charging privileges.
Auto origination volume – Dollar amount of auto loans and leases originated.
 
Selected metrics
As of or for the year
ended December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Credit data and quality statistics
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net charge-offs:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit Card
 
$
3,429

 
$
3,879

 
$
4,944

Auto(a)
 
181

 
158

 
188

Student
 
375

 
333

 
377

Total net charge-offs
 
$
3,985

 
$
4,370

 
$
5,509

Net charge-off rate:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit Card(b)
 
2.75
%
 
3.14
%
 
3.95
%
Auto(a)
 
0.34

 
0.31

 
0.39

Student
 
3.75

 
3.01

 
3.01

Total net charge-off rate
 
2.12

 
2.36

 
2.96

Delinquency rates
 
 
 
 
 
 
30+ day delinquency rate:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit Card(c)
 
1.44

 
1.67

 
2.10

Auto
 
1.23

 
1.15

 
1.25

Student(d)
 
2.35

 
2.56

 
2.13

Total 30+ day delinquency rate
 
1.42

 
1.58

 
1.87

90+ day delinquency rate – Credit Card(c)
 
0.70

 
0.80

 
1.02

Nonperforming assets(e)
 
$
411

 
$
280

 
$
265

Allowance for loan losses:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit Card
 
$
3,439

 
$
3,795

 
$
5,501

Auto & Student
 
749

 
953

 
954

Total allowance for loan losses
 
$
4,188

 
$
4,748

 
$
6,455

Allowance for loan losses to period-end loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit Card(c)
 
2.69
%
 
2.98
%
 
4.30
%
Auto & Student
 
1.17

 
1.51

 
1.55

Total allowance for loan losses to period-end loans
 
2.18

 
2.49

 
3.41

(a)
Net charge-offs and net charge-off rates for the year ended December 31, 2012, included $53 million of charge-offs of Chapter 7 loans. Excluding these incremental charge-offs, net charge-offs for the year ended December 31, 2012 would have been $135 million, and the net charge-off rate would have been 0.28%.
(b)
Average credit card loans included loans held-for-sale of $509 million, $95 million and $433 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. These amounts are excluded when calculating the net charge-off rate.
(c)
Period-end credit card loans included loans held-for-sale of $3.0 billion and $326 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. There were no loans held-for-sale at December 31, 2012. These amounts are excluded when calculating delinquency rates and the allowance for loan losses to period-end loans.
(d)
Excluded student loans insured by U.S. government agencies under the FFELP of $654 million, $737 million and $894 million at December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, that are 30 or more days past due. These amounts have been excluded based upon the government guarantee.
(e)
Nonperforming assets excluded student loans insured by U.S. government agencies under the FFELP of $367 million, $428 million and $525 million at December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, that are 90 or more days past due. These amounts have been excluded from nonaccrual loans based upon the government guarantee.


90
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Card Services supplemental information
Year ended December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Revenue
 
 
 
 
 
Noninterest revenue
$
3,593

 
$
3,977

 
$
3,887

Net interest income
11,462

 
11,638

 
11,745

Total net revenue
15,055

 
15,615

 
15,632

 
 
 
 
 
 
Provision for credit losses
3,079

 
2,179

 
3,444

 
 
 
 
 
 
Noninterest expense
6,152

 
6,245

 
6,566

Income before income tax expense
5,824

 
7,191

 
5,622

Net income
$
3,547

 
$
4,340

 
$
3,426

 
 
 
 
 
 
Percentage of average loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Noninterest revenue
2.87
%
 
3.22
%
 
3.10
%
Net interest income
9.16

 
9.41

 
9.36

Total net revenue
12.03

 
12.63

 
12.46




JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
91

Management’s discussion and analysis

CORPORATE & INVESTMENT BANK

The Corporate & Investment Bank, comprised of Banking and Markets & Investor Services, offers a broad suite of investment banking, market-making, prime brokerage, and treasury and securities products and services to a global client base of corporations, investors, financial institutions, government and municipal entities. Within Banking, the CIB offers a full range of investment banking products and services in all major capital markets, including advising on corporate strategy and structure, capital-raising in equity and debt markets, as well as loan origination and syndication. Also included in Banking is Treasury Services, which includes transaction services, comprised primarily of cash management and liquidity solutions, and trade finance products. The Markets & Investor Services segment of the CIB is a global market-maker in cash securities and derivative instruments, and also offers sophisticated risk management solutions, prime brokerage, and research. Markets & Investor Services also includes the Securities Services business, a leading global custodian which includes custody, fund accounting and administration, and securities lending products sold principally to asset managers, insurance companies and public and private investment funds.
Selected income statement data
 
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Revenue
 
 
 
 
 
Investment banking fees
$
6,570

 
$
6,331

 
$
5,769

Principal transactions(a)
8,947

 
9,289

 
9,510

Lending- and deposit-related fees
1,742

 
1,884

 
1,948

Asset management, administration and commissions
4,687

 
4,713

 
4,693

All other income
1,512

 
1,593

 
1,184

Noninterest revenue
23,458

 
23,810

 
23,104

Net interest income
11,175

 
10,976

 
11,658

Total net revenue(b)
34,633

 
34,786

 
34,762

 
 
 
 
 
 
Provision for credit losses
(161
)
 
(232
)
 
(479
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Noninterest expense
 
 
 
 
 
Compensation expense
10,449

 
10,835

 
11,313

Noncompensation expense
12,824

 
10,909

 
10,537

Total noninterest expense
23,273

 
21,744

 
21,850

Income before income tax expense
11,521

 
13,274

 
13,391

Income tax expense
4,596

 
4,387

 
4,719

Net income
$
6,925

 
$
8,887

 
$
8,672

Note: As discussed on pages 79–80, effective with the fourth quarter of 2014 the Firm changed its methodology for allocating the cost of preferred stock to its reportable business segments. Prior periods have been revised to conform with the current period presentation.
 

(a)
Included FVA (effective 2013) and DVA on OTC derivatives and structured notes, measured at fair value. FVA and DVA gains/(losses) were $468 million and $(1.9) billion for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. DVA losses were ($930) million for the year ended December 31, 2012.
(b)
Included tax-equivalent adjustments, predominantly due to income tax credits related to affordable housing and alternative energy investments, as well as tax-exempt income from municipal bond investments, of $2.5 billion, $2.3 billion and $2.0 billion for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
Selected income statement data
 
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions, except ratios)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Financial ratios
 
 
 
 
 
Return on common equity(a)
10
%
 
15
%
 
18
%
Overhead ratio(b)
67

 
63

 
63

Compensation expense as
  percentage of total net
  revenue(c)
30

 
31

 
33

Revenue by business
 
 
 
 
 
Advisory
$
1,627

 
$
1,315

 
$
1,491

Equity underwriting
1,571

 
1,499

 
1,026

Debt underwriting
3,372

 
3,517

 
3,252

Total investment banking fees
6,570

 
6,331

 
5,769

Treasury Services
4,145

 
4,171

 
4,249

Lending
1,130

 
1,669

 
1,389

Total Banking
11,845

 
12,171

 
11,407

Fixed Income Markets(d)
13,848

 
15,832

 
15,701

Equity Markets
4,861

 
4,803

 
4,448

Securities Services
4,351

 
4,100

 
4,000

Credit Adjustments & Other(e)
(272
)
 
(2,120
)
 
(794
)
Total Markets & Investor Services
22,788

 
22,615

 
23,355

Total net revenue
$
34,633

 
$
34,786

 
$
34,762

(a)
Return on equity excluding FVA (effective 2013) and DVA, a non-GAAP financial measure, was 17% and 19% for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
(b)
Overhead ratio excluding FVA (effective 2013) and DVA, a non-GAAP financial measure, was 59% and 61% for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
(c)
Compensation expense as a percentage of total net revenue excluding FVA (effective 2013) and DVA, a non-GAAP financial measure, was 30% and 32% for the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
(d)
Includes results of the synthetic credit portfolio that was transferred from the CIO effective July 2, 2012.
(e)
Consists primarily of credit valuation adjustments (“CVA”) managed by the credit portfolio group, and FVA (effective 2013) and DVA on OTC derivatives and structured notes. Results are presented net of associated hedging activities and net of CVA and FVA amounts allocated to Fixed Income Markets and Equity Markets.

Prior to January 1, 2014, CIB provided several non-GAAP financial measures excluding the impact of implementing the FVA framework (effective 2013) and DVA on: net revenue, net income, compensation ratio, overhead ratio, and return on equity. Beginning in the first quarter 2014, the Firm did not exclude FVA and DVA from its assessment of business performance; however, the Firm continues to present these non-GAAP measures for the periods prior to January 1, 2014, as they reflected how management assessed the underlying business performance of the CIB in those prior periods. In addition, the ratio for the allowance for loan losses to end-of-period loans, also a non-GAAP financial measure, is


92
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



calculated excluding the impact of consolidated Firm-administered multi-seller conduits and trade finance, to provide a more meaningful assessment of CIB’s allowance coverage ratio. These measures are used by management to assess the underlying performance of the business and for comparability with peers.
2014 compared with 2013
Net income was $6.9 billion, down 22% compared with $8.9 billion in the prior year. These results primarily reflected lower revenue as well as higher noninterest expense. Net revenue was $34.6 billion, flat compared with the prior year.
Banking revenue was $11.8 billion, down 3% from the prior year. Investment banking fees were $6.6 billion, up 4% from the prior year. The increase was driven by higher advisory and equity underwriting fees, partially offset by lower debt underwriting fees. Advisory fees were $1.6 billion up 24% on stronger share of fees for completed transactions as well as growth in the industry-wide fee levels, according to Dealogic. Equity underwriting fees were $1.6 billion up 5%, driven by higher industry wide issuance. Debt underwriting fees were $3.4 billion, down 4%, primarily related to lower loan syndication fees on lower industry-wide fee levels and lower bond underwriting fees. The Firm also ranked #1 globally in fees and volumes share across high grade, high yield and loan products. The Firm maintained its #2 ranking for M&A, and improved share of fees both globally and in the U.S. compared to the prior year. Treasury Services revenue was $4.1 billion, down 1% compared with the prior year, primarily driven by lower trade finance revenue as well as the impact of business simplification initiatives, largely offset by higher net interest income from increased deposits. Lending revenue was $1.1 billion, down from $1.7 billion in the prior year, driven by losses, compared with gains in the prior periods, on securities received from restructured loans, as well as lower net interest income.
Markets & Investor Services revenue was $22.8 billion, up 1% from the prior year. Fixed Income Markets revenue was $13.8 billion down 13% from the prior year driven by lower revenues in Fixed Income primarily from credit-related and rates products as well as the impact of business simplification. Equity Markets revenue was $4.9 billion up 1% as higher prime services revenue was partially offset by lower equity derivatives revenue. Securities Services revenue was $4.4 billion, up 6% from the prior year, primarily driven by higher net interest income on increased deposits and higher fees and commissions. Credit Adjustments & Other revenue was a loss of $272 million driven by net CVA losses partially offset by gains, net of hedges, related to FVA/DVA. The prior year was a loss of $2.1 billion (including the FVA implementation loss of $1.5 billion and DVA losses of $452 million).
Noninterest expense was $23.3 billion, up 7% compared to the prior year as a result of higher legal expense and investment in controls. This was partially offset by lower performance-based compensation expense as well as the impact of business simplification, including the sale or liquidation of a significant part of the physical commodities
 
business. The compensation expense to net revenue ratio was 30%.
Return on equity was 10% on $61.0 billion of average allocated capital.
2013 compared with 2012
Net income was $8.9 billion, up 2% compared with the prior year.
Net revenue was $34.8 billion, flat compared with the prior year. Net revenue in 2013 included a $1.5 billion loss as a result of implementing a FVA framework for OTC derivatives and structured notes. The FVA framework incorporates the impact of funding into the Firm’s valuation estimates for OTC derivatives and structured notes and reflects an industry migration towards incorporating the market cost of unsecured funding in the valuation of such instruments. The loss recorded in 2013 was a one-time adjustment arising on implementation of the new FVA framework.
Net revenue in 2013 also included a $452 million loss from DVA on structured notes and derivative liabilities, compared with a loss of $930 million in the prior year. Excluding the impact of FVA and DVA, net revenue was $36.7 billion and net income was $10.1 billion, compared with $35.7 billion and $9.2 billion, respectively in the prior year.
Banking revenue was $12.2 billion, compared with $11.4 billion in the prior year. Investment banking fees were $6.3 billion, up 10% from the prior year, driven by higher equity underwriting fees of $1.5 billion (up 46%) and record debt underwriting fees of $3.5 billion (up 8%), partially offset by lower advisory fees of $1.3 billion (down 12%). Equity underwriting results were driven by higher industry-wide issuance and an increase in share of fees compared with the prior year, according to Dealogic. Industry-wide loan syndication volumes and fees increased as the low-rate environment continued to fuel refinancing activity. The Firm also ranked #1 in industry-wide fee shares across high grade, high yield and loan products. Advisory fees were lower compared with the prior year as industry-wide completed M&A industry-wide fee levels declined 13%. The Firm maintained its #2 ranking and improved share for both announced and completed volumes during the year.
Treasury Services revenue was $4.2 billion, down 2% compared with the prior year, primarily reflecting lower trade finance spreads, partially offset by higher net interest income on higher deposit balances. Lending revenue was $1.7 billion, up from $1.4 billion, in the prior year reflecting net interest income on retained loans, fees on lending-related commitments, and gains on securities received from restructured loans.
Markets and Investor Services revenue was $22.6 billion compared to $23.4 billion in the prior year. Combined Fixed Income and Equity Markets revenue was $20.6 billion, up from $20.1 billion the prior year. Fixed Income Markets revenue was $15.8 billion slightly higher reflecting consistently strong client revenue and lower losses from the synthetic credit portfolio, which was partially offset by lower rates-related revenue given an uncertain rate outlook and low spread environment. Equities Markets revenue was


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
93

Management’s discussion and analysis

$4.8 billion up 8% compared with the prior year driven by higher revenue in derivatives and cash equities products and Prime Services primarily on higher balances. Securities Services revenue was $4.1 billion compared with $4.0 billion in the prior year on higher custody and fund services revenue primarily driven by higher assets under custody of $20.5 trillion. Credit Adjustments & Other was a loss of $2.1 billion predominantly driven by FVA (effective 2013) and DVA.
The provision for credit losses was a benefit of $232 million, compared with a benefit of $479 million in the prior year. The 2013 benefit reflected lower recoveries as compared with 2012 as the prior year benefited from the restructuring of certain nonperforming loans. Net recoveries were $78 million, compared with $284 million in the prior year reflecting a continued favorable credit environment with stable credit quality trends. Nonperforming loans were down 57% from the prior year.
Noninterest expense was $21.7 billion slightly down compared with the prior year, driven by lower compensation expense, offset by higher noncompensation expense related to higher litigation expense as compared with the prior year. The compensation ratio, excluding the impact of DVA and FVA (effective 2013), was 30% and 32% for 2013 and 2012, respectively.
Return on equity was 15% on $56.5 billion of average allocated capital and 17% excluding FVA (effective 2013) and DVA.
Selected metrics
 
 
 
 
As of or for the year ended
December 31,
(in millions, except headcount)
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Selected balance sheet data (period-end)
 
 
 
 
 
Assets
$
861,819

 
$
843,577

 
$
876,107

Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Loans retained(a)
96,409

 
95,627

 
109,501

Loans held-for-sale and loans at fair value
5,567

 
11,913

 
5,749

Total loans
101,976

 
107,540

 
115,250

Equity
61,000

 
56,500

 
47,500

Selected balance sheet data (average)
 
 
 
 
 
Assets
$
854,712

 
$
859,071

 
$
854,670

Trading assets-debt and equity instruments
317,535

 
321,585

 
312,944

Trading assets-derivative receivables
64,833

 
70,353

 
74,874

Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Loans retained(a)
95,764

 
104,864

 
110,100

Loans held-for-sale and loans at fair value
7,599

 
5,158

 
3,502

Total loans
103,363

 
110,022

 
113,602

Equity
61,000

 
56,500

 
47,500

 
 
 
 
 
 
Headcount
51,129

 
52,250

 
52,022

(a)
Loans retained includes credit portfolio loans, trade finance loans, other held-for-investment loans and overdrafts.
 
Selected metrics
 
 
 
 
 
As of or for the year ended
December 31,
(in millions, except ratios and where otherwise noted)
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Credit data and quality statistics
 
 
 
 
 
Net charge-offs/(recoveries)
$
(12
)
 
$
(78
)
 
$
(284
)
Nonperforming assets:
 
 
 
 
 
Nonaccrual loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Nonaccrual loans retained(a)(b)
110

 
163

 
535

Nonaccrual loans held-for-sale and loans at fair value
11

 
180

 
254

Total nonaccrual loans
121

 
343

 
789

Derivative receivables
275

 
415

 
239

Assets acquired in loan satisfactions
67

 
80

 
64

Total nonperforming assets
463

 
838

 
1,092

Allowance for credit losses:
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses
1,034

 
1,096

 
1,300

Allowance for lending-related commitments
439

 
525

 
473

Total allowance for credit losses
1,473

 
1,621

 
1,773

Net charge-off/(recovery) rate(a)
(0.01
)%
 
(0.07
)%
 
(0.26
)%
Allowance for loan losses to period-end loans
  retained(a)
1.07

 
1.15

 
1.19

Allowance for loan losses to period-end loans retained, excluding trade finance and conduits
1.82

 
2.02

 
2.52

Allowance for loan losses to nonaccrual loans
  retained(a)(b)
940

 
672

 
243

Nonaccrual loans to total period-end loans
0.12

 
0.32

 
0.68

(a)
Loans retained includes credit portfolio loans, trade finance loans, other held-for-investment loans and overdrafts.
(b)
Allowance for loan losses of $18 million, $51 million and $153 million were held against these nonaccrual loans at December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.


94
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Business metrics
 
 
 
 
As of or for the year ended
December 31,
(in millions, except ratios and where otherwise noted)
 
 
 
 
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Market risk-related revenue – trading loss days(a)
9

 
0

 
7

Assets under custody (“AUC”) by asset class (period-end) in billions:
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed Income
$
12,328

 
$
11,903

 
$
11,745

Equity
6,524

 
6,913

 
5,637

Other(b)
1,697

 
1,669

 
1,453

Total AUC
$
20,549

 
$
20,485

 
$
18,835

Client deposits and other third party liabilities (average)(c)
$
417,369

 
$
383,667

 
$
355,766

Trade finance loans (period-end)
25,713

 
30,752

 
35,783

(a)
Market risk-related revenue is defined as the change in value of: principal transactions revenue; trading-related net interest income; brokerage commissions, underwriting fees or other revenue; and revenue from syndicated lending facilities that the Firm intends to distribute; gains and losses from DVA and FVA are excluded. Market risk-related revenue – trading loss days represent the number of days for which the CIB posted losses under this measure. The loss days determined under this measure differ from the loss days that are determined based on the disclosure of market risk-related gains and losses for the Firm in the VaR back-testing discussion on pages 134–135.
(b)
Consists of mutual funds, unit investment trusts, currencies, annuities, insurance contracts, options and other contracts.
(c)
Client deposits and other third party liabilities pertain to the Treasury Services and Securities Services businesses, and include deposits, as well as deposits that are swept to on-balance sheet liabilities (e.g., commercial paper, federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements) as part of their client cash management program.
 



































 
League table results – IB Fee Share(a)
 
League table results – volumes(e)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
Year ended
December 31,
Fee Share
Rankings
 
Fee Share
Rankings
 
Fee Share
Rankings
 
Year ended
December 31,
Market Share
Rankings
 
Market Share
Rankings
 
Market Share
Rankings
 
 
Debt, equity and equity-related
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt, equity and equity-related
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Global
7.6%
#1
 
8.3%
#1
 
7.8%
#1
 
Global
6.8%
#1
 
7.3%
#1
 
7.2%
#1
 
 
U.S.
10.7
1
 
11.5
1
 
11.1
1
 
U.S.
11.8
1
 
12.0
1
 
11.5
1
 
 
Long-term debt(b)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Long-term debt(b)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Global
8.0
1
 
8.2
1
 
8.3
1
 
Global
6.7
1
 
7.2
1
 
7.1
1
 
 
U.S.
11.6
1
 
11.6
1
 
11.7
1
 
U.S.
11.3
1
 
11.7
1
 
11.6
1
 
 
Equity and equity-related
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity and equity-related
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Global(c)
7.1
3
 
8.4
2
 
7.1
1
 
Global(c)
7.6
3
 
8.2
2
 
7.8
4
 
 
U.S.
9.6
2
 
11.3
2
 
10.1
2
 
U.S.
11.0
2
 
12.1
2
 
10.4
5
 
 
M&A(d)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
M&A announced(d)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Global
8.2
2
 
7.6
2
 
6.5
2
 
Global
21.6
2
 
23.5
2
 
20.0
2
 
 
U.S.
10.0
2
 
8.8
2
 
7.7
2
 
U.S.
27.8
2
 
36.4
2
 
24.3
2
 
 
Loan syndications
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loan syndications
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Global
9.5
1
 
9.9
1
 
8.2
2
 
Global
12.4
1
 
11.6
1
 
11.6
1
 
 
U.S.
13.3
1
 
13.8
1
 
11.2
2
 
U.S.
19.4
1
 
17.8
1
 
18.2
1
 
 
Global Investment Banking fees
8.1%
#1
 
8.5%
#1
 
7.5%
#1
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(a) Source: Dealogic. Reflects the ranking and share of Global Investment Banking fees
(b) Long-term debt rankings include investment-grade, high-yield, supranationals, sovereigns, agencies, covered bonds, asset-backed securities (“ABS”) and mortgage-backed
  securities; and exclude money market, short-term debt, and U.S. municipal securities.
(c) Global equity and equity-related rankings include rights offerings and Chinese A-Shares.
(d) M&A and Announced M&A rankings reflect the removal of any withdrawn transactions. U.S. M&A revenue wallet represents wallet from client parents based in the U.S. U.S.
  announced M&A volumes represents any U.S. involvement ranking.
(e) Source: Dealogic. Reflects transaction volume and market share. Global announced M&A is based on transaction value at announcement; because of joint M&A
  assignments, M&A market share of all participants will add up to more than 100%. All other transaction volume-based rankings are based on proceeds, with full credit to
  each book manager/equal if joint.
 

JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
95

Management’s discussion and analysis

International metrics
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31,
 
(in millions)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Total net revenue(a)
 
 
 
 
 
Europe/Middle East/Africa
$
11,598

 
$
10,689

 
$
10,787

Asia/Pacific
4,698

 
4,736

 
4,128

Latin America/Caribbean
1,179

 
1,340

 
1,533

Total international net revenue
17,475

 
16,765

 
16,448

North America
17,158

 
18,021

 
18,314

Total net revenue
$
34,633

 
$
34,786

 
$
34,762

 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans (period-end)(a)
 
 
 
 
 
Europe/Middle East/Africa
$
27,155

 
$
29,392

 
$
30,266

Asia/Pacific
19,992

 
22,151

 
27,193

Latin America/Caribbean
8,950

 
8,362

 
10,220

Total international loans
56,097

 
59,905

 
67,679

North America
40,312

 
35,722

 
41,822

Total loans
$
96,409

 
$
95,627

 
$
109,501

 
 
 
 
 
 
Client deposits and other third-party liabilities (average)(a)
 
 
 
 
 
Europe/Middle East/Africa
$
152,712

 
$
143,807

 
$
127,326

Asia/Pacific
66,933

 
54,428

 
51,180

Latin America/Caribbean
22,360

 
15,301

 
11,052

Total international
$
242,005

 
$
213,536

 
$
189,558

North America
175,364

 
170,131

 
166,208

Total client deposits and other third-party liabilities
$
417,369

 
$
383,667

 
$
355,766

 
 
 
 
 
 
AUC (period-end) (in billions)(a)
 
 
 
 
 
North America
$
11,987

 
$
11,299

 
$
10,504

All other regions
8,562

 
9,186

 
8,331

Total AUC
$
20,549

 
$
20,485

 
$
18,835

(a)
Total net revenue is based predominantly on the domicile of the client or location of the trading desk, as applicable. Loans outstanding (excluding loans held-for-sale and loans at fair value), client deposits and other third-party liabilities, and AUC are based predominantly on the domicile of the client.



96
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



COMMERCIAL BANKING
Commercial Banking delivers extensive industry knowledge, local expertise and dedicated service to U.S. and U.S. multinational clients, including corporations, municipalities, financial institutions and nonprofit entities with annual revenue generally ranging from $20 million to $2 billion. CB provides financing to real estate investors and owners. Partnering with the Firm’s other businesses, CB provides comprehensive financial solutions, including lending, treasury services, investment banking and asset management to meet its clients’ domestic and international financial needs.
Selected income statement data
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Revenue
 
 
 
 
 
Lending- and deposit-related fees
$
978

 
$
1,033

 
$
1,072

Asset management, administration and commissions
92

 
116

 
130

All other income(a)
1,279

 
1,149

 
1,081

Noninterest revenue
2,349

 
2,298

 
2,283

Net interest income
4,533

 
4,794

 
4,629

Total net revenue(b)
6,882

 
7,092

 
6,912

Provision for credit losses
(189
)
 
85

 
41

Noninterest expense
 
 
 
 
 
Compensation expense
1,203

 
1,115

 
1,014

Noncompensation expense
1,492

 
1,495

 
1,375

Total noninterest expense
2,695

 
2,610

 
2,389

Income before income tax expense
4,376

 
4,397

 
4,482

Income tax expense
1,741

 
1,749

 
1,783

Net income
$
2,635

 
$
2,648

 
$
2,699

 
 
 
 
 
 
Revenue by product
 
 
 
 
 
Lending
$
3,576

 
$
3,945

 
$
3,762

Treasury services
2,448

 
2,429

 
2,428

Investment banking
684

 
575

 
545

Other
174

 
143

 
177

Total Commercial Banking net revenue
$
6,882

 
$
7,092

 
$
6,912

 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment banking revenue, gross
$
1,986

 
$
1,676

 
$
1,597

 
 
 
 
 
 
Revenue by client segment
 
 
 
 
 
Middle Market Banking
$
2,838

 
$
3,075

 
$
3,010

Corporate Client Banking
1,935

 
1,851

 
1,843

Commercial Term Lending
1,252

 
1,239

 
1,206

Real Estate Banking
495

 
561

 
450

Other
362

 
366

 
403

Total Commercial Banking net revenue
$
6,882

 
$
7,092

 
$
6,912

 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial ratios
 
 
 
 
 
Return on common equity
18
%
 
19
%
 
28
%
Overhead ratio
39

 
37

 
35

Note: As discussed on pages 79–80, effective with the fourth quarter of 2014 the Firm changed its methodology for allocating the cost of preferred stock to its reportable business segments. Prior periods have been revised to conform with the current period presentation.
 

(a)
Includes revenue from investment banking products and commercial card transactions.
(b)
Total net revenue included tax-equivalent adjustments from income tax credits related to equity investments in designated community development entities that provide loans to qualified businesses in low-income communities, as well as tax-exempt income from municipal bond activity of $462 million, $407 million and $381 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
2014 compared with 2013
Net income was $2.6 billion, flat compared with the prior year, reflecting lower net revenue and higher noninterest expense, predominantly offset by a lower provision for credit losses.
Net revenue was $6.9 billion, a decrease of $210 million, or 3%, compared with the prior year. Net interest income was $4.5 billion, a decrease of $261 million, or 5%, reflecting yield compression, the absence of proceeds received in the prior year from a lending-related workout, and lower purchase discounts recognized on loan repayments, partially offset by higher loan balances. Noninterest revenue was $2.3 billion, up $51 million, or 2%, reflecting higher investment banking revenue largely offset by business simplification and lower lending fees.
Noninterest expense was $2.7 billion, an increase of $85 million, or 3%, from the prior year, largely reflecting higher investments in controls.
2013 compared with 2012
Net income was $2.6 billion, a decrease of $51 million, or 2%, from the prior year, driven by an increase in noninterest expense and the provision for credit losses, partially offset by an increase in net revenue.
Net revenue was a record $7.1 billion, an increase of $180 million, or 3%, from the prior year. Net interest income was $4.8 billion, up by $165 million, or 4%, driven by higher loan balances and proceeds from a lending-related workout, partially offset by lower purchase discounts recognized on loan repayments. Noninterest revenue was $2.3 billion, flat compared with the prior year.
Noninterest expense was $2.6 billion, an increase of $221 million, or 9%, from the prior year, reflecting higher product- and headcount-related expense.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
97

Management’s discussion and analysis

CB revenue comprises the following:
Lending includes a variety of financing alternatives, which are predominantly secured by receivables, inventory, equipment, real estate or other assets. Products include term loans, revolving lines of credit, bridge financing, asset-based structures, leases, commercial card products and standby letters of credit.
Treasury services includes revenue from a broad range of products and services that enable CB clients to manage payments and receipts, as well as invest and manage funds.
Investment banking includes revenue from a range of products that provide CB clients with sophisticated capital-raising alternatives, as well as balance sheet and risk management tools through advisory, equity underwriting, and loan syndications. Revenue from Fixed income and Equity market products used by CB clients is also included. Investment banking revenue, gross, represents total revenue related to investment banking products sold to
CB clients.
Other product revenue primarily includes tax-equivalent adjustments generated from Community Development Banking activities and certain income derived from principal transactions.
CB is divided into four primary client segments: Middle Market Banking, Corporate Client Banking, Commercial Term Lending, and Real Estate Banking.
Middle Market Banking covers corporate, municipal and nonprofit clients, with annual revenue generally ranging between $20 million and $500 million.
Corporate Client Banking covers clients with annual revenue generally ranging between $500 million and $2 billion and focuses on clients that have broader investment banking needs.
Commercial Term Lending primarily provides term financing to real estate investors/owners for multifamily properties as well as office, retail and industrial properties.
Real Estate Banking provides full-service banking to investors and developers of institutional-grade real estate investment properties.
Other primarily includes lending and investment activities within the Community Development Banking and Chase Capital businesses.
 
Selected metrics
 
 
 
 
 
As of or for the year ended December 31, (in millions, except headcount)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Selected balance sheet data (period-end)
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
$
195,267

 
$
190,782

 
$
181,502

Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Loans retained
147,661

 
135,750

 
126,996

Loans held-for-sale and loans at fair value
845

 
1,388

 
1,212

Total loans
$
148,506

 
$
137,138

 
$
128,208

Equity
14,000

 
13,500

 
9,500

 
 
 
 
 
 
Period-end loans by client segment
 
 
 
 
 
Middle Market Banking
$
53,635

 
$
52,289

 
$
50,552

Corporate Client Banking
22,695

 
20,925

 
21,707

Commercial Term Lending
54,038

 
48,925

 
43,512

Real Estate Banking
13,298

 
11,024

 
8,552

Other
4,840

 
3,975

 
3,885

Total Commercial Banking loans
$
148,506

 
$
137,138

 
$
128,208

 
 
 
 
 
 
Selected balance sheet data (average)
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
$
191,857

 
$
185,776

 
$
165,111

Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Loans retained
140,982

 
131,100

 
119,218

Loans held-for-sale and loans at fair value
782

 
930

 
882

Total loans
$
141,764

 
$
132,030

 
$
120,100

Client deposits and other third-party liabilities
204,017

 
198,356

 
195,912

Equity
14,000

 
13,500

 
9,500

 
 
 
 
 
 
Average loans by client segment
 
 
 
 
 
Middle Market Banking
$
52,444

 
$
51,830

 
$
47,009

Corporate Client Banking
21,608

 
20,918

 
19,572

Commercial Term Lending
51,120

 
45,989

 
40,872

Real Estate Banking
12,080

 
9,582

 
8,562

Other
4,512

 
3,711

 
4,085

Total Commercial Banking loans
$
141,764

 
$
132,030

 
$
120,100

 
 
 
 
 
 
Headcount
7,262

 
6,848

 
6,117



98
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Selected metrics (continued)
 
 
 
 
As of or for the year ended December 31, (in millions, except ratios)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Credit data and quality statistics
 
 
 
 
 
Net charge-offs/(recoveries)
$
(7
)
 
$
43

 
$
35

Nonperforming assets
 
 
 
 
 
Nonaccrual loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Nonaccrual loans retained(a)
317

 
471

 
644

Nonaccrual loans held-for-sale and loans at fair value
14

 
43

 
29

Total nonaccrual loans
331

 
514

 
673

Assets acquired in loan satisfactions
10

 
15

 
14

Total nonperforming assets
341

 
529

 
687

Allowance for credit losses:
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses
2,466

 
2,669

 
2,610

Allowance for lending-related commitments
165

 
142

 
183

Total allowance for credit losses
2,631

 
2,811

 
2,793

Net charge-off/(recovery) rate(b)

 
0.03
%
 
0.03
%
Allowance for loan losses to period-end loans retained
1.67

 
1.97

 
2.06

Allowance for loan losses to nonaccrual loans retained(a)
778

 
567

 
405

Nonaccrual loans to total period-end loans
0.22

 
0.37

 
0.52

(a)
An allowance for loan losses of $45 million, $81 million and $107 million was held against nonaccrual loans retained at December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
(b)
Loans held-for-sale and loans at fair value were excluded when calculating the net charge-off/(recovery) rate.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
99

Management’s discussion and analysis

ASSET MANAGEMENT
Asset Management, with client assets of $2.4 trillion, is a global leader in investment and wealth management. AM clients include institutions, high-net-worth individuals and retail investors in every major market throughout the world. AM offers investment management across all major asset classes including equities, fixed income, alternatives and money market funds. AM also offers multi-asset investment management, providing solutions for a broad range of clients’ investment needs. For Global Wealth Management clients, AM also provides retirement products and services, brokerage and banking services including trusts and estates, loans, mortgages and deposits. The majority of AM’s client assets are in actively managed portfolios.
Selected income statement data
 
 
Year ended December 31,
(in millions, except ratios
and headcount)
2014
2013
2012
Revenue
 
 
 
Asset management, administration and commissions
$
9,024

$
8,232

$
7,041

All other income
564

797

806

Noninterest revenue
9,588

9,029

7,847

Net interest income
2,440

2,376

2,163

Total net revenue
12,028

11,405

10,010

 
 
 
 
Provision for credit losses
4

65

86

 
 
 
 
Noninterest expense
 
 
 
Compensation expense
5,082

4,875

4,405

Noncompensation expense
3,456

3,141

2,699

Total noninterest expense
8,538

8,016

7,104

 
 
 
 
Income before income tax expense
3,486

3,324

2,820

Income tax expense
1,333

1,241

1,078

Net income
$
2,153

$
2,083

$
1,742

 
 
 
 
Revenue by line of business
 
 
 
Global Investment Management
$
6,327

$
5,951

$
5,141

Global Wealth Management
5,701

5,454

4,869

Total net revenue
$
12,028

$
11,405

$
10,010

 
 
 
 
Financial ratios
 
 
 
Return on common equity
23
%
23
%
24
%
Overhead ratio
71

70

71

Pretax margin ratio:
 
 
 
Global Investment Management
31

32

30

Global Wealth Management
27

26

26

Asset Management
29

29

28

 
 
 
 
Headcount
19,735

20,048

18,645

 
 
 
 
Number of client advisors
2,836

2,962
2,821

Note: As discussed on pages 79–80, effective with the fourth quarter of 2014 the Firm changed its methodology for allocating the cost of preferred stock to its reportable business segments. Prior periods have been revised to conform with the current period presentation.
 
2014 compared with 2013
Net income was $2.2 billion, an increase of $70 million, or 3%, from the prior year, reflecting higher net revenue and lower provision for credit losses, predominantly offset by higher noninterest expense.
Net revenue was $12.0 billion, an increase of $623 million, or 5%, from the prior year. Noninterest revenue was $9.6 billion, up $559 million, or 6%, from the prior year, due to net client inflows and the effect of higher market levels, partially offset by lower valuations of seed capital investments. Net interest income was $2.4 billion, up $64 million, or 3%, from the prior year, due to higher loan and deposit balances, largely offset by spread compression.
Revenue from Global Investment Management was $6.3 billion, up 6% due to net client inflows and the effect of higher market levels, partially offset by lower valuations of seed capital investments. Revenue from Global Wealth Management was $5.7 billion, up 5% from the prior year due to higher net interest income from loan and deposit balances and net client inflows, partially offset by spread compression and lower brokerage revenue.
Noninterest expense was $8.5 billion, an increase of $522 million, or 7%, from the prior year, as the business continues to invest in both infrastructure and controls.
2013 compared with 2012
Net income was $2.1 billion, an increase of $341 million, or 20%, from the prior year, reflecting higher net revenue, largely offset by higher noninterest expense.
Net revenue was $11.4 billion, an increase of $1.4 billion, or 14%, from the prior year. Noninterest revenue was $9.0 billion, up $1.2 billion, or 15%, from the prior year, due to net client inflows, the effect of higher market levels and higher performance fees. Net interest income was $2.4 billion, up $213 million, or 10%, from the prior year, due to higher loan and deposit balances, partially offset by narrower loan and deposit spreads.
Revenue from Global Investment Management was $6.0 billion, up 16% due to net client inflows, the effect of higher market levels and higher performance fees. Revenue from Global Wealth Management was $5.5 billion, up 12% from the prior year due to higher net interest income from loan and deposit balances and higher brokerage revenue.
Noninterest expense was $8.0 billion, an increase of $912 million, or 13%, from the prior year, primarily due to higher headcount-related expense driven by continued front office expansion efforts, higher performance-based compensation and costs related to the control agenda.


100
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



AM’s lines of business comprise the following:
Global Investment Management provides comprehensive global investment services, including asset management, pension analytics, asset-liability management and active risk-budgeting strategies.
Global Wealth Management offers investment advice and wealth management, including investment management, capital markets and risk management, tax and estate planning, banking, lending and specialty-wealth advisory services.
AM’s client segments comprise the following:
Private Banking clients include high- and ultra-high-net-worth individuals, families, money managers, business owners and small corporations worldwide.
Institutional clients include both corporate and public institutions, endowments, foundations, nonprofit organizations and governments worldwide.
Retail clients include financial intermediaries and individual investors.
J.P. Morgan Asset Management has two high-level measures of its overall fund performance.
Percentage of mutual fund assets under management in funds rated 4- or 5-star: Mutual fund rating services rank funds based on their risk-adjusted performance over various periods. A 5-star rating is the best rating and represents the top 10% of industry-wide ranked funds. A 4-star rating represents the next 22.5% of industry-wide ranked funds. A 3-star rating represents the next 35% of industry-wide ranked funds. A 2-star rating represents the next 22.5% of industry-wide ranked funds. A 1-star rating is the worst rating and represents the bottom 10% of industry-wide ranked funds. The overall Morningstar rating is derived from a weighted average of the performance figures associated with a fund’s three-, five- and ten-year (if applicable) Morningstar Rating metrics. For U.S. domiciled funds, separate star ratings are given at the individual share class level. The Nomura star rating is based on three-year risk-adjusted performance only. Funds with fewer than three years of history are not rated and hence excluded from this analysis. All ratings, the assigned peer categories and the asset values used to derive this analysis are sourced from these fund rating providers as mentioned in footnote (a). The data providers re-denominate the asset values into USD. This % of AUM is based on star ratings at the share class level for U.S. domiciled funds, and at a primary share class level to represent the star rating of all other funds except for Japan where Nomura provides ratings at the fund level. The “primary share class”, as defined by Morningstar, denotes the share class recommended as being the best proxy for the portfolio and in most cases will be the most retail version (based upon annual management charge, minimum investment, currency and other factors). Past performance is not indicative of future results.
Percentage of mutual fund assets under management in funds ranked in the 1st or 2nd quartile (one, three and five years): All quartile rankings, the assigned peer categories and the asset values used to derive this analysis are sourced from the fund ranking providers mentioned in footnote (b). Quartile rankings are done on the net-of-fee absolute return of each fund. The data providers re-denominate the asset values into USD. This % of AUM is based on fund performance and associated peer rankings at the share class level for U.S. domiciled funds, at a primary share class” level to represent the quartile ranking of Luxembourg, U.K. and Hong Kong funds and at the fund level for all other funds. The primary share class, as defined by Morningstar, denotes the share class recommended as being the best proxy for the portfolio and in most cases will be the most retail version (based upon annual management charge, minimum investment, currency and other factors). Where peer group rankings given for a fund are in more than one “primary share class” territory both rankings are included to reflect local market competitiveness (applies to “Offshore Territories” and “HK SFC Authorized” funds only). Past performance is not indicative of future results.
 
Selected metrics
 
 
 
As of or for the year ended December 31,
(in millions, except ranking data and ratios)
2014
2013
2012
% of JPM mutual fund assets rated as 4- or 5-star(a)
52
%
49
%
47
%
% of JPM mutual fund assets ranked in 1st or 2nd quartile:(b)
 
 
 
1 year
72

68

67

3 years
72

68

74

5 years
76

69

76

 
 
 
 
Selected balance sheet data (period-end)
 
 
 
Total assets
$
128,701

$
122,414

$
108,999

Loans(c)
104,279

95,445

80,216

Deposits
155,247

146,183

144,579

Equity
9,000

9,000

7,000

 
 
 
 
Selected balance sheet data (average)
 
 
 
Total assets
$
126,440

$
113,198

$
97,447

Loans
99,805

86,066

68,719

Deposits
150,121

139,707
129,208

Equity
9,000

9,000

7,000

 
 
 
 
Credit data and quality statistics
 
 
 
Net charge-offs
$
6

$
40

$
64

Nonaccrual loans
218

167

250

Allowance for credit losses:
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses
271

278

248

Allowance for lending-related commitments
5

5

5

Total allowance for credit losses
276

283

253

Net charge-off rate
0.01
%
0.05
%
0.09
%
Allowance for loan losses to period-end loans
0.26

0.29

0.31

Allowance for loan losses to nonaccrual loans
124

166

99

Nonaccrual loans to period-end loans
0.21

0.17

0.31

(a)
Represents the “overall star rating” derived from Morningstar for the U.S., the U.K., Luxembourg, Hong Kong and Taiwan domiciled funds; and Nomura ’star rating’ for Japan domiciled funds. Includes only retail open ended mutual funds that have a rating. Excludes money market funds, Undiscovered Managers Fund, and Brazil and India domiciled funds.
(b)
Quartile ranking sourced from: Lipper for the U.S. and Taiwan domiciled funds; Morningstar for the U.K., Luxembourg and Hong Kong domiciled funds; Nomura for Japan domiciled funds and FundDoctor for South Korea domiciled funds. Includes only retail open ended mutual funds that are ranked by the aforementioned sources. Excludes money market funds, Undiscovered Managers Fund, and Brazil and India domiciled funds.
(c)
Included $22.1 billion, $18.9 billion and $10.9 billion of prime mortgage loans reported in the Consumer, excluding credit card, loan portfolio at December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. For the same periods, excluded $2.7 billion, $3.7 billion and $6.7 billion, respectively, of prime mortgage loans reported in the CIO portfolio within the Corporate segment.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
101

Management’s discussion and analysis

Client assets
2014 compared with 2013
Client assets were $2.4 trillion, an increase of $44 billion, or 2%, compared with the prior year. Excluding the sale of Retirement Plan Services, client assets were up 8% compared with the prior year. Assets under management were $1.7 trillion, an increase of $146 billion, or 9%, from the prior year, due to net inflows to long-term products and the effect of higher market levels.
2013 compared with 2012
Client assets were $2.3 trillion at December 31, 2013, an increase of $248 billion, or 12%, compared with the prior year. Assets under management were $1.6 trillion, an increase of $172 billion, or 12%, from the prior year, due to net inflows to long-term products and the effect of higher market levels. Custody, brokerage, administration and deposit balances were $745 billion, up $76 billion, or 11%, from the prior year, due to the effect of higher market levels and custody inflows, partially offset by brokerage outflows.
Client assets
 
 
December 31,
(in billions)
2014

2013

2012
Assets by asset class
 
 
 
Liquidity
$
461

$
451

$
458

Fixed income
359

330

330

Equity
375

370

277

Multi-asset and alternatives
549

447

361

Total assets under management
1,744

1,598

1,426

Custody/brokerage/administration/deposits
643

745

669

Total client assets
$
2,387

$
2,343

$
2,095

 
 
 
 
Memo:
 
 
 
Alternatives client assets(a)
166

158

142

 
 
 
 
Assets by client segment
 
 
 
Private Banking
$
428

$
361

$
318

Institutional
827

777

741

Retail
489

460

367

Total assets under management
$
1,744

$
1,598

$
1,426

 
 
 
 
Private Banking
$
1,057

$
977

$
877

Institutional
835

777

741

Retail
495

589

477

Total client assets
$
2,387

$
2,343

$
2,095

(a)
Represents assets under management, as well as client balances in brokerage accounts.
 
Client assets (continued)
 
 
 
Year ended December 31,
(in billions)
2014
2013
2012
Assets under management rollforward
 
 
 
Beginning balance
$
1,598

$
1,426

$
1,336

Net asset flows:
 
 
 
Liquidity
18

(4
)
(41
)
Fixed income
33

8

27

Equity
5

34

8

Multi-asset and alternatives
42

48

23

Market/performance/other impacts
48

86

73

Ending balance, December 31
$
1,744

$
1,598

$
1,426

 
 
 
 
Client assets rollforward
 
 
 
Beginning balance
$
2,343

$
2,095

$
1,921

Net asset flows
118

80

60

Market/performance/other impacts
(74
)
168

114

Ending balance, December 31
$
2,387

$
2,343

$
2,095


International metrics
Year ended December 31,
(in billions,
except where otherwise noted)
2014
2013
2012
Total net revenue (in millions)(a)
 
 
 
Europe/Middle East/Africa
$
2,080

$
1,881

$
1,641

Asia/Pacific
1,199

1,133

958

Latin America/Caribbean
841

879

773

North America
7,908

7,512

6,638

Total net revenue
$
12,028

$
11,405

$
10,010

 
 
 
 
Assets under management
 
 
 
Europe/Middle East/Africa
$
329

$
305

$
258

Asia/Pacific
126

132

114

Latin America/Caribbean
46

47

45

North America
1,243

1,114

1,009

Total assets under management
$
1,744

$
1,598

$
1,426

 
 
 
 
Client assets
 
 
 
Europe/Middle East/Africa
$
391

$
367

$
317

Asia/Pacific
174

180

160

Latin America/Caribbean
115

117

110

North America
1,707

1,679

1,508

Total client assets
$
2,387

$
2,343

$
2,095

(a)
Regional revenue is based on the domicile of the client.



102
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



CORPORATE
The Corporate segment comprises Private Equity, Treasury and Chief Investment Office (“CIO”) and Other Corporate, which includes corporate staff units and expense that is centrally managed. Treasury and CIO are predominantly responsible for measuring, monitoring, reporting and managing the Firm’s liquidity, funding and structural interest rate and foreign exchange risks, as well as executing the Firm’s capital plan. The major Other Corporate units include Real Estate, Enterprise Technology, Legal, Compliance, Finance, Human Resources, Internal Audit, Risk Management, Oversight & Control, Corporate Responsibility and various Other Corporate groups. Other centrally managed expense includes the Firm’s occupancy and pension-related expenses that are subject to allocation to the businesses.
Selected income statement data
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31,
(in millions, except headcount)
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Revenue
 
 
 
 
 
Principal transactions
$
1,197

 
$
563

 
$
(4,268
)
Securities gains
71

 
666

 
2,024

All other income
704

 
1,864

 
2,434

Noninterest revenue
1,972

 
3,093

 
190

Net interest income
(1,960
)
 
(3,115
)
 
(2,262
)
Total net revenue(a)
12

 
(22
)
 
(2,072
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Provision for credit losses
(35
)
 
(28
)
 
(37
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Noninterest expense
 
 
 
 
 
Compensation expense
2,888

 
2,299

 
2,221

Noncompensation expense(b)
4,589

 
13,208

 
6,972

Subtotal
7,477

 
15,507

 
9,193

Net expense allocated to other businesses
(6,318
)
 
(5,252
)
 
(4,634
)
Total noninterest expense
1,159

 
10,255

 
4,559

Income/(loss) before income tax expense/(benefit)
(1,112
)
 
(10,249
)
 
(6,594
)
Income tax expense/(benefit)
(1,976
)
 
(3,493
)
 
(3,974
)
Net income/(loss)
$
864

 
$
(6,756
)
 
$
(2,620
)
Total net revenue
 
 
 
 
 
Private equity
$
1,118

 
$
589

 
$
645

Treasury and CIO
(1,317
)
 
(2,068
)
 
(4,089
)
Other Corporate
211

 
1,457

 
1,372

Total net revenue
$
12

 
$
(22
)
 
$
(2,072
)
Net income/(loss)
 
 
 
 
 
Private equity
$
400

 
$
285

 
$
319

Treasury and CIO
(1,165
)
 
(1,454
)
 
(2,718
)
Other Corporate
1,629

 
(5,587
)
 
(221
)
Total net income/(loss)
$
864

 
$
(6,756
)
 
$
(2,620
)
Total assets (period-end)
$
931,705

 
$
805,987

 
$
725,251

Headcount
26,047

 
20,717

 
17,758

Note: As discussed on pages 79–80, effective with the fourth quarter of 2014 the Firm changed its methodology for allocating the cost of preferred stock to its reportable business segments. Prior periods have been revised to conform with the current period presentation.
 
(a)
Included tax-equivalent adjustments, predominantly due to tax-exempt income from municipal bond investments of $730 million, $480 million and $443 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
(b)
Included legal expense of $821 million, $10.2 billion and $3.7 billion for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
2014 compared with 2013
Net income was $864 million, compared with a net loss of $6.8 billion in the prior year.
Private Equity reported net income of $400 million, compared with net income of $285 million in the prior year, primarily due to higher net gains on sales, largely offset by higher noninterest expense related to goodwill impairment.
Treasury and CIO reported a net loss of $1.2 billion, compared with a net loss of $1.5 billion in the prior year. Net revenue was a loss of $1.3 billion, compared with a loss of $2.1 billion in the prior year. Current year net interest income was a loss of $1.7 billion compared with a loss of $2.7 billion in the prior year, primarily reflecting higher yields on investment securities. Securities gains were $71 million, compared to $659 million in the prior year, reflecting lower repositioning activity of the investment securities portfolio in the current period.
Other Corporate reported net income of $1.6 billion, compared with a net loss of $5.6 billion in the prior year. Current year noninterest revenue was $353 million compared with $1.8 billion in the prior year. Prior year noninterest revenue included gains of $1.3 billion and $493 million on the sales of Visa shares and One Chase Manhattan Plaza, respectively. The current year included $821 million of legal expense, compared with $10.2 billion, which included reserves for litigation and regulatory proceedings, in the prior year.
2013 compared with 2012
Net loss was $6.8 billion, compared with a net loss of $2.6 billion in the prior year.
Private Equity reported net income of $285 million, compared with net income of $319 million in the prior year. Net revenue was of $589 million, compared with $645 million in the prior year.
Treasury and CIO reported a net loss of $1.5 billion, compared with a net loss of $2.7 billion in the prior year. Net revenue was a loss of $2.1 billion, compared with a loss of $4.1 billion in the prior year. Net revenue in 2013 included $659 million of net securities gains from sales of available-for-sale investment securities, compared with securities gains of $2.0 billion; and $888 million of pretax extinguishment gains related to the redemption of trust preferred securities in the prior year. The extinguishment gains were related to adjustments applied to the cost basis of the trust preferred securities during the period they were in a qualified hedge accounting relationship. The prior year loss also reflected $5.8 billion of losses incurred by CIO from the synthetic credit portfolio for the six months ended June 30, 2012, and $449 million of losses from the retained index credit derivative positions for the three


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
103

Management’s discussion and analysis

months ended September 30, 2012. Net interest income in 2013 was a loss of $2.7 billion compared with a loss of $1.7 billion in the prior year, primarily due to low interest rates and limited reinvestment opportunities. Net interest income improved in the fourth quarter of 2013 due to higher interest rates and better reinvestment opportunities.
Other Corporate reported a net loss of $5.6 billion, compared with a net loss of $221 million in the prior year. Noninterest revenue in 2013 was $1.8 billion, down 2% compared with the prior year. In 2013, noninterest revenue included gains of $1.3 billion and $493 million on the sales of Visa shares and One Chase Manhattan Plaza, respectively. Noninterest revenue in the prior year included a $1.1 billion benefit for the Washington Mutual bankruptcy settlement and a $665 million gain from the recovery on a Bear Stearns-related subordinated loan. Noninterest expense of $9.7 billion was up $5.9 billion compared with the prior year. Included in 2013 noninterest expense was $10.2 billion of legal expense, including reserves for litigation and regulatory proceedings, compared with $3.7 billion of expense for additional litigation reserves, largely for mortgage-related matters, in the prior year.
Treasury and CIO overview
Treasury and CIO are predominantly responsible for measuring, monitoring, reporting and managing the Firm’s liquidity, funding and structural interest rate and foreign exchange risks, as well as executing the Firm’s capital plan. The risks managed by Treasury and CIO arise from the activities undertaken by the Firm’s four major reportable business segments to serve their respective client bases, which generate both on- and off-balance sheet assets and liabilities.
Treasury and CIO achieve the Firm’s asset-liability management objectives generally by investing in high-quality securities that are managed for the longer-term as part of the Firm’s investment securities portfolio. Treasury and CIO also use derivatives to meet the Firms asset-liability management objectives. For further information on derivatives, see Note 6. The investment securities portfolio primarily consists of U.S. and non-U.S. government securities, agency and nonagency mortgage-backed securities, other asset-backed securities, corporate debt securities and obligations of U.S. states and municipalities. At December 31, 2014, the investment securities portfolio was $343.1 billion, and the average credit rating of the securities comprising the portfolio was AA+ (based upon external ratings where available and where not available, based primarily upon internal ratings that correspond to ratings as defined by S&P and Moody’s). See Note 12 for further information on the details of the Firm’s investment securities portfolio.
For further information on liquidity and funding risk, see Liquidity Risk Management on pages 156–160. For information on interest rate, foreign exchange and other risks, Treasury and CIO Value-at-risk (“VaR”) and the Firm’s structural interest rate-sensitive revenue at risk, see Market Risk Management on pages 131–136.
 
Selected income statement and balance sheet data
As of or for the year ended December 31, (in millions)
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Securities gains
$
71

 
$
659

 
$
2,028

Investment securities portfolio (average)
349,285

 
353,712

 
358,029

Investment securities portfolio (period–end)(a)
343,146

 
347,562

 
365,421

Mortgage loans (average)
3,308

 
5,145

 
10,241

Mortgage loans (period-end)
2,834

 
3,779

 
7,037

(a)
Period-end investment securities included held-to-maturity securities of $49.3 billion and $24.0 billion at December 31, 2014, and 2013, respectively. Held-to-maturity securities as of December 31, 2012, were not material.
Private Equity portfolio
Selected income statement and balance sheet data
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Private equity gains/(losses)
 
 
 
 
 
Realized gains
$
1,164

 
$
(170
)
 
$
17

Unrealized gains/(losses)(a)
43

 
734

 
639

Total direct investments
1,207

 
564

 
656

Third-party fund investments
34

 
137

 
134

Total private equity gains/(losses)(b)
$
1,241

 
$
701

 
$
790

(a)
Includes reversals of unrealized gains and losses that were recognized in prior periods and have now been realized.
(b)
Included in principal transactions revenue in the Consolidated statements of income.
Private equity portfolio information(a)
 
 
December 31, (in millions)
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Publicly held securities
 
 
 
 
 
Carrying value
$
878

 
$
1,035

 
$
578

Cost
583

 
672

 
350

Quoted public value
893

 
1,077

 
578

Privately held direct securities
 
 
 
 
 
Carrying value
4,555

 
5,065

 
5,379

Cost
5,275

 
6,022

 
6,584

Third-party fund investments(b)
 
 
 
 
 
Carrying value
433

 
1,768

 
2,117

Cost
423

 
1,797

 
1,963

Total private equity portfolio
 
 
 
 
 
Carrying value
$
5,866

 
$
7,868

 
$
8,074

Cost
6,281

 
8,491

 
8,897

(a)
For more information on the Firm’s methodologies regarding the valuation of the Private Equity portfolio, see Note 3. For information on the sale of a portion of the Private Equity business in January 2015, see Note 2.
(b)
Unfunded commitments to third-party private equity funds were $147 million, $215 million and $370 million at December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
2014 compared with 2013
The carrying value of the private equity portfolio at December 31, 2014 was $5.9 billion, down from $7.9 billion at December 31, 2013. The decrease in the portfolio was predominantly driven by sales of investments, partially offset by unrealized gains.
2013 compared with 2012
The carrying value of the private equity portfolio at December 31, 2013 was $7.9 billion, down from $8.1 billion at December 31, 2012. The decrease in the portfolio was predominantly driven by sales of investments, partially offset by new investments and unrealized gains.


104
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report


ENTERPRISE-WIDE RISK MANAGEMENT
Risk is an inherent part of JPMorgan Chase’s business activities. When the Firm extends a consumer or wholesale loan, advises customers on their investment decisions, makes markets in securities, or conducts any number of other services or activities, the Firm takes on some degree of risk. The Firm’s overall objective in managing risk is to protect the safety and soundness of the Firm, avoid excessive risk taking, and manage and balance risk in a manner that serves the interest of our clients, customers and shareholders.
The Firm’s approach to risk management covers a broad spectrum of risk areas, such as credit, market, liquidity, model, structural interest rate, principal, country, operational, fiduciary and reputation risk.
The Firm believes that effective risk management requires:
Acceptance of responsibility, including identification and escalation of risk issues, by all individuals within the Firm;
Ownership of risk management within each line of business and corporate functions; and
Firmwide structures for risk governance.
 
Firmwide Risk Management is overseen and managed on an enterprise-wide basis. The Firm’s Chief Executive Officer (“CEO”), Chief Financial Officer (“CFO”), Chief Risk Officer (“CRO”) and Chief Operating Officer (“COO”) develop and set the risk management framework and governance structure for the Firm, which is intended to provide comprehensive controls and ongoing management of the major risks inherent in the Firm’s business activities. The Firm’s risk management framework is intended to create a culture of transparency, awareness and personal responsibility through reporting, collaboration, discussion, escalation and sharing of information. The CEO, CFO, CRO and COO are ultimately responsible and accountable to the Firm’s Board of Directors.
The Firm’s risk culture strives for continual improvement through ongoing employee training and development, as well as talent retention. The Firm also approaches its incentive compensation arrangements through an integrated risk, compensation and financial management framework to encourage a culture of risk awareness and personal accountability.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
105

Management’s discussion and analysis

The following sections outline the key risks that are inherent in the Firm’s business activities.
Risk
Definition
Key risk management metrics
Page
references
Capital risk
The risk the Firm has an insufficient level and composition of capital to support the Firm’s business activities and associated risks during normal economic environments and stressed conditions.
Risk-based capital ratios, Supplementary Leverage ratio
146-155
Compliance risk
The risk of fines or sanctions or of financial damage or loss due to the failure to comply with laws, rules, and regulations.
Not Applicable
144
Country risk
The risk that a sovereign event or action alters the value or terms of contractual obligations of obligors, counterparties and issuers or adversely affects markets related to a particular country.
Default exposure at 0% recovery, Stress
137-138
Credit risk
The risk of loss arising from the default of a customer, client or counterparty.
Total exposure; industry, geographic and customer concentrations; risk ratings; delinquencies; loss experience; stress
110-130
Fiduciary risk
The risk of a failure to exercise the applicable high standard of care, to act in the best interests of clients or to treat clients fairly, as required under applicable law or regulation.
Not Applicable
145
Legal risk
The risk of loss or imposition of damages, fines, penalties or other liability arising from failure to comply with a contractual obligation or to comply with laws or regulations to which the Firm is subject.
Not Applicable
144

Liquidity risk
The risk that the Firm will not have the appropriate amount, composition and tenor of funding and liquidity in support of its assets, and that the Firm will be unable to meet its contractual and contingent obligations through normal economic cycles and market stress events.
LCR; Stress
156-160
Market risk
The risk of loss arising from potential adverse changes in the value of the Firm’s assets and liabilities resulting from changes in market variables such as interest rates, foreign exchange rates, equity prices, commodity prices, implied volatilities or credit spreads.
VaR, Stress, Sensitivities
131-136
Model risk
The risk of the potential for adverse consequences from decisions based on incorrect or misused model outputs and reports.
Model Status, Model Tier
139
Non-USD FX risk
The risk arising from capital investments, forecasted expense and revenue, investment securities portfolio or issuing debt in denominations other than the U.S. dollar.
FX Net Open Position (“NOP”)
203, 211-213
Operational risk
The risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed processes or systems or due to external events that are neither market nor credit-related.
Firm-specific loss experience; industry loss experience; business environment and internal control factors (“BEICF”)

140-143
Principal risk
The risk of an adverse change in the value of privately-held financial assets and instruments, typically representing an ownership or junior capital position. These positions have unique risks due to their illiquidity or for which there is less observable market or valuation data.
Carrying Value, Stress
140
Reputation risk
The risk that an action, transaction, investment or event will reduce the trust that clients, shareholders, employees or the broader public has in the Firm’s integrity or competence.
Not Applicable
145
Structural interest rate risk
The risk resulting from the Firm’s traditional banking activities (both on- and off-balance sheet positions) arising from the extension of loans and credit facilities, taking deposits and issuing debt (collectively referred to as “non-trading activities”), and also the impact from the CIO investment securities portfolio and other related CIO, Treasury activities.
Earnings-at-risk
136

Risk organization
The LOBs are responsible for managing the risks inherent in their respective business activities. The Risk organization operates independently from the revenue-generating businesses, providing a credible challenge to them. The CRO is the head of the Risk organization and is responsible for the overall direction of Risk oversight. The CRO is supported by individuals and organizations that align to lines of business and corporate functions, as well as others that align to specific risk types.
 
The Firm’s Risk Management Organization and other Firmwide functions with risk-related responsibilities (i.e., Regulatory Capital Management Office (“RCMO”), Firmwide Oversight and Control Group, Valuation Control Group (“VCG”), Legal and Compliance) provide independent oversight of the monitoring, evaluation and escalation of risk.
Risk governance
The independent stature of the Risk organization is supported by a governance structure that provides for escalation of risk issues up to senior management and the Board of Directors.



106
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report


The chart below illustrates the governance structure and certain senior management level committees and forums that are primarily responsible for key risk-related functions. There are additional committees and forums not represented in the chart that are also responsible for management and oversight of risk.
The Board of Directors provides oversight of risk principally through the Board of Directors’ Risk Policy Committee (“DRPC”), Audit Committee and, with respect to compensation, Compensation & Management Development Committee. Each committee of the Board oversees reputation risk issues within its scope of responsibility.
The Directors’ Risk Policy Committee approves and periodically reviews the primary risk-management policies of the Firm’s global operations and oversees the operation of the Firm’s global risk management framework. The committee’s responsibilities include oversight of management’s exercise of its responsibility to assess and manage: (i) credit risk, market risk, liquidity risk, model risk, structural interest rate risk, principal risk and country risk; (ii) the governance frameworks or policies for operational, fiduciary, reputational risks and the New Business Initiative Approval (“NBIA”) process; and (iii) capital and liquidity planning and analysis. The DRPC
 
reviews the firmwide value-at-risk and market stress tolerances, as well as any other parameter tolerances established by management in accordance with the Firm’s Risk Appetite Policy. It reviews reports of significant issues identified by risk management officers, including reports describing the Firm’s credit risk profile, and information about concentrations and country risks. The Firm’s CRO, LOB CROs, LOB CEOs, heads of risk for Country Risk, Market Risk, Structural Interest Rate Risk, Liquidity Risk, Principal Risk, Wholesale Credit Risk, Consumer Credit Risk, Model Risk, Risk Management Policy, Reputation Risk Governance, Fiduciary Risk Governance, and Operational Risk Governance (all referred to as Firmwide Risk Executives) meet with and provide updates to the DRPC. Additionally, breaches in risk appetite tolerances, liquidity issues that may have a material adverse impact on the Firm and other significant matters as determined by the CRO or Firmwide functions with risk responsibility are escalated to the DRPC.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
107

Management’s discussion and analysis

The Audit Committee has primary responsibility for assisting the Board in its oversight of the system of controls designed to reasonably assure the quality and integrity of the Firm’s financial statements and that are relied upon to provide reasonable assurance of the Firm’s management of operational risk. The Audit Committee also assists the Board in its oversight of legal and compliance risk. Internal Audit, an independent function within the Firm that provides independent and objective assessments of the control environment, reports directly to the Audit Committee and administratively to the CEO. Internal Audit conducts independent reviews to evaluate the Firm’s internal control structure and compliance with applicable regulatory requirements and is responsible for providing the Audit Committee, senior management and regulators with an independent assessment of the Firm’s ability to manage and control risk.
The Compensation & Management Development Committee assists the Board in its oversight of the Firm’s compensation programs and reviews and approves the Firm’s overall compensation philosophy and practices. The Committee reviews the Firm’s compensation practices as they relate to risk and risk management in light of the Firm’s objectives, including its safety and soundness and the avoidance of practices that encourage excessive risk taking. The Committee reviews and approves the terms of compensation award programs, including recovery provisions, vesting periods, and restrictive covenants, taking into account regulatory requirements. The Committee also reviews and approves the Firm’s overall incentive compensation pools and reviews those of each of the Firm’s lines of business and the Corporate segment. The Committee reviews the goals relevant to compensation for the Firm’s Operating Committee, reviews Operating Committee members’ performance against such goals, and approves their compensation awards. The Committee recommends to the full Board’s independent directors, for ratification, the CEO’s compensation. In addition, the Committee periodically reviews the Firm’s management development and succession planning, as well as the Firm’s diversity programs.
Among the Firm’s senior management level committees that are primarily responsible for key risk-related functions are:
The Firmwide Risk Committee (“FRC”) is the Firm’s highest management-level Risk Committee. It provides oversight of the risks inherent in the Firm’s businesses, including credit risk, market risk, liquidity risk, model risk, structural interest rate risk, principal risk and country risk. It also provides oversight of the governance frameworks for operational, fiduciary and reputational risks. The Committee is co-chaired by the Firm’s CEO and CRO. Members of the committee include the Firm’s COO, the Firm’s CFO, LOB CEOs, LOB CROs, General Counsel, and other senior managers from risk and control functions. This committee serves as an escalation point for risk topics and issues raised by its members, the Line of Business Risk Committees, Firmwide Control Committee, Firmwide
 
Fiduciary Risk Committee, Reputation Risk committees and regional Risk Committees. The committee escalates significant issues to the Board of Directors, as appropriate.
The Firmwide Control Committee (“FCC”) is a forum to review and discuss firmwide operational risk, metrics and management, including existing and emerging issues, and execution against the operational risk management framework. The committee is co-chaired by the Firm’s Chief Control Officer and the head of Firmwide Operational Risk Governance/Model Risk and Development. It serves as an escalation point for the line of business, function and regional Control Committees and escalates significant issues to the Firmwide Risk Committee, as appropriate.
The Firmwide Fiduciary Risk Committee (“FFRC”) is a forum for risk matters related to the Firm’s fiduciary activities and oversees the firmwide fiduciary risk governance framework, which supports the consistent identification and escalation of fiduciary risk matters by the relevant lines of business or corporate functions responsible for managing fiduciary activities. The committee escalates significant issues to the Firmwide Risk Committee and any other committee considered appropriate.
The Firmwide Reputation Risk Governance group seeks to promote consistent management of reputational risk across the Firm. Its objectives are to increase visibility of reputation risk governance; promote and maintain a globally consistent governance model for reputation risk across lines of business; promote early self-identification of potential reputation risks to the Firm; and provide thought leadership on cross-line of business reputation risk issues. Each line of business has a separate reputation risk governance structure which includes, in most cases, one or more dedicated reputation risk committees.
Line of business, corporate function, and regional risk and control committees:
Risk committees oversee the inherent risks in the respective line of business, function or region, including the review, assessment and decision making relating to specific risks, risk strategy, policy and controls. These committees escalate issues to the Firmwide Risk Committee, as appropriate.
Control committees oversee the operational risks and control environment of the respective line of business, function or region. These committees escalate operational risk issues to their respective line of business, function or regional Risk committee and also escalate significant risk issues (and/or risk issues with potential firmwide impact) to the Firmwide Control Committee.
The Asset-Liability Committee (“ALCO”), chaired by the Corporate Treasurer under the direction of the COO, monitors the Firm’s overall balance sheet, liquidity risk and interest rate risk. ALCO is responsible for reviewing and approving the Firm’s funds transfer pricing policy (through which lines of business “transfer” interest rate and foreign exchange risk to Treasury). ALCO is responsible for reviewing the Firm’s Liquidity Risk Management and


108
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report


Oversight Policy and contingency funding plan. ALCO also reviews the Firm’s overall structural interest rate risk position, funding requirements and strategy, and the Firm’s securitization programs (and any required liquidity support by the Firm of such programs).
The Capital Governance Committee, chaired by the Head of Regulatory Capital Management Office (under the direction of the Firm’s CFO) is responsible for reviewing the Firm’s Capital Management Policy and the principles underlying capital issuance and distribution alternatives. The Committee is also responsible for governing the capital adequacy assessment process, including overall design, assumptions and risk streams and ensuring that capital stress test programs are designed to adequately capture the idiosyncratic risks across the Firm’s businesses.
Other corporate functions and forums with risk management-related responsibilities include:
The Firmwide Oversight and Control Group is comprised of dedicated control officers within each of the lines of business and corporate functional areas, as well as a central oversight team. The group is charged with enhancing the Firm’s controls by looking within and across the lines of business and corporate functional areas to identify and control issues. The group enables the Firm to detect control problems more quickly, escalate issues promptly and get the right people involved to understand common themes and interdependencies among the various parts of the Firm. The group works closely with the Firm’s other control-related functions, including Compliance, Legal, Internal Audit and Risk Management, to effectively remediate identified control issues across all affected areas of the Firm. As a result, the group facilitates the effective execution of the Firm’s control framework and helps support operational risk management across the Firm.
The Firmwide Valuation Governance Forum (“VGF”) is composed of senior finance and risk executives and is responsible for overseeing the management of risks arising from valuation activities conducted across the Firm. The VGF is chaired by the firmwide head of the Valuation Control function (under the direction of the Firm’s CFO), and also includes sub-forums for the CIB, Consumer & Community Banking, Commercial Banking, Asset Management and certain corporate functions, including Treasury and CIO.
In addition to the committees, forums and groups listed above, the Firm has other management committees and forums at the LOB and regional levels, where risk-related topics are discussed and escalated as necessary. The membership of these committees is composed of senior management of the Firm including representation from the business and various control functions. The committees meet regularly to discuss a broad range of topics.
 
The JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A. Board of Directors is responsible for the oversight of management on behalf of JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A. The JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A. Board accomplishes this function acting directly and through the principal standing committees of the Firm’s Board of Directors. Risk oversight on behalf of JPMorgan Chase Bank N.A. is primarily the responsibility of the Firm’s DRPC, Audit Committee and, with respect to compensation-related matters, the Compensation & Management Development Committee.
Risk appetite
The Firm’s overall risk appetite is established by management taking into consideration the Firm’s capital and liquidity positions, earnings power, and diversified business model. The risk appetite framework is a tool to measure the capacity to take risk and is expressed in loss tolerance parameters at the Firm and/or LOB levels, including net income loss tolerances, liquidity limits and market limits. Performance against these parameters informs management’s strategic decisions and is reported to the DRPC.
The Firm-level risk appetite parameters are set and approved by the Firm’s CEO, CFO, CRO and COO. LOB-level risk appetite parameters are set by the LOB CEO, CFO, and CRO and are approved by the Firm’s functional heads as noted above. Firmwide LOB diversification allows the sum of the LOBs’ loss tolerances to be greater than the Firmwide loss tolerance.
Risk identification for large exposures
The Firm has certain potential low-probability but plausible and material, idiosyncratic risks not well captured by its other existing risk analysis and reporting for credit, market, and other risks. These idiosyncratic risks may arise in a number of forms, e.g. changes in legislation, an unusual combination of market events, or specific counterparty events. These identified risks are grouped under the term Risk Identification for Large Exposures (“RIFLEs”). The identified and monitored RIFLEs allow the Firm to monitor earnings vulnerability that is not adequately covered by its other standard risk measurements.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
109

Management’s discussion and analysis

CREDIT RISK MANAGEMENT
Credit risk is the risk of loss arising from the default of a customer, client or counterparty. The Firm provides credit to a variety of customers, ranging from large corporate and institutional clients to individual consumers and small businesses. In its consumer businesses, the Firm is exposed to credit risk primarily through its residential real estate, credit card, auto, business banking and student lending businesses. Originated mortgage loans are retained in the mortgage portfolio, or securitized or sold to U.S. government agencies and U.S. government-sponsored enterprises; other types of consumer loans are typically retained on the balance sheet. In its wholesale businesses, the Firm is exposed to credit risk through its underwriting, lending and derivatives activities with and for clients and counterparties, as well as through its operating services activities, such as cash management and clearing activities. A portion of the loans originated or acquired by the Firm’s wholesale businesses are generally retained on the balance sheet; the Firm’s syndicated loan business distributes a significant percentage of originations into the market and is an important component of portfolio management.
Credit risk organization
Credit risk management is overseen by the Firm’s CRO. The Firm’s credit risk management governance consists of the following activities:
Establishing a comprehensive credit risk policy framework
Monitoring and managing credit risk across all portfolio segments, including transaction and line approval
Assigning and managing credit authorities in connection with the approval of all credit exposure
Managing criticized exposures and delinquent loans
Determining the allowance for credit losses and ensuring appropriate credit risk-based capital management
Risk identification and measurement
The Credit Risk Management function identifies, measures, limits, manages and monitors credit risk across our businesses. To measure credit risk, the Firm employs several methodologies for estimating the likelihood of obligor or counterparty default. Methodologies for measuring credit risk vary depending on several factors, including type of asset (e.g., consumer versus wholesale), risk measurement parameters (e.g., delinquency status and borrower’s credit score versus wholesale risk-rating) and risk management and collection processes (e.g., retail collection center versus centrally managed workout groups). Credit risk measurement is based on the probability of default of an obligor or counterparty, the loss severity given a default event and the exposure at default.
Based on these factors and related market-based inputs, the Firm estimates credit losses for its exposures. Probable credit losses inherent in the consumer and wholesale loan portfolios are reflected in the allowance for loan losses, and
 
probable credit losses inherent in lending-related commitments are reflected in the allowance for lending-related commitments. These losses are estimated using statistical analyses and other factors as described in Note 15. In addition, potential and unexpected credit losses are reflected in the allocation of credit risk capital and represent the potential volatility of actual losses relative to the established allowances for loan losses and lending-related commitments. The analyses for these losses include stress testing (considering alternative economic scenarios) as described in the Stress testing section below.
The methodologies used to estimate credit losses depend on the characteristics of the credit exposure, as described below.
Scored exposure
The scored portfolio is generally held in CCB and predominantly includes residential real estate loans, credit card loans, certain auto and business banking loans, and student loans. For the scored portfolio, credit loss estimates are based on statistical analysis of credit losses over discrete periods of time and are estimated using portfolio modeling, credit scoring, and decision-support tools, which consider loan-level factors such as delinquency status, credit scores, collateral values, and other risk factors. Credit loss analyses also consider, as appropriate, uncertainties and other factors, including those related to current macroeconomic and political conditions, the quality of underwriting standards, and other internal and external factors. The factors and analysis are updated on a quarterly basis or more frequently as market conditions dictate.
Risk-rated exposure
Risk-rated portfolios are generally held in CIB, CB and AM, but also include certain business banking and auto dealer loans held in CCB that are risk-rated because they have characteristics similar to commercial loans. For the risk-rated portfolio, credit loss estimates are based on estimates of the probability of default (“PD”) and loss severity given a default. The estimation process begins with risk-ratings that are assigned to each loan facility to differentiate risk within the portfolio. These risk ratings are reviewed regularly by Credit Risk management and revised as needed to reflect the borrower’s current financial position, risk profile and related collateral. The probability of default is the likelihood that a loan will default and not be fully repaid by the borrower. The loss given default (“LGD”) is the estimated loss on the loan that would be realized upon the default of the borrower and takes into consideration collateral and structural support for each credit facility. The probability of default is estimated for each borrower, and a loss given default is estimated for each credit facility. The calculations and assumptions are based on historic experience and management judgment and are reviewed regularly.



110
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Stress testing
Stress testing is important in measuring and managing credit risk in the Firm’s credit portfolio. The process assesses the potential impact of alternative economic and business scenarios on estimated credit losses for the Firm. Economic scenarios, and the parameters underlying those scenarios, are defined centrally, are articulated in terms of macroeconomic factors, and applied across the businesses. The stress test results may indicate credit migration, changes in delinquency trends and potential losses in the credit portfolio. In addition to the periodic stress testing processes, management also considers additional stresses outside these scenarios, as necessary. The Firm uses stress testing to inform decisions on setting risk appetite both at a Firm and LOB level, as well as to assess the impact of stress on industry concentrations.
Risk monitoring and management
The Firm has developed policies and practices that are designed to preserve the independence and integrity of the approval and decision-making process of extending credit to ensure credit risks are assessed accurately, approved properly, monitored regularly and managed actively at both the transaction and portfolio levels. The policy framework establishes credit approval authorities, concentration limits, risk-rating methodologies, portfolio review parameters and guidelines for management of distressed exposures. In addition, certain models, assumptions and inputs used in evaluating and monitoring credit risk are independently validated by groups that are separate from the line of businesses.
For consumer credit risk, delinquency and other trends, including any concentrations at the portfolio level, are monitored, as certain of these trends can be modified through changes in underwriting policies and portfolio guidelines. Consumer Risk Management evaluates delinquency and other trends against business expectations, current and forecasted economic conditions, and industry benchmarks. Historical and forecasted trends are incorporated into the modeling of estimated consumer credit losses and are part of the monitoring of the credit risk profile of the portfolio. Under the Firm’s model risk policy, new significant risk management models, as well as major changes to such models, are required to be reviewed and approved by the Model Review Group prior to implementation into the operating environment. Internal Audit also periodically tests the internal controls around the modeling process including the integrity of the data utilized. For a discussion of the Model Review Group, see page 139. For further discussion of consumer loans, see Note 14.
 
Wholesale credit risk is monitored regularly at an aggregate portfolio, industry and individual client and counterparty level with established concentration limits that are reviewed and revised as deemed appropriate by management, typically on an annual basis. Industry and counterparty limits, as measured in terms of exposure and economic credit risk capital, are subject to stress-based loss constraints.
Management of the Firm’s wholesale credit risk exposure is accomplished through a number of means, including:
Loan underwriting and credit approval process
Loan syndications and participations
Loan sales and securitizations
Credit derivatives
Master netting agreements
Collateral and other risk-reduction techniques
In addition to Risk Management, Internal Audit performs periodic exams, as well as continuous review, where appropriate, of the Firm’s consumer and wholesale portfolios. For risk-rated portfolios, a credit review group within Internal Audit is responsible for:
Independently assessing and validating the changing risk grades assigned to exposures; and
Evaluating the effectiveness of business units’ risk-ratings, including the accuracy and consistency of risk grades, the timeliness of risk grade changes and the justification of risk grades in credit memoranda
Risk reporting
To enable monitoring of credit risk and effective decision-making, aggregate credit exposure, credit quality forecasts, concentration levels and risk profile changes are reported regularly to senior Credit Risk Management. Detailed portfolio reporting of industry, customer, product and geographic concentrations occurs monthly, and the appropriateness of the allowance for credit losses is reviewed by senior management at least on a quarterly basis. Through the risk reporting and governance structure, credit risk trends and limit exceptions are provided regularly to, and discussed with, senior management and the Board of Directors as appropriate.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
111

Management’s discussion and analysis

CREDIT PORTFOLIO
2014 Credit Risk Overview
In 2014, the consumer credit environment continued to improve and the wholesale credit environment remained favorable. Over the course of the year, the Firm continued to actively manage its underperforming and nonaccrual loans and reduce such exposures through loan restructurings, loan sales and workouts. The Firm saw decreased downgrade, default and charge-off activity and improved consumer delinquency trends. The Firm increased its overall lending activity in both wholesale and consumer businesses. The combination of these factors resulted in an improvement in the credit quality of the portfolio compared with 2013 and contributed to the Firm’s reduction in the allowance for credit losses. For further discussion of the consumer credit environment and consumer loans, see Consumer Credit Portfolio on pages 113–119 and Note 14. For further discussion of wholesale credit environment and wholesale loans, see Wholesale Credit Portfolio on pages 120–127 and Note 14.
In the following tables, reported loans include loans retained (i.e., held-for-investment); loans held-for-sale (which are carried at the lower of cost or fair value, with valuation changes recorded in noninterest revenue); and certain loans accounted for at fair value. In addition, the Firm records certain loans accounted for at fair value in trading assets. For further information regarding these loans, see Note 3 and Note 4. For additional information on the Firm’s loans and derivative receivables, including the Firm’s accounting policies, see Note 14 and Note 6.
For further information regarding the credit risk inherent in the Firm’s investment securities portfolio, see Note 12.
 
Total credit portfolio
 
 
 
 
December 31,
(in millions)
Credit exposure
 
Nonperforming(b)(c)(d)
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
Loans retained
$
747,508

$
724,177

 
$
7,017

$
8,317

Loans held-for-sale
7,217

12,230

 
95

26

Loans at fair value
2,611

2,011

 
21

197

Total loans – reported
757,336

738,418

 
7,133

8,540

Derivative receivables
78,975

65,759

 
275

415

Receivables from customers and other
29,080

26,883

 


Total credit-related assets
865,391

831,060

 
7,408

8,955

Assets acquired in loan satisfactions
 
 
 
 
 
Real estate owned
NA

NA

 
515

710

Other
NA

NA

 
44

41

Total assets acquired in loan satisfactions
NA

NA

 
559

751

Total assets
865,391

831,060

 
7,967

9,706

Lending-related commitments
1,056,172

1,031,672

 
103

206

Total credit portfolio
$
1,921,563

$
1,862,732

 
$
8,070

$
9,912

Credit Portfolio Management derivatives notional, net(a)
$
(26,703
)
$
(27,996
)
 
$

$
(5
)
Liquid securities and other cash collateral held against derivatives
(19,604
)
(14,435
)
 
NA

NA

Year ended December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
 
2014
2013
Net charge-offs
 
$
4,759

$
5,802

Average retained loans
 
 
 
Loans – reported
 
729,876

720,152

Loans – reported, excluding
  residential real estate PCI loans
 
679,869

663,629

Net charge-off rates
 
 
 
Loans – reported
 
0.65
%
0.81
%
Loans – reported, excluding PCI
 
0.70

0.87

(a)
Represents the net notional amount of protection purchased and sold through credit derivatives used to manage both performing and nonperforming wholesale credit exposures; these derivatives do not qualify for hedge accounting under U.S. GAAP. For additional information, see Credit derivatives on page 127 and Note 6.
(b)
Excludes PCI loans. The Firm is recognizing interest income on each pool of PCI loans as they are all performing.
(c)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, nonperforming assets excluded: (1) mortgage loans insured by U.S. government agencies of $7.8 billion and $8.4 billion, respectively, that are 90 or more days past due; (2) student loans insured by U.S. government agencies under the FFELP of $367 million and $428 million, respectively, that are 90 or more days past due; and (3) real estate owned (“REO”) insured by U.S. government agencies of $462 million and $2.0 billion, respectively. These amounts have been excluded based upon the government guarantee. In addition, the Firm’s policy is generally to exempt credit card loans from being placed on nonaccrual status as permitted by regulatory guidance issued by the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council (“FFIEC”).
(d)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, total nonaccrual loans represented 0.94% and 1.16%, respectively, of total loans.


112
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



CONSUMER CREDIT PORTFOLIO
The Firm’s consumer portfolio consists primarily of residential real estate loans, credit card loans, auto loans, business banking loans, and student loans. The Firm’s focus is on serving the prime segment of the consumer credit market. For further information on consumer loans, see
Note 14.
The credit performance of the consumer portfolio continues to benefit from the improvement in the economy and home prices. Both early-stage delinquencies (30–89 days delinquent) and late-stage delinquencies (150+ days delinquent) for residential real estate, excluding government
 
guaranteed loans, declined from December 31, 2013. Although late-stage delinquencies declined, they remain elevated due to loss-mitigation activities and to elongated foreclosure processing timelines. Losses related to these loans continue to be recognized in accordance with the Firm’s standard charge-off practices, but some delinquent loans that would otherwise have been foreclosed upon remain in the mortgage and home equity loan portfolios.
The Credit Card 30+ day delinquency rate remains near historic lows.


The following table presents consumer credit-related information with respect to the credit portfolio held by CCB, prime mortgage and home equity loans held by AM, and prime mortgage loans held by Corporate. For further information about the Firm’s nonaccrual and charge-off accounting policies, see Note 14.
Consumer credit portfolio
As of or for the year ended December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
Credit exposure
 
Nonaccrual loans(f)(g)
 
Net charge-offs/(recoveries)(h)
 
Average annual net charge-off/(recovery) rate(h)(i)
2014
 
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
Consumer, excluding credit card
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans, excluding PCI loans and loans held-for-sale
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Home equity – senior lien
$
16,367

 
$
17,113

 
$
938

$
932

 
$
82

$
132

 
0.50
 %
0.72
%
Home equity – junior lien
36,375

 
40,750

 
1,590

1,876

 
391

834

 
1.03

1.90

Prime mortgage, including option ARMs
104,921

 
87,162

 
2,190

2,666

 
39

59

 
0.04

0.07

Subprime mortgage
5,056

 
7,104

 
1,036

1,390

 
(27
)
90

 
(0.43
)
1.17

Auto(a)
54,536

 
52,757

 
115

161

 
181

158

 
0.34

0.31

Business banking
20,058

 
18,951

 
279

385

 
305

337

 
1.58

1.81

Student and other
10,970

 
11,557

 
270

86

 
347

297

 
3.07

2.51

Total loans, excluding PCI loans and loans held-for-sale
248,283

 
235,394

 
6,418

7,496

 
1,318

1,907

 
0.55

0.82

Loans – PCI
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Home equity
17,095

 
18,927

 
NA

NA

 
NA

NA

 
NA

NA

Prime mortgage
10,220

 
12,038

 
NA

NA

 
NA

NA

 
NA

NA

Subprime mortgage
3,673

 
4,175

 
NA

NA

 
NA

NA

 
NA

NA

Option ARMs
15,708

 
17,915

 
NA

NA

 
NA

NA

 
NA

NA

Total loans – PCI
46,696

 
53,055

 
NA

NA

 
NA

NA

 
NA

NA

Total loans – retained
294,979

 
288,449

 
6,418

7,496

 
1,318

1,907

 
0.46

0.66

Loans held-for-sale
395

(e) 
614

(e) 
91


 


 


Total consumer, excluding credit card loans
295,374

 
289,063

 
6,509

7,496

 
1,318

1,907

 
0.46

0.66

Lending-related commitments(b)
58,153

 
56,057

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Receivables from customers(c)
108

 
139

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total consumer exposure, excluding credit card
353,635

 
345,259

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit Card
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans retained(d)
128,027

 
127,465

 


 
3,429

3,879

 
2.75

3.14

Loans held-for-sale
3,021

 
326

 


 


 


Total credit card loans
131,048

 
127,791

 


 
3,429

3,879

 
2.75

3.14

Lending-related commitments(b)
525,963

 
529,383

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total credit card exposure
657,011

 
657,174

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total consumer credit portfolio
$
1,010,646

 
$
1,002,433

 
$
6,509

$
7,496

 
$
4,747

$
5,786

 
1.15
 %
1.40
%
Memo: Total consumer credit portfolio, excluding PCI
$
963,950

 
$
949,378

 
$
6,509

$
7,496

 
$
4,747

$
5,786

 
1.30
 %
1.62
%
(a)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, excluded operating lease-related assets of $6.7 billion and $5.5 billion, respectively.
(b)
Credit card and home equity lending-related commitments represent the total available lines of credit for these products. The Firm has not experienced, and does not anticipate, that all available lines of credit would be used at the same time. For credit card and home equity commitments (if certain conditions are met), the Firm can reduce or cancel these lines of credit by providing the borrower notice or, in some cases as permitted by law, without notice.
(c)
Receivables from customers represent margin loans to retail brokerage customers, and are included in accrued interest and accounts receivable on the Consolidated balance sheets.

JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
113

Management’s discussion and analysis

(d)
Includes accrued interest and fees net of an allowance for the uncollectible portion of accrued interest and fee income.
(e)
Predominantly represents prime mortgage loans held-for-sale.
(f)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, nonaccrual loans excluded: (1) mortgage loans insured by U.S. government agencies of $7.8 billion and $8.4 billion, respectively, that are 90 or more days past due; and (2) student loans insured by U.S. government agencies under the FFELP of $367 million and $428 million, respectively, that are 90 or more days past due. These amounts have been excluded from nonaccrual loans based upon the government guarantee. In addition, the Firm’s policy is generally to exempt credit card loans from being placed on nonaccrual status as permitted by regulatory guidance.
(g)
Excludes PCI loans. The Firm is recognizing interest income on each pool of PCI loans as they are all performing.
(h)
Net charge-offs and net charge-off rates excluded $533 million and $53 million of write-offs of prime mortgages in the PCI portfolio for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013. These write-offs decreased the allowance for loan losses for PCI loans. See Allowance for Credit Losses on pages 128–130 for further details.
(i)
Average consumer loans held-for-sale were $917 million and $209 million, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013. These amounts were excluded when calculating net charge-off rates.

Consumer, excluding credit card
Portfolio analysis
Consumer loan balances increased during the year ended December 31, 2014, due to prime mortgage, business banking and auto loan originations, partially offset by paydowns and the charge-off or liquidation of delinquent loans. Credit performance has improved across most portfolios but delinquent residential real estate loans and home equity charge-offs remain elevated compared with pre-recessionary levels.
In the following discussion of loan and lending-related categories, PCI loans are excluded from individual loan product discussions and are addressed separately below. For further information about the Firm’s consumer portfolio, including information about delinquencies, loan modifications and other credit quality indicators, see
Note 14.
Home equity: The home equity portfolio declined from December 31, 2013 primarily reflecting loan paydowns and charge-offs. Early-stage delinquencies showed improvement from December 31, 2013. Late-stage delinquencies continue to be elevated as improvement in the number of loans becoming severely delinquent was offset by a higher number of loans remaining in late-stage delinquency due to higher average carrying values on these delinquent loans, reflecting improving collateral values. Senior lien nonaccrual loans were flat compared with the prior year while junior lien nonaccrual loans decreased in 2014. Net charge-offs for both senior and junior lien home equity loans declined when compared with the prior year as a result of improvement in home prices and delinquencies.
Approximately 15% of the Firm’s home equity portfolio consists of home equity loans (“HELOANs”) and the remainder consists of home equity lines of credit (“HELOCs”). HELOANs are generally fixed-rate, closed-end, amortizing loans, with terms ranging from 3–30 years. Approximately half of the HELOANs are senior liens and the remainder are junior liens. In general, HELOCs originated by the Firm are revolving loans for a 10-year period, after which time the HELOC recasts into a loan with a 20-year amortization period. At the time of origination, the borrower typically selects one of two minimum payment options that will generally remain in effect during the revolving period: a monthly payment of 1% of the outstanding balance, or interest-only payments based on a variable index (typically Prime). HELOCs originated by Washington Mutual were generally revolving loans for a 10-year period, after which time the HELOC converts to an
 
interest-only loan with a balloon payment at the end of the loan’s term.
The unpaid principal balance of non-PCI HELOCs outstanding was $47 billion at December 31, 2014. Of the $47 billion, approximately $29 billion have recently recast or are scheduled to recast from interest-only to fully amortizing payments, with $3 billion having recast in 2014; $6 billion, $7 billion, and $6 billion are scheduled to recast in 2015, 2016, and 2017, respectively; and $7 billion is scheduled to recast after 2017. However, of the total $26 billion still remaining to recast, $18 billion are expected to actually recast; and the remaining $8 billion represents loans to borrowers who are expected either to pre-pay or charge-off prior to recast. In the third quarter of 2014, the Firm refined its approach for estimating the number of HELOCs expected to voluntarily pre-pay prior to recast. Based on the refined methodology, the number of loans expected to pre-pay declined, resulting in an increase in the number of loans expected to recast. The Firm has considered this payment recast risk in its allowance for loan losses based upon the estimated amount of payment shock (i.e., the excess of the fully-amortizing payment over the interest-only payment in effect prior to recast) expected to occur at the payment recast date, along with the corresponding estimated probability of default and loss severity assumptions. Certain factors, such as future developments in both unemployment rates and home prices, could have a significant impact on the performance of these loans.
The Firm manages the risk of HELOCs during their revolving period by closing or reducing the undrawn line to the extent permitted by law when borrowers are exhibiting a material deterioration in their credit risk profile. The Firm will continue to evaluate both the near-term and longer-term repricing and recast risks inherent in its HELOC portfolio to ensure that changes in the Firm’s estimate of incurred losses are appropriately considered in the allowance for loan losses and that the Firm’s account management practices are appropriate given the portfolio’s risk profile.
High-risk seconds are loans where the borrower has a first mortgage loan that is either delinquent or has been modified. Such loans are considered to pose a higher risk of default than junior lien loans for which the senior lien is neither delinquent nor modified. At December 31, 2014, the Firm estimated that its home equity portfolio contained approximately $1.8 billion of current high-risk seconds, compared with $2.3 billion at December 31, 2013. The Firm estimates the balance of its total exposure to high-risk seconds on a quarterly basis using internal data and loan


114
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



level credit bureau data (which typically provides the delinquency status of the senior lien). The estimated balance of these high-risk seconds may vary from quarter to quarter for reasons such as the movement of related senior liens into and out of the 30+ day delinquency bucket.
Current high-risk seconds
December 31, (in billions)
2014
 
2013
 
Junior liens subordinate to:
 
 
 
 
Modified current senior lien
$
0.7

 
$
0.9

 
Senior lien 30 – 89 days delinquent
0.5

 
0.6

 
Senior lien 90 days or more delinquent(a)
0.6

 
0.8

 
Total current high-risk seconds
$
1.8

 
$
2.3

 
(a)
Junior liens subordinate to senior liens that are 90 days or more past due are classified as nonaccrual loans. At December 31, 2014 and 2013, excluded approximately $50 million and approximately $100 million, respectively, of junior liens that are performing but not current, which were placed on nonaccrual in accordance with the regulatory guidance.
Of the estimated $1.8 billion of current high-risk seconds at December 31, 2014, the Firm owns approximately 10% and services approximately 25% of the related senior lien loans to the same borrowers. The performance of the Firm’s junior lien loans is generally consistent regardless of whether the Firm owns, services or does not own or service the senior lien. The increased probability of default associated with these higher-risk junior lien loans was considered in estimating the allowance for loan losses.
Mortgage: Prime mortgages, including option adjustable-rate mortgages (“ARMs”) and loans held-for-sale, increased from December 31, 2013 due to higher retained originations partially offset by paydowns, the run-off of option ARM loans and the charge-off or liquidation of delinquent loans. Excluding loans insured by U.S. government agencies, both early-stage and late-stage delinquencies showed improvement from December 31, 2013. Nonaccrual loans decreased from the prior year but remain elevated primarily due to loss mitigation activities and elongated foreclosure processing timelines. Net charge-offs remain low, reflecting continued improvement in home prices and delinquencies.
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm’s prime mortgage portfolio included $12.4 billion and $14.3 billion, respectively, of mortgage loans insured and/or guaranteed by U.S. government agencies, of which $9.7 billion and $9.6 billion, respectively, were 30 days or more past due (of these past due loans, $7.8 billion and $8.4 billion, respectively, were 90 days or more past due). The Firm has entered into a settlement regarding loans insured under federal mortgage insurance programs overseen by the FHA, HUD, and VA; the Firm will continue to monitor exposure on future claim payments for government insured loans, but any financial impact related to exposure on future claims is not expected to be significant and was considered in estimating the allowance for loan losses. For further discussion of the settlement, see Note 31.
 
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm’s prime mortgage portfolio included $16.3 billion and $15.6 billion, respectively, of interest-only loans, which represented 15% and 18%, respectively, of the prime mortgage portfolio. These loans have an interest-only payment period generally followed by an adjustable-rate or fixed-rate fully amortizing payment period to maturity and are typically originated as higher-balance loans to higher-income borrowers. To date, losses on this portfolio generally have been consistent with the broader prime mortgage portfolio and the Firm’s expectations. The Firm continues to monitor the risks associated with these loans.
Subprime mortgages continued to decrease due to portfolio runoff. Early-stage and late-stage delinquencies have improved from December 31, 2013, but remain at elevated levels. Net charge-offs continued to improve as a result of improvement in home prices and delinquencies.
Auto: Auto loans increased from December 31, 2013 as new originations outpaced paydowns and payoffs. Nonaccrual loans improved compared with December 31, 2013. Net charge-offs for the year ended December 31, 2014 increased compared with the prior year, reflecting higher average loss per default as national used car valuations declined from historically strong levels. The auto loan portfolio reflects a high concentration of prime-quality credits.
Business banking: Business banking loans increased from December 31, 2013 due to an increase in loan originations. Nonaccrual loans improved compared with December 31, 2013. Net charge-offs for the year ended December 31, 2014 decreased from the prior year.
Student and other: Student and other loans decreased from December 31, 2013 due primarily to the run-off of the student loan portfolio. Student nonaccrual loans increased from December 31, 2013 due to a modification program began in May 2014 that extended the deferment period for up to 24 months for certain student loans, which resulted in extending the maturity of these loans at their original contractual interest rates.
Purchased credit-impaired loans: PCI loans acquired in the Washington Mutual transaction decreased as the portfolio continues to run off.
As of December 31, 2014, approximately 16% of the option ARM PCI loans were delinquent and approximately 57% of the portfolio has been modified into fixed-rate, fully amortizing loans. Substantially all of the remaining loans are making amortizing payments, although such payments are not necessarily fully amortizing. This latter group of loans is subject to the risk of payment shock due to future payment recast. Default rates generally increase on option ARM loans when payment recast results in a payment increase. The expected increase in default rates is considered in the Firm’s quarterly impairment assessment.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
115

Management’s discussion and analysis

The following table provides a summary of lifetime principal loss estimates included in either the nonaccretable difference or the allowance for loan losses.
Summary of lifetime principal loss estimates
December 31,
(in billions)
Lifetime loss
 estimates(a)
 
LTD liquidation
 losses(b)
 
2014
 
2013
 
2014
 
2013
Home equity
$
14.6

 
$
14.7

 
$
12.4

 
$
12.1

Prime mortgage
3.8

 
3.8

 
3.5

 
3.3

Subprime mortgage
3.3

 
3.3

 
2.8

 
2.6

Option ARMs
9.9

 
10.2

 
9.3

 
8.8

Total
$
31.6

 
$
32.0

 
$
28.0

 
$
26.8

(a)
Includes the original nonaccretable difference established in purchase accounting of $30.5 billion for principal losses plus additional principal losses recognized subsequent to acquisition through the provision and
 
allowance for loan losses. The remaining nonaccretable difference for principal losses was $2.3 billion and $3.8 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
(b)
Life-to-date (“LTD”) liquidation losses represent both realization of loss upon loan resolution and any principal forgiven upon modification.
Lifetime principal loss estimates declined from December 31, 2013, to December 31, 2014, reflecting improvement in home prices and delinquencies. The decline in lifetime principal loss estimates during the year ended December 31, 2014, resulted in a $300 million reduction of the PCI allowance for loan losses related to option ARM loans. In addition, for the year ended December 31, 2014, PCI write-offs of $533 million were recorded against the prime mortgage allowance for loan losses. For further information on the Firm’s PCI loans, including write-offs, see Note 14.


Geographic composition of residential real estate loans
At December 31, 2014, $94.3 billion, or 63% of total retained residential real estate loan portfolio, excluding mortgage loans insured by U.S. government agencies and PCI loans, were concentrated in California, New York, Illinois, Florida and Texas, compared with $85.9 billion, or 62%, at December 31, 2013. California had the greatest concentration of these loans with 26% at December 31, 2014, compared with 25% at December 31, 2013. The unpaid principal balance of PCI loans concentrated in these five states represented 74% of total PCI loans at both December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013. For further information on the geographic composition of the Firm’s residential real estate loans, see Note 14.
Current estimated LTVs of residential real estate loans
The current estimated average loan-to-value (“LTV”) ratio for residential real estate loans retained, excluding mortgage loans insured by U.S. government agencies and PCI loans, was 71% at December 31, 2014, compared with 75% at December 31, 2013.
 
Although home prices continue to recover, the decline in
home prices since 2007 has had a significant impact on the collateral values underlying the Firm’s residential real estate loan portfolio. In general, the delinquency rate for loans with high LTV ratios is greater than the delinquency rate for loans in which the borrower has greater equity in the collateral. While a large portion of the loans with current estimated LTV ratios greater than 100% continue to pay and are current, the continued willingness and ability of these borrowers to pay remains a risk.



116
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The following table presents the current estimated LTV ratios for PCI loans, as well as the ratios of the carrying value of the underlying loans to the current estimated collateral value. Because such loans were initially measured at fair value, the ratios of the carrying value to the current estimated collateral value will be lower than the current estimated LTV ratios, which are based on the unpaid principal balances. The estimated collateral values used to calculate these ratios do not represent actual appraised loan-level collateral values; as such, the resulting ratios are necessarily imprecise and should therefore be viewed as estimates.
LTV ratios and ratios of carrying values to current estimated collateral values – PCI loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
2014
 
2013
December 31,
(in millions,
except ratios)
 
Unpaid principal balance
Current estimated
LTV ratio(a)
Net carrying value(c)
Ratio of net
carrying value
to current estimated
collateral value(c)
 
Unpaid principal
balance
Current estimated
LTV ratio(a)
Net carrying value(c)
Ratio of net
carrying value
to current estimated
collateral value(c)
Home equity
 
$
17,740

83
%
(b) 
$
15,337

72
%
 
$
19,830

90
%
(b) 
$
17,169

78
%
Prime mortgage
 
10,249

76

 
9,027

67

 
11,876

83

 
10,312

72

Subprime mortgage
 
4,652

82

 
3,493

62

 
5,471

91

 
3,995

66

Option ARMs
 
16,496

74

 
15,514

70

 
19,223

82

 
17,421

74

(a)
Represents the aggregate unpaid principal balance of loans divided by the estimated current property value. Current property values are estimated at least quarterly based on home valuation models that utilize nationally recognized home price index valuation estimates; such models incorporate actual data to the extent available and forecasted data where actual data is not available.
(b)
Represents current estimated combined LTV for junior home equity liens, which considers all available lien positions, as well as unused lines, related to the property. All other products are presented without consideration of subordinate liens on the property.
(c)
Net carrying value includes the effect of fair value adjustments that were applied to the consumer PCI portfolio at the date of acquisition and is also net of the allowance for loan losses at December 31, 2014 and 2013 of $1.2 billion and $1.7 billion for prime mortgage, $194 million and $494 million for option ARMs, respectively, and $1.8 billion for home equity and $180 million for subprime mortgage for both periods.
The current estimated average LTV ratios were 77% and 88% for California and Florida PCI loans, respectively, at December 31, 2014, compared with 85% and 103%, respectively, at December 31, 2013. Average LTV ratios have declined consistent with recent improvements in home prices. Although home prices have improved, home prices in most areas of California and Florida are still lower than at the peak of the housing market; this continues to negatively contribute to current estimated average LTV ratios and the ratio of net carrying value to current estimated collateral value for loans in the PCI portfolio. Of the total PCI portfolio, 15% had a current estimated LTV ratio greater than 100%, and 3% had a current LTV ratio of greater than 125% at December 31, 2014, compared with 26% and 7%, respectively, at December 31, 2013.
While the current estimated collateral value is greater than the net carrying value of PCI loans, the ultimate performance of this portfolio is highly dependent on borrowers’ behavior and ongoing ability and willingness to continue to make payments on homes with negative equity, as well as on the cost of alternative housing.
For further information on current estimated LTVs of residential real estate loans, see Note 14.
Loan modification activities – residential real estate loans
The performance of modified loans generally differs by product type due to differences in both the credit quality and the types of modifications provided. Performance metrics for the residential real estate portfolio, excluding PCI loans, that have been modified and seasoned more than six months show weighted-average redefault rates of 20% for senior lien home equity, 22% for junior lien home equity, 16% for prime mortgages including option ARMs, and 29% for subprime mortgages. The cumulative performance metrics for the PCI residential real estate
 
portfolio modified and seasoned more than six months show weighted average redefault rates of 20% for home equity, 17% for prime mortgages, 15% for option ARMs and 32% for subprime mortgages. The favorable performance of the PCI option ARM modifications is the result of a targeted proactive program which fixed the borrower’s payment to the amount at the point of modification. The cumulative redefault rates reflect the performance of modifications completed under both the Home Affordable Modification Program (“HAMP”) and the Firm’s proprietary modification programs (primarily the Firm’s modification program that was modeled after HAMP) from October 1, 2009, through December 31, 2014.
Certain loans that were modified under HAMP and the Firm’s proprietary modification programs have interest rate reset provisions (“step-rate modifications”). Interest rates on these loans will generally increase beginning in 2014 by 1% per year until the rate reaches a specified cap, typically at a prevailing market interest rate for a fixed-rate loan as of the modification date. The carrying value of non-PCI loans modified in step-rate modifications was $5 billion at December 31, 2014, with $1 billion scheduled to experience the initial interest rate increase in each of 2015 and 2016. The unpaid principal balance of PCI loans modified in step-rate modifications was $10 billion at December 31, 2014, with $2 billion and $3 billion scheduled to experience the initial interest rate increase in 2015 and 2016, respectively. The impact of these potential interest rate increases is considered in the Firm’s allowance for loan losses. The Firm will continue to monitor this risk exposure to ensure that it is appropriately considered in the Firm’s allowance for loan losses.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
117

Management’s discussion and analysis

The following table presents information as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, relating to modified retained residential real estate loans for which concessions have been granted to borrowers experiencing financial difficulty. Modifications of PCI loans continue to be accounted for and reported as PCI loans, and the impact of the modification is incorporated into the Firm’s quarterly assessment of estimated future cash flows. Modifications of consumer loans other than PCI loans are generally accounted for and reported as troubled debt restructurings (“TDRs”). For further information on modifications for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, see Note 14.
Modified residential real estate loans
 
2014
 
2013
December 31,
(in millions)
On–balance
sheet loans
Nonaccrual on–balance sheet
 loans(d)
 
On–balance
sheet loans
Nonaccrual on–balance sheet
 loans(d)
Modified residential real estate loans, excluding PCI loans(a)(b)
 
 
 
 
 
Home equity – senior lien
$
1,101

$
628

 
$
1,146

$
641

Home equity –
  junior lien
1,304

632

 
1,319

666

Prime mortgage, including option ARMs
6,145

1,559

 
7,004

1,737

Subprime mortgage
2,878

931

 
3,698

1,127

Total modified residential real estate loans, excluding PCI loans
$
11,428

$
3,750

 
$
13,167

$
4,171

Modified PCI loans(c)
 
 
 
 
 
Home equity
$
2,580

NA

 
$
2,619

NA

Prime mortgage
6,309

NA

 
6,977

NA

Subprime mortgage
3,647

NA

 
4,168

NA

Option ARMs
11,711

NA

 
13,131

NA

Total modified PCI loans
$
24,247

NA

 
$
26,895

NA

(a)
Amounts represent the carrying value of modified residential real estate loans.
(b)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, $4.9 billion and $7.6 billion, respectively, of loans modified subsequent to repurchase from Ginnie Mae in accordance with the standards of the appropriate government agency (i.e., FHA, VA, RHS) are not included in the table above. When such loans perform subsequent to modification in accordance with Ginnie Mae guidelines, they are generally sold back into Ginnie Mae loan pools. Modified loans that do not re-perform become subject to foreclosure. For additional information about sales of loans in securitization transactions with Ginnie Mae, see Note 16.
(c)
Amounts represent the unpaid principal balance of modified PCI loans.
(d)
As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, nonaccrual loans included $2.9 billion and $3.0 billion, respectively, of TDRs for which the borrowers were less than 90 days past due. For additional information about loans modified in a TDR that are on nonaccrual status, see Note 14.
Nonperforming assets
The following table presents information as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, about consumer, excluding credit card, nonperforming assets.
 
Nonperforming assets(a)
 
 
 
December 31, (in millions)
2014
 
2013
Nonaccrual loans(b)
 
 
 
Residential real estate
$
5,845

 
$
6,864

Other consumer
664

 
632

Total nonaccrual loans
6,509

 
7,496

Assets acquired in loan satisfactions
 
 
 
Real estate owned
437

 
614

Other
36

 
41

Total assets acquired in loan satisfactions
473

 
655

Total nonperforming assets
$
6,982

 
$
8,151

(a)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, nonperforming assets excluded: (1) mortgage loans insured by U.S. government agencies of $7.8 billion and $8.4 billion, respectively, that are 90 or more days past due; (2) student loans insured by U.S. government agencies under the FFELP of $367 million and $428 million, respectively, that are 90 or more days past due; and (3) real estate owned insured by U.S. government agencies of $462 million and $2.0 billion, respectively. These amounts have been excluded based upon the government guarantee.
(b)
Excludes PCI loans that were acquired as part of the Washington Mutual transaction, which are accounted for on a pool basis. Since each pool is accounted for as a single asset with a single composite interest rate and an aggregate expectation of cash flows, the past-due status of the pools, or that of individual loans within the pools, is not meaningful. Because the Firm is recognizing interest income on each pool of loans, they are all considered to be performing.
Nonaccrual loans in the residential real estate portfolio totaled $5.8 billion and $6.9 billion at December 31, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, of which 32% and 34%, respectively, were greater than 150 days past due. In the aggregate, the unpaid principal balance of residential real estate loans greater than 150 days past due was charged down by approximately 50% to the estimated net realizable value of the collateral at both December 31, 2014 and 2013. The elongated foreclosure processing timelines are expected to continue to result in elevated levels of nonaccrual loans in the residential real estate portfolios.
Active and suspended foreclosure: For information on loans that were in the process of active or suspended foreclosure, see Note 14.

Nonaccrual loans: The following table presents changes in the consumer, excluding credit card, nonaccrual loans for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013.
Nonaccrual loans
 
 
Year ended December 31,
 
 
 
(in millions)
 
2014
2013
Beginning balance
 
$
7,496

$
9,174

Additions
 
4,905

6,618

Reductions:
 
 
 
Principal payments and other(a)
 
1,859

1,559

Charge-offs
 
1,306

1,869

Returned to performing status
 
2,083

3,793

Foreclosures and other liquidations
 
644

1,075

Total reductions
 
5,892

8,296

Net additions/(reductions)
 
(987
)
(1,678
)
Ending balance
 
$
6,509

$
7,496

(a)
Other reductions includes loan sales.



118
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Credit Card
Total credit card loans increased from December 31, 2013 due to higher new account originations and increased credit card sales volume. The 30+ day delinquency rate decreased to 1.44% at December 31, 2014, from 1.67% at December 31, 2013. For the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, the net charge-off rates were 2.75% and 3.14%, respectively. Charge-offs have improved compared with a year ago as a result of improvement in delinquent loans. The credit card portfolio continues to reflect a well-seasoned, largely rewards-based portfolio that has good U.S. geographic diversification.
 
Loans outstanding in the top five states of California, Texas, New York, Illinois and Florida consisted of $54.9 billion in receivables, or 43% of the retained loan portfolio, at December 31, 2014, compared with $52.7 billion, or 41%, at December 31, 2013. The greatest geographic concentration of credit card retained loans is in California, which represented 14% and 13% of total retained loans at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. For further information on the geographic composition of the Firm’s credit card loans, see Note 14.



Modifications of credit card loans
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm had $2.0 billion and $3.1 billion, respectively, of credit card loans outstanding that have been modified in TDRs. These balances included both credit card loans with modified payment terms and credit card loans that reverted back to their pre-modification payment terms because the cardholder did not comply with the modified payment terms. The decrease in modified credit card loans outstanding from December 31, 2013, was attributable to a reduction in new modifications as well as ongoing payments and charge-offs on previously modified credit card loans.
 
Consistent with the Firm’s policy, all credit card loans typically remain on accrual status until charged-off. However, the Firm establishes an allowance, which is offset against loans and charged to interest income, for the estimated uncollectible portion of accrued interest and fee income.
For additional information about loan modification programs to borrowers, see Note 14.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
119

Management’s discussion and analysis

WHOLESALE CREDIT PORTFOLIO
The Firm’s wholesale businesses are exposed to credit risk through underwriting, lending and trading activities with and for clients and counterparties, as well as through various operating services such as cash management and clearing activities. A portion of the loans originated or acquired by the Firm’s wholesale businesses is generally retained on the balance sheet. The Firm distributes a significant percentage of the loans it originates into the market as part of its syndicated loan business and to manage portfolio concentrations and credit risk.
The wholesale credit environment remained favorable throughout 2014 driving an increase in client activity. Growth in loans retained was driven primarily by activity in Commercial Banking, while growth in lending-related commitments reflected increased activity in both the Corporate & Investment Bank and Commercial Banking.
Discipline in underwriting across all areas of lending continues to remain a key point of focus, consistent with evolving market conditions and the Firm’s risk management activities. The wholesale portfolio is actively managed, in part by conducting ongoing, in-depth reviews of client credit quality and transaction structure, inclusive of collateral where applicable; and of industry, product and client concentrations. During the year, wholesale criticized assets decreased from 2013, including a reduction in nonaccrual loans by 40%.

 
Wholesale credit portfolio
December 31,
Credit exposure
 
Nonperforming(d)
(in millions)
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
Loans retained
$
324,502

$
308,263

 
$
599

$
821

Loans held-for-sale
3,801

11,290

 
4

26

Loans at fair value
2,611

2,011

 
21

197

Loans – reported
330,914

321,564

 
624

1,044

Derivative receivables
78,975

65,759

 
275

415

Receivables from customers and other(a)
28,972

26,744

 


Total wholesale credit-related assets
438,861

414,067

 
899

1,459

Lending-related commitments(b)
472,056

446,232

 
103

206

Total wholesale credit exposure
$
910,917

$
860,299

 
$
1,002

$
1,665

Credit Portfolio Management derivatives notional, net(c)
$
(26,703
)
$
(27,996
)
 
$

$
(5
)
Liquid securities and other cash collateral held against derivatives
(19,604
)
(14,435
)
 
NA

NA

(a)
Receivables from customers and other include $28.8 billion and $26.5 billion of margin loans at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, to prime and retail brokerage customers; these are classified in accrued interest and accounts receivable on the Consolidated balance sheets.
(b)
Includes unused advised lines of credit of $105.2 billion and $102.0 billion as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. An advised line of credit is a revolving credit line which specifies the maximum amount the Firm may make available to an obligor, on a nonbinding basis. The borrower receives written or oral advice of this facility. The Firm may cancel this facility at any time by providing the borrower notice or, in some cases, without notice as permitted by law.
(c)
Represents the net notional amount of protection purchased and sold through credit derivatives used to manage both performing and nonperforming wholesale credit exposures; these derivatives do not qualify for hedge accounting under U.S. GAAP. For additional information, see Credit derivatives on page 127, and Note 6.
(d)
Excludes assets acquired in loan satisfactions.


120
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The following tables present the maturity and ratings profiles of the wholesale credit portfolio as of December 31, 2014 and 2013. The ratings scale is based on the Firm’s internal risk ratings, which generally correspond to the ratings as defined by S&P and Moody’s.
Wholesale credit exposure – maturity and ratings profile
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Maturity profile(e)
 
Ratings profile
December 31, 2014
Due in 1 year or less
Due after 1 year through 5 years
Due after 5 years
Total
 
Investment-grade
 
Noninvestment-grade
 
Total
Total %
of IG
(in millions, except ratios)
 
AAA/Aaa to BBB-/Baa3
 
BB+/Ba1 & below
 
Loans retained
$
112,411

$
134,277

$
77,814

$
324,502

 
$
241,666

 
$
82,836

 
$
324,502

74
%
Derivative receivables
 
 
 
78,975

 
 
 
 
 
78,975

 
Less: Liquid securities and other cash collateral held against derivatives
 
 
 
(19,604
)
 
 
 
 
 
(19,604
)
 
Total derivative receivables, net of all collateral
20,032

16,130

23,209

59,371

 
52,150

 
7,221

 
59,371

88

Lending-related commitments
185,451

276,793

9,812

472,056

 
379,214

 
92,842

 
472,056

80

Subtotal
317,894

427,200

110,835

855,929

 
673,030

 
182,899

 
855,929

79

Loans held-for-sale and loans at fair value(a)
 
 
 
6,412

 
 
 
 
 
6,412

 
Receivables from customers and other
 
 
 
28,972

 
 
 
 
 
28,972

 
Total exposure – net of liquid securities and other cash collateral held against derivatives
 
 
 
$
891,313

 
 
 
 
 
$
891,313

 
Credit Portfolio Management derivatives net
 notional by reference entity ratings profile(b)(c)(d)
$
(2,050
)
$
(18,653
)
$
(6,000
)
$
(26,703
)
 
$
(23,571
)
 
$
(3,132
)
 
$
(26,703
)
88
%

 
Maturity profile(e)
 
Ratings profile
December 31, 2013
Due in 1 year or less
Due after 1 year through 5 years
Due after 5 years
Total
 
Investment-grade
 
Noninvestment-grade
 
Total
Total %
of IG
(in millions, except ratios)
 
AAA/Aaa to BBB-/Baa3
 
BB+/Ba1 & below
 
Loans retained
$
108,392

$
124,111

$
75,760

$
308,263

 
$
226,070

 
$
82,193

 
$
308,263

73
%
Derivative receivables
 
 
 
65,759

 
 
 
 
 
65,759

 
Less: Liquid securities and other cash collateral held against derivatives
 
 
 
(14,435
)
 
 
 
 
 
(14,435
)
 
Total derivative receivables, net of all collateral
13,550

15,935

21,839

51,324

 
41,104

(f) 
10,220

(f) 
51,324

80

Lending-related commitments
179,301

255,426

11,505

446,232

 
353,974

 
92,258

 
446,232

79

Subtotal
301,243

395,472

109,104

805,819

 
621,148

 
184,671

 
805,819

77

Loans held-for-sale and loans at fair value(a)
 
 
 
13,301

 
 
 
 
 
13,301

 
Receivables from customers and other
 
 
 
26,744

 
 
 
 
 
26,744

 
Total exposure – net of liquid securities and other cash collateral held against derivatives
 
 
 
$
845,864

 
 
 
 
 
$
845,864

 
Credit Portfolio Management derivatives net
 notional by reference entity ratings profile(b)(c)(d)
$
(1,149
)
$
(19,516
)
$
(7,331
)
$
(27,996
)
 
$
(24,649
)
 
$
(3,347
)
 
$
(27,996
)
88
%
(a)
Represents loans held-for-sale, primarily related to syndicated loans and loans transferred from the retained portfolio, and loans at fair value.
(b)
These derivatives do not quality for hedge accounting under U.S. GAAP.
(c)
The notional amounts are presented on a net basis by underlying reference entity and the ratings profile shown is based on the ratings of the reference entity on which protection has been purchased.
(d)
Predominantly all of the credit derivatives entered into by the Firm where it has purchased protection, including Credit Portfolio Management derivatives, are executed with investment grade counterparties.
(e)
The maturity profile of retained loans, lending-related commitments and derivative receivables is based on remaining contractual maturity. Derivative contracts that are in a receivable position at December 31, 2014, may become a payable prior to maturity based on their cash flow profile or changes in market conditions.
(f)
The prior period amounts have been revised to conform with the current period presentation.

Wholesale credit exposure – selected industry exposures
The Firm focuses on the management and diversification of its industry exposures, paying particular attention to industries with actual or potential credit concerns. Exposures deemed criticized align with the U.S. banking regulators’ definition of criticized exposures, which consist of the special mention, substandard and doubtful categories. The total criticized component of the portfolio, excluding loans held-for-sale and loans at fair value, decreased by 16% to $10.2 billion at December 31, 2014, from $12.2 billion at December 31, 2013.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
121

Management’s discussion and analysis

Below are summaries of the top 25 industry exposures as of December 31, 2014 and 2013. For additional information on industry concentrations, see Note 5.
 
 
 
 
 
 
Selected metrics
 
 
 
 
 
 
30 days or more past due and accruing
loans
Net charge-offs/
(recoveries)
Credit derivative hedges(e)
Liquid securities
and other cash collateral held against derivative
receivables
 
 
 
Noninvestment-grade
 
Credit
exposure(d)
Investment-
grade
Noncriticized
Criticized performing
Criticized
nonperforming
As of or for the year ended December 31, 2014
(in millions)
Top 25 industries(a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real Estate
$
107,386

$
80,219

$
25,558

$
1,356

$
253

$
309

$
(9
)
$
(36
)
$
(27
)
Banks & Finance Cos
68,203

58,360

9,266

508

69

46

(4
)
(1,232
)
(9,369
)
Healthcare
57,707

49,361

7,816

488

42

193

17

(94
)
(244
)
Oil & Gas
48,315

33,547

14,685

82

1

15

2

(144
)
(161
)
Consumer Products
37,818

26,070

11,081

650

17

21


(20
)
(2
)
Asset Managers
36,374

31,880

4,436

57

1

38

(12
)
(9
)
(4,545
)
State & Municipal Govt(b)
31,858

30,919

837

102


69

24

(148
)
(130
)
Retail & Consumer Services
28,258

18,233

9,023

971

31

56

4

(47
)
(1
)
Utilities
28,060

24,058

3,747

255


198

(3
)
(155
)
(193
)
Central Govt
21,081

20,868

155

58




(11,297
)
(1,071
)
Technology
20,977

13,759

6,557

641

20

24

(3
)
(225
)

Machinery & Equipment Mfg
20,573

12,094

8,229

250


5

(2
)
(157
)
(19
)
Transportation
16,365

11,444

4,835

86


5

(3
)
(34
)
(107
)
Business Services
16,201

8,450

7,512

224

15

10

5

(9
)

Metals/Mining
15,911

8,845

6,562

504



18

(377
)
(19
)
Media
14,534

9,131

5,107

266

30

1

(1
)
(69
)
(6
)
Building Materials/Construction
13,672

6,721

6,271

674

6

12

2

(104
)

Insurance
13,637

10,790

2,605

80

162



(52
)
(2,372
)
Automotive
13,586

8,647

4,778

161


1

(1
)
(140
)

Chemicals/Plastics
13,545

9,800

3,716

29


1

(2
)
(14
)

Telecom Services
13,136

8,277

4,303

546

10


(2
)
(813
)
(6
)
Securities Firms & Exchanges
8,936

6,198

2,726

10

2

20

4

(102
)
(216
)
Agriculture/Paper Mfg
7,242

4,890

2,224

122

6

36

(1
)
(4
)
(4
)
Aerospace/Defense
6,070

5,088

958

24




(71
)

Leisure
5,562

2,937

2,023

478

124

6


(5
)
(23
)
All other(c)
210,526

190,135

19,581

622

188

1,235

(21
)
(11,345
)
(1,089
)
Subtotal
$
875,533

$
690,721

$
174,591

$
9,244

$
977

$
2,301

$
12

$
(26,703
)
$
(19,604
)
Loans held-for-sale and loans at fair value
6,412

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Receivables from customers and other
28,972

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total
$
910,917

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

122
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report





 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Selected metrics
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
30 days or more past due and accruing
loans
Net charge-offs/
(recoveries)
Credit derivative hedges(e)
Liquid securities
and other cash collateral held against derivative
receivables
 
 
 
 
Noninvestment-grade
 
Credit
exposure(d)
Investment-
grade
 
Noncriticized
 
Criticized performing
Criticized
nonperforming
As of or for the year ended
December 31, 2013
(in millions)
Top 25 industries(a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real Estate
$
87,102

$
62,964

 
$
21,505

 
$
2,286

$
347

$
178

$
6

$
(66
)
$
(125
)
Banks & Finance Cos
66,881

56,675

 
9,707

 
431

68

14

(22
)
(2,692
)
(6,227
)
Healthcare
45,910

37,635

 
7,952

 
317

6

49

3

(198
)
(195
)
Oil & Gas
46,934

34,708

 
11,779

 
436

11

34

13

(227
)
(67
)
Consumer Products
34,145

21,100

 
12,505

 
537

3

4

11

(149
)
(1
)
Asset Managers
33,506

26,991

 
6,477

 
38


217

(7
)
(5
)
(3,191
)
State & Municipal Govt(b)
35,666

34,563

 
826

 
157

120

40

1

(161
)
(144
)
Retail & Consumer Services
25,068

16,101

 
8,453

 
492

22

6


(91
)

Utilities
28,983

25,521

 
3,045

 
411

6

2

28

(445
)
(306
)
Central Govt
21,049

20,633

 
345

 
71




(10,088
)
(1,541
)
Technology
21,403

13,787

 
6,771

 
825

20



(512
)

Machinery & Equipment Mfg
19,078

11,154

 
7,549

 
368

7

20

(18
)
(257
)
(8
)
Transportation
13,975

9,683

 
4,165

 
100

27

10

8

(68
)

Business Services
14,601

7,838

 
6,447

 
286

30

9

10

(10
)
(2
)
Metals/Mining
17,434

9,266

 
7,508

 
594

66

1

16

(621
)
(36
)
Media
13,858

7,783

 
5,658

 
315

102

6

36

(26
)
(5
)
Building Materials/Construction
12,901

5,701

 
6,354

 
839

7

15

3

(132
)

Insurance
13,761

10,681

 
2,757

 
84

239


(2
)
(98
)
(1,935
)
Automotive
12,532

7,881

 
4,490

 
159

2

3

(3
)
(472
)

Chemicals/Plastics
10,637

7,189

 
3,211

 
222

15



(13
)
(83
)
Telecom Services
13,906

9,130

 
4,284

 
482

10


7

(272
)
(8
)
Securities Firms & Exchanges
10,035

4,208

(f) 
5,806

(f) 
14

7

1

(68
)
(4,169
)
(175
)
Agriculture/Paper Mfg
7,387

4,238

 
3,064

 
82

3

31


(4
)
(4
)
Aerospace/Defense
6,873

5,447

 
1,426

 




(142
)
(1
)
Leisure
5,331

2,950

 
1,797

 
495

89

5


(10
)
(14
)
All other(c)
201,298

180,460

 
19,911

 
692

235

1,249

(6
)
(7,068
)
(367
)
Subtotal
$
820,254

$
634,287

 
$
173,792

 
$
10,733

$
1,442

$
1,894

$
16

$
(27,996
)
$
(14,435
)
Loans held-for-sale and loans at fair value
13,301

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Receivables from customers and other
26,744

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total
$
860,299

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(a)
The industry rankings presented in the table as of December 31, 2013, are based on the industry rankings of the corresponding exposures at December 31, 2014, not actual rankings of such exposures at December 31, 2013.
(b)
In addition to the credit risk exposure to states and municipal governments (both U.S. and non-U.S.) at December 31, 2014 and 2013, noted above, the Firm held: $10.6 billion and $7.9 billion, respectively, of trading securities; $30.1 billion and $29.5 billion, respectively, of AFS securities; and $10.2 billion and $920 million, respectively, of HTM securities, issued by U.S. state and municipal governments. For further information, see Note 3 and Note 12.
(c)
All other includes: individuals, private education and civic organizations; SPEs; and holding companies, representing approximately 68%, 21% and 5%, respectively, at December 31, 2014, and 64%, 22% and 5%, respectively, at December 31, 2013.
(d)
Credit exposure is net of risk participations and excludes the benefit of “Credit Portfolio Management derivatives net notional” held against derivative receivables or loans and “Liquid securities and other cash collateral held against derivative receivables”.
(e)
Represents the net notional amounts of protection purchased and sold through credit derivatives used to manage the credit exposures; these derivatives do not qualify for hedge accounting under U.S. GAAP. The all other category includes purchased credit protection on certain credit indices.
(f)
The prior period amounts have been revised to conform with the current period presentation.

JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
123

Management’s discussion and analysis

Presented below is a discussion of several industries to which the Firm has significant exposure and/or present actual or potential credit concerns. The Firm is actively monitoring these exposures. For additional information, refer to the tables on the previous pages.
Real Estate: Exposure to this industry increased by $20.3 billion or 23%, in 2014 to $107.4 billion. The increase was largely driven by growth in multifamily exposure in the CB. The credit quality of this industry improved as the investment-grade portion of the exposures to this industry increased to 75% in 2014 from 72% in 2013. The ratio of nonaccrual retained loans to total retained loans decreased to 0.32% at December 31, 2014 from 0.50% at December 31, 2013. For further information on commercial real estate loans, see Note 14.
Oil & Gas: Exposure to this industry increased by $1.4 billion in 2014 to $48.3 billion, of which $15.6 billion was drawn at year-end. The portfolio largely consisted of exposure in North America, and was concentrated in the Exploration and Production subsector. The Oil & Gas portfolio was comprised of 69% investment-grade exposure, and was approximately 5% of the Firm’s total wholesale credit exposure as of December 31, 2014.

Loans
In the normal course of its wholesale business, the Firm provides loans to a variety of customers, ranging from large corporate and institutional clients to high-net-worth individuals. For further discussion on loans, including information on credit quality indicators, see Note 14.
The Firm actively manages its wholesale credit exposure. One way of managing credit risk is through secondary market sales of loans and lending-related commitments. During the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm sold $22.8 billion and $16.3 billion, respectively, of loans and lending-related commitments.
 
The following table presents the change in the nonaccrual loan portfolio for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013.
Wholesale nonaccrual loan activity
 
 
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
 
2014
2013
Beginning balance
 
$
1,044

$
1,717

Additions
 
882

1,293

Reductions:
 
 
 
Paydowns and other
 
756

1,075

Gross charge-offs
 
148

241

Returned to performing status
 
303

279

Sales
 
95

371

Total reductions
 
1,302

1,966

Net reductions
 
(420
)
(673
)
Ending balance
 
$
624

$
1,044


The following table presents net charge-offs, which are defined as gross charge-offs less recoveries, for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013. The amounts in the table below do not include gains or losses from sales of nonaccrual loans.
Wholesale net charge-offs
Year ended December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
2014
2013
Loans – reported
 
 
Average loans retained
$
316,060

$
307,340

Gross charge-offs
151

241

Gross recoveries
(139
)
(225
)
Net charge-offs
12

16

Net charge-off rate
%
0.01
%

Receivables from customers
Receivables from customers primarily represent margin loans to prime and retail brokerage clients that are collateralized through a pledge of assets maintained in clients’ brokerage accounts that are subject to daily minimum collateral requirements. In the event that the collateral value decreases, a maintenance margin call is made to the client to provide additional collateral into the account. If additional collateral is not provided by the client, the client’s position may be liquidated by the Firm to meet the minimum collateral requirements.


124
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Lending-related commitments
The Firm uses lending-related financial instruments, such as commitments (including revolving credit facilities) and guarantees, to meet the financing needs of its customers. The contractual amounts of these financial instruments represent the maximum possible credit risk should the counterparties draw down on these commitments or the Firm fulfills its obligations under these guarantees, and the counterparties subsequently fail to perform according to the terms of these contracts.
In the Firm’s view, the total contractual amount of these wholesale lending-related commitments is not representative of the Firm’s actual future credit exposure or funding requirements. In determining the amount of credit risk exposure the Firm has to wholesale lending-related commitments, which is used as the basis for allocating credit risk capital to these commitments, the Firm has established a “loan-equivalent” amount for each commitment; this amount represents the portion of the unused commitment or other contingent exposure that is expected, based on average portfolio historical experience, to become drawn upon in an event of a default by an obligor. The loan-equivalent amount of the Firm’s lending-related commitments was $229.6 billion and $218.9 billion as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
Clearing services
The Firm provides clearing services for clients entering into securities and derivative transactions. Through the provision of these services the Firm is exposed to the risk of non-performance by its clients and may be required to share in losses incurred by central counterparties (“CCPs”). Where possible, the Firm seeks to mitigate its credit risk to its clients through the collection of adequate margin at inception and throughout the life of the transactions and can also cease provision of clearing services if clients do not adhere to their obligations under the clearing agreement. For further discussion of Clearing services, see Note 29.
Derivative contracts
In the normal course of business, the Firm uses derivative instruments predominantly for market-making activities. Derivatives enable customers to manage exposures to fluctuations in interest rates, currencies and other markets. The Firm also uses derivative instruments to manage its own credit exposure. The nature of the counterparty and the settlement mechanism of the derivative affect the credit risk to which the Firm is exposed. For OTC derivatives the Firm is exposed to the credit risk of the derivative counterparty. For exchange-traded derivatives (“ETD”) such as futures and options, and “cleared” over-the-counter (“OTC-cleared”) derivatives, the Firm is generally exposed to the credit risk of the relevant CCP. Where possible, the Firm seeks to mitigate its credit risk exposures arising from derivative transactions through the use of legally enforceable master netting arrangements and collateral agreements. For further discussion of derivative contracts, counterparties and settlement types, see Note 6.
 
The following table summarizes the net derivative receivables for the periods presented.
Derivative receivables
 
 
December 31, (in millions)
2014
2013
Interest rate
$
33,725

$
25,782

Credit derivatives
1,838

1,516

Foreign exchange
21,253

16,790

Equity
8,177

12,227

Commodity
13,982

9,444

Total, net of cash collateral
78,975

65,759

Liquid securities and other cash collateral held against derivative receivables
(19,604
)
(14,435
)
Total, net of all collateral
$
59,371

$
51,324

Derivative receivables reported on the Consolidated balance sheets were $79.0 billion and $65.8 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. These amounts represent the fair value of the derivative contracts, after giving effect to legally enforceable master netting agreements and cash collateral held by the Firm. However, in management’s view, the appropriate measure of current credit risk should also take into consideration additional liquid securities (primarily U.S. government and agency securities and other G7 government bonds) and other cash collateral held by the Firm aggregating $19.6 billion and $14.4 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, that may be used as security when the fair value of the client’s exposure is in the Firm’s favor.
In addition to the collateral described in the preceding paragraph, the Firm also holds additional collateral (primarily: cash; G7 government securities; other liquid government-agency and guaranteed securities; and corporate debt and equity securities) delivered by clients at the initiation of transactions, as well as collateral related to contracts that have a non-daily call frequency and collateral that the Firm has agreed to return but has not yet settled as of the reporting date. Although this collateral does not reduce the balances and is not included in the table above, it is available as security against potential exposure that could arise should the fair value of the client’s derivative transactions move in the Firm’s favor. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm held $48.6 billion and $50.8 billion, respectively, of this additional collateral. The prior period amount has been revised to conform with the current period presentation. The derivative receivables fair value, net of all collateral, also does not include other credit enhancements, such as letters of credit. For additional information on the Firm’s use of collateral agreements, see Note 6.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
125

Management’s discussion and analysis

While useful as a current view of credit exposure, the net fair value of the derivative receivables does not capture the potential future variability of that credit exposure. To capture the potential future variability of credit exposure, the Firm calculates, on a client-by-client basis, three measures of potential derivatives-related credit loss: Peak, Derivative Risk Equivalent (“DRE”), and Average exposure (“AVG”). These measures all incorporate netting and collateral benefits, where applicable.
Peak exposure to a counterparty is an extreme measure of exposure calculated at a 97.5% confidence level. DRE exposure is a measure that expresses the risk of derivative exposure on a basis intended to be equivalent to the risk of loan exposures. The measurement is done by equating the unexpected loss in a derivative counterparty exposure (which takes into consideration both the loss volatility and the credit rating of the counterparty) with the unexpected loss in a loan exposure (which takes into consideration only the credit rating of the counterparty). DRE is a less extreme measure of potential credit loss than Peak and is the primary measure used by the Firm for credit approval of derivative transactions.
Finally, AVG is a measure of the expected fair value of the Firm’s derivative receivables at future time periods, including the benefit of collateral. AVG exposure over the total life of the derivative contract is used as the primary metric for pricing purposes and is used to calculate credit capital and the CVA, as further described below. The three year AVG exposure was $37.5 billion and $35.4 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, compared with derivative receivables, net of all collateral, of $59.4 billion and $51.3 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
 
The fair value of the Firm’s derivative receivables incorporates an adjustment, the CVA, to reflect the credit quality of counterparties. The CVA is based on the Firm’s AVG to a counterparty and the counterparty’s credit spread in the credit derivatives market. The primary components of changes in CVA are credit spreads, new deal activity or unwinds, and changes in the underlying market environment. The Firm believes that active risk management is essential to controlling the dynamic credit risk in the derivatives portfolio. In addition, the Firm’s risk management process takes into consideration the potential impact of wrong-way risk, which is broadly defined as the potential for increased correlation between the Firm’s exposure to a counterparty (AVG) and the counterparty’s credit quality. Many factors may influence the nature and magnitude of these correlations over time. To the extent that these correlations are identified, the Firm may adjust the CVA associated with that counterparty’s AVG. The Firm risk manages exposure to changes in CVA by entering into credit derivative transactions, as well as interest rate, foreign exchange, equity and commodity derivative transactions.
The accompanying graph shows exposure profiles to the Firm’s current derivatives portfolio over the next 10 years as calculated by the DRE and AVG metrics. The two measures generally show that exposure will decline after the first year, if no new trades are added to the portfolio.

The following table summarizes the ratings profile by derivative counterparty of the Firm’s derivative receivables, including credit derivatives, net of other liquid securities collateral, for the dates indicated. The ratings scale is based on the Firm’s internal ratings, which generally correspond to the ratings as defined by S&P and Moody’s.
Ratings profile of derivative receivables
 
 
 
 
 
Rating equivalent
2014
 
2013(a)
December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
Exposure net of all collateral
% of exposure net of all collateral
 
Exposure net of all collateral
% of exposure net of all collateral
AAA/Aaa to AA-/Aa3
$
19,202

32
%
 
$
12,953

25
%
A+/A1 to A-/A3
13,940

24

 
12,930

25

BBB+/Baa1 to BBB-/Baa3
19,008

32

 
15,220

30

BB+/Ba1 to B-/B3
6,384

11

 
6,806

13

CCC+/Caa1 and below
837

1

 
3,415

7

Total
$
59,371

100
%
 
$
51,324

100
%
(a) The prior period amounts have been revised to conform with the current period presentation.

126
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



As noted above, the Firm uses collateral agreements to mitigate counterparty credit risk. The percentage of the Firm’s derivatives transactions subject to collateral agreements – excluding foreign exchange spot trades, which are not typically covered by collateral agreements due to their short maturity – was 88% as of December 31, 2014, largely unchanged compared with 86% as of December 31, 2013.
Credit derivatives
The Firm uses credit derivatives for two primary purposes: first, in its capacity as a market-maker; and second, as an end-user, to manage the Firm’s own credit risk associated with various exposures. For a detailed description of credit derivatives, see Credit derivatives in Note 6.
Credit portfolio management activities
Included in the Firm’s end-user activities are credit derivatives used to mitigate the credit risk associated with traditional lending activities (loans and unfunded commitments) and derivatives counterparty exposure in the Firm’s wholesale businesses (collectively, “credit portfolio management” activities). Information on credit portfolio management activities is provided in the table below. For further information on derivatives used in credit portfolio management activities, see Credit derivatives in Note 6.
The Firm also uses credit derivatives as an end-user to manage other exposures, including credit risk arising from certain securities held in the Firm’s market-making businesses. These credit derivatives are not included in credit portfolio management activities; for further information on these credit derivatives as well as credit derivatives used in the Firm’s capacity as a market maker in credit derivatives, see Credit derivatives in Note 6.
 
Credit derivatives used in credit portfolio management activities
 
Notional amount of protection
purchased and sold (a)
December 31, (in millions)
2014
 
2013
Credit derivatives used to manage:
 
 
 
Loans and lending-related commitments
$
2,047

 
$
2,764

Derivative receivables
24,656

 
25,328

Total net protection purchased
26,703

 
28,092

Total net protection sold

 
96

Credit portfolio management derivatives notional, net
$
26,703

 
$
27,996

(a)
Amounts are presented net, considering the Firm’s net protection purchased or sold with respect to each underlying reference entity or index.

The credit derivatives used in credit portfolio management activities do not qualify for hedge accounting under U.S. GAAP; these derivatives are reported at fair value, with gains and losses recognized in principal transactions revenue. In contrast, the loans and lending-related commitments being risk-managed are accounted for on an accrual basis. This asymmetry in accounting treatment, between loans and lending-related commitments and the credit derivatives used in credit portfolio management activities, causes earnings volatility that is not representative, in the Firm’s view, of the true changes in value of the Firm’s overall credit exposure.
The effectiveness of the Firm’s credit default swap (“CDS”) protection as a hedge of the Firm’s exposures may vary depending on a number of factors, including the named reference entity (i.e., the Firm may experience losses on specific exposures that are different than the named reference entities in the purchased CDS); the contractual terms of the CDS (which may have a defined credit event that does not align with an actual loss realized by the Firm); and the maturity of the Firm’s CDS protection (which in some cases may be shorter than the Firm’s exposures). However, the Firm generally seeks to purchase credit protection with a maturity date that is the same or similar to the maturity date of the exposure for which the protection was purchased, and remaining differences in maturity are actively monitored and managed by the Firm.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
127

Management’s discussion and analysis

ALLOWANCE FOR CREDIT LOSSES
JPMorgan Chase’s allowance for loan losses covers both the consumer (primarily scored) portfolio and wholesale (risk-rated) portfolio. The allowance represents management’s estimate of probable credit losses inherent in the Firm’s loan portfolio. Management also determines an allowance for wholesale and certain consumer lending-related commitments.
The allowance for loan losses includes an asset-specific component, a formula-based component, and a component related to PCI loans. For a further discussion of the components of the allowance for credit losses and related management judgments, see Critical Accounting Estimates Used by the Firm on pages 161–165 and Note 15.
At least quarterly, the allowance for credit losses is reviewed by the Chief Risk Officer, the Chief Financial Officer and the Controller of the Firm, and discussed with the DRPC and Audit Committees of the Board of Directors of the Firm. As of December 31, 2014, JPMorgan Chase deemed the allowance for credit losses to be appropriate and sufficient to absorb probable credit losses inherent in the portfolio.
The allowance for credit losses was $14.8 billion at December 31, 2014, a decrease of $2.2 billion from $17.0 billion at December 31, 2013.
 
The consumer, excluding credit card, allowance for loan losses reflected a reduction from December 31, 2013, primarily due to the continued improvement in home prices and delinquencies in the residential real estate portfolio and the run-off of the student loan portfolio. For additional information about delinquencies and nonaccrual loans in the consumer, excluding credit card, loan portfolio, see Consumer Credit Portfolio on pages 113–119 and Note 14.
The credit card allowance for loan losses reflected a reduction from December 31, 2013, primarily related to a decrease in the asset-specific allowance resulting from increased granularity of the impairment estimates and lower balances related to credit card loans modified in TDRs. For additional information about delinquencies in the credit card loan portfolio, see Consumer Credit Portfolio on pages 113–119 and Note 14.
The wholesale allowance for credit losses decreased from December 31, 2013, reflecting a continued favorable credit environment as evidenced by low charge-off rates, and declining nonaccrual balances and other portfolio activity.


128
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Summary of changes in the allowance for credit losses
 
 
 
 
 
 
2014
 
2013
Year ended December 31,
Consumer, excluding
credit card
Credit card
Wholesale
Total
 
Consumer, excluding
credit card
Credit card
Wholesale
Total
(in millions, except ratios)
Allowance for loan losses
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Beginning balance at January 1,
$
8,456

$
3,795

$
4,013

$
16,264

 
$
12,292

$
5,501

$
4,143

$
21,936

Gross charge-offs
2,132

3,831

151

6,114

 
2,754

4,472

241

7,467

Gross recoveries
(814
)
(402
)
(139
)
(1,355
)
 
(847
)
(593
)
(225
)
(1,665
)
Net charge-offs
1,318

3,429

12

4,759

 
1,907

3,879

16

5,802

Write-offs of PCI loans(a)
533



533

 
53



53

Provision for loan losses
414

3,079

(269
)
3,224

 
(1,872
)
2,179

(119
)
188

Other
31

(6
)
(36
)
(11
)
 
(4
)
(6
)
5

(5
)
Ending balance at December 31,
$
7,050

$
3,439

$
3,696

$
14,185

 
$
8,456

$
3,795

$
4,013

$
16,264

Impairment methodology
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Asset-specific(b)
$
539

$
500

$
87

$
1,126

 
$
601

$
971

$
181

$
1,753

Formula-based
3,186

2,939

3,609

9,734

 
3,697

2,824

3,832

10,353

PCI
3,325



3,325

 
4,158



4,158

Total allowance for loan losses
$
7,050

$
3,439

$
3,696

$
14,185

 
$
8,456

$
3,795

$
4,013

$
16,264

Allowance for lending-related commitments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Beginning balance at January 1,
$
8

$

$
697

$
705

 
$
7

$

$
661

$
668

Provision for lending-related commitments
5


(90
)
(85
)
 
1


36

37

Other


2

2

 




Ending balance at December 31,
$
13

$

$
609

$
622

 
$
8

$

$
697

$
705

Impairment methodology
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Asset-specific
$

$

$
60

$
60

 
$

$

$
60

$
60

Formula-based
13


549

562

 
8


637

645

Total allowance for lending-related commitments(c)
$
13

$

$
609

$
622

 
$
8

$

$
697

$
705

Total allowance for credit losses
$
7,063

$
3,439

$
4,305

$
14,807

 
$
8,464

$
3,795

$
4,710

$
16,969

Memo:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Retained loans, end of period
$
294,979

$
128,027

$
324,502

$
747,508

 
$
288,449

$
127,465

$
308,263

$
724,177

Retained loans, average
289,212

124,604

316,060

729,876

 
289,294

123,518

307,340

720,152

PCI loans, end of period
46,696


4

46,700

 
53,055


6

53,061

Credit ratios
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses to retained loans
2.39
%
2.69
%
1.14
%
1.90
%
 
2.93
%
2.98
%
1.30
%
2.25
%
Allowance for loan losses to retained nonaccrual loans(d)
110

NM
617

202

 
113

NM
489

196

Allowance for loan losses to retained nonaccrual loans excluding credit card
110

NM
617

153

 
113

NM
489

150

Net charge-off rates
0.46

2.75


0.65

 
0.66

3.14

0.01

0.81

Credit ratios, excluding residential real estate PCI loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses to
retained loans
1.50

2.69

1.14

1.55

 
1.83

2.98

1.30

1.80

Allowance for loan losses to
retained nonaccrual loans
(d)
58

NM
617

155

 
57

NM
489

146

Allowance for loan losses to
retained nonaccrual loans excluding credit card
58

NM
617

106

 
57

NM
489

100

Net charge-off rates
0.55
%
2.75
%
%
0.70
%
 
0.82
%
3.14
%
0.01
%
0.87
%
Note:
In the table above, the financial measures which exclude the impact of PCI loans are non-GAAP financial measures. For additional information, see Explanation and Reconciliation of the Firm’s Use of Non-GAAP Financial Measures on pages 77–78.
(a)
Write-offs of PCI loans are recorded against the allowance for loan losses when actual losses for a pool exceed estimated losses that were recorded as purchase accounting adjustments at the time of acquisition. A write-off of a PCI loan is recognized when the underlying loan is removed from a pool (e.g., upon liquidation). During the fourth quarter of 2014, the Firm recorded a $291 million adjustment to reduce the PCI allowance and the recorded investment in the Firm’s PCI loan portfolio, primarily reflecting the cumulative effect of interest forgiveness modifications. This adjustment had no impact to the Firm’s Consolidated statements of income.
(b)
Includes risk-rated loans that have been placed on nonaccrual status and loans that have been modified in a TDR.
(c)
The allowance for lending-related commitments is reported in other liabilities on the Consolidated balance sheets.
(d)
The Firm’s policy is generally to exempt credit card loans from being placed on nonaccrual status as permitted by regulatory guidance.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
129

Management’s discussion and analysis

Provision for credit losses
For the year ended December 31, 2014, the provision for credit losses was $3.1 billion, compared with $225 million for the year ended December 31, 2013.
The increase in consumer, excluding credit card, provision for credit losses for the year ended December 31, 2014 reflected a $904 million reduction in the allowance for loan losses, as noted above in the Allowance for Credit Losses discussion, which was lower than the $3.8 billion reduction in the prior year. The lower allowance reduction was partially offset by lower net charge-offs in 2014.
The increase in credit card provision for credit losses for the year ended December 31, 2014 reflected a $350 million
 
reduction in the allowance for loan losses, as noted above in the Allowance for Credit Losses discussion, which was lower than the $1.7 billion reduction in the prior year. The lower allowance reduction was partially offset by lower net charge-offs in 2014.
The wholesale provision for credit losses for the year ended December 31, 2014 reflected a continued favorable credit environment as evidenced by low charge-off rates, and declining nonaccrual balances and other portfolio activity.
For further information on the provision for credit losses, see the Consolidated Results of Operations on pages 68–71.


Year ended December 31,
 
Provision for loan losses
 
Provision for
lending-related commitments
 
Total provision for credit losses
(in millions)
 
2014

2013

2012
 
2014

2013

2012

 
2014

2013

2012

Consumer, excluding credit card
 
$
414

$
(1,872
)
$
302

 
$
5

$
1

$

 
$
419

$
(1,871
)
$
302

Credit card
 
3,079

2,179

3,444

 



 
3,079

2,179

3,444

Total consumer
 
3,493

307

3,746

 
5

1


 
3,498

308

3,746

Wholesale
 
(269
)
(119
)
(359
)
 
(90
)
36

(2
)
 
(359
)
(83
)
(361
)
Total
 
$
3,224

$
188

$
3,387

 
$
(85
)
$
37

$
(2
)
 
$
3,139

$
225

$
3,385



130
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



MARKET RISK MANAGEMENT
Market risk is the potential for adverse changes in the value of the Firm’s assets and liabilities resulting from changes in market variables such as interest rates, foreign exchange rates, equity prices, commodity prices, implied volatilities or credit spreads.
Market risk management
Market Risk is an independent risk management function that identifies and monitors market risks throughout the Firm and defines market risk policies and procedures. The Market Risk function reports to the Firm’s CRO.
Market Risk seeks to control risk, facilitate efficient risk/return decisions, reduce volatility in operating performance and provide transparency into the Firm’s market risk profile for senior management, the Board of Directors and regulators. Market Risk is responsible for the following functions:
Establishment of a market risk policy framework
Independent measurement, monitoring and control of line of business and firmwide market risk
Definition, approval and monitoring of limits
Performance of stress testing and qualitative risk assessments
Risk identification and classification
Each line of business is responsible for the management of the market risks within its units. The independent risk management group responsible for overseeing each line of business is charged with ensuring that all material market risks are appropriately identified, measured, monitored and managed in accordance with the risk policy framework set out by Market Risk.
Risk measurement
Tools used to measure risk
Because no single measure can reflect all aspects of market risk, the Firm uses various metrics, both statistical and nonstatistical, including:
VaR
Economic-value stress testing
Nonstatistical risk measures
Loss advisories
Profit and loss drawdowns
Earnings-at-risk
 
Risk monitoring and control
Market risk is controlled primarily through a series of limits set in the context of the market environment and business strategy. In setting limits, the Firm takes into consideration factors such as market volatility, product liquidity and accommodation of client business and management experience. The Firm maintains different levels of limits. Corporate level limits include VaR and stress limits. Similarly, line of business limits include VaR and stress limits and may be supplemented by loss advisories, nonstatistical measurements and profit and loss drawdowns. Limits may also be set within the lines of business, as well at the portfolio or legal entity level.
Limits are set by Market Risk and are regularly reviewed and updated as appropriate, with any changes approved by lines of business management and Market Risk. Senior management, including the Firm’s CEO and CRO, are responsible for reviewing and approving certain of these risk limits on an ongoing basis. All limits that have not been reviewed within specified time periods by Market Risk are escalated to senior management. The lines of business are responsible for adhering to established limits against which exposures are monitored and reported.
Limit breaches are required to be reported in a timely manner by Risk Management to limit approvers, Market Risk and senior management. In the event of a breach, Market Risk consults with Firm senior management and lines of business senior management to determine the appropriate course of action required to return to compliance, which may include a reduction in risk in order to remedy the breach. Certain Firm or line of business-level limits that have been breached for three business days or longer, or by more than 30%, are escalated to senior management and the Firmwide Risk Committee.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
131

Management’s discussion and analysis

The following table summarizes by LOB the predominant business activities that give rise to market risk, and the market risk management tools utilized to manage those risks; CB is not presented in the table below as it does not give rise to significant market risk.
 
Risk identification and classification for business activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
LOB
Predominant business activities and related market risks
Positions included in Risk Management VaR
Positions included in other risk measures (Not included in Risk Management VaR)
 
CIB
• Makes markets and services clients across fixed income, foreign exchange, equities and commodities
• Market risk arising from a potential decline in net income as a result of changes in market prices; e.g. rates and credit spreads
• Market risk(a) related to:
• Trading assets/liabilities - debt and equity instruments, and derivatives, including hedges of the retained loan portfolio and CVA
• Certain securities purchased under resale agreements and securities borrowed
• Certain securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements
• Structured notes
• Derivative CVA
• Principal investing activities
• Retained loan portfolio
• Deposits
• DVA and FVA on derivatives and structured notes
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CCB
• Originates and services mortgage loans
• Complex, non-linear interest rate and basis risk
• Non-linear risk arises primarily from prepayment options embedded in mortgages and changes in the probability of newly originated mortgage commitments actually closing
• Basis risk results from differences in the relative movements of the rate indices underlying mortgage exposure and other interest rates
Mortgage Banking
• Mortgage pipeline loans, classified as derivatives
• Warehouse loans, classified as trading assets - debt instruments
• MSRs
• Hedges of the MSRs and loans, classified as derivatives
• Interest-only securities, classified as trading assets and related hedges classified as derivatives
• Retained loan portfolio
• Deposits
 
 
 
 
 
 
Corporate
• Manages the Firm’s liquidity, funding, structural interest rate and foreign exchange risks arising from activities undertaken by the Firm’s four major reportable business segments
Treasury and CIO
• Primarily derivative positions measured at fair value through earnings, classified as derivatives
• Private equity and other related investments
• Investment securities portfolio and related hedges
• Deposits
• Long-term debt and related hedges
 
 
 
 
 
 
AM
• Market risk arising from the Firm’s initial capital investments in products, such as mutual funds, managed by AM
• Initial seed capital investments and related hedges classified as derivatives
• Capital invested alongside third-party investors, typically in privately distributed collective vehicles managed by AM (i.e., co-Investments)
• Retained loan portfolio
• Deposits
(a)
Market risk for derivatives is generally measured after consideration of DVA and FVA on those positions; market risk for structured notes is generally measured without consideration to such adjustments.

132
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Value-at-risk
JPMorgan Chase utilizes VaR, a statistical risk measure, to estimate the potential loss from adverse market moves in a normal market environment. The Firm has a single overarching VaR model framework used for calculating Risk Management VaR and Regulatory VaR.
The framework is employed across the Firm using historical simulation based on data for the previous 12 months. The framework’s approach assumes that historical changes in market values are representative of the distribution of potential outcomes in the immediate future. The Firm believes the use of Risk Management VaR provides a stable measure of VaR that closely aligns to the day-to-day risk management decisions made by the lines of business and provides necessary/appropriate information to respond to risk events on a daily basis.
Risk Management VaR is calculated assuming a one-day holding period and an expected tail-loss methodology which approximates a 95% confidence level. This means that, assuming current changes in market values are consistent with the historical changes used in the simulation, the Firm would expect to incur VaR “band breaks,” defined as losses greater than that predicted by VaR estimates, not more than five times every 100 trading days. The number of VaR band breaks observed can differ from the statistically expected number of band breaks if the current level of market volatility is materially different from the level of market volatility during the twelve months of historical data used in the VaR calculation.
Underlying the overall VaR model framework are individual VaR models that simulate historical market returns for individual products and/or risk factors. To capture material market risks as part of the Firm’s risk management framework, comprehensive VaR model calculations are performed daily for businesses whose activities give rise to market risk. These VaR models are granular and incorporate numerous risk factors and inputs to simulate daily changes in market values over the historical period; inputs are selected based on the risk profile of each portfolio as sensitivities and historical time series used to generate daily market values may be different across product types or risk management systems. The VaR model results across all portfolios are aggregated at the Firm level.
Data sources used in VaR models may be the same as those used for financial statement valuations. However, in cases where market prices are not observable, or where proxies are used in VaR historical time series, the sources may differ. In addition, the daily market data used in VaR models may be different than the independent third-party data collected for VCG price testing in their monthly valuation process (see Valuation process in Note 3 for further information on the Firm’s valuation process). VaR model calculations require daily data and a consistent source for valuation and therefore it is not practical to use the data collected in the VCG monthly valuation process.
 
VaR provides a consistent framework to measure risk profiles and levels of diversification across product types and is used for aggregating risks across businesses and monitoring limits. These VaR results are reported to senior management, the Board of Directors and regulators.
Since VaR is based on historical data, it is an imperfect measure of market risk exposure and potential losses, and it is not used to estimate the impact of stressed market conditions or to manage any impact from potential stress events. In addition, based on their reliance on available historical data, limited time horizons, and other factors, VaR measures are inherently limited in their ability to measure certain risks and to predict losses, particularly those associated with market illiquidity and sudden or severe shifts in market conditions. The Firm therefore considers other measures in addition to VaR, such as stress testing, to capture and manage its market risk positions.
In addition, for certain products, specific risk parameters are not captured in VaR due to the lack of inherent liquidity and availability of appropriate historical data. The Firm uses proxies to estimate the VaR for these and other products when daily time series are not available. It is likely that using an actual price-based time series for these products, if available, would affect the VaR results presented.
The Firm uses alternative methods to capture and measure those risk parameters that are not otherwise captured in VaR, including economic-value stress testing and nonstatistical measures as described further below.
The Firm’s VaR model calculations are periodically evaluated and enhanced in response to changes in the composition of the Firm’s portfolios, changes in market conditions, improvements in the Firm’s modeling techniques and other factors. Such changes will also affect historical comparisons of VaR results. Model changes go through a review and approval process by the Model Review Group prior to implementation into the operating environment. For further information, see Model risk on page 139.
Separately, the Firm calculates a daily aggregated VaR in accordance with regulatory rules (“Regulatory VaR”), which is used to derive the Firm’s regulatory VaR-based capital requirements under Basel III. This Regulatory VaR model framework currently assumes a ten business-day holding period and an expected tail loss methodology which approximates a 99% confidence level. Regulatory VaR is applied to “covered” positions as defined by Basel III, which may be different than the positions included in the Firm’s Risk Management VaR. For example, credit derivative hedges of accrual loans are included in the Firm’s Risk Management VaR, while Regulatory VaR excludes these credit derivative hedges. In addition, in contrast to the Firm’s Risk Management VaR, Regulatory VaR currently excludes the diversification benefit for certain VaR models.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
133

Management’s discussion and analysis

For additional information on Regulatory VaR and the other components of market risk regulatory capital (e.g. VaR-based measure, stressed VaR-based measure and the respective backtesting) for the Firm, see JPMorgan Chase’s
 
Basel III Pillar 3 Regulatory Capital Disclosures reports, which are available on the Firm’s website (http://investor.shareholder.com/jpmorganchase/basel.cfm).

The table below shows the results of the Firm’s Risk Management VaR measure using a 95% confidence level.
Total VaR
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
As of or for the year ended December 31,
2014
 
2013
 
At December 31,
(in millions)
 Avg.
Min
Max
 
 Avg.
Min
Max
 
2014
2013
CIB trading VaR by risk type
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed income
$
34

 
$
23

 
$
45

 
 
$
43

 
$
23

 
$
62

 
 
$
34

 
$
36

 
Foreign exchange
8

 
4

 
25

 
 
7

 
5

 
11

 
 
8

 
9

 
Equities
15

 
10

 
23

 
 
13

 
9

 
21

 
 
22

 
14

 
Commodities and other
8

 
5

 
14

 
 
14

 
11

 
18

 
 
6

 
13

 
Diversification benefit to CIB trading VaR
(30
)
(a) 
NM

(b) 
NM

(b) 
 
(34
)
(a) 
NM

(b) 
NM

(b) 
 
(32
)
(a) 
(36
)
(a) 
CIB trading VaR
35

 
24

 
49

 
 
43

 
21

 
66

 
 
38

 
36

 
Credit portfolio VaR
13

 
8

 
18

 
 
13

 
10

 
18

 
 
16

 
11

 
Diversification benefit to CIB VaR
(8
)
(a) 
NM

(b) 
NM

(b) 
 
(9
)
(a) 
NM

(b) 
NM

(b) 
 
(9
)
(a) 
(5
)
(a) 
CIB VaR
40

 
29

 
56

 
 
47

 
25

 
74

 
 
45

 
42

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage Banking VaR
7

 
2

 
28

 
 
12

 
4

 
24

 
 
3

 
5

 
Treasury and CIO VaR (c)
4

 
3

 
6

 
 
6

 
3

 
14

 
 
4

 
4

 
Asset Management VaR
3

 
2

 
4

 
 
4

 
2

 
5

 
 
2

 
3

 
Diversification benefit to other VaR
(4
)
(a) 
NM

(b) 
NM

(b) 
 
(8
)
(a) 
NM

(b) 
NM

(b) 
 
(3
)
(a) 
(5
)
(a) 
Other VaR
10

 
5

 
27

 
 
14

 
6

 
28

 
 
6

 
7

 
Diversification benefit to CIB and other VaR
(7
)
(a) 
NM

(b) 
NM

(b) 
 
(9
)
(a) 
NM

(b) 
NM

(b) 
 
(5
)
(a) 
(5
)
(a) 
Total VaR
$
43

 
$
30

 
$
70

 
 
$
52

 
$
29

 
$
87

 
 
$
46

 
$
44

 
(a)
Average portfolio VaR and period-end portfolio VaR were less than the sum of the VaR of the components described above, which is due to portfolio diversification. The diversification effect reflects the fact that risks are not perfectly correlated.
(b)
Designated as not meaningful (“NM”), because the minimum and maximum may occur on different days for distinct risk components, and hence it is not meaningful to compute a portfolio-diversification effect.
(c)
The Treasury and CIO VaR includes Treasury VaR as of the third quarter of 2013.

As presented in the table above, average Total VaR and average CIB VaR decreased during 2014, compared with 2013. The decrease in Total VaR was primarily due to risk reduction in CIB and Mortgage Banking as well as lower volatility in the historical one-year look-back period during 2014 versus 2013.
Average CIB trading VaR decreased during 2014 primarily due to lower VaR in Fixed Income (driven by unwinding of risk and redemptions in the synthetic credit portfolio, and lower volatility in the historical one-year look-back period) and to reduced risk positions in commodities.
Average Mortgage Banking VaR decreased during 2014 as a result of reduced exposures due to lower loan originations.
Average Treasury and CIO VaR decreased during 2014, compared with 2013. The decrease predominantly reflected the unwind and roll-off of certain marked to market positions, and lower market volatility in the historical one-year look-back period.
 
The Firm’s average Total VaR diversification benefit was $7 million or 16% of the sum for 2014, compared with $9 million or 17% of the sum for 2013. In general, over the course of the year, VaR exposure can vary significantly as positions change, market volatility fluctuates and diversification benefits change.
VaR back-testing
The Firm evaluates the effectiveness of its VaR methodology by back-testing, which compares the daily Risk Management VaR results with the daily gains and losses recognized on market-risk related revenue.
The Firm’s definition of market risk-related gains and losses is consistent with the definition used by the banking regulators under Basel III. Under this definition market risk-related gains and losses are defined as: profits and losses on the Firm’s Risk Management positions, excluding fees, commissions, certain valuation adjustments (e.g., liquidity and DVA), net interest income, and gains and losses arising from intraday trading.


134
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The following chart compares the daily market risk-related gains and losses on the Firm’s Risk Management positions for the year ended December 31, 2014. As the chart presents market risk-related gains and losses related to those positions included in the Firm’s Risk Management VaR, the results in the table below differ from the results of backtesting disclosed in the Market Risk section of the
 
Firm’s Basel III Pillar 3 Regulatory Capital Disclosures reports, which are based on Regulatory VaR applied to covered positions. The chart shows that for the year ended December 31, 2014, the Firm observed five VaR band breaks and posted gains on 157 of the 260 days in this period.


Other risk measures
Economic-value stress testing
Along with VaR, stress testing is an important tool in measuring and controlling risk. While VaR reflects the risk of loss due to adverse changes in markets using recent historical market behavior as an indicator of losses, stress testing is intended to capture the Firm’s exposure to unlikely but plausible events in abnormal markets. The Firm runs weekly stress tests on market-related risks across the lines of business using multiple scenarios that assume significant changes in risk factors such as credit spreads, equity prices, interest rates, currency rates or commodity prices. The framework uses a grid-based approach, which calculates multiple magnitudes of stress for both market rallies and market sell-offs for each risk factor. Stress-test results, trends and explanations based on current market risk positions are reported to the Firm’s senior management and to the lines of business to allow them to better understand the sensitivity of positions to certain defined events and to enable them to manage their risks with more transparency.
 

Stress scenarios are defined and reviewed by Market Risk, and significant changes are reviewed by the relevant Risk Committees. While most of the scenarios estimate losses based on significant market moves, such as an equity market collapse or credit crisis, the Firm also develops scenarios to quantify risk arising from specific portfolios or concentrations of risks, which attempt to capture certain idiosyncratic market movements. Scenarios may be redefined on an ongoing basis to reflect current market conditions. Ad hoc scenarios are run in response to specific market events or concerns. The Firm’s stress testing framework is utilized in calculating results under scenarios mandated by the Federal Reserve’s CCAR and ICAAP (“Internal Capital Adequacy Assessment Process”) processes.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
135

Management’s discussion and analysis

Nonstatistical risk measures
Nonstatistical risk measures include sensitivities to variables used to value positions, such as credit spread sensitivities, interest rate basis point values and market values. These measures provide granular information on the Firm’s market risk exposure. They are aggregated by line-of-business and by risk type, and are used for tactical control and monitoring limits.
Loss advisories and profit and loss drawdowns
Loss advisories and profit and loss drawdowns are tools used to highlight trading losses above certain levels of risk tolerance. Profit and loss drawdowns are defined as the decline in net profit and loss since the year-to-date peak revenue level.
Earnings-at-risk
The VaR and stress-test measures described above illustrate the total economic sensitivity of the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets to changes in market variables. The effect of interest rate exposure on the Firm’s reported net income is also important as interest rate risk represents one of the Firm’s significant market risks. Interest rate risk arises not only from trading activities but also from the Firm’s traditional banking activities, which include extension of loans and credit facilities, taking deposits and issuing debt. The Firm evaluates its structural interest rate risk exposure through earnings-at-risk, which measures the extent to which changes in interest rates will affect the Firm’s core net interest income (see page 78 for further discussion of core net interest income) and interest rate-sensitive fees. Earnings-at-risk excludes the impact of trading activities and MSR, as these sensitivities are captured under VaR.
The CIO, Treasury and Corporate (“CTC”) Risk Committee establishes the Firm’s structural interest rate risk policies and market risk limits, which are subject to approval by the Risk Policy Committee of the Firm’s Board of Directors. CIO, working in partnership with the lines of business, calculates the Firm’s structural interest rate risk profile and reviews it with senior management including the CTC Risk Committee and the Firm’s ALCO. In addition, oversight of structural interest rate risk is managed through a dedicated risk function reporting to the CTC CRO. This risk function is responsible for providing independent oversight and governance around assumptions; and establishing and monitoring limits for structural interest rate risk.
Structural interest rate risk can occur due to a variety of factors, including:
Differences in the timing among the maturity or repricing of assets, liabilities and off-balance sheet instruments.
Differences in the amounts of assets, liabilities and off-balance sheet instruments that are repricing at the same time.
Differences in the amounts by which short-term and long-term market interest rates change (for example, changes in the slope of the yield curve).
 
The impact of changes in the maturity of various assets, liabilities or off-balance sheet instruments as interest rates change.
The Firm manages interest rate exposure related to its assets and liabilities on a consolidated, corporate-wide basis. Business units transfer their interest rate risk to Treasury through a transfer-pricing system, which takes into account the elements of interest rate exposure that can be risk-managed in financial markets. These elements include asset and liability balances and contractual rates of interest, contractual principal payment schedules, expected prepayment experience, interest rate reset dates and maturities, rate indices used for repricing, and any interest rate ceilings or floors for adjustable rate products. All transfer-pricing assumptions are dynamically reviewed.
The Firm manages structural interest rate risk generally through its investment securities portfolio and related derivatives.
The Firm conducts simulations of changes in structural interest rate-sensitive revenue under a variety of interest rate scenarios. Earnings-at-risk scenarios estimate the potential change in this revenue, and the corresponding impact to the Firm’s pretax core net interest income, over the following 12 months, utilizing multiple assumptions as described below. These scenarios highlight exposures to changes in interest rates, pricing sensitivities on deposits, optionality and changes in product mix. The scenarios include forecasted balance sheet changes, as well as prepayment and reinvestment behavior. Mortgage prepayment assumptions are based on current interest rates compared with underlying contractual rates, the time since origination, and other factors which are updated periodically based on historical experience.
JPMorgan Chase’s 12-month pretax core net interest income sensitivity profiles.
(Excludes the impact of trading activities and MSRs)
 
Instantaneous change in rates
 
(in millions)
+200 bps
+100 bps
-100 bps
-200 bps
December 31, 2014
$
4,667


$
2,864


NM
(a) 
NM
(a) 
(a)
Downward 100- and 200-basis-points parallel shocks result in a federal funds target rate of zero and negative three- and six-month U.S. Treasury rates. The earnings-at-risk results of such a low-probability scenario are not meaningful.
The Firm’s benefit to rising rates is largely a result of reinvesting at higher yields and assets re-pricing at a faster pace than deposits.
Additionally, another interest rate scenario used by the Firm — involving a steeper yield curve with long-term rates rising by 100 basis points and short-term rates staying at current levels — results in a 12-month pretax core net interest income benefit of $566 million. The increase in core net interest income under this scenario reflects the Firm reinvesting at the higher long-term rates, with funding costs remaining unchanged.



136
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



COUNTRY RISK MANAGEMENT
Country risk is the risk that a sovereign event or action alters the value or terms of contractual obligations of obligors, counterparties and issuers or adversely affects markets related to a particular country. The Firm has a comprehensive country risk management framework for assessing country risks, determining risk tolerance, and measuring and monitoring direct country exposures in the Firm. The Country Risk Management group is responsible for developing guidelines and policies for managing country risk in both emerging and developed countries. The Country Risk Management group actively monitors the various portfolios giving rise to country risk to ensure the Firm’s country risk exposures are diversified and that exposure levels are appropriate given the Firm’s strategy and risk tolerance relative to a country.
Country risk organization
The Country Risk Management group is an independent risk management function which works in close partnership with other risk functions to identify and monitor country risk within the Firm. The Firmwide Risk Executive for Country Risk reports to the Firm’s CRO.
Country Risk Management is responsible for the following functions:
Developing guidelines and policies consistent with a comprehensive country risk framework
Assigning sovereign ratings and assessing country risks
Measuring and monitoring country risk exposure and stress across the Firm
Managing country limits and reporting trends and limit breaches to senior management
Developing surveillance tools for early identification of potential country risk concerns
Providing country risk scenario analysis
 
Country risk identification and measurement
The Firm is exposed to country risk through its lending, investing, and market-making activities, whether cross-border or locally funded. Country exposure includes activity with both government and private-sector entities in a country. Under the Firm’s internal country risk management approach, country exposure is reported based on the country where the majority of the assets of the obligor, counterparty, issuer or guarantor are located or where the majority of its revenue is derived, which may be different than the domicile (legal residence) or country of incorporation of the obligor, counterparty, issuer or guarantor. Country exposures are generally measured by considering the Firm’s risk to an immediate default of the counterparty or obligor, with zero recovery. Assumptions are sometimes required in determining the measurement and allocation of country exposure, particularly in the case of certain tranched credit derivatives. Different measurement approaches or assumptions would affect the amount of reported country exposure.
Under the Firm’s internal country risk measurement framework:
Lending exposures are measured at the total committed amount (funded and unfunded), net of the allowance for credit losses and cash and marketable securities collateral received
Securities financing exposures are measured at their receivable balance, net of collateral received
Debt and equity securities are measured at the fair value of all positions, including both long and short positions
Counterparty exposure on derivative receivables is measured at the derivative’s fair value, net of the fair value of the related collateral. Counterparty exposure on derivatives can change significantly because of market movements.
Credit derivatives protection purchased and sold is reported based on the underlying reference entity and is measured at the notional amount of protection purchased or sold, net of the fair value of the recognized derivative receivable or payable. Credit derivatives protection purchased and sold in the Firm’s market-making activities is measured on a net basis, as such activities often result in selling and purchasing protection related to the same underlying reference entity; this reflects the manner in which the Firm manages these exposures


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
137

Management’s discussion and analysis

The Firm also has indirect exposures to country risk (for example, related to the collateral received on securities financing receivables or related to client clearing activities). These indirect exposures are managed in the normal course of business through the Firm’s credit, market, and operational risk governance, rather than through Country Risk Management.
The Firm’s internal country risk reporting differs from the reporting provided under the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council (“FFIEC”) bank regulatory requirements as there are significant differences in reporting methodology. For further information on the FFIEC’s reporting methodology, see Cross-border outstandings on page 325.
Country risk stress testing
The country risk stress framework aims to identify potential losses arising from a country crisis by capturing the impact of large asset price movements in a country based on market shocks combined with counterparty specific assumptions. Country Risk Management periodically defines and runs ad hoc stress scenarios for individual countries in response to specific market events and sector performance concerns.
Country risk monitoring and control
The Country Risk Management Group establishes guidelines for sovereign ratings reviews and limit management. Country stress and nominal exposures are measured under a comprehensive country limit framework. Country ratings and limits activity are actively monitored and reported on a regular basis. Country limit requirements are reviewed and approved by senior management as often as necessary, but at least annually. In addition, the Country Risk Management group uses surveillance tools for early identification of potential country risk concerns, such as signaling models and ratings indicators.
 
Country risk reporting
The following table presents the Firm’s top 20 exposures by country (excluding the U.S.) as of December 31, 2014. The selection of countries is based solely on the Firm’s largest total exposures by country, based on the Firm’s internal country risk management approach, and does not represent the Firm’s view of any actual or potentially adverse credit conditions. Country exposures may fluctuate from period-to-period due to normal client activity and market flows.
Top 20 country exposures
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2014

(in billions)
 
Lending(a)
Trading and investing(b)(c)
Other(d)
Total exposure
United Kingdom
 
$
25.8

$
31.1

$
1.4

$
58.3

Germany
 
23.5

21.6

0.2

45.3

Netherlands
 
6.1

19.2

2.1

27.4

France
 
11.4

15.2

0.2

26.8

China
 
10.8

7.0

0.5

18.3

Japan
 
11.5

5.5

0.4

17.4

Australia
 
6.4

10.8


17.2

Canada
 
12.4

4.2

0.3

16.9

Switzerland
 
9.3

1.7

2.3

13.3

India
 
5.8

6.2

0.6

12.6

Brazil
 
6.3

6.3


12.6

Korea
 
5.1

5.2

0.1

10.4

Spain
 
3.4

3.5


6.9

Hong Kong
 
1.7

4.1

1.0

6.8

Italy
 
2.4

3.4

0.2

6.0

Belgium
 
3.1

2.6

0.1

5.8

Taiwan
 
2.2

3.5


5.7

Singapore
 
3.1

1.9

0.5

5.5

Mexico
 
2.5

3.0


5.5

Luxembourg
 
3.5

0.3

1.1

4.9

(a)
Lending includes loans and accrued interest receivable, net of collateral and the allowance for loan losses, deposits with banks, acceptances, other monetary assets, issued letters of credit net of participations, and undrawn commitments to extend credit. Excludes intra-day and operating exposures, such as from settlement and clearing activities.
(b)
Includes market-making inventory, securities held in AFS accounts, counterparty exposure on derivative and securities financings net of collateral and hedging.
(c)
Includes single-name and index and tranched credit derivatives for which one or more of the underlying reference entities is in a country listed in the above table.
(d)
Includes capital invested in local entities and physical commodity inventory.

The Firm’s country exposure to Russia was $4.2 billion at December 31, 2014. The Firm is closely monitoring events in the region, and assessing the impact of falling oil prices, a weakening currency, ongoing sanctions and potential countermeasures such as capital controls. The Firm is also focused on possible contagion effects, via trade, financial or political channels.


138
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



MODEL RISK MANAGEMENT
Model risk
Model risk is the potential for adverse consequences from decisions based on incorrect or misused model outputs and reports.
The Firm uses models, for many purposes, but primarily for the measurement, monitoring and management of risk positions. Valuation models are employed by the Firm to value certain financial instruments that cannot otherwise be valued using quoted prices. These valuation models may also be employed as inputs to risk management models, including VaR and economic stress models. The Firm also makes use of models for a number of other purposes, including the calculation of regulatory capital requirements and estimating the allowance for credit losses.
Models are owned by various functions within the Firm based on the specific purposes of such models. For example, VaR models and certain regulatory capital models are owned by the line of business-aligned risk management functions. Owners of models are responsible for the development, implementation and testing of their models, as well as referral of models to the Model Risk function (within the Model Risk and Development unit) for review and approval. Once models have been approved, model owners are responsible for the maintenance of a robust operating environment and must monitor and evaluate the performance of the models on an ongoing basis. Model owners may seek to enhance models in response to changes in the portfolios and for changes in product and market developments, as well as to capture improvements in available modeling techniques and systems capabilities.
The Model Risk review and governance functions are independent of the model owners and they review and approve a wide range of models, including risk management, valuation and regulatory capital models used by the Firm. The Model Risk review and governance functions are part of the Firm’s Model Risk and Development unit, and the Firmwide Model Risk and Development Executive reports to the Firm’s CRO.
 
Models are tiered based on an internal standard according to their complexity, the exposure associated with the model and the Firm’s reliance on the model. This tiering is subject to the approval of the Model Risk function. A model review conducted by the Model Risk function considers the model’s suitability for the specific uses to which it will be put. The factors considered in reviewing a model include whether the model accurately reflects the characteristics of the product and its significant risks, the selection and reliability of model inputs, consistency with models for similar products, the appropriateness of any model-related adjustments, and sensitivity to input parameters and assumptions that cannot be observed from the market. When reviewing a model, the Model Risk function analyzes and challenges the model methodology and the reasonableness of model assumptions and may perform or require additional testing, including back-testing of model outcomes. Model reviews are approved by the appropriate level of management within the Model Risk function based on the relevant tier of the model.
Under the Firm’s model risk policy, new models, as well as material changes to existing models, are reviewed and approved by the Model Risk function prior to implementation in the operating environment.
In the event that the Model Risk function does not approve a model, the model owner is required to remediate the model within a time period agreed upon with the Model Risk function. The model owner is also required to resubmit the model for review to the Model Risk function and to take appropriate actions to mitigate the model risk if it is to be used in the interim. These actions will depend on the model and may include, for example, limitation of trading activity. The Firm may also implement other appropriate risk measurement tools to augment the model that is subject to remediation. In certain circumstances, exceptions to the Firm’s model risk policy may be granted by the head of the Model Risk function to allow a model to be used prior to review or approval.
For a summary of valuations based on models, see Critical Accounting Estimates Used by the Firm and Note 3.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
139

Management’s discussion and analysis

PRINCIPAL RISK MANAGEMENT
Principal investments are predominantly privately-held financial assets and instruments, typically representing an ownership or junior capital position, that have unique risks due to their illiquidity or for which there is less observable market or valuation data. Such investing activities are typically intended to be held over extended investment periods and, accordingly, the Firm has no expectation for short-term gain with respect to these investments. Principal investments cover multiple asset classes and are made either in stand-alone investing businesses or as part of a broader business platform. Asset classes include tax-oriented investments including affordable housing and alternative energy investments, private equity, and mezzanine/junior debt investments.
 
The Firm’s principal investments are managed under various lines of business and are captured within the respective LOB’s financial results. The Firm’s approach to managing principal risk is consistent with the Firm’s general risk governance structure. A Firmwide risk policy framework exists for all principal investing activities. All investments are approved by investment committees that include executives who are independent from the investing businesses. The Firm’s independent control functions are responsible for reviewing the appropriateness of the carrying value of principal investments in accordance with relevant policies. Targeted levels for total and annual investments are established in order to manage the overall size of the portfolios. Industry, geographic, and position level concentration limits are in place intended to ensure diversification of the portfolios. The Firm also conducts stress testing on these portfolios using specific scenarios that estimate losses based on significant market moves and/or other risk events.
The Firm has taken steps to reduce its exposure to principal investments, selling portions of Corporate’s One Equity Partners private equity portfolio and the CIB’s Global Special Opportunities Group equity and mezzanine financing portfolio.



140
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



OPERATIONAL RISK MANAGEMENT
Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed processes or systems or due to external events that are neither market nor credit-related. Operational risk is inherent in the Firm’s activities and can manifest itself in various ways, including fraudulent acts, business interruptions, inappropriate behavior of employees, failure to comply with applicable laws and regulations or failure of vendors to perform in accordance with their arrangements. These events could result in financial losses, litigation and regulatory fines, as well as other damage to the Firm. The goal is to keep operational risk at appropriate levels, in light of the Firm’s financial strength, the characteristics of its businesses, the markets in which it operates, and the competitive and regulatory environment to which it is subject.
Overview
To monitor and control operational risk, the Firm maintains an overall Operational Risk Management Framework (“ORMF”) which comprises governance oversight, risk assessment, capital measurement, and reporting and monitoring. The ORMF is intended to enable the Firm to function with a sound and well-controlled operational environment.
Risk Management is responsible for prescribing the ORMF to the lines of business and corporate functions and to provide independent oversight of its implementation. In 2014, Operational Risk Officers (“OROs”) were appointed across each line of business and corporate function to provide this independent oversight.
The lines of business and corporate functions are responsible for implementing the ORMF. The Firmwide Oversight and Control Group, comprised of dedicated control officers within each of the lines of business and corporate functional areas, as well as a central oversight team, is responsible for day to day review and monitoring of ORMF execution.
Operational risk management framework
The components of the Operational Risk Management Framework are:
Oversight and governance
Control committees oversee the operational risks and control environment of the respective line of business, function or region. These committees escalate operational risk issues to their respective line of business, function or regional Risk committee and also escalate significant risk issues (and/or risk issues with potential Firmwide impact) to the Firmwide Control Committee (“FCC”). The FCC provides a monthly forum for reviewing and discussing Firmwide operational risk metrics and management, including existing and emerging issues, and reviews execution against the ORMF. It escalates significant issues to the Firmwide Risk Committee, as appropriate. For additional information on the Firmwide Control Committee, see Risk Governance on pages 106–109.
 
Risk self-assessment
In order to evaluate and monitor operational risk, the lines of business and functions utilize the Firm’s standard risk and control self-assessment (“RCSA”) process and supporting architecture. The RCSA process requires management to identify material inherent operational risks, assess the design and operating effectiveness of relevant controls in place to mitigate such risks, and evaluate residual risk. Action plans are developed for control issues that are identified, and businesses are held accountable for tracking and resolving issues on a timely basis. Commencing in 2015, Risk Management will perform sample independent challenge of the RCSA program.
Risk reporting and monitoring
Operational risk management and control reports provide information, including actual operational loss levels, self-assessment results and the status of issue resolution to the lines of business and senior management. The purpose of these reports is to enable management to maintain operational risk at appropriate levels within each line of business, to escalate issues and to provide consistent data aggregation across the Firm’s businesses and functions.
The Firm has a process for capturing, tracking and monitoring operational risk events. The Firm analyzes errors and losses and identifies trends. Such analysis enables identification of the causes associated with risk events faced by the lines of business.
Capital measurement
Operational risk capital is measured primarily using a statistical model based on the Loss Distribution Approach (“LDA”). The operational risk capital model uses actual losses (internal and external to the Firm), an inventory of material forward-looking potential loss scenarios and adjustments to reflect changes in the quality of the control environment in determining Firmwide operational risk capital. This methodology is designed to comply with the Advanced Measurement rules under the Basel framework.
The Firm’s capital methodology incorporates four required elements of the Advanced Measurement Approach (“AMA”):
Internal losses,
External losses,
Scenario analysis, and
Business environment and internal control factors (“BEICF”).
The primary component of the operational risk capital estimate is the result of a statistical model, the LDA, which simulates the frequency and severity of future operational risk losses based on historical data. The LDA model is used to estimate an aggregate operational loss over a one-year time horizon, at a 99.9% confidence level. The LDA model incorporates actual operational losses in the quarter following the period in which those losses were realized,


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
141

Management’s discussion and analysis

and the calculation generally continues to reflect such losses even after the issues or business activities giving rise to the losses have been remediated or reduced.
The LDA is supplemented by both management’s view of plausible tail risk, which is captured as part of the Scenario Analysis process, and evaluation of key LOB internal control metrics (BEICF). The Firm may further supplement such analysis to incorporate management judgment and feedback from its bank regulators. For information related to operational risk RWA, see Regulatory capital on pages 146–153.
Audit alignment
Internal Audit utilizes a risk-based program of audit coverage to provide an independent assessment of the design and effectiveness of key controls over the Firm’s operations, regulatory compliance and reporting. This includes reviewing the operational risk framework, the effectiveness of the RCSA process, and the loss data-collection and reporting activities.
Insurance
One of the ways operational loss is mitigated is through insurance maintained by the Firm. The Firm purchases insurance to be in compliance with local laws and regulations (e.g., workers compensation), as well as to serve other needs (e.g., property loss and public liability). Insurance may also be required by third parties with whom the Firm does business. The insurance purchased is reviewed and approved by senior management.
Cybersecurity
The Firm devotes significant resources to maintain and regularly update its systems and processes that are designed to protect the security of the Firm’s computer systems, software, networks and other technology assets against attempts by unauthorized parties to obtain access to confidential information, destroy data, disrupt or degrade service, sabotage systems or cause other damage. In 2014, the Firm spent more than $250 million, and had approximately 1,000 people focused on cybersecurity efforts, and these efforts are expected to grow significantly over the coming years.
Third parties with which the Firm does business or that facilitate the Firm’s business activities (e.g., vendors, exchanges, clearing houses, central depositories, and financial intermediaries) could also be sources of cybersecurity risk to the Firm, including with respect to breakdowns or failures of their systems, misconduct by the employees of such parties, or cyberattacks which could affect their ability to deliver a product or service to the Firm or result in lost or compromised information of the Firm or its clients. In addition, customers with which or whom the Firm does business can also be sources of cybersecurity risk to the Firm, particularly when their activities and systems are beyond the Firm’s own security and control systems. Customers will generally be responsible for losses incurred due to their own failure to maintain the security of their own systems and processes.
 
The Firm and several other U.S. financial institutions have experienced significant distributed denial-of-service attacks from technically sophisticated and well-resourced unauthorized parties which are intended to disrupt online banking services. The Firm and its clients are also regularly targeted by unauthorized parties using malicious code and viruses.
On September 10, 2014, the Firm disclosed that a cyberattack against the Firm had occurred. On October 2, 2014, the Firm updated that information and disclosed that, while user contact information (name, address, phone number and email address) and internal JPMorgan Chase information relating to such users had been compromised, there had been no evidence that account information for such affected customers -- account numbers, passwords, user IDs, dates of birth or Social Security numbers -- was compromised during the attack. The Firm continues to vigilantly monitor the situation. In addition, as of the October 2, 2014 announcement, as well as of the date of this Annual Report, the Firm has not seen any unusual customer fraud related to this incident. The Firm is cooperating with government agencies in connection with their investigation of the incident. The Firm also notified its customers that they were not liable for unauthorized transactions in their accounts attributable to this attack that they promptly alerted the Firm about.
The Firm has established, and continues to establish, defenses on an ongoing basis to mitigate this and other possible future attacks. The cyberattacks experienced to date have not resulted in any material disruption to the Firm’s operations or had a material adverse effect on the Firm’s results of operations. The Board of Directors and the Audit Committee are regularly apprised regarding the cybersecurity policies and practices of the Firm as well as the Firm’s efforts regarding this attack and other significant cybersecurity events.
Cybersecurity attacks, like the one experienced by the Firm, highlight the need for continued and increased cooperation among businesses and the government, and the Firm continues to work with the appropriate government and law enforcement agencies and other businesses, including the Firm’s third-party service providers, to continue to enhance defenses and improve resiliency to cybersecurity threats.
Business and Technology Resiliency
JPMorgan Chase’s global resiliency and crisis management program is intended to ensure that the Firm has the ability to recover its critical business functions and supporting assets (i.e., staff, technology and facilities) in the event of a business interruption, and to remain in compliance with global laws and regulations as they relate to resiliency risk. The program includes corporate governance, awareness and training, as well as strategic and tactical initiatives aimed to ensure that risks are properly identified, assessed, and managed.


142
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The Firm has established comprehensive tracking and reporting of resiliency plans in order to proactively anticipate and manage various potential disruptive circumstances such as severe weather, technology and communications outages, flooding, mass transit shutdowns and terrorist threats, among others. The resiliency measures utilized by the Firm include backup infrastructure for data centers, a geographically distributed workforce, dedicated recovery facilities, providing technological capabilities to support remote work capacity for displaced staff and accommodation of employees at alternate locations. JPMorgan Chase continues to coordinate its global resiliency program across the Firm and mitigate business continuity risks by reviewing and testing recovery procedures. The strength and proficiency of the Firm’s global resiliency program has played an integral role in maintaining the Firm’s business operations during and quickly after various events in 2014 that have resulted in business interruptions, such as severe winter weather in the U.S., tropical storms in the Philippines, and geopolitical events in Brazil and Hong Kong.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
143

Management’s discussion and analysis

LEGAL RISK MANAGEMENT
Legal risk is the risk of loss or imposition of damages, fines, penalties or other liability arising from failure to comply with a contractual obligation or to comply with laws or regulations to which the Firm is subject.
Overview
In addition to providing legal services and advice to the Firm, and communicating and helping the lines business adjust to the legal and regulatory changes they face, including the heightened scrutiny and expectations of the Firm’s regulators, the global Legal function is responsible for working with the businesses and corporate functions to fully understand and assess their adherence to laws and regulations, as well as potential exposures on key litigation and transactional matters. In particular, Legal assists Oversight & Control, Risk, Finance, Compliance and Internal Audit in their efforts to ensure compliance with all applicable laws and regulations and the Firm’s corporate standards for doing business. The Firm’s lawyers also advise the Firm on potential legal exposures on key litigation and transactional matters, and perform a significant defense and advocacy role by defending the Firm against claims and potential claims and, when needed, pursuing claims against others.
Governance and Oversight
The Firm’s General Counsel reports to the CEO and is a member of the Operating Committee, the Firmwide Risk Committee and the Firmwide Control Committee. The General Counsel’s leadership team includes a General Counsel for each line of business, the heads of the Litigation and Corporate & Regulatory practices, as well as the Firm’s Corporate Secretary. Each region (e.g., Latin America, Asia Pacific) has a General Counsel who is responsible for managing legal risk across all lines of business and functions in the region.
Legal works with various committees (including new business initiative and reputation risk committees) and the Firm’s businesses to protect the Firm’s reputation beyond any particular legal requirements. In addition, the Firm’s Conflicts Office examines the Firm’s wholesale transactions that may have the potential to create conflicts of interest for the Firm.
 
COMPLIANCE RISK MANAGEMENT
Compliance risk is the risk fines or sanctions or of financial damage or loss due to the failure to comply with laws, rules, and regulations.
Overview
Global Compliance Risk Management’s (“Compliance”) role is to identify, measure, monitor, and report on and provide oversight regarding compliance risks arising from business operations, and provide guidance on how the Firm can mitigate these risks.
While each line of business is accountable for managing its compliance risk, the Firm’s Compliance teams work closely with the Operating Committee and senior management to provide independent review and oversight of the lines of business operations, with a focus on compliance with applicable global, regional and local laws and regulations. In recent years, the Firm has experienced heightened scrutiny by its regulators of its compliance with regulations, and with respect to its controls and operational processes. The Firm expects such regulatory scrutiny will continue.
Governance and Oversight
Compliance operates independent of the lines of business, and is led by the Chief Compliance Officer (“CCO”) who reports directly to the Firm’s COO. The Firm maintains oversight and coordination in its Compliance Risk Management practices globally through ongoing dialog and reporting between the lines of business, Regional Chief Compliance Officers and the CCO regarding significant compliance and regulatory management matters, as well as implementation of the Compliance program across the lines of business and Regions.
The Firm has in place a Code of Conduct (the “Code”), and each employee is given annual training in respect of the Code and is required annually to affirm his or her compliance with the Code. The Code sets forth the Firm’s core principles and fundamental values, including that no employee should ever sacrifice integrity - or give the impression that he or she has - even if one thinks it would help the Firm’s business. The Code requires prompt reporting of any known or suspected violation of the Code, any internal Firm policy, or any law or regulation applicable to the Firm’s business. It also requires the reporting of any illegal conduct, or conduct that violates the underlying principles of the Code, by any of the Firm’s customers, suppliers, contract workers, business partners, or agents. Specified employees are specially trained and designated as “code specialists” who act as a resource to employees on Code of Conduct matters. In addition, concerns may be reported anonymously and the Firm prohibits retaliation against employees for the good faith reporting of any actual or suspected violations of the Code.



144
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



FIDUCIARY RISK MANAGEMENT
Fiduciary risk is the risk of a failure to exercise the applicable high standard of care, to act in the best interests of clients or to treat clients fairly, as required under applicable law or regulation.
Depending on the fiduciary activity and capacity in which the Firm is acting, federal and state statutes and regulations, and common law require the Firm to adhere to specific duties in which the Firm must always place the client’s interests above its own.
Fiduciary risk governance
Fiduciary Risk Management is the responsibility of the relevant LOB risk and/or other governance committees. Senior business, legal, risk and compliance managers, who have particular responsibility for fiduciary matters, work with the relevant LOB risk committees with the goal of ensuring that businesses providing investment, trusts and estates, or other fiduciary products or services that give rise to fiduciary duties to clients perform at the appropriate standard relative to their fiduciary relationship with a client. Each LOB and its respective risk and/or other governance committees are responsible for the oversight and management of the fiduciary risks in their businesses. Of particular focus are the policies and practices that address a business’s responsibilities to a client, including performance and service requirements and expectations; client suitability determinations; and disclosure obligations and communications. In this way, the relevant LOB risk and/or other governance committees provide oversight of the Firm’s efforts to monitor, measure and control the performance and delivery of the products or services to clients that may give rise to such fiduciary duties, as well as the Firm’s fiduciary responsibilities with respect to the Firm’s employee benefit plans.
The Firmwide Fiduciary Risk Committee (“FFRC”) is a forum for risk matters related to the Firm’s fiduciary activities and oversees the firmwide fiduciary risk governance framework. It supports the consistent identification and escalation of fiduciary risk matters by the relevant lines of business or corporate functions responsible for managing fiduciary activities. The committee escalates significant issues to the Firmwide Risk Committee and any other committee considered appropriate.

 
REPUTATION RISK MANAGEMENT
Reputation risk is the risk that an action, transaction, investment or event will reduce the trust that clients, shareholders, employees or the broader public has in the Firm’s integrity or competence. Maintaining the Firm’s reputation is the responsibility of each individual employee of the Firm. The Firm’s Reputation Risk policy explicitly vests each employee with the responsibility to consider the reputation of the Firm when engaging in any activity. Since the types of events that could harm the Firm’s reputation are so varied across the Firm’s lines of business, each line of business has a separate reputation risk governance infrastructure in place, which comprises three key elements: clear, documented escalation criteria appropriate to the business footprint; a designated primary discussion forum – in most cases, one or more dedicated reputation risk committees; and a list of designated contacts. Line of business reputation risk governance is overseen by a Firmwide Reputation Risk Governance function, which provides oversight of the governance infrastructure and process to support the consistent identification, escalation, management and reporting of reputation risk issues firmwide.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
145

Management’s discussion and analysis

CAPITAL MANAGEMENT
A strong capital position is essential to the Firm’s business strategy and competitive position. The Firm’s capital strategy focuses on long-term stability, which enables the Firm to build and invest in market-leading businesses, even in a highly stressed environment. Prior to making any decisions on future business activities, senior management considers the implications on the Firm’s capital. In addition to considering the Firm’s earnings outlook, senior management evaluates all sources and uses of capital with a view to preserving the Firm’s capital strength. Maintaining a strong balance sheet to manage through economic volatility is considered a strategic imperative by the Firm’s Board of Directors, CEO and Operating Committee. The Firm’s balance sheet philosophy focuses on risk-adjusted returns, strong capital and reserves, and robust liquidity.
The Firm’s capital management objectives are to hold capital sufficient to:
Cover all material risks underlying the Firm’s business activities;
Maintain “well-capitalized” status under regulatory requirements;
Maintain debt ratings that enable the Firm to optimize its funding mix and liquidity sources while minimizing costs;
Retain flexibility to take advantage of future investment opportunities;
Maintain sufficient capital in order to continue to build and invest in its businesses through the cycle and in stressed environments; and
Distribute excess capital to shareholders while balancing other stated objectives.
These objectives are achieved through ongoing monitoring of the Firm’s capital position, regular stress testing, and a capital governance framework. Capital management is intended to be flexible in order to react to a range of potential events. JPMorgan Chase has firmwide and LOB processes for ongoing monitoring and active management of its capital position.
Capital strategy and governance
The Firm’s CEO, in conjunction with the Board and its subcommittees, establish principles and guidelines for capital planning, capital issuance, usage and distributions, and establish capital targets for the level and composition of capital in both business-as-usual and highly stressed environments.
The Firm’s senior management recognizes the importance of a capital management function that supports strategic decision-making. The Firm has established the Capital Governance Committee and the Regulatory Capital Management Office (“RCMO”) as key components in support of this objective. The Capital Governance Committee is responsible for reviewing the Firm’s Capital Management Policy and the principles underlying capital issuance and distribution alternatives. The Committee is also responsible
 
for governing the capital adequacy assessment process, including overall design, assumptions and risk streams, and ensuring that capital stress test programs are designed to adequately capture the idiosyncratic risks across the Firm’s businesses. RCMO, which reports to the Firm’s CFO, is responsible for reviewing, approving and monitoring the implementation of the Firm’s capital policies and strategies, as well as its capital adequacy assessment process. The DRPC assesses the Firm’s capital adequacy process and its components. This review determines the effectiveness of the capital adequacy process, the appropriateness of the risk tolerance levels, and the strength of the control infrastructure. For additional discussion on the DRPC, see Enterprise-wide Risk Management on pages 105–109.
Capital disciplines
In its capital management, the Firm uses three primary disciplines, which are further described below:
Regulatory capital
Economic capital
Line of business equity
Regulatory capital
The Federal Reserve establishes capital requirements, including well-capitalized standards, for the consolidated financial holding company. The Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (“OCC”) establishes similar capital requirements and standards for the Firm’s national banks, including JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and Chase Bank USA, N.A.
The U.S. capital requirements follow the Capital Accord of the Basel Committee, as amended from time to time. Prior to January 1, 2014, the Firm and its banking subsidiaries were subject to the capital requirements of Basel I and Basel 2.5. Effective January 1, 2014, the Firm became subject to Basel III (which incorporates Basel 2.5).
Basel III overview
Basel III, for U.S. bank holding companies and banks, revises, among other things, the definition of capital and introduces a new common equity Tier 1 capital (“CET1 capital”) requirement; presents two comprehensive methodologies for calculating risk-weighted assets (“RWA”), a general (Standardized) approach, which replaces Basel I RWA (“Basel III Standardized”) and an advanced approach, which replaces Basel II RWA (“Basel III Advanced”); and sets out minimum capital ratios and overall capital adequacy standards. Certain of the requirements of Basel III are subject to phase-in periods that began January 1, 2014 and continue through the end of 2018 (“Transitional period”) as described below. Both Basel III Standardized and Basel III Advanced became effective commencing January 1, 2014 for large and internationally active U.S. bank holding companies and banks, including the Firm and its insured depository institution (“IDI”) subsidiaries.


146
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Prior to the implementation of Basel III Advanced, the Firm was required to complete a qualification period (“parallel run”) during which it needed to demonstrate that it met the requirements of the rule to the satisfaction of its U.S. banking regulators. On February 21, 2014, the Federal Reserve and the OCC informed the Firm and its national bank subsidiaries that they had satisfactorily completed the parallel run requirements and were approved to calculate capital under Basel III Advanced, in addition to Basel III Standardized, as of April 1, 2014. In conjunction with its exit from the parallel run, the capital adequacy of the Firm and its national bank subsidiaries is evaluated against the Basel III approach (Standardized or Advanced) which results, for each quarter beginning with the second quarter of 2014, in the lower ratio (the “Collins Floor”), as required by the Collins Amendment of the Dodd-Frank Act.
Definition of capital
Basel III revises Basel I and II by narrowing the definition of capital and increasing the capital requirements for specific exposures. Under Basel III, CET1 capital predominantly includes common stockholders’ equity (including capital for AOCI related to debt and equity securities classified as AFS as well as for defined benefit pension and other post-retirement employee benefit (“OPEB”) plans), less certain deductions for goodwill, MSRs and deferred tax assets that arise from net operating loss (“NOL”) and tax credit carryforwards. Tier 1 capital is predominantly comprised of CET1 capital as well as perpetual preferred stock. Tier 2 capital includes long-term debt qualifying as Tier 2 and qualifying allowance for credit losses. Total capital is Tier 1 capital plus Tier 2 capital. The revisions to CET1 capital, Tier 1 capital and Tier 2 capital are subject to phase-in periods that began January 1, 2014, and continue through the end of 2018, and during that period, CET1 capital, Tier 1 capital and Tier 2 capital represent Basel III Transitional capital.
 
Risk-weighted assets
Basel III establishes two comprehensive methodologies for calculating RWA (a Standardized approach and an Advanced approach) which include capital requirements for credit risk, market risk, and in the case of Basel III Advanced, also operational risk. Key differences in the calculation of credit risk RWA between the Standardized and Advanced approaches are that for Basel III Advanced, credit risk RWA is based on risk-sensitive approaches which largely rely on the use of internal credit models and parameters, whereas for Basel III Standardized, credit risk RWA is generally based on supervisory risk-weightings which vary primarily by counterparty type and asset class. Market risk RWA is calculated on a generally consistent basis between Basel III Standardized and Basel III Advanced, both of which incorporate the requirements set forth in Basel 2.5. In addition to the RWA calculated under these methodologies, the Firm may supplement such amounts to incorporate management judgment and feedback from its bank regulators.
Supplementary leverage ratio (“SLR”)
Basel III also includes a requirement for Advanced Approach banking organizations, including the Firm, to calculate a SLR. The SLR, a non-GAAP financial measure, is defined as Tier 1 capital under Basel III divided by the Firm’s total leverage exposure. Total leverage exposure is calculated by taking the Firm’s total average on-balance sheet assets, less amounts permitted to be deducted for Tier 1 capital, and adding certain off-balance sheet exposures, such as undrawn commitments and derivatives potential future exposure.
On September 3, 2014, the U.S. banking regulators adopted a final rule for the calculation of the SLR. The U.S. final rule requires public disclosure of the SLR beginning with the first quarter of 2015, and also requires U.S. bank holding companies, including the Firm, to have a minimum SLR of at least 5% and IDI subsidiaries, including JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and Chase Bank USA, N.A., to have a minimum SLR of at least 6%, both beginning January 1, 2018.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
147

Management’s discussion and analysis

Capital ratios
The basis to calculate the Firm’s capital ratios (both risk-based and leverage) under Basel III during the transitional period and when fully phased-in are shown in the table below.
 
 
Transitional period
 
Fully Phased-In
 
 
2014
 
2015 – 2017
2018
 
2019+
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capital (Numerator)
 
Basel III Transitional Capital(a)
 
Basel III Capital
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
RWA (Denominator)
Standardized Approach
Basel I with 2.5(b)
 
Basel III Standardized
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Advanced
Approach
Basel III Advanced
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Leverage (Denominator)
Tier 1 Leverage
Adjusted average assets(c)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Supplementary leverage
 
 
Adjusted average assets(c) + off-balance sheet exposures
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(a)
Trust preferred securities (“TruPS”) are being phased out from inclusion in Basel III capital commencing January 1, 2014, continuing through the end of 2021.
(b)
Defined as Basel III Standardized Transitional for 2014. Beginning January 1, 2015, Basel III Standardized RWA is calculated under the Basel III definition of the Standardized Approach.
(c)
Adjusted average assets, for purposes of calculating the leverage ratio and SLR, includes total quarterly average assets adjusted for unrealized gains/(losses) on securities, less deductions for disallowed goodwill and other intangible assets, investments in certain subsidiaries, and the total adjusted carrying value of nonfinancial equity investments that are subject to deductions from Tier 1 capital.

Risk-based capital regulatory minimums
The Basel III rules include minimum capital ratio requirements that are also subject to phase-in periods through January 1, 2019.
In addition to the regulatory minimum capital requirements, certain banking organizations, including the Firm, will be required to hold an additional 2.5% of CET1 capital to serve as a “capital conservation buffer.” The capital conservation buffer is intended to be used to absorb potential losses in times of financial or economic stress; if not maintained, the Firm could be limited in the amount of capital that may be distributed, including dividends and common equity repurchases. The capital conservation buffer will be phased-in beginning January 1, 2016.
Moreover, G-SIBs will be required to maintain, in addition to the capital conservation buffer, further amounts of capital ranging from 1% to 2.5% across all tiers of regulatory capital. In November 2014, based upon data as of December 31, 2013, the Financial Stability Board (“FSB”) indicated that certain G-SIBs, including the Firm, would be required to hold the additional 2.5% of capital; the requirement will be phased-in beginning January 1, 2016.
 
The Basel Committee has stated that G-SIBs could in the future be required to hold 3.5% or more of additional capital if their relative systemic importance were to increase. Currently, no G-SIB is required to hold more than the additional 2.5% of capital.
Consequently, based upon the final rules currently in effect, the minimum Basel III CET1 capital ratio requirement for the Firm is expected to be 9.5%, comprised of the minimum ratio of 4.5% plus the 2.5% capital conservation buffer and the 2.5% G-SIB requirement both beginning January 1, 2019.
Basel III also establishes a minimum 6.5% CET1 standard for the definition of “well capitalized” under the Prompt Corrective Action (“PCA”) requirements of the FDIC Improvement Act (“FDICIA”). The CET1 standard is effective beginning with the first quarter of 2015.






148
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The following chart presents the Basel III minimum CET1 capital ratio during the transitional periods and on a fully phased-in basis under the Basel III rules currently in effect. It is the Firm’s current expectation that its Basel III CET1 ratio will exceed the regulatory minimums, both during the transition period and upon full implementation in 2019 and thereafter.
On December 9, 2014, the Federal Reserve issued a Notice of Proposed Rulemaking (“NPR”) that would establish a new capital surcharge across all tiers of regulatory capital for G-SIBs in the U.S., including the Firm. The Firm estimates its fully phased-in G-SIB surcharge (based upon data as of December 31, 2013) would be 4.5% under the NPR, compared to a fully phased-in G-SIB surcharge of 2.5% as estimated under the Basel III rules currently in effect.
Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In
Based on the U.S. capital rules currently in effect, Basel III capital rules will become fully phased-in on January 1, 2019, at which point the Firm will continue to calculate its capital ratios under both the Basel III Standardized and Advanced Approaches, and the Firm will continue to have its capital adequacy evaluated against the approach that results in the lower ratio. While the Firm has recently imposed Basel III Standardized Fully Phased-In RWA limits on the lines of business in adapting its capital framework, the Firm currently expects to manage each of the businesses (including line of business equity allocations), as well as the corporate functions, primarily on a Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In basis.
The Firm’s capital, RWA and capital ratios that are presented under Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In (and CET1 under Basel I as of December 31, 2013), are non-GAAP financial measures. However, such measures are used by bank regulators, investors and analysts to assess the Firm’s capital position and to compare the Firm’s capital to that of other financial services companies.
The Firm’s estimates of its Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In capital, RWA and capital ratios and of the Firm’s, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.’s, and Chase Bank USA, N.A.’s SLRs reflect management’s current understanding of the U.S. Basel III rules based on the current published rules and
 
on the application of such rules to the Firm’s businesses as currently conducted. The actual impact on the Firm’s capital ratios and SLR as of the effective date of the rules may differ from the Firm’s current estimates depending on changes the Firm may make to its businesses in the future, further implementation guidance from the regulators, and regulatory approval of certain of the Firm’s internal risk models (or, alternatively, regulatory disapproval of the Firm’s internal risk models that have previously been conditionally approved).
The following table presents the estimated Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In Capital ratios for JPMorgan Chase at December 31, 2014. Also included in the table are the regulatory minimum ratios currently expected to be in effect beginning January 1, 2019.
 
 
Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In
 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2014
Fully phased-in minimum capital ratios(a)
Fully phased-in well-capitalized ratios(b)
Risk-based capital ratios:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CET1 capital
 
10.2
%
 
9.5
%
 
6.5
%
 
Tier 1 capital
 
11.4

 
11.0

 
8.0

 
Total capital
 
12.8

 
13.0

 
10.0

 
Leverage ratio:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Tier 1
 
7.5

 
4.0

 
5.0

 
SLR
 
5.6

 
3.0

 
5.0

 
(a)
Represents the minimum capital ratios applicable to the Firm under fully phased-in Basel III rules currently in effect.
(b)
Represents the minimum Basel III Fully Phased-In capital ratios applicable to the Firm under the PCA requirements of FDICIA.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
149

Management’s discussion and analysis

A reconciliation of total stockholders’ equity to Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In CET1 capital, Tier 1 capital and Total qualifying capital is presented in the table below.
Risk-based capital components and assets
 
Basel III Advanced
Fully Phased-In
(in millions)
December 31, 2014
 
Total stockholders’ equity
 
$
232,065

Less: Preferred stock
 
20,063

Common stockholders’ equity
 
212,002

Less:
 
 
Goodwill(a)
 
44,925

Other intangible assets(a)
 
1,062

Other CET1 capital adjustments
 
1,163

CET1 capital
 
164,852

Preferred stock
 
20,063

Less:
 
 
Other Tier 1 adjustments
 
5

Total Tier 1 capital
 
184,910

Long-term debt and other instruments qualifying as Tier 2 capital
 
17,504

Qualifying allowance for credit losses
 
4,266

Other
 
(86
)
Total Tier 2 capital
 
21,684

Total capital
 
$
206,594

Credit risk RWA
 
$
1,040,087

Market risk RWA
 
179,200

Operational risk RWA
 
400,000

Total RWA
 
$
1,619,287

SLR leverage exposure
 
$
3,320,404

(a)
Goodwill and other intangible assets are net of any associated deferred tax liabilities.
 
Capital rollforward
The following table presents the changes in CET1 capital, Tier 1 capital and Tier 2 capital for the year ended December 31, 2014. Under Basel I CET1 represents Tier 1 common capital.
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
2014
Basel I CET1 capital at December 31, 2013
$
148,887

Effect of rule changes(a)
2,315

Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In CET1 capital at December 31, 2013
151,202

Net income applicable to common equity
20,637

Dividends declared on common stock
(6,078
)
Net purchases of treasury stock
(3,009
)
Changes in additional paid-in capital
(558
)
Changes related to AOCI
1,327

Adjustment related to FVA/DVA
580

Other
751

Increase in CET1 capital
13,650

Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In CET1 capital at December 31, 2014
$
164,852

 
 
Basel I Tier 1 capital at December 31, 2013
$
165,663

Effect of rule changes(b)
(3,295
)
Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In Tier 1 capital at December 31, 2013
162,368

Change in CET1 capital
13,650

Net issuance of noncumulative perpetual preferred stock
8,905

Other
(13
)
Increase in Tier 1 capital
22,542

Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In Tier 1 capital at December 31, 2014
$
184,910

 
 
Basel I Tier 2 capital at December 31, 2013
$
33,623

Effect of rule changes(c)
(11,644
)
Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In Tier 2 capital at December 31, 2013
21,979

Change in long-term debt and other instruments qualifying as Tier 2
809

Change in allowance for credit losses
(1,063
)
Other
(41
)
Decrease in Tier 2 capital
(295
)
Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In Tier 2 capital at December 31, 2014
$
21,684

Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In Total capital at December 31, 2014
$
206,594

(a)
Predominantly represents: (1) the addition of certain exposures, which were deducted from capital under Basel I, that are risk-weighted under Basel III; (2) adjustments related to AOCI for AFS securities and defined benefit pension and OPEB plans; and (3) a deduction for deferred tax assets related to NOL carryforwards.
(b)
Predominantly represents the exclusion of TruPS from Tier 1 capital under Basel III.
(c)
Predominantly represents a change in the calculation of qualifying allowance for credit losses under Basel III.


150
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



RWA rollforward
The following table presents changes in the components of RWA under Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In for the year ended December 31, 2014. The amounts in the rollforward categories are estimates, based on the predominant driver of the change.
 
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
(in billions)
Credit risk RWA
 
Market risk RWA
 
Operational risk RWA
 
Total RWA
Basel I RWA at December 31, 2013
$
1,223

 
$
165

 
NA

 
$
1,388

Effect of rule changes(a)
(168
)
 
(4
)
 
375

 
203

Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In RWA at December 31, 2013
1,055

 
161

 
375

 
1,591

Model & data changes(b)
56

 
36

 
25

 
117

Portfolio runoff(c)
(22
)
 
(22
)
 
 

 
(44
)
Movement in portfolio levels(d)
(49
)
 
4

 

 
(45
)
Changes in RWA
(15
)
 
18

 
25

 
28

Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In RWA at December 31, 2014
$
1,040

 
$
179

 
$
400

 
$
1,619

(a)
Effect of rule changes refers to movements in levels of RWA as a result of changing to calculating RWA under the Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In rules. See Risk-weighted assets on page 147 for additional information on the calculation of RWA under Basel III.
(b)
Model & data changes refer to movements in levels of RWA as a result of revised methodologies and/or treatment per regulatory guidance (exclusive of rule changes).
(c)
Portfolio runoff for credit risk RWA reflects lower loan balances in Mortgage Banking and reduced risk from position rolloffs in legacy portfolios, and for market risk RWA reflects reduced risk from position rolloffs in legacy portfolios.
(d)
Movement in portfolio levels for credit risk RWA refers to changes in book size, composition, credit quality, and market movements; and for market risk RWA, refers to changes in position and market movements.
 
Basel III Transitional
Basel III Transitional capital requirements became effective on January 1, 2014, and will become fully phased-in on January 1, 2019. The following table presents a reconciliation of the Firm’s Basel III Advanced Transitional capital and RWA to the Firm’s estimated Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In capital and RWA as of December 31, 2014.
December 31, 2014
(in millions)
 
Basel III Advanced Transitional CET1 capital
$
164,764

AOCI phase-in(a)
2,249

CET1 capital deduction phased-in(b)
(1,212
)
Intangibles deduction phase-in(c)
(850
)
Other adjustments to CET1 capital(d)
(99
)
Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In CET1 capital
$
164,852

 
 
Basel III Advanced Transitional Additional Tier 1 capital
$
21,868

Non-qualifying instruments phase-out
(2,670
)
Tier 1 capital deduction phased-out(b)
1,212

Other adjustments to Tier 1 capital(d)
(352
)
Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In Additional Tier 1 capital
$
20,058

 
 
Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In Tier 1 capital
$
184,910

 
 
Basel III Advanced Transitional Tier 2 capital
$
24,390

Non-qualifying instruments phase-out
(2,670
)
Other adjustments to Tier 2 capital(e)
(36
)
Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In Tier 2 capital
$
21,684

 
 
Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In Total capital
$
206,594

 
 
Basel III Advanced Transitional RWA
$
1,608,240

Adjustment related to change in risk-weighting(f)
11,047

Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In RWA
$
1,619,287

(a)
Includes the remaining balance of AOCI related to AFS debt securities and defined benefit pension and OPEB plans that will qualify as Basel III CET1 capital upon full phase-in.
(b)
Predominantly includes regulatory adjustments related to changes in FVA/DVA, as well as CET1 deductions for defined benefit pension plan assets and DTA related to net operating loss carryforwards.
(c)
Relates to intangible assets, other than goodwill and MSRs, that are required to be deducted from CET1 capital upon full phase-in.
(d)
Includes minority interest and the Firm’s investments in its own CET1 capital instruments.
(e)
Includes the Firm’s investments in its own Tier 2 capital instruments and unrealized gains on AFS equity securities.
(f)
Primarily relates to the risk-weighting of items not subject to capital deduction thresholds including MSRs.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
151

Management’s discussion and analysis

The following table presents the regulatory capital ratios as of December 31 2014, under Basel III Standardized Transitional and Basel III Advanced Transitional. Also included in the table are the regulatory minimum ratios in effect as of December 31, 2014.
 
December 31, 2014
 
 
 
 
 
Basel III Standardized Transitional
Basel III Advanced Transitional
 
Minimum capital ratios(b)
Well-capitalized ratios(c)
 
Risk-based capital ratios(a):
 
 
 
 
 
 
CET1 capital
11.2
%
10.2
%
 
4.0
%
NA

(d) 
Tier 1 capital
12.7

11.6

 
5.5

6.0
%
 
Total capital
15.0

13.1

 
8.0

10.0

 
Leverage ratio:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Tier 1 leverage
7.6

7.6

 
4.0

5.0

 
(a)
For each of the risk-based capital ratios the lower of the Standardized Transitional or Advanced Transitional ratio represents the Collins Floor.
(b)
Represents the minimum capital ratios for 2014 currently applicable to the Firm under Basel III.
(c)
Represents the minimum capital ratios for 2014 currently applicable to the Firm under the PCA requirements of the FDICIA.
(d)
The CET1 capital ratio became a relevant measure of capital under the prompt corrective action requirements on January 1, 2015.
At December 31, 2014, JPMorgan Chase maintained Basel III Standardized Transitional and Basel III Advanced Transitional capital ratios in excess of the well-capitalized standards established by the Federal Reserve.
Additional information regarding the Firm’s capital ratios and the U.S. federal regulatory capital standards to which the Firm is subject is presented in Note 28. For further information on the Firm’s Basel III measures, see the Firm’s consolidated Pillar 3 Regulatory Capital Disclosures reports, which are available on the Firm’s website (http://investor.shareholder.com/jpmorganchase/basel.cfm).
Supplementary leverage ratio
The Firm estimates that if the U.S. SLR final rule were in effect at December 31, 2014, the Firm’s SLR would have been approximately 5.6% and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.’s and Chase Bank USA, N.A.’s SLRs would have been approximately 5.9% and 8.1%, respectively, at that date.
Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review (“CCAR”)
The Federal Reserve requires large bank holding companies, including the Firm, to submit a capital plan on an annual basis. The Federal Reserve uses the CCAR and Dodd-Frank Act stress test processes to ensure that large bank holding companies have sufficient capital during periods of economic and financial stress, and have robust, forward-looking capital assessment and planning processes in place that address each BHC’s unique risks to enable them to have the ability to absorb losses under certain stress scenarios. Through the CCAR, the Federal Reserve evaluates each BHC’s capital adequacy and internal capital adequacy assessment processes, as well as its plans to make capital distributions, such as dividend payments or stock repurchases.
 
On March 26, 2014, the Federal Reserve informed the Firm that it did not object, on either a quantitative or qualitative basis, to the Firm’s 2014 capital plan. For information on actions taken by the Firm’s Board of Directors following the 2014 CCAR results, see Capital actions on page 154.
On January 5, 2015, the Firm submitted its 2015 capital plan to the Federal Reserve under the Federal Reserve’s 2015 CCAR process. The Firm expects to receive the Federal Reserve’s final response to its plan no later than March 31, 2015.
The Firm’s CCAR process is integrated into and employs the same methodologies utilized in the Firm’s Internal Capital Adequacy Assessment Process (“ICAAP”) process, as discussed below.
Internal Capital Adequacy Assessment Process
Semiannually, the Firm completes the ICAAP, which provides management with a view of the impact of severe and unexpected events on earnings, balance sheet positions, reserves and capital. The Firm’s ICAAP integrates stress testing protocols with capital planning.
The process assesses the potential impact of alternative economic and business scenarios on the Firm’s earnings and capital. Economic scenarios, and the parameters underlying those scenarios, are defined centrally and applied uniformly across the businesses. These scenarios are articulated in terms of macroeconomic factors, which are key drivers of business results; global market shocks, which generate short-term but severe trading losses; and idiosyncratic operational risk events. The scenarios are intended to capture and stress key vulnerabilities and idiosyncratic risks facing the Firm. However, when defining a broad range of scenarios, realized events can always be worse. Accordingly, management considers additional stresses outside these scenarios, as necessary. ICAAP results are reviewed by management and the Board of Directors.
Minimum Total Loss Absorbing Capacity (“TLAC”)
In November 2014, the FSB, in consultation with the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision, issued a consultative document proposing that, in order for G-SIBs to have sufficient loss absorbing and recapitalization capacity to support an orderly resolution, they would be required to have outstanding a sufficient amount and type of debt and capital instruments. This amount and type of debt and capital instruments (or “total loss absorbing capacity” or TLAC) is intended to effectively absorb losses, as necessary, upon a failure of a G-SIB, without imposing such losses on taxpayers of the relevant jurisdiction or causing severe systemic disruptions, and thereby ensuring the continuity of the G-SIBs critical functions. The document identifies specific criteria that must be met for instruments to be considered eligible under TLAC and sets out minimum requirements that include existing Basel III minimum capital requirements, excluding capital buffers. The FSB’s proposed range for a common minimum TLAC requirement is 16-20% of the financial institution’s RWA and at least twice its Basel III Tier 1 leverage ratio. The Firm estimated that it has approximately 15% minimum TLAC as a percentage of


152
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-in RWA, excluding capital buffers currently in effect, at year end 2014 based on its understanding of how the FSB proposal may be implemented in the United States. The FSB is expected to revise its proposal following a period of public consultation and findings from a quantitative impact study and market survey to be conducted in the first quarter of 2015. The final proposal is expected to be submitted to the G-20 in advance of the G-20 Summit scheduled for fourth quarter of 2015. U.S. banking regulators are expected to issue an NPR that would outline TLAC requirements specific to U.S. banks.
Regulatory capital outlook
The Firm expects to continue to accrete capital in the near term and believes its current capital levels enable it to retain market access, continue its strategy to invest in and grow its businesses and maintain flexibility to distribute excess capital. The Firm intends to balance return of capital to shareholders with achieving higher capital ratios over time. Additionally, the Firm expects the capital ratio calculated under the Basel III Standardized Fully Phased-In Approach to become its binding constraint by the end of 2015, or slightly thereafter. As a result, the Firm expects to reach Basel III Advanced and Standardized Fully Phased-In CET1 ratios of approximately 11% by the end of 2015 and is targeting reaching a Basel III CET1 ratio of approximately 12% by the end of 2018.
The Firm’s capital targets take into consideration the current U.S. Basel III requirements and contemplate the requirements under the U.S. G-SIB proposal issued on December 9, 2014 and therefore, assume a 4.5% G-SIB capital surcharge. These targets are subject to revision in the future as a result of changes that may be introduced by banking regulators to the required minimum ratios to which the Firm is subject. In particular, if the Firm’s G-SIB capital surcharge is determined to be lower than 4.5%, the capital targets would be adjusted accordingly. The Firm intends to manage its capital so that it achieves the required capital levels and composition in line with or in advance of the required timetables of current and proposed rules.
Economic risk capital
Economic risk capital is another of the disciplines the Firm uses to assess the capital required to support its businesses. Economic risk capital is a measure of the capital needed to cover JPMorgan Chase’s business activities in the event of unexpected losses. The Firm measures economic risk capital using internal risk-assessment methodologies and models based primarily on four risk factors: credit, market, operational and private equity risk and considers factors, assumptions and inputs that differ from those required to be used for regulatory capital requirements. Accordingly, economic risk capital provides a complementary measure to regulatory capital. As economic risk capital is a separate component of the capital framework for Advanced Approach banking organizations under Basel III, the Firm continues to enhance its economic risk capital framework.

 
Line of business equity
The Firm’s framework for allocating capital to its business segments is based on the following objectives:
Integrate firmwide and line of business capital management activities;
Measure performance consistently across all lines of business; and
Provide comparability with peer firms for each of the lines of business
Equity for a line of business represents the amount the Firm believes the business would require if it were operating independently, considering capital levels for similarly rated peers, regulatory capital requirements (as estimated under Basel III Advanced Fully Phased-In) and economic risk measures. Capital is also allocated to each line of business for, among other things, goodwill and other intangibles associated with acquisitions effected by the line of business. ROE is measured and internal targets for expected returns are established as key measures of a business segment’s performance.
Line of business equity
 
Yearly average
Year ended December 31,
(in billions)
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Consumer & Community Banking
 
$
51.0

 
$
46.0

 
$
43.0

Corporate & Investment Bank
 
61.0

 
56.5

 
47.5

Commercial Banking
 
14.0

 
13.5

 
9.5

Asset Management
 
9.0

 
9.0

 
7.0

Corporate
 
72.4

 
71.4

 
77.4

Total common stockholders’ equity
 
$
207.4

 
$
196.4

 
$
184.4

Effective January 1, 2013, the Firm refined the capital allocation framework to align it with the revised line of business structure that became effective in the fourth quarter of 2012. The change in equity levels for the lines of businesses was largely driven by the evolving regulatory requirements and higher capital targets the Firm had established under the Basel III Advanced Approach.
On at least an annual basis, the Firm assesses the level of capital required for each line of business as well as the assumptions and methodologies used to allocate capital to its lines of business and updates the equity allocations to its lines of business as refinements are implemented.
Line of business equity
January 1,

 
December 31,
(in billions)
2015(a)
 
2014
 
2013
Consumer & Community Banking
$
51.0

 
$
51.0

 
$
46.0

Corporate & Investment Bank
62.0

 
61.0

 
56.5

Commercial Banking
14.0

 
14.0

 
13.5

Asset Management
9.0

 
9.0

 
9.0

Corporate
76.0

 
77.0

 
75.0

Total common stockholders’ equity
$
212.0

 
$
212.0

 
$
200.0

(a)
Reflects refined capital allocations effective January 1, 2015.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
153

Management’s discussion and analysis

Capital actions
Dividends
The Firm’s common stock dividend policy reflects JPMorgan Chase’s earnings outlook, desired dividend payout ratio, capital objectives, and alternative investment opportunities.
The Firm’s current expectation is to continue to target a payout ratio of approximately 30% of normalized earnings over time. Following the Federal Reserve’s non-objection to the Firm’s 2014 capital plan, the Board of Directors increased the quarterly common stock dividend on May 20, 2014, from $0.38 to $0.40 per share, effective beginning with the dividend paid on July 31, 2014, to stockholders of record on July 3, 2014.
For information regarding dividend restrictions, see Note 22 and Note 27.
The following table shows the common dividend payout ratio based on reported net income.
Year ended December 31,
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Common dividend payout ratio
29
%
 
33
%
 
23
%
Preferred stock
During the year ended December 31, 2014, the Firm issued $8.9 billion of noncumulative preferred stock. Preferred stock dividends declared were $1.1 billion for the year ended December 31, 2014. Assuming all preferred stock issuances were outstanding for the entire year and quarterly dividends were declared on such issuances, preferred stock dividends would have been $1.3 billion for the year ended December 31, 2014. For additional information on the Firm’s preferred stock, see Note 22.
Redemption of outstanding trust preferred securities
On May 8, 2013, the Firm redeemed approximately $5.0 billion, or 100% of the liquidation amount, of the following eight series of trust preferred securities: JPMorgan Chase Capital X, XI, XII, XIV, XVI, XIX, XXIV, and BANK ONE Capital VI. For a further discussion of trust preferred securities, see Note 21.
Common equity
On March 13, 2012, the Board of Directors authorized a $15.0 billion common equity (i.e., common stock and warrants) repurchase program. As of December 31, 2014, $3.8 billion (on a trade-date basis) of authorized repurchase capacity remained under the program. The amount of equity that may be repurchased by the Firm is also subject to the amount that is set forth in the Firm’s annual capital plan submitted to the Federal Reserve as part of the CCAR process. In conjunction with the Federal Reserve’s release of its 2014 CCAR results, the Firm’s Board of Directors has authorized the Firm to repurchase $6.5 billion of common equity between April 1, 2014, and March 31, 2015. As of December 31, 2014, $2.1 billion (on a trade-date basis) of such repurchase capacity remains. This authorization includes shares repurchased to offset issuances under the Firm’s equity-based compensation plans.
 
The following table sets forth the Firm’s repurchases of common equity for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, on a trade-date basis. There were no warrants repurchased during the years ended December 31, 2014, and 2013.
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Total number of shares of common stock repurchased
 
83.4

 
96.1

 
30.9

Aggregate purchase price of common stock repurchases
 
$
4,834

 
$
4,789

 
$
1,329

Total number of warrants repurchased
 

 

 
18.5

Aggregate purchase price of warrant repurchases
 
$

 
$

 
$
238

The Firm may, from time to time, enter into written trading plans under Rule 10b5-1 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 to facilitate repurchases in accordance with the common equity repurchase program. A Rule 10b5-1 repurchase plan allows the Firm to repurchase its equity during periods when it would not otherwise be repurchasing common equity — for example, during internal trading “blackout periods.” All purchases under a Rule 10b5-1 plan must be made according to a predefined plan established when the Firm is not aware of material nonpublic information.
The authorization to repurchase common equity will be utilized at management’s discretion, and the timing of purchases and the exact amount of common equity that may be repurchased is subject to various factors, including market conditions; legal and regulatory considerations affecting the amount and timing of repurchase activity; the Firm’s capital position (taking into account goodwill and intangibles); internal capital generation; and alternative investment opportunities. The repurchase program does not include specific price targets or timetables; may be executed through open market purchases or privately negotiated transactions, or utilizing Rule 10b5-1 programs; and may be suspended at any time.
For additional information regarding repurchases of the Firm’s equity securities, see Part II, Item 5: Market for registrant’s common equity, related stockholder matters and issuer purchases of equity securities on pages 18–19.


154
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Broker-dealer regulatory capital
JPMorgan Chase’s principal U.S. broker-dealer subsidiaries are J.P. Morgan Securities LLC (“JPMorgan Securities”) and J.P. Morgan Clearing Corp. (“JPMorgan Clearing”). JPMorgan Clearing is a subsidiary of JPMorgan Securities and provides clearing and settlement services. JPMorgan Securities and JPMorgan Clearing are each subject to Rule 15c3-1 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the “Net Capital Rule”). JPMorgan Securities and JPMorgan Clearing are also each registered as futures commission merchants and subject to Rule 1.17 of the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (“CFTC”).
JPMorgan Securities and JPMorgan Clearing have elected to compute their minimum net capital requirements in accordance with the “Alternative Net Capital Requirements” of the Net Capital Rule. At December 31, 2014, JPMorgan Securities’ net capital, as defined by the Net Capital Rule, was $12.8 billion, exceeding the minimum requirement by $10.6 billion, and JPMorgan Clearing’s net capital was $7.5 billion, exceeding the minimum requirement by $5.6 billion.
In addition to its minimum net capital requirement, JPMorgan Securities is required to hold tentative net capital in excess of $1.0 billion and is also required to notify the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) in the event that tentative net capital is less than $5.0 billion, in accordance with the market and credit risk standards of Appendix E of the Net Capital Rule. As of December 31, 2014, JPMorgan Securities had tentative net capital in excess of the minimum and notification requirements.
J.P. Morgan Securities plc is a wholly owned subsidiary of JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and is the Firm’s principal operating subsidiary in the U.K. It has authority to engage in banking, investment banking and broker-dealer activities. J.P. Morgan Securities plc is jointly regulated by the U.K. Prudential Regulation Authority (“PRA”) and Financial Conduct Authority (“FCA”). Commencing January 1, 2014, J.P. Morgan Securities plc became subject to the U.K. Basel III capital rules.
At December 31, 2014, J.P. Morgan Securities plc had estimated total capital of $30.1 billion; its estimated CET1 capital ratio was 10.7% and its estimated Total capital ratio was 14.1%. Both ratios exceeded the minimum transitional standards (4.0% and 8.0% for the CET1 ratio and Total capital ratio, respectively) as established by the Capital Requirements Directive and Regulation (the European Union (“EU”) implementation of Basel III) as well as additional minimum requirements specified by the Prudential Regulatory Authority as Individual Capital Guidance and PRA Buffer requirements.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
155

Management’s discussion and analysis

LIQUIDITY RISK MANAGEMENT
Liquidity risk is the risk that the Firm will be unable to meet its contractual and contingent obligations. Liquidity risk management is intended to ensure that the Firm has the appropriate amount, composition and tenor of funding and liquidity in support of its assets.
Liquidity Risk Oversight
The Firm has an independent liquidity risk oversight function whose primary objective is to provide assessment, measurement, monitoring, and control of liquidity risk across the Firm. Liquidity risk oversight is managed through a dedicated firmwide Liquidity Risk Oversight group reporting into the CIO, Treasury, and Corporate (“CTC”) Chief Risk Officer (“CRO”). The CTC CRO has responsibility for firmwide Liquidity Risk Oversight and reports to the Firm’s CRO. Liquidity Risk Oversight’s responsibilities include but are not limited to:
Establishing and monitoring limits, indicators, and thresholds, including liquidity appetite tolerances;
Defining and monitoring internal Firmwide and legal entity stress tests and regulatory defined stress testing;
Reporting and monitoring liquidity positions, balance sheet variances and funding activities;
Conducting ad hoc analysis to identify potential emerging liquidity risks.
Risk Governance and Measurement
Specific committees responsible for liquidity governance include firmwide ALCO as well as lines of business and regional ALCOs, and the CTC Risk Committee. For further discussion of the risk and risk-related committees, see Enterprise-wide Risk Management on pages 105–109.
Internal Stress testing
Liquidity stress tests are intended to ensure sufficient liquidity for the Firm under a variety of adverse scenarios. Results of stress tests are therefore considered in the formulation of the Firm’s funding plan and assessment of its liquidity position. Liquidity outflow assumptions are modeled across a range of time horizons and contemplate both market and idiosyncratic stress. Standard stress tests are performed on a regular basis and ad hoc stress tests are performed in response to specific market events or concerns. In addition, stress scenarios are produced for the parent holding company and the Firm’s major subsidiaries.
Liquidity stress tests assume all of the Firm’s contractual obligations are met and then take into consideration varying levels of access to unsecured and secured funding markets. Additionally, assumptions with respect to potential non-contractual and contingent outflows are contemplated.
Liquidity Management
Treasury is responsible for liquidity management. The primary objectives of effective liquidity management are to ensure that the Firm’s core businesses are able to operate in support of client needs, meet contractual and contingent obligations through normal economic cycles as well as during stress events, ensure funding mix optimization, and
 
availability of liquidity sources. The Firm manages liquidity and funding using a centralized, global approach in order to optimize liquidity sources and uses.
In the context of the Firm’s liquidity management, Treasury is responsible for:
Analyzing and understanding the liquidity characteristics of the Firm, lines of business and legal entities’ assets and liabilities, taking into account legal, regulatory, and operational restrictions;
Defining and monitoring firmwide and legal entity liquidity strategies, policies, guidelines, and contingency funding plans;
Managing liquidity within approved liquidity risk appetite tolerances and limits;
Setting transfer pricing in accordance with underlying liquidity characteristics of balance sheet assets and liabilities as well as certain off-balance sheet items.
Contingency funding plan
The Firm’s contingency funding plan (“CFP”), which is reviewed by ALCO and approved by the DRPC, is a compilation of procedures and action plans for managing liquidity through stress events. The CFP incorporates the limits and indicators set by the Liquidity Risk Oversight group. These limits and indicators are reviewed regularly to identify the emergence of risks or vulnerabilities in the Firm’s liquidity position. The CFP identifies the alternative contingent liquidity resources available to the Firm in a stress event.
Parent holding company and subsidiary funding
The parent holding company acts as a source of funding to its subsidiaries. The Firm’s liquidity management is intended to maintain liquidity at the parent holding company, in addition to funding and liquidity raised at the subsidiary operating level, at levels sufficient to fund the operations of the parent holding company and its subsidiaries for an extended period of time in a stress environment where access to normal funding sources is disrupted. The parent holding company currently holds more than 18 months of pre-funding assuming no access to wholesale funding markets.
LCR and NSFR
In December 2010, the Basel Committee introduced two new measures of liquidity risk: the liquidity coverage ratio (“LCR”), which is intended to measure the amount of “high-quality liquid assets” (“HQLA”) held by the Firm in relation to estimated net cash outflows within a 30-day period during an acute stress event; and the net stable funding ratio (“NSFR”) which is intended to measure the “available” amount of stable funding relative to the “required” amount of stable funding over a one-year horizon. The standards require that the LCR be no lower than 100% and the NSFR be greater than 100%.


156
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



On September 3, 2014, the U.S. banking regulators approved the final LCR rule (“U.S. LCR”), which became effective on January 1, 2015. Under the final rules, the LCR is required to be 80% at January 1, 2015, increasing by 10% each year until reaching 100% at January 1, 2017. At December 31, 2014, the Firm was compliant with the fully phased-in U.S. LCR based on its current understanding of the final rule. The Firm’s LCR may fluctuate from period-to-period due to normal flows from client activity.
On October 31, 2014, the Basel Committee issued the final standard for the NSFR which will become a minimum standard by January 1, 2018. At December 31, 2014, the Firm was compliant with the NSFR based on its current understanding of the final Basel rule. The U.S. Banking Regulators are expected to issue a proposal on the NSFR that would outline requirements specific to U.S. banks.
HQLA
HQLA is the estimated amount of assets that qualify for inclusion in the U.S. LCR. HQLA primarily consists of cash and certain unencumbered high quality liquid assets as defined in the rule.
As of December 31, 2014, HQLA was estimated to be approximately $600 billion, as determined under the U.S. LCR final rule, compared with $522 billion as of December 31, 2013, which was calculated using the Basel Committee’s definition of HQLA. The increase in HQLA was due to higher cash balances largely driven by higher deposit balances, partially offset by the impact of the application of the U.S. LCR rule which excludes certain types of securities that are permitted under the Basel Rules. HQLA may fluctuate from period-to-period primarily due to normal flows from client activity.
The following table presents the estimated HQLA included in the U.S. LCR broken out by HQLA-eligible cash and HQLA-eligible securities as of December 31, 2014.
(in billions)
December 31, 2014
 
HQLA
 
 
Eligible cash(a)
 
$
454

Eligible securities(b)
 
146

Total HQLA
 
$
600

(a)
Predominantly cash on deposit at central banks.
(b)
Predominantly includes U.S. agency mortgage-backed securities, U.S. Treasuries, and sovereign bonds.
In addition to HQLA, as of December 31, 2014, the Firm has approximately $321 billion of unencumbered marketable securities, such as equity securities and fixed income debt securities, available to raise liquidity, if required. Furthermore, the Firm maintains borrowing capacity at various Federal Home Loan Banks (“FHLBs”), the Federal Reserve Bank discount window and various other central banks as a result of collateral pledged by the Firm to such banks. Although available, the Firm does not view the borrowing capacity at the Federal Reserve Bank discount
 
window and the various other central banks as a primary source of liquidity. As of December 31, 2014, the Firm’s remaining borrowing capacity at various FHLBs and the Federal Reserve Bank discount window was approximately $143 billion. This borrowing capacity excludes the benefit of securities included above in HQLA or other unencumbered securities held at the Federal Reserve Bank discount window for which the Firm has not drawn liquidity.
Funding
Sources of funds
Management believes that the Firm’s unsecured and secured funding capacity is sufficient to meet its on- and off-balance sheet obligations.
The Firm funds its global balance sheet through diverse sources of funding including a stable deposit franchise as well as secured and unsecured funding in the capital markets. The Firm’s loan portfolio (aggregating approximately $757.3 billion at December 31, 2014), is funded with a portion of the Firm’s deposits (aggregating approximately $1,363.4 billion at December 31, 2014) and through securitizations and, with respect to a portion of the Firm’s real estate-related loans, with secured borrowings from the FHLBs. Deposits in excess of the amount utilized to fund loans are primarily invested in the Firm’s investment securities portfolio or deployed in cash or other short-term liquid investments based on their interest rate and liquidity risk characteristics. Capital markets secured financing assets and trading assets are primarily funded by the Firm’s capital markets secured financing liabilities, trading liabilities and a portion of the Firm’s long-term debt and stockholders’ equity.
In addition to funding capital markets assets, proceeds from the Firm’s debt and equity issuances are used to fund certain loans, and other financial and non-financial assets, or may be invested in the Firm’s investment securities portfolio. See the discussion below for additional disclosures relating to Deposits, Short-term funding, and Long-term funding and issuance.
Deposits
A key strength of the Firm is its diversified deposit franchise, through each of its lines of business, which provides a stable source of funding and limits reliance on the wholesale funding markets. As of December 31, 2014, the Firm’s loans-to-deposits ratio was 56%, compared with 57% at December 31, 2013.
As of December 31, 2014, total deposits for the Firm were $1,363.4 billion, compared with $1,287.8 billion at December 31, 2013 (58% of total liabilities at both December 31, 2014 and 2013). The increase was due to growth in both wholesale and consumer deposits. For further information, see Balance Sheet Analysis on pages 72–73.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
157

Management’s discussion and analysis


The Firm typically experiences higher customer deposit inflows at period-ends. Therefore, the Firm believes average deposit balances are more representative of deposit trends. The table below summarizes, by line of business, the period-end and average deposit balances as of and for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013.
Deposits
 
 
Year ended December 31,
As of or for the period ended December 31,
 
 
 
Average
(in millions)
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
Consumer & Community Banking
$
502,520

$
464,412

 
$
486,919

$
453,304

Corporate & Investment Bank
468,423

446,237

 
417,517

384,289

Commercial Banking
213,682

206,127

 
190,425

184,409

Asset Management
155,247

146,183

 
150,121

139,707

Corporate
23,555

24,806

 
19,319

27,433

Total Firm
$
1,363,427

$
1,287,765

 
$
1,264,301

$
1,189,142

A significant portion of the Firm’s deposits are consumer deposits (37% and 36% at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively), which are considered particularly stable as they are less sensitive to interest rate changes or market volatility. Additionally, the majority of the Firm’s institutional deposits are also considered to be stable sources of funding since they are generated from customers that maintain operating service relationships with the Firm. For further discussions of deposit and liability balance trends, see the discussion of the results for the Firm’s business segments and the Balance Sheet Analysis on pages 79–104 and pages 72–73, respectively.
The following table summarizes short-term and long-term funding, excluding deposits, as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, and average balances for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013. For additional information, see the Balance Sheet Analysis on pages 72–73 and Note 21.
Sources of funds (excluding deposits)
2014
2013
 
 
As of or for the year ended December 31,
 
Average
(in millions)
 
2014
2013
Commercial paper:
 
 
 
 
 
Wholesale funding
$
24,052

$
17,249

 
$
19,442

$
17,785

Client cash management
42,292

40,599

 
40,474

35,932

Total commercial paper
$
66,344

$
57,848

 
$
59,916

$
53,717

 
 
 
 
 
 
Obligations of Firm-administered multi-seller conduits(a)
$
12,047

$
14,892

 
$
10,427

$
15,504

 
 
 
 
 
 
Other borrowed funds
$
30,222

$
27,994

 
$
31,721

$
30,449

 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase:
 
 
 
 
 
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase
$
167,077

$
155,808

 
$
181,186

$
207,106

Securities loaned
21,798

19,509

 
22,586

26,068

Total securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase(b)(c)(d)
$
188,875

$
175,317

 
$
203,772

$
233,174

 
 
 
 
 
 
Total senior notes
$
142,480

$
135,754

 
$
139,707

$
137,662

Trust preferred securities
5,496

5,445

 
5,471

7,178

Subordinated debt
29,472

29,578

 
29,082

27,955

Structured notes
30,021

28,603

 
30,311

29,517

Total long-term unsecured funding
$
207,469

$
199,380

 
$
204,571

$
202,312

 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit card securitization
$
31,239

$
26,580

 
$
28,935

$
27,834

Other securitizations(e)
2,008

3,253

 
2,734

3,501

FHLB advances
64,994

61,876

 
60,667

55,487

Other long-term secured funding(f)
4,373

6,633

 
5,031

6,284

Total long-term secured funding
$
102,614

$
98,342

 
$
97,367

$
93,106

 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock(g)
$
20,063

$
11,158

 
17,018

$
10,960

Common stockholders’ equity(g)
$
212,002

$
200,020

 
207,400

$
196,409

(a)
Included in beneficial interests issued by consolidated variable interest entities on the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets.
(b)
Excludes federal funds purchased.
(c)
Excluded long-term structured repurchase agreements of $2.7 billion and $4.6 billion as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, and average balance of $4.2 billion for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013.

158
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



(d)
Excluded long-term securities loaned of $483 million as of December 31, 2013, and average balance of $24 million and $414 million for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. There were no long-term securities loaned as of December 31, 2014.
(e)
Other securitizations includes securitizations of residential mortgages and student loans. The Firm’s wholesale businesses also securitize loans for client-driven transactions; those client-driven loan securitizations are not considered to be a source of funding for the Firm and are not included in the table.
(f)
Includes long-term structured notes which are secured.
(g)
For additional information on preferred stock and common stockholders’ equity see Capital Management on pages 146–155, Consolidated statements of changes in stockholders’ equity, Note 22 and Note 23.

Short-term funding
A significant portion of the Firm’s total commercial paper liabilities, approximately 64% as of December 31, 2014, were not sourced from wholesale funding markets, but were originated from deposits that customers choose to sweep into commercial paper liabilities as a cash management program offered to customers of the Firm.
The Firm’s sources of short-term secured funding primarily consist of securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase. Securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase are secured predominantly by high-quality securities collateral, including government-issued debt, agency debt and agency MBS, and constitute a significant portion of the federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under purchase agreements. The amounts of securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase at December 31, 2014, increased predominantly due to a change in the mix of the Firm’s funding sources. The decrease in average balances for the year ended December 31, 2014, compared with December 31, 2013, was predominantly due to less secured financing of the Firm’s investment securities portfolio, and a change in the mix of the Firm’s funding sources. The balances associated with securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase fluctuate over time due to customers’ investment and financing activities; the Firm’s demand for financing; the ongoing management of the mix of the Firm’s liabilities, including its secured and unsecured financing (for both the investment securities and market-making portfolios); and other market and portfolio factors.
Long-term funding and issuance
Long-term funding provides additional sources of stable funding and liquidity for the Firm. The Firm’s long-term funding plan is driven by expected client activity, liquidity considerations, and regulatory requirements. Long-term funding objectives include maintaining diversification, maximizing market access and optimizing funding costs, as well as maintaining a certain level of pre-funding at the parent holding company. The Firm evaluates various funding markets, tenors and currencies in creating its optimal long-term funding plan.
The significant majority of the Firm’s long-term unsecured funding is issued by the parent holding company to provide maximum flexibility in support of both bank and nonbank subsidiary funding. The following table summarizes long-term unsecured issuance and maturities or redemptions for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013. For additional information, see Note 21.
 
Long-term unsecured funding
 
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
2014
2013
Issuance
 
 
Senior notes issued in the U.S. market
$
16,373

$
19,835

Senior notes issued in non-U.S. markets
11,221

8,843

Total senior notes
27,594

28,678

Subordinated debt
4,979

3,232

Structured notes
19,806

16,979

Total long-term unsecured funding – issuance
$
52,379

$
48,889

 
 
 
Maturities/redemptions
 
 
Total senior notes
$
21,169

$
18,418

Trust preferred securities

5,052

Subordinated debt
4,487

2,418

Structured notes
18,554

17,785

Total long-term unsecured funding – maturities/redemptions
$
44,210

$
43,673

In addition, from January 1, 2015, through February 24, 2015, the Firm issued $10.1 billion of senior notes.
The Firm raises secured long-term funding through securitization of consumer credit card loans and advances from the FHLBs. It may also in the future raise long-term funding through securitization of residential mortgages, auto loans and student loans, which will increase funding and investor diversity.
The following table summarizes the securitization issuance and FHLB advances and their respective maturities or redemption for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013.
Long-term secured funding
 
 
 
 
Year ended
December 31,
Issuance
 
Maturities/Redemptions
(in millions)
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
Credit card securitization
$
8,350

$
8,434

 
$
3,774

$
11,853

Other securitizations(a)


 
309

427

FHLB advances
15,200

23,650

 
12,079

3,815

Other long-term secured funding
$
802

$
751

 
$
3,076

$
159

Total long-term secured funding
$
24,352

$
32,835

 
$
19,238

$
16,254

(a)
Other securitizations includes securitizations of residential mortgages and student loans.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
159

Management’s discussion and analysis

The Firm’s wholesale businesses also securitize loans for client-driven transactions; those client-driven loan securitizations are not considered to be a source of funding for the Firm and are not included in the table above. For further description of the client-driven loan securitizations, see Note 16.
Credit ratings
The cost and availability of financing are influenced by credit ratings. Reductions in these ratings could have an adverse effect on the Firm’s access to liquidity sources, increase the cost of funds, trigger additional collateral or
 
funding requirements and decrease the number of investors and counterparties willing to lend to the Firm. Additionally, the Firm’s funding requirements for VIEs and other third party commitments may be adversely affected by a decline in credit ratings. For additional information on the impact of a credit ratings downgrade on the funding requirements for VIEs, and on derivatives and collateral agreements, see Special-purpose entities on page 74, and Credit risk, liquidity risk and credit-related contingent features in
Note 6.



The credit ratings of the parent holding company and the Firm’s principal bank and nonbank subsidiaries as of December 31, 2014, were as follows.
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co.
 
JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.
Chase Bank USA, N.A.
 
J.P. Morgan Securities LLC
December 31, 2014
Long-term issuer
Short-term issuer
Outlook
 
Long-term issuer
Short-term issuer
Outlook
 
Long-term issuer
Short-term issuer
Outlook
Moody’s Investor Services
A3
P-2
Stable
 
Aa3
P-1
Stable
 
Aa3
P-1
Stable
Standard & Poor’s
A
A-1
Negative
 
A+
A-1
Stable
 
A+
A-1
Stable
Fitch Ratings
A+
F1
Stable
 
A+
F1
Stable
 
A+
F1
Stable
Downgrades of the Firm’s long-term ratings by one or two notches could result in a downgrade of the Firm’s short-term ratings. If this were to occur, the Firm believes its cost of funds could increase and access to certain funding markets could be reduced as noted above. The nature and magnitude of the impact of ratings downgrades depends on numerous contractual and behavioral factors (which the Firm believes are incorporated in its liquidity risk and stress testing metrics). The Firm believes it maintains sufficient liquidity to withstand a potential decrease in funding capacity due to ratings downgrades.
JPMorgan Chase’s unsecured debt does not contain requirements that would call for an acceleration of payments, maturities or changes in the structure of the existing debt, provide any limitations on future borrowings or require additional collateral, based on unfavorable changes in the Firm’s credit ratings, financial ratios, earnings, or stock price.
Critical factors in maintaining high credit ratings include a stable and diverse earnings stream, strong capital ratios, strong credit quality and risk management controls, diverse funding sources, and disciplined liquidity monitoring procedures. Rating agencies continue to evaluate economic and geopolitical trends, regulatory developments, rating uplift assumptions surrounding government support, future profitability, risk management practices, and litigation matters, as well as their broader ratings methodologies. Changes in any of these factors could lead to changes in the Firm’s credit ratings.
 
On September 18, 2014, S&P revised its ratings methodology for hybrid capital securities issued by financial institutions, and on September 29, 2014, the ratings of the Firm’s hybrid capital securities (including trust preferred securities and preferred stock) were lowered by 1 notch from BBB to BBB-, reflecting the new methodology. Furthermore, S&P has announced a Request for Comment on a proposed change to rating criteria related to additional loss absorbing capacity. In addition, Moody’s and Fitch are in the process of reviewing their ratings methodologies: Moody’s has announced a Request for Comment on the revision to its Bank Rating Methodology and Fitch has announced a review of the ratings differential that it applies between bank holding companies and their bank subsidiaries.
Although the Firm closely monitors and endeavors to manage, to the extent it is able, factors influencing its credit ratings, there is no assurance that its credit ratings will not be changed in the future.


160
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



CRITICAL ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES USED BY THE FIRM
JPMorgan Chase’s accounting policies and use of estimates are integral to understanding its reported results. The Firm’s most complex accounting estimates require management’s judgment to ascertain the appropriate carrying value of assets and liabilities. The Firm has established policies and control procedures intended to ensure that estimation methods, including any judgments made as part of such methods, are well-controlled, independently reviewed and applied consistently from period to period. The methods used and judgments made reflect, among other factors, the nature of the assets or liabilities and the related business and risk management strategies, which may vary across the Firm’s businesses and portfolios. In addition, the policies and procedures are intended to ensure that the process for changing methodologies occurs in an appropriate manner. The Firm believes its estimates for determining the carrying value of its assets and liabilities are appropriate. The following is a brief description of the Firm’s critical accounting estimates involving significant judgments.
Allowance for credit losses
JPMorgan Chase’s allowance for credit losses covers the retained consumer and wholesale loan portfolios, as well as the Firm’s consumer and wholesale lending-related commitments. The allowance for loan losses is intended to adjust the carrying value of the Firm’s loan assets to reflect probable credit losses inherent in the loan portfolio as of the balance sheet date. Similarly, the allowance for lending-related commitments is established to cover probable credit losses inherent in the lending-related commitments portfolio as of the balance sheet date.
The allowance for loan losses includes an asset-specific component, a formula-based component, and a component related to PCI loans. The determination of each of these components involves significant judgment on a number of matters, as discussed below. For further discussion of the methodologies used in establishing the Firm’s allowance for credit losses, see Note 15.
Asset-specific component
The asset-specific allowance for loan losses for each of the Firm’s portfolio segments is generally measured as the difference between the recorded investment in the impaired loan and the present value of the cash flows expected to be collected, discounted at the loan’s original effective interest rate. Estimating the timing and amounts of future cash flows is highly judgmental as these cash flow projections rely upon estimates such as redefault rates, loss severities, the amounts and timing of prepayments and other factors that are reflective of current and expected future market conditions. These estimates are, in turn, dependent on factors such as the level of future home prices, the duration of current overall economic conditions, and other macroeconomic and portfolio-specific factors. All of these estimates and assumptions require significant management judgment and certain assumptions are highly subjective.
 
Formula-based component - Consumer loans and lending-related commitments, excluding PCI loans
The formula-based allowance for credit losses for the consumer portfolio, including credit card, is calculated by applying statistical credit loss factors to outstanding principal balances over an estimated loss emergence period to arrive at an estimate of incurred credit losses in the portfolio. The loss emergence period represents the time period between the date at which the loss is estimated to have been incurred and the ultimate realization of that loss (through a charge-off). Estimated loss emergence periods may vary by product and may change over time; management applies judgment in estimating loss emergence periods, using available credit information and trends. In addition, management applies judgment to the statistical loss estimates for each loan portfolio category, using delinquency trends and other risk characteristics to estimate the total incurred credit losses in the portfolio. Management uses additional statistical methods and considers portfolio and collateral valuation trends to review the appropriateness of the primary statistical loss estimate.
The statistical calculation is then adjusted to take into consideration model imprecision, external factors and current economic events that have occurred but that are not yet reflected in the factors used to derive the statistical calculation; these adjustments are accomplished in part by analyzing the historical loss experience for each major product segment. However, it is difficult to predict whether historical loss experience is indicative of future loss levels. Management applies judgment in making this adjustment, taking into account uncertainties associated with current macroeconomic and political conditions, quality of underwriting standards, borrower behavior, the potential impact of payment recasts within the HELOC portfolio, and other relevant internal and external factors affecting the credit quality of the portfolio. In certain instances, the interrelationships between these factors create further uncertainties. For example, the performance of a HELOC that experiences a payment recast may be affected by both the quality of underwriting standards applied in originating the loan and the general economic conditions in effect at the time of the payment recast. For junior lien products, management considers the delinquency and/or modification status of any senior liens in determining the adjustment. The application of different inputs into the statistical calculation, and the assumptions used by management to adjust the statistical calculation, are subject to management judgment, and emphasizing one input or assumption over another, or considering other inputs or assumptions, could affect the estimate of the allowance for loan losses for the consumer credit portfolio.
Overall, the allowance for credit losses for the consumer portfolio, including credit card, is sensitive to changes in the economic environment (e.g., unemployment rates), delinquency rates, the realizable value of collateral (e.g.,


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
161

Management’s discussion and analysis

housing prices), FICO scores, borrower behavior and other risk factors. While all of these factors are important determinants of overall allowance levels, changes in the various factors may not occur at the same time or at the same rate, or changes may be directionally inconsistent such that improvement in one factor may offset deterioration in the other. In addition, changes in these factors would not necessarily be consistent across all geographies or product types. Finally, it is difficult to predict the extent to which changes in these factors would ultimately affect the frequency of losses, the severity of losses or both.
PCI loans
In connection with the Washington Mutual transaction, JPMorgan Chase acquired certain PCI loans, which are accounted for as described in Note 14. The allowance for loan losses for the PCI portfolio is based on quarterly estimates of the amount of principal and interest cash flows expected to be collected over the estimated remaining lives of the loans.
These cash flow projections are based on estimates regarding default rates (including redefault rates on modified loans), loss severities, the amounts and timing of prepayments and other factors that are reflective of current and expected future market conditions. These estimates are dependent on assumptions regarding the level of future home price declines, and the duration of current overall economic conditions, among other factors. These estimates and assumptions require significant management judgment and certain assumptions are highly subjective.
Formula-based component - Wholesale loans and lending-related commitments
The Firm’s methodology for determining the allowance for loan losses and the allowance for lending-related commitments requires the early identification of credits that are deteriorating. The formula-based component of the allowance calculation for wholesale loans and lending-related components is the product of an estimated PD and estimated LGD. These factors are determined based on the credit quality and specific attributes of the Firm’s loans and lending-related commitments to each obligor.
The Firm uses a risk rating system to determine the credit quality of its wholesale loans and lending-related commitments. In assessing the risk rating of a particular loan or lending-related commitment, among the factors considered are the obligor’s debt capacity and financial flexibility, the level of the obligor’s earnings, the amount and sources for repayment, the level and nature of contingencies, management strength, and the industry and geography in which the obligor operates. These factors are based on an evaluation of historical and current information and involve subjective assessment and interpretation. Emphasizing one factor over another or considering additional factors could affect the risk rating assigned by the Firm to that loan.
 
PD estimates are based on observable external through-the-cycle data, using credit rating agency default statistics. A LGD estimate is assigned to each loan or lending-related commitment. The estimate represents the amount of economic loss if the obligor were to default. The type of obligor, quality of collateral, and the seniority of the Firm’s loans in the obligor’s capital structure affect LGD. LGD estimates are based on the Firm’s history of actual credit losses over more than one credit cycle. Changes to the time period used for PD and LGD estimates (for example, point-in-time loss versus longer views of the credit cycle) could also affect the allowance for credit losses.
The Firm applies judgment in estimating PD and LGD used in calculating the allowances. Wherever possible, the Firm uses independent, verifiable data or the Firm’s own historical loss experience in its models for estimating the allowances, but differences in loan characteristics between the Firm’s specific loan portfolio and those reflected in external and Firm-specific historical data could affect loss estimates. Estimates of PD and LGD are subject to periodic refinement based on any changes to underlying external and Firm-specific historical data. The use of different inputs would change the amount of the allowance for credit losses determined appropriate by the Firm.
Management also applies its judgment to adjust the modeled loss estimates, taking into consideration model imprecision, external factors and economic events that have occurred but are not yet reflected in the loss factors. Historical experience of both LGD and PD are considered when estimating these adjustments. Factors related to concentrated and deteriorating industries also are incorporated where relevant. These estimates are based on management’s view of uncertainties that relate to current macroeconomic and political conditions, quality of underwriting standards and other relevant internal and external factors affecting the credit quality of the current portfolio.
Allowance for credit losses sensitivity
As noted above, the Firm’s allowance for credit losses is sensitive to numerous factors, depending on the portfolio. Changes in economic conditions or in the Firm’s assumptions could affect its estimate of probable credit losses inherent in the portfolio at the balance sheet date. For example, changes in the inputs below would have the following effects on the Firm’s modeled loss estimates as of December 31, 2014, without consideration of any offsetting or correlated effects of other inputs in the Firm’s allowance for loan losses:
For PCI loans, a combined 5% decline in housing prices and a 1% increase in unemployment from current levels could imply an increase to modeled credit loss estimates of approximately $1.2 billion.
For the residential real estate portfolio, excluding PCI loans, a combined 5% decline in housing prices and a 1% increase in unemployment from current levels could


162
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



imply an increase to modeled annual loss estimates of approximately $100 million.
A 50 basis point deterioration in forecasted credit card loss rates could imply an increase to modeled annualized credit card loan loss estimates of approximately $600 million.
A one-notch downgrade in the Firm’s internal risk ratings for its entire wholesale loan portfolio could imply an increase in the Firm’s modeled loss estimates of approximately $1.8 billion.
A 100 basis point increase in estimated loss given default for the Firm’s entire wholesale loan portfolio could imply an increase in the Firm’s modeled loss estimates of approximately $140 million.
The purpose of these sensitivity analyses is to provide an indication of the isolated impacts of hypothetical alternative assumptions on modeled loss estimates. The changes in the inputs presented above are not intended to imply management’s expectation of future deterioration of those risk factors. In addition, these analyses are not intended to estimate changes in the overall allowance for loan losses, which would also be influenced by the judgment management applies to the modeled loss estimates to reflect the uncertainty and imprecision of these modeled loss estimates based on then current circumstances and conditions.
It is difficult to estimate how potential changes in specific factors might affect the overall allowance for credit losses because management considers a variety of factors and inputs in estimating the allowance for credit losses. Changes in these factors and inputs may not occur at the same rate and may not be consistent across all geographies or product types, and changes in factors may be directionally inconsistent, such that improvement in one factor may offset deterioration in other factors. In addition, it is difficult to predict how changes in specific economic conditions or assumptions could affect borrower behavior or other factors considered by management in estimating the allowance for credit losses. Given the process the Firm follows and the judgments made in evaluating the risk factors related to its loans and credit card loss estimates, management believes that its current estimate of the allowance for credit loss is appropriate.
Fair value of financial instruments, MSRs and commodities inventory
JPMorgan Chase carries a portion of its assets and liabilities at fair value. The majority of such assets and liabilities are measured at fair value on a recurring basis. Certain assets and liabilities are measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis, including certain mortgage, home equity and other loans, where the carrying value is based on the fair value of the underlying collateral.
 
Assets measured at fair value
The following table includes the Firm’s assets measured at fair value and the portion of such assets that are classified within level 3 of the valuation hierarchy. For further information, see Note 3.
December 31, 2014
(in billions, except ratio data)
Total assets at fair value
Total level 3 assets
Trading debt and equity instruments
$
320.0

 
$
22.5

 
Derivative receivables
79.0

 
12.6

 
Trading assets
399.0

 
35.1

 
AFS securities
298.8

 
1.0

 
Loans
2.6

 
2.5

 
MSRs
7.4

 
7.4

 
Private equity investments(a)
5.7

 
2.5

 
Other
36.2

 
2.4

 
Total assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis
749.7

 
50.9

 
Total assets measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis
4.5

 
3.2

 
Total assets measured at fair value
$
754.2

 
$
54.1

 
Total Firm assets
$
2,573.1

 
 
 
Level 3 assets as a percentage of total Firm assets
 
 
2.1
%
 
Level 3 assets as a percentage of total Firm assets at fair value
 
 
7.2
%
 
(a)
Private equity instruments represent investments within the Corporate line of business.
Valuation
Details of the Firm’s processes for determining fair value are set out in Note 3. Estimating fair value requires the application of judgment. The type and level of judgment required is largely dependent on the amount of observable market information available to the Firm. For instruments valued using internally developed models that use significant unobservable inputs and are therefore classified within level 3 of the valuation hierarchy, judgments used to estimate fair value are more significant than those required when estimating the fair value of instruments classified within levels 1 and 2.
In arriving at an estimate of fair value for an instrument within level 3, management must first determine the appropriate model to use. Second, the lack of observability of certain significant inputs requires management to assess all relevant empirical data in deriving valuation inputs — including, for example, transaction details, yield curves, interest rates, prepayment rates, default rates, volatilities, correlations, equity or debt prices, valuations of comparable instruments, foreign exchange rates and credit curves. For further discussion of the valuation of level 3 instruments, including unobservable inputs used, see
Note 3.
For instruments classified in levels 2 and 3, management judgment must be applied to assess the appropriate level of valuation adjustments to reflect counterparty credit quality, the Firm’s credit-worthiness, market funding rates, liquidity considerations, unobservable parameters, and for portfolios that meet specified criteria, the size of the net open risk


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
163

Management’s discussion and analysis

position. The judgments made are typically affected by the type of product and its specific contractual terms, and the level of liquidity for the product or within the market as a whole. For further discussion of valuation adjustments applied by the Firm see Note 3.
Imprecision in estimating unobservable market inputs or other factors can affect the amount of gain or loss recorded for a particular position. Furthermore, while the Firm believes its valuation methods are appropriate and consistent with those of other market participants, the methods and assumptions used reflect management judgment and may vary across the Firm’s businesses and portfolios.
The Firm uses various methodologies and assumptions in the determination of fair value. The use of methodologies or assumptions different than those used by the Firm could result in a different estimate of fair value at the reporting date. For a detailed discussion of the Firm’s valuation process and hierarchy, and its determination of fair value for individual financial instruments, see Note 3.
Goodwill impairment
Under U.S. GAAP, goodwill must be allocated to reporting units and tested for impairment at least annually. The Firm’s process and methodology used to conduct goodwill impairment testing is described in Note 17.
Management applies significant judgment when estimating the fair value of its reporting units. Estimates of fair value are dependent upon estimates of (a) the future earnings potential of the Firm’s reporting units, including the estimated effects of regulatory and legislative changes, such as the Dodd-Frank Act, (b) long-term growth rates and (c) the relevant cost of equity. Imprecision in estimating these factors can affect the estimated fair value of the reporting units.
During 2014, the Firm recognized an impairment of the Private Equity business’ goodwill totaling $276 million. Remaining goodwill of $101 million at December 31, 2014 associated with the Private Equity business was disposed of as part of the Private Equity sale completed in January 2015. For further information on the Private Equity sale, see Note 2.
Based upon the updated valuations for all of its reporting units, the Firm concluded that the goodwill allocated to its other reporting units was not impaired at December 31, 2014. The fair values of these reporting units exceeded their carrying values. Except for the Firm’s mortgage banking business, the excess fair value as a percentage of carrying value ranged from approximately 20-210% for the other reporting units and did not indicate a significant risk of goodwill impairment based on current projections and valuations. The fair value of the Firm’s Mortgage Banking business exceeded its carrying value by less than 5% and accordingly, the associated goodwill of approximately $2 billion remains at an elevated risk for goodwill impairment.
 
The projections for all of the Firm’s reporting units are consistent with the short-term assumptions discussed in the Business outlook on pages 66–67, and in the longer term, incorporate a set of macroeconomic assumptions and the Firm’s best estimates of long-term growth and returns of its businesses. Where possible, the Firm uses third-party and peer data to benchmark its assumptions and estimates.
Deterioration in economic market conditions, increased estimates of the effects of recent regulatory or legislative changes, or additional regulatory or legislative changes may result in declines in projected business performance beyond management’s current expectations. For example, in the Firm’s Mortgage Banking business, such declines could result from increases in primary mortgage interest rates, lower mortgage origination volume, higher costs to resolve foreclosure-related matters or from deterioration in economic conditions, including decreases in home prices that result in increased credit losses. Declines in business performance, increases in equity capital requirements, or increases in the estimated cost of equity, could cause the estimated fair values of the Firm’s reporting units or their associated goodwill to decline in the future, which could result in a material impairment charge to earnings in a future period related to some portion of the associated goodwill.
For additional information on goodwill, see Note 17.
Income taxes
JPMorgan Chase is subject to the income tax laws of the various jurisdictions in which it operates, including U.S. federal, state and local and non-U.S. jurisdictions. These laws are often complex and may be subject to different interpretations. To determine the financial statement impact of accounting for income taxes, including the provision for income tax expense and unrecognized tax benefits, JPMorgan Chase must make assumptions and judgments about how to interpret and apply these complex tax laws to numerous transactions and business events, as well as make judgments regarding the timing of when certain items may affect taxable income in the U.S. and non-U.S. tax jurisdictions.
JPMorgan Chase’s interpretations of tax laws around the world are subject to review and examination by the various taxing authorities in the jurisdictions where the Firm operates, and disputes may occur regarding its view on a tax position. These disputes over interpretations with the various taxing authorities may be settled by audit, administrative appeals or adjudication in the court systems of the tax jurisdictions in which the Firm operates. JPMorgan Chase regularly reviews whether it may be assessed additional income taxes as a result of the resolution of these matters, and the Firm records additional reserves as appropriate. In addition, the Firm may revise its estimate of income taxes due to changes in income tax laws, legal interpretations and tax planning strategies. It is possible that revisions in the Firm’s estimate of income


164
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



taxes may materially affect the Firm’s results of operations in any reporting period.
The Firm’s provision for income taxes is composed of current and deferred taxes. Deferred taxes arise from differences between assets and liabilities measured for financial reporting versus income tax return purposes. Deferred tax assets are recognized if, in management’s judgment, their realizability is determined to be more likely than not. The Firm has also recognized deferred tax assets in connection with certain NOLs. The Firm performs regular reviews to ascertain whether deferred tax assets are realizable. These reviews include management’s estimates and assumptions regarding future taxable income, which also incorporates various tax planning strategies, including strategies that may be available to utilize NOLs before they expire. In connection with these reviews, if it is determined that a deferred tax asset is not realizable, a valuation allowance is established. The valuation allowance may be reversed in a subsequent reporting period if the Firm determines that, based on revised estimates of future taxable income or changes in tax planning strategies, it is more likely than not that all or part of the deferred tax asset will become realizable. As of December 31, 2014, management has determined it is more likely than not that the Firm will realize its deferred tax assets, net of the existing valuation allowance.
JPMorgan Chase does not record U.S. federal income taxes on the undistributed earnings of certain non-U.S. subsidiaries, to the extent that such earnings have been reinvested abroad for an indefinite period of time. Changes to the income tax rates applicable to these non-U.S. subsidiaries may have a material impact on the effective tax rate in a future period if such changes were to occur.
 
The Firm adjusts its unrecognized tax benefits as necessary when additional information becomes available. Uncertain tax positions that meet the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold are measured to determine the amount of benefit to recognize. An uncertain tax position is measured at the largest amount of benefit that management believes is more likely than not to be realized upon settlement. It is possible that the reassessment of JPMorgan Chase’s unrecognized tax benefits may have a material impact on its effective tax rate in the period in which the reassessment occurs.
For additional information on income taxes, see Note 26.
Litigation reserves
For a description of the significant estimates and judgments associated with establishing litigation reserves, see
Note 31.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
165

Management’s discussion and analysis

ACCOUNTING AND REPORTING DEVELOPMENTS
Amendments to the consolidation analysis
In February 2015, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued guidance regarding consolidation of legal entities such as limited partnerships, limited liability corporations, and securitization structures. The guidance eliminates the deferral issued by the FASB in February 2010 of the accounting guidance for VIEs for certain investment funds, including mutual funds, private equity funds and hedge funds. In addition, the guidance amends the evaluation of fees paid to a decision maker or a service provider, and exempts certain money market funds from consolidation. The guidance will be effective in the first quarter of 2016 with early adoption permitted. The Firm is currently evaluating the potential impact on the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Reclassification of residential real estate collateralized consumer mortgage loans upon foreclosure and classification of certain government-guaranteed mortgage loans upon foreclosure
In January 2014, the FASB issued guidance which clarified the timing of when a creditor is considered to have taken physical possession of residential real estate collateral for a consumer mortgage loan, resulting in the reclassification of the loan receivable to real estate owned. The final standard also requires disclosure of outstanding foreclosed residential real estate and the amount of the recorded investment in residential real estate mortgage loans in the process of foreclosure. In August 2014, the FASB issued separate guidance clarifying the classification and measurement of certain foreclosed government-guaranteed mortgage loans. Under the final standard, certain foreclosed government-insured mortgage loan amounts were reclassified on the balance sheet as a receivable from the guarantor at the guaranteed amount. The Firm early adopted both of these new standards in the third quarter of 2014 with a cumulative-effect adjustment as of January 1, 2014; the adoption of these standards (and related reclassification adjustment) had no material impact on the Firm’s Consolidated Financial Statements.
Measuring the financial assets and financial liabilities of a consolidated collateralized financing entity
In August 2014, the FASB issued guidance to address diversity in the accounting for differences in the measurement of the fair values of financial assets and liabilities of consolidated financing VIEs. The new guidance provides an alternative for consolidated financing VIEs to elect: (1) to measure their financial assets and liabilities separately under existing U.S. GAAP for fair value measurement with any differences in such fair values reflected in earnings; or (2) to measure both their financial assets and liabilities using the more observable of the fair value of the financial assets or the fair value of the financial liabilities. The guidance will become effective in the first quarter of 2016, with early adoption permitted. The
 
adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Firm’s Consolidated Financial Statements.
Repurchase agreements and similar transactions
In June 2014, the FASB issued guidance that amends the accounting for certain secured financing transactions, and requires enhanced disclosures with respect to transactions recognized as sales in which exposure to the derecognized asset is retained through a separate agreement with the counterparty. In addition, the guidance requires enhanced disclosures with respect to the types and quality of financial assets pledged in secured financing transactions. The guidance will become effective in the first quarter of 2015, except for the disclosures regarding the types and quality of financial assets pledged, which will become effective in the second quarter of 2015. The adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Firm’s Consolidated Financial Statements.
Revenue recognition – revenue from contracts with customers
In May 2014, the FASB issued revenue recognition guidance that is intended to create greater consistency with respect to how and when revenue from contracts with customers is shown in the statements of income. The guidance requires that revenue from contracts with customers be recognized upon delivery of a good or service based on the amount of consideration expected to be received, and requires additional disclosures about revenue. The guidance will be effective in the first quarter of 2017 and early adoption is prohibited. The Firm is currently evaluating the potential impact on the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Reporting discontinued operations and disclosures of disposals of components of an entity
In April 2014, the FASB issued guidance regarding the reporting of discontinued operations. The guidance changes the criteria for determining whether a disposition qualifies for discontinued operations presentation. It also requires enhanced disclosures about discontinued operations and significant dispositions that do not qualify to be presented as discontinued operations. The guidance will become effective in the first quarter of 2015. The adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Firm’s Consolidated Financial Statements.


166
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Investments in qualified affordable housing projects
In January 2014, the FASB issued guidance regarding the accounting for investments in affordable housing projects that qualify for the low-income housing tax credit. The guidance replaces the effective yield method and allows companies to make an accounting policy election to amortize the initial cost of its investments in proportion to the tax credits and other benefits received if certain criteria are met, and to present the amortization as a component of income tax expense. The guidance will become effective in the first quarter of 2015 and is required to be applied retrospectively, such that the Firm’s results of operations for prior periods will be revised to reflect the guidance.
The Firm intends to adopt the guidance for all qualifying investments. The adoption of this guidance is estimated to reduce retained earnings by approximately $230 million. The Firm expects that reported other income and income tax expense will each increase as a result of presenting the amortization of the initial cost of its investments as component of income tax expense. The amount of this increase in each period depends on the size and characteristics of the Firm’s portfolio of affordable housing investments; the estimated increase for 2014 is approximately $900 million. The effect of this guidance on the Firm’s net income is not expected to be material.





JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
167

Management’s discussion and analysis

NONEXCHANGE-TRADED COMMODITY DERIVATIVE CONTRACTS AT FAIR VALUE
In the normal course of business, JPMorgan Chase trades nonexchange-traded commodity derivative contracts. To determine the fair value of these contracts, the Firm uses various fair value estimation techniques, primarily based on internal models with significant observable market parameters. The Firm’s nonexchange-traded commodity derivative contracts are primarily energy-related.
The following table summarizes the changes in fair value for nonexchange-traded commodity derivative contracts for the year ended December 31, 2014.
Year ended December 31, 2014
(in millions)
Asset position
 
Liability position
Net fair value of contracts outstanding at January 1, 2014
$
8,128

 
$
9,929

Effect of legally enforceable master netting agreements
15,082

 
15,318

Gross fair value of contracts outstanding at January 1, 2014
23,210

 
25,247

Contracts realized or otherwise settled
(14,451
)
 
(15,557
)
Fair value of new contracts
13,954

 
15,664

Changes in fair values attributable to changes in valuation techniques and assumptions

 

Other changes in fair value
1,440

 
1,783

Gross fair value of contracts outstanding at December 31, 2014
24,153

 
27,137

Effect of legally enforceable master netting agreements
(14,327
)
 
(13,211
)
Net fair value of contracts outstanding at December 31, 2014
$
9,826

 
$
13,926

 
The following table indicates the maturities of nonexchange-traded commodity derivative contracts at December 31, 2014.
December 31, 2014 (in millions)
Asset position
 
Liability position
Maturity less than 1 year
$
15,635

 
$
16,376

Maturity 1–3 years
6,561

 
8,459

Maturity 4–5 years
1,230

 
1,790

Maturity in excess of 5 years
727

 
512

Gross fair value of contracts outstanding at December 31, 2014
24,153

 
27,137

Effect of legally enforceable master netting agreements
(14,327
)
 
(13,211
)
Net fair value of contracts outstanding at December 31, 2014
$
9,826

 
$
13,926




168
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
From time to time, the Firm has made and will make forward-looking statements. These statements can be identified by the fact that they do not relate strictly to historical or current facts. Forward-looking statements often use words such as “anticipate,” “target,” “expect,” “estimate,” “intend,” “plan,” “goal,” “believe,” or other words of similar meaning. Forward-looking statements provide JPMorgan Chase’s current expectations or forecasts of future events, circumstances, results or aspirations. JPMorgan Chase’s disclosures in this Annual Report contain forward-looking statements within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. The Firm also may make forward-looking statements in its other documents filed or furnished with the Securities and Exchange Commission. In addition, the Firm’s senior management may make forward-looking statements orally to investors, analysts, representatives of the media and others.
All forward-looking statements are, by their nature, subject to risks and uncertainties, many of which are beyond the Firm’s control. JPMorgan Chase’s actual future results may differ materially from those set forth in its forward-looking statements. While there is no assurance that any list of risks and uncertainties or risk factors is complete, below are certain factors which could cause actual results to differ from those in the forward-looking statements:
Local, regional and international business, economic and political conditions and geopolitical events;
Changes in laws and regulatory requirements;
Changes in trade, monetary and fiscal policies and laws;
Securities and capital markets behavior, including changes in market liquidity and volatility;
Changes in investor sentiment or consumer spending or savings behavior;
Ability of the Firm to manage effectively its capital and liquidity, including approval of its capital plans by banking regulators;
Changes in credit ratings assigned to the Firm or its subsidiaries;
Damage to the Firm’s reputation;
Ability of the Firm to deal effectively with an economic slowdown or other economic or market disruption;
Technology changes instituted by the Firm, its counterparties or competitors;
The success of the Firm’s business simplification initiatives and the effectiveness of its control agenda;
Ability of the Firm to develop new products and services, and the extent to which products or services previously sold by the Firm (including but not limited to mortgages and asset-backed securities) require the Firm to incur liabilities or absorb losses not contemplated at their initiation or origination;
 
Ability of the Firm to address enhanced regulatory requirements affecting its consumer businesses;
Acceptance of the Firm’s new and existing products and services by the marketplace and the ability of the Firm to increase market share;
Ability of the Firm to attract and retain qualified employees;
Ability of the Firm to control expense;
Competitive pressures;
Changes in the credit quality of the Firm’s customers and counterparties;
Adequacy of the Firm’s risk management framework, disclosure controls and procedures and internal control over financial reporting;
Adverse judicial or regulatory proceedings;
Changes in applicable accounting policies;
Ability of the Firm to determine accurate values of certain assets and liabilities;
Occurrence of natural or man-made disasters or calamities or conflicts;
Ability of the Firm to maintain the security of its financial, accounting, technology, data processing and other operating systems and facilities;
The other risks and uncertainties detailed in Part I, Item 1A: Risk Factors in the Firm’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2014.
Any forward-looking statements made by or on behalf of the Firm speak only as of the date they are made, and JPMorgan Chase does not undertake to update forward-looking statements to reflect the impact of circumstances or events that arise after the date the forward-looking statements were made. The reader should, however, consult any further disclosures of a forward-looking nature the Firm may make in any subsequent Annual Reports on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, or Current Reports on Form 8-K.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
169

Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting


Management of JPMorgan Chase & Co. (“JPMorgan Chase” or the “Firm”) is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. Internal control over financial reporting is a process designed by, or under the supervision of, the Firm’s principal executive and principal financial officers, or persons performing similar functions, and effected by JPMorgan Chase’s Board of Directors, management and other personnel, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.
JPMorgan Chase’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records, that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the Firm’s assets; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the Firm are being made only in accordance with authorizations of JPMorgan Chase’s management and directors; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the Firm’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. Management has completed an assessment of the effectiveness of the Firm’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014. In making the assessment, management used the framework in “Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013)” promulgated by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission, commonly referred to as the “COSO” criteria.
 
Based upon the assessment performed, management concluded that as of December 31, 2014, JPMorgan Chase’s internal control over financial reporting was effective based upon the COSO 2013 criteria. Additionally, based upon management’s assessment, the Firm determined that there were no material weaknesses in its internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014.
The effectiveness of the Firm’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014, has been audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report which appears herein.
James Dimon
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer

Marianne Lake
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer


February 24, 2015


170
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report

Report of independent registered public accounting firm

To the Board of Directors and Stockholders of JPMorgan Chase & Co.:
In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated balance sheets and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in stockholders’ equity and cash flows present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of JPMorgan Chase & Co. and its subsidiaries (the “Firm”) at December 31, 2014 and 2013 and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2014 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also in our opinion, the Firm maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2014 based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Firm’s management is responsible for these financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying “Management’s report on internal control over financial reporting”. Our responsibility is to express opinions on these financial statements and on the Firm’s internal control over financial reporting based on our integrated audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audits of the financial statements included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the
 
design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.


February 24, 2015










PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP Ÿ  300 Madison Avenue Ÿ  New York, NY 10017

JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
171

Consolidated statements of income




Year ended December 31, (in millions, except per share data)
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Revenue
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment banking fees
 
$
6,542

 
$
6,354

 
$
5,808

Principal transactions
 
10,531

 
10,141

 
5,536

Lending- and deposit-related fees
 
5,801

 
5,945

 
6,196

Asset management, administration and commissions
 
15,931

 
15,106

 
13,868

Securities gains(a)
 
77

 
667

 
2,110

Mortgage fees and related income
 
3,563

 
5,205

 
8,687

Card income
 
6,020

 
6,022

 
5,658

Other income
 
2,106

 
3,847

 
4,258

Noninterest revenue
 
50,571

 
53,287

 
52,121

Interest income
 
51,531

 
52,669

 
55,953

Interest expense
 
7,897

 
9,350

 
11,043

Net interest income
 
43,634

 
43,319

 
44,910

Total net revenue
 
94,205

 
96,606

 
97,031

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Provision for credit losses
 
3,139

 
225

 
3,385

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Noninterest expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
Compensation expense
 
30,160

 
30,810

 
30,585

Occupancy expense
 
3,909

 
3,693

 
3,925

Technology, communications and equipment expense
 
5,804

 
5,425

 
5,224

Professional and outside services
 
7,705

 
7,641

 
7,429

Marketing
 
2,550

 
2,500

 
2,577

Other expense
 
11,146

 
20,398

 
14,989

Total noninterest expense
 
61,274

 
70,467

 
64,729

Income before income tax expense
 
29,792

 
25,914

 
28,917

Income tax expense
 
8,030

 
7,991

 
7,633

Net income
 
$
21,762

 
$
17,923

 
$
21,284

Net income applicable to common stockholders
 
$
20,093

 
$
16,593

 
$
19,877

Net income per common share data
 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic earnings per share
 
$
5.34

 
$
4.39

 
$
5.22

Diluted earnings per share
 
5.29

 
4.35

 
5.20

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted-average basic shares
 
3,763.5

 
3,782.4

 
3,809.4

Weighted-average diluted shares
 
3,797.5

 
3,814.9

 
3,822.2

Cash dividends declared per common share
 
$
1.58

 
$
1.44

 
$
1.20

(a)
The following other-than-temporary impairment losses are included in securities gains for the periods presented.
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Debt securities the Firm does not intend to sell that have credit losses
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total other-than-temporary impairment losses
 
$
(2
)
 
$
(1
)
 
$
(113
)
Losses recorded in/(reclassified from) accumulated other comprehensive income
 

 

 
85

Total credit losses recognized in income
 
(2
)
 
(1
)
 
(28
)
Securities the Firm intends to sell
 
(2
)
 
(20
)
 
(15
)
Total other-than-temporary impairment losses recognized in income
 
$
(4
)
 
$
(21
)
 
$
(43
)
The Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements are an integral part of these statements.

172
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report

Consolidated statements of comprehensive income

Year ended December 31, (in millions)
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Net income
 
$
21,762

 
$
17,923

 
$
21,284

Other comprehensive income/(loss), after–tax
 
 
 
 
 
 
Unrealized gains/(losses) on investment securities
 
1,975

 
(4,070
)
 
3,303

Translation adjustments, net of hedges
 
(11
)
 
(41
)
 
(69
)
Cash flow hedges
 
44

 
(259
)
 
69

Defined benefit pension and OPEB plans
 
(1,018
)
 
1,467

 
(145
)
Total other comprehensive income/(loss), after–tax
 
990

 
(2,903
)
 
3,158

Comprehensive income
 
$
22,752

 
$
15,020

 
$
24,442

The Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements are an integral part of these statements.

JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
173

Consolidated balance sheets


December 31, (in millions, except share data)
2014
 
2013
Assets
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
$
27,831

 
$
39,771

Deposits with banks
484,477

 
316,051

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements (included $28,585 and $25,135 at fair value)
215,803

 
248,116

Securities borrowed (included $992 and $3,739 at fair value)
110,435

 
111,465

Trading assets (included assets pledged of $125,034 and $116,499)
398,988

 
374,664

Securities (included $298,752 and $329,977 at fair value and assets pledged of $24,912 and $23,446)
348,004

 
354,003

Loans (included $2,611 and $2,011 at fair value)
757,336

 
738,418

Allowance for loan losses
(14,185
)
 
(16,264
)
Loans, net of allowance for loan losses
743,151

 
722,154

Accrued interest and accounts receivable
70,079

 
65,160

Premises and equipment
15,133

 
14,891

Goodwill
47,647

 
48,081

Mortgage servicing rights
7,436

 
9,614

Other intangible assets
1,192

 
1,618

Other assets (included $12,366 and $15,187 at fair value and assets pledged of $1,396 and $2,066)
102,950

 
110,101

Total assets(a)
$
2,573,126

 
$
2,415,689

Liabilities
 
 
 
Deposits (included $8,807 and $6,624 at fair value)
$
1,363,427

 
$
1,287,765

Federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements (included $2,979 and $5,426 at fair value)
192,101

 
181,163

Commercial paper
66,344

 
57,848

Other borrowed funds (included $14,739 and $13,306 at fair value)
30,222

 
27,994

Trading liabilities
152,815

 
137,744

Accounts payable and other liabilities (included $36 and $25 at fair value)
206,954

 
194,491

Beneficial interests issued by consolidated variable interest entities (included $2,162 and $1,996 at fair value)
52,362

 
49,617

Long-term debt (included $30,226 and $28,878 at fair value)
276,836

 
267,889

Total liabilities(a)
2,341,061

 
2,204,511

Commitments and contingencies (see Notes 29, 30 and 31)


 


Stockholders’ equity
 
 
 
Preferred stock ($1 par value; authorized 200,000,000 shares: issued 2,006,250 and 1,115,750 shares)
20,063

 
11,158

Common stock ($1 par value; authorized 9,000,000,000 shares; issued 4,104,933,895 shares)
4,105

 
4,105

Additional paid-in capital
93,270

 
93,828

Retained earnings
130,315

 
115,756

Accumulated other comprehensive income
2,189

 
1,199

Shares held in RSU trust, at cost (472,953 and 476,642 shares)
(21
)
 
(21
)
Treasury stock, at cost (390,144,630 and 348,825,583 shares)
(17,856
)
 
(14,847
)
Total stockholders’ equity
232,065

 
211,178

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
$
2,573,126

 
$
2,415,689

(a)
The following table presents information on assets and liabilities related to VIEs that are consolidated by the Firm at December 31, 2014 and 2013. The difference between total VIE assets and liabilities represents the Firm’s interests in those entities, which were eliminated in consolidation.
December 31, (in millions)
2014
 
2013
Assets
 
 
 
Trading assets
$
9,090

 
$
6,366

Loans
68,880

 
70,072

All other assets
1,815

 
2,168

Total assets
$
79,785

 
$
78,606

Liabilities
 
 
 
Beneficial interests issued by consolidated variable interest entities
$
52,362

 
$
49,617

All other liabilities
949

 
1,061

Total liabilities
$
53,311

 
$
50,678

The assets of the consolidated VIEs are used to settle the liabilities of those entities. The holders of the beneficial interests do not have recourse to the general credit of JPMorgan Chase. At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm provided limited program-wide credit enhancement of $2.0 billion and $2.6 billion, respectively, related to its Firm-administered multi-seller conduits, which are eliminated in consolidation. For further discussion, see Note 16.
The Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements are an integral part of these statements.

174
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report

Consolidated statements of changes in stockholders’ equity

Year ended December 31, (in millions, except per share data)
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Preferred stock
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at January 1
 
$
11,158

 
$
9,058

 
$
7,800

Issuance of preferred stock
 
8,905

 
3,900

 
1,258

Redemption of preferred stock
 

 
(1,800
)
 

Balance at December 31
 
20,063

 
11,158

 
9,058

Common stock
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at January 1 and December 31
 
4,105

 
4,105

 
4,105

Additional paid-in capital
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at January 1
 
93,828

 
94,604

 
95,602

Shares issued and commitments to issue common stock for employee stock-based compensation awards, and related tax effects
 
(508
)
 
(752
)
 
(736
)
Other
 
(50
)
 
(24
)
 
(262
)
Balance at December 31
 
93,270

 
93,828

 
94,604

Retained earnings
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at January 1
 
115,756

 
104,223

 
88,315

Net income
 
21,762

 
17,923

 
21,284

Dividends declared:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock
 
(1,125
)
 
(805
)
 
(647
)
Common stock ($1.58, $1.44 and $1.20 per share for 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively)
 
(6,078
)
 
(5,585
)
 
(4,729
)
Balance at December 31
 
130,315

 
115,756

 
104,223

Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at January 1
 
1,199

 
4,102

 
944

Other comprehensive income/(loss)
 
990

 
(2,903
)
 
3,158

Balance at December 31
 
2,189

 
1,199

 
4,102

Shares held in RSU Trust, at cost
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at January 1
 
(21
)
 
(21
)
 
(38
)
Reissuance from RSU Trust
 

 

 
17

Balance at December 31
 
(21
)
 
(21
)
 
(21
)
Treasury stock, at cost
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at January 1
 
(14,847
)
 
(12,002
)
 
(13,155
)
Purchase of treasury stock
 
(4,760
)
 
(4,789
)
 
(1,415
)
Reissuance from treasury stock
 
1,751

 
1,944

 
2,574

Share repurchases related to employee stock-based compensation awards
 

 

 
(6
)
Balance at December 31
 
(17,856
)
 
(14,847
)
 
(12,002
)
Total stockholders equity
 
$
232,065

 
$
211,178

 
$
204,069

The Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements are an integral part of these statements.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
175

Consolidated statements of cash flows


Year ended December 31, (in millions)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
Net income
$
21,762

 
$
17,923

 
$
21,284

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by/(used in) operating activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Provision for credit losses
3,139

 
225

 
3,385

Depreciation and amortization
4,759

 
5,306

 
5,147

Deferred tax expense
4,210

 
8,003

 
1,130

Investment securities gains
(77
)
 
(667
)
 
(2,110
)
Stock-based compensation
2,190

 
2,219

 
2,545

Originations and purchases of loans held-for-sale
(67,525
)
 
(75,928
)
 
(34,026
)
Proceeds from sales, securitizations and paydowns of loans held-for-sale
71,407

 
73,566

 
33,202

Net change in:
 
 
 
 
 
Trading assets
(24,814
)
 
89,110

 
(5,379
)
Securities borrowed
1,020

 
7,562

 
23,455

Accrued interest and accounts receivable
(3,637
)
 
(2,340
)
 
1,732

Other assets
(9,166
)
 
526

 
(4,683
)
Trading liabilities
26,818

 
(9,772
)
 
(3,921
)
Accounts payable and other liabilities
6,065

 
(5,743
)
 
(13,069
)
Other operating adjustments
442

 
(2,037
)
 
(3,613
)
Net cash provided by operating activities
36,593

 
107,953

 
25,079

Investing activities
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in:
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits with banks
(168,426
)
 
(194,363
)
 
(36,595
)
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements
30,848

 
47,726

 
(60,821
)
Held-to-maturity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from paydowns and maturities
4,169

 
189

 
4

Purchases
(10,345
)
 
(24,214
)
 

Available-for-sale securities:
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from paydowns and maturities
90,664

 
89,631

 
112,633

Proceeds from sales
38,411

 
73,312

 
81,957

Purchases
(121,504
)
 
(130,266
)
 
(189,630
)
Proceeds from sales and securitizations of loans held-for-investment
20,115

 
12,033

 
6,430

Other changes in loans, net
(51,749
)
 
(23,721
)
 
(30,491
)
Net cash received from/(used in) business acquisitions or dispositions
843

 
(149
)
 
88

All other investing activities, net
1,338

 
(679
)
 
(3,400
)
Net cash used in investing activities
(165,636
)
 
(150,501
)
 
(119,825
)
Financing activities
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in:
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
89,346

 
81,476

 
67,250

Federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements
10,905

 
(58,867
)
 
26,546

Commercial paper and other borrowed funds
9,242

 
2,784

 
9,315

Beneficial interests issued by consolidated variable interest entities
(834
)
 
(10,433
)
 
345

Proceeds from long-term borrowings
78,515

 
83,546

 
86,271

Payments of long-term borrowings
(65,275
)
 
(60,497
)
 
(96,473
)
Excess tax benefits related to stock-based compensation
407

 
137

 
255

Proceeds from issuance of preferred stock
8,847

 
3,873

 
1,234

Redemption of preferred stock

 
(1,800
)
 

Treasury stock and warrants repurchased
(4,760
)
 
(4,789
)
 
(1,653
)
Dividends paid
(6,990
)
 
(6,056
)
 
(5,194
)
All other financing activities, net
(1,175
)
 
(1,050
)
 
(189
)
Net cash provided by financing activities
118,228

 
28,324

 
87,707

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and due from banks
(1,125
)
 
272

 
1,160

Net decrease in cash and due from banks
(11,940
)
 
(13,952
)
 
(5,879
)
Cash and due from banks at the beginning of the period
39,771

 
53,723

 
59,602

Cash and due from banks at the end of the period
$
27,831

 
$
39,771

 
$
53,723

Cash interest paid
$
8,194

 
$
9,573

 
$
11,161

Cash income taxes paid, net
1,392

 
3,502

 
2,050

The Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements are an integral part of these statements.



176
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report

Notes to consolidated financial statements


Note 1 – Basis of presentation
JPMorgan Chase & Co. (“JPMorgan Chase” or the “Firm”), a financial holding company incorporated under Delaware law in 1968, is a leading global financial services firm and one of the largest banking institutions in the United States of America (“U.S.”), with operations worldwide. The Firm is a leader in investment banking, financial services for consumers and small business, commercial banking, financial transaction processing and asset management. For a discussion of the Firm’s business segments, see Note 33.
The accounting and financial reporting policies of JPMorgan Chase and its subsidiaries conform to accounting principles generally accepted in the U.S. (“U.S. GAAP”). Additionally, where applicable, the policies conform to the accounting and reporting guidelines prescribed by regulatory authorities.
Certain amounts reported in prior periods have been reclassified to conform with the current presentation.
Consolidation
The Consolidated Financial Statements include the accounts of JPMorgan Chase and other entities in which the Firm has a controlling financial interest. All material intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated.
Assets held for clients in an agency or fiduciary capacity by the Firm are not assets of JPMorgan Chase and are not included on the Consolidated balance sheets.
The Firm determines whether it has a controlling financial interest in an entity by first evaluating whether the entity is a voting interest entity or a variable interest entity (“VIE”).
Voting Interest Entities
Voting interest entities are entities that have sufficient equity and provide the equity investors voting rights that enable them to make significant decisions relating to the entity’s operations. For these types of entities, the Firm’s determination of whether it has a controlling interest is primarily based on the amount of voting equity interests held. Entities in which the Firm has a controlling financial interest, through ownership of the majority of the entities’ voting equity interests, or through other contractual rights that give the Firm control, are consolidated by the Firm.
Investments in companies in which the Firm has significant influence over operating and financing decisions (but does not own a majority of the voting equity interests) are accounted for (i) in accordance with the equity method of accounting (which requires the Firm to recognize its proportionate share of the entity’s net earnings), or (ii) at fair value if the fair value option was elected. These investments are generally included in other assets, with income or loss included in other income.
Certain Firm-sponsored asset management funds are structured as limited partnerships or limited liability companies. For many of these entities, the Firm is the general partner or managing member, but the non-affiliated
 
partners or members have the ability to remove the Firm as the general partner or managing member without cause (i.e., kick-out rights), based on a simple majority vote, or the non-affiliated partners or members have rights to participate in important decisions. Accordingly, the Firm does not consolidate these funds. In the limited cases where the nonaffiliated partners or members do not have substantive kick-out or participating rights, the Firm consolidates the funds.
The Firm’s investment companies have investments in both publicly-held and privately-held entities, including investments in buyouts, growth equity and venture opportunities. These investments are accounted for under investment company guidelines and accordingly, irrespective of the percentage of equity ownership interests held, are carried on the Consolidated balance sheets at fair value, and are recorded in other assets.
Variable Interest Entities
VIEs are entities that, by design, either (1) lack sufficient equity to permit the entity to finance its activities without additional subordinated financial support from other parties, or (2) have equity investors that do not have the ability to make significant decisions relating to the entity’s operations through voting rights, or do not have the obligation to absorb the expected losses, or do not have the right to receive the residual returns of the entity.
The most common type of VIE is a special purpose entity (“SPE”). SPEs are commonly used in securitization transactions in order to isolate certain assets and distribute the cash flows from those assets to investors. The basic SPE structure involves a company selling assets to the SPE; the SPE funds the purchase of those assets by issuing securities to investors. The legal documents that govern the transaction specify how the cash earned on the assets must be allocated to the SPE’s investors and other parties that have rights to those cash flows. SPEs are generally structured to insulate investors from claims on the SPE’s assets by creditors of other entities, including the creditors of the seller of the assets.
The primary beneficiary of a VIE (i.e., the party that has a controlling financial interest) is required to consolidate the assets and liabilities of the VIE. The primary beneficiary is the party that has both (1) the power to direct the activities of the VIE that most significantly impact the VIE’s economic performance; and (2) through its interests in the VIE, the obligation to absorb losses or the right to receive benefits from the VIE that could potentially be significant to the VIE.
To assess whether the Firm has the power to direct the activities of a VIE that most significantly impact the VIE’s economic performance, the Firm considers all the facts and circumstances, including its role in establishing the VIE and its ongoing rights and responsibilities. This assessment includes, first, identifying the activities that most significantly impact the VIE’s economic performance; and second, identifying which party, if any, has power over those activities. In general, the parties that make the most


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
177

Notes to consolidated financial statements

significant decisions affecting the VIE (such as asset managers, collateral managers, servicers, or owners of call options or liquidation rights over the VIE’s assets) or have the right to unilaterally remove those decision-makers are deemed to have the power to direct the activities of a VIE.
To assess whether the Firm has the obligation to absorb losses of the VIE or the right to receive benefits from the VIE that could potentially be significant to the VIE, the Firm considers all of its economic interests, including debt and equity investments, servicing fees, and derivative or other arrangements deemed to be variable interests in the VIE. This assessment requires that the Firm apply judgment in determining whether these interests, in the aggregate, are considered potentially significant to the VIE. Factors considered in assessing significance include: the design of the VIE, including its capitalization structure; subordination of interests; payment priority; relative share of interests held across various classes within the VIE’s capital structure; and the reasons why the interests are held by the Firm.
The Firm performs on-going reassessments of: (1) whether entities previously evaluated under the majority voting-interest framework have become VIEs, based on certain events, and therefore subject to the VIE consolidation framework; and (2) whether changes in the facts and circumstances regarding the Firm’s involvement with a VIE cause the Firm’s consolidation conclusion to change.
In February 2010, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued an amendment which deferred the requirements of the accounting guidance for VIEs for certain investment funds, including mutual funds, private equity funds and hedge funds. For the funds to which the deferral applies, the Firm continues to apply other existing authoritative accounting guidance to determine whether such funds should be consolidated.
Use of estimates in the preparation of consolidated financial statements
The preparation of the Consolidated Financial Statements requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, revenue and expense, and disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities. Actual results could be different from these estimates.
 
Foreign currency translation
JPMorgan Chase revalues assets, liabilities, revenue and expense denominated in non-U.S. currencies into U.S. dollars using applicable exchange rates.
Gains and losses relating to translating functional currency financial statements for U.S. reporting are included in other comprehensive income/(loss) (“OCI”) within stockholders’ equity. Gains and losses relating to nonfunctional currency transactions, including non-U.S. operations where the functional currency is the U.S. dollar, are reported in the Consolidated statements of income.
Offsetting assets and liabilities
U.S. GAAP permits entities to present derivative receivables and derivative payables with the same counterparty and the related cash collateral receivables and payables on a net basis on the balance sheet when a legally enforceable master netting agreement exists. U.S. GAAP also permits securities sold and purchased under repurchase agreements to be presented net when specified conditions are met, including the existence of a legally enforceable master netting agreement. The Firm has elected to net such balances when the specified conditions are met.
The Firm uses master netting agreements to mitigate counterparty credit risk in certain transactions, including derivatives transactions, repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements, and securities borrowed and loaned agreements. A master netting agreement is a single contract with a counterparty that permits multiple transactions governed by that contract to be terminated and settled through a single payment in a single currency in the event of a default (e.g., bankruptcy, failure to make a required payment or securities transfer or deliver collateral or margin when due after expiration of any grace period). Upon the exercise of termination rights by the non-defaulting party (i) all transactions are terminated, (ii) all transactions are valued and the positive value or “in the money” transactions are netted against the negative value or “out of the money” transactions and (iii) the only remaining payment obligation is of one of the parties to pay the netted termination amount. Upon exercise of repurchase agreement and securities loaned default rights (i) all securities loan transactions are terminated and accelerated, (ii) all values of securities or cash held or to be delivered are calculated, and all such sums are netted against each other and (iii) the only remaining payment obligation is of one of the parties to pay the netted termination amount.


178
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Typical master netting agreements for these types of transactions also often contain a collateral/margin agreement that provides for a security interest in, or title transfer of, securities or cash collateral/margin to the party that has the right to demand margin (the “demanding party”). The collateral/margin agreement typically requires a party to transfer collateral/margin to the demanding party with a value equal to the amount of the margin deficit on a net basis across all transactions governed by the master netting agreement, less any threshold. The collateral/margin agreement grants to the demanding party, upon default by the counterparty, the right to set-off any amounts payable by the counterparty against any posted collateral or the cash equivalent of any posted collateral/margin. It also grants to the demanding party the right to liquidate collateral/margin and to apply the proceeds to an amount payable by the counterparty.
For further discussion of the Firm’s derivative instruments, see Note 6. For further discussion of the Firm’s repurchase and reverse repurchase agreements, and securities borrowing and lending agreements, see Note 13.
Statements of cash flows
For JPMorgan Chase’s Consolidated statements of cash flows, cash is defined as those amounts included in cash and due from banks.
Significant accounting policies
The following table identifies JPMorgan Chase’s other significant accounting policies and the Note and page where a detailed description of each policy can be found.
Fair value measurement
Note 3
 
Page 180
Fair value option
Note 4
 
Page 199
Derivative instruments
Note 6
 
Page 203
Noninterest revenue
Note 7
 
Page 216
Interest income and interest expense
Note 8
 
Page 218
Pension and other postretirement employee benefit plans
Note 9
 
Page 218
Employee stock-based incentives
Note 10
 
Page 228
Securities
Note 12
 
Page 230
Securities financing activities
Note 13
 
Page 235
Loans
Note 14
 
Page 238
Allowance for credit losses
Note 15
 
Page 258
Variable interest entities
Note 16
 
Page 262
Goodwill and other intangible assets
Note 17
 
Page 271
Premises and equipment
Note 18
 
Page 276
Long-term debt
Note 21
 
Page 277
Income taxes
Note 26
 
Page 282
Off–balance sheet lending-related financial instruments, guarantees and other commitments
Note 29
 
Page 287
Litigation
Note 31
 
Page 295

 
Note 2 – Business changes and developments
Subsequent events
As part of the Firm’s business simplification agenda, the sale of a portion of the Private Equity Business (“Private Equity sale”) was completed on January 9, 2015. Concurrent with the sale, a new independent management company was formed by the former One Equity Partners (“OEP”) investment professionals. The new management company will provide investment management services to the acquirer of the investments sold in the Private Equity sale and for the portion of private equity investments retained by the Firm. Upon closing, this transaction did not have a material impact on the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets or its results of operations.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
179

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Note 3 – Fair value measurement
JPMorgan Chase carries a portion of its assets and liabilities at fair value. These assets and liabilities are predominantly carried at fair value on a recurring basis (i.e., assets and liabilities that are measured and reported at fair value on the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets). Certain assets (e.g., certain mortgage, home equity and other loans where the carrying value is based on the fair value of the underlying collateral), liabilities and unfunded lending-related commitments are measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis; that is, they are not measured at fair value on an ongoing basis but are subject to fair value adjustments only in certain circumstances (for example, when there is evidence of impairment).
Fair value is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. Fair value is based on quoted market prices, where available. If listed prices or quotes are not available, fair value is based on models that consider relevant transaction characteristics (such as maturity) and use as inputs observable or unobservable market parameters, including but not limited to yield curves, interest rates, volatilities, equity or debt prices, foreign exchange rates and credit curves. Valuation adjustments may be made to ensure that financial instruments are recorded at fair value, as described below.
The level of precision in estimating unobservable market inputs or other factors can affect the amount of gain or loss recorded for a particular position. Furthermore, while the Firm believes its valuation methods are appropriate and consistent with those of other market participants, the methods and assumptions used reflect management judgment and may vary across the Firm’s businesses and portfolios.
The Firm uses various methodologies and assumptions in the determination of fair value. The use of different methodologies or assumptions to those used by the Firm could result in a different estimate of fair value at the reporting date.
Valuation process
Risk-taking functions are responsible for providing fair value estimates for assets and liabilities carried on the Consolidated balance sheets at fair value. The Firm’s valuation control function, which is part of the Firm’s Finance function and independent of the risk-taking functions, is responsible for verifying these estimates and determining any fair value adjustments that may be required to ensure that the Firm’s positions are recorded at fair value. In addition, the Firm has a firmwide Valuation Governance Forum (“VGF”) comprised of senior finance and risk executives to oversee the management of risks arising from valuation activities conducted across the Firm. The VGF is chaired by the Firmwide head of the valuation control function, and also includes sub-forums for the Corporate & Investment Bank (“CIB”), Mortgage Banking, (part of
 
Consumer & Community Banking) and certain corporate functions including Treasury and Chief Investment Office (“CIO”).
The valuation control function verifies fair value estimates provided by the risk-taking functions by leveraging independently derived prices, valuation inputs and other market data, where available. Where independent prices or inputs are not available, additional review is performed by the valuation control function to ensure the reasonableness of the estimates, and may include: evaluating the limited market activity including client unwinds; benchmarking of valuation inputs to those for similar instruments; decomposing the valuation of structured instruments into individual components; comparing expected to actual cash flows; reviewing profit and loss trends; and reviewing trends in collateral valuation. In addition there are additional levels of management review for more significant or complex positions.
The valuation control function determines any valuation adjustments that may be required to the estimates provided by the risk-taking functions. No adjustments are applied to the quoted market price for instruments classified within level 1 of the fair value hierarchy (see below for further information on the fair value hierarchy). For other positions, judgment is required to assess the need for valuation adjustments to appropriately reflect liquidity considerations, unobservable parameters, and, for certain portfolios that meet specified criteria, the size of the net open risk position. The determination of such adjustments follows a consistent framework across the Firm:
Liquidity valuation adjustments are considered where an observable external price or valuation parameter exists but is of lower reliability, potentially due to lower market activity. Liquidity valuation adjustments are applied and determined based on current market conditions. Factors that may be considered in determining the liquidity adjustment include analysis of: (1) the estimated bid-offer spread for the instrument being traded; (2) alternative pricing points for similar instruments in active markets; and (3) the range of reasonable values that the price or parameter could take.
The Firm manages certain portfolios of financial instruments on the basis of net open risk exposure and, as permitted by U.S. GAAP, has elected to estimate the fair value of such portfolios on the basis of a transfer of the entire net open risk position in an orderly transaction. Where this is the case, valuation adjustments may be necessary to reflect the cost of exiting a larger-than-normal market-size net open risk position. Where applied, such adjustments are based on factors that a relevant market participant would consider in the transfer of the net open risk position including the size of the adverse market move that is likely to occur during the period required to reduce the net open risk position to a normal market-size.


180
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Unobservable parameter valuation adjustments may be made when positions are valued using prices or input parameters to valuation models that are unobservable due to a lack of market activity or because they cannot be implied from observable market data. Such prices or parameters must be estimated and are, therefore, subject to management judgment. Unobservable parameter valuation adjustments are applied to reflect the uncertainty inherent in the resulting valuation estimate.
Where appropriate, the Firm also applies adjustments to its estimates of fair value in order to appropriately reflect counterparty credit quality, the Firm’s own creditworthiness and the impact of funding, applying a consistent framework across the Firm. For more information on such adjustments see Credit and funding adjustments on pages 196–197 of this Note.
Valuation model review and approval
If prices or quotes are not available for an instrument or a similar instrument, fair value is generally determined using valuation models that consider relevant transaction data such as maturity and use as inputs market-based or independently sourced parameters. Where this is the case the price verification process described above is applied to the inputs to those models.
The Model Risk function is independent of the model owners and reviews and approves a wide range of models, including risk management, valuation and certain regulatory capital models used by the Firm. The Model Risk function is part of the Firm’s Model Risk and Development unit, and the Firmwide Model Risk and Development Executive reports to the Firm’s CRO. When reviewing a model, the Model Risk function analyzes and challenges the model methodology and the reasonableness of model assumptions and may perform or require additional testing, including back-testing of model outcomes.
New significant valuation models, as well as material changes to existing valuation models, are reviewed and approved prior to implementation except where specified conditions are met. The Model Risk function performs an annual firmwide model risk assessment where developments in the product or market are considered in determining whether valuation models which have already been reviewed need to be reviewed and approved again.
 
Valuation hierarchy
A three-level valuation hierarchy has been established under U.S. GAAP for disclosure of fair value measurements. The valuation hierarchy is based on the transparency of inputs to the valuation of an asset or liability as of the measurement date. The three levels are defined as follows.
Level 1 – inputs to the valuation methodology are quoted prices (unadjusted) for identical assets or liabilities in active markets.
Level 2 – inputs to the valuation methodology include quoted prices for similar assets and liabilities in active markets, and inputs that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly, for substantially the full term of the financial instrument.
Level 3 – one or more inputs to the valuation methodology are unobservable and significant to the fair value measurement.
A financial instrument’s categorization within the valuation hierarchy is based on the lowest level of input that is significant to the fair value measurement.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
181

Notes to consolidated financial statements

The following table describes the valuation methodologies used by the Firm to measure its more significant products/instruments at fair value, including the general classification of such instruments pursuant to the valuation hierarchy.
 
Product/instrument
 Valuation methodology
Classifications in the valuation hierarchy
 
Securities financing agreements
Valuations are based on discounted cash flows, which consider:
Level 2
 
 • Derivative features. For further information refer to the
   discussion of derivatives below.
 
 • Market rates for the respective maturity
 
 • Collateral
 
Loans and lending-related commitments - wholesale
 
 
Trading portfolio
Where observable market data is available, valuations are based on:
Level 2 or 3
 
 
 • Observed market prices (circumstances are infrequent)
 
 
 
 • Relevant broker quotes
 
 
 
 • Observed market prices for similar instruments
 
 
 
Where observable market data is unavailable or limited, valuations are based on discounted cash flows, which consider the following:
 
 
 
• Yield
 
 
 
• Lifetime credit losses
 
 
 
• Loss severity
 
 
 
• Prepayment speed
 
 
 
• Servicing costs
 
 
Loans held for investment and associated lending-related commitments
Valuations are based on discounted cash flows, which consider:
Predominantly level 3
 
• Credit spreads, derived from the cost of credit default swaps (“CDS”); or benchmark credit curves developed by the Firm, by industry and credit rating, and which take into account the difference in loss severity rates between bonds and loans
 
 
 
 
• Prepayment speed
 
 
 
Lending-related commitments are valued similar to loans and reflect the portion of an unused commitment expected, based on the Firm’s average portfolio historical experience, to become funded prior to an obligor default
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
For information regarding the valuation of loans measured at collateral value, see Note 14.
 
 
 
 
 
Loans - consumer
 
 
 
Held for investment consumer loans, excluding credit card
Valuations are based on discounted cash flows, which consider:
Predominantly level 3
 
• Discount rates (derived from primary origination rates and market activity)
 
 
 
 
• Expected lifetime credit losses (considering expected and current default rates for existing portfolios, collateral prices, and economic environment expectations (e.g., unemployment rates))
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 Estimated prepayments
 
 
 
 Servicing costs
 
 
 
• Market liquidity
 
 
 
For information regarding the valuation of loans measured at collateral value, see Note 14.
 
 
 
 
 
Held for investment credit card receivables
Valuations are based on discounted cash flows, which consider:
Level 3
 
• Projected interest income and late fee revenue, servicing and credit costs, and loan repayment rates
 
 
 
 
• Estimated life of receivables (based on projected loan payment rates)
 
 
• Discount rate - based on cost of funding and expected return on receivables
 
 
 
• Credit costs - allowance for loan losses is considered a reasonable proxy for the credit cost based on the short-term nature of credit card receivables
 
 
Trading loans - Conforming residential mortgage loans expected to be sold
Fair value is based upon observable prices for mortgage-backed securities with similar collateral and incorporates adjustments to these prices to account for differences between the securities and the value of the underlying loans, which include credit characteristics, portfolio composition, and liquidity.
Predominantly level 2
 
 
 
 
 
 

182
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Product/instrument
Valuation methodology, inputs and assumptions
Classifications in the valuation hierarchy
Securities
Quoted market prices are used where available.
Level 1
 
In the absence of quoted market prices, securities are valued based on:
Level 2 or 3
 
• Observable market prices for similar securities
 
 
 Relevant broker quotes
 
 
 Discounted cash flows
 
 
In addition, the following inputs to discounted cash flows are used for the following products:
 
 
Mortgage- and asset-backed securities specific inputs:
 
 
 Collateral characteristics
 
 
• Deal-specific payment and loss allocations
 
 
• Current market assumptions related to yield, prepayment speed, conditional default rates and loss severity
 
 
Collateralized loan obligations (“CLOs”), specific inputs:
 
 
 Collateral characteristics
 
 
 Deal-specific payment and loss allocations
 
 
 Expected prepayment speed, conditional default rates, loss severity
 
 
 Credit spreads
 
 
• Credit rating data
 
Physical commodities
Valued using observable market prices or data
Predominantly Level 1 and 2
Derivatives
Exchange-traded derivatives that are actively traded and valued using the exchange price, and over-the-counter contracts where quoted prices are available in an active market.
Level 1
 
Derivatives that are valued using models such as the Black-Scholes option pricing model, simulation models, or a combination of models, that use observable or unobservable valuation inputs (e.g., plain vanilla options and interest rate and credit default swaps). Inputs include:
Level 2 or 3
 
 
 
 
 Contractual terms including the period to maturity
 
 
 Readily observable parameters including interest rates and volatility
 
 
 Credit quality of the counterparty and of the Firm
 
 
 Market funding levels
 
 
 Correlation levels
 
 
In addition, the following specific inputs are used for the following derivatives that are valued based on models with significant unobservable inputs:
 
 
Structured credit derivatives specific inputs include:
 
 
 CDS spreads and recovery rates
 
 
 Credit correlation between the underlying debt instruments (levels are modeled on a transaction basis and calibrated to liquid benchmark tranche indices)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 Actual transactions, where available, are used to regularly recalibrate unobservable parameters
 
 
 
 
Certain long-dated equity option specific inputs include:
 
 
 Long-dated equity volatilities
 
 
Certain interest rate and foreign exchange (“FX) exotic options specific inputs include:
 
 
 Interest rate correlation
 
 
 Interest rate spread volatility
 
 
 Foreign exchange correlation
 
 
 Correlation between interest rates and foreign exchange rates
 
 
 Parameters describing the evolution of underlying interest rates
 
 
Certain commodity derivatives specific inputs include:
 
 
 Commodity volatility
 
 
• Forward commodity price
 
 
Additionally, adjustments are made to reflect counterparty credit quality (credit valuation adjustments or “CVA”), the Firm’s own creditworthiness (debit valuation adjustments or “DVA”), and funding valuation adjustment (“FVA”) to incorporate the impact of funding. See pages 196197 of this Note.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
183

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 
Product/instrument
Valuation methodology, inputs and assumptions
Classification in the valuation hierarchy
 
Mortgage servicing rights (“MSRs”)
See Mortgage servicing rights in Note 17.
Level 3
 
 
 
Private equity direct investments
Private equity direct investments
Level 2 or 3
 
 
Fair value is estimated using all available information and considering the range of potential inputs, including:



 
 
 Transaction prices
 
 
 
 Trading multiples of comparable public companies
 
 
 
• Operating performance of the underlying portfolio company
 
 
 
 Additional available inputs relevant to the investment
 
 
 
 Adjustments as required, since comparable public companies are not identical to the company being valued, and for company-specific issues and lack of liquidity
 
 
 
Public investments held in the Private Equity portfolio
Level 1 or 2
 
 
 Valued using observable market prices less adjustments for relevant restrictions, where applicable
 
 
 
 
 
Fund investments (i.e., mutual/collective investment funds, private equity funds, hedge funds, and real estate funds)
Net asset value (“NAV”)
 
 
 NAV is validated by sufficient level of observable activity (i.e., purchases and sales)
Level 1
 
 
 
 Adjustments to the NAV as required, for restrictions on redemption (e.g., lock up periods or withdrawal limitations) or where observable activity is limited
Level 2 or 3
 
 
 
 
Beneficial interests issued by consolidated VIEs
Valued using observable market information, where available
Level 2 or 3
 
In the absence of observable market information, valuations are based on the fair value of the underlying assets held by the VIE
 
 
Long-term debt, not carried at fair value
Valuations are based on discounted cash flows, which consider:
Predominantly level 2
 
  Market rates for respective maturity
 
 
• The Firm’s own creditworthiness (DVA). See pages 196-197 of this Note.
 
Structured notes (included in deposits, other borrowed funds and long-term debt)
• Valuations are based on discounted cash flow analyses that consider the embedded derivative and the terms and payment structure of the note.
• The embedded derivative features are considered using models such as the Black-Scholes option pricing model, simulation models, or a combination of models that use observable or unobservable valuation inputs, depending on the embedded derivative. The specific inputs used vary according to the nature of the embedded derivative features, as described in the discussion above regarding derivative valuation. Adjustments are then made to this base valuation to reflect the Firm’s own creditworthiness (DVA) and to incorporate the impact of funding (FVA). See pages 196197 of this Note.
Level 2 or 3
 
 
 
 




184
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The following table presents the asset and liabilities reported at fair value as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, by major product category and fair value hierarchy.
Assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis

 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value hierarchy
 
 
 
December 31, 2014 (in millions)
Level 1
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Derivative netting adjustments
Total fair value
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements
$

$
28,585

 
$

 
$

$
28,585

Securities borrowed

992

 

 

992

Trading assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt instruments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. government agencies(a)
14

31,904

 
922

 

32,840

Residential – nonagency

1,381

 
663

 

2,044

Commercial – nonagency

927

 
306

 

1,233

Total mortgage-backed securities
14

34,212

 
1,891

 

36,117

U.S. Treasury and government agencies(a)
17,816

8,460

 

 

26,276

Obligations of U.S. states and municipalities

9,298

 
1,273

 

10,571

Certificates of deposit, bankers’ acceptances and commercial paper

1,429

 

 

1,429

Non-U.S. government debt securities
25,854

27,294

 
302

 

53,450

Corporate debt securities

28,099

 
2,989

 

31,088

Loans(b)

23,080

 
13,287

 

36,367

Asset-backed securities

3,088

 
1,264

 

4,352

Total debt instruments
43,684

134,960

 
21,006

 

199,650

Equity securities
104,890

748

 
431

 

106,069

Physical commodities(c)
2,739

1,741

 
2

 

4,482

Other

8,762

 
1,050

 

9,812

Total debt and equity instruments(d)
151,313

146,211

 
22,489

 

320,013

Derivative receivables:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate
473

951,901

 
4,149

 
(922,798
)
33,725

Credit

73,853

 
2,989

 
(75,004
)
1,838

Foreign exchange
758

205,887

 
2,276

 
(187,668
)
21,253

Equity

44,240

 
2,552

 
(38,615
)
8,177

Commodity
247

42,807

 
599

 
(29,671
)
13,982

Total derivative receivables(e)
1,478

1,318,688

 
12,565

 
(1,253,756
)
78,975

Total trading assets
152,791

1,464,899

 
35,054

 
(1,253,756
)
398,988

Available-for-sale securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. government agencies(a)

65,319

 

 

65,319

Residential – nonagency

50,865

 
30

 

50,895

Commercial – nonagency

21,009

 
99

 

21,108

Total mortgage-backed securities

137,193

 
129

 

137,322

U.S. Treasury and government agencies(a)
13,591

54

 

 

13,645

Obligations of U.S. states and municipalities

30,068

 

 

30,068

Certificates of deposit

1,103

 

 

1,103

Non-U.S. government debt securities
24,074

28,669

 

 

52,743

Corporate debt securities

18,532

 

 

18,532

Asset-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Collateralized loan obligations

29,402

 
792

 

30,194

Other

12,499

 
116

 

12,615

Equity securities
2,530


 

 

2,530

Total available-for-sale securities
40,195

257,520

 
1,037

 

298,752

Loans

70

 
2,541

 

2,611

Mortgage servicing rights


 
7,436

 

7,436

Other assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Private equity investments(f)
648

2,624

 
2,475

 

5,747

All other
4,018

230

 
2,371

 

6,619

Total other assets
4,666

2,854

 
4,846

 

12,366

Total assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis
$
197,652

$
1,754,920

(g) 
$
50,914

(g) 
$
(1,253,756
)
$
749,730

Deposits
$

$
5,948

 
$
2,859

 
$

$
8,807

Federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements

2,979

 

 

2,979

Other borrowed funds

13,286

 
1,453

 

14,739

Trading liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 


Debt and equity instruments(d)
62,914

18,713

 
72

 

81,699

Derivative payables:
 
 
 
 
 
 


Interest rate
499

920,623

 
3,523

 
(906,900
)
17,745

Credit

73,095

 
2,800

 
(74,302
)
1,593

Foreign exchange
746

214,800

 
2,802

 
(195,378
)
22,970

Equity

46,228

 
4,337

 
(38,825
)
11,740

Commodity
141

44,318

 
1,164

 
(28,555
)
17,068

Total derivative payables(e)
1,386

1,299,064

 
14,626

 
(1,243,960
)
71,116

Total trading liabilities
64,300

1,317,777

 
14,698

 
(1,243,960
)
152,815

Accounts payable and other liabilities


 
36

 

36

Beneficial interests issued by consolidated VIEs

1,016

 
1,146

 

2,162

Long-term debt

18,349

 
11,877

 

30,226

Total liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis
$
64,300

$
1,359,355

 
$
32,069

 
$
(1,243,960
)
$
211,764


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
185

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 
Fair value hierarchy
 
 
 
December 31, 2013 (in millions)
Level 1
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Derivative netting adjustments
Total fair value
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements
$

$
25,135

 
$

 
$

$
25,135

Securities borrowed

3,739

 

 

3,739

Trading assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt instruments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. government agencies(a)
4

25,582

 
1,005

 

26,591

Residential – nonagency

1,749

 
726

 

2,475

Commercial – nonagency

871

 
432

 

1,303

Total mortgage-backed securities
4

28,202

 
2,163

 

30,369

U.S. Treasury and government agencies(a)
14,933

10,547

 

 

25,480

Obligations of U.S. states and municipalities

6,538

 
1,382

 

7,920

Certificates of deposit, bankers’ acceptances and commercial paper

3,071

 

 

3,071

Non-U.S. government debt securities
25,762

22,379

 
143

 

48,284

Corporate debt securities(h)

24,802

 
5,920

 

30,722

Loans(b)

17,331

 
13,455

 

30,786

Asset-backed securities

3,647

 
1,272

 

4,919

Total debt instruments
40,699

116,517

 
24,335

 

181,551

Equity securities
107,667

954

 
885

 

109,506

Physical commodities(c)
4,968

5,217

 
4

 

10,189

Other

5,659

 
2,000

 

7,659

Total debt and equity instruments(d)
153,334

128,347

 
27,224

 

308,905

Derivative receivables:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate
419

848,862

 
5,398

 
(828,897
)
25,782

Credit

79,754

 
3,766

 
(82,004
)
1,516

Foreign exchange
434

151,521

 
1,644

 
(136,809
)
16,790

Equity

45,892

 
7,039

 
(40,704
)
12,227

Commodity
320

34,696

 
722

 
(26,294
)
9,444

Total derivative receivables(e)
1,173

1,160,725

 
18,569

 
(1,114,708
)
65,759

Total trading assets
154,507

1,289,072

 
45,793

 
(1,114,708
)
374,664

Available-for-sale securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. government agencies(a)

77,815

 

 

77,815

Residential – nonagency

61,760

 
709

 

62,469

Commercial – nonagency

15,900

 
525

 

16,425

Total mortgage-backed securities

155,475

 
1,234

 

156,709

U.S. Treasury and government agencies(a)
21,091

298

 

 

21,389

Obligations of U.S. states and municipalities

29,461

 

 

29,461

Certificates of deposit

1,041

 

 

1,041

Non-U.S. government debt securities
25,648

30,600

 

 

56,248

Corporate debt securities

21,512

 

 

21,512

Asset-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Collateralized loan obligations

27,409

 
821

 

28,230

Other

11,978

 
267

 

12,245

Equity securities
3,142


 

 

3,142

Total available-for-sale securities
49,881

277,774

 
2,322

 

329,977

Loans

80

 
1,931

 

2,011

Mortgage servicing rights


 
9,614

 

9,614

Other assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Private equity investments(f)
606

429

 
6,474

 

7,509

All other
4,213

289

 
3,176

 

7,678

Total other assets
4,819

718

 
9,650

 

15,187

Total assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis
$
209,207

$
1,596,518

(g) 
$
69,310

(g) 
$
(1,114,708
)
$
760,327

Deposits
$

$
4,369

 
$
2,255

 
$

$
6,624

Federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements

5,426

 

 

5,426

Other borrowed funds

11,232

 
2,074

 

13,306

Trading liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt and equity instruments(d)
61,262

19,055

 
113

 

80,430

Derivative payables:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate
321

822,014

 
3,019

 
(812,071
)
13,283

Credit

78,731

 
3,671

 
(80,121
)
2,281

Foreign exchange
443

156,838

 
2,844

 
(144,178
)
15,947

Equity

46,552

 
8,102

 
(39,935
)
14,719

Commodity
398

36,609

 
607

 
(26,530
)
11,084

Total derivative payables(e)
1,162

1,140,744

 
18,243

 
(1,102,835
)
57,314

Total trading liabilities
62,424

1,159,799

 
18,356

 
(1,102,835
)
137,744

Accounts payable and other liabilities


 
25

 

25

Beneficial interests issued by consolidated VIEs

756

 
1,240

 

1,996

Long-term debt

18,870

 
10,008

 

28,878

Total liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis
$
62,424

$
1,200,452

 
$
33,958

 
$
(1,102,835
)
$
193,999

(a)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, included total U.S. government-sponsored enterprise obligations of $84.1 billion and $91.5 billion, respectively, which were predominantly mortgage-related.
(b)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, included within trading loans were $17.0 billion and $14.8 billion, respectively, of residential first-lien mortgages, and $5.8 billion and $2.1 billion, respectively, of commercial first-lien mortgages. Residential mortgage loans include conforming mortgage loans originated with the intent to sell to U.S. government agencies of $7.7 billion and $6.0 billion, respectively, and reverse mortgages of $3.4 billion and $3.6 billion, respectively.

186
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



(c)
Physical commodities inventories are generally accounted for at the lower of cost or market. “Market” is a term defined in U.S. GAAP as not exceeding fair value less costs to sell (“transaction costs”). Transaction costs for the Firm’s physical commodities inventories are either not applicable or immaterial to the value of the inventory. Therefore, market approximates fair value for the Firm’s physical commodities inventories. When fair value hedging has been applied (or when market is below cost), the carrying value of physical commodities approximates fair value, because under fair value hedge accounting, the cost basis is adjusted for changes in fair value. For a further discussion of the Firm’s hedge accounting relationships, see Note 6. To provide consistent fair value disclosure information, all physical commodities inventories have been included in each period presented.
(d)
Balances reflect the reduction of securities owned (long positions) by the amount of identical securities sold but not yet purchased (short positions).
(e)
As permitted under U.S. GAAP, the Firm has elected to net derivative receivables and derivative payables and the related cash collateral received and paid when a legally enforceable master netting agreement exists. For purposes of the tables above, the Firm does not reduce derivative receivables and derivative payables balances for this netting adjustment, either within or across the levels of the fair value hierarchy, as such netting is not relevant to a presentation based on the transparency of inputs to the valuation of an asset or liability. Therefore, the balances reported in the fair value hierarchy table are gross of any counterparty netting adjustments. However, if the Firm were to net such balances within level 3, the reduction in the level 3 derivative receivables and payables balances would be $2.5 billion and $7.6 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively; this is exclusive of the netting benefit associated with cash collateral, which would further reduce the level 3 balances.
(f)
Private equity instruments represent investments within the Corporate line of business. The cost basis of the private equity investment portfolio totaled $6.0 billion and $8.0 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
(g)
Includes investments in hedge funds, private equity funds, real estate and other funds that do not have readily determinable fair values. The Firm uses net asset value per share when measuring the fair value of these investments. At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the fair values of these investments were $1.8 billion and $3.2 billion, respectively, of which $337 million and $899 million, respectively were classified in level 2, and $1.4 billion and $2.3 billion, respectively, in level 3.

Transfers between levels for instruments carried at fair value on a recurring basis
For the year ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, there were no significant transfers between levels 1 and 2.
During the year ended December 31, 2014, transfers from level 3 to level 2 included the following:
$4.3 billion and $4.4 billion of gross equity derivative receivables and payables, respectively, due to increased observability of certain equity option valuation inputs;
$2.7 billion of trading loans, $2.6 billion of margin loans, $2.3 billion of private equity investments, $2.0 billion of corporate debt, and $1.3 billion of long-term debt, based on increased liquidity and price transparency.
Transfers from level 2 into level 3 included $1.1 billion of other borrowed funds, $1.1 billion of trading loans and $1.0 billion of long-term debt, based on a decrease in observability of valuation inputs and price transparency.
During the year ended December 31, 2013, transfers from level 3 to level 2 included certain highly rated CLOs, including $27.4 billion held in the Firms available-for-sale (“AFS”) securities portfolio and $1.4 billion held in the trading portfolio, based on increased liquidity and price transparency; and $1.3 billion of long-term debt, largely driven by an increase in observability of certain equity structured notes. Transfers from level 2 to level 3 included $1.4 billion of corporate debt securities in the trading portfolio largely driven by a decrease in observability for certain credit instruments.
For the year ended December 31, 2012, $113.9 billion of settled U.S. government agency mortgage-backed securities were transferred from level 1 to level 2. While the U.S. government agency mortgage-backed securities market remained highly liquid and transparent, the transfer reflected greater market price differentiation between settled securities based on certain underlying loan specific factors. There were no significant transfers from level 2 to level 1 for the year ended December 31, 2012.
 
For the year ended December 31, 2012, there were no significant transfers from level 2 into level 3. For the year ended December 31, 2012, transfers from level 3 into level 2 included $1.2 billion of derivative payables based on increased observability of certain structured equity derivatives; and $1.8 billion of long-term debt due to increased observability of certain equity structured notes.
All transfers are assumed to occur at the beginning of the quarterly reporting period in which they occur.




JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
187

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Level 3 valuations
The Firm has established well-documented processes for determining fair value, including for instruments where fair value is estimated using significant unobservable inputs (level 3). For further information on the Firm’s valuation process and a detailed discussion of the determination of fair value for individual financial instruments, see pages 181–184 of this Note.
Estimating fair value requires the application of judgment. The type and level of judgment required is largely dependent on the amount of observable market information available to the Firm. For instruments valued using internally developed models that use significant unobservable inputs and are therefore classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy, judgments used to estimate fair value are more significant than those required when estimating the fair value of instruments classified within levels 1 and 2.
In arriving at an estimate of fair value for an instrument within level 3, management must first determine the appropriate model to use. Second, due to the lack of observability of significant inputs, management must assess all relevant empirical data in deriving valuation inputs including, but not limited to, transaction details, yield curves, interest rates, prepayment speed, default rates, volatilities, correlations, equity or debt prices, valuations of comparable instruments, foreign exchange rates and credit curves.
The following table presents the Firm’s primary level 3 financial instruments, the valuation techniques used to measure the fair value of those financial instruments, the significant unobservable inputs, the range of values for those inputs and, for certain instruments, the weighted averages of such inputs. While the determination to classify an instrument within level 3 is based on the significance of the unobservable inputs to the overall fair value measurement, level 3 financial instruments typically include observable components (that is, components that are actively quoted and can be validated to external sources) in addition to the unobservable components. The level 1 and/or level 2 inputs are not included in the table. In addition, the Firm manages the risk of the observable components of level 3 financial instruments using securities and derivative
 
positions that are classified within levels 1 or 2 of the fair value hierarchy.
The range of values presented in the table is representative of the highest and lowest level input used to value the significant groups of instruments within a product/instrument classification. Where provided, the weighted averages of the input values presented in the table are calculated based on the fair value of the instruments that the input is being used to value.
In the Firm’s view, the input range and the weighted average value do not reflect the degree of input uncertainty or an assessment of the reasonableness of the Firm’s estimates and assumptions. Rather, they reflect the characteristics of the various instruments held by the Firm and the relative distribution of instruments within the range of characteristics. For example, two option contracts may have similar levels of market risk exposure and valuation uncertainty, but may have significantly different implied volatility levels because the option contracts have different underlyings, tenors, or strike prices. The input range and weighted average values will therefore vary from period-to-period and parameter to parameter based on the characteristics of the instruments held by the Firm at each balance sheet date.
For the Firm’s derivatives and structured notes positions classified within level 3, the equity and interest rate correlation inputs used in estimating fair value were concentrated at the upper end of the range presented, while the credit correlation inputs were distributed across the range presented and the foreign exchange correlation inputs were concentrated at the lower end of the range presented. In addition, the interest rate volatility inputs used in estimating fair value were concentrated at the upper end of the range presented and the foreign exchange correlation inputs were concentrated at the lower end of the range presented. The equity volatility is concentrated in the lower half end of the range. The forward commodity prices used in estimating the fair value of commodity derivatives were concentrated within the lower end of the range presented.



188
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Level 3 inputs(a)
 
December 31, 2014 (in millions, except for ratios and basis points)
 
 
 
 
 
Product/Instrument
Fair value
 
Principal valuation technique
Unobservable inputs
Range of input values
Weighted average
Residential mortgage-backed securities and loans
$
8,917

 
Discounted cash flows
Yield
1%

-
25%
5%
 
 
 
Prepayment speed
0%

-
18%
6%
 
 
 
 
Conditional default rate
0%

-
100%
22%
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
0%

-
90%
27%
Commercial mortgage-backed securities and loans(b)
5,319

 
Discounted cash flows
Yield
2%

-
32%
5%
 
 
 
Conditional default rate
0%

-
100%
8%
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
0%

-
50%
29%
Corporate debt securities, obligations of U.S. states and municipalities, and other(c)
6,387

 
Discounted cash flows
Credit spread
53 bps

-
270 bps
140 bps
 
 
 
Yield
1%

-
22%
7%
6,629

 
Market comparables
Price
$

-
$131
$90
Net interest rate derivatives
626

 
Option pricing
Interest rate correlation
(75
)%
-
95%
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate spread volatility
0%

-
60%
 
Net credit derivatives(b)(c)
189

 
Discounted cash flows
Credit correlation
47%

-
90%
 
Net foreign exchange derivatives
(526
)
 
Option pricing
Foreign exchange correlation
0%

-
60%
 
Net equity derivatives
(1,785
)
 
Option pricing
Equity volatility
15%

-
65%
 
Net commodity derivatives
(565
)
 
Discounted cash flows
Forward commodity price
$
50

-
$90 per barrel
Collateralized loan obligations
792

 
Discounted cash flows
Credit spread
260 bps

-
675 bps
279 bps
 
 
 
 
Prepayment speed
20%
20%
 
 
 
 
Conditional default rate
2%
2%
 
 
 
 
Loss severity
40%
40%
 
393

 
Market comparables
Price
$

-
$146
$79
Mortgage servicing rights
7,436

 
Discounted cash flows
Refer to Note 17
 
Private equity direct investments
2,054

 
Market comparables
EBITDA multiple
6x

-
12.4x
9.1x
 
 
 
Liquidity adjustment
0%

-
15%
7%
Private equity fund investments
421

 
Net asset value
Net asset value(e)
 
 
Long-term debt, other borrowed funds, and deposits(d)
15,069

 
Option pricing
Interest rate correlation
(75
)%
-
95%
 
 
 
 
Interest rate spread volatility
0%

-
60%
 
 
 
 
Foreign exchange correlation
0%

-
60%
 
 
 
 
Equity correlation
(55
)%
-
85%
 
 
1,120

 
Discounted cash flows
Credit correlation
47%

-
90%
 
(a)
The categories presented in the table have been aggregated based upon the product type, which may differ from their classification on the Consolidated balance sheets.
(b)
The unobservable inputs and associated input ranges for approximately $491 million of credit derivative receivables and $433 million of credit derivative payables with underlying commercial mortgage risk have been included in the inputs and ranges provided for commercial mortgage-backed securities and loans.
(c)
The unobservable inputs and associated input ranges for approximately $795 million of credit derivative receivables and $715 million of credit derivative payables with underlying asset-backed securities risk have been included in the inputs and ranges provided for corporate debt securities, obligations of U.S. states and municipalities and other.
(d)
Long-term debt, other borrowed funds and deposits include structured notes issued by the Firm that are predominantly financial instruments containing embedded derivatives. The estimation of the fair value of structured notes is predominantly based on the derivative features embedded within the instruments. The significant unobservable inputs are broadly consistent with those presented for derivative receivables.
(e)
The range has not been disclosed due to the wide range of possible values given the diverse nature of the underlying investments.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
189

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Changes in and ranges of unobservable inputs
The following discussion provides a description of the impact on a fair value measurement of a change in each unobservable input in isolation, and the interrelationship between unobservable inputs, where relevant and significant. The impact of changes in inputs may not be independent as a change in one unobservable input may give rise to a change in another unobservable input; where relationships exist between two unobservable inputs, those relationships are discussed below. Relationships may also exist between observable and unobservable inputs (for example, as observable interest rates rise, unobservable prepayment rates decline); such relationships have not been included in the discussion below. In addition, for each of the individual relationships described below, the inverse relationship would also generally apply.
In addition, the following discussion provides a description of attributes of the underlying instruments and external market factors that affect the range of inputs used in the valuation of the Firm’s positions.
Yield – The yield of an asset is the interest rate used to discount future cash flows in a discounted cash flow calculation. An increase in the yield, in isolation, would result in a decrease in a fair value measurement.
Credit spread – The credit spread is the amount of additional annualized return over the market interest rate that a market participant would demand for taking exposure to the credit risk of an instrument. The credit spread for an instrument forms part of the discount rate used in a discounted cash flow calculation. Generally, an increase in the credit spread would result in a decrease in a fair value measurement.
The yield and the credit spread of a particular mortgage-backed security primarily reflect the risk inherent in the instrument. The yield is also impacted by the absolute level of the coupon paid by the instrument (which may not correspond directly to the level of inherent risk). Therefore, the range of yield and credit spreads reflects the range of risk inherent in various instruments owned by the Firm. The risk inherent in mortgage-backed securities is driven by the subordination of the security being valued and the characteristics of the underlying mortgages within the collateralized pool, including borrower FICO scores, loan-to-value ratios for residential mortgages and the nature of the property and/or any tenants for commercial mortgages. For corporate debt securities, obligations of U.S. states and municipalities and other similar instruments, credit spreads reflect the credit quality of the obligor and the tenor of the obligation.
 
Prepayment speed – The prepayment speed is a measure of the voluntary unscheduled principal repayments of a prepayable obligation in a collateralized pool. Prepayment speeds generally decline as borrower delinquencies rise. An increase in prepayment speeds, in isolation, would result in a decrease in a fair value measurement of assets valued at a premium to par and an increase in a fair value measurement of assets valued at a discount to par.
Prepayment speeds may vary from collateral pool to collateral pool, and are driven by the type and location of the underlying borrower, the remaining tenor of the obligation as well as the level and type (e.g., fixed or floating) of interest rate being paid by the borrower. Typically collateral pools with higher borrower credit quality have a higher prepayment rate than those with lower borrower credit quality, all other factors being equal.
Conditional default rate – The conditional default rate is a measure of the reduction in the outstanding collateral balance underlying a collateralized obligation as a result of defaults. While there is typically no direct relationship between conditional default rates and prepayment speeds, collateralized obligations for which the underlying collateral has high prepayment speeds will tend to have lower conditional default rates. An increase in conditional default rates would generally be accompanied by an increase in loss severity and an increase in credit spreads. An increase in the conditional default rate, in isolation, would result in a decrease in a fair value measurement. Conditional default rates reflect the quality of the collateral underlying a securitization and the structure of the securitization itself. Based on the types of securities owned in the Firm’s market-making portfolios, conditional default rates are most typically at the lower end of the range presented.
Loss severity – The loss severity (the inverse concept is the recovery rate) is the expected amount of future realized losses resulting from the ultimate liquidation of a particular loan, expressed as the net amount of loss relative to the outstanding loan balance. An increase in loss severity is generally accompanied by an increase in conditional default rates. An increase in the loss severity, in isolation, would result in a decrease in a fair value measurement.
The loss severity applied in valuing a mortgage-backed security investment depends on a host of factors relating to the underlying mortgages. This includes the loan-to-value ratio, the nature of the lender’s lien on the property and various other instrument-specific factors.


190
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Correlation – Correlation is a measure of the relationship between the movements of two variables (e.g., how the change in one variable influences the change in the other). Correlation is a pricing input for a derivative product where the payoff is driven by one or more underlying risks. Correlation inputs are related to the type of derivative (e.g., interest rate, credit, equity and foreign exchange) due to the nature of the underlying risks. When parameters are positively correlated, an increase in one parameter will result in an increase in the other parameter. When parameters are negatively correlated, an increase in one parameter will result in a decrease in the other parameter. An increase in correlation can result in an increase or a decrease in a fair value measurement. Given a short correlation position, an increase in correlation, in isolation, would generally result in a decrease in a fair value measurement. The range of correlation inputs between risks within the same asset class are generally narrower than those between underlying risks across asset classes. In addition, the ranges of credit correlation inputs tend to be narrower than those affecting other asset classes.
The level of correlation used in the valuation of derivatives with multiple underlying risks depends on a number of factors including the nature of those risks. For example, the correlation between two credit risk exposures would be different than that between two interest rate risk exposures. Similarly, the tenor of the transaction may also impact the correlation input as the relationship between the underlying risks may be different over different time periods. Furthermore, correlation levels are very much dependent on market conditions and could have a relatively wide range of levels within or across asset classes over time, particularly in volatile market conditions.
Volatility – Volatility is a measure of the variability in possible returns for an instrument, parameter or market index given how much the particular instrument, parameter or index changes in value over time. Volatility is a pricing input for options, including equity options, commodity options, and interest rate options. Generally, the higher the volatility of the underlying, the riskier the instrument. Given a long position in an option, an increase in volatility, in isolation, would generally result in an increase in a fair value measurement.
The level of volatility used in the valuation of a particular option-based derivative depends on a number of factors, including the nature of the risk underlying the option (e.g., the volatility of a particular equity security may be significantly different from that of a particular commodity index), the tenor of the derivative as well as the strike price of the option.
 
EBITDA multiple – EBITDA multiples refer to the input (often derived from the value of a comparable company) that is multiplied by the historic and/or expected earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization (“EBITDA”) of a company in order to estimate the company’s value. An increase in the EBITDA multiple, in isolation, net of adjustments, would result in an increase in a fair value measurement.
Net asset value – Net asset value is the total value of a fund’s assets less liabilities. An increase in net asset value would result in an increase in a fair value measurement.
Changes in level 3 recurring fair value measurements
The following tables include a rollforward of the Consolidated balance sheets amounts (including changes in fair value) for financial instruments classified by the Firm within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012. When a determination is made to classify a financial instrument within level 3, the determination is based on the significance of the unobservable parameters to the overall fair value measurement. However, level 3 financial instruments typically include, in addition to the unobservable or level 3 components, observable components (that is, components that are actively quoted and can be validated to external sources); accordingly, the gains and losses in the table below include changes in fair value due in part to observable factors that are part of the valuation methodology. Also, the Firm risk-manages the observable components of level 3 financial instruments using securities and derivative positions that are classified within level 1 or 2 of the fair value hierarchy; as these level 1 and level 2 risk management instruments are not included below, the gains or losses in the following tables do not reflect the effect of the Firm’s risk management activities related to such level 3 instruments.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
191

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 
Fair value measurements using significant unobservable inputs
 
 
Year ended
December 31, 2014
(in millions)
Fair value at January 1, 2014
Total realized/unrealized gains/(losses)
 
 
 
 
Transfers into and/or out of level 3(h)
Fair value at Dec. 31, 2014
 
Change in unrealized gains/(losses) related to financial instruments held at Dec. 31, 2014
Purchases(g)
Sales
 
Settlements
Assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt instruments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. government agencies
$
1,005

$
(97
)
 
$
351

$
(186
)
 
$
(121
)
$
(30
)
$
922

 
$
(92
)
 
Residential – nonagency
726

66

 
827

(761
)
 
(41
)
(154
)
663

 
(15
)
 
Commercial – nonagency
432

17

 
980

(914
)
 
(60
)
(149
)
306

 
(12
)
 
Total mortgage-backed securities
2,163

(14
)
 
2,158

(1,861
)
 
(222
)
(333
)
1,891

 
(119
)
 
Obligations of U.S. states and municipalities
1,382

90

 
298

(358
)
 
(139
)

1,273

 
(27
)
 
Non-U.S. government debt securities
143

24

 
719

(617
)
 
(3
)
36

302

 
10

 
Corporate debt securities
5,920

210

 
5,854

(3,372
)
 
(4,531
)
(1,092
)
2,989

 
379

 
Loans
13,455

387

 
13,551

(7,917
)
 
(4,623
)
(1,566
)
13,287

 
123

 
Asset-backed securities
1,272

19

 
2,240

(2,126
)
 
(283
)
142

1,264

 
(30
)
 
Total debt instruments
24,335

716

 
24,820

(16,251
)
 
(9,801
)
(2,813
)
21,006

 
336

 
Equity securities
885

112

 
248

(272
)
 
(290
)
(252
)
431

 
46

 
Physical commodities
4

(1
)
 


 
(1
)

2

 

 
Other
2,000

239

 
1,426

(276
)
 
(201
)
(2,138
)
1,050

 
329

 
Total trading assets – debt and equity instruments
27,224

1,066

(c) 
26,494

(16,799
)
 
(10,293
)
(5,203
)
22,489

 
711

(c) 
Net derivative receivables:(a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate
2,379

184

 
198

(256
)
 
(1,771
)
(108
)
626

 
(853
)
 
Credit
95

(149
)
 
272

(47
)
 
92

(74
)
189

 
(107
)
 
Foreign exchange
(1,200
)
(137
)
 
139

(27
)
 
668

31

(526
)
 
(62
)
 
Equity
(1,063
)
154

 
2,044

(2,863
)
 
10

(67
)
(1,785
)
 
583

 
Commodity
115

(465
)
 
1

(113
)
 
(109
)
6

(565
)
 
(186
)
 
Total net derivative receivables
326

(413
)
(c) 
2,654

(3,306
)
 
(1,110
)
(212
)
(2,061
)
 
(625
)
(c) 
Available-for-sale securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Asset-backed securities
1,088

(41
)
 
275

(2
)
 
(101
)
(311
)
908

 
(40
)
 
Other
1,234

(19
)
 
122


 
(223
)
(985
)
129

 
(2
)
 
Total available-for-sale securities
2,322

(60
)
(d) 
397

(2
)
 
(324
)
(1,296
)
1,037

 
(42
)
(d) 
Loans
1,931

(254
)
(c) 
3,258

(845
)
 
(1,549
)

2,541

 
(234
)
(c) 
Mortgage servicing rights
9,614

(1,826
)
(e) 
768

(209
)
 
(911
)

7,436

 
(1,826
)
(e) 
Other assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Private equity investments
6,474

443

(c) 
164

(1,967
)
 
(360
)
(2,279
)
2,475

 
26

(c) 
All other
3,176

33

(f) 
190

(451
)
 
(577
)

2,371

 
11

(f) 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value measurements using significant unobservable inputs
 
 
Year ended
December 31, 2014
(in millions)
Fair value at January 1, 2014
Total realized/unrealized (gains)/losses
 
 
 
 
Transfers into and/or out of level 3(h)
Fair value at Dec. 31, 2014
 
Change in unrealized (gains)/losses related to financial instruments held at Dec. 31, 2014
Purchases(g)
Sales
Issuances
Settlements
Liabilities:(b)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
$
2,255

$
149

(c) 
$

$

$
1,578

$
(197
)
$
(926
)
$
2,859

 
$
130

(c) 
Other borrowed funds
2,074

(596
)
(c) 


5,377

(6,127
)
725

1,453

 
(415
)
(c) 
Trading liabilities – debt and equity instruments
113

(5
)
(c) 
(305
)
323


(5
)
(49
)
72

 
2

(c) 
Accounts payable and other liabilities
25

27

(f) 



(16
)

36

 

(f) 
Beneficial interests issued by consolidated VIEs
1,240

(4
)
(c) 


775

(763
)
(102
)
1,146

 
(22
)
(c) 
Long-term debt
10,008

(40
)
(c) 


7,421

(5,231
)
(281
)
11,877

 
(9
)
(c) 

192
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



 
Fair value measurements using significant unobservable inputs
 
 
Year ended
December 31, 2013
(in millions)
Fair value at January 1, 2013
Total realized/unrealized gains/(losses)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Transfers into and/or out of level 3(h)
Fair value at
Dec. 31, 2013
Change in unrealized gains/(losses) related to financial instruments held at Dec. 31, 2013
Purchases(g)
 
Sales
 
 
Settlements
Assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt instruments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. government agencies
$
498

$
169

 
$
819

 
$
(381
)
 
 
$
(100
)
$

$
1,005

 
$
200

 
Residential – nonagency
663

407

 
780

 
(1,028
)
 
 
(91
)
(5
)
726

 
205

 
Commercial – nonagency
1,207

114

 
841

 
(1,522
)
 
 
(208
)

432

 
(4
)
 
Total mortgage-backed securities
2,368

690

 
2,440

 
(2,931
)
 
 
(399
)
(5
)
2,163

 
401

 
Obligations of U.S. states and municipalities
1,436

71

 
472

 
(251
)
 
 
(346
)

1,382

 
18

 
Non-U.S. government debt securities
67

4

 
1,449

 
(1,479
)
 
 
(8
)
110

143

 
(1
)
 
Corporate debt securities
5,308

103

 
7,602

 
(5,975
)
 
 
(1,882
)
764

5,920

 
466

 
Loans
10,787

665

 
10,411

 
(7,431
)
 
 
(685
)
(292
)
13,455

 
315

 
Asset-backed securities
3,696

191

 
1,912

 
(2,379
)
 
 
(292
)
(1,856
)
1,272

 
105

 
Total debt instruments
23,662

1,724

 
24,286

 
(20,446
)
 
 
(3,612
)
(1,279
)
24,335

 
1,304

 
Equity securities
1,114

(41
)
 
328

 
(266
)
 
 
(135
)
(115
)
885

 
46

 
Physical Commodities

(4
)
 

 
(8
)
 
 

16

4

 
(4
)
 
Other
863

558

 
659

 
(95
)
 
 
(120
)
135

2,000

 
1,074

 
Total trading assets – debt and equity instruments
25,639

2,237

(c) 
25,273

 
(20,815
)
 
 
(3,867
)
(1,243
)
27,224

 
2,420

(c) 
Net derivative receivables:(a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate
3,322

1,358

 
344

 
(220
)
 
 
(2,391
)
(34
)
2,379

 
107

 
Credit
1,873

(1,697
)
 
115

 
(12
)
 
 
(357
)
173

95

 
(1,449
)
 
Foreign exchange
(1,750
)
(101
)
 
3

 
(4
)
 
 
683

(31
)
(1,200
)
 
(110
)
 
Equity
(1,806
)
2,528

(i) 
1,305

(i) 
(2,111
)
(i) 
 
(1,353
)
374

(1,063
)
 
872

 
Commodity
254

816

 
105

 
(3
)
 
 
(1,107
)
50

115

 
410

 
Total net derivative receivables
1,893

2,904

(c) 
1,872

 
(2,350
)
 
 
(4,525
)
532

326

 
(170
)
(c) 
Available-for-sale securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Asset-backed securities
28,024

4

 
579

 
(57
)
 
 
(57
)
(27,405
)
1,088

 
4

 
Other
892

26

 
508

 
(216
)
 
 
(6
)
30

1,234

 
25

 
Total available-for-sale securities
28,916

30

(d) 
1,087

 
(273
)
 
 
(63
)
(27,375
)
2,322

 
29

(d) 
Loans
2,282

81

(c) 
1,065

 
(191
)
 
 
(1,306
)

1,931

 
(21
)
(c) 
Mortgage servicing rights
7,614

1,612

(e) 
2,215

 
(725
)
 
 
(1,102
)

9,614

 
1,612

(e) 
Other assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Private equity investments
7,181

645

(c) 
673

 
(1,137
)
 
 
(687
)
(201
)
6,474

 
262

(c) 
All other
4,258

98

(f) 
272

 
(730
)
 
 
(722
)

3,176

 
53

(f) 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value measurements using significant unobservable inputs
 
 
Year ended
December 31, 2013
(in millions)
Fair value at January 1, 2013
Total realized/unrealized (gains)/losses
 
 
 
 
 
 
Transfers into and/or out of level 3(h)
Fair value at Dec. 31, 2013
Change in unrealized (gains)/losses related to financial instruments held at Dec. 31, 2013
Purchases(g)
 
Sales
 
Issuances
Settlements
Liabilities:(b)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
$
1,983

$
(82
)
(c) 
$

 
$

 
$
1,248

$
(222
)
$
(672
)
$
2,255

 
$
(88
)
(c) 
Other borrowed funds
1,619

(177
)
(c) 

 

 
7,108

(6,845
)
369

2,074

 
291

(c) 
Trading liabilities – debt and equity instruments
205

(83
)
(c) 
(2,418
)
 
2,594

 

(54
)
(131
)
113

 
(100
)
(c) 
Accounts payable and other liabilities
36

(2
)
(f) 

 

 

(9
)

25

 
(2
)
(f) 
Beneficial interests issued by consolidated VIEs
925

174

(c) 

 

 
353

(212
)

1,240

 
167

(c) 
Long-term debt
8,476

(435
)
(c) 

 

 
6,830

(4,362
)
(501
)
10,008

 
(85
)
(c) 


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
193

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 
Fair value measurements using significant unobservable inputs
 
 
Year ended
December 31, 2012
(in millions)
Fair value at January 1, 2012
Total realized/unrealized gains/(losses)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Transfers into and/or out of level 3(h)
Fair value at
Dec. 31, 2012
Change in unrealized gains/(losses) related to financial instruments held at Dec. 31, 2012
Purchases(g)
 
Sales
 
 
Settlements
Assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt instruments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. government agencies
$
86

$
(44
)
 
$
575

 
$
(103
)
 
 
$
(16
)
$

$
498

 
$
(21
)
 
Residential – nonagency
796

151

 
417

 
(533
)
 
 
(145
)
(23
)
663

 
74

 
Commercial – nonagency
1,758

(159
)
 
287

 
(475
)
 
 
(104
)
(100
)
1,207

 
(145
)
 
Total mortgage-backed securities
2,640

(52
)
 
1,279

 
(1,111
)
 
 
(265
)
(123
)
2,368

 
(92
)
 
Obligations of U.S. states and municipalities
1,619

37

 
336

 
(552
)
 
 
(4
)

1,436

 
(15
)
 
Non-U.S. government debt securities
104

(6
)
 
661

 
(668
)
 
 
(24
)

67

 
(5
)
 
Corporate debt securities
6,373

187

 
8,391

 
(6,186
)
 
 
(3,045
)
(412
)
5,308

 
689

 
Loans
12,209

836

 
5,342

 
(3,269
)
 
 
(3,801
)
(530
)
10,787

 
411

 
Asset-backed securities
7,965

272

 
2,550

 
(6,468
)
 
 
(614
)
(9
)
3,696

 
184

 
Total debt instruments
30,910

1,274

 
18,559

 
(18,254
)
 
 
(7,753
)
(1,074
)
23,662

 
1,172

 
Equity securities
1,177

(209
)
 
460

 
(379
)
 
 
(12
)
77

1,114

 
(112
)
 
Other
880

186

 
68

 
(108
)
 
 
(163
)

863

 
180

 
Total trading assets – debt and equity instruments
32,967

1,251

(c) 
19,087

 
(18,741
)
 
 
(7,928
)
(997
)
25,639

 
1,240

(c) 
Net derivative receivables:(a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate
3,561

6,930

 
406

 
(194
)
 
 
(7,071
)
(310
)
3,322

 
905

 
Credit
7,732

(4,487
)
 
124

 
(84
)
 
 
(1,416
)
4

1,873

 
(3,271
)
 
Foreign exchange
(1,263
)
(800
)
 
112

 
(184
)
 
 
436

(51
)
(1,750
)
 
(957
)
 
Equity
(3,105
)
160

(i) 
1,279

(i) 
(2,174
)
(i) 
 
899

1,135

(1,806
)
 
580

 
Commodity
(687
)
(673
)
 
74

 
64

 
 
1,278

198

254

 
(160
)
 
Total net derivative receivables
6,238

1,130

(c) 
1,995

 
(2,572
)
 
 
(5,874
)
976

1,893

 
(2,903
)
(c) 
Available-for-sale securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Asset-backed securities
24,958

135

 
9,280

 
(3,361
)
 
 
(3,104
)
116

28,024

 
118

 
Other
528

55

 
667

 
(113
)
 
 
(245
)

892

 
59

 
Total available-for-sale securities
25,486

190

(d) 
9,947

 
(3,474
)
 
 
(3,349
)
116

28,916

 
177

(d) 
Loans
1,647

695

(c) 
1,536

 
(22
)
 
 
(1,718
)
144

2,282

 
12

(c) 
Mortgage servicing rights
7,223

(635
)
(e) 
2,833

 
(579
)
 
 
(1,228
)

7,614

 
(635
)
(e) 
Other assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Private equity investments
6,751

420

(c) 
1,545

 
(512
)
 
 
(977
)
(46
)
7,181

 
333

(c) 
All other
4,374

(195
)
(f) 
818

 
(238
)
 
 
(501
)

4,258

 
(200
)
(f) 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value measurements using significant unobservable inputs
 
 
Year ended
December 31, 2012
(in millions)
Fair value at January 1, 2012
Total realized/unrealized (gains)/losses
 
 
 
 
 
 
Transfers into and/or out of level 3(h)
Fair value at Dec. 31, 2012
Change in unrealized (gains)/losses related to financial instruments held at Dec. 31, 2012
Purchases(g)
 
Sales
 
Issuances
Settlements
Liabilities:(b)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
$
1,418

$
212

(c) 
$

 
$

 
$
1,236

$
(380
)
$
(503
)
$
1,983

 
$
185

(c) 
Other borrowed funds
1,507

148

(c) 

 

 
1,646

(1,774
)
92

1,619

 
72

(c) 
Trading liabilities – debt and equity instruments
211

(16
)
(c) 
(2,875
)
 
2,940

 

(50
)
(5
)
205

 
(12
)
(c) 
Accounts payable and other liabilities
51

1

(f) 

 

 

(16
)

36

 
1

(f) 
Beneficial interests issued by consolidated VIEs
791

181

(c) 

 

 
221

(268
)

925

 
143

(c) 
Long-term debt
10,310

328

(c) 

 

 
3,662

(4,511
)
(1,313
)
8,476

 
(101
)
(c) 
(a)
All level 3 derivatives are presented on a net basis, irrespective of underlying counterparty.
(b)
Level 3 liabilities as a percentage of total Firm liabilities accounted for at fair value (including liabilities measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis) were 15%, 18% and 18% at December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
(c)
Predominantly reported in principal transactions revenue, except for changes in fair value for CCB mortgage loans, lending-related commitments originated with the intent to sell, and mortgage loan purchase commitments, which are reported in mortgage fees and related income.

194
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



(d)
Realized gains/(losses) on AFS securities, as well as other-than-temporary impairment losses that are recorded in earnings, are reported in securities gains. Unrealized gains/(losses) are reported in Other Comprehensive Income (“OCI”). Realized gains/(losses) and foreign exchange remeasurement adjustments recorded in income on AFS securities were $(43) million, $17 million, and $145 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Unrealized gains/(losses) recorded on AFS securities in OCI were $(16) million, $13 million and $45 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
(e)
Changes in fair value for CCB mortgage servicing rights are reported in mortgage fees and related income.
(f)
Predominantly reported in other income.
(g)
Loan originations are included in purchases.
(h)
All transfers into and/or out of level 3 are assumed to occur at the beginning of the quarterly reporting period in which they occur.
(i)
The prior period amounts have been revised. The revision had no impact on the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets or its results of operations.

Level 3 analysis
Consolidated balance sheets changes
Level 3 assets (including assets measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis) were 2.1% of total Firm assets at December 31, 2014. The following describes significant changes to level 3 assets since December 31, 2013, for those items measured at fair value on a recurring basis. For further information on changes impacting items measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis, see Assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis on page 197.
For the year ended December 31, 2014
Level 3 assets were $50.9 billion at December 31, 2014, reflecting a decrease of $18.4 billion from December 31, 2013, due to the following:
$6.0 billion decrease in gross derivative receivables due to a $4.5 billion decrease in equity derivative receivables due to expirations and a transfer from level 3 into level 2 as a result of an increase in observability of certain equity option valuation inputs; and a
$1.2 billion decrease in interest rate derivatives due to market movements;
$4.7 billion decrease in trading assets - debt and equity instruments is largely due to a decrease of $2.9 billion in corporate debt securities. The decrease in corporate debt securities is driven by transfers from level 3 to level 2 as a result of an increase in observability of certain valuation inputs, as well as net sales and maturities;
$4.0 billion decrease in private equity investments predominantly driven by $2.0 billion in sales and $2.3 billion of transfers into level 2 based on an increase in observability and price transparency;
$2.2 billion decrease in MSRs. For further discussion of the change, refer to Note 17.

 
Gains and losses
The following describes significant components of total realized/unrealized gains/(losses) for instruments measured at fair value on a recurring basis for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012. For further information on these instruments, see Changes in level 3 recurring fair value measurements rollforward tables on pages 191–195.
2014
$1.8 billion of losses on MSRs. For further discussion of the change, refer to Note 17;
$1.1 billion of net gains on trading assets - debt and equity instruments, largely driven by market movements and client-driven financing transactions.
2013
$2.9 billion of net gains on derivatives, largely driven by $2.5 billion of gains on equity derivatives, primarily related to client-driven market-making activity and a rise in equity markets; and $1.4 billion of gains, predominantly on interest rate lock and mortgage loan purchase commitments; partially offset by $1.7 billion of losses on credit derivatives from the impact of tightening reference entity credit spreads;
$2.2 billion of net gains on trading assets - debt and equity instruments, largely driven by market making and credit spread tightening in nonagency mortgage-backed securities and trading loans, and the impact of market movements on client-driven financing transactions;
$1.6 billion of net gains on MSRs. For further discussion of the change, refer to Note 17.
2012
$1.3 billion of net gains on trading assets - debt and equity instruments, largely driven by tightening of credit spreads and fluctuation in foreign exchange rates;
$1.1 billion of net gains on derivatives, driven by
$6.9 billion of net gains predominantly on interest rate lock commitments due to increased volumes and lower interest rates, partially offset by $4.5 billion of net losses on credit derivatives largely as a result of tightening of reference entity credit spreads.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
195

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Credit and funding adjustments
When determining the fair value of an instrument, it may be necessary to record adjustments to the Firm’s estimates of fair value in order to reflect counterparty credit quality, the Firm’s own creditworthiness, and the impact of funding:
Credit valuation adjustments (“CVA”) are taken to reflect the credit quality of a counterparty in the valuation of derivatives. CVA are necessary when the market price (or parameter) is not indicative of the credit quality of the counterparty. As few classes of derivative contracts are listed on an exchange, derivative positions are predominantly valued using models that use as their basis observable market parameters. An adjustment therefore may be necessary to reflect the credit quality of each derivative counterparty to arrive at fair value.
The Firm estimates derivatives CVA using a scenario analysis to estimate the expected credit exposure across all of the Firm’s positions with each counterparty, and then estimates losses as a result of a counterparty credit event. The key inputs to this methodology are (i) the expected positive exposure to each counterparty based on a simulation that assumes the current population of existing derivatives with each counterparty remains unchanged and considers contractual factors designed to mitigate the Firm’s credit exposure, such as collateral and legal rights of offset; (ii) the probability of a default event occurring for each counterparty, as derived from observed or estimated CDS spreads; and (iii) estimated recovery rates implied by CDS, adjusted to consider the differences in recovery rates as a derivative creditor relative to those reflected in CDS spreads, which generally reflect senior unsecured creditor risk. As such, the Firm estimates derivatives CVA relative to the relevant benchmark interest rate.
DVA is taken to reflect the credit quality of the Firm in the valuation of liabilities measured at fair value. The DVA calculation methodology is generally consistent with the CVA methodology described above and incorporates JPMorgan Chase’s credit spread as observed through the CDS market to estimate the probability of default and loss given default as a result of a systemic event affecting the Firm. Structured notes DVA is estimated using the current fair value of the structured note as the exposure amount, and is otherwise consistent with the derivative DVA methodology.
The Firm incorporates the impact of funding in its valuation estimates where there is evidence that a market participant in the principal market would incorporate it in a transfer of the instrument. As a result, the fair value of collateralized derivatives is estimated by discounting expected future cash flows at the relevant overnight indexed swap (“OIS”) rate given the underlying collateral agreement with the counterparty. Effective in 2013, the Firm implemented a FVA framework to incorporate the impact of funding into its
 
valuation estimates for uncollateralized (including partially collateralized) over-the-counter (“OTC”) derivatives and structured notes. The Firm’s FVA framework leverages its existing CVA and DVA calculation methodologies, and considers the fact that the Firm’s own credit risk is a significant component of funding costs. The key inputs are: (i) the expected funding requirements arising from the Firm’s positions with each counterparty and collateral arrangements; (ii) for assets, the estimated market funding cost in the principal market; and (iii) for liabilities, the hypothetical market funding cost for a transfer to a market participant with a similar credit standing as the Firm.
Upon the implementation of the FVA framework in 2013, the Firm recorded a one time $1.5 billion loss in principal transactions revenue that was recorded in the CIB. While the FVA framework applies to both assets and liabilities, the loss on implementation largely related to uncollateralized derivative receivables given that the impact of the Firm’s own credit risk, which is a significant component of funding costs, was already incorporated in the valuation of liabilities through the application of DVA.
The following table provides the credit and funding adjustments, excluding the effect of any associated hedging activities, reflected within the Consolidated balance sheets as of the dates indicated.
December 31, (in millions)
2014
 
2013
Derivative receivables balance(a)
$
78,975

 
$
65,759

Derivative payables balance(a)
71,116

 
57,314

Derivatives CVA(b)
(2,674
)
 
(2,352
)
Derivatives DVA and FVA(b)(c)
(380
)
 
(322
)
Structured notes balance (a)(d)
53,772

 
48,808

Structured notes DVA and FVA(b)(e)
1,152

 
952

(a)
Balances are presented net of applicable CVA and DVA/FVA.
(b)
Positive CVA and DVA/FVA represent amounts that increased receivable balances or decreased payable balances; negative CVA and DVA/FVA represent amounts that decreased receivable balances or increased payable balances.
(c)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, included derivatives DVA of $714 million and $715 million, respectively.
(d)
Structured notes are predominantly financial instruments containing embedded derivatives that are measured at fair value based on the Firm’s election under the fair value option. At December 31, 2014 and 2013, included $943 million and $1.1 billion, respectively, of financial instruments with no embedded derivative for which the fair value option has also been elected. For further information on these elections, see Note 4.
(e)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, included structured notes DVA of $1.4 billion and $1.4 billion, respectively.


196
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The following table provides the impact of credit and funding adjustments on Principal transactions revenue in the respective periods, excluding the effect of any associated hedging activities.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Credit adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
Derivatives CVA
$
(322
)
 
$
1,886

 
$
2,698

Derivatives DVA and FVA(a)
(58
)
 
(1,152
)
 
(590
)
Structured notes DVA and FVA(b)
200

 
(760
)
 
(340
)
(a)
Included derivatives DVA of $(1) million, $(115) million and $(590) million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
(b)
Included structured notes DVA of $20 million, $(337) million and $(340) million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

Assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, assets measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis were $4.5 billion and $6.2 billion, respectively, comprised predominantly of loans that had fair value adjustments for the year ended December 31, 2014. At December 31, 2014, $1.3 billion and $3.2 billion of these assets were classified in levels 2 and 3 of the fair value hierarchy, respectively. At December 31, 2013, $339 million and $5.8 billion of these assets were classified in levels 2 and 3 of the fair value hierarchy, respectively. Liabilities measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis were not significant at December 31, 2014 and 2013. For the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, there were no significant transfers between levels 1, 2
and 3.
Of the $3.2 billion of the level 3 assets measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis as of December 31, 2014:
$1.6 billion related to consumer loans that were reclassified to held-for-sale during the fourth quarter of 2014 subject to a lower of cost or fair value adjustment. These loans were classified as level 3, as they are valued based on the Firm’s internal valuation methodology;
$809 million related to residential real estate loans carried at the net realizable value of the underlying collateral (i.e., collateral-dependent loans and other loans charged off in accordance with regulatory guidance). These amounts are classified as level 3, as they are valued using a broker’s price opinion and discounted based upon the Firm’s experience with actual liquidation values. These discounts to the broker price opinions ranged from 8% to 66%, with a weighted average of 26%.
 
The total change in the recorded value of assets and liabilities for which a fair value adjustment has been included in the Consolidated statements of income for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, related to financial instruments held at those dates were losses of $992 million, $789 million and $1.6 billion, respectively; these reductions were predominantly associated with loans.
For further information about the measurement of impaired collateral-dependent loans, and other loans where the carrying value is based on the fair value of the underlying collateral (e.g., residential mortgage loans charged off in accordance with regulatory guidance), see Note 14.
Additional disclosures about the fair value of financial instruments that are not carried on the Consolidated balance sheets at fair value
U.S. GAAP requires disclosure of the estimated fair value of certain financial instruments, and the methods and significant assumptions used to estimate their fair value. Financial instruments within the scope of these disclosure requirements are included in the following table. However, certain financial instruments and all nonfinancial instruments are excluded from the scope of these disclosure requirements. Accordingly, the fair value disclosures provided in the following table include only a partial estimate of the fair value of JPMorgan Chase’s assets and liabilities. For example, the Firm has developed long-term relationships with its customers through its deposit base and credit card accounts, commonly referred to as core deposit intangibles and credit card relationships. In the opinion of management, these items, in the aggregate, add significant value to JPMorgan Chase, but their fair value is not disclosed in this Note.
Financial instruments for which carrying value approximates fair value
Certain financial instruments that are not carried at fair value on the Consolidated balance sheets are carried at amounts that approximate fair value, due to their short-term nature and generally negligible credit risk. These instruments include cash and due from banks; deposits with banks; federal funds sold; securities purchased under resale agreements and securities borrowed with short-dated maturities; short-term receivables and accrued interest receivable; commercial paper; federal funds purchased; securities loaned and sold under repurchase agreements with short-dated maturities; other borrowed funds; accounts payable; and accrued liabilities. In addition, U.S. GAAP requires that the fair value of deposit liabilities with no stated maturity (i.e., demand, savings and certain money market deposits) be equal to their carrying value; recognition of the inherent funding value of these instruments is not permitted.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
197

Notes to consolidated financial statements

The following table presents by fair value hierarchy classification the carrying values and estimated fair values at December 31, 2014 and 2013, of financial assets and liabilities, excluding financial instruments which are carried at fair value on a recurring basis. For additional information regarding the financial instruments within the scope of this disclosure, and the methods and significant assumptions used to estimate their fair value, see pages 181–184 of this Note.
 
December 31, 2014
 
December 31, 2013
 
 
Estimated fair value hierarchy
 
 
 
Estimated fair value hierarchy
 
(in billions)
Carrying
value
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total estimated
fair value
 
Carrying
value
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total estimated
fair value
Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
$
27.8

$
27.8

$

$

$
27.8

 
$
39.8

$
39.8

$

$

$
39.8

Deposits with banks
484.5

480.4

4.1


484.5

 
316.1

309.7

6.4


316.1

Accrued interest and accounts receivable
70.1


70.0

0.1

70.1

 
65.2


64.9

0.3

65.2

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements
187.2


187.2


187.2

 
223.0


223.0


223.0

Securities borrowed
109.4


109.4


109.4

 
107.7


107.7


107.7

Securities, held-to-maturity(a)
49.3


51.2


51.2

 
24.0


23.7


23.7

Loans, net of allowance for loan losses(b)
740.5


21.8

723.1

744.9

 
720.1


23.0

697.2

720.2

Other(c)
58.1


55.7

7.1

62.8

 
58.2


54.5

7.4

61.9

Financial liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits
$
1,354.6

$

$
1,353.6

$
1.2

$
1,354.8

 
$
1,281.1

$

$
1,280.3

$
1.2

$
1,281.5

Federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements
189.1


189.1


189.1

 
175.7


175.7


175.7

Commercial paper
66.3


66.3


66.3

 
57.8


57.8


57.8

Other borrowed funds
15.5



15.5


15.5

 
14.7


14.7


14.7

Accounts payable and other liabilities
176.7


173.7

2.8

176.5

 
160.2


158.2

1.8

160.0

Beneficial interests issued by consolidated VIEs
50.2


48.2

2.0

50.2

 
47.6


44.3

3.2

47.5

Long-term debt and junior subordinated deferrable interest debentures(d)
246.6


251.6

3.8

255.4

 
239.0


240.8

6.0

246.8

(a)
Carrying value includes unamortized discount or premium.
(b)
Fair value is typically estimated using a discounted cash flow model that incorporates the characteristics of the underlying loans (including principal, contractual interest rate and contractual fees) and other key inputs, including expected lifetime credit losses, interest rates, prepayment rates, and primary origination or secondary market spreads. For certain loans, the fair value is measured based on the value of the underlying collateral. The difference between the estimated fair value and carrying value of a financial asset or liability is the result of the different methodologies used to determine fair value as compared with carrying value. For example, credit losses are estimated for a financial asset’s remaining life in a fair value calculation but are estimated for a loss emergence period in the allowance for loan loss calculation; future loan income (interest and fees) is incorporated in a fair value calculation but is generally not considered in the allowance for loan losses. For a further discussion of the Firm’s methodologies for estimating the fair value of loans and lending-related commitments, see Valuation hierarchy on pages 181–184.
(c)
Current period amounts have been updated to include certain nonmarketable equity securities. Prior period amounts have been revised to conform to the current presentation.
(d)
Carrying value includes unamortized original issue discount and other valuation adjustments.

198
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The majority of the Firm’s lending-related commitments are not carried at fair value on a recurring basis on the Consolidated balance sheets, nor are they actively traded. The carrying value and estimated fair value of the Firm’s wholesale lending-related commitments were as follows for the periods indicated.
 
December 31, 2014
 
December 31, 2013
 
 
Estimated fair value hierarchy
 
 
 
Estimated fair value hierarchy
 
(in billions)
Carrying value(a)
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total estimated fair value
 
Carrying value(a)
Level 1
Level 2
Level 3
Total estimated fair value
Wholesale lending-related commitments
$
0.6

$

$

$
1.6

$
1.6

 
$
0.7

$

$

$
1.0

$
1.0

(a)
Represents the allowance for wholesale lending-related commitments. Excludes the current carrying values of the guarantee liability and the offsetting asset, each of which are recognized at fair value at the inception of guarantees.

The Firm does not estimate the fair value of consumer lending-related commitments. In many cases, the Firm can reduce or cancel these commitments by providing the borrower notice or, in some cases as permitted by law, without notice. For a further discussion of the valuation of lending-related commitments, see page 182 of this Note.
Trading assets and liabilities
Trading assets include debt and equity instruments owned by JPMorgan Chase (“long” positions) that are held for client market-making and client-driven activities, as well as for certain risk management activities, certain loans managed on a fair value basis and for which the Firm has elected the fair value option, and physical commodities
 
inventories that are generally accounted for at the lower of cost or market (market approximates fair value). Trading liabilities include debt and equity instruments that the Firm has sold to other parties but does not own (“short” positions). The Firm is obligated to purchase instruments at a future date to cover the short positions. Included in trading assets and trading liabilities are the reported receivables (unrealized gains) and payables (unrealized losses) related to derivatives. Trading assets and liabilities are carried at fair value on the Consolidated balance sheets. Balances reflect the reduction of securities owned (long positions) by the amount of identical securities sold but not yet purchased (short positions).


Trading assets and liabilities – average balances
Average trading assets and liabilities were as follows for the periods indicated.
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Trading assets – debt and equity instruments
 
$
327,259

 
$
340,449

 
$
349,337

Trading assets – derivative receivables
 
67,123

 
72,629

 
85,744

Trading liabilities – debt and equity instruments(a)
 
84,707

 
77,706

 
69,001

Trading liabilities – derivative payables
 
54,758

 
64,553

 
76,162

(a)
Primarily represent securities sold, not yet purchased.
Note 4 – Fair value option
The fair value option provides an option to elect fair value as an alternative measurement for selected financial assets, financial liabilities, unrecognized firm commitments, and written loan commitments not previously carried at fair value.
The Firm has elected to measure certain instruments at fair value in order to:
Mitigate income statement volatility caused by the differences in the measurement basis of elected instruments (for example, certain instruments elected were previously accounted for on an accrual basis) while the associated risk management arrangements are accounted for on a fair value basis;
Eliminate the complexities of applying certain accounting models (e.g., hedge accounting or bifurcation accounting for hybrid instruments); and/or
Better reflect those instruments that are managed on a fair value basis.
 
The Firm has elected to measure the following instruments at fair value:
Loans purchased or originated as part of securitization warehousing activity, subject to bifurcation accounting, or managed on a fair value basis.
Securities financing arrangements with an embedded derivative and/or a maturity of greater than one year.
Owned beneficial interests in securitized financial assets that contain embedded credit derivatives, which would otherwise be required to be separately accounted for as a derivative instrument.
Certain investments that receive tax credits and other equity investments acquired as part of the Washington Mutual transaction.
Structured notes issued as part of CIB’s client-driven activities. (Structured notes are predominantly financial instruments that contain embedded derivatives.)
Long-term beneficial interests issued by CIB’s consolidated securitization trusts where the underlying assets are carried at fair value.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
199

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Changes in fair value under the fair value option election
The following table presents the changes in fair value included in the Consolidated statements of income for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, for items for which the fair value option was elected. The profit and loss information presented below only includes the financial instruments that were elected to be measured at fair value; related risk management instruments, which are required to be measured at fair value, are not included in the table.
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
December 31, (in millions)
Principal transactions
All other income
Total changes in fair value recorded
 
Principal transactions
All other income
Total changes in fair value recorded
 
Principal transactions
All other income
Total changes in fair value recorded
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements
$
(15
)
$

 
$
(15
)
 
$
(454
)
$

 
$
(454
)
 
$
161

$

 
$
161

Securities borrowed
(10
)

 
(10
)
 
10


 
10

 
10


 
10

Trading assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 

Debt and equity instruments, excluding loans
639


 
639

 
582

7

 
589

 
513

7

 
520

Loans reported as trading assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 
 
 
 


Changes in instrument-specific credit risk
885

29

(c) 
914

 
1,161

23

(c) 
1,184

 
1,489

81

(c) 
1,570

Other changes in fair value
352

1,353

(c) 
1,705

 
(133
)
1,833

(c) 
1,700

 
(183
)
7,670

(c) 
7,487

Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 
 
 
 


Changes in instrument-specific credit risk
40


 
40

 
36


 
36

 
(14
)

 
(14
)
Other changes in fair value
34


 
34

 
17


 
17

 
676


 
676

Other assets
24

(122
)
(d) 
(98
)
 
32

(29
)
(d) 
3

 

(339
)
(d) 
(339
)
Deposits(a)
(287
)

 
(287
)
 
260


 
260

 
(188
)

 
(188
)
Federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements
(33
)

 
(33
)
 
73


 
73

 
(25
)

 
(25
)
Other borrowed funds(a) 
(891
)

 
(891
)
 
(399
)

 
(399
)
 
494


 
494

Trading liabilities
(17
)

 
(17
)
 
(46
)

 
(46
)
 
(41
)

 
(41
)
Beneficial interests issued by consolidated VIEs
(233
)

 
(233
)
 
(278
)

 
(278
)
 
(166
)

 
(166
)
Other liabilities
(27
)

 
(27
)
 

2

 
2

 


 

Long-term debt:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 


 
 
 
 


Changes in instrument-specific credit risk(a) 
101


 
101

 
(271
)

 
(271
)
 
(835
)

 
(835
)
Other changes in fair value(b)
(615
)

 
(615
)
 
1,280


 
1,280

 
(1,025
)

 
(1,025
)
(a)
Total changes in instrument-specific credit risk (DVA) related to structured notes were $20 million, $(337) million and $(340) million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. These totals include such changes for structured notes classified within deposits and other borrowed funds, as well as long-term debt.
(b)
Structured notes are predominantly financial instruments containing embedded derivatives. Where present, the embedded derivative is the primary driver of risk. Although the risk associated with the structured notes is actively managed, the gains/(losses) reported in this table do not include the income statement impact of the risk management instruments used to manage such risk.
(c)
Reported in mortgage fees and related income.
(d)
Reported in other income.

Determination of instrument-specific credit risk for items for which a fair value election was made
The following describes how the gains and losses included in earnings that are attributable to changes in instrument-specific credit risk, were determined.
Loans and lending-related commitments: For floating-rate instruments, all changes in value are attributed to instrument-specific credit risk. For fixed-rate instruments, an allocation of the changes in value for the period is made between those changes in value that are interest rate-related and changes in value that are credit-related. Allocations are generally based on an analysis of borrower-specific credit spread and recovery
 
information, where available, or benchmarking to similar entities or industries.
Long-term debt: Changes in value attributable to instrument-specific credit risk were derived principally from observable changes in the Firm’s credit spread.
Resale and repurchase agreements, securities borrowed agreements and securities lending agreements: Generally, for these types of agreements, there is a requirement that collateral be maintained with a market value equal to or in excess of the principal amount loaned; as a result, there would be no adjustment or an immaterial adjustment for instrument-specific credit risk related to these agreements.


200
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Difference between aggregate fair value and aggregate remaining contractual principal balance outstanding
The following table reflects the difference between the aggregate fair value and the aggregate remaining contractual principal balance outstanding as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, for loans, long-term debt and long-term beneficial interests for which the fair value option has been elected.
 
2014
 
2013
December 31, (in millions)
Contractual principal outstanding
 
Fair value
Fair value over/(under) contractual principal outstanding
 
Contractual principal outstanding
 
Fair value
Fair value over/(under) contractual principal outstanding
Loans(a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Nonaccrual loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans reported as trading assets
$
3,847

 
$
905

$
(2,942
)
 
$
5,156

 
$
1,491

$
(3,665
)
Loans
7

 
7


 
209

 
154

(55
)
Subtotal
3,854

 
912

(2,942
)
 
5,365

 
1,645

(3,720
)
All other performing loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans reported as trading assets
37,608

 
35,462

(2,146
)
 
33,069

 
29,295

(3,774
)
Loans
2,397

 
2,389

(8
)
 
1,618

 
1,563

(55
)
Total loans
$
43,859

 
$
38,763

$
(5,096
)
 
$
40,052

 
$
32,503

$
(7,549
)
Long-term debt
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Principal-protected debt
$
14,660

(c) 
$
15,484

$
824

 
$
15,797

(c) 
$
15,909

$
112

Nonprincipal-protected debt(b)
NA

 
14,742

NA

 
NA

 
12,969

NA

Total long-term debt
NA

 
$
30,226

NA

 
NA

 
$
28,878

NA

Long-term beneficial interests
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Nonprincipal-protected debt(b)
NA

 
$
2,162

NA

 
NA

 
$
1,996

NA

Total long-term beneficial interests
NA


$
2,162

NA

 
NA

 
$
1,996

NA

(a)
There were no performing loans that were ninety days or more past due as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
(b)
Remaining contractual principal is not applicable to nonprincipal-protected notes. Unlike principal-protected structured notes, for which the Firm is obligated to return a stated amount of principal at the maturity of the note, nonprincipal-protected structured notes do not obligate the Firm to return a stated amount of principal at maturity, but to return an amount based on the performance of an underlying variable or derivative feature embedded in the note. However, investors are exposed to the credit risk of the Firm as issuer for both nonprincipal-protected and principal protected notes.
(c)
Where the Firm issues principal-protected zero-coupon or discount notes, the balance reflected as the remaining contractual principal is the final principal payment at maturity.

At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the contractual amount of letters of credit for which the fair value option was elected was $4.5 billion and $4.5 billion, respectively, with a corresponding fair value of $(147) million and $(99) million, respectively. For further information regarding off-balance sheet lending-related financial instruments, see Note 29.


Structured note products by balance sheet classification and risk component
The table below presents the fair value of the structured notes issued by the Firm, by balance sheet classification and the primary risk to which the structured notes’ embedded derivative relates.
 
December 31, 2014
 
December 31, 2013
(in millions)
Long-term debt
Other borrowed funds
Deposits
Total
 
Long-term debt
Other borrowed funds
Deposits
Total
Risk exposure
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate
$
10,858

$
460

$
2,119

$
13,437

 
$
9,516

$
615

$
1,270

$
11,401

Credit
4,023

450


4,473

 
4,248

13


4,261

Foreign exchange
2,150

211

17

2,378

 
2,321

194

27

2,542

Equity
12,348

12,412

4,415

29,175

 
11,082

11,936

3,736

26,754

Commodity
710

644

2,012

3,366

 
1,260

310

1,133

2,703

Total structured notes
$
30,089

$
14,177

$
8,563

$
52,829

 
$
28,427

$
13,068

$
6,166

$
47,661





JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
201

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Note 5 – Credit risk concentrations
Concentrations of credit risk arise when a number of customers are engaged in similar business activities or activities in the same geographic region, or when they have similar economic features that would cause their ability to meet contractual obligations to be similarly affected by changes in economic conditions.
JPMorgan Chase regularly monitors various segments of its credit portfolios to assess potential concentration risks and to obtain collateral when deemed necessary. Senior management is significantly involved in the credit approval and review process, and risk levels are adjusted as needed to reflect the Firm’s risk appetite.
In the Firm’s consumer portfolio, concentrations are evaluated primarily by product and by U.S. geographic region, with a key focus on trends and concentrations at the portfolio level, where potential risk concentrations can be remedied through changes in underwriting policies and portfolio guidelines. In the wholesale portfolio, risk
 
concentrations are evaluated primarily by industry and monitored regularly on both an aggregate portfolio level and on an individual customer basis. The Firm’s wholesale exposure is managed through loan syndications and participations, loan sales, securitizations, credit derivatives, master netting agreements, and collateral and other risk-reduction techniques. For additional information on loans, see Note 14.
The Firm does not believe that its exposure to any particular loan product (e.g., option adjustable rate mortgages (“ARMs”)), industry segment (e.g., commercial real estate) or its exposure to residential real estate loans with high loan-to-value ratios results in a significant concentration of credit risk. Terms of loan products and collateral coverage are included in the Firm’s assessment when extending credit and establishing its allowance for loan losses.



The table below presents both on–balance sheet and off–balance sheet consumer and wholesale-related credit exposure by the Firm’s three credit portfolio segments as of December 31, 2014 and 2013.
 
2014
 
2013
 
Credit exposure
On-balance sheet
Off-balance sheet(d)
 
Credit exposure
On-balance sheet
Off-balance sheet(d)
December 31, (in millions)
Loans
Derivatives
 
Loans
Derivatives
Total consumer, excluding credit card
$
353,635

$
295,374

$

$
58,153

 
$
345,259

$
289,063

$

$
56,057

Total credit card
657,011

131,048


525,963

 
657,174

127,791


529,383

Total consumer
1,010,646

426,422


584,116

 
1,002,433

416,854


585,440

Wholesale-related
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real Estate
107,386

79,113

333

27,940

 
87,102

69,151

460

17,491

Banks & Finance Cos
68,203

24,244

22,057

21,902

 
66,881

25,482

18,888

22,511

Healthcare
57,707

13,793

4,630

39,284

 
46,934

14,383

2,203

30,348

Oil & Gas
48,315

15,616

1,872

30,827

 
45,910

13,319

3,202

29,389

Consumer Products
37,818

10,646

593

26,579

 
35,666

8,708

3,319

23,639

Asset Managers
36,374

8,043

9,569

18,762

 
34,145

9,099

715

24,331

State & Municipal Govt
31,858

7,593

4,079

20,186

 
33,506

5,656

7,175

20,675

Retail & Consumer Services
28,258

7,752

361

20,145

 
28,983

5,582

2,248

21,153

Utilities
28,060

4,843

2,317

20,900

 
25,068

7,504

273

17,291

Central Govt
21,081

1,081

11,819

8,181

 
21,403

4,426

1,392

15,585

Technology
20,977

4,727

1,341

14,909

 
21,049

1,754

9,998

9,297

Machinery & Equipment Mfg
20,573

6,537

553

13,483

 
19,078

5,969

476

12,633

Transportation
16,365

9,107

699

6,559

 
17,434

5,825

560

11,049

Business Services
16,201

4,867

456

10,878

 
14,601

4,497

594

9,510

Metals/Mining
15,911

5,628

601

9,682

 
13,975

6,845

621

6,509

All other(a)
320,446

120,912

17,695

181,839

 
308,519

120,063

13,635

174,821

Subtotal
875,533

324,502

78,975

472,056

 
820,254

308,263

65,759

446,232

Loans held-for-sale and loans at fair value
6,412

6,412



 
13,301

13,301



Receivables from customers and other(b)
28,972




 
26,744




Total wholesale-related
910,917

330,914

78,975

472,056

 
860,299

321,564

65,759

446,232

Total exposure(c)
$
1,921,563

$
757,336

$
78,975

$
1,056,172

 
$
1,862,732

$
738,418

$
65,759

$
1,031,672

(a)
For more information on exposures to SPEs included within All other, see Note 16.
(b)
Primarily consists of margin loans to prime brokerage customers that are generally over-collateralized through a pledge of assets maintained in clients’ brokerage accounts and are subject to daily minimum collateral requirements. As a result of the Firm’s credit risk mitigation practices, the Firm did not hold any reserves for credit impairment on these receivables.
(c)
For further information regarding on–balance sheet credit concentrations by major product and/or geography, see Note 6 and Note 14. For information regarding concentrations of off–balance sheet lending-related financial instruments by major product, see Note 29.
(d)
Represents lending-related financial instruments.

202
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Note 6 – Derivative instruments
Derivative instruments enable end-users to modify or mitigate exposure to credit or market risks. Counterparties to a derivative contract seek to obtain risks and rewards similar to those that could be obtained from purchasing or selling a related cash instrument without having to exchange upfront the full purchase or sales price. JPMorgan Chase makes markets in derivatives for customers and also uses derivatives to hedge or manage its own risk exposures. Predominantly all of the Firm’s derivatives are entered into for market-making or risk management purposes.
Market-making derivatives
The majority of the Firm’s derivatives are entered into for market-making purposes. Customers use derivatives to mitigate or modify interest rate, credit, foreign exchange, equity and commodity risks. The Firm actively manages the risks from its exposure to these derivatives by entering into other derivative transactions or by purchasing or selling other financial instruments that partially or fully offset the exposure from client derivatives. The Firm also seeks to earn a spread between the client derivatives and offsetting positions, and from the remaining open risk positions.
Risk management derivatives
The Firm manages its market risk exposures using various derivative instruments.
Interest rate contracts are used to minimize fluctuations in earnings that are caused by changes in interest rates. Fixed-rate assets and liabilities appreciate or depreciate in market value as interest rates change. Similarly, interest income and expense increases or decreases as a result of variable-rate assets and liabilities resetting to current market rates, and as a result of the repayment and subsequent origination or issuance of fixed-rate assets and liabilities at current market rates. Gains or losses on the derivative instruments that are related to such assets and liabilities are expected to substantially offset this variability in earnings. The Firm generally uses interest rate swaps, forwards and futures to manage the impact of interest rate fluctuations on earnings.
Foreign currency forward contracts are used to manage the foreign exchange risk associated with certain foreign currency–denominated (i.e., non-U.S. dollar) assets and liabilities and forecasted transactions, as well as the Firm’s net investments in certain non-U.S. subsidiaries or branches whose functional currencies are not the U.S. dollar. As a result of fluctuations in foreign currencies, the U.S. dollar–equivalent values of the foreign currency–denominated assets and liabilities or forecasted revenue or expense increase or decrease. Gains or losses on the derivative instruments related to these foreign currency–denominated assets or liabilities, or forecasted transactions, are expected to substantially offset this variability.
 
Commodities contracts are used to manage the price risk of certain commodities inventories. Gains or losses on these derivative instruments are expected to substantially offset the depreciation or appreciation of the related inventory.
Credit derivatives are used to manage the counterparty credit risk associated with loans and lending-related commitments. Credit derivatives compensate the purchaser when the entity referenced in the contract experiences a credit event, such as bankruptcy or a failure to pay an obligation when due. Credit derivatives primarily consist of credit default swaps. For a further discussion of credit derivatives, see the discussion in the Credit derivatives section on pages 213–215 of this Note.
For more information about risk management derivatives, see the risk management derivatives gains and losses table on page 213 of this Note, and the hedge accounting gains and losses tables on pages 211–213 of this Note.
Derivative counterparties and settlement types
The Firm enters into OTC derivatives, which are negotiated and settled bilaterally with the derivative counterparty. The Firm also enters into, as principal, certain exchange-traded derivatives (“ETD”) such as futures and options, and “cleared” over-the-counter (“OTC-cleared”) derivative contracts with central counterparties (“CCPs”). ETD contracts are generally standardized contracts traded on an exchange and cleared by the CCP, which is the counterparty from the inception of the transactions. OTC-cleared derivatives are traded on a bilateral basis and then novated to the CCP for clearing.
Derivative Clearing Services
The Firm provides clearing services for clients where the Firm acts as a clearing member with respect to certain derivative exchanges and clearinghouses. The Firm does not reflect the clients’ derivative contracts in its Consolidated Financial Statements. For further information on the Firm’s clearing services, see Note 29.
Accounting for derivatives
All free-standing derivatives that the Firm executes for its own account are required to be recorded on the Consolidated balance sheets at fair value.
As permitted under U.S. GAAP, the Firm nets derivative assets and liabilities, and the related cash collateral receivables and payables, when a legally enforceable master netting agreement exists between the Firm and the derivative counterparty. For further discussion of the offsetting of assets and liabilities, see Note 1. The accounting for changes in value of a derivative depends on whether or not the transaction has been designated and qualifies for hedge accounting. Derivatives that are not designated as hedges are reported and measured at fair value through earnings. The tabular disclosures on pages 207–213 of this Note provide additional information on the amount of, and reporting for, derivative assets, liabilities, gains and losses. For further discussion of derivatives embedded in structured notes, see Notes 3 and 4.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
203

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Derivatives designated as hedges
The Firm applies hedge accounting to certain derivatives executed for risk management purposes – generally interest rate, foreign exchange and commodity derivatives. However, JPMorgan Chase does not seek to apply hedge accounting to all of the derivatives involved in the Firm’s risk management activities. For example, the Firm does not apply hedge accounting to purchased credit default swaps used to manage the credit risk of loans and lending-related commitments, because of the difficulties in qualifying such contracts as hedges. For the same reason, the Firm does not apply hedge accounting to certain interest rate and commodity derivatives used for risk management purposes.
To qualify for hedge accounting, a derivative must be highly effective at reducing the risk associated with the exposure being hedged. In addition, for a derivative to be designated as a hedge, the risk management objective and strategy must be documented. Hedge documentation must identify the derivative hedging instrument, the asset or liability or forecasted transaction and type of risk to be hedged, and how the effectiveness of the derivative is assessed prospectively and retrospectively. To assess effectiveness, the Firm uses statistical methods such as regression analysis, as well as nonstatistical methods including dollar-value comparisons of the change in the fair value of the derivative to the change in the fair value or cash flows of the hedged item. The extent to which a derivative has been, and is expected to continue to be, effective at offsetting changes in the fair value or cash flows of the hedged item must be assessed and documented at least quarterly. Any hedge ineffectiveness (i.e., the amount by which the gain or loss on the designated derivative instrument does not exactly offset the change in the hedged item attributable to the hedged risk) must be reported in current-period earnings. If it is determined that a derivative is not highly effective at hedging the designated exposure, hedge accounting is discontinued.
 
There are three types of hedge accounting designations: fair value hedges, cash flow hedges and net investment hedges. JPMorgan Chase uses fair value hedges primarily to hedge fixed-rate long-term debt, AFS securities and certain commodities inventories. For qualifying fair value hedges, the changes in the fair value of the derivative, and in the value of the hedged item for the risk being hedged, are recognized in earnings. If the hedge relationship is terminated, then the adjustment to the hedged item continues to be reported as part of the basis of the hedged item and for interest-bearing instruments is amortized to earnings as a yield adjustment. Derivative amounts affecting earnings are recognized consistent with the classification of the hedged item – primarily net interest income and principal transactions revenue.
JPMorgan Chase uses cash flow hedges primarily to hedge the exposure to variability in forecasted cash flows from floating-rate assets and liabilities and foreign currency–denominated revenue and expense. For qualifying cash flow hedges, the effective portion of the change in the fair value of the derivative is recorded in OCI and recognized in the Consolidated statements of income when the hedged cash flows affect earnings. Derivative amounts affecting earnings are recognized consistent with the classification of the hedged item – primarily interest income, interest expense, noninterest revenue and compensation expense. The ineffective portions of cash flow hedges are immediately recognized in earnings. If the hedge relationship is terminated, then the value of the derivative recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss) (“AOCI”) is recognized in earnings when the cash flows that were hedged affect earnings. For hedge relationships that are discontinued because a forecasted transaction is not expected to occur according to the original hedge forecast, any related derivative values recorded in AOCI are immediately recognized in earnings.
JPMorgan Chase uses foreign currency hedges to protect the value of the Firm’s net investments in certain non-U.S. subsidiaries or branches whose functional currencies are not the U.S. dollar. For foreign currency qualifying net investment hedges, changes in the fair value of the derivatives are recorded in the translation adjustments account within AOCI.


204
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The following table outlines the Firm’s primary uses of derivatives and the related hedge accounting designation or disclosure category.
Type of Derivative
Use of Derivative
Designation and disclosure
Affected segment or unit
Page reference
Manage specifically identified risk exposures in qualifying hedge accounting relationships:
 
 
 
◦ Interest rate
Hedge fixed rate assets and liabilities
Fair value hedge
Corporate
211
◦ Interest rate
Hedge floating rate assets and liabilities
Cash flow hedge
Corporate
212
 Foreign exchange
Hedge foreign currency-denominated assets and liabilities
Fair value hedge
Corporate
211
 Foreign exchange
Hedge forecasted revenue and expense
Cash flow hedge
Corporate
212
 Foreign exchange
Hedge the value of the Firm’s investments in non-U.S. subsidiaries
Net investment hedge
Corporate
213
 Commodity
Hedge commodity inventory
Fair value hedge
CIB
211
Manage specifically identified risk exposures not designated in qualifying hedge accounting relationships:
 
 
 
 Interest rate
Manage the risk of the mortgage pipeline, warehouse loans and MSRs
Specified risk management
CCB
213
 Credit
Manage the credit risk of wholesale lending exposures
Specified risk management
CIB
213
 Commodity
Manage the risk of certain commodities-related contracts and investments
Specified risk management
CIB
213
Interest rate and foreign exchange
Manage the risk of certain other specified assets and liabilities
Specified risk management
Corporate
213
Market-making derivatives and other activities:
 
 
 
 Various
Market-making and related risk management
Market-making and other
CIB
213
 Various
Other derivatives(a)
Market-making and other
CIB, Corporate
213
(a)
Other derivatives included the synthetic credit portfolio. The synthetic credit portfolio was a portfolio of index credit derivatives, including short and long positions, that was originally held by CIO. On July 2, 2012, CIO transferred the synthetic credit portfolio, other than a portion that aggregated to a notional amount of approximately $12 billion, to CIB; these retained positions were effectively closed out during the third quarter of 2012. CIB effectively sold the positions that had been transferred to it by the end of 2014. The results of the synthetic credit portfolio, including the portion transferred to CIB, have been included in the gains and losses on derivatives related to market-making activities and other derivatives category discussed on page 213 of this Note.

JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
205

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Notional amount of derivative contracts
The following table summarizes the notional amount of derivative contracts outstanding as of December 31, 2014 and 2013.
 
Notional amounts(c)
December 31, (in billions)
2014

2013

Interest rate contracts
 
 
Swaps
$
29,734

$
35,221

Futures and forwards(a)
10,189

11,238

Written options(a)
3,903

4,059

Purchased options
4,259

4,187

Total interest rate contracts
48,085

54,705

Credit derivatives(a)(b)
4,249

5,331

Foreign exchange contracts
 
 

Cross-currency swaps
3,346

3,488

Spot, futures and forwards
4,669

3,773

Written options
790

659

Purchased options
780

652

Total foreign exchange contracts
9,585

8,572

Equity contracts
 
 
Swaps(a)
206

187

Futures and forwards(a)
50

50

Written options
432

425

Purchased options
375

380

Total equity contracts
1,063

1,042

Commodity contracts
 
 

Swaps
126

124

Spot, futures and forwards
193

234

Written options
181

202

Purchased options
180

203

Total commodity contracts
680

763

Total derivative notional amounts
$
63,662

$
70,413

(a)
The prior period amounts have been revised. This revision had no impact on the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets or its results of operations.
(b)
For more information on volumes and types of credit derivative contracts, see the Credit derivatives discussion on pages 213–215 of this Note.
(c)
Represents the sum of gross long and gross short third-party notional derivative contracts.

While the notional amounts disclosed above give an indication of the volume of the Firm’s derivatives activity, the notional amounts significantly exceed, in the Firm’s view, the possible losses that could arise from such transactions. For most derivative transactions, the notional amount is not exchanged; it is used simply as a reference to calculate payments.
 





206
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Impact of derivatives on the Consolidated balance sheets
The following table summarizes information on derivative receivables and payables (before and after netting adjustments) that are reflected on the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, by accounting designation (e.g., whether the derivatives were designated in qualifying hedge accounting relationships or not) and contract type.
Free-standing derivative receivables and payables(a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross derivative receivables
 
 
 
Gross derivative payables
 
 
December 31, 2014
(in millions)
Not designated as hedges
Designated as hedges
Total derivative receivables
 
Net derivative receivables(b)
 
Not designated as hedges
Designated as hedges
Total derivative payables
 
Net derivative payables(b)
Trading assets and liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate
$
951,151

$
5,372

 
$
956,523

 
$
33,725

 
$
921,634

$
3,011

$
924,645

 
$
17,745

Credit
76,842


 
76,842

 
1,838

 
75,895


75,895

 
1,593

Foreign exchange
205,271

3,650

 
208,921

 
21,253

 
217,722

626

218,348

 
22,970

Equity
46,792


 
46,792

 
8,177

 
50,565


50,565

 
11,740

Commodity
43,151

502

 
43,653

 
13,982

 
45,455

168

45,623

 
17,068

Total fair value of trading assets and liabilities
$
1,323,207

$
9,524

 
$
1,332,731

 
$
78,975

 
$
1,311,271

$
3,805

$
1,315,076

 
$
71,116

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gross derivative receivables
 
 
 
Gross derivative payables
 
 
December 31, 2013
(in millions)
Not designated as hedges
Designated as hedges
Total derivative receivables
 
Net derivative receivables(b)
 
Not designated as hedges
Designated as hedges
Total derivative payables
 
Net derivative payables(b)
Trading assets and liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate
$
851,189

$
3,490

 
$
854,679

 
$
25,782

 
$
820,811

$
4,543

$
825,354

 
$
13,283

Credit
83,520


 
83,520

 
1,516

 
82,402


82,402

 
2,281

Foreign exchange
152,240

1,359

 
153,599

 
16,790

 
158,728

1,397

160,125

 
15,947

Equity
52,931


 
52,931

 
12,227

 
54,654


54,654

 
14,719

Commodity
34,344

1,394

 
35,738

 
9,444

 
37,605

9

37,614

 
11,084

Total fair value of trading assets and liabilities
$
1,174,224

$
6,243

 
$
1,180,467

 
$
65,759

 
$
1,154,200

$
5,949

$
1,160,149

 
$
57,314

(a)
Balances exclude structured notes for which the fair value option has been elected. See Note 4 for further information.
(b)
As permitted under U.S. GAAP, the Firm has elected to net derivative receivables and derivative payables and the related cash collateral receivables and payables when a legally enforceable master netting agreement exists.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
207

Notes to consolidated financial statements

The following table presents, as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the gross and net derivative receivables by contract and settlement type. Derivative receivables have been netted on the Consolidated balance sheets against derivative payables and cash collateral payables to the same counterparty with respect to derivative contracts for which the Firm has obtained an appropriate legal opinion with respect to the master netting agreement. Where such a legal opinion has not been either sought or obtained, the receivables are not eligible under U.S. GAAP for netting on the Consolidated balance sheets, and are shown separately in the table below.
 
2014
 
2013
December 31, (in millions)
Gross derivative receivables
Amounts netted on the Consolidated balance sheets
Net derivative receivables
 
Gross derivative receivables
Amounts netted on the Consolidated balance sheets
Net derivative receivables
U.S. GAAP nettable derivative receivables
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
OTC
$
548,373

$
(521,180
)
 
$
27,193

 
$
486,449

$
(466,493
)
 
$
19,956

OTC–cleared
401,656

(401,618
)
 
38

 
362,426

(362,404
)
 
22

Exchange-traded(a)


 

 


 

Total interest rate contracts
950,029

(922,798
)
 
27,231

 
848,875

(828,897
)
 
19,978

Credit contracts:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
OTC
66,636

(65,720
)
 
916

 
66,269

(65,725
)
 
544

OTC–cleared
9,320

(9,284
)
 
36

 
16,841

(16,279
)
 
562

Total credit contracts
75,956

(75,004
)
 
952

 
83,110

(82,004
)
 
1,106

Foreign exchange contracts:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
OTC
202,537

(187,634
)
 
14,903

 
148,953

(136,763
)
 
12,190

OTC–cleared
36

(34
)
 
2

 
46

(46
)
 

Exchange-traded(a)


 

 


 

Total foreign exchange contracts
202,573

(187,668
)
 
14,905

 
148,999

(136,809
)
 
12,190

Equity contracts:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
OTC
23,258

(22,826
)
 
432

 
31,870

(29,289
)
 
2,581

OTC–cleared


 

 


 

Exchange-traded(a)
18,143

(15,789
)
 
2,354

 
17,732

(11,415
)
 
6,317

Total equity contracts
41,401

(38,615
)
 
2,786

 
49,602

(40,704
)
 
8,898

Commodity contracts:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
OTC
22,555

(14,327
)
 
8,228

 
21,619

(15,082
)
 
6,537

OTC–cleared


 

 


 

Exchange-traded(a)
19,500

(15,344
)
 
4,156

 
12,528

(11,212
)
 
1,316

Total commodity contracts
42,055

(29,671
)
 
12,384

 
34,147

(26,294
)
 
7,853

Derivative receivables with appropriate legal opinion
$
1,312,014

$
(1,253,756
)
(b) 
$
58,258

 
$
1,164,733

$
(1,114,708
)
(b) 
$
50,025

Derivative receivables where an appropriate legal opinion has not been either sought or obtained
20,717

 
 
20,717

 
15,734

 
 
15,734

Total derivative receivables recognized on the Consolidated balance sheets
$
1,332,731

 
 
$
78,975

 
$
1,180,467

 
 
$
65,759

(a)
Exchange-traded derivative amounts that relate to futures contracts are settled daily.
(b)
Included cash collateral netted of $74.0 billion and $63.9 billion at December 31, 2014, and 2013, respectively.

208
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The following table presents, as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the gross and net derivative payables by contract and settlement type. Derivative payables have been netted on the Consolidated balance sheets against derivative receivables and cash collateral receivables from the same counterparty with respect to derivative contracts for which the Firm has obtained an appropriate legal opinion with respect to the master netting agreement. Where such a legal opinion has not been either sought or obtained, the payables are not eligible under U.S. GAAP for netting on the Consolidated balance sheets, and are shown separately in the table below.
 
2014
 
2013
December 31, (in millions)
Gross derivative payables
Amounts netted on the Consolidated balance sheets
Net derivative payables
 
Gross derivative payables
Amounts netted on the Consolidated balance sheets
Net derivative payables
U.S. GAAP nettable derivative payables
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate contracts:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
OTC
$
522,170

$
(509,650
)
 
$
12,520

 
$
467,850

$
(458,081
)
 
$
9,769

OTC–cleared
398,518

(397,250
)
 
1,268

 
354,698

(353,990
)
 
708

Exchange-traded(a)


 

 


 

Total interest rate contracts
920,688

(906,900
)
 
13,788

 
822,548

(812,071
)
 
10,477

Credit contracts:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
OTC
65,432

(64,904
)
 
528

 
65,223

(63,671
)
 
1,552

OTC–cleared
9,398

(9,398
)
 

 
16,506

(16,450
)
 
56

Total credit contracts
74,830

(74,302
)
 
528

 
81,729

(80,121
)
 
1,608

Foreign exchange contracts:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
OTC
211,732

(195,312
)
 
16,420

 
155,110

(144,119
)
 
10,991

OTC–cleared
66

(66
)
 

 
61

(59
)
 
2

Exchange-traded(a)


 

 


 

Total foreign exchange contracts
211,798

(195,378
)
 
16,420

 
155,171

(144,178
)
 
10,993

Equity contracts:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
OTC
27,908

(23,036
)
 
4,872

 
33,295

(28,520
)
 
4,775

OTC–cleared


 

 


 

Exchange-traded(a)
17,167

(15,789
)
 
1,378

 
17,349

(11,415
)
 
5,934

Total equity contracts
45,075

(38,825
)
 
6,250

 
50,644

(39,935
)
 
10,709

Commodity contracts:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
OTC
25,129

(13,211
)
 
11,918

 
21,993

(15,318
)
 
6,675

OTC–cleared


 

 


 

Exchange-traded(a)
18,486

(15,344
)
 
3,142

 
12,367

(11,212
)
 
1,155

Total commodity contracts
43,615

(28,555
)
 
15,060

 
34,360

(26,530
)
 
7,830

Derivative payables with appropriate legal opinions
$
1,296,006

$
(1,243,960
)
(b) 
$
52,046

 
$
1,144,452

$
(1,102,835
)
(b) 
$
41,617

Derivative payables where an appropriate legal opinion has not been either sought or obtained
19,070

 
 
19,070

 
15,697

 
 
15,697

Total derivative payables recognized on the Consolidated balance sheets
$
1,315,076

 
 
$
71,116

 
$
1,160,149

 
 
$
57,314

(a)
Exchange-traded derivative balances that relate to futures contracts are settled daily.
(b)
Included cash collateral netted of $64.2 billion and $52.1 billion related to OTC and OTC-cleared derivatives at December 31, 2014, and 2013, respectively.

In addition to the cash collateral received and transferred that is presented on a net basis with net derivative receivables and payables, the Firm receives and transfers additional collateral (financial instruments and cash). These amounts mitigate counterparty credit risk associated with the Firm’s derivative instruments but are not eligible for net presentation, because (a) the collateral is comprised of
 
non-cash financial instruments (generally U.S. government and agency securities and other G7 government bonds), (b) the amount of collateral held or transferred exceeds the fair value exposure, at the individual counterparty level, as of the date presented, or (c) the collateral relates to derivative receivables or payables where an appropriate legal opinion has not been either sought or obtained.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
209

Notes to consolidated financial statements

The following tables present information regarding certain financial instrument collateral received and transferred as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, that is not eligible for net presentation under U.S. GAAP. The collateral included in these tables relates only to the derivative instruments for which appropriate legal opinions have been obtained; excluded are (i) additional collateral that exceeds the fair value exposure and (ii) all collateral related to derivative instruments where an appropriate legal opinion has not been either sought or obtained.
Derivative receivable collateral
 
 
 
 
 
 
2014
 
2013
December 31, (in millions)
Net derivative receivables
Collateral not nettable on the Consolidated balance sheets
 
Net exposure
 
Net derivative receivables
Collateral not nettable on the Consolidated balance sheets
 
Net exposure
Derivative receivables with appropriate legal opinions
$
58,258

$
(16,194
)
(a) 
$
42,064

 
$
50,025

$
(12,414
)
(a) 
$
37,611

Derivative payable collateral(b)
 
 
 
 
 
 
2014
 
2013
December 31, (in millions)
Net derivative payables
Collateral not nettable on the Consolidated balance sheets
 
Net amount(c)
 
Net derivative payables
Collateral not nettable on the Consolidated balance sheets
 
Net amount(c)
Derivative payables with appropriate legal opinions
$
52,046

$
(10,505
)
(a) 
$
41,541

 
$
41,617

$
(6,873
)
(a) 
$
34,744

(a)
Represents liquid security collateral as well as cash collateral held at third party custodians. For some counterparties, the collateral amounts of financial instruments may exceed the derivative receivables and derivative payables balances. Where this is the case, the total amount reported is limited to the net derivative receivables and net derivative payables balances with that counterparty.
(b)
Derivative payable collateral relates only to OTC and OTC-cleared derivative instruments. Amounts exclude collateral transferred related to exchange-traded derivative instruments.
(c)
Net amount represents exposure of counterparties to the Firm.

Liquidity risk and credit-related contingent features
In addition to the specific market risks introduced by each derivative contract type, derivatives expose JPMorgan Chase to credit risk — the risk that derivative counterparties may fail to meet their payment obligations under the derivative contracts and the collateral, if any, held by the Firm proves to be of insufficient value to cover the payment obligation. It is the policy of JPMorgan Chase to actively pursue, where possible, the use of legally enforceable master netting arrangements and collateral agreements to mitigate derivative counterparty credit risk. The amount of derivative receivables reported on the Consolidated balance sheets is the fair value of the derivative contracts after giving effect to legally enforceable master netting agreements and cash collateral held by the Firm.
While derivative receivables expose the Firm to credit risk, derivative payables expose the Firm to liquidity risk, as the derivative contracts typically require the Firm to post cash or securities collateral with counterparties as the fair value of the contracts moves in the counterparties’ favor or upon specified downgrades in the Firm’s and its subsidiaries’ respective credit ratings. Certain derivative contracts also provide for termination of the contract, generally upon a downgrade of either the Firm or the counterparty, at the fair value of the derivative contracts. The following table shows the aggregate fair value of net derivative payables related to OTC and OTC-cleared derivatives that contain contingent collateral or termination features that may be triggered upon a ratings downgrade, and the associated collateral the Firm has posted in the normal course of business, at December 31, 2014 and 2013.
 
OTC and OTC-cleared derivative payables containing downgrade triggers
December 31, (in millions)
2014
2013
Aggregate fair value of net derivative payables
$
32,303

$
24,631

Collateral posted
27,585

20,346

The following table shows the impact of a single-notch and two-notch downgrade of the long-term issuer ratings of JPMorgan Chase & Co. and its subsidiaries, predominantly JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association (“JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.”), at December 31, 2014 and 2013, related to OTC and OTC-cleared derivative contracts with contingent collateral or termination features that may be triggered upon a ratings downgrade. Derivatives contracts generally require additional collateral to be posted or terminations to be triggered when the predefined threshold rating is breached. A downgrade by a single rating agency that does not result in a rating lower than a preexisting corresponding rating provided by another major rating agency will generally not result in additional collateral, except in certain instances in which additional initial margin may be required upon a ratings downgrade, or termination payment requirements. The liquidity impact in the table is calculated based upon a downgrade below the lowest current rating of the rating agencies referred to in the derivative contract.





210
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Liquidity impact of downgrade triggers on OTC and
OTC-cleared derivatives
 
 
 
 
 
 
2014
 
2013
December 31, (in millions)
Single-notch downgrade
Two-notch downgrade
 
Single-notch downgrade
Two-notch downgrade
Amount of additional collateral to be posted upon downgrade(a)
$
1,046

$
3,331

 
$
952

$
3,244

Amount required to settle contracts with termination triggers upon downgrade(b)
366

1,388

 
540

876

(a)
Includes the additional collateral to be posted for initial margin.
(b)
Amounts represent fair value of derivative payables, and do not reflect collateral posted.

Impact of derivatives on the Consolidated statements of income
The following tables provide information related to gains and losses recorded on derivatives based on their hedge accounting
designation or purpose.
Fair value hedge gains and losses
The following tables present derivative instruments, by contract type, used in fair value hedge accounting relationships, as well as pretax gains/(losses) recorded on such derivatives and the related hedged items for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The Firm includes gains/(losses) on the hedging derivative and the related hedged item in the same line item in the Consolidated statements of income.
 
Gains/(losses) recorded in income
 
Income statement impact due to:
Year ended December 31, 2014 (in millions)
Derivatives
Hedged items
Total income statement impact
 
Hedge ineffectiveness(d)
Excluded components(e)
Contract type
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate(a)
$
2,106

 
$
(801
)
 
$
1,305

 
$
131

 
$
1,174

Foreign exchange(b)
8,279

 
(8,532
)
 
(253
)
 

 
(253
)
Commodity(c)
49

 
145

 
194

 
42

 
152

Total
$
10,434

 
$
(9,188
)
 
$
1,246

 
$
173

 
$
1,073

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains/(losses) recorded in income
 
Income statement impact due to:
Year ended December 31, 2013 (in millions)
Derivatives
Hedged items
Total income statement impact
 
Hedge ineffectiveness(d)
Excluded components(e)
Contract type
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate(a)
$
(3,469
)
 
$
4,851

 
$
1,382

 
$
(132
)
 
$
1,514

Foreign exchange(b)
(1,096
)
 
864

 
(232
)
 

 
(232
)
Commodity(c)
485

 
(1,304
)
 
(819
)
 
38

 
(857
)
Total
$
(4,080
)
 
$
4,411

 
$
331

 
$
(94
)
 
$
425

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains/(losses) recorded in income
 
Income statement impact due to:
Year ended December 31, 2012 (in millions)
Derivatives
Hedged items
Total income statement impact
 
Hedge ineffectiveness(d)
Excluded components(e)
Contract type
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate(a)
$
(1,238
)
 
$
1,879

 
$
641

 
$
(28
)
 
$
669

Foreign exchange(b)
(3,027
)
 
2,925

 
(102
)
 

 
(102
)
Commodity(c)
(2,530
)
 
1,131

 
(1,399
)
 
107

 
(1,506
)
Total
$
(6,795
)
 
$
5,935

 
$
(860
)
 
$
79

 
$
(939
)
(a)
Primarily consists of hedges of the benchmark (e.g., London Interbank Offered Rate (“LIBOR”)) interest rate risk of fixed-rate long-term debt and AFS securities. Gains and losses were recorded in net interest income. The current presentation excludes accrued interest.
(b)
Primarily consists of hedges of the foreign currency risk of long-term debt and AFS securities for changes in spot foreign currency rates. Gains and losses related to the derivatives and the hedged items, due to changes in foreign currency rates, were recorded in principal transactions revenue and net interest income.
(c)
Consists of overall fair value hedges of physical commodities inventories that are generally carried at the lower of cost or market (market approximates fair value). Gains and losses were recorded in principal transactions revenue.
(d)
Hedge ineffectiveness is the amount by which the gain or loss on the designated derivative instrument does not exactly offset the gain or loss on the hedged item attributable to the hedged risk.
(e)
The assessment of hedge effectiveness excludes certain components of the changes in fair values of the derivatives and hedged items such as forward points on foreign exchange forward contracts and time values.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
211

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Cash flow hedge gains and losses
The following tables present derivative instruments, by contract type, used in cash flow hedge accounting relationships, and the pretax gains/(losses) recorded on such derivatives, for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The Firm includes the gain/(loss) on the hedging derivative and the change in cash flows on the hedged item in the same line item in the Consolidated statements of income.
 
 
Gains/(losses) recorded in income and other comprehensive income/(loss)(c)
 
Year ended December 31, 2014
(in millions)
Derivatives – effective portion reclassified from AOCI to income
Hedge ineffectiveness recorded directly in income(d)
Total income statement impact
Derivatives – effective portion recorded in OCI
Total change
in OCI
for period
Contract type
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate(a)
 
$
(54
)
 
 
$

 
 
$
(54
)
 
$
189

 
$
243

 
Foreign exchange(b)
 
78

 
 

 
 
78

 
(91
)
 
(169
)
 
Total
 
$
24

 
 
$

 
 
$
24

 
$
98

 
$
74

 

 
 
Gains/(losses) recorded in income and other comprehensive income/(loss)(c)
 
Year ended December 31, 2013
(in millions)
Derivatives – effective portion reclassified from AOCI to income
Hedge ineffectiveness recorded directly in income(d)
Total income statement impact
Derivatives – effective portion recorded in OCI
Total change
in OCI
for period
Contract type
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate(a)
 
$
(108
)
 
 
$

 
 
$
(108
)
 
$
(565
)
 
$
(457
)
 
Foreign exchange(b)
 
7

 
 

 
 
7

 
40

 
33

 
Total
 
$
(101
)
 
 
$

 
 
$
(101
)
 
$
(525
)
 
$
(424
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gains/(losses) recorded in income and other comprehensive income/(loss)(c)
 
Year ended December 31, 2012
(in millions)
Derivatives – effective portion reclassified from AOCI to income
Hedge ineffectiveness recorded directly in income(d)
Total income statement impact
Derivatives – effective portion recorded in OCI
 
Total change
in OCI
for period
 
Contract type
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate(a)
 
$
(3
)
 
 
$
5

 
 
$
2

 
$
13

 
$
16

 
Foreign exchange(b)
 
31

 
 

 
 
31

 
128

 
97

 
Total
 
$
28

 
 
$
5

 
 
$
33

 
$
141

 
$
113

 
(a)
Primarily consists of benchmark interest rate hedges of LIBOR-indexed floating-rate assets and floating-rate liabilities. Gains and losses were recorded in net interest income.
(b)
Primarily consists of hedges of the foreign currency risk of non-U.S. dollar-denominated revenue and expense. The income statement classification of gains and losses follows the hedged item – primarily noninterest revenue and compensation expense.
(c)
The Firm did not experience any forecasted transactions that failed to occur for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 or 2012.
(d)
Hedge ineffectiveness is the amount by which the cumulative gain or loss on the designated derivative instrument exceeds the present value of the cumulative expected change in cash flows on the hedged item attributable to the hedged risk.
Over the next 12 months, the Firm expects that $33 million (after-tax) of net losses recorded in AOCI at December 31, 2014, related to cash flow hedges will be recognized in income. The maximum length of time over which forecasted transactions are hedged is 9 years, and such transactions primarily relate to core lending and borrowing activities.

212
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Net investment hedge gains and losses
The following table presents hedging instruments, by contract type, that were used in net investment hedge accounting relationships, and the pretax gains/(losses) recorded on such instruments for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012.
 
Gains/(losses) recorded in income and other comprehensive income/(loss)
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
Excluded components recorded directly in income(a)
Effective portion recorded in OCI
 
Excluded components recorded directly in income(a)
Effective portion recorded in OCI
 
Excluded components recorded directly in income(a)
Effective portion recorded in OCI
Foreign exchange derivatives
$(448)
$1,698
 
$(383)
$773
 
$(306)
$(82)
(a)
Certain components of hedging derivatives are permitted to be excluded from the assessment of hedge effectiveness, such as forward points on foreign exchange forward contracts. Amounts related to excluded components are recorded in current-period income. The Firm measures the ineffectiveness of net investment hedge accounting relationships based on changes in spot foreign currency rates, and therefore there was no significant ineffectiveness for net investment hedge accounting relationships during 2014, 2013 and 2012.
Gains and losses on derivatives used for specified risk management purposes
The following table presents pretax gains/(losses) recorded on a limited number of derivatives, not designated in hedge accounting relationships, that are used to manage risks associated with certain specified assets and liabilities, including certain risks arising from the mortgage pipeline, warehouse loans, MSRs, wholesale lending exposures, AFS securities, foreign currency-denominated liabilities, and commodities-related contracts and investments.
 
Derivatives gains/(losses)
recorded in income
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
2014

2013

2012

Contract type
 
 
 
Interest rate(a)
$
2,308

$
617

$
5,353

Credit(b)
(58
)
(142
)
(175
)
Foreign exchange(c)
(7
)
1

47

Commodity(d)
156

178

94

Total
$
2,399

$
654

$
5,319

(a)
Primarily represents interest rate derivatives used to hedge the interest rate risk inherent in the mortgage pipeline, warehouse loans and MSRs, as well as written commitments to originate warehouse loans. Gains and losses were recorded predominantly in mortgage fees and related income.
(b)
Relates to credit derivatives used to mitigate credit risk associated with lending exposures in the Firm’s wholesale businesses. These derivatives do not include credit derivatives used to mitigate counterparty credit risk arising from derivative receivables, which is included in gains and losses on derivatives related to market-making activities and other derivatives. Gains and losses were recorded in principal transactions revenue.
(c)
Primarily relates to hedges of the foreign exchange risk of specified foreign currency-denominated assets and liabilities. Gains and losses were recorded in principal transactions revenue.
(d)
Primarily relates to commodity derivatives used to mitigate energy price risk associated with energy-related contracts and investments. Gains and losses were recorded in principal transactions revenue.


 
Gains and losses on derivatives related to market-making activities and other derivatives
The Firm makes markets in derivatives in order to meet the needs of customers and uses derivatives to manage certain risks associated with net open risk positions from the Firm’s market-making activities, including the counterparty credit risk arising from derivative receivables. All derivatives not included in the hedge accounting or specified risk management categories above are included in this category. Gains and losses on these derivatives are primarily recorded in principal transactions revenue. See Note 7 for information on principal transactions revenue.
Credit derivatives
Credit derivatives are financial instruments whose value is derived from the credit risk associated with the debt of a third-party issuer (the reference entity) and which allow one party (the protection purchaser) to transfer that risk to another party (the protection seller). Credit derivatives expose the protection purchaser to the creditworthiness of the protection seller, as the protection seller is required to make payments under the contract when the reference entity experiences a credit event, such as a bankruptcy, a failure to pay its obligation or a restructuring. The seller of credit protection receives a premium for providing protection but has the risk that the underlying instrument referenced in the contract will be subject to a credit event.
The Firm is both a purchaser and seller of protection in the credit derivatives market and uses these derivatives for two primary purposes. First, in its capacity as a market-maker, the Firm actively manages a portfolio of credit derivatives by purchasing and selling credit protection, predominantly on corporate debt obligations, to meet the needs of customers. Second, as an end-user, the Firm uses credit derivatives to manage credit risk associated with lending exposures (loans and unfunded commitments) and derivatives counterparty exposures in the Firm’s wholesale businesses, and to manage the credit risk arising from certain financial instruments in the Firm’s market-making businesses. Following is a summary of various types of credit derivatives.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
213

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Credit default swaps
Credit derivatives may reference the credit of either a single reference entity (“single-name”) or a broad-based index. The Firm purchases and sells protection on both single- name and index-reference obligations. Single-name CDS and index CDS contracts are typically OTC-cleared derivative contracts. Single-name CDS are used to manage the default risk of a single reference entity, while index CDS contracts are used to manage the credit risk associated with the broader credit markets or credit market segments. Like the S&P 500 and other market indices, a CDS index comprises a portfolio of CDS across many reference entities. New series of CDS indices are periodically established with a new underlying portfolio of reference entities to reflect changes in the credit markets. If one of the reference entities in the index experiences a credit event, then the reference entity that defaulted is removed from the index. CDS can also be referenced against specific portfolios of reference names or against customized exposure levels based on specific client demands: for example, to provide protection against the first $1 million of realized credit losses in a $10 million portfolio of exposure. Such structures are commonly known as tranche CDS.
For both single-name CDS contracts and index CDS contracts, upon the occurrence of a credit event, under the terms of a CDS contract neither party to the CDS contract has recourse to the reference entity. The protection purchaser has recourse to the protection seller for the difference between the face value of the CDS contract and the fair value of the reference obligation at settlement of the credit derivative contract, also known as the recovery value. The protection purchaser does not need to hold the debt instrument of the underlying reference entity in order to receive amounts due under the CDS contract when a credit event occurs.
 
Credit-related notes
A credit-related note is a funded credit derivative where the issuer of the credit-related note purchases from the note investor credit protection on a reference entity or an index. Under the contract, the investor pays the issuer the par value of the note at the inception of the transaction, and in return, the issuer pays periodic payments to the investor, based on the credit risk of the referenced entity. The issuer also repays the investor the par value of the note at maturity unless the reference entity experiences a specified credit event (or one of the entities that makes up a reference index). If a credit event occurs, the issuer is not obligated to repay the par value of the note, but rather, the issuer pays the investor the difference between the par value of the note and the fair value of the defaulted reference obligation at the time of settlement. Neither party to the credit-related note has recourse to the defaulting reference entity. For a further discussion of credit-related notes, see Note 16.
The following tables present a summary of the notional amounts of credit derivatives and credit-related notes the Firm sold and purchased as of December 31, 2014 and 2013. Upon a credit event, the Firm as a seller of protection would typically pay out only a percentage of the full notional amount of net protection sold, as the amount actually required to be paid on the contracts takes into account the recovery value of the reference obligation at the time of settlement. The Firm manages the credit risk on contracts to sell protection by purchasing protection with identical or similar underlying reference entities. Other purchased protection referenced in the following tables includes credit derivatives bought on related, but not identical, reference positions (including indices, portfolio coverage and other reference points) as well as protection purchased through credit-related notes.


214
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The Firm does not use notional amounts of credit derivatives as the primary measure of risk management for such derivatives, because the notional amount does not take into account the probability of the occurrence of a credit event, the recovery value of the reference obligation, or related cash instruments and economic hedges, each of which reduces, in the Firm’s view, the risks associated with such derivatives.
Total credit derivatives and credit-related notes
 
Maximum payout/Notional amount
 
 
Protection sold
 
Protection purchased with identical underlyings(c)
Net protection (sold)/purchased(d)
Other protection purchased(e)
 
December 31, 2014 (in millions)
 
Credit derivatives
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit default swaps
$
(2,056,982
)
 
 
$
2,078,096

 
$
21,114

$
18,631

 
Other credit derivatives(a)
(43,281
)
 
 
32,048

 
(11,233
)
19,475

 
Total credit derivatives
(2,100,263
)
 
 
2,110,144

 
9,881

38,106

 
Credit-related notes
(40
)
 
 

 
(40
)
3,704

 
Total
$
(2,100,303
)
 
 
$
2,110,144

 
$
9,841

$
41,810

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Maximum payout/Notional amount
 
 
Protection sold
 
Protection purchased with identical underlyings(c)
Net protection (sold)/purchased(d)
Other protection purchased(e)
 
December 31, 2013 (in millions)
 
Credit derivatives
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Credit default swaps
$
(2,601,581
)
 
 
$
2,610,198

 
$
8,617

$
8,722

 
Other credit derivatives(a)
(44,137
)
(b) 
 
45,921

 
1,784

20,480

(b) 
Total credit derivatives
(2,645,718
)
 
 
2,656,119

 
10,401

29,202

 
Credit-related notes
(130
)
 
 

 
(130
)
2,720

 
Total
$
(2,645,848
)
 
 
$
2,656,119

 
$
10,271

$
31,922

 
(a)
Other credit derivatives predominantly consists of credit swap options.
(b)
The prior period amounts have been revised. This revision had no impact on the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets or its results of operations.
(c)
Represents the total notional amount of protection purchased where the underlying reference instrument is identical to the reference instrument on protection sold; the notional amount of protection purchased for each individual identical underlying reference instrument may be greater or lower than the notional amount of protection sold.
(d)
Does not take into account the fair value of the reference obligation at the time of settlement, which would generally reduce the amount the seller of protection pays to the buyer of protection in determining settlement value.
(e)
Represents protection purchased by the Firm on referenced instruments (single-name, portfolio or index) where the Firm has not sold any protection on the identical reference instrument.
The following tables summarize the notional amounts by the ratings and maturity profile, and the total fair value, of credit derivatives as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, where JPMorgan Chase is the seller of protection. The maturity profile is based on the remaining contractual maturity of the credit derivative contracts. The ratings profile is based on the rating of the reference entity on which the credit derivative contract is based. The ratings and maturity profile of credit derivatives and credit-related notes where JPMorgan Chase is the purchaser of protection are comparable to the profile reflected below.
Protection sold – credit derivatives and credit-related notes ratings(a)/maturity profile
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2014
(in millions)
<1 year
 
1–5 years
 
>5 years
 
Total notional amount
 
Fair value of receivables(c)
 
Fair value of payables(c)
 
Net fair value
 
Risk rating of reference entity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment-grade
$
(323,398
)
 
$
(1,118,293
)
 
$
(79,486
)
 
$
(1,521,177
)
 
$
25,767

 
$
(6,314
)
 
$
19,453

 
Noninvestment-grade
(157,281
)
 
(396,798
)
 
(25,047
)
 
(579,126
)
 
20,677

 
(22,455
)
 
(1,778
)
 
Total
$
(480,679
)
 
$
(1,515,091
)
 
$
(104,533
)
 
$
(2,100,303
)
 
$
46,444

 
$
(28,769
)
 
$
17,675

 
December 31, 2013
(in millions)
<1 year
 
1–5 years
 
>5 years
 
Total notional amount
 
Fair value of receivables(c)
 
Fair value of payables(c)
 
Net fair value
 
Risk rating of reference entity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment-grade
$
(368,712
)
(b) 
$
(1,469,773
)
(b) 
$
(93,209
)
(b) 
$
(1,931,694
)
(b) 
$
31,730

(b) 
$
(5,664
)
(b) 
$
26,066

(b) 
Noninvestment-grade
(140,540
)
 
(544,671
)
 
(28,943
)
 
(714,154
)
 
27,426

 
(16,674
)
 
10,752

 
Total
$
(509,252
)
 
$
(2,014,444
)
 
$
(122,152
)
 
$
(2,645,848
)
 
$
59,156

 
$
(22,338
)
 
$
36,818

 
(a)
The ratings scale is primarily based on external credit ratings defined by S&P and Moody’s.
(b)
The prior period amounts have been revised. This revision had no impact on the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets or its results of operations.
(c)
Amounts are shown on a gross basis, before the benefit of legally enforceable master netting agreements and cash collateral received by the Firm.

JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
215

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Note 7 – Noninterest revenue
Investment banking fees
This revenue category includes equity and debt underwriting and advisory fees. Underwriting fees are recognized as revenue when the Firm has rendered all services to the issuer and is entitled to collect the fee from the issuer, as long as there are no other contingencies associated with the fee. Underwriting fees are net of syndicate expense; the Firm recognizes credit arrangement and syndication fees as revenue after satisfying certain retention, timing and yield criteria. Advisory fees are recognized as revenue when the related services have been performed and the fee has been earned.
The following table presents the components of investment banking fees.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Underwriting
 
 
 
 
 
Equity
$
1,571

 
$
1,499

 
$
1,026

Debt
3,340

 
3,537

 
3,290

Total underwriting
4,911

 
5,036

 
4,316

Advisory
1,631

 
1,318

 
1,492

Total investment banking fees
$
6,542

 
$
6,354

 
$
5,808

Principal transactions
Principal transactions revenue consists of realized and unrealized gains and losses on derivatives and other instruments (including those accounted for under the fair value option) used in client-driven market-making activities and on private equity investments. In connection with its client-driven market-making activities, the Firm transacts in debt and equity instruments, derivatives and commodities (including physical commodities inventories and financial instruments that reference commodities).
Principal transactions revenue also includes realized and unrealized gains and losses related to hedge accounting and specified risk-management activities, including: (a) certain derivatives designated in qualifying hedge accounting relationships (primarily fair value hedges of commodity and foreign exchange risk), (b) certain derivatives used for specific risk management purposes, primarily to mitigate credit risk, foreign exchange risk and commodity risk, and (c) other derivatives, including the synthetic credit portfolio. For further information on the income statement classification of gains and losses from derivatives activities, see Note 6.
In the financial commodity markets, the Firm transacts in OTC derivatives (e.g., swaps, forwards, options) and exchange-traded derivatives that reference a wide range of underlying commodities. In the physical commodity markets, the Firm primarily purchases and sells precious and base metals and may hold other commodities inventories under financing and other arrangements with clients. Prior to the 2014 sale of certain parts of its physical commodity business, the Firm also engaged in the
 
purchase, sale, transport and storage of power, gas, liquefied natural gas, coal, crude oil and refined products.
Physical commodities inventories are generally carried at the lower of cost or market (market approximates fair value) subject to any applicable fair value hedge accounting adjustments, with realized gains and losses and unrealized losses recorded in principal transactions revenue.
The following table presents all realized and unrealized gains and losses recorded in principal transactions revenue. This table excludes interest income and interest expense on trading assets and liabilities, which are an integral part of the overall performance of the Firm’s client-driven market-making activities. See Note 8 for further information on interest income and interest expense. Trading revenue is presented primarily by instrument type. The Firm’s client-driven market-making businesses generally utilize a variety of instrument types in connection with their market-making and related risk-management activities; accordingly, the trading revenue presented in the table below is not representative of the total revenue of any individual line of business.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Trading revenue by instrument type (a)
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate(b)
$
1,362

 
$
284

 
$
4,002

Credit(c)
1,880

 
2,654

 
(4,975
)
Foreign exchange
1,556

 
1,801

 
918

Equity
2,563

 
2,517

 
2,455

Commodity(d)
1,663

 
2,083

 
2,365

Total trading revenue(e)
9,024

 
9,339

 
4,765

Private equity gains(f)
1,507

 
802

 
771

Principal transactions
$
10,531

 
$
10,141

 
$
5,536

(a)
Prior to the second quarter of 2014, trading revenue was presented by major underlying type of risk exposure, generally determined based upon the business primarily responsible for managing that risk exposure. Prior period amounts have been revised to conform with the current period presentation. This revision had no impact on the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets or results of operations.
(b)
Includes a pretax gain of $665 million for the year ended December 31, 2012, reflecting the recovery on a Bear Stearns-related subordinated loan.
(c)
Includes $5.8 billion of losses incurred by CIO from the synthetic credit portfolio for the six months ended June 30, 2012, and $449 million of losses incurred by CIO from the retained index credit derivative positions for the three months ended September 30, 2012; and losses incurred by CIB from the synthetic credit portfolio.
(d)
Commodity derivatives are frequently used to manage the Firm’s risk exposure to its physical commodities inventories. For gains/(losses) related to commodity fair value hedges, see Note 6.
(e)
During 2013, the Firm implemented a FVA framework in order to incorporate the impact of funding into its valuation estimates for OTC derivatives and structured notes. As a result, the Firm recorded a $1.5 billion loss in principal transactions revenue in 2013, reported in the CIB. This reflected an industry migration towards incorporating the cost of unsecured funding in the valuation of such instruments.
(f)
Includes revenue on private equity investments held in the Private Equity business within Corporate, as well as those held in other business segments.


216
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Lending- and deposit-related fees
This revenue category includes fees from loan commitments, standby letters of credit, financial guarantees, deposit-related fees in lieu of compensating balances, cash management-related activities or transactions, deposit accounts and other loan-servicing activities. These fees are recognized over the period in which the related service is provided.
Asset management, administration and commissions
This revenue category includes fees from investment management and related services, custody, brokerage services, insurance premiums and commissions, and other products. These fees are recognized over the period in which the related service is provided. Performance-based fees, which are earned based on exceeding certain benchmarks or other performance targets, are accrued and recognized at the end of the performance period in which the target is met. The Firm has contractual arrangements with third parties to provide certain services in connection with its asset management activities. Amounts paid to third-party service providers are predominantly expensed, such that asset management fees are recorded gross of payments made to third parties.
The following table presents components of asset management, administration and commissions.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Asset management fees
 
 
 
 
 
Investment management fees(a)
$
9,169

 
$
8,044

 
$
6,744

All other asset management fees(b)
477

 
505

 
357

Total asset management fees
9,646

 
8,549

 
7,101

 
 
 
 
 
 
Total administration fees(c)
2,179

 
2,101

 
2,135

 
 
 
 
 
 
Commissions and other fees
 
 
 
 
 
Brokerage commissions
2,270

 
2,321

 
2,331

All other commissions and fees
1,836

 
2,135

 
2,301

Total commissions and fees
4,106

 
4,456

 
4,632

Total asset management, administration and commissions
$
15,931

 
$
15,106

 
$
13,868

(a)
Represents fees earned from managing assets on behalf of Firm clients, including investors in Firm-sponsored funds and owners of separately managed investment accounts.
(b)
Represents fees for services that are ancillary to investment management services, such as commissions earned on the sales or distribution of mutual funds to clients.
(c)
Predominantly includes fees for custody, securities lending, funds services and securities clearance.
 
Mortgage fees and related income
This revenue category primarily reflects CCB’s Mortgage Production and Mortgage Servicing revenue, including fees and income derived from mortgages originated with the intent to sell; mortgage sales and servicing including losses related to the repurchase of previously sold loans; the impact of risk-management activities associated with the mortgage pipeline, warehouse loans and MSRs; and revenue related to any residual interests held from mortgage securitizations. This revenue category also includes gains and losses on sales and lower of cost or fair value adjustments for mortgage loans held-for-sale, as well as changes in fair value for mortgage loans originated with the intent to sell and measured at fair value under the fair value option. Changes in the fair value of CCB MSRs are reported in mortgage fees and related income. Net interest income from mortgage loans is recorded in interest income. For a further discussion of MSRs, see Note 17.
Card income
This revenue category includes interchange income from credit and debit cards and net fees earned from processing credit card transactions for merchants. Card income is recognized as earned. Cost related to rewards programs is recorded when the rewards are earned by the customer and presented as a reduction to interchange income. Annual fees and direct loan origination costs are deferred and recognized on a straight-line basis over a 12-month period.
Credit card revenue sharing agreements
The Firm has contractual agreements with numerous co-brand partners and affinity organizations (collectively, “partners”), which grant the Firm exclusive rights to market to the customers or members of such partners. These partners endorse the credit card programs and provide their customer and member lists to the Firm, and they may also conduct marketing activities and provide awards under the various credit card programs. The terms of these agreements generally range from three to ten years.
The Firm typically makes incentive payments to the partners based on new account originations, charge volumes and the cost of the partners’ marketing activities and awards. Payments based on new account originations are accounted for as direct loan origination costs. Payments to partners based on sales volumes are deducted from interchange income as the related revenue is earned. Payments based on marketing efforts undertaken by the partners are expensed by the Firm as incurred and reported as noninterest expense.
Other income
Included in other income is operating lease income of $1.7 billion, $1.5 billion and $1.3 billion for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Additionally, included in other income for the year ended December 31, 2013, is a net pretax gain of approximately $1.3 billion, from the sale of Visa B Shares.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
217

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Note 8 – Interest income and Interest expense
Interest income and interest expense are recorded in the Consolidated statements of income and classified based on the nature of the underlying asset or liability. Interest income and interest expense includes the current-period interest accruals for financial instruments measured at fair value, except for financial instruments containing embedded derivatives that would be separately accounted for in accordance with U.S. GAAP absent the fair value option election; for those instruments, all changes in fair value, including any interest elements, are reported in principal transactions revenue. For financial instruments that are not measured at fair value, the related interest is included within interest income or interest expense, as applicable.
Details of interest income and interest expense were as follows.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
 
Interest income
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans
$
32,218

 
$
33,489

 
$
35,832

 
Taxable securities
7,617

 
6,916

 
7,231

 
Non-taxable securities(a)
1,423

 
896

 
708

 
Total securities
9,040

 
7,812

 
7,939

 
Trading assets(b)
7,312

 
8,099

 
8,929

 
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements
1,642

 
1,940

 
2,442

 
Securities borrowed (c)
(501
)
 
(127
)
 
(3
)
 
Deposits with banks
1,157

 
918

 
555

 
Other assets(d)
663

 
538

 
259

 
Total interest income(b)
51,531

 
52,669

 
55,953

 
Interest expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing deposits
1,633

 
2,067

 
2,655

 
Short-term and other liabilities(b)(e)
1,450

 
1,798

 
1,678

 
Long-term debt
4,409

 
5,007

 
6,062

 
Beneficial interests issued by consolidated VIEs
405

 
478

 
648

 
Total interest expense(b)
7,897

 
9,350

 
11,043

 
Net interest income
43,634

 
43,319

 
44,910

 
Provision for credit losses
3,139

 
225

 
3,385

 
Net interest income after provision for credit losses
$
40,495

 
$
43,094

 
$
41,525

 
(a)
Represents securities which are tax exempt for U.S. Federal Income Tax purposes.
(b)
Prior period amounts have been reclassified to conform with the current period presentation.
(c)
Negative interest income for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, is a result of increased client-driven demand for certain securities combined with the impact of low interest rates; the offset of this matched book activity is reflected as lower net interest expense reported within short-term and other liabilities.
(d)
Largely margin loans.
(e)
Includes brokerage customer payables.


 
Note 9 – Pension and other postretirement employee benefit plans
The Firm’s defined benefit pension plans and its other postretirement employee benefit (“OPEB”) plans are accounted for in accordance with U.S. GAAP for retirement benefits.
Defined benefit pension plans
The Firm has a qualified noncontributory U.S. defined benefit pension plan that provides benefits to substantially all U.S. employees. The U.S. plan employs a cash balance formula in the form of pay and interest credits to determine the benefits to be provided at retirement, based on years of service and eligible compensation (generally base pay capped at $100,000 annually; effective January 1, 2015, in addition to base pay, eligible compensation will include certain other types of variable incentive compensation capped at $100,000 annually). Employees begin to accrue plan benefits after completing one year of service, and benefits generally vest after three years of service. The Firm also offers benefits through defined benefit pension plans to qualifying employees in certain non-U.S. locations based on factors such as eligible compensation, age and/or years of service.
It is the Firm’s policy to fund the pension plans in amounts sufficient to meet the requirements under applicable laws. The Firm does not anticipate at this time any contribution to the U.S. defined benefit pension plan in 2015. The 2015 contributions to the non-U.S. defined benefit pension plans are expected to be $47 million of which $31 million are contractually required.
JPMorgan Chase also has a number of defined benefit pension plans that are not subject to Title IV of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act. The most significant of these plans is the Excess Retirement Plan, pursuant to which certain employees previously earned pay credits on compensation amounts above the maximum stipulated by law under a qualified plan; no further pay credits are allocated under this plan. The Excess Retirement Plan had an unfunded projected benefit obligation (“PBO”) in the amount of $257 million and $245 million, at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
Defined contribution plans
JPMorgan Chase currently provides two qualified defined contribution plans in the U.S. and other similar arrangements in certain non-U.S. locations, all of which are administered in accordance with applicable local laws and regulations. The most significant of these plans is The JPMorgan Chase 401(k) Savings Plan (the “401(k) Savings Plan”), which covers substantially all U.S. employees. Employees can contribute to the 401(k) Savings Plan on a pretax and/or Roth 401(k) after-tax basis. The JPMorgan Chase Common Stock Fund, which is an investment option under the 401(k) Savings Plan, is a nonleveraged employee stock ownership plan.


218
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The Firm matches eligible employee contributions up to 5% of eligible compensation (generally base pay; effective January 1, 2015, in addition to base pay, eligible compensation will include certain other types of variable incentive compensation) on an annual basis. Employees begin to receive matching contributions after completing a one-year-of-service requirement. Employees with total annual cash compensation of $250,000 or more are not eligible for matching contributions. Matching contributions vest after three years of service for employees hired on or after May 1, 2009. The 401(k) Savings Plan also permits discretionary profit-sharing contributions by participating companies for certain employees, subject to a specified vesting schedule.
 
OPEB plans
JPMorgan Chase offers postretirement medical and life insurance benefits to certain retirees and postretirement medical benefits to qualifying U.S. employees. These benefits vary with the length of service and the date of hire and provide for limits on the Firm’s share of covered medical benefits. The medical and life insurance benefits are both contributory. Postretirement medical benefits also are offered to qualifying United Kingdom (“U.K.”) employees.
JPMorgan Chase’s U.S. OPEB obligation is funded with corporate-owned life insurance (“COLI”) purchased on the lives of eligible employees and retirees. While the Firm owns the COLI policies, COLI proceeds (death benefits, withdrawals and other distributions) may be used only to reimburse the Firm for its net postretirement benefit claim payments and related administrative expense. The U.K. OPEB plan is unfunded.


The following table presents the changes in benefit obligations, plan assets and funded status amounts reported on the Consolidated balance sheets for the Firm’s U.S. and non-U.S. defined benefit pension and OPEB plans.
 
Defined benefit pension plans
 
 
As of or for the year ended December 31,
U.S.
 
Non-U.S.
 
OPEB plans(d)
(in millions)
2014
 
2013
 
2014
 
2013
 
2014
 
2013
Change in benefit obligation
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Benefit obligation, beginning of year
$
(10,776
)
 
$
(11,478
)
 
$
(3,433
)
 
$
(3,243
)
 
$
(826
)
 
$
(990
)
Benefits earned during the year
(281
)
 
(314
)
 
(33
)
 
(34
)
 

 
(1
)
Interest cost on benefit obligations
(534
)
 
(447
)
 
(137
)
 
(125
)
 
(38
)
 
(35
)
Plan amendments
(53
)
 

 

 

 

 

Special termination benefits

 

 
(1
)
 

 

 

Curtailments

 

 

 

 
(3
)
 

Employee contributions
NA

 
NA

 
(7
)
 
(7
)
 
(62
)
 
(72
)
Net gain/(loss)
(1,669
)
 
794

 
(408
)
 
(62
)
 
(58
)
 
138

Benefits paid
777

 
669

 
119

 
106

 
145

 
144

Expected Medicare Part D subsidy receipts
NA

 
NA

 
NA

 
NA

 
(2
)
 
(10
)
Foreign exchange impact and other

 

 
260

 
(68
)
 
2

 

Benefit obligation, end of year
$
(12,536
)
 
$
(10,776
)
 
$
(3,640
)
 
$
(3,433
)
 
$
(842
)
 
$
(826
)
Change in plan assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fair value of plan assets, beginning of year
$
14,354

 
$
13,012

 
$
3,532

 
$
3,330

 
$
1,757

 
$
1,563

Actual return on plan assets
1,010

 
1,979

 
518

 
187

 
159

 
211

Firm contributions
36

 
32

 
46

 
45

 
3

 
2

Employee contributions

 

 
7

 
7

 

 

Benefits paid
(777
)
 
(669
)
 
(119
)
 
(106
)
 
(16
)
 
(19
)
Foreign exchange impact and other

 

 
(266
)
 
69

 

 

Fair value of plan assets, end of year
$
14,623

 
$
14,354

(b)(c) 
$
3,718

 
$
3,532

 
$
1,903

 
$
1,757

Net funded status(a)
$
2,087

 
$
3,578

 
$
78

 
$
99

 
$
1,061

 
$
931

Accumulated benefit obligation, end of year
$
(12,375
)
 
$
(10,685
)
 
$
(3,615
)
 
$
(3,406
)
 
NA

 
NA

(a)
Represents plans with an aggregate overfunded balance of $3.9 billion and $5.1 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, and plans with an aggregate underfunded balance of $708 million and $540 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
(b)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, approximately $336 million and $429 million, respectively, of U.S. plan assets included participation rights under participating annuity contracts.
(c)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, defined benefit pension plan amounts not measured at fair value included $106 million and $96 million, respectively, of accrued receivables, and $257 million and $104 million, respectively, of accrued liabilities, for U.S. plans.
(d)
Includes an unfunded accumulated postretirement benefit obligation of $37 million and $34 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, for the U.K. plan.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
219

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Gains and losses
For the Firm’s defined benefit pension plans, fair value is used to determine the expected return on plan assets. Amortization of net gains and losses is included in annual net periodic benefit cost if, as of the beginning of the year, the net gain or loss exceeds 10% of the greater of the PBO or the fair value of the plan assets. Any excess is amortized over the average future service period of defined benefit pension plan participants, which for the U.S. defined benefit pension plan is currently seven years. In addition, prior service costs are amortized over the average remaining service period of active employees expected to receive benefits under the plan when the prior service cost is first recognized. The average remaining amortization period for current prior service costs is five years.
 
For the Firm’s OPEB plans, a calculated value that recognizes changes in fair value over a five-year period is used to determine the expected return on plan assets. This value is referred to as the market related value of assets. Amortization of net gains and losses, adjusted for gains and losses not yet recognized, is included in annual net periodic benefit cost if, as of the beginning of the year, the net gain or loss exceeds 10% of the greater of the accumulated postretirement benefit obligation or the market related value of assets. Any excess net gain or loss is amortized over the average expected lifetime of retired participants, which is currently twelve years; however, prior service costs resulting from plan changes are amortized over the average years of service remaining to full eligibility age, which is currently two years.


The following table presents pretax pension and OPEB amounts recorded in AOCI.
 
Defined benefit pension plans
 
 
December 31,
U.S.
 
Non-U.S.
 
OPEB plans
(in millions)
2014
 
2013
 
2014
 
2013
 
2014
 
2013
Net gain/(loss)
$
(3,346
)
 
$
(1,726
)
 
$
(628
)
 
$
(658
)
 
$
130

 
$
125

Prior service credit/(cost)
102

 
196

 
11

 
14

 

 
1

Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss), pretax, end of year
$
(3,244
)
 
$
(1,530
)
 
$
(617
)
 
$
(644
)
 
$
130

 
$
126

The following table presents the components of net periodic benefit costs reported in the Consolidated statements of income and other comprehensive income for the Firm’s U.S. and non-U.S. defined benefit pension, defined contribution and OPEB plans.
 
Pension plans
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
 
Non-U.S.
 
OPEB plans
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
2014

2013

2012

 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

 
2014

2013

2012

Components of net periodic benefit cost
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Benefits earned during the year
$
281

$
314

$
272

 
$
33

 
$
34

 
$
41

 
$

$
1

$
1

Interest cost on benefit obligations
534

447

466

 
137

 
125

 
126

 
38

35

44

Expected return on plan assets
(985
)
(956
)
(861
)
 
(172
)
 
(142
)
 
(137
)
 
(101
)
(92
)
(90
)
Amortization:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net (gain)/loss
25

271

289

 
47

 
49

 
36

 

1

(1
)
Prior service cost/(credit)
(41
)
(41
)
(41
)
 
(2
)
 
(2
)
 

 
(1
)


Net periodic defined benefit cost
(186
)
35

125

 
43

 
64

 
66

 
(64
)
(55
)
(46
)
Other defined benefit pension plans(a)
14

15

15

 
6

 
14

 
8

 
NA

NA

NA

Total defined benefit plans
(172
)
50

140

 
49

 
78

 
74

 
(64
)
(55
)
(46
)
Total defined contribution plans
438

447

409

 
329

 
321

 
302

 
NA

NA

NA

Total pension and OPEB cost included in compensation expense
$
266

$
497

$
549

 
$
378

 
$
399

 
$
376

 
$
(64
)
$
(55
)
$
(46
)
Changes in plan assets and benefit obligations recognized in other comprehensive income
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net (gain)/loss arising during the year
$
1,645

$
(1,817
)
$
434

 
$
57

 
$
19

 
$
146

 
$
(5
)
$
(257
)
$
(43
)
Prior service credit arising during the year
53



 

 

 
(6
)
 



Amortization of net loss
(25
)
(271
)
(289
)
 
(47
)
 
(49
)
 
(36
)
 

(1
)
1

Amortization of prior service (cost)/credit
41

41

41

 
2

 
2

 

 
1



Foreign exchange impact and other



 
(39
)
(a) 
14

(a) 
22

(a) 


(1
)
Total recognized in other comprehensive income
$
1,714

$
(2,047
)
$
186

 
$
(27
)
 
$
(14
)
 
$
126

 
$
(4
)
$
(258
)
$
(43
)
Total recognized in net periodic benefit cost and other comprehensive income
$
1,528

$
(2,012
)
$
311

 
$
16

 
$
50

 
$
192

 
$
(68
)
$
(313
)
$
(89
)
(a)
Includes various defined benefit pension plans which are individually immaterial.

220
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The estimated pretax amounts that will be amortized from AOCI into net periodic benefit cost in 2015 are as follows.
 
 
Defined benefit pension plans
 
OPEB plans
(in millions)
 
U.S.
 
Non-U.S.
 
U.S.
 
Non-U.S.
Net loss/(gain)
 
$
257

 
$
37

 
$

 
$

Prior service cost/(credit)
 
(34
)
 
(2
)
 

 

Total
 
$
223

 
$
35

 
$

 
$

The following table presents the actual rate of return on plan assets for the U.S. and non-U.S. defined benefit pension and OPEB plans.
 
U.S.
 
Non-U.S.
Year ended December 31,
2014

 
2013

 
2012

 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Actual rate of return:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Defined benefit pension plans
7.29
%
 
15.95
%
 
12.66
%
 
5.62 - 17.69%
 
3.74 - 23.80%
 
7.21 - 11.72%
OPEB plans
9.84

 
13.88

 
10.10

 
NA
 
NA
 
NA

Plan assumptions
JPMorgan Chase’s expected long-term rate of return for U.S. defined benefit pension and OPEB plan assets is a blended average of the investment advisor’s projected long-term (10 years or more) returns for the various asset classes, weighted by the asset allocation. Returns on asset classes are developed using a forward-looking approach and are not strictly based on historical returns. Equity returns are generally developed as the sum of inflation, expected real earnings growth and expected long-term dividend yield. Bond returns are generally developed as the sum of inflation, real bond yield and risk spread (as appropriate), adjusted for the expected effect on returns from changing yields. Other asset-class returns are derived from their relationship to the equity and bond markets. Consideration is also given to current market conditions and the short-term portfolio mix of each plan.
For the U.K. defined benefit pension plans, which represent the most significant of the non-U.S. defined benefit pension plans, procedures similar to those in the U.S. are used to develop the expected long-term rate of return on plan assets, taking into consideration local market conditions and the specific allocation of plan assets. The expected long-term rate of return on U.K. plan assets is an average of projected long-term returns for each asset class. The return on equities has been selected by reference to the yield on long-term U.K. government bonds plus an equity risk premium above the risk-free rate. The expected return on “AA” rated long-term corporate bonds is based on an implied yield for similar bonds.
The discount rate used in determining the benefit obligation under the U.S. defined benefit pension and OPEB plans was selected by reference to the yields on portfolios of bonds with maturity dates and coupons that closely match each of the plan’s projected cash flows; such portfolios are derived from a broad-based universe of high-quality corporate bonds as of the measurement date. In years in which these hypothetical bond portfolios generate excess cash, such excess is assumed to be reinvested at the one-year forward
 
rates implied by the Citigroup Pension Discount Curve published as of the measurement date. The discount rate for the U.K. defined benefit pension plan represents a rate of appropriate duration from the analysis of yield curves provided by our actuaries.
In 2014, the Society of Actuaries (“SOA”) completed a comprehensive review of mortality experience of uninsured private retirement plans in the U.S. In October 2014, the SOA published new mortality tables and a new mortality improvement scale that reflects improved life expectancies and an expectation that this trend will continue. The Firm has adopted the SOA’s tables and projection scale, resulting in an estimated increase in PBO of $533 million.
At December 31, 2014, the Firm decreased the discount rates used to determine its benefit obligations for the U.S. defined benefit pension and OPEB plans in light of current market interest rates, which will result in an increase in expense of approximately $139 million for 2015. The 2015 expected long-term rate of return on U.S. defined benefit pension plan assets and U.S. OPEB plan assets are 6.50% and 6.00%, respectively. For 2015, the initial health care benefit obligation trend assumption has been set at 6.00%, and the ultimate health care trend assumption and the year to reach the ultimate rate remains at 5.00% and 2017, respectively, unchanged from 2014. As of December 31, 2014, the interest crediting rate assumption and the assumed rate of compensation increase remained at 5.00% and 3.50%, respectively.
The following tables present the weighted-average annualized actuarial assumptions for the projected and accumulated postretirement benefit obligations, and the components of net periodic benefit costs, for the Firm’s significant U.S. and non-U.S. defined benefit pension and OPEB plans, as of and for the periods indicated.




JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
221

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Weighted-average assumptions used to determine benefit obligations
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
 
Non-U.S.
December 31,
2014

 
2013

 
2014

 
2013

Discount rate:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Defined benefit pension plans
4.00
%
 
5.00
%
 
1.00 - 3.60%

 
1.10 - 4.40%

OPEB plans
4.10

 
4.90

 

 

Rate of compensation increase
3.50

 
3.50

 
2.75 - 4.20

 
2.75 - 4.60

Health care cost trend rate:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Assumed for next year
6.00

 
6.50

 

 

Ultimate
5.00

 
5.00

 

 

Year when rate will reach ultimate
2017

 
2017

 

 

Weighted-average assumptions used to determine net periodic benefit costs
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
 
Non-U.S.
Year ended December 31,
2014

 
2013

 
2012

 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Discount rate:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Defined benefit pension plans
5.00
%
 
3.90
%
 
4.60
%
 
1.10 - 4.40%

 
1.40 - 4.40%

 
1.50 - 4.80%

OPEB plans
4.90

 
3.90

 
4.70

 

 

 

Expected long-term rate of return on plan assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
Defined benefit pension plans
7.00

 
7.50

 
7.50

 
1.20 - 5.30

 
2.40 - 4.90

 
2.50 - 4.60

OPEB plans
6.25

 
6.25

 
6.25

 
NA

 
NA

 
NA

Rate of compensation increase
3.50

 
4.00

 
4.00

 
2.75 - 4.60

 
2.75 - 4.10

 
2.75 - 4.20

Health care cost trend rate:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
Assumed for next year
6.50

 
7.00

 
7.00

 

 

 

Ultimate
5.00

 
5.00

 
5.00

 

 

 

Year when rate will reach ultimate
2017

 
2017

 
2017

 

 

 

The following table presents the effect of a one-percentage-point change in the assumed health care cost trend rate on JPMorgan Chase’s accumulated postretirement benefit obligation. As of December 31, 2014, there was no material effect on total service and interest cost.
Year ended December 31, 2014
(in millions)
1-Percentage point increase
 
1-Percentage point decrease
Effect on accumulated postretirement benefit obligation
$
9

 
$
(8
)

 
JPMorgan Chase’s U.S. defined benefit pension and OPEB plan expense is sensitive to the expected long-term rate of return on plan assets and the discount rate. With all other assumptions held constant, a 25-basis point decline in the expected long-term rate of return on U.S. plan assets would result in an aggregate increase of approximately $40 million in 2015 U.S. defined benefit pension and OPEB plan expense. A 25-basis point decline in the discount rate for the U.S. plans would result in an increase in 2015 U.S. defined benefit pension and OPEB plan expense of approximately an aggregate $36 million and an increase in the related benefit obligations of approximately an aggregate $333 million. A 25-basis point decrease in the interest crediting rate for the U.S. defined benefit pension plan would result in a decrease in 2015 U.S. defined benefit pension expense of approximately $36 million and a decrease in the related PBO of approximately $148 million. A 25-basis point decline in the discount rates for the non-U.S. plans would result in an increase in the 2015 non-U.S. defined benefit pension plan expense of approximately $19 million.


222
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Investment strategy and asset allocation
The Firm’s U.S. defined benefit pension plan assets are held in trust and are invested in a well-diversified portfolio of equity and fixed income securities, cash and cash equivalents, and alternative investments (e.g., hedge funds, private equity, real estate and real assets). Non-U.S. defined benefit pension plan assets are held in various trusts and are also invested in well-diversified portfolios of equity, fixed income and other securities. Assets of the Firm’s COLI policies, which are used to partially fund the U.S. OPEB plan, are held in separate accounts of an insurance company and are allocated to investments intended to replicate equity and fixed income indices.
The investment policy for the Firm’s U.S. defined benefit pension plan assets is to optimize the risk-return relationship as appropriate to the needs and goals of the plan using a global portfolio of various asset classes diversified by market segment, economic sector, and issuer. Assets are managed by a combination of internal and external investment managers. Periodically the Firm performs a comprehensive analysis on the U.S. defined benefit pension plan asset allocations, incorporating projected asset and liability data, which focuses on the short- and long-term impact of the asset allocation on cumulative pension expense, economic cost, present value of contributions and funded status. As the U.S. defined benefit pension plan is overfunded, the investment strategy for this plan was adjusted in 2013 to provide for greater liquidity. Currently, approved asset allocation ranges are: U.S. equity 0% to 45%, international equity 0% to 40%, debt securities 0% to 80%, hedge funds 0% to 5%, real estate 0% to 10%, real assets 0% to 10% and private equity 0% to 20%. Asset allocations are not managed to a specific target but seek to shift asset class allocations within these stated ranges. Investment strategies incorporate the economic outlook and the anticipated implications of the
 
macroeconomic environment on the various asset classes while maintaining an appropriate level of liquidity for the plan. The Firm regularly reviews the asset allocations and asset managers, as well as other factors that impact the portfolio, which is rebalanced when deemed necessary.
For the U.K. defined benefit pension plans, which represent the most significant of the non-U.S. defined benefit pension plans, the assets are invested to maximize returns subject to an appropriate level of risk relative to the plans’ liabilities. In order to reduce the volatility in returns relative to the plans’ liability profiles, the U.K. defined benefit pension plans’ largest asset allocations are to debt securities of appropriate durations. Other assets, mainly equity securities, are then invested for capital appreciation, to provide long-term investment growth. Similar to the U.S. defined benefit pension plan, asset allocations and asset managers for the U.K. plans are reviewed regularly and the portfolio is rebalanced when deemed necessary.
Investments held by the Plans include financial instruments which are exposed to various risks such as interest rate, market and credit risks. Exposure to a concentration of credit risk is mitigated by the broad diversification of both U.S. and non-U.S. investment instruments. Additionally, the investments in each of the common/collective trust funds and registered investment companies are further diversified into various financial instruments. As of December 31, 2014, assets held by the Firm’s U.S. and non-U.S. defined benefit pension and OPEB plans do not include JPMorgan Chase common stock, except through indirect exposures through investments in third-party stock-index funds. The plans hold investments in funds that are sponsored or managed by affiliates of JPMorgan Chase in the amount of $3.7 billion and $2.9 billion for U.S. plans and $1.4 billion and $242 million for non-U.S. plans, as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.


The following table presents the weighted-average asset allocation of the fair values of total plan assets at December 31 for the years indicated, as well as the respective approved range/target allocation by asset category, for the Firm’s U.S. and non-U.S. defined benefit pension and OPEB plans.
 
Defined benefit pension plans
 
 
 
U.S.
 
Non-U.S.
 
OPEB plans(c)
 
Target
 
% of plan assets
 
Target
 
% of plan assets
 
Target
 
% of plan assets
December 31,
Allocation
 
2014

 
2013

 
Allocation
 
2014

 
2013

 
Allocation
 
2014

 
2013

Asset category
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Debt securities(a)
0-80%
 
31
%
 
25
%
 
62
%
 
61
%
 
63
%
 
30-70%

 
50
%
 
50
%
Equity securities
0-85
 
46

 
48

 
37

 
38

 
36

 
30-70

 
50

 
50

Real estate
0-10
 
4

 
4

 

 

 

 

 

 

Alternatives(b)
0-35
 
19

 
23

 
1

 
1

 
1

 

 

 

Total
100%
 
100
%
 
100
%
 
100
%
 
100
%
 
100
%
 
100
%
 
100
%
 
100
%
(a)
Debt securities primarily include corporate debt, U.S. federal, state, local and non-U.S. government, and mortgage-backed securities.
(b)
Alternatives primarily include limited partnerships.
(c)
Represents the U.S. OPEB plan only, as the U.K. OPEB plan is unfunded.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
223

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Fair value measurement of the plans’ assets and liabilities
For information on fair value measurements, including descriptions of level 1, 2, and 3 of the fair value hierarchy and the valuation methods employed by the Firm, see Note 3.
Pension and OPEB plan assets and liabilities measured at fair value
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. defined benefit pension plans
 
Non-U.S. defined benefit pension plans(i)
December 31, 2014
(in millions)
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Total fair value
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Total fair value
Cash and cash equivalents
$
87

 
$

 
$

 
$
87

 
$
128

 
$
1

 
$
129

Equity securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Capital equipment
1,249

 

 

 
1,249

 
96

 
24

 
120

Consumer goods
1,198

 
8

 

 
1,206

 
250

 
32

 
282

Banks and finance companies
778

 
7

 

 
785

 
279

 
31

 
310

Business services
458

 

 

 
458

 
277

 
18

 
295

Energy
267

 

 

 
267

 
50

 
15

 
65

Materials
319

 
1

 

 
320

 
40

 
9

 
49

Real Estate
46

 

 

 
46

 
1

 

 
1

Other
971

 
4

 
4

 
979

 
26

 
40

 
66

Total equity securities
5,286

 
20

 
4

 
5,310

 
1,019

 
169

 
1,188

Common/collective trust funds(a)
345

 
1,277

 
8

 
1,630

 
112

 
251

 
363

Limited partnerships:(b)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Hedge funds

 
26

 
77

 
103

 

 

 

Private equity

 

 
2,208

 
2,208

 

 

 

Real estate

 

 
533

 
533

 

 

 

Real assets(c)
70

 

 
202

 
272

 

 

 

Total limited partnerships
70

 
26

 
3,020

 
3,116

 

 

 

Corporate debt securities(d)

 
1,454

 
9

 
1,463

 

 
724

 
724

U.S. federal, state, local and non-U.S. government debt securities
446

 
161

 

 
607

 
235

 
540

 
775

Mortgage-backed securities
1

 
73

 
1

 
75

 
2

 
77

 
79

Derivative receivables

 
114

 

 
114

 

 
258

 
258

Other(e)
2,031

 
27

 
337

 
2,395

 
283

 
58

 
341

Total assets measured at fair value(f)
$
8,266

 
$
3,152

 
$
3,379

 
$
14,797

(g) 
$
1,779

 
$
2,078

 
$
3,857

Derivative payables
$

 
$
(23
)
 
$

 
$
(23
)
 
$

 
$
(139
)
 
$
(139
)
Total liabilities measured at fair value
$

 
$
(23
)
 
$

 
$
(23
)
(h) 
$

 
$
(139
)
 
$
(139
)



224
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



 
U.S. defined benefit pension plans
 
Non-U.S. defined benefit pension plans(i)
December 31, 2013
(in millions)
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Total fair value
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Total fair value
Cash and cash equivalents
$
62

 
$

 
$

 
$
62

 
$
221

 
$
3

 
$
224

Equity securities:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Capital equipment
1,084

 

 

 
1,084

 
86

 
17

 
103

Consumer goods
1,085

 

 

 
1,085

 
225

 
50

 
275

Banks and finance companies
737

 

 

 
737

 
233

 
29

 
262

Business services
510

 

 

 
510

 
209

 
14

 
223

Energy
292

 

 

 
292

 
64

 
20

 
84

Materials
344

 

 

 
344

 
36

 
9

 
45

Real estate
38

 

 

 
38

 

 
1

 
1

Other
1,337

 
18

 
4

 
1,359

 
25

 
103

 
128

Total equity securities
5,427

 
18

 
4

 
5,449

 
878

 
243

 
1,121

Common/collective trust funds(a)

 
1,308

 
4

 
1,312

 
98

 
248

 
346

Limited partnerships:(b)
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Hedge funds

 
355

 
718

 
1,073

 

 

 

Private equity

 

 
1,969

 
1,969

 

 

 

Real estate

 

 
558

 
558

 

 

 

Real assets(c)

 

 
271

 
271

 

 

 

Total limited partnerships

 
355

 
3,516

 
3,871

 

 

 

Corporate debt securities(d)

 
1,223

 
7

 
1,230

 

 
787

 
787

U.S. federal, state, local and non-U.S. government debt securities
343

 
299

 

 
642

 

 
777

 
777

Mortgage-backed securities
37

 
50

 

 
87

 
73

 

 
73

Derivative receivables

 
30

 

 
30

 

 
302

 
302

Other(e)
1,214

 
41

 
430

 
1,685

 
148

 
52

 
200

Total assets measured at fair value(f)
$
7,083

 
$
3,324

 
$
3,961

 
$
14,368

(g) 
$
1,418

 
$
2,412

 
$
3,830

Derivative payables
$

 
$
(6
)
 
$

 
$
(6
)
 
$

 
$
(298
)
 
$
(298
)
Total liabilities measured at fair value
$

 
$
(6
)
 
$

 
$
(6
)
(h) 
$

 
$
(298
)
 
$
(298
)
(a)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, common/collective trust funds primarily included a mix of short-term investment funds, domestic and international equity investments (including index) and real estate funds.
(b)
Unfunded commitments to purchase limited partnership investments for the plans were $1.2 billion and $1.6 billion for 2014 and 2013, respectively.
(c)
Real assets include investments in productive assets such as agriculture, energy rights, mining and timber properties and exclude raw land to be developed for real estate purposes.
(d)
Corporate debt securities include debt securities of U.S. and non-U.S. corporations.
(e)
Other consists of money markets, exchange-traded funds and participating and non-participating annuity contracts. Money markets and exchange-traded funds are primarily classified within level 1 of the fair value hierarchy given they are valued using market observable prices. Participating and non-participating annuity contracts are classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy due to lack of market mechanisms for transferring each policy and surrender restrictions.
(f)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the fair value of investments valued at NAV were $2.1 billion and $2.7 billion, respectively, which were classified within the valuation hierarchy as follows: $500 million and $100 million in level 1, $1.6 billion and $1.9 billion in level 2, zero and $700 million in level 3.
(g)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, excluded U.S. defined benefit pension plan receivables for investments sold and dividends and interest receivables of $106 million and $96 million, respectively.
(h)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, excluded $241 million and $102 million, respectively, of U.S. defined benefit pension plan payables for investments purchased; and $16 million and $2 million, respectively, of other liabilities.
(i)
There were no assets or liabilities classified as level 3 for the non-U.S. defined benefit pension plans as of December 31, 2014 and 2013.
The Firm’s U.S. OPEB plan was partially funded with COLI policies of $1.9 billion and $1.7 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, which were classified in level 3 of the valuation hierarchy.

JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
225

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Changes in level 3 fair value measurements using significant unobservable inputs
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31, 2014
(in millions)
 
Fair value, January 1, 2014
 
Actual return on plan assets
 
Purchases, sales and settlements, net
 
Transfers in and/or out of level 3
 
Fair value, December 31, 2014
Realized gains/(losses)
 
Unrealized gains/(losses)
U.S. defined benefit pension plans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equities
 
$
4

 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$
4

Common/collective trust funds
 
4

 

 
1

 
3

 

 
8

Limited partnerships:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Hedge funds
 
718

 
193

 
(180
)
 
(662
)
 
8

 
77

Private equity
 
1,969

 
192

 
173

 
(126
)
 

 
2,208

Real estate
 
558

 
29

 
36

 
(90
)
 

 
533

Real assets
 
271

 
27

 
(6
)
 
(90
)
 

 
202

Total limited partnerships
 
3,516

 
441

 
23

 
(968
)
 
8

 
3,020

Corporate debt securities
 
7

 
(2
)
 
2

 
4

 
(2
)
 
9

Mortgage-backed securities
 

 

 

 
1

 

 
1

Other
 
430

 

 
(93
)
 

 

 
337

Total U.S. defined benefit pension plans
 
$
3,961

 
$
439

 
$
(67
)
 
$
(960
)
 
$
6

 
$
3,379

OPEB plans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
COLI
 
$
1,749

 
$

 
$
154

 
$

 
$

 
$
1,903

Total OPEB plans
 
$
1,749

 
$

 
$
154

 
$

 
$

 
$
1,903

Year ended December 31, 2013
(in millions)
 
Fair value, January 1, 2013
 
Actual return on plan assets
 
Purchases, sales and settlements, net
 
Transfers in and/or out of level 3
 
Fair value, December 31, 2013
Realized gains/(losses)
 
Unrealized gains/(losses)
U.S. defined benefit pension plans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equities
 
$
4

 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$
4

Common/collective trust funds
 
199

 
59

 
(32
)
 
(222
)
 

 
4

Limited partnerships:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Hedge funds
 
1,166

 
137

 
14

 
(593
)
 
(6
)
 
718

Private equity
 
1,743

 
108

 
170

 
(4
)
 
(48
)
 
1,969

Real estate
 
467

 
21

 
44

 
26

 

 
558

Real assets
 
311

 
4

 
12

 
(98
)
 
42

 
271

Total limited partnerships
 
3,687

 
270

 
240

 
(669
)
 
(12
)
 
3,516

Corporate debt securities
 
1

 

 

 

 
6

 
7

Mortgage-backed securities
 

 

 

 

 

 

Other
 
420

 

 
10

 

 

 
430

Total U.S. defined benefit pension plans
 
$
4,311

 
$
329

 
$
218

 
$
(891
)
 
$
(6
)
 
$
3,961

OPEB plans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
COLI
 
$
1,554

 
$

 
$
195

 
$

 
$

 
$
1,749

Total OPEB plans
 
$
1,554

 
$

 
$
195

 
$

 
$

 
$
1,749



226
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Year ended December 31, 2012
(in millions)
 
Fair value, January 1, 2012
 
Actual return on plan assets
 
Purchases, sales and settlements, net
 
Transfers in and/or out of level 3
 
Fair value, December 31, 2012
Realized gains/(losses)
 
Unrealized gains/(losses)
U.S. defined benefit pension plans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equities
 
$
1

 
$

 
$
(1
)
 
$

 
$
4

 
$
4

Common/collective trust funds
 
202

 
2

 
22

 
(27
)
 

 
199

Limited partnerships:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Hedge funds
 
1,039

 
1

 
71

 
55

 

 
1,166

Private equity
 
1,367

 
59

 
54

 
263

 

 
1,743

Real estate
 
306

 
16

 
1

 
144

 

 
467

Real assets
 
264

 

 
10

 
37

 

 
311

Total limited partnerships
 
2,976

 
76

 
136

 
499

 

 
3,687

Corporate debt securities
 
2

 

 

 
(1
)
 

 
1

Mortgage-backed securities
 

 

 

 

 

 

Other
 
427

 

 
(7
)
 

 

 
420

Total U.S. defined benefit pension plans
 
$
3,608

 
$
78

 
$
150

 
$
471

 
$
4

 
$
4,311

OPEB plans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
COLI
 
$
1,427

 
$

 
$
127

 
$

 
$

 
$
1,554

Total OPEB plans
 
$
1,427

 
$

 
$
127

 
$

 
$

 
$
1,554


Estimated future benefit payments
The following table presents benefit payments expected to be paid, which include the effect of expected future service, for the years indicated. The OPEB medical and life insurance payments are net of expected retiree contributions.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
 
U.S. defined benefit pension plans
 
Non-U.S. defined benefit pension plans
 
 OPEB before Medicare Part D subsidy
 
Medicare Part D subsidy
2015
 
$
712

 
$
110

 
$
73

 
$
1

2016
 
765

 
113

 
71

 
1

2017
 
899

 
118

 
70

 
1

2018
 
926

 
128

 
68

 
1

2019
 
966

 
132

 
66

 
1

Years 2020–2024
 
4,357

 
746

 
293

 
5


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
227

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Note 10 – Employee stock-based incentives
Employee stock-based awards
In 2014, 2013 and 2012, JPMorgan Chase granted long-term stock-based awards to certain employees under its Long-Term Incentive Plan, which was last amended in May 2011 (“LTIP”). Under the terms of the LTIP, as of December 31, 2014, 266 million shares of common stock were available for issuance through May 2015. The LTIP is the only active plan under which the Firm is currently granting stock-based incentive awards. In the following discussion, the LTIP, plus prior Firm plans and plans assumed as the result of acquisitions, are referred to collectively as the “LTI Plans,” and such plans constitute the Firm’s stock-based incentive plans.
Restricted stock units (“RSUs”) are awarded at no cost to the recipient upon their grant. Generally, RSUs are granted annually and vest at a rate of 50% after two years and 50% after three years and are converted into shares of common stock as of the vesting date. In addition, RSUs typically include full-career eligibility provisions, which allow employees to continue to vest upon voluntary termination, subject to post-employment and other restrictions based on age or service-related requirements. All RSUs awards are subject to forfeiture until vested and contain clawback provisions that may result in cancellation under certain specified circumstances. RSUs entitle the recipient to receive cash payments equivalent to any dividends paid on the underlying common stock during the period the RSUs are outstanding and, as such, are considered participating securities as discussed in Note 24.
Under the LTI Plans, stock options and stock appreciation rights (“SARs”) have generally been granted with an exercise price equal to the fair value of JPMorgan Chase’s common stock on the grant date. The Firm periodically grants employee stock options to individual employees. There were no material grants of stock options or SARs
in 2014. Grants of SARs in 2013 and 2012 become exercisable ratably over five years (i.e., 20% per year)
and contain clawback provisions similar to RSUs. The
2013 and 2012 grants of SARs contain full-career
eligibility provisions. SARs generally expire ten years
after the grant date.
 
The Firm separately recognizes compensation expense for each tranche of each award as if it were a separate award with its own vesting date. Generally, for each tranche granted, compensation expense is recognized on a straight-line basis from the grant date until the vesting date of the respective tranche, provided that the employees will not become full-career eligible during the vesting period. For awards with full-career eligibility provisions and awards granted with no future substantive service requirement, the Firm accrues the estimated value of awards expected to be awarded to employees as of the grant date without giving consideration to the impact of post-employment restrictions. For each tranche granted to employees who will become full-career eligible during the vesting period, compensation expense is recognized on a straight-line basis from the grant date until the earlier of the employee’s full-career eligibility date or the vesting date of the respective tranche.
The Firm’s policy for issuing shares upon settlement of employee stock-based incentive awards is to issue either new shares of common stock or treasury shares. During 2014, 2013 and 2012, the Firm settled all of its employee stock-based awards by issuing treasury shares.
In January 2008, the Firm awarded to its Chairman and Chief Executive Officer up to 2 million SARs. The terms of this award are distinct from, and more restrictive than, other equity grants regularly awarded by the Firm. On July 15, 2014, the Compensation Committee and Board of Directors determined that all requirements for the vesting of the 2 million SAR awards had been met and thus, the awards became exercisable. The SARs, which will expire in January 2018, have an exercise price of $39.83 (the price of JPMorgan Chase common stock on the date of grant). The expense related to this award was dependent on changes in fair value of the SARs through July 15, 2014 (the date when the vested number of SARs were determined), and the cumulative expense was recognized ratably over the service period, which was initially assumed to be five years but, effective in the first quarter of 2013, had been extended to six and one-half years. The Firm recognized $3 million, $14 million and $5 million in compensation expense in 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, for this award.



228
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report


RSUs, employee stock options and SARs activity
Compensation expense for RSUs is measured based on the number of shares granted multiplied by the stock price at the grant date, and for employee stock options and SARs, is measured at the grant date using the Black-Scholes valuation model. Compensation expense for these awards is recognized in net income as described previously. The following table summarizes JPMorgan Chase’s RSUs, employee stock options and SARs activity for 2014.
 
 
RSUs
 
Options/SARs
Year ended December 31, 2014
 
Number of
shares
Weighted-average grant
date fair value
 
Number of awards
 
Weighted-average exercise price
 
Weighted-average remaining contractual life
(in years)
Aggregate intrinsic value
(in thousands, except weighted-average data, and where otherwise stated)
 
 
 
Outstanding, January 1
 
121,241

$
41.47

 
87,075

 
$
44.24

 
 
 
Granted
 
37,817

57.88

 
101

 
59.18

 
 
 
Exercised or vested
 
(54,265
)
40.67

 
(24,950
)
 
36.59

 
 
 
Forfeited
 
(4,225
)
47.32

 
(2,059
)
 
41.90

 
 
 
Canceled
 
NA

NA

 
(972
)
 
200.86

 
 
 
Outstanding, December 31
 
100,568

$
47.81

 
59,195

 
$
45.00

 
5.2
$
1,313,939

Exercisable, December 31
 
NA

NA

 
37,171

 
46.46

 
4.3
862,374

The total fair value of RSUs that vested during the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, was $3.2 billion, $2.9 billion and $2.8 billion, respectively. There were no material grants of stock options or SARs in 2014. The weighted-average grant date per share fair value of stock options and SARs granted during the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, was $9.58 and $8.89, respectively. The total intrinsic value of options exercised during the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, was $539 million, $507 million and $283 million, respectively.
Compensation expense
The Firm recognized the following noncash compensation expense related to its various employee stock-based incentive plans in its Consolidated statements of income.
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Cost of prior grants of RSUs and SARs that are amortized over their applicable vesting periods
 
$
1,371

 
$
1,440

 
$
1,810

Accrual of estimated costs of stock-based awards to be granted in future periods including those to full-career eligible employees
 
819

 
779

 
735

Total noncash compensation expense related to employee stock-based incentive plans
 
$
2,190

 
$
2,219

 
$
2,545

At December 31, 2014, approximately $758 million (pretax) of compensation cost related to unvested awards had not yet been charged to net income. That cost is expected to be amortized into compensation expense over a weighted-average period of 1.0 year. The Firm does not capitalize any compensation cost related to share-based compensation awards to employees.
Cash flows and tax benefits
Income tax benefits related to stock-based incentive arrangements recognized in the Firm’s Consolidated statements of income for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, were $854 million, $865 million and $1.0 billion, respectively.
 
The following table sets forth the cash received from the exercise of stock options under all stock-based incentive arrangements, and the actual income tax benefit realized related to tax deductions from the exercise of the stock options.
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Cash received for options exercised
 
$
63

 
$
166

 
$
333

Tax benefit realized(a)
 
104

 
42

 
53

(a)
The tax benefit realized from dividends or dividend equivalents paid on equity-classified share-based payment awards that are charged to retained earnings are recorded as an increase to additional paid-in capital and included in the pool of excess tax benefits available to absorb tax deficiencies on share-based payment awards.
Valuation assumptions
The following table presents the assumptions used to value employee stock options and SARs granted during the years ended December 31, 2013 and 2012, under the Black-Scholes valuation model. There were no material grants of stock options or SARs for the year ended December 31, 2014.
Year ended December 31,
 
2013

 
2012

Weighted-average annualized valuation assumptions
 
 
 
 
Risk-free interest rate
 
1.18
%
 
1.19
%
Expected dividend yield
 
2.66

 
3.15

Expected common stock price volatility
 
28

 
35

Expected life (in years)
 
6.6
 
6.6

The expected dividend yield is determined using forward-looking assumptions. The expected volatility assumption is derived from the implied volatility of JPMorgan Chase’s stock options. The expected life assumption is an estimate of the length of time that an employee might hold an option or SAR before it is exercised or canceled, and the assumption is based on the Firm’s historical experience.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
229

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Note 11 – Noninterest expense
The following table presents the components of noninterest expense.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Compensation expense
$
30,160

 
$
30,810

 
$
30,585

Noncompensation expense:
 
 
 
 
 
Occupancy
3,909

 
3,693

 
3,925

Technology, communications and equipment
5,804

 
5,425

 
5,224

Professional and outside services
7,705

 
7,641

 
7,429

Marketing
2,550

 
2,500

 
2,577

Other(a)(b)
11,146

 
20,398

 
14,989

Total noncompensation expense
31,114

 
39,657

 
34,144

Total noninterest expense
$
61,274

 
$
70,467

 
$
64,729

(a)
Included firmwide legal expense of $2.9 billion, $11.1 billion and $5.0 billion and for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
(b)
Included FDIC-related expense of $1.0 billion, $1.5 billion and $1.7 billion for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

Note 12 – Securities
Securities are classified as trading, AFS or held-to-maturity (“HTM”). Securities classified as trading assets are discussed in Note 3. Predominantly all of the Firm’s AFS and HTM investment securities (the “investment securities portfolio”) are held by CIO in connection with its asset-liability management objectives. At December 31, 2014, the average credit rating of the debt securities comprising the investment securities portfolio was AA+ (based upon external ratings where available, and where not available, based primarily upon internal ratings which correspond to ratings as defined by S&P and Moody’s). AFS securities are carried at fair value on the Consolidated balance sheets. Unrealized gains and losses, after any applicable hedge accounting adjustments, are reported as net increases or decreases to accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss). The specific identification method is used to determine realized gains and losses on AFS securities, which are included in securities gains/(losses) on the Consolidated statements of income. HTM debt securities, which management has the intent and ability to hold until maturity, are carried at amortized cost on the Consolidated balance sheets. For both AFS and HTM debt securities, purchase discounts or premiums are generally amortized into interest income over the contractual life of the security.
During the first quarter of 2014, the Firm transferred U.S. government agency mortgage-backed securities and obligations of U.S. states and municipalities with a fair value of $19.3 billion from AFS to HTM. These securities were transferred at fair value, and the transfer was a non-cash transaction. AOCI included net pretax unrealized losses of $9 million on the securities at the date of transfer. The transfer reflected the Firm’s intent to hold the securities to maturity in order to reduce the impact of price volatility on AOCI and certain capital measures under Basel III.
 
Other-than-temporary impairment
AFS debt and equity securities and HTM debt securities in unrealized loss positions are analyzed as part of the Firm’s ongoing assessment of other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”). For most types of debt securities, the Firm considers a decline in fair value to be other-than-temporary when the Firm does not expect to recover the entire amortized cost basis of the security. For beneficial interests in securitizations that are rated below “AA” at their acquisition, or that can be contractually prepaid or otherwise settled in such a way that the Firm would not recover substantially all of its recorded investment, the Firm considers an OTTI to have occurred when there is an adverse change in expected cash flows. For AFS equity securities, the Firm considers a decline in fair value to be other-than-temporary if it is probable that the Firm will not recover its cost basis.
Potential OTTI is considered using a variety of factors, including the length of time and extent to which the market value has been less than cost; adverse conditions specifically related to the industry, geographic area or financial condition of the issuer or underlying collateral of a security; payment structure of the security; changes to the rating of the security by a rating agency; the volatility of the fair value changes; and the Firm’s intent and ability to hold the security until recovery.
For AFS debt securities, the Firm recognizes OTTI losses in earnings if the Firm has the intent to sell the debt security, or if it is more likely than not that the Firm will be required to sell the debt security before recovery of its amortized cost basis. In these circumstances the impairment loss is equal to the full difference between the amortized cost basis and the fair value of the securities. For debt securities in an unrealized loss position that the Firm has the intent and ability to hold, the expected cash flows to be received from the securities are evaluated to determine if a credit loss exists. In the event of a credit loss, only the amount of impairment associated with the credit loss is recognized in income. Amounts relating to factors other than credit losses are recorded in OCI.
The Firm’s cash flow evaluations take into account the factors noted above and expectations of relevant market and economic data as of the end of the reporting period. For securities issued in a securitization, the Firm estimates cash flows considering underlying loan-level data and structural features of the securitization, such as subordination, excess spread, overcollateralization or other forms of credit enhancement, and compares the losses projected for the underlying collateral (“pool losses”) against the level of credit enhancement in the securitization structure to determine whether these features are sufficient to absorb the pool losses, or whether a credit loss exists. The Firm also performs other analyses to support its cash flow projections, such as first-loss analyses or stress scenarios.


230
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



For equity securities, OTTI losses are recognized in earnings if the Firm intends to sell the security. In other cases the Firm considers the relevant factors noted above, as well as the Firm’s intent and ability to retain its investment for a period of time sufficient to allow for any anticipated recovery in market value, and whether evidence exists to support a realizable value equal to or greater than the cost basis. Any impairment loss on an equity security is equal to the full difference between the cost basis and the fair value of the security.
 
Realized gains and losses
The following table presents realized gains and losses and credit losses that were recognized in income from AFS securities.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Realized gains
$
314

 
$
1,302

 
$
2,610

Realized losses
(233
)
 
(614
)
 
(457
)
Net realized gains
81

 
688

 
2,153

OTTI losses


 


 


Credit-related
(2
)
 
(1
)
 
(28
)
Securities the Firm intends to sell(a)
(2
)
 
(20
)
 
(15
)
Total OTTI losses recognized in income
(4
)
 
(21
)
 
(43
)
Net securities gains
$
77

 
$
667

 
$
2,110

(a)
Excludes realized losses on securities sold of $3 million, $12 million and $24 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively that had been previously reported as an OTTI loss due to the intention to sell the securities.


The amortized costs and estimated fair values of the investment securities portfolio were as follows for the dates indicated.
 
2014
 
2013
December 31, (in millions)
Amortized cost
Gross unrealized gains
Gross unrealized losses
Fair
value
 
Amortized cost
Gross unrealized gains
Gross unrealized losses
Fair
value
Available-for-sale debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. government agencies(a) 
$
63,089

$
2,302

$
72

 
$
65,319

 
$
76,428

$
2,364

$
977

 
$
77,815

Residential:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Prime and Alt-A
5,595

78

29

 
5,644

 
2,744

61

27

 
2,778

Subprime
677

14


 
691

 
908

23

1

 
930

Non-U.S.
43,550

1,010


 
44,560

 
57,448

1,314

1

 
58,761

Commercial
20,687

438

17

 
21,108

 
15,891

560

26

 
16,425

Total mortgage-backed securities
133,598

3,842

118

 
137,322

 
153,419

4,322

1,032

 
156,709

U.S. Treasury and government agencies(a)
13,603

56

14

 
13,645

 
21,310

385

306

 
21,389

Obligations of U.S. states and municipalities
27,841

2,243

16

 
30,068

 
29,741

707

987

 
29,461

Certificates of deposit
1,103

1

1

 
1,103

 
1,041

1

1

 
1,041

Non-U.S. government debt securities
51,492

1,272

21

 
52,743

 
55,507

863

122

 
56,248

Corporate debt securities
18,158

398

24

 
18,532

 
21,043

498

29

 
21,512

Asset-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Collateralized loan obligations
30,229

147

182

 
30,194

 
28,130

236

136

 
28,230

Other
12,442

184

11

 
12,615

 
12,062

186

3

 
12,245

Total available-for-sale debt securities
288,466

8,143

387

 
296,222

 
322,253

7,198

2,616

 
326,835

Available-for-sale equity securities
2,513

17


 
2,530

 
3,125

17


 
3,142

Total available-for-sale securities
$
290,979

$
8,160

$
387

 
$
298,752

 
$
325,378

$
7,215

$
2,616

 
$
329,977

Total held-to-maturity securities(b)
$
49,252

$
1,902

$

 
$
51,154

 
$
24,026

$
22

$
317

 
$
23,731

(a)
Includes total U.S. government-sponsored enterprise obligations with fair values of $59.3 billion and $67.0 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, which were predominantly mortgage-related.
(b)
As of December 31, 2014, consists of MBS issued by U.S. government-sponsored enterprises with an amortized cost of $35.3 billion, MBS issued by U.S. government agencies with an amortized cost of $3.7 billion and obligations of U.S. states and municipalities with an amortized cost of $10.2 billion. As of December 31, 2013, consists of MBS issued by U.S. government-sponsored enterprises with an amortized cost of $23.1 billion and obligations of U.S. states and municipalities with an amortized cost of $920 million.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
231

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Securities impairment
The following tables present the fair value and gross unrealized losses for the investment securities portfolio by aging category at December 31, 2014 and 2013.
 
Securities with gross unrealized losses
 
Less than 12 months
 
12 months or more
 
 
December 31, 2014 (in millions)
Fair value
Gross unrealized losses
 
Fair value
Gross unrealized losses
Total fair value
Total gross unrealized losses
Available-for-sale debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. government agencies
$
1,118

$
5

 
$
4,989

$
67

$
6,107

$
72

Residential:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Prime and Alt-A
1,840

10

 
405

19

2,245

29

Subprime


 




Non-U.S.


 




Commercial
4,803

15

 
92

2

4,895

17

Total mortgage-backed securities
7,761

30

 
5,486

88

13,247

118

U.S. Treasury and government agencies
8,412

14

 


8,412

14

Obligations of U.S. states and municipalities
1,405

15

 
130

1

1,535

16

Certificates of deposit
1,050

1

 


1,050

1

Non-U.S. government debt securities
4,433

4

 
906

17

5,339

21

Corporate debt securities
2,492

22

 
80

2

2,572

24

Asset-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Collateralized loan obligations
13,909

76

 
9,012

106

22,921

182

Other
2,258

11

 


2,258

11

Total available-for-sale debt securities
41,720

173

 
15,614

214

57,334

387

Available-for-sale equity securities


 




Held-to-maturity securities


 




Total securities with gross unrealized losses
$
41,720

$
173

 
$
15,614

$
214

$
57,334

$
387

 
Securities with gross unrealized losses
 
Less than 12 months
 
12 months or more
 
 
December 31, 2013 (in millions)
Fair value
Gross unrealized losses
 
Fair value
Gross unrealized losses
Total fair value
Total gross unrealized losses
Available-for-sale debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. government agencies
$
20,293

$
895

 
$
1,150

$
82

$
21,443

$
977

Residential:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Prime and Alt-A
1,061

27

 


1,061

27

Subprime
152

1

 


152

1

Non-U.S.


 
158

1

158

1

Commercial
3,980

26

 


3,980

26

Total mortgage-backed securities
25,486

949

 
1,308

83

26,794

1,032

U.S. Treasury and government agencies
6,293

250

 
237

56

6,530

306

Obligations of U.S. states and municipalities
15,387

975

 
55

12

15,442

987

Certificates of deposit
988

1

 


988

1

Non-U.S. government debt securities
11,286

110

 
821

12

12,107

122

Corporate debt securities
1,580

21

 
505

8

2,085

29

Asset-backed securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Collateralized loan obligations
18,369

129

 
393

7

18,762

136

Other
1,114

3

 


1,114

3

Total available-for-sale debt securities
80,503

2,438

 
3,319

178

83,822

2,616

Available-for-sale equity securities


 




Held-to-maturity securities
20,745

317

 


20,745

317

Total securities with gross unrealized losses
$
101,248

$
2,755

 
$
3,319

$
178

$
104,567

$
2,933


232
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Other-than-temporary impairment
The following table presents OTTI losses that are included in the securities gains and losses table above.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

 
Debt securities the Firm does not intend to sell that have credit losses
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total OTTI(a)
 
$
(2
)
 
$
(1
)
 
$
(113
)
 
Losses recorded in/(reclassified from) AOCI
 

 

 
85

 
Total credit losses recognized in income
 
(2
)
 
(1
)
 
(28
)
 
Securities the Firm intends to sell(b)
 
(2
)
 
(20
)
 
(15
)
 
Total OTTI losses recognized in income
 
$
(4
)
 
$
(21
)
 
$
(43
)
 
(a)
For initial OTTI, represents the excess of the amortized cost over the fair value of AFS debt securities. For subsequent impairments of the same security, represents additional declines in fair value subsequent to previously recorded OTTI, if applicable.
(b)
Excludes realized losses on securities sold of $3 million, $12 million and $24 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively that had been previously reported as an OTTI loss due to the intention to sell the securities.
 
Changes in the credit loss component of credit-impaired debt securities
The following table presents a rollforward for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, of the credit loss component of OTTI losses that have been recognized in income, related to AFS debt securities that the Firm does not intend to sell.
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
2014

2013

2012

Balance, beginning of period
$
1

$
522

$
708

Additions:
 
 
 
Newly credit-impaired securities
2

1

21

Losses reclassified from other comprehensive income on previously credit-impaired securities


7

Reductions:
 
 
 
Sales and redemptions of credit-impaired securities

(522
)
(214
)
Balance, end of period
$
3

$
1

$
522

Gross unrealized losses
Gross unrealized losses have generally decreased since December 31, 2013. Though losses on securities that have been in an unrealized loss position for 12 months or more have increased, the increase is not material. The Firm has recognized the unrealized losses on securities it intends to sell. As of December 31, 2014, the Firm does not intend to sell any securities with a loss position in AOCI, and it is not likely that the Firm will be required to sell these securities before recovery of their amortized cost basis. Except for the securities reported in the table above, for which credit losses have been recognized in income, the Firm believes that the securities with an unrealized loss in AOCI are not other-than-temporarily impaired as of December 31, 2014.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
233

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Contractual maturities and yields
The following table presents the amortized cost and estimated fair value at December 31, 2014, of JPMorgan Chase’s investment securities portfolio by contractual maturity.
By remaining maturity
December 31, 2014
(in millions)
Due in one
year or less
Due after one year through five years
Due after five years through 10 years
Due after
10 years(c)
Total
Available-for-sale debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage-backed securities(a)
 
 
 
 
 
Amortized cost
$
996

$
14,132

$
5,768

$
112,702

$
133,598

Fair value
1,003

14,467

5,974

115,878

137,322

Average yield(b)
2.65
%
1.85
%
3.12
%
2.93
%
2.82
%
U.S. Treasury and government agencies(a)
 
 
 
 
 
Amortized cost
$
2,209

$

$
10,284

$
1,110

$
13,603

Fair value
2,215


10,275

1,155

13,645

Average yield(b)
0.80
%
%
0.62
%
0.35
%
0.63
%
Obligations of U.S. states and municipalities
 
 
 
 
 
Amortized cost
$
65

$
498

$
1,432

$
25,846

$
27,841

Fair value
66

515

1,508

27,979

30,068

Average yield(b)
2.13
%
4.00
%
4.93
%
6.78
%
6.63
%
Certificates of deposit
 
 
 
 
 
Amortized cost
$
1,052

$
51

$

$

$
1,103

Fair value
1,050

53



1,103

Average yield(b)
0.84
%
3.28
%
%
%
0.95
%
Non-U.S. government debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
Amortized cost
$
13,559

$
14,276

$
21,220

$
2,437

$
51,492

Fair value
13,588

14,610

21,957

2,588

52,743

Average yield(b)
3.31
%
2.04
%
1.04
%
1.19
%
1.90
%
Corporate debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
Amortized cost
$
3,830

$
9,619

$
4,523

$
186

$
18,158

Fair value
3,845

9,852

4,651

184

18,532

Average yield(b)
2.39
%
2.40
%
2.56
%
3.43
%
2.45
%
Asset-backed securities
 
 
 
 
 
Amortized cost
$

$
2,240

$
17,439

$
22,992

$
42,671

Fair value

2,254

17,541

23,014

42,809

Average yield(b)
%
1.66
%
1.75
%
1.73
%
1.73
%
Total available-for-sale debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
Amortized cost
$
21,711

$
40,816

$
60,666

$
165,273

$
288,466

Fair value
21,767

41,751

61,906

170,798

296,222

Average yield(b)
2.74
%
2.06
%
1.58
%
3.32
%
2.73
%
Available-for-sale equity securities
 
 
 
 
 
Amortized cost
$

$

$

$
2,513

$
2,513

Fair value



2,530

2,530

Average yield(b)
%
%
%
0.25
%
0.25
%
Total available-for-sale securities
 
 
 
 
 
Amortized cost
$
21,711

$
40,816

$
60,666

$
167,786

$
290,979

Fair value
21,767

41,751

61,906

173,328

298,752

Average yield(b)
2.74
%
2.06
%
1.58
%
3.28
%
2.71
%
Total held-to-maturity securities
 
 
 
 
 
Amortized cost
$

$
54

$
487

$
48,711

$
49,252

Fair value

54

512

50,588

51,154

Average yield(b)
%
4.33
%
4.81
%
3.98
%
3.98
%
(a)
U.S. government-sponsored enterprises were the only issuers whose securities exceeded 10% of JPMorgan Chase’s total stockholders’ equity at December 31, 2014.
(b)
Average yield is computed using the effective yield of each security owned at the end of the period, weighted based on the amortized cost of each security. The effective yield considers the contractual coupon, amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts, and the effect of related hedging derivatives. Taxable-equivalent amounts are used where applicable. The effective yield excludes unscheduled principal prepayments; and accordingly, actual maturities of securities may differ from their contractual or expected maturities as certain securities may be prepaid.
(c)
Includes securities with no stated maturity. Substantially all of the Firm’s residential mortgage-backed securities and collateralized mortgage obligations are due in 10 years or more, based on contractual maturity. The estimated duration, which reflects anticipated future prepayments, is approximately five years for agency residential mortgage-backed securities, three years for agency residential collateralized mortgage obligations and four years for nonagency residential collateralized mortgage obligations.

234
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Note 13 – Securities financing activities
JPMorgan Chase enters into resale agreements, repurchase agreements, securities borrowed transactions and securities loaned transactions (collectively, “securities financing agreements”) primarily to finance the Firm’s inventory positions, acquire securities to cover short positions, accommodate customers’ financing needs, and settle other securities obligations.
Securities financing agreements are treated as collateralized financings on the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets. Resale and repurchase agreements are generally carried at the amounts at which the securities will be subsequently sold or repurchased. Securities borrowed and securities loaned transactions are generally carried at the amount of cash collateral advanced or received. Where appropriate under applicable accounting guidance, resale and repurchase agreements with the same counterparty are reported on a net basis. For further discussion of the offsetting of assets and liabilities, see Note 1. Fees received
 
and paid in connection with securities financing agreements are recorded in interest income and interest expense on the Consolidated statements of income.
The Firm has elected the fair value option for certain securities financing agreements. For further information regarding the fair value option, see Note 4. The securities financing agreements for which the fair value option has been elected are reported within securities purchased under resale agreements; securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements; and securities borrowed on the Consolidated balance sheets. Generally, for agreements carried at fair value, current-period interest accruals are recorded within interest income and interest expense, with changes in fair value reported in principal transactions revenue. However, for financial instruments containing embedded derivatives that would be separately accounted for in accordance with accounting guidance for hybrid instruments, all changes in fair value, including any interest elements, are reported in principal transactions revenue.


The following table presents as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the gross and net securities purchased under resale agreements and securities borrowed. Securities purchased under resale agreements have been presented on the Consolidated balance sheets net of securities sold under repurchase agreements where the Firm has obtained an appropriate legal opinion with respect to the master netting agreement, and where the other relevant criteria have been met. Where such a legal opinion has not been either sought or obtained, the securities purchased under resale agreements are not eligible for netting and are shown separately in the table below. Securities borrowed are presented on a gross basis on the Consolidated balance sheets.
 
2014
 
 
2013
 
December 31, (in millions)
Gross asset balance
Amounts netted on the Consolidated balance sheets
Net asset balance
 
 
Gross asset balance
Amounts netted on the Consolidated balance sheets
Net asset balance
 
Securities purchased under resale agreements
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities purchased under resale agreements with an appropriate legal opinion
$
341,989

$
(142,719
)
$
199,270

 
 
$
354,814

$
(115,408
)
$
239,406

 
Securities purchased under resale agreements where an appropriate legal opinion has not been either sought or obtained
15,751

 
15,751

 
 
8,279

 
8,279

 
Total securities purchased under resale agreements
$
357,740

$
(142,719
)
$
215,021

(a) 
 
$
363,093

$
(115,408
)
$
247,685

(a) 
Securities borrowed
$
110,435

N/A

$
110,435

(b)(c) 
 
$
111,465

N/A

$
111,465

(b)(c) 
(a)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, included securities purchased under resale agreements of $28.6 billion and $25.1 billion, respectively, accounted for at fair value.
(b)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, included securities borrowed of $992 million and $3.7 billion, respectively, accounted for at fair value.
(c)
Included $28.0 billion and $26.9 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, of securities borrowed where an appropriate legal opinion has not been either sought or obtained with respect to the master netting agreement.

JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
235

Notes to consolidated financial statements

The following table presents information as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, regarding the securities purchased under resale agreements and securities borrowed for which an appropriate legal opinion has been obtained with respect to the master netting agreement. The below table excludes information related to resale agreements and securities borrowed where such a legal opinion has not been either sought or obtained.
 
2014
 
2013
 
 
 
Amounts not nettable on the Consolidated balance sheets(a)
 
 
 
 
Amounts not nettable on the Consolidated balance sheets(a)
 
December 31, (in millions)
Net asset balance
 
Financial instruments(b)
Cash collateral
Net exposure
 
Net asset balance
 
Financial instruments(b)
Cash collateral
Net exposure
Securities purchased under resale agreements with an appropriate legal opinion
$
199,270

 
$
(196,136
)
$
(232
)
$
2,902

 
$
239,406

 
$
(234,495
)
$
(98
)
$
4,813

Securities borrowed
$
82,464

 
$
(80,267
)
$

$
2,197

 
$
84,531

 
$
(81,127
)
$

$
3,404

(a)
For some counterparties, the sum of the financial instruments and cash collateral not nettable on the Consolidated balance sheets may exceed the net asset balance. Where this is the case the total amounts reported in these two columns are limited to the balance of the net reverse repurchase agreement or securities borrowed asset with that counterparty. As a result a net exposure amount is reported even though the Firm, on an aggregate basis for its securities purchased under resale agreements and securities borrowed, has received securities collateral with a total fair value that is greater than the funds provided to counterparties.
(b)
Includes financial instrument collateral received, repurchase liabilities and securities loaned liabilities with an appropriate legal opinion with respect to the master netting agreement; these amounts are not presented net on the Consolidated balance sheets because other U.S. GAAP netting criteria are not met.

The following table presents as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the gross and net securities sold under repurchase agreements and securities loaned. Securities sold under repurchase agreements have been presented on the Consolidated balance sheets net of securities purchased under resale agreements where the Firm has obtained an appropriate legal opinion with respect to the master netting agreement, and where the other relevant criteria have been met. Where such a legal opinion has not been either sought or obtained, the securities sold under repurchase agreements are not eligible for netting and are shown separately in the table below. Securities loaned are presented on a gross basis on the Consolidated balance sheets.
 
2014
 
2013
 
December 31, (in millions)
Gross liability balance
Amounts netted on the Consolidated balance sheets
Net liability balance
 
Gross liability balance
 
Amounts netted on the Consolidated balance sheets
Net liability balance
 
Securities sold under repurchase agreements
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities sold under repurchase agreements with an appropriate legal opinion
$
289,619

$
(142,719
)
$
146,900

 
$
257,630

(f) 
$
(115,408
)
$
142,222

(f) 
Securities sold under repurchase agreements where an appropriate legal opinion has not been either sought or obtained(a)
22,906

 
22,906

 
18,143

(f) 
 
18,143

(f) 
Total securities sold under repurchase agreements
$
312,525

$
(142,719
)
$
169,806

(c) 
$
275,773

 
$
(115,408
)
$
160,365

(c) 
Securities loaned(b)
$
25,927

N/A

$
25,927

(d)(e) 
$
25,769

 
N/A

$
25,769

(d)(e) 
(a)
Includes repurchase agreements that are not subject to a master netting agreement but do provide rights to collateral.
(b)
Included securities-for-securities borrow vs. pledge transactions of $4.1 billion and $5.8 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, when acting as lender and as presented within other liabilities in the Consolidated balance sheets.
(c)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, included securities sold under repurchase agreements of $3.0 billion and $4.9 billion, respectively, accounted for at fair value.
(d)
At December 31, 2013, included securities loaned of $483 million accounted for at fair value; there were no securities loaned accounted for at fair value at December 31, 2014.
(e)
Included $537 million and $397 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, of securities loaned where an appropriate legal opinion has not been either sought or obtained with respect to the master netting agreement.
(f)
The prior period amounts have been revised with a corresponding impact in the table below. This revision had no impact on the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets or its results of operations.

236
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The following table presents information as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, regarding the securities sold under repurchase agreements and securities loaned for which an appropriate legal opinion has been obtained with respect to the master netting agreement. The below table excludes information related to repurchase agreements and securities loaned where such a legal opinion has not been either sought or obtained.
 
2014
 
2013
 
 
 
Amounts not nettable on the Consolidated balance sheets(a)
 
 
 
 
Amounts not nettable on the Consolidated balance sheets(a)
 
December 31, (in millions)
Net liability balance
 
Financial instruments(b)
Cash collateral
Net amount(c)
 
Net liability balance
 
Financial instruments(b)
 
Cash collateral
Net amount(c)
Securities sold under repurchase agreements with an appropriate legal opinion
$
146,900

 
$
(143,985
)
$
(363
)
$
2,552

 
$
142,222

(d) 
$
(139,051
)
(d) 
$
(450
)
$
2,721

Securities loaned
$
25,390

 
$
(25,040
)
$

$
350

 
$
25,372

 
$
(25,125
)
 
$

$
247

(a)
For some counterparties the sum of the financial instruments and cash collateral not nettable on the Consolidated balance sheets may exceed the net liability balance. Where this is the case the total amounts reported in these two columns are limited to the balance of the net repurchase agreement or securities loaned liability with that counterparty.
(b)
Includes financial instrument collateral transferred, reverse repurchase assets and securities borrowed assets with an appropriate legal opinion with respect to the master netting agreement; these amounts are not presented net on the Consolidated balance sheets because other U.S. GAAP netting criteria are not met.
(c)
Net amount represents exposure of counterparties to the Firm.
(d)
The prior period amounts have been revised with a corresponding impact in the table above. This revision had no impact on the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets or its results of operations.

JPMorgan Chase’s policy is to take possession, where possible, of securities purchased under resale agreements and of securities borrowed. The Firm monitors the value of the underlying securities (primarily G7 government securities, U.S. agency securities and agency MBS, and equities) that it has received from its counterparties and either requests additional collateral or returns a portion of the collateral when appropriate in light of the market value of the underlying securities. Margin levels are established initially based upon the counterparty and type of collateral and monitored on an ongoing basis to protect against declines in collateral value in the event of default. JPMorgan Chase typically enters into master netting agreements and other collateral arrangements with its resale agreement and securities borrowed counterparties, which provide for the right to liquidate the purchased or borrowed securities in the event of a customer default. As a result of the Firm’s credit risk mitigation practices with respect to resale and securities borrowed agreements as described above, the Firm did not hold any reserves for credit impairment with respect to these agreements as of December 31, 2014 and 2013.
For further information regarding assets pledged and collateral received in securities financing agreements, see Note 30.
 
Transfers not qualifying for sale accounting
In addition, at December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm held $13.8 billion and $14.6 billion, respectively, of financial assets for which the rights have been transferred to third parties; however, the transfers did not qualify as a sale in accordance with U.S. GAAP. These transfers have been recognized as collateralized financing transactions. The transferred assets are recorded in trading assets, other assets and loans, and the corresponding liabilities are predominantly recorded in other borrowed funds on the Consolidated balance sheets.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
237

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Note 14 – Loans
Loan accounting framework
The accounting for a loan depends on management’s strategy for the loan, and on whether the loan was credit-impaired at the date of acquisition. The Firm accounts for loans based on the following categories:
Originated or purchased loans held-for-investment (i.e., “retained”), other than purchased credit-impaired (“PCI”) loans
Loans held-for-sale
Loans at fair value
PCI loans held-for-investment
The following provides a detailed accounting discussion of these loan categories:
Loans held-for-investment (other than PCI loans)
Originated or purchased loans held-for-investment, other than PCI loans, are measured at the principal amount outstanding, net of the following: allowance for loan losses; net charge-offs; interest applied to principal (for loans accounted for on the cost recovery method); unamortized discounts and premiums; and net deferred loan fees or costs. Credit card loans also include billed finance charges and fees net of an allowance for uncollectible amounts.
Interest income
Interest income on performing loans held-for-investment, other than PCI loans, is accrued and recognized as interest income at the contractual rate of interest. Purchase price discounts or premiums, as well as net deferred loan fees or costs, are amortized into interest income over the life of the loan to produce a level rate of return.
Nonaccrual loans
Nonaccrual loans are those on which the accrual of interest has been suspended. Loans (other than credit card loans and certain consumer loans insured by U.S. government agencies) are placed on nonaccrual status and considered nonperforming when full payment of principal and interest is in doubt, or when principal and interest has been in default for a period of 90 days or more, unless the loan is both well-secured and in the process of collection. A loan is determined to be past due when the minimum payment is not received from the borrower by the contractually specified due date or for certain loans (e.g., residential real estate loans), when a monthly payment is due and unpaid for 30 days or more. Finally, collateral-dependent loans are typically maintained on nonaccrual status.
 
On the date a loan is placed on nonaccrual status, all interest accrued but not collected is reversed against interest income. In addition, the amortization of deferred amounts is suspended. Interest income on nonaccrual loans may be recognized as cash interest payments are received (i.e., on a cash basis) if the recorded loan balance is deemed fully collectible; however, if there is doubt regarding the ultimate collectibility of the recorded loan balance, all interest cash receipts are applied to reduce the carrying value of the loan (the cost recovery method). For consumer loans, application of this policy typically results in the Firm recognizing interest income on nonaccrual consumer loans on a cash basis.
A loan may be returned to accrual status when repayment is reasonably assured and there has been demonstrated performance under the terms of the loan or, if applicable, the terms of the restructured loan.
As permitted by regulatory guidance, credit card loans are generally exempt from being placed on nonaccrual status; accordingly, interest and fees related to credit card loans continue to accrue until the loan is charged off or paid in full. However, the Firm separately establishes an allowance for the estimated uncollectible portion of accrued interest and fee income on credit card loans. The allowance is established with a charge to interest income and is reported as an offset to loans.
Allowance for loan losses
The allowance for loan losses represents the estimated probable credit losses inherent in the held-for-investment loan portfolio at the balance sheet date. Changes in the allowance for loan losses are recorded in the provision for credit losses on the Firm’s Consolidated statements of income. See Note 15 for further information on the Firm’s accounting policies for the allowance for loan losses.
Charge-offs
Consumer loans, other than risk-rated business banking, risk-rated auto and PCI loans, are generally charged off or charged down to the net realizable value of the underlying collateral (i.e., fair value less costs to sell), with an offset to the allowance for loan losses, upon reaching specified stages of delinquency in accordance with standards established by the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council (“FFIEC”). Residential real estate loans, non-modified credit card loans and scored business banking loans are generally charged off at 180 days past due. In the second quarter of 2013, the Firm revised its policy to charge-off modified credit card loans that do not comply with their modified payment terms at 120 days past due rather than 180 days past due. Auto and student loans are charged off no later than 120 days past due.


238
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Certain consumer loans will be charged off earlier than the FFIEC charge-off standards in certain circumstances as follows:
A charge-off is recognized when a loan is modified in a TDR if the loan is determined to be collateral-dependent. A loan is considered to be collateral-dependent when repayment of the loan is expected to be provided solely by the underlying collateral, rather than by cash flows from the borrower’s operations, income or other resources.
Loans to borrowers who have experienced an event (e.g., bankruptcy) that suggests a loss is either known or highly certain are subject to accelerated charge-off standards. Residential real estate and auto loans are charged off when the loan becomes 60 days past due, or sooner if the loan is determined to be collateral-dependent. Credit card and scored business banking loans are charged off within 60 days of receiving notification of the bankruptcy filing or other event. Student loans are generally charged off when the loan becomes 60 days past due after receiving notification of a bankruptcy.
Auto loans are written down to net realizable value upon repossession of the automobile and after a redemption period (i.e., the period during which a borrower may cure the loan) has passed.
Other than in certain limited circumstances, the Firm typically does not recognize charge-offs on government-guaranteed loans.
Wholesale loans, risk-rated business banking loans and risk-rated auto loans are charged off when it is highly certain that a loss has been realized, including situations where a loan is determined to be both impaired and collateral-dependent. The determination of whether to recognize a charge-off includes many factors, including the prioritization of the Firm’s claim in bankruptcy, expectations of the workout/restructuring of the loan and valuation of the borrower’s equity or the loan collateral.
When a loan is charged down to the estimated net realizable value, the determination of the fair value of the collateral depends on the type of collateral (e.g., securities, real estate). In cases where the collateral is in the form of liquid securities, the fair value is based on quoted market prices or broker quotes. For illiquid securities or other financial assets, the fair value of the collateral is estimated using a discounted cash flow model.
 
For residential real estate loans, collateral values are based upon external valuation sources. When it becomes likely that a borrower is either unable or unwilling to pay, the Firm obtains a broker’s price opinion of the home based on an exterior-only valuation (“exterior opinions”), which is then updated at least every six months thereafter. As soon as practicable after the Firm receives the property in satisfaction of a debt (e.g., by taking legal title or physical possession), generally, either through foreclosure or upon the execution of a deed in lieu of foreclosure transaction with the borrower, the Firm obtains an appraisal based on an inspection that includes the interior of the home (“interior appraisals”). Exterior opinions and interior appraisals are discounted based upon the Firm’s experience with actual liquidation values as compared to the estimated values provided by exterior opinions and interior appraisals, considering state- and product-specific factors.
For commercial real estate loans, collateral values are generally based on appraisals from internal and external valuation sources. Collateral values are typically updated every six to twelve months, either by obtaining a new appraisal or by performing an internal analysis, in accordance with the Firm’s policies. The Firm also considers both borrower- and market-specific factors, which may result in obtaining appraisal updates or broker price opinions at more frequent intervals.
Loans held-for-sale
Held-for-sale loans are measured at the lower of cost or fair value, with valuation changes recorded in noninterest revenue. For consumer loans, the valuation is performed on a portfolio basis. For wholesale loans, the valuation is performed on an individual loan basis.
Interest income on loans held-for-sale is accrued and recognized based on the contractual rate of interest.
Loan origination fees or costs and purchase price discounts or premiums are deferred in a contra loan account until the related loan is sold. The deferred fees and discounts or premiums are an adjustment to the basis of the loan and therefore are included in the periodic determination of the lower of cost or fair value adjustments and/or the gain or loss recognized at the time of sale.
Held-for-sale loans are subject to the nonaccrual policies described above.
Because held-for-sale loans are recognized at the lower of cost or fair value, the Firm’s allowance for loan losses and charge-off policies do not apply to these loans.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
239

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Loans at fair value
Loans used in a market-making strategy or risk managed on a fair value basis are measured at fair value, with changes in fair value recorded in noninterest revenue.
For these loans, the earned current contractual interest payment is recognized in interest income. Changes in fair value are recognized in noninterest revenue. Loan origination fees are recognized upfront in noninterest revenue. Loan origination costs are recognized in the associated expense category as incurred.
Because these loans are recognized at fair value, the Firm’s nonaccrual, allowance for loan losses, and charge-off policies do not apply to these loans.
See Note 4 for further information on the Firm’s elections of fair value accounting under the fair value option. See Note 3 and Note 4 for further information on loans carried at fair value and classified as trading assets.
PCI loans
PCI loans held-for-investment are initially measured at fair value. PCI loans have evidence of credit deterioration since the loan’s origination date and therefore it is probable, at acquisition, that all contractually required payments will not be collected. Because PCI loans are initially measured at fair value, which includes an estimate of future credit losses, no allowance for loan losses related to PCI loans is recorded at the acquisition date. See page 251 of this Note for information on accounting for PCI loans subsequent to their acquisition.
Loan classification changes
Loans in the held-for-investment portfolio that management decides to sell are transferred to the held-for-sale portfolio at the lower of cost or fair value on the date of transfer. Credit-related losses are charged against the allowance for loan losses; non-credit related losses such as those due to changes in interest rates or foreign currency exchange rates are recognized in noninterest revenue.
In the event that management decides to retain a loan in the held-for-sale portfolio, the loan is transferred to the held-for-investment portfolio at the lower of cost or fair value on the date of transfer. These loans are subsequently assessed for impairment based on the Firm’s allowance methodology. For a further discussion of the methodologies used in establishing the Firm’s allowance for loan losses, see Note 15.
 
Loan modifications
The Firm seeks to modify certain loans in conjunction with its loss-mitigation activities. Through the modification, JPMorgan Chase grants one or more concessions to a borrower who is experiencing financial difficulty in order to minimize the Firm’s economic loss, avoid foreclosure or repossession of the collateral, and to ultimately maximize payments received by the Firm from the borrower. The concessions granted vary by program and by borrower-specific characteristics, and may include interest rate reductions, term extensions, payment deferrals, principal forgiveness, or the acceptance of equity or other assets in lieu of payments.
Such modifications are accounted for and reported as troubled debt restructurings (“TDRs”). A loan that has been modified in a TDR is generally considered to be impaired until it matures, is repaid, or is otherwise liquidated, regardless of whether the borrower performs under the modified terms. In certain limited cases, the effective interest rate applicable to the modified loan is at or above the current market rate at the time of the restructuring. In such circumstances, and assuming that the loan subsequently performs under its modified terms and the Firm expects to collect all contractual principal and interest cash flows, the loan is disclosed as impaired and as a TDR only during the year of the modification; in subsequent years, the loan is not disclosed as an impaired loan or as a TDR so long as repayment of the restructured loan under its modified terms is reasonably assured.
Loans, except for credit card loans, modified in a TDR are generally placed on nonaccrual status, although in many cases such loans were already on nonaccrual status prior to modification. These loans may be returned to performing status (the accrual of interest is resumed) if the following criteria are met: (a) the borrower has performed under the modified terms for a minimum of six months and/or six payments, and (b) the Firm has an expectation that repayment of the modified loan is reasonably assured based on, for example, the borrower’s debt capacity and level of future earnings, collateral values, loan-to-value (“LTV”) ratios, and other current market considerations. In certain limited and well-defined circumstances in which the loan is current at the modification date, such loans are not placed on nonaccrual status at the time of modification.
Because loans modified in TDRs are considered to be impaired, these loans are measured for impairment using the Firm’s established asset-specific allowance methodology, which considers the expected re-default rates for the modified loans. A loan modified in a TDR remains subject to the asset-specific allowance methodology throughout its remaining life, regardless of whether the loan is performing and has been returned to accrual status and/or the loan has been removed from the impaired loans disclosures (i.e., loans restructured at market rates). For further discussion of the methodology used to estimate the Firm’s asset-specific allowance, see Note 15.


240
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Foreclosed property
The Firm acquires property from borrowers through loan restructurings, workouts, and foreclosures. Property acquired may include real property (e.g., residential real estate, land, and buildings) and commercial and personal property (e.g., automobiles, aircraft, railcars, and ships).
The Firm recognizes foreclosed property upon receiving assets in satisfaction of a loan (e.g., by taking legal title or physical possession). For loans collateralized by real property, the Firm generally recognizes the asset received at foreclosure sale or upon the execution of a deed in lieu of
 
foreclosure transaction with the borrower. Foreclosed assets are reported in other assets on the Consolidated balance sheets and initially recognized at fair value less costs to sell. Each quarter the fair value of the acquired property is reviewed and adjusted, if necessary, to the lower of cost or fair value. Subsequent adjustments to fair value are charged/credited to noninterest revenue. Operating expense, such as real estate taxes and maintenance, are charged to other expense.


Loan portfolio
The Firm’s loan portfolio is divided into three portfolio segments, which are the same segments used by the Firm to determine the allowance for loan losses: Consumer, excluding credit card; Credit card; and Wholesale. Within each portfolio segment, the Firm monitors and assesses the credit risk in the following classes of loans, based on the risk characteristics of each loan class:
Consumer, excluding
credit card(a)
 
Credit card
 
Wholesale(c)
Residential real estate – excluding PCI
• Home equity – senior lien
• Home equity – junior lien
• Prime mortgage, including
     option ARMs
• Subprime mortgage
Other consumer loans
• Auto(b)
• Business banking(b)
• Student and other
Residential real estate – PCI
• Home equity
• Prime mortgage
• Subprime mortgage
• Option ARMs
 
• Credit card loans
 
• Commercial and industrial
• Real estate
• Financial institutions
• Government agencies
• Other(d)
(a)
Includes loans held in CCB, prime mortgage and home equity loans held in AM and prime mortgage loans held in Corporate.
(b)
Includes certain business banking and auto dealer risk-rated loans that apply the wholesale methodology for determining the allowance for loan losses; these loans are managed by CCB, and therefore, for consistency in presentation, are included with the other consumer loan classes.
(c)
Includes loans held in CIB, CB, AM and Corporate. Excludes prime mortgage and home equity loans held in AM and prime mortgage loans held in Corporate. Classes are internally defined and may not align with regulatory definitions.
(d)
Other primarily includes loans to SPEs and loans to private banking clients. See Note 1 for additional information on SPEs.

JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
241

Notes to consolidated financial statements

The following tables summarize the Firm’s loan balances by portfolio segment.
December 31, 2014
Consumer, excluding credit card
Credit card(a)
Wholesale
Total
 
(in millions)
 
Retained
 
$
294,979

 
 
$
128,027

 
 
$
324,502

 
 
$
747,508

(b) 
Held-for-sale
 
395

 
 
3,021

 
 
3,801

 
 
7,217

 
At fair value
 

 
 

 
 
2,611

 
 
2,611

 
Total
 
$
295,374

 
 
$
131,048

 
 
$
330,914

 
 
$
757,336

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
December 31, 2013
Consumer, excluding credit card
 
Credit card(a)
 
 
Wholesale
 
 
Total
 
(in millions)
 
Retained
 
$
288,449

 
 
$
127,465

 
 
$
308,263

 
 
$
724,177

(b) 
Held-for-sale
 
614

 
 
326

 
 
11,290

 
 
12,230

 
At fair value
 

 
 

 
 
2,011

 
 
2,011

 
Total
 
$
289,063

 
 
$
127,791

 
 
$
321,564

 
 
$
738,418

 
(a)
Includes billed finance charges and fees net of an allowance for uncollectible amounts.
(b)
Loans (other than PCI loans and those for which the fair value option has been elected) are presented net of unearned income, unamortized discounts and premiums, and net deferred loan costs of $1.3 billion and $1.9 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
The following tables provide information about the carrying value of retained loans purchased, sold and reclassified to held-for-sale during the periods indicated. These tables exclude loans recorded at fair value. The Firm manages its exposure to credit risk on an ongoing basis. Selling loans is one way that the Firm reduces its credit exposures.
 
 
 
2014
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
 
Consumer, excluding
credit card
Credit card
Wholesale
Total
Purchases
 
 
$
7,434

(a)(b) 
 
$

 
 
$
885

 
 
$
8,319

Sales
 
 
6,655

 
 
291

 
 
7,381

 
 
14,327

Retained loans reclassified to held-for-sale
 
 
1,190

 
 
3,039

 
 
581

 
 
4,810

 
 
 
2013
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
 
Consumer, excluding
credit card
Credit card
Wholesale
Total
Purchases
 
 
$
7,616

(a)(b) 
 
$
328

 
 
$
697

 
 
$
8,641

Sales
 
 
4,845

 
 

 
 
4,232

 
 
9,077

Retained loans reclassified to held-for-sale
 
 
1,261

 
 
309

 
 
5,641

 
 
7,211

 
 
 
2012
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
 
Consumer, excluding
credit card
Credit card
Wholesale
Total
Purchases
 
 
$
6,601

(a)(b) 
 
$

 
 
$
827

 
 
$
7,428

Sales
 
 
1,852

 
 

 
 
3,423

 
 
5,275

Retained loans reclassified to held-for-sale
 
 

 
 
1,043

 
 
504

 
 
1,547

(a)
Purchases predominantly represent the Firm’s voluntary repurchase of certain delinquent loans from loan pools as permitted by Ginnie Mae guidelines. The Firm typically elects to repurchase these delinquent loans as it continues to service them and/or manage the foreclosure process in accordance with applicable requirements of Ginnie Mae, the Federal Housing Administration (“FHA”), Rural Housing Services (“RHS”) and/or the U.S. Department of Veterans Affairs (“VA”).
(b)
Excluded retained loans purchased from correspondents that were originated in accordance with the Firm’s underwriting standards. Such purchases were $15.1 billion, $5.7 billion and $1.4 billion for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
The following table provides information about gains and losses, including lower of cost or fair value adjustments, on loan sales by portfolio segment.
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
2014
2013
2012
Net gains/(losses) on sales of loans (including lower of cost or fair value adjustments)(a)
 
 
 
Consumer, excluding credit card
$
341

$
313

$
122

Credit card
(241
)
3

(9
)
Wholesale
101

(76
)
180

Total net gains/(losses) on sales of loans (including lower of cost or fair value adjustments)
$
201

$
240

$
293

(a)
Excludes sales related to loans accounted for at fair value.


242
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Consumer, excluding credit card, loan portfolio
Consumer loans, excluding credit card loans, consist primarily of residential mortgages, home equity loans and lines of credit, auto loans, business banking loans, and student and other loans, with a focus on serving the prime consumer credit market. The portfolio also includes home equity loans secured by junior liens, prime mortgage loans with an interest-only payment period, and certain payment-option loans originated by Washington Mutual that may result in negative amortization.
The table below provides information about retained consumer loans, excluding credit card, by class.
December 31, (in millions)
2014
2013
Residential real estate – excluding PCI
 
 
Home equity:
 
 
Senior lien
$
16,367

$
17,113

Junior lien
36,375

40,750

Mortgages:
 
 
Prime, including option ARMs
104,921

87,162

Subprime
5,056

7,104

Other consumer loans
 
 
Auto
54,536

52,757

Business banking
20,058

18,951

Student and other
10,970

11,557

Residential real estate – PCI
 
 
Home equity
17,095

18,927

Prime mortgage
10,220

12,038

Subprime mortgage
3,673

4,175

Option ARMs
15,708

17,915

Total retained loans
$
294,979

$
288,449

Delinquency rates are a primary credit quality indicator for consumer loans. Loans that are more than 30 days past due provide an early warning of borrowers who may be experiencing financial difficulties and/or who may be unable or unwilling to repay the loan. As the loan continues to age, it becomes more clear that the borrower is likely either unable or unwilling to pay. In the case of residential real estate loans, late-stage delinquencies (greater than 150 days past due) are a strong indicator of loans that will ultimately result in a foreclosure or similar liquidation transaction. In addition to delinquency rates, other credit quality indicators for consumer loans vary based on the class of loan, as follows:
For residential real estate loans, including both non-PCI and PCI portfolios, the current estimated LTV ratio, or the combined LTV ratio in the case of junior lien loans, is an indicator of the potential loss severity in the event of default. Additionally, LTV or combined LTV can provide
 
insight into a borrower’s continued willingness to pay, as the delinquency rate of high-LTV loans tends to be greater than that for loans where the borrower has equity in the collateral. The geographic distribution of the loan collateral also provides insight as to the credit quality of the portfolio, as factors such as the regional economy, home price changes and specific events such as natural disasters, will affect credit quality. The borrower’s current or “refreshed” FICO score is a secondary credit-quality indicator for certain loans, as FICO scores are an indication of the borrower’s credit payment history. Thus, a loan to a borrower with a low FICO score (660 or below) is considered to be of higher risk than a loan to a borrower with a high FICO score. Further, a loan to a borrower with a high LTV ratio and a low FICO score is at greater risk of default than a loan to a borrower that has both a high LTV ratio and a high FICO score.
For scored auto, scored business banking and student loans, geographic distribution is an indicator of the credit performance of the portfolio. Similar to residential real estate loans, geographic distribution provides insights into the portfolio performance based on regional economic activity and events.
Risk-rated business banking and auto loans are similar to wholesale loans in that the primary credit quality indicators are the risk rating that is assigned to the loan and whether the loans are considered to be criticized and/or nonaccrual. Risk ratings are reviewed on a regular and ongoing basis by Credit Risk Management and are adjusted as necessary for updated information about borrowers’ ability to fulfill their obligations. For further information about risk-rated wholesale loan credit quality indicators, see page 255 of this Note.
Residential real estate – excluding PCI loans
The following table provides information by class for residential real estate – excluding retained PCI loans in the consumer, excluding credit card, portfolio segment.
The following factors should be considered in analyzing certain credit statistics applicable to the Firm’s residential real estate – excluding PCI loans portfolio: (i) junior lien home equity loans may be fully charged off when the loan becomes 180 days past due, and the value of the collateral does not support the repayment of the loan, resulting in relatively high charge-off rates for this product class; and (ii) the lengthening of loss-mitigation timelines may result in higher delinquency rates for loans carried at the net realizable value of the collateral that remain on the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
243

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Residential real estate – excluding PCI loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Home equity
 
Mortgages
 
 
 
December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
Senior lien
 
Junior lien
 
Prime, including option ARMs
 
Subprime
 
Total residential real estate – excluding PCI
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
Loan delinquency(a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current
$
15,730

$
16,470

 
$
35,575

$
39,864

 
$
93,951

$
76,108

 
$
4,296

$
5,956

 
$
149,552

$
138,398

30–149 days past due
275

298

 
533

662

 
4,091

3,155

 
489

646

 
5,388

4,761

150 or more days past due
362

345

 
267

224

 
6,879

7,899

 
271

502

 
7,779

8,970

Total retained loans
$
16,367

$
17,113

 
$
36,375

$
40,750

 
$
104,921

$
87,162

 
$
5,056

$
7,104

 
$
162,719

$
152,129

% of 30+ days past due to total retained loans(b)
3.89
%
3.76
%
 
2.20
%
2.17
%
 
1.42
%
2.32
%
 
15.03
%
16.16
%
 
2.27
%
3.09
%
90 or more days past due and still accruing
$

$

 
$

$

 
$

$

 
$

$

 
$

$

90 or more days past due and government guaranteed(c)


 


 
7,544

7,823

 


 
7,544

7,823

Nonaccrual loans
938

932

 
1,590

1,876

 
2,190

2,666

 
1,036

1,390

 
5,754

6,864

Current estimated LTV ratios(d)(e)(f)(g)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Greater than 125% and refreshed FICO scores:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equal to or greater than 660
$
21

$
40

 
$
467

$
1,101

 
$
120

$
236

 
$
10

$
52

 
$
618

$
1,429

Less than 660
10

22

 
138

346

 
103

281

 
51

197

 
302

846

101% to 125% and refreshed FICO scores:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equal to or greater than 660
134

212

 
3,149

4,645

 
648

1,210

 
118

249

 
4,049

6,316

Less than 660
69

107

 
923

1,407

 
340

679

 
298

597

 
1,630

2,790

80% to 100% and refreshed FICO scores:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equal to or greater than 660
633

858

 
6,481

7,995

 
3,863

4,749

 
432

614

 
11,409

14,216

Less than 660
226

326

 
1,780

2,128

 
1,026

1,590

 
770

1,141

 
3,802

5,185

Less than 80% and refreshed FICO scores:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equal to or greater than 660
13,048

13,186

 
20,030

19,732

 
81,805

59,634

 
1,586

1,961

 
116,469

94,513

Less than 660
2,226

2,362

 
3,407

3,396

 
4,906

5,071

 
1,791

2,293

 
12,330

13,122

U.S. government-guaranteed


 


 
12,110

13,712

 


 
12,110

13,712

Total retained loans
$
16,367

$
17,113

 
$
36,375

$
40,750

 
$
104,921

$
87,162

 
$
5,056

$
7,104

 
$
162,719

$
152,129

Geographic region
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
California
$
2,232

$
2,397

 
$
8,144

$
9,240

 
$
28,133

$
21,876

 
$
718

$
1,069

 
$
39,227

$
34,582

New York
2,805

2,732

 
7,685

8,429

 
16,550

14,085

 
677

942

 
27,717

26,188

Illinois
1,306

1,248

 
2,605

2,815

 
6,654

5,216

 
207

280

 
10,772

9,559

Florida
861

847

 
1,923

2,167

 
5,106

4,598

 
632

885

 
8,522

8,497

Texas
1,845

2,044

 
1,087

1,199

 
4,935

3,565

 
177

220

 
8,044

7,028

New Jersey
654

630

 
2,233

2,442

 
3,361

2,679

 
227

339

 
6,475

6,090

Arizona
927

1,019

 
1,595

1,827

 
1,805

1,385

 
112

144

 
4,439

4,375

Washington
506

555

 
1,216

1,378

 
2,410

1,951

 
109

150

 
4,241

4,034

Michigan
736

799

 
848

976

 
1,203

998

 
121

178

 
2,908

2,951

Ohio
1,150

1,298

 
778

907

 
615

466

 
112

161

 
2,655

2,832

All other(h)
3,345

3,544

 
8,261

9,370

 
34,149

30,343

 
1,964

2,736

 
47,719

45,993

Total retained loans
$
16,367

$
17,113

 
$
36,375

$
40,750

 
$
104,921

$
87,162

 
$
5,056

$
7,104

 
$
162,719

$
152,129

(a)
Individual delinquency classifications include mortgage loans insured by U.S. government agencies as follows: current included $2.6 billion and $4.7 billion; 30149 days past due included $3.5 billion and $2.4 billion; and 150 or more days past due included $6.0 billion and $6.6 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
(b)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, Prime, including option ARMs loans excluded mortgage loans insured by U.S. government agencies of $9.5 billion and $9.0 billion, respectively. These amounts have been excluded from nonaccrual loans based upon the government guarantee.
(c)
These balances, which are 90 days or more past due but insured by U.S. government agencies, are excluded from nonaccrual loans. In predominantly all cases, 100% of the principal balance of the loans is insured and interest is guaranteed at a specified reimbursement rate subject to meeting agreed-upon servicing guidelines. These amounts have been excluded from nonaccrual loans based upon the government guarantee. At December 31, 2014 and 2013, these balances included $4.2 billion and $4.7 billion, respectively, of loans that are no longer accruing interest because interest has been curtailed by the U.S. government agencies although, in predominantly all cases, 100% of the principal is still insured. For the remaining balance, interest is being accrued at the guaranteed reimbursement rate.
(d)
Represents the aggregate unpaid principal balance of loans divided by the estimated current property value. Current property values are estimated, at a minimum, quarterly, based on home valuation models using nationally recognized home price index valuation estimates incorporating actual data to the extent available and forecasted data where actual data is not available. These property values do not represent actual appraised loan level collateral values; as such, the resulting ratios are necessarily imprecise and should be viewed as estimates.
(e)
Junior lien represents combined LTV, which considers all available lien positions, as well as unused lines, related to the property. All other products are presented without consideration of subordinate liens on the property.
(f)
Refreshed FICO scores represent each borrower’s most recent credit score, which is obtained by the Firm on at least a quarterly basis.
(g)
The prior period prime, including option ARMs have been revised. This revision had no impact on the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets or its results of operations.
(h)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, included mortgage loans insured by U.S. government agencies of $12.1 billion and $13.7 billion, respectively.

244
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The following tables represent the Firm’s delinquency statistics for junior lien home equity loans and lines as of December 31, 2014 and 2013.
 
 
Delinquencies
 
 
 
Total 30+ day delinquency rate
December 31, 2014
 
30–89 days past due
 
90–149 days past due
 
150+ days
 past due
 
Total loans
 
(in millions, except ratios)
 
 
 
 
 
HELOCs:(a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Within the revolving period(b)
 
$
233

 
$
69

 
$
141

 
$
25,252

 
1.75
%
Beyond the revolving period
 
108

 
37

 
107

 
7,979

 
3.16

HELOANs
 
66

 
20

 
19

 
3,144

 
3.34

Total
 
$
407

 
$
126

 
$
267

 
$
36,375

 
2.20
%
 
 
Delinquencies
 
 
 
Total 30+ day delinquency rate
December 31, 2013
 
30–89 days past due
 
90–149 days past due
 
150+ days
 past due
 
Total loans
 
(in millions, except ratios)
 
 
 
 
 
HELOCs:(a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Within the revolving period(b)
 
$
341

 
$
104

 
$
162

 
$
31,848

 
1.91
%
Beyond the revolving period
 
84

 
21

 
46

 
4,980

 
3.03

HELOANs
 
86

 
26

 
16

 
3,922

 
3.26

Total
 
$
511

 
$
151

 
$
224

 
$
40,750

 
2.17
%
(a) These HELOCs are predominantly revolving loans for a 10-year period, after which time the HELOC converts to a loan with a 20-year amortization period, but also include HELOCs originated by Washington Mutual that require interest-only payments beyond the revolving period.
(b) The Firm manages the risk of HELOCs during their revolving period by closing or reducing the undrawn line to the extent permitted by law when borrowers are experiencing financial difficulty or when the collateral does not support the loan amount.
Home equity lines of credit (“HELOCs”) beyond the revolving period and home equity loans (“HELOANs”) have higher delinquency rates than do HELOCs within the revolving period. That is primarily because the fully-amortizing payment that is generally required for those products is higher than the minimum payment options
 
available for HELOCs within the revolving period. The higher delinquency rates associated with amortizing HELOCs and HELOANs are factored into the loss estimates produced by the Firm’s delinquency roll-rate methodology, which estimates defaults based on the current delinquency status of a portfolio.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
245

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Impaired loans
The table below sets forth information about the Firm’s residential real estate impaired loans, excluding PCI loans. These loans are considered to be impaired as they have been modified in a TDR. All impaired loans are evaluated for an asset-specific allowance as described in Note 15.
 
Home equity
 
Mortgages
 
Total residential
 real estate
– excluding PCI
December 31,
(in millions)
Senior lien
 
Junior lien
 
Prime, including
option ARMs
 
Subprime
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
Impaired loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
With an allowance
$
552

$
567

 
$
722

$
727

 
$
4,949

$
5,871

 
$
2,239

$
2,989

 
$
8,462

$
10,154

Without an allowance(a)
549

579

 
582

592

 
1,196

1,133

 
639

709

 
2,966

3,013

Total impaired loans(b)(c)
$
1,101

$
1,146

 
$
1,304

$
1,319

 
$
6,145

$
7,004

 
$
2,878

$
3,698

 
$
11,428

$
13,167

Allowance for loan losses related to impaired loans
$
84

$
94

 
$
147

$
162

 
$
127

$
144

 
$
64

$
94

 
$
422

$
494

Unpaid principal balance of impaired loans(d)
1,451

1,515

 
2,603

2,625

 
7,813

8,990

 
4,200

5,461

 
16,067

18,591

Impaired loans on nonaccrual status(e)
628

641

 
632

666

 
1,559

1,737

 
931

1,127

 
3,750

4,171

(a)
Represents collateral-dependent residential mortgage loans that are charged off to the fair value of the underlying collateral less cost to sell. The Firm reports, in accordance with regulatory guidance, residential real estate loans that have been discharged under Chapter 7 bankruptcy and not reaffirmed by the borrower (“Chapter 7 loans”) as collateral-dependent nonaccrual TDRs, regardless of their delinquency status. At December 31, 2014, Chapter 7 residential real estate loans included approximately 19% of senior lien home equity, 12% of junior lien home equity, 25% of prime mortgages, including option ARMs, and 18% of subprime mortgages that were 30 days or more past due.
(b)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, $4.9 billion and $7.6 billion, respectively, of loans modified subsequent to repurchase from Government National Mortgage Association (“Ginnie Mae”) in accordance with the standards of the appropriate government agency (i.e., FHA, VA, RHS) are not included in the table above. When such loans perform subsequent to modification in accordance with Ginnie Mae guidelines, they are generally sold back into Ginnie Mae loan pools. Modified loans that do not re-perform become subject to foreclosure.
(c)
Predominantly all residential real estate impaired loans, excluding PCI loans, are in the U.S.
(d)
Represents the contractual amount of principal owed at December 31, 2014 and 2013. The unpaid principal balance differs from the impaired loan balances due to various factors, including charge-offs, net deferred loan fees or costs; and unamortized discounts or premiums on purchased loans.
(e)
As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, nonaccrual loans included $2.9 billion and $3.0 billion, respectively, of TDRs for which the borrowers were less than 90 days past due. For additional information about loans modified in a TDR that are on nonaccrual status refer to the Loan accounting framework on pages 238–240 of this Note.

The following table presents average impaired loans and the related interest income reported by the Firm.
Year ended December 31,
Average impaired loans
 
Interest income on
impaired loans(a)
 
Interest income on impaired
loans on a cash basis(a)
(in millions)
2014
2013
2012
 
2014
2013
2012
 
2014
2013
2012
Home equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Senior lien
$
1,122

$
1,151

$
610

 
$
55

$
59

$
27

 
$
37

$
40

$
12

Junior lien
1,313

1,297

848

 
82

82

42

 
53

55

16

Mortgages
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Prime, including option ARMs
6,730

7,214

5,989

 
262

280

238

 
54

59

28

Subprime
3,444

3,798

3,494

 
182

200

183

 
51

55

31

Total residential real estate – excluding PCI
$
12,609

$
13,460

$
10,941

 
$
581

$
621

$
490

 
$
195

$
209

$
87

(a)
Generally, interest income on loans modified in TDRs is recognized on a cash basis until such time as the borrower has made a minimum of six payments under the new terms.



246
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Loan modifications
The Firm is required to provide borrower relief under the terms of certain Consent Orders and settlements entered into by the Firm related to its mortgage servicing, originations and residential mortgage-backed securities activities. This borrower relief includes reductions of principal and forbearance.
Modifications of residential real estate loans, excluding PCI loans, are generally accounted for and reported as TDRs. There were no additional commitments to lend to borrowers whose residential real estate loans, excluding PCI loans, have been modified in TDRs.
 
The following table presents new TDRs reported by the Firm.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
2014
2013
2012
Home equity:
 
 
 
Senior lien
$
110

$
210

$
835

Junior lien
211

388

711

Mortgages:
 
 
 
Prime, including option ARMs
287

770

2,918

Subprime
124

319

1,043

Total residential real estate – excluding PCI
$
732

$
1,687

$
5,507



Nature and extent of modifications
Making Home Affordable (“MHA”), as well as the Firm’s proprietary modification programs, generally provide various concessions to financially troubled borrowers including, but not limited to, interest rate reductions, term or payment extensions and deferral of principal and/or interest payments that would otherwise have been required under the terms of the original agreement.
The following table provides information about how residential real estate loans, excluding PCI loans, were modified under the Firm’s loss mitigation programs during the periods presented. This table excludes Chapter 7 loans where the sole concession granted is the discharge of debt.
Year ended Dec. 31,
Home equity
 
Mortgages
 
Total residential real estate
 - excluding PCI
Senior lien
 
Junior lien
 
Prime, including
option ARMs
 
Subprime
 
2014
2013
2012
 
2014
2013
2012
 
2014
2013
2012
 
2014
2013
2012
 
2014
2013
2012
Number
of loans approved
for a trial modification
939

1,719

1,695

 
626

884

918

 
1,052

2,846

3,895

 
2,056

4,233

4,841

 
4,673

9,682

11,349

Number
of loans permanently modified
1,171

1,765

4,385

 
2,813

5,040

7,430

 
2,507

4,356

9,043

 
3,141

5,364

9,964

 
9,632

16,525

30,822

Concession granted:(a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate reduction
53
%
70
%
83
%
 
84
%
88
%
88
%
 
43
%
73
%
74
%
 
47
%
72
%
69
%
 
58
%
77
%
77
%
Term or payment extension
67

76

47

 
83

80

76

 
51

73

57

 
53

56

41

 
63

70

55

Principal and/or interest deferred
16

12

6

 
23

24

17

 
19

30

16

 
12

13

7

 
18

21

12

Principal forgiveness
36

38

11

 
22

32

23

 
51

38

29

 
53

48

42

 
41

39

29

Other(b)



 



 
10

23

29

 
10

14

8

 
6

11

11

(a)
Represents concessions granted in permanent modifications as a percentage of the number of loans permanently modified. The sum of the percentages exceeds 100% because predominantly all of the modifications include more than one type of concession. A significant portion of trial modifications include interest rate reductions and/or term or payment extensions.
(b)
Represents variable interest rate to fixed interest rate modifications.

JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
247

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Financial effects of modifications and redefaults
The following table provides information about the financial effects of the various concessions granted in modifications of residential real estate loans, excluding PCI, under the Firm’s loss mitigation programs and about redefaults of certain loans modified in TDRs for the periods presented. Because the specific types and amounts of concessions offered to borrowers frequently change between the trial modification and the permanent modification, the following table presents only the financial effects of permanent modifications. This table also excludes Chapter 7 loans where the sole concession granted is the discharge of debt.
Year ended
December 31,
(in millions, except weighted-average data and number of loans)
Home equity
 
Mortgages
 
Total residential real estate – excluding PCI
Senior lien
 
Junior lien
 
Prime, including
option ARMs
 
Subprime
 
2014
2013
2012
 
2014
2013
2012
 
2014
2013
2012
 
2014
2013
2012
 
2014
2013
2012
Weighted-average interest rate of loans with interest rate reductions – before TDR
6.38
%
6.35
%
7.20
%
 
4.81
%
5.05
%
5.45
%
 
4.82
%
5.28
%
6.14
%
 
7.16
%
7.33
%
7.73
%
 
5.61
%
5.88
%
6.57
%
Weighted-average interest rate of loans with interest rate reductions – after TDR
3.03

3.23

4.61

 
2.00

2.14

1.94

 
2.69

2.77

3.67

 
3.37

3.52

4.14

 
2.78

2.92

3.69

Weighted-average remaining contractual term (in years) of loans with term or payment extensions – before TDR
17

19

18

 
19

20

20

 
25

25

25

 
24

24

24

 
23

23

24

Weighted-average remaining contractual term (in years) of loans with term or payment extensions – after TDR
30

31

28

 
35

34

32

 
37

37

36

 
36

35

32

 
36

36

34

Charge-offs recognized upon permanent modification
$
2

$
7

$
8

 
$
25

$
70

$
65

 
$
9

$
16

$
35

 
$
3

$
5

$
29

 
$
39

$
98

$
137

Principal deferred
5

7

4

 
11

24

23

 
39

129

133

 
19

43

43

 
74

203

203

Principal forgiven
14

30

20

 
21

51

58

 
83

206

249

 
89

218

324

 
207

505

651

Balance of loans that redefaulted within one year of permanent modification(a)
$
19

$
26

$
30

 
$
10

$
20

$
46

 
$
121

$
164

$
255

 
$
93

$
106

$
156

 
$
243

$
316

$
487

(a)
Represents loans permanently modified in TDRs that experienced a payment default in the periods presented, and for which the payment default occurred within one year of the modification. The dollar amounts presented represent the balance of such loans at the end of the reporting period in which such loans defaulted. For residential real estate loans modified in TDRs, payment default is deemed to occur when the loan becomes two contractual payments past due. In the event that a modified loan redefaults, it is probable that the loan will ultimately be liquidated through foreclosure or another similar type of liquidation transaction. Redefaults of loans modified within the last 12 months may not be representative of ultimate redefault levels.
At December 31, 2014, the weighted-average estimated remaining lives of residential real estate loans, excluding PCI loans, permanently modified in TDRs were 6 years for senior lien home equity, 8 years for junior lien home equity, 9 years for prime mortgages, including option ARMs, and 8 years for subprime mortgage. The estimated remaining lives of these loans reflect estimated prepayments, both voluntary and involuntary (i.e., foreclosures and other forced liquidations).
 
Active and suspended foreclosure
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm had non-PCI residential real estate loans, excluding those insured by U.S. government agencies, with a carrying value of $1.5 billion and $2.1 billion, respectively, that were not included in REO, but were in the process of active or suspended foreclosure.



248
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Other consumer loans
The table below provides information for other consumer retained loan classes, including auto, business banking and student loans.
December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
Auto
 
Business banking
 
Student and other
 
Total other consumer
 
2014
 
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
 
2013
 
2014
 
2013
 
Loan delinquency(a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current
$
53,866

 
$
52,152

 
$
19,710

$
18,511

 
$
10,080

 
$
10,529

 
$
83,656

 
$
81,192

 
30–119 days past due
663

 
599

 
208

280

 
576

 
660

 
1,447

 
1,539

 
120 or more days past due
7

 
6

 
140

160

 
314

 
368

 
461

 
534

 
Total retained loans
$
54,536

 
$
52,757

 
$
20,058

$
18,951

 
$
10,970

 
$
11,557

 
$
85,564

 
$
83,265

 
% of 30+ days past due to total retained loans
1.23
%
 
1.15
%
 
1.73
%
2.32
%
 
2.15
%
(d) 
2.52
%
(d) 
1.47
%
(d) 
1.60
%
(d) 
90 or more days past due and still accruing (b)
$

 
$

 
$

$

 
$
367

 
$
428

 
$
367

 
$
428

 
Nonaccrual loans
115

 
161

 
279

385

 
270

 
86

 
664

 
632

 
Geographic region
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
California
$
6,294

 
$
5,615

 
$
3,008

$
2,374

 
$
1,143

 
$
1,112

 
$
10,445

 
$
9,101

 
New York
3,662

 
3,898

 
3,187

3,084

 
1,259

 
1,218

 
8,108

 
8,200

 
Illinois
3,175

 
2,917

 
1,373

1,341

 
729

 
740

 
5,277

 
4,998

 
Florida
2,301

 
2,012

 
827

646

 
521

 
539

 
3,649

 
3,197

 
Texas
5,608

 
5,310

 
2,626

2,646

 
868

 
878

 
9,102

 
8,834

 
New Jersey
1,945

 
2,014

 
451

392

 
378

 
397

 
2,774

 
2,803

 
Arizona
2,003

 
1,855

 
1,083

1,046

 
239

 
252

 
3,325

 
3,153

 
Washington
1,019

 
950

 
258

234

 
235

 
227

 
1,512

 
1,411

 
Michigan
1,633

 
1,902

 
1,375

1,383

 
466

 
513

 
3,474

 
3,798

 
Ohio
2,157

 
2,229

 
1,354

1,316

 
629

 
708

 
4,140

 
4,253

 
All other
24,739

 
24,055

 
4,516

4,489

 
4,503

 
4,973

 
33,758

 
33,517

 
Total retained loans
$
54,536

 
$
52,757

 
$
20,058

$
18,951

 
$
10,970

 
$
11,557

 
$
85,564

 
$
83,265

 
Loans by risk ratings(c)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Noncriticized
$
9,822

 
$
9,968

 
$
14,619

$
13,622

 
NA

 
NA

 
$
24,441

 
$
23,590

 
Criticized performing
35

 
54

 
708

711

 
NA

 
NA

 
743

 
765

 
Criticized nonaccrual

 
38

 
213

316

 
NA

 
NA

 
213

 
354

 
(a)
Individual delinquency classifications included loans insured by U.S. government agencies under the Federal Family Education Loan Program (“FFELP”) as follows: current included $4.3 billion and $4.9 billion; 30-119 days past due included $364 million and $387 million; and 120 or more days past due included $290 million and $350 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
(b)
These amounts represent student loans, which are insured by U.S. government agencies under the FFELP. These amounts were accruing as reimbursement of insured amounts is proceeding normally.
(c)
For risk-rated business banking and auto loans, the primary credit quality indicator is the risk rating of the loan, including whether the loans are considered to be criticized and/or nonaccrual.
(d)
December 31, 2014 and 2013, excluded loans 30 days or more past due and still accruing, which are insured by U.S. government agencies under the FFELP, of $654 million and $737 million, respectively. These amounts were excluded as reimbursement of insured amounts is proceeding normally.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
249

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Other consumer impaired loans and loan modifications
The table below sets forth information about the Firm’s other consumer impaired loans, including risk-rated business banking and auto loans that have been placed on nonaccrual status, and loans that have been modified in TDRs.
December 31,
(in millions)
2014
2013
Impaired loans
 
 
With an allowance
$
557

$
571

Without an allowance(a)
35

47

Total impaired loans(b)(c)
$
592

$
618

Allowance for loan losses related to impaired loans
$
117

$
107

Unpaid principal balance of impaired loans(d)
719

788

Impaired loans on nonaccrual status
456

441

(a)
When discounted cash flows, collateral value or market price equals or exceeds the recorded investment in the loan, the loan does not require an allowance. This typically occurs when the impaired loans have been partially charged off and/or there have been interest payments received and applied to the loan balance.
(b)
Predominantly all other consumer impaired loans are in the U.S.
(c)
Other consumer average impaired loans were $599 million, $648 million and $733 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The related interest income on impaired loans, including those on a cash basis, was not material for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012.
(d)
Represents the contractual amount of principal owed at December 31, 2014 and 2013. The unpaid principal balance differs from the impaired loan balances due to various factors, including charge-offs; interest payments received and applied to the principal balance; net deferred loan fees or costs; and unamortized discounts or premiums on purchased loans.

Loan modifications
The following table provides information about the Firm’s other consumer loans modified in TDRs. All of these TDRs are reported as impaired loans in the tables above.
December 31,
(in millions)
2014
2013
Loans modified in troubled debt restructurings(a)(b)
$
442

$
378

TDRs on nonaccrual status
306

201

(a)
The impact of these modifications was not material to the Firm for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013.
(b)
Additional commitments to lend to borrowers whose loans have been modified in TDRs as of December 31, 2014 and 2013 were immaterial.
Other consumer new TDRs were $291 million, $156 million, and $249 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
 
Financial effects of modifications and redefaults
For auto loans, TDRs typically occur in connection with the bankruptcy of the borrower. In these cases, the loan is modified with a revised repayment plan that typically incorporates interest rate reductions and, to a lesser extent, principal forgiveness.
For business banking loans, concessions are dependent on individual borrower circumstances and can be of a short-term nature for borrowers who need temporary relief or longer term for borrowers experiencing more fundamental financial difficulties. Concessions are predominantly term or payment extensions, but also may include interest rate reductions.
The balance of business banking loans modified in TDRs that experienced a payment default, and for which the payment default occurred within one year of the modification, was $25 million, $43 million and $42 million, during the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The balance of auto loans modified in TDRs that experienced a payment default, and for which the payment default occurred within one year of the modification, was $43 million, $54 million, and $46 million, during the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, respectively. A payment default is deemed to occur as follows: (1) for scored auto and business banking loans, when the loan is two payments past due; and (2) for risk-rated business banking loans and auto loans, when the borrower has not made a loan payment by its scheduled due date after giving effect to the contractual grace period, if any.
In May 2014 the Firm began extending the deferment period for up to 24 months for certain student loans, which resulted in extending the maturity of the loans at their original contractual interest rates. These modified loans are considered TDRs and placed on nonaccrual status.



250
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Purchased credit-impaired loans
PCI loans are initially recorded at fair value at acquisition. PCI loans acquired in the same fiscal quarter may be aggregated into one or more pools, provided that the loans have common risk characteristics. A pool is then accounted for as a single asset with a single composite interest rate and an aggregate expectation of cash flows. With respect to the Washington Mutual transaction, all of the consumer PCI loans were aggregated into pools of loans with common risk characteristics.
On a quarterly basis, the Firm estimates the total cash flows (both principal and interest) expected to be collected over the remaining life of each pool. These estimates incorporate assumptions regarding default rates, loss severities, the amounts and timing of prepayments and other factors that reflect then-current market conditions. Probable decreases in expected cash flows (i.e., increased credit losses) trigger the recognition of impairment, which is then measured as the present value of the expected principal loss plus any related foregone interest cash flows, discounted at the pool’s effective interest rate. Impairments are recognized through the provision for credit losses and an increase in the allowance for loan losses. Probable and significant increases in expected cash flows (e.g., decreased credit losses, the net benefit of modifications) would first reverse any previously recorded allowance for loan losses with any remaining increases recognized prospectively as a yield adjustment over the remaining estimated lives of the underlying loans. The impacts of (i) prepayments, (ii) changes in variable interest rates, and (iii) any other changes in the timing of expected cash flows are recognized prospectively as adjustments to interest income.
The Firm continues to modify certain PCI loans. The impact of these modifications is incorporated into the Firm’s quarterly assessment of whether a probable and significant change in expected cash flows has occurred, and the loans continue to be accounted for and reported as PCI loans. In evaluating the effect of modifications on expected cash flows, the Firm incorporates the effect of any foregone interest and also considers the potential for redefault. The Firm develops product-specific probability of default estimates, which are used to compute expected credit losses. In developing these probabilities of default, the Firm considers the relationship between the credit quality characteristics of the underlying loans and certain assumptions about home prices and unemployment based upon industry-wide data. The Firm also considers its own historical loss experience to-date based on actual redefaulted modified PCI loans.
 
The excess of cash flows expected to be collected over the carrying value of the underlying loans is referred to as the accretable yield. This amount is not reported on the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets but is accreted into interest income at a level rate of return over the remaining estimated lives of the underlying pools of loans.
If the timing and/or amounts of expected cash flows on PCI loans were determined not to be reasonably estimable, no interest would be accreted and the loans would be reported as nonaccrual loans; however, since the timing and amounts of expected cash flows for the Firm’s PCI consumer loans are reasonably estimable, interest is being accreted and the loans are being reported as performing loans.
The liquidation of PCI loans, which may include sales of loans, receipt of payment in full by the borrower, or foreclosure, results in removal of the loans from the underlying PCI pool. When the amount of the liquidation proceeds (e.g., cash, real estate), if any, is less than the unpaid principal balance of the loan, the difference is first applied against the PCI pool’s nonaccretable difference for principal losses (i.e., the lifetime credit loss estimate established as a purchase accounting adjustment at the acquisition date). When the nonaccretable difference for a particular loan pool has been fully depleted, any excess of the unpaid principal balance of the loan over the liquidation proceeds is written off against the PCI pool’s allowance for loan losses. Beginning in the fourth quarter of 2014, write-offs of PCI loans also include other adjustments, primarily related to interest forgiveness modifications. Because the Firm’s PCI loans are accounted for at a pool level, the Firm does not recognize charge-offs of PCI loans when they reach specified stages of delinquency (i.e., unlike non-PCI consumer loans, these loans are not charged off based on FFIEC standards).
The PCI portfolio affects the Firm’s results of operations primarily through: (i) contribution to net interest margin; (ii) expense related to defaults and servicing resulting from the liquidation of the loans; and (iii) any provision for loan losses. The PCI loans acquired in the Washington Mutual transaction were funded based on the interest rate characteristics of the loans. For example, variable-rate loans were funded with variable-rate liabilities and fixed-rate loans were funded with fixed-rate liabilities with a similar maturity profile. A net spread will be earned on the declining balance of the portfolio, which is estimated as of December 31, 2014, to have a remaining weighted-average life of 8 years.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
251

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Residential real estate – PCI loans

The table below sets forth information about the Firm’s consumer, excluding credit card, PCI loans.
December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
Home equity
 
Prime mortgage
 
Subprime mortgage
 
Option ARMs
 
Total PCI
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
Carrying value(a)
$
17,095

$
18,927

 
$
10,220

$
12,038

 
$
3,673

$
4,175

 
$
15,708

$
17,915

 
$
46,696

$
53,055

Related allowance for loan losses(b)
1,758

1,758

 
1,193

1,726

 
180

180

 
194

494

 
3,325

4,158

Loan delinquency (based on unpaid principal balance)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current
$
16,295

$
18,135

 
$
8,912

$
10,118

 
$
3,565

$
4,012

 
$
13,814

$
15,501

 
$
42,586

$
47,766

30–149 days past due
445

583

 
500

589

 
536

662

 
858

1,006

 
2,339

2,840

150 or more days past due
1,000

1,112

 
837

1,169

 
551

797

 
1,824

2,716

 
4,212

5,794

Total loans
$
17,740

$
19,830

 
$
10,249

$
11,876

 
$
4,652

$
5,471

 
$
16,496

$
19,223

 
$
49,137

$
56,400

% of 30+ days past due to total loans
8.15
%
8.55
%
 
13.05
%
14.80
%
 
23.37
%
26.67
%
 
16.26
%
19.36
%
 
13.33
%
15.31
%
Current estimated LTV ratios (based on unpaid principal balance)(c)(d)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Greater than 125% and refreshed FICO scores:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equal to or greater than 660
$
513

$
1,168

 
$
45

$
240

 
$
34

$
115

 
$
89

$
301

 
$
681

$
1,824

Less than 660
273

662

 
97

290

 
160

459

 
150

575

 
680

1,986

101% to 125% and refreshed FICO scores:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equal to or greater than 660
2,245

3,248

 
456

1,017

 
215

316

 
575

1,164

 
3,491

5,745

Less than 660
1,073

1,541

 
402

884

 
509

919

 
771

1,563

 
2,755

4,907

80% to 100% and refreshed FICO scores:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equal to or greater than 660
4,171

4,473

 
2,154

2,787

 
519

544

 
2,418

3,311

 
9,262

11,115

Less than 660
1,647

1,782

 
1,316

1,699

 
1,006

1,197

 
1,996

2,769

 
5,965

7,447

Lower than 80% and refreshed FICO scores:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equal to or greater than 660
5,824

5,077

 
3,663

2,897

 
719

521

 
6,593

5,671

 
16,799

14,166

Less than 660
1,994

1,879

 
2,116

2,062

 
1,490

1,400

 
3,904

3,869

 
9,504

9,210

Total unpaid principal balance
$
17,740

$
19,830

 
$
10,249

$
11,876

 
$
4,652

$
5,471

 
$
16,496

$
19,223

 
$
49,137

$
56,400

Geographic region (based on unpaid principal balance)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
California
$
10,671

$
11,937

 
$
5,965

$
6,845

 
$
1,138

$
1,293

 
$
9,190

$
10,419

 
$
26,964

$
30,494

New York
876

962

 
672

807

 
463

563

 
933

1,196

 
2,944

3,528

Illinois
405

451

 
301

353

 
229

283

 
397

481

 
1,332

1,568

Florida
1,696

1,865

 
689

826

 
432

526

 
1,440

1,817

 
4,257

5,034

Texas
273

327

 
92

106

 
281

328

 
85

100

 
731

861

New Jersey
348

381

 
279

334

 
165

213

 
553

701

 
1,345

1,629

Arizona
323

361

 
167

187

 
85

95

 
227

264

 
802

907

Washington
959

1,072

 
225

266

 
95

112

 
395

463

 
1,674

1,913

Michigan
53

62

 
166

189

 
130

145

 
182

206

 
531

602

Ohio
20

23

 
48

55

 
72

84

 
69

75

 
209

237

All other
2,116

2,389

 
1,645

1,908

 
1,562

1,829

 
3,025

3,501

 
8,348

9,627

Total unpaid principal balance
$
17,740

$
19,830

 
$
10,249

$
11,876

 
$
4,652

$
5,471

 
$
16,496

$
19,223

 
$
49,137

$
56,400

(a)
Carrying value includes the effect of fair value adjustments that were applied to the consumer PCI portfolio at the date of acquisition.
(b)
Management concluded as part of the Firm’s regular assessment of the PCI loan pools that it was probable that higher expected credit losses would result in a decrease in expected cash flows. As a result, an allowance for loan losses for impairment of these pools has been recognized.
(c)
Represents the aggregate unpaid principal balance of loans divided by the estimated current property value. Current property values are estimated, at a minimum, quarterly, based on home valuation models using nationally recognized home price index valuation estimates incorporating actual data to the extent available and forecasted data where actual data is not available. These property values do not represent actual appraised loan level collateral values; as such, the resulting ratios are necessarily imprecise and should be viewed as estimates. Current estimated combined LTV for junior lien home equity loans considers all available lien positions, as well as unused lines, related to the property.
(d)
Refreshed FICO scores represent each borrower’s most recent credit score, which is obtained by the Firm on at least a quarterly basis.

252
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Approximately 20% of the PCI home equity portfolio are senior lien loans; the remaining balance are junior lien HELOANs or HELOCs. The following tables set forth delinquency statistics for PCI junior lien home equity loans and lines of credit based on unpaid principal balance as of December 31, 2014 and 2013.
 
 
Delinquencies
 
 
 
Total 30+ day delinquency rate
December 31, 2014
 
30–89 days past due
 
90–149 days past due
 
150+ days
 past due
 
Total loans
 
(in millions, except ratios)
 
 
 
 
 
HELOCs:(a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Within the revolving period(b)
 
$
155

 
$
50

 
$
371

 
$
8,972

 
6.42
%
Beyond the revolving period(c)
 
76

 
24

 
166

 
4,143

 
6.42

HELOANs
 
20

 
7

 
38

 
736

 
8.83

Total
 
$
251

 
$
81

 
$
575

 
$
13,851

 
6.55
%
 
 
Delinquencies
 
 
 
Total 30+ day delinquency rate
December 31, 2013
 
30–89 days past due
 
90–149 days past due
 
150+ days
 past due
 
Total loans
 
(in millions, except ratios)
 
 
 
 
 
 
HELOCs:(a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Within the revolving period(b)
 
$
243

 
$
88

 
$
526

 
$
12,670

 
6.76
%
Beyond the revolving period(c)
 
54

 
21

 
82

 
2,336

 
6.72

HELOANs
 
24

 
11

 
39

 
908

 
8.15

Total
 
$
321

 
$
120

 
$
647

 
$
15,914

 
6.84
%
(a)
In general, these HELOCs are revolving loans for a 10-year period, after which time the HELOC converts to an interest-only loan with a balloon payment at the end of the loan’s term.
(b)
Substantially all undrawn HELOCs within the revolving period have been closed.
(c)
Includes loans modified into fixed-rate amortizing loans.
The table below sets forth the accretable yield activity for the Firm’s PCI consumer loans for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, and represents the Firm’s estimate of gross interest income expected to be earned over the remaining life of the PCI loan portfolios. The table excludes the cost to fund the PCI portfolios, and therefore the accretable yield does not represent net interest income expected to be earned on these portfolios.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
Total PCI
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Beginning balance
$
16,167

 
$
18,457

 
$
19,072

Accretion into interest income
(1,934
)
 
(2,201
)
 
(2,491
)
Changes in interest rates on variable-rate loans
(174
)
 
(287
)
 
(449
)
Other changes in expected cash flows(a)
533

 
198

 
2,325

Balance at December 31
$
14,592

 
$
16,167

 
$
18,457

Accretable yield percentage
4.19
%
 
4.31
%
 
4.38
%
(a)
Other changes in expected cash flows may vary from period to period as the Firm continues to refine its cash flow model and periodically updates model assumptions. For the year ended December 31, 2014, other changes in expected cash flows were driven by changes in prepayment assumptions. For the year ended December 31, 2013, other changes in expected cash flows were due to refining the expected interest cash flows on HELOCs with balloon payments, partially offset by changes in prepayment assumptions. For the year ended December 31, 2012, other changes in expected cash flows were principally driven by the impact of modifications, but also related to changes in prepayment assumptions.

The factors that most significantly affect estimates of gross cash flows expected to be collected, and accordingly the accretable yield balance, include: (i) changes in the benchmark interest rate indices for variable-rate products such as option ARM and home equity loans; and (ii) changes in prepayment assumptions.
Since the date of acquisition, the decrease in the accretable yield percentage has been primarily related to a decrease in interest rates on variable-rate loans and, to a lesser extent, extended loan liquidation periods. Certain events, such as extended or shortened loan liquidation periods, affect the timing of expected cash flows and the accretable yield percentage, but not the amount of cash expected to be received (i.e., the accretable yield balance). While extended
 
loan liquidation periods reduce the accretable yield percentage (because the same accretable yield balance is recognized against a higher-than-expected loan balance over a longer-than-expected period of time), shortened loan liquidation periods would have the opposite effect.
Active and suspended foreclosure
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm had PCI residential real estate loans with an unpaid principal balance of $3.2 billion and $4.8 billion, respectively, that were not included in REO, but were in the process of active or suspended foreclosure.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
253

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Credit card loan portfolio
The credit card portfolio segment includes credit card loans originated and purchased by the Firm. Delinquency rates are the primary credit quality indicator for credit card loans as they provide an early warning that borrowers may be experiencing difficulties (30 days past due); information on those borrowers that have been delinquent for a longer period of time (90 days past due) is also considered. In addition to delinquency rates, the geographic distribution of the loans provides insight as to the credit quality of the portfolio based on the regional economy.
While the borrower’s credit score is another general indicator of credit quality, the Firm does not view credit scores as a primary indicator of credit quality because the borrower’s credit score tends to be a lagging indicator. However, the distribution of such scores provides a general indicator of credit quality trends within the portfolio. Refreshed FICO score information, which is obtained at least quarterly, for a statistically significant random sample of the credit card portfolio is indicated in the table below; FICO is considered to be the industry benchmark for credit scores.
The Firm generally originates new card accounts to prime consumer borrowers. However, certain cardholders’ FICO scores may decrease over time, depending on the performance of the cardholder and changes in credit score technology.
 
The table below sets forth information about the Firm’s credit card loans.
As of or for the year ended December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
2014
2013
Net charge-offs
$
3,429

$
3,879

% of net charge-offs to retained loans
2.75
%
3.14
%
Loan delinquency
 
 
Current and less than 30 days past due
and still accruing
$
126,189

$
125,335

30–89 days past due and still accruing
943

1,108

90 or more days past due and still accruing
895

1,022

Nonaccrual loans


Total retained credit card loans
$
128,027

$
127,465

Loan delinquency ratios
 
 
% of 30+ days past due to total retained loans
1.44
%
1.67
%
% of 90+ days past due to total retained loans
0.70

0.80

Credit card loans by geographic region
 
 
California
$
17,940

$
17,194

Texas
11,088

10,400

New York
10,940

10,497

Illinois
7,497

7,412

Florida
7,398

7,178

New Jersey
5,750

5,554

Ohio
4,707

4,881

Pennsylvania
4,489

4,462

Michigan
3,552

3,618

Virginia
3,263

3,239

All other
51,403

53,030

Total retained credit card loans
$
128,027

$
127,465

Percentage of portfolio based on carrying value with estimated refreshed FICO scores
 
 
Equal to or greater than 660
85.7
%
85.1
%
Less than 660
14.3

14.9



254
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Credit card impaired loans and loan modifications
The table below sets forth information about the Firm’s impaired credit card loans. All of these loans are considered to be impaired as they have been modified in TDRs.
December 31, (in millions)
2014
2013
Impaired credit card loans with an allowance(a)(b)
 
 
Credit card loans with modified payment terms(c)
$
1,775

$
2,746

Modified credit card loans that have reverted to pre-modification payment terms(d)
254

369

Total impaired credit card loans(e)
$
2,029

$
3,115

Allowance for loan losses related to impaired credit card loans
$
500

$
971

(a)
The carrying value and the unpaid principal balance are the same for credit card impaired loans.
(b)
There were no impaired loans without an allowance.
(c)
Represents credit card loans outstanding to borrowers enrolled in a credit card modification program as of the date presented.
(d)
Represents credit card loans that were modified in TDRs but that have subsequently reverted back to the loans’ pre-modification payment terms. At December 31, 2014 and 2013, $159 million and $226 million, respectively, of loans have reverted back to the pre-modification payment terms of the loans due to noncompliance with the terms of the modified loans. The remaining $95 million and $143 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, of these loans are to borrowers who have successfully completed a short-term modification program. The Firm continues to report these loans as TDRs since the borrowers’ credit lines remain closed.
(e)
Predominantly all impaired credit card loans are in the U.S.
The following table presents average balances of impaired credit card loans and interest income recognized on those loans.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
 
2014
2013
2012
Average impaired credit card loans
 
$
2,503

$
3,882

$
5,893

Interest income on
  impaired credit card loans
 
123

198

308

Loan modifications
JPMorgan Chase may offer one of a number of loan modification programs to credit card borrowers who are experiencing financial difficulty. Most of the credit card loans have been modified under long-term programs for borrowers who are experiencing financial difficulties. Modifications under long-term programs involve placing the customer on a fixed payment plan, generally for 60 months. The Firm may also offer short-term programs for borrowers who may be in need of temporary relief; however, none are currently being offered. Modifications under all short- and long-term programs typically include reducing the interest rate on the credit card. Substantially all modifications are considered to be TDRs.
If the cardholder does not comply with the modified payment terms, then the credit card loan agreement reverts back to its pre-modification payment terms. Assuming that the cardholder does not begin to perform in accordance with those payment terms, the loan continues to age and will ultimately be charged-off in accordance with the Firm’s standard charge-off policy. In addition, if a borrower successfully completes a short-term modification program,
 
then the loan reverts back to its pre-modification payment terms. However, in most cases, the Firm does not reinstate the borrower’s line of credit.
New enrollments in these loan modification programs for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, were $807 million, $1.2 billion and $1.7 billion, respectively.

Financial effects of modifications and redefaults
The following table provides information about the financial effects of the concessions granted on credit card loans modified in TDRs and redefaults for the periods presented.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions, except
weighted-average data)
 
2014
2013
2012
Weighted-average interest rate of loans – before TDR
 
14.96
%
15.37
%
15.67
%
Weighted-average interest rate of loans – after TDR
 
4.40

4.38

5.19

Loans that redefaulted within one year of modification(a)
 
$
119

$
167

$
309

(a)
Represents loans modified in TDRs that experienced a payment default in the periods presented, and for which the payment default occurred within one year of the modification. The amounts presented represent the balance of such loans as of the end of the quarter in which they defaulted.
For credit card loans modified in TDRs, payment default is deemed to have occurred when the loans become two payments past due. A substantial portion of these loans is expected to be charged-off in accordance with the Firm’s standard charge-off policy. Based on historical experience, the estimated weighted-average default rate for credit card loans modified was expected to be 27.91%, 30.72% and 38.23% as of December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
Wholesale loan portfolio
Wholesale loans include loans made to a variety of customers, ranging from large corporate and institutional clients to high-net-worth individuals.
The primary credit quality indicator for wholesale loans is the risk rating assigned each loan. Risk ratings are used to identify the credit quality of loans and differentiate risk within the portfolio. Risk ratings on loans consider the probability of default (“PD”) and the loss given default (“LGD”). The PD is the likelihood that a loan will default and not be fully repaid by the borrower. The LGD is the estimated loss on the loan that would be realized upon the default of the borrower and takes into consideration collateral and structural support for each credit facility.
Management considers several factors to determine an appropriate risk rating, including the obligor’s debt capacity and financial flexibility, the level of the obligor’s earnings, the amount and sources for repayment, the level and nature of contingencies, management strength, and the industry and geography in which the obligor operates. The Firm’s definition of criticized aligns with the banking regulatory definition of criticized exposures, which consist of special mention, substandard and doubtful categories. Risk ratings generally represent ratings profiles similar to those defined


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
255

Notes to consolidated financial statements

by S&P and Moody’s. Investment-grade ratings range from “AAA/Aaa” to “BBB-/Baa3.” Noninvestment-grade ratings are classified as noncriticized (“BB+/Ba1 and B-/B3”) and criticized (“CCC+”/“Caa1 and below”), and the criticized portion is further subdivided into performing and nonaccrual loans, representing management’s assessment of the collectibility of principal and interest. Criticized loans have a higher probability of default than noncriticized loans.
Risk ratings are reviewed on a regular and ongoing basis by Credit Risk Management and are adjusted as necessary for
 
updated information affecting the obligor’s ability to fulfill its obligations.
As noted above, the risk rating of a loan considers the industry in which the obligor conducts its operations. As part of the overall credit risk management framework, the Firm focuses on the management and diversification of its industry and client exposures, with particular attention paid to industries with actual or potential credit concern. See Note 5 for further detail on industry concentrations.


The table below provides information by class of receivable for the retained loans in the Wholesale portfolio segment.
As of or for the year ended December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
Commercial
and industrial
 
Real estate
 
Financial
institutions
 
Government agencies
 
Other(d)
 
Total
retained loans
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
Loans by risk ratings
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment grade
$
63,069

$
57,690

 
$
61,006

$
52,195

 
$
27,111

$
26,712

 
$
8,393

$
9,979

 
$
82,087

$
79,494

 
$
241,666

$
226,070

Noninvestment grade:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Noncriticized
44,117

43,477

 
16,541

14,381

 
7,085

6,674

 
300

440

 
10,075

10,992

 
78,118

75,964

Criticized performing
2,251

2,385

 
1,313

2,229

 
316

272

 
3

42

 
236

480

 
4,119

5,408

Criticized nonaccrual
188

294

 
253

346

 
18

25

 

1

 
140

155

 
599

821

Total noninvestment grade
46,556

46,156

 
18,107

16,956

 
7,419

6,971

 
303

483

 
10,451

11,627

 
82,836

82,193

Total retained loans
$
109,625

$
103,846

 
$
79,113

$
69,151

 
$
34,530

$
33,683

 
$
8,696

$
10,462

 
$
92,538

$
91,121

 
$
324,502

$
308,263

% of total criticized to total retained loans
2.22
%
2.58
%
 
1.98
 %
3.72
%
 
0.97
 %
0.88
 %
 
0.03
%
0.41
%
 
0.41
 %
0.70
%
 
1.45
%
2.02
%
% of nonaccrual loans to total retained loans
0.17

0.28

 
0.32

0.50

 
0.05

0.07

 

0.01

 
0.15

0.17

 
0.18

0.27

Loans by geographic distribution(a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total non-U.S.
$
33,739

$
34,440

 
$
2,099

$
1,369

 
$
20,944

$
22,726

 
$
1,122

$
2,146

 
$
42,961

$
43,376

 
$
100,865

$
104,057

Total U.S.
75,886

69,406

 
77,014

67,782

 
13,586

10,957

 
7,574

8,316

 
49,577

47,745

 
223,637

204,206

Total retained loans
$
109,625

$
103,846

 
$
79,113

$
69,151

 
$
34,530

$
33,683

 
$
8,696

$
10,462

 
$
92,538

$
91,121

 
$
324,502

$
308,263

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net charge-offs/(recoveries)
$
22

$
99

 
$
(9
)
$
6

 
$
(12
)
$
(99
)
 
$
25

$
1

 
$
(14
)
$
9

 
$
12

$
16

% of net charge-offs/(recoveries) to end-of-period retained loans
0.02
%
0.10
%
 
(0.01
)%
0.01
%
 
(0.04
)%
(0.29
)%
 
0.29
%
0.01
%
 
(0.02
)%
0.01
%
 
%
0.01
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loan delinquency(b)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Current and less than 30 days past due and still accruing
$
108,857

$
103,357

 
$
78,552

$
68,627

 
$
34,408

$
33,426

 
$
8,627

$
10,421

 
$
91,168

$
89,717

 
$
321,612

$
305,548

30–89 days past due and still accruing
566

181

 
275

164

 
104

226

 
69

40

 
1,201

1,233

 
2,215

1,844

90 or more days past due and still accruing(c)
14

14

 
33

14

 

6

 


 
29

16

 
76

50

Criticized nonaccrual
188

294

 
253

346

 
18

25

 

1

 
140

155

 
599

821

Total retained loans
$
109,625

$
103,846

 
$
79,113

$
69,151

 
$
34,530

$
33,683

 
$
8,696

$
10,462

 
$
92,538

$
91,121

 
$
324,502

$
308,263

(a)
The U.S. and non-U.S. distribution is determined based predominantly on the domicile of the borrower.
(b)
The credit quality of wholesale loans is assessed primarily through ongoing review and monitoring of an obligor’s ability to meet contractual obligations rather than relying on the past due status, which is generally a lagging indicator of credit quality. For a discussion of more significant risk factors, see pages 255–256 of this Note.
(c)
Represents loans that are considered well-collateralized and therefore still accruing interest.
(d)
Other primarily includes loans to SPEs and loans to private banking clients. See Note 1 for additional information on SPEs.

256
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The following table presents additional information on the real estate class of loans within the Wholesale portfolio segment for the periods indicated. The real estate class primarily consists of secured commercial loans mainly to borrowers for multi-family and commercial lessor properties. Multifamily lending specifically finances apartment buildings. Commercial lessors receive financing specifically for real estate leased to retail, office and industrial tenants. Commercial construction and development loans represent financing for the construction of apartments, office and professional buildings and malls. Other real estate loans include lodging, real estate investment trusts (“REITs”), single-family, homebuilders and other real estate.
December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
Multifamily
 
Commercial lessors
 
Commercial construction and development
 
Other
 
Total real estate loans
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
Real estate retained loans
$
51,049

$
44,389

 
$
17,438

$
15,949

 
$
4,264

$
3,674

 
$
6,362

$
5,139

 
$
79,113

$
69,151

Criticized
652

1,142

 
841

1,323

 
42

81

 
31

29

 
1,566

2,575

% of criticized to total real estate retained loans
1.28
%
2.57
%
 
4.82
%
8.30
%
 
0.98
%
2.20
%
 
0.49
%
0.56
%
 
1.98
%
3.72
%
Criticized nonaccrual
$
126

$
191

 
$
110

$
143

 
$

$
3

 
$
17

$
9

 
$
253

$
346

% of criticized nonaccrual to total real estate retained loans
0.25
%
0.43
%
 
0.63
%
0.90
%
 
%
0.08
%
 
0.27
%
0.18
%
 
0.32
%
0.50
%

Wholesale impaired loans and loan modifications
Wholesale impaired loans are comprised of loans that have been placed on nonaccrual status and/or that have been modified in a TDR. All impaired loans are evaluated for an asset-specific allowance as described in Note 15.
The table below sets forth information about the Firm’s wholesale impaired loans.
December 31,
(in millions)
Commercial
and industrial
 
Real estate
 
Financial
institutions
 
Government
 agencies
 
Other
 
Total
retained loans
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
 
2013
 
Impaired loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
With an allowance
$
174

$
236

 
$
193

$
258

 
$
15

$
17

 
$

$
1

 
$
89

$
85

 
$
471

 
$
597

 
Without an allowance(a)
24

58

 
87

109

 
3

8

 


 
52

73

 
166

 
248

 
Total impaired loans
$
198

$
294

 
$
280

$
367

 
$
18

$
25

 
$

$
1

 
$
141

$
158

 
$
637

(c) 
$
845

(c) 
Allowance for loan losses related to impaired loans
$
34

$
75

 
$
36

$
63

 
$
4

$
16

 
$

$

 
$
13

$
27

 
$
87

 
$
181

 
Unpaid principal balance of impaired loans(b)
266

448

 
345

454

 
22

24

 

1

 
202

241

 
835

 
1,168

 
(a)
When the discounted cash flows, collateral value or market price equals or exceeds the recorded investment in the loan, the loan does not require an allowance. This typically occurs when the impaired loans have been partially charged-off and/or there have been interest payments received and applied to the loan balance.
(b)
Represents the contractual amount of principal owed at December 31, 2014 and 2013. The unpaid principal balance differs from the impaired loan balances due to various factors, including charge-offs; interest payments received and applied to the carrying value; net deferred loan fees or costs; and unamortized discount or premiums on purchased loans.
(c)
Based upon the domicile of the borrower, predominantly all wholesale impaired loans are in the U.S.

The following table presents the Firm’s average impaired loans for the years ended 2014, 2013 and 2012.
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
2014
2013
2012
Commercial and industrial
$
243

$
412

$
873

Real estate
297

484

784

Financial institutions
20

17

17

Government agencies


9

Other
155

211

277

Total(a)
$
715

$
1,124

$
1,960

(a)
The related interest income on accruing impaired loans and interest income recognized on a cash basis were not material for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012.

Certain loan modifications are considered to be TDRs as they provide various concessions to borrowers who are experiencing financial difficulty. All TDRs are reported as impaired loans in the tables above. TDRs were not material as of December 31, 2014 and 2013.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
257

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Note 15 – Allowance for credit losses
JPMorgan Chase’s allowance for loan losses covers the consumer, including credit card, portfolio segments (primarily scored); and wholesale (risk-rated) portfolio, and represents management’s estimate of probable credit losses inherent in the Firm’s loan portfolio. The allowance for loan losses includes an asset-specific component, a formula-based component and a component related to PCI loans, as described below. Management also estimates an allowance for wholesale and consumer lending-related commitments using methodologies similar to those used to estimate the allowance on the underlying loans. During 2014, the Firm did not make any significant changes to the methodologies or policies used to determine its allowance for credit losses; such policies are described in the following paragraphs.
The asset-specific component of the allowance relates to loans considered to be impaired, which includes loans that have been modified in TDRs as well as risk-rated loans that have been placed on nonaccrual status. To determine the asset-specific component of the allowance, larger loans are evaluated individually, while smaller loans are evaluated as pools using historical loss experience for the respective class of assets. Scored loans (i.e., consumer loans) are pooled by product type, while risk-rated loans (primarily wholesale loans) are segmented by risk rating.
The Firm generally measures the asset-specific allowance as the difference between the recorded investment in the loan and the present value of the cash flows expected to be collected, discounted at the loan’s original effective interest rate. Subsequent changes in impairment are reported as an adjustment to the provision for loan losses. In certain cases, the asset-specific allowance is determined using an observable market price, and the allowance is measured as the difference between the recorded investment in the loan and the loan’s fair value. Impaired collateral-dependent loans are charged down to the fair value of collateral less costs to sell and therefore may not be subject to an asset-specific reserve as are other impaired loans. See Note 14 for more information about charge-offs and collateral-dependent loans.
 
The asset-specific component of the allowance for impaired loans that have been modified in TDRs incorporates the effects of foregone interest, if any, in the present value calculation and also incorporates the effect of the modification on the loan’s expected cash flows, which considers the potential for redefault. For residential real estate loans modified in TDRs, the Firm develops product-specific probability of default estimates, which are applied at a loan level to compute expected losses. In developing these probabilities of default, the Firm considers the relationship between the credit quality characteristics of the underlying loans and certain assumptions about home prices and unemployment, based upon industry-wide data. The Firm also considers its own historical loss experience to date based on actual redefaulted modified loans. For credit card loans modified in TDRs, expected losses incorporate projected redefaults based on the Firm’s historical experience by type of modification program. For wholesale loans modified in TDRs, expected losses incorporate redefaults based on management’s expectation of the borrower’s ability to repay under the modified terms.
The formula-based component is based on a statistical calculation to provide for incurred credit losses in performing risk-rated loans and all consumer loans, except for any loans restructured in TDRs and PCI loans. See Note 14 for more information on PCI loans.
For scored loans, the statistical calculation is performed on pools of loans with similar risk characteristics (e.g., product type) and generally computed by applying loss factors to outstanding principal balances over an estimated loss emergence period. The loss emergence period represents the time period between the date at which the loss is estimated to have been incurred and the ultimate realization of that loss (through a charge-off). Estimated loss emergence periods may vary by product and may change over time; management applies judgment in estimating loss emergence periods, using available credit information and trends.


258
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Loss factors are statistically derived and sensitive to changes in delinquency status, credit scores, collateral values and other risk factors. The Firm uses a number of different forecasting models to estimate both the PD and the loss severity, including delinquency roll rate models and credit loss severity models. In developing PD and loss severity assumptions, the Firm also considers known and anticipated changes in the economic environment, including changes in home prices, unemployment rates and other risk indicators.
A nationally recognized home price index measure is used to estimate both the PD and the loss severity on residential real estate loans at the metropolitan statistical areas (“MSA”) level. Loss severity estimates are regularly validated by comparison to actual losses recognized on defaulted loans, market-specific real estate appraisals and property sales activity. The economic impact of potential modifications of residential real estate loans is not included in the statistical calculation because of the uncertainty regarding the type and results of such modifications.
For risk-rated loans, the statistical calculation is the product of an estimated PD and an estimated LGD. These factors are differentiated by risk rating and expected maturity. In assessing the risk rating of a particular loan, among the factors considered are the obligor’s debt capacity and financial flexibility, the level of the obligor’s earnings, the amount and sources for repayment, the level and nature of contingencies, management strength, and the industry and geography in which the obligor operates. These factors are based on an evaluation of historical and current information, and involve subjective assessment and interpretation. Emphasizing one factor over another or considering additional factors could impact the risk rating assigned by the Firm to that loan. PD estimates are based on observable external through-the-cycle data, using credit-rating agency default statistics. LGD estimates are based on the Firm’s history of actual credit losses over more than one credit cycle. Estimates of PD and LGD are subject to periodic refinement based on changes to underlying external and Firm-specific historical data.
 
Management applies judgment within an established framework to adjust the results of applying the statistical calculation described above. The determination of the appropriate adjustment is based on management’s view of loss events that have occurred but that are not yet reflected in the loss factors and that relate to current macroeconomic and political conditions, the quality of underwriting standards and other relevant internal and external factors affecting the credit quality of the portfolio. For the scored loan portfolios, adjustments to the statistical calculation are made in part by analyzing the historical loss experience for each major product segment. Factors related to unemployment, home prices, borrower behavior and lien position, the estimated effects of the mortgage foreclosure-related settlement with federal and state officials and uncertainties regarding the ultimate success of loan modifications are incorporated into the calculation, as appropriate. For junior lien products, management considers the delinquency and/or modification status of any senior liens in determining the adjustment. In addition, for the risk-rated portfolios, any adjustments made to the statistical calculation take into consideration model imprecision, deteriorating conditions within an industry, product or portfolio type, geographic location, credit concentration, and current economic events that have occurred but that are not yet reflected in the factors used to derive the statistical calculation.
Management establishes an asset-specific allowance for lending-related commitments that are considered impaired and computes a formula-based allowance for performing consumer and wholesale lending-related commitments. These are computed using a methodology similar to that used for the wholesale loan portfolio, modified for expected maturities and probabilities of drawdown.
Determining the appropriateness of the allowance is complex and requires judgment by management about the effect of matters that are inherently uncertain. Subsequent evaluations of the loan portfolio, in light of the factors then prevailing, may result in significant changes in the allowances for loan losses and lending-related commitments in future periods. At least quarterly, the allowance for credit losses is reviewed by the Chief Risk Officer, the Chief Financial Officer and the Controller of the Firm and discussed with the Risk Policy and Audit Committees of the Board of Directors of the Firm. As of December 31, 2014, JPMorgan Chase deemed the allowance for credit losses to be appropriate (i.e., sufficient to absorb probable credit losses inherent in the portfolio).


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
259

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Allowance for credit losses and loans and lending-related commitments by impairment methodology
The table below summarizes information about the allowance for loan losses, loans by impairment methodology, the allowance for lending-related commitments and lending-related commitments by impairment methodology.

 
2014
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
Consumer,
excluding
credit card
 
Credit card
 
Wholesale
 
Total
Allowance for loan losses
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Beginning balance at January 1,
$
8,456

 
$
3,795

 
$
4,013

 
$
16,264

Gross charge-offs
2,132


3,831

 
151

 
6,114

Gross recoveries
(814
)
 
(402
)
 
(139
)
 
(1,355
)
Net charge-offs/(recoveries)
1,318


3,429

 
12

 
4,759

Write-offs of PCI loans(a)
533

 

 

 
533

Provision for loan losses
414

 
3,079

 
(269
)
 
3,224

Other
31


(6
)
 
(36
)
 
(11
)
Ending balance at December 31,
$
7,050

 
$
3,439

 
$
3,696

 
$
14,185

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses by impairment methodology
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Asset-specific(b)
$
539

 
$
500

(c) 
$
87

 
$
1,126

Formula-based
3,186

 
2,939

 
3,609

 
9,734

PCI
3,325

 

 

 
3,325

Total allowance for loan losses
$
7,050

 
$
3,439

 
$
3,696

 
$
14,185

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans by impairment methodology
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Asset-specific
$
12,020

 
$
2,029

 
$
637

 
$
14,686

Formula-based
236,263

 
125,998

 
323,861

 
686,122

PCI
46,696

 

 
4

 
46,700

Total retained loans
$
294,979

 
$
128,027

 
$
324,502

 
$
747,508

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Impaired collateral-dependent loans
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net charge-offs
$
133


$

 
$
21

 
$
154

Loans measured at fair value of collateral less cost to sell
3,025

 

 
326

 
3,351

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for lending-related commitments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Beginning balance at January 1,
$
8

 
$

 
$
697

 
$
705

Provision for lending-related commitments
5

 

 
(90
)
 
(85
)
Other

 

 
2

 
2

Ending balance at December 31,
$
13

 
$

 
$
609

 
$
622

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for lending-related commitments by impairment methodology
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Asset-specific
$

 
$

 
$
60

 
$
60

Formula-based
13

 

 
549

 
562

Total allowance for lending-related commitments
$
13

 
$

 
$
609

 
$
622

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Lending-related commitments by impairment methodology
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Asset-specific
$

 
$

 
$
103

 
$
103

Formula-based
58,153

 
525,963

 
471,953

 
1,056,069

Total lending-related commitments
$
58,153

 
$
525,963

 
$
472,056

 
$
1,056,172

(a)
Write-offs of PCI loans are recorded against the allowance for loan losses when actual losses for a pool exceed estimated losses that were recorded as purchase accounting adjustments at the time of acquisition. A write-off of a PCI loan is recognized when the underlying loan is removed from a pool (e.g., upon liquidation). During the fourth quarter of 2014, the Firm recorded a $291 million adjustment to reduce the PCI allowance and the recorded investment in the Firm’s PCI loan portfolio, primarily reflecting the cumulative effect of interest forgiveness modifications. This adjustment had no impact to the Firm’s Consolidated statements of income.
(b)
Includes risk-rated loans that have been placed on nonaccrual status and loans that have been modified in a TDR.
(c)
The asset-specific credit card allowance for loan losses is related to loans that have been modified in a TDR; such allowance is calculated based on the loans’ original contractual interest rates and does not consider any incremental penalty rates.

260
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report







(table continued from previous page)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2013
 
2012
Consumer,
excluding
credit card
 
Credit card
 
Wholesale
Total
 
Consumer,
excluding
credit card
 
Credit card
 
Wholesale
Total
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
12,292

 
$
5,501

 
$
4,143

$
21,936

 
$
16,294

 
$
6,999

 
$
4,316

$
27,609

2,754

 
4,472

 
241

7,467

 
4,805

 
5,755

 
346

10,906

(847
)
 
(593
)
 
(225
)
(1,665
)
 
(508
)
 
(811
)
 
(524
)
(1,843
)
1,907

 
3,879

 
16

5,802

 
4,297

 
4,944

 
(178
)
9,063

53

 

 

53

 

 

 


(1,872
)
 
2,179

 
(119
)
188

 
302

 
3,444

 
(359
)
3,387

(4
)
 
(6
)
 
5

(5
)
 
(7
)
 
2

 
8

3

$
8,456

 
$
3,795

 
$
4,013

$
16,264

 
$
12,292

 
$
5,501

 
$
4,143

$
21,936

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
601

 
$
971

(c) 
$
181

$
1,753

 
$
729

 
$
1,681

(c) 
$
319

$
2,729

3,697

 
2,824

 
3,832

10,353

 
5,852

 
3,820

 
3,824

13,496

4,158

 

 

4,158

 
5,711

 

 

5,711

$
8,456

 
$
3,795

 
$
4,013

$
16,264

 
$
12,292

 
$
5,501

 
$
4,143

$
21,936

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
13,785

 
$
3,115

 
$
845

$
17,745

 
$
13,938

 
$
4,762

 
$
1,475

$
20,175

221,609

 
124,350

 
307,412

653,371

 
218,945

 
123,231

 
304,728

646,904

53,055

 

 
6

53,061

 
59,737

 

 
19

59,756

$
288,449

 
$
127,465

 
$
308,263

$
724,177

 
$
292,620

 
$
127,993

 
$
306,222

$
726,835

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
235

 
$

 
$
37

$
272

 
$
973

 
$

 
$
77

$
1,050

3,105

 

 
362

3,467

 
3,272

 

 
445

3,717

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
7

 
$

 
$
661

$
668

 
$
7

 
$

 
$
666

$
673

1

 

 
36

37

 

 

 
(2
)
(2
)

 

 


 

 

 
(3
)
(3
)
$
8

 
$

 
$
697

$
705

 
$
7

 
$

 
$
661

$
668

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$

 
$

 
$
60

$
60

 
$

 
$

 
$
97

$
97

8

 

 
637

645

 
7

 

 
564

571

$
8

 
$

 
$
697

$
705

 
$
7

 
$

 
$
661

$
668

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$

 
$

 
$
206

$
206

 
$

 
$

 
$
355

$
355

56,057

 
529,383

 
446,026

1,031,466

 
60,156

 
533,018

 
434,459

1,027,633

$
56,057

 
$
529,383

 
$
446,232

$
1,031,672

 
$
60,156

 
$
533,018

 
$
434,814

$
1,027,988




JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
261

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Note 16 – Variable interest entities
For a further description of JPMorgan Chase’s accounting policies regarding consolidation of VIEs, see Note 1.
The following table summarizes the most significant types of Firm-sponsored VIEs by business segment. The Firm considers a “sponsored” VIE to include any entity where: (1) JPMorgan Chase is the principal beneficiary of the structure; (2) the VIE is used by JPMorgan Chase to securitize Firm assets; (3) the VIE issues financial instruments with the JPMorgan Chase name; or (4) the entity is a JPMorgan Chase–administered asset-backed commercial paper conduit.
Line-of-Business
Transaction Type
Activity
Annual Report
page references
CCB
Credit card securitization trusts
Securitization of both originated and purchased credit card receivables
262
 
Mortgage securitization trusts
Securitization of originated and purchased residential mortgages
263-265
 
Other securitization trusts
Securitization of originated student loans
263-265
CIB
Mortgage and other securitization trusts
Securitization of both originated and purchased residential and commercial mortgages, automobile and student loans
263-265
 
Multi-seller conduits
Investor intermediation activities:
Assist clients in accessing the financial markets in a cost-efficient manner and structures transactions to meet investor needs
265-267
 
Municipal bond vehicles
 
265-266
 
Credit-related note and asset swap vehicles
 
267
The Firm’s other business segments are also involved with VIEs, but to a lesser extent, as follows:
Asset Management: Sponsors and manages certain funds that are deemed VIEs. As asset manager of the funds, AM earns a fee based on assets managed; the fee varies with each fund’s investment objective and is competitively priced. For fund entities that qualify as VIEs, AM’s interests are, in certain cases, considered to be significant variable interests that result in consolidation of the financial results of these entities.
Commercial Banking: CB makes investments in and provides lending to community development entities that may meet the definition of a VIE. In addition, CB provides financing and lending-related services to certain client-sponsored VIEs. In general, CB does not control the activities of these entities and does not consolidate these entities.
Corporate: The Private Equity business, within Corporate, may be involved with entities that are deemed VIEs. However, the Firm’s private equity business is subject to specialized investment company accounting, which does not require the consolidation of investments, including VIEs.
The Firm also invests in and provides financing and other services to VIEs sponsored by third parties, as described on page 268 of this Note.
Significant Firm-sponsored variable interest entities
Credit card securitizations
The Card business securitizes originated and purchased credit card loans, primarily through the Chase Issuance Trust (the “Trust”). The Firm’s continuing involvement in credit card securitizations includes servicing the receivables, retaining an undivided seller’s interest in the receivables, retaining certain senior and subordinated securities and maintaining escrow accounts.
The Firm is considered to be the primary beneficiary of these Firm-sponsored credit card securitization trusts based on the Firm’s ability to direct the activities of these VIEs through its servicing responsibilities and other duties, including making decisions as to the receivables that are transferred into those trusts and as to any related modifications and workouts. Additionally, the nature and extent of the Firm’s other continuing involvement with the trusts, as indicated above, obligates the Firm to absorb losses and gives the Firm the right to receive certain benefits from these VIEs that could potentially be significant.
 
The underlying securitized credit card receivables and other assets of the securitization trusts are available only for payment of the beneficial interests issued by the securitization trusts; they are not available to pay the Firm’s other obligations or the claims of the Firm’s other creditors.
The agreements with the credit card securitization trusts require the Firm to maintain a minimum undivided interest in the credit card trusts (which is generally 4%). As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm held undivided interests in Firm-sponsored credit card securitization trusts of $10.9 billion and $14.3 billion, respectively. The Firm maintained an average undivided interest in principal receivables owned by those trusts of approximately 22% and 30% for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The Firm also retained $40 million and $130 million of senior securities and $5.3 billion and $5.5 billion of subordinated securities in certain of its credit card securitization trusts as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The Firm’s undivided interests in the credit card trusts and securities retained are eliminated in consolidation.


262
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Firm-sponsored mortgage and other securitization trusts
The Firm securitizes (or has securitized) originated and purchased residential mortgages, commercial mortgages and other consumer loans (including automobile and student loans) primarily in its CCB and CIB businesses.
 
Depending on the particular transaction, as well as the line of business involved, the Firm may act as the servicer of the loans and/or retain certain beneficial interests in the securitization trusts.


The following table presents the total unpaid principal amount of assets held in Firm-sponsored private-label securitization entities, including those in which the Firm has continuing involvement, and those that are consolidated by the Firm. Continuing involvement includes servicing the loans; holding senior interests or subordinated interests; recourse or guarantee arrangements; and derivative transactions. In certain instances, the Firm’s only continuing involvement is servicing the loans. See Securitization activity on page 269 of this Note for further information regarding the Firm’s cash flows with and interests retained in nonconsolidated VIEs, and pages 269–270 of this Note for information on the Firm’s loan sales to U.S. government agencies.
 
Principal amount outstanding
 
JPMorgan Chase interest in securitized assets in nonconsolidated VIEs(c)(d)(e)
December 31, 2014 (a) (in billions)
Total assets held by securitization VIEs
Assets held in consolidated securitization VIEs
Assets held in nonconsolidated securitization VIEs with continuing involvement
 
Trading assets
AFS securities
Total interests held by JPMorgan Chase
Securitization-related
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Prime/Alt-A and Option ARMs
$
96.3

$
2.7

$
78.3

 
$
0.5

$
0.7

$
1.2

Subprime
28.4

0.8

25.7

 
0.1


0.1

Commercial and other(b)
129.6

0.2

94.4

 
0.4

3.5

3.9

Total
$
254.3

$
3.7

$
198.4

 
$
1.0

$
4.2

$
5.2


 
Principal amount outstanding
 
JPMorgan Chase interest in securitized assets in nonconsolidated VIEs(c)(d)(e)
December 31, 2013(a) (in billions)
Total assets held by securitization VIEs
Assets held in consolidated securitization VIEs
Assets held in nonconsolidated securitization VIEs with continuing involvement
 
Trading assets
AFS securities
Total interests held by JPMorgan Chase
Securitization-related
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Prime/Alt-A and Option ARMs
$
109.2

$
3.2

$
90.4

 
$
0.5

$
0.3

$
0.8

Subprime
32.1

1.3

28.0

 
0.1


0.1

Commercial and other(b)
130.4


98.0

 
0.5

3.5

4.0

Total
$
271.7

$
4.5

$
216.4

 
$
1.1

$
3.8

$
4.9

(a)
Excludes U.S. government agency securitizations. See pages 269–270 of this Note for information on the Firm’s loan sales to U.S. government agencies.
(b)
Consists of securities backed by commercial loans (predominantly real estate) and non-mortgage-related consumer receivables purchased from third parties. The Firm generally does not retain a residual interest in its sponsored commercial mortgage securitization transactions.
(c)
The table above excludes the following: retained servicing (see Note 17 for a discussion of MSRs); securities retained from loan sales to U.S. government agencies; interest rate and foreign exchange derivatives primarily used to manage interest rate and foreign exchange risks of securitization entities (See Note 6 for further information on derivatives); senior and subordinated securities of $136 million and $34 million, respectively, at December 31, 2014, and $151 million and $30 million, respectively, at December 31, 2013, which the Firm purchased in connection with CIB’s secondary market-making activities.
(d)
Includes interests held in re-securitization transactions.
(e)
As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, 77% and 69%, respectively, of the Firm’s retained securitization interests, which are carried at fair value, were risk-rated “A” or better, on an S&P-equivalent basis. The retained interests in prime residential mortgages consisted of $1.1 billion and $551 million of investment-grade and $185 million and $260 million of noninvestment-grade retained interests at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The retained interests in commercial and other securitizations trusts consisted of $3.7 billion and $3.9 billion of investment-grade and $194 million and $80 million of noninvestment-grade retained interests at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
263

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Residential mortgage
The Firm securitizes residential mortgage loans originated by CCB, as well as residential mortgage loans purchased from third parties by either CCB or CIB. CCB generally retains servicing for all residential mortgage loans originated or purchased by CCB, and for certain mortgage loans purchased by CIB. For securitizations serviced by CCB, the Firm has the power to direct the significant activities of the VIE because it is responsible for decisions related to loan modifications and workouts. CCB may also retain an interest upon securitization.
In addition, CIB engages in underwriting and trading activities involving securities issued by Firm-sponsored securitization trusts. As a result, CIB at times retains senior and/or subordinated interests (including residual interests) in residential mortgage securitizations upon securitization, and/or reacquires positions in the secondary market in the normal course of business. In certain instances, as a result of the positions retained or reacquired by CIB or held by CCB, when considered together with the servicing arrangements entered into by CCB, the Firm is deemed to be the primary beneficiary of certain securitization trusts. See the table on page 268 of this Note for more information on consolidated residential mortgage securitizations.
The Firm does not consolidate a residential mortgage securitization (Firm-sponsored or third-party-sponsored) when it is not the servicer (and therefore does not have the power to direct the most significant activities of the trust) or does not hold a beneficial interest in the trust that could potentially be significant to the trust. At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm did not consolidate the assets of certain Firm-sponsored residential mortgage securitization VIEs, in which the Firm had continuing involvement, primarily due to the fact that the Firm did not hold an interest in these trusts that could potentially be significant to the trusts. See the table on page 268 of this Note for more information on the consolidated residential mortgage securitizations, and the table on the previous page of this Note for further information on interests held in nonconsolidated residential mortgage securitizations.
Commercial mortgages and other consumer securitizations
CIB originates and securitizes commercial mortgage loans, and engages in underwriting and trading activities involving the securities issued by securitization trusts. CIB may retain unsold senior and/or subordinated interests in commercial mortgage securitizations at the time of securitization but, generally, the Firm does not service commercial loan securitizations. For commercial mortgage securitizations the power to direct the significant activities of the VIE generally is held by the servicer or investors in a specified class of securities (“controlling class”). See the table on page 268 of this Note for more information on the consolidated commercial mortgage securitizations,
and the table on the previous page of this Note for further information on interests held in nonconsolidated securitizations.
 
The Firm retains servicing responsibilities for certain student loan securitizations. The Firm has the power to direct the activities of these VIEs through these servicing responsibilities. See the table on page 268 of this Note for more information on the consolidated student loan securitizations, and the table on the previous page of this Note for further information on interests held in nonconsolidated securitizations.
Re-securitizations
The Firm engages in certain re-securitization transactions in which debt securities are transferred to a VIE in exchange for new beneficial interests. These transfers occur in connection with both agency (Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac and Ginnie Mae) and nonagency (private-label) sponsored VIEs, which may be backed by either residential or commercial mortgages. The Firm’s consolidation analysis is largely dependent on the Firm’s role and interest in the re-securitization trusts. During the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, the Firm transferred $22.7 billion, $25.3 billion and $10.0 billion, respectively, of securities to agency VIEs, and $1.1 billion, $55 million and $286 million, respectively, of securities to private-label VIEs.
Most re-securitizations with which the Firm is involved are client-driven transactions in which a specific client or group of clients is seeking a specific return or risk profile. For these transactions, the Firm has concluded that the decision-making power of the entity is shared between the Firm and its clients, considering the joint effort and decisions in establishing the re-securitization trust and its assets, as well as the significant economic interest the client holds in the re-securitization trust; therefore the Firm does not consolidate the re-securitization VIE.
In more limited circumstances, the Firm creates a re-securitization trust independently and not in conjunction with specific clients. In these circumstances, the Firm is deemed to have the unilateral ability to direct the most significant activities of the re-securitization trust because of the decisions made during the establishment and design of the trust; therefore, the Firm consolidates the re-securitization VIE if the Firm holds an interest that could potentially be significant.
Additionally, the Firm may invest in beneficial interests of third-party securitizations and generally purchases these interests in the secondary market. In these circumstances, the Firm does not have the unilateral ability to direct the most significant activities of the re-securitization trust, either because it was not involved in the initial design of the trust, or the Firm is involved with an independent third-party sponsor and demonstrates shared power over the creation of the trust; therefore, the Firm does not consolidate the re-securitization VIE.
As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm did not consolidate any agency re-securitizations. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm consolidated assets of $77 million and $86 million, respectively, and liabilities of $21 million and $23 million, respectively, of


264
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



private-label re-securitizations. See the table on page 268 of this Note for more information on the consolidated re-securitization transactions.
As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, total assets (including the notional amount of interest-only securities) of nonconsolidated Firm-sponsored private-label re-securitization entities in which the Firm has continuing involvement were $2.9 billion and $2.8 billion, respectively. At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm held approximately $2.4 billion and $1.3 billion, respectively, of interests in nonconsolidated agency re-securitization entities, and $36 million and $6 million, respectively, of senior and subordinated interests in nonconsolidated private-label re-securitization entities. See the table on page 263 of this Note for further information on interests held in nonconsolidated securitizations.
Multi-seller conduits
Multi-seller conduit entities are separate bankruptcy remote entities that purchase interests in, and make loans secured by, pools of receivables and other financial assets pursuant to agreements with customers of the Firm. The conduits fund their purchases and loans through the issuance of highly rated commercial paper. The primary source of repayment of the commercial paper is the cash flows from the pools of assets. In most instances, the assets are structured with deal-specific credit enhancements provided to the conduits by the customers (i.e., sellers) or other third parties. Deal-specific credit enhancements are generally structured to cover a multiple of historical losses expected on the pool of assets, and are typically in the form of overcollateralization provided by the seller. The deal-specific credit enhancements mitigate the Firm’s potential losses on its agreements with the conduits.
To ensure timely repayment of the commercial paper, and to provide the conduits with funding to purchase interests in or make loans secured by pools of receivables in the event that the conduits do not obtain funding in the commercial paper market, each asset pool financed by the conduits has a minimum 100% deal-specific liquidity facility associated with it provided by JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. also provides the multi-seller conduit vehicles with uncommitted program-wide liquidity facilities and program-wide credit enhancement in the form of standby letters of credit. The amount of program-wide credit enhancement required is based upon commercial paper issuance and approximates 10% of the outstanding balance.
The Firm consolidates its Firm-administered multi-seller conduits, as the Firm has both the power to direct the significant activities of the conduits and a potentially significant economic interest in the conduits. As administrative agent and in its role in structuring transactions, the Firm makes decisions regarding asset types and credit quality, and manages the commercial paper funding needs of the conduits. The Firm’s interests that could potentially be significant to the VIEs include the fees received as administrative agent and liquidity and
 
program-wide credit enhancement provider, as well as the potential exposure created by the liquidity and credit enhancement facilities provided to the conduits. See page 268 of this Note for further information on consolidated VIE assets and liabilities.
In the normal course of business, JPMorgan Chase makes markets in and invests in commercial paper issued by the Firm-administered multi-seller conduits. The Firm held $5.7 billion and $4.1 billion of the commercial paper issued by the Firm-administered multi-seller conduits at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The Firm’s investments reflect the Firm’s funding needs and capacity and were not driven by market illiquidity. The Firm is not obligated under any agreement to purchase the commercial paper issued by the Firm-administered multi-seller conduits.
Deal-specific liquidity facilities, program-wide liquidity and credit enhancement provided by the Firm have been eliminated in consolidation. The Firm or the Firm-administered multi-seller conduits provide lending-related commitments to certain clients of the Firm-administered multi-seller conduits. The unfunded portion of these commitments was $9.9 billion and $9.1 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, and are reported as off-balance sheet lending-related commitments. For more information on off-balance sheet lending-related commitments, see Note 29.
VIEs associated with investor intermediation activities
As a financial intermediary, the Firm creates certain types of VIEs and also structures transactions with these VIEs, typically using derivatives, to meet investor needs. The Firm may also provide liquidity and other support. The risks inherent in the derivative instruments or liquidity commitments are managed similarly to other credit, market or liquidity risks to which the Firm is exposed. The principal types of VIEs for which the Firm is engaged in on behalf of clients are municipal bond vehicles, credit-related note vehicles and asset swap vehicles.
Municipal bond vehicles
The Firm has created a series of trusts that provide short-term investors with qualifying tax-exempt investments, and that allow investors in tax-exempt securities to finance their investments at short-term tax-exempt rates. In a typical transaction, the vehicle purchases fixed-rate longer-term highly rated municipal bonds and funds the purchase by issuing two types of securities: (1) puttable floating-rate certificates and (2) inverse floating-rate residual interests (“residual interests”). The maturity of each of the puttable floating-rate certificates and the residual interests is equal to the life of the vehicle, while the maturity of the underlying municipal bonds is typically longer. Holders of the puttable floating-rate certificates may “put,” or tender, the certificates if the remarketing agent cannot successfully remarket the floating-rate certificates to another investor. A liquidity facility conditionally obligates the liquidity provider to fund the purchase of the tendered floating-rate certificates. Upon termination of the vehicle, proceeds from


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
265

Notes to consolidated financial statements

the sale of the underlying municipal bonds would first repay any funded liquidity facility or outstanding floating-rate certificates and the remaining amount, if any, would be paid to the residual interests. If the proceeds from the sale of the underlying municipal bonds are not sufficient to repay the liquidity facility, in certain transactions the liquidity provider has recourse to the residual interest holders for reimbursement. Certain residual interest holders may be required to post collateral with the Firm, as liquidity provider, to support such reimbursement obligations should the market value of the municipal bonds decline.
JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. often serves as the sole liquidity provider, and J.P. Morgan Securities LLC serves as remarketing agent, of the puttable floating-rate certificates. The liquidity provider’s obligation to perform is conditional and is limited by certain termination events, which include bankruptcy or failure to pay by the municipal bond issuer or credit enhancement provider, an event of taxability on the municipal bonds or the immediate downgrade of the municipal bond to below investment grade. In addition, the Firm’s exposure as liquidity provider is further limited by the high credit quality of the underlying municipal bonds, the excess collateralization in the vehicle, or in certain transactions, the reimbursement agreements with the residual interest holders.
The long-term credit ratings of the puttable floating rate certificates are directly related to the credit ratings of the underlying municipal bonds, the credit rating of any insurer of the underlying municipal bond, and the Firm’s short-term credit rating as liquidity provider. A downgrade in any of these ratings would affect the rating of the puttable
 
floating-rate certificates and could cause demand for these certificates by investors to decline or disappear. However, a downgrade of JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.’s short-term rating does not affect the Firm’s obligation under the liquidity facility.
As remarketing agent, the Firm may hold puttable floating-rate certificates of the municipal bond vehicles. At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm held $55 million and $262 million, respectively, of these certificates on its Consolidated balance sheets. The largest amount held by the Firm at any end of day during 2014 was $250 million, or 3.0%, of the municipal bond vehicles’ aggregate outstanding puttable floating-rate certificates. The Firm did not have and continues not to have any intent to protect any residual interest holder from potential losses on any of the municipal bond holdings.
The Firm consolidates municipal bond vehicles if it owns the residual interest. The residual interest generally allows the owner to make decisions that significantly impact the economic performance of the municipal bond vehicle, primarily by directing the sale of the municipal bonds owned by the vehicle. In addition, the residual interest owners have the right to receive benefits and bear losses that could potentially be significant to the municipal bond vehicle. The Firm does not consolidate municipal bond vehicles if it does not own the residual interests, since the Firm does not have the power to make decisions that significantly impact the economic performance of the municipal bond vehicle. See page 268 of this Note for further information on consolidated municipal bond vehicles.


The Firm’s exposure to nonconsolidated municipal bond VIEs at December 31, 2014 and 2013, including the ratings profile of the VIEs’ assets, was as follows.
December 31,
(in billions)
Fair value of assets held by VIEs
Liquidity facilities
Excess/(deficit)(a)
Maximum exposure
Nonconsolidated municipal bond vehicles
 
 
 
 
2014
$
11.5

$
6.3

$
5.2

$
6.3

2013
11.8

6.9

4.9

6.9

 
 
 
 
 
 
Ratings profile of VIE assets(b)
Fair value of assets held by VIEs
Wt. avg. expected life of assets (years)
 
Investment-grade
 
Noninvestment- grade
December 31,
(in billions, except where otherwise noted)
AAA to AAA-
AA+ to AA-
A+ to A-
BBB+ to BBB-
 
BB+ and below
2014
$
2.7

$
8.4

$
0.4

$

 
$

$
11.5

4.9
2013
2.7

8.9

0.2


 

$
11.8

7.2
(a)
Represents the excess/(deficit) of the fair values of municipal bond assets available to repay the liquidity facilities, if drawn.
(b)
The ratings scale is presented on an S&P-equivalent basis.


266
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Credit-related note and asset swap vehicles
Credit-related note vehicles
The Firm structures transactions with credit-related note vehicles in which the VIE purchases highly rated assets (generally investment-grade), such as government bonds, corporate bonds or asset-backed securities, and enters into a credit derivative contract with the Firm to obtain exposure to a referenced credit which the VIE otherwise does not hold. The VIE then issues credit-linked notes (“CLNs”) to transfer the risk of the referenced credit to the VIE’s investors. Clients and investors often prefer using a CLN vehicle since they may be of the view that the CLNs issued by the VIE is of a higher credit quality than equivalent notes issued directly by JPMorgan Chase. The Firm divides its credit-related note structures broadly into two types: static and managed. In a static credit-related note structure, the CLNs and associated credit derivative contract either reference a single credit (e.g., a multi-national corporation), or all or part of a fixed portfolio of credits. In a managed credit-related note structure, the CLNs and associated credit derivative generally reference all or part of an actively managed portfolio of credits.
The Firm’s involvement with CLN vehicles is generally limited to being a derivative counterparty and it does not act as a portfolio manager for managed CLN VIEs. The Firm does not provide any additional contractual financial support to the VIE over and above its contractual obligations as derivative counterparty, but may also make a market in the CLNs issued by such VIEs, although it is under no obligation to do so. The Firm has not historically provided any financial support to the CLN vehicles over and above its contractual obligations. As a derivative counterparty the assets held by the VIE serve as collateral for any derivatives receivables. As such the collateral represents the maximum exposure the Firm has to these vehicles, which was $5.9 billion and $8.7 billion as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The Firm’s maximum exposure arises through the derivatives executed with the VIEs; the exposure varies over time with changes in the fair value of the derivatives. The Firm relies on the collateral held by the VIEs to pay any amounts due under the derivatives; the vehicles are structured at inception so that the par value of the collateral is expected to be sufficient to pay amounts due under the derivative contracts
Since each CLN is established to the specifications of the investors, the investors have the power over the activities of that VIE that most significantly affect the performance of the CLN. The Firm consolidates credit-related note entities only in limited circumstances where it holds positions in these entities that provided the Firm with control over the entity. The Firm consolidated credit-related note vehicles with collateral fair values of $163 million and $311 million, at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. These consolidated VIEs included some that were structured by the Firm where the Firm provides the credit derivative, and
 
some that have been structured by third parties where the Firm is not the credit derivative provider.
The Firm reports derivatives with unconsolidated CLN vehicles as well as any CLNs that it holds as market-maker on its Consolidated balance sheets at fair value with changes in fair value reported in principal transactions revenue. The Firm’s exposure to non-consolidated CLN VIEs as of December 31, 2014 and 2013 was not material.
Asset swap vehicles
The Firm structures transactions with asset swap vehicles on behalf of investors. In such transactions, the VIE purchases a specific asset or assets (substantially all of which are investment-grade) and then enters into a derivative with the Firm in order to tailor the interest rate or foreign exchange currency risk, or both, according to investors’ requirements. Investors typically invest in the notes issued by such VIEs in order to obtain exposure to the credit risk of the specific assets, as well as exposure to foreign exchange and interest rate risk that is tailored to their specific needs.
The Firm’s involvement with asset swap vehicles is generally limited to being an interest rate or foreign exchange derivative counterparty. The Firm does not provide any additional contractual financial support to the VIE over and above its contractual obligations as derivative counterparty, but may also make a market in the notes issued by such VIEs, although it is under no obligation to do so. The Firm has not historically provided any financial support to asset swap vehicles over and above its contractual obligations. As a derivative counterparty the assets held by the VIE serve as collateral for any derivatives receivables. As such the collateral represents the maximum exposure the Firm has to these vehicles, which was $5.7 billion and $7.7 billion as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The Firm’s maximum exposure arises through the derivatives executed with the VIEs; the exposure varies over time with changes in the fair value of the derivatives. The Firm relies on the collateral held by the VIEs to pay any amounts due under the derivatives; the vehicles are structured at inception so that the par value of the collateral is expected to be sufficient to pay amounts due under the derivative contracts
Since each asset swap vehicle is established to the specifications of the investors, the investors have the power over the activities of that VIE that most significantly affect the performance of the entity. Accordingly, the Firm does not generally consolidate these asset swap vehicles and did not consolidate any asset swap vehicles at December 31, 2014 and 2013.
The Firm reports derivatives with unconsolidated asset swap vehicles that it holds as market-maker on its Consolidated balance sheets at fair value with changes in fair value reported in principal transactions revenue. The Firm’s exposure to non-consolidated asset swap VIEs as of December 31, 2014 and 2013 was not material.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
267

Notes to consolidated financial statements

VIEs sponsored by third parties
The Firm enters into transactions with VIEs structured by other parties. These include, for example, acting as a derivative counterparty, liquidity provider, investor, underwriter, placement agent, trustee or custodian. These transactions are conducted at arm’s-length, and individual credit decisions are based on the analysis of the specific VIE, taking into consideration the quality of the underlying assets. Where the Firm does not have the power to direct
 
the activities of the VIE that most significantly impact the VIE’s economic performance, or a variable interest that could potentially be significant, the Firm records and reports these positions on its Consolidated balance sheets similarly to the way it would record and report positions in respect of any other third-party transaction.



Consolidated VIE assets and liabilities
The following table presents information on assets and liabilities related to VIEs consolidated by the Firm as of December 31, 2014 and 2013.
 
Assets
 
Liabilities
December 31, 2014 (in billions)(a)
Trading assets
Loans
Other(c)
Total
assets
(d)
 
Beneficial interests in
VIE assets
(e)
Other(f)
Total
liabilities
VIE program type
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Firm-sponsored credit card trusts
$

$
48.3

$
0.7

$
49.0

 
$
31.2

$

$
31.2

Firm-administered multi-seller conduits

17.7

0.1

17.8

 
12.0


12.0

Municipal bond vehicles
5.3



5.3

 
4.9


4.9

Mortgage securitization entities(b)
3.3

0.7


4.0

 
2.1

0.8

2.9

Student loan securitization entities
0.2

2.2


2.4

 
2.1


2.1

Other
0.3


1.0

1.3

 
0.1

0.1

0.2

Total
$
9.1

$
68.9

$
1.8

$
79.8

 
$
52.4

$
0.9

$
53.3

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Assets
 
Liabilities
December 31, 2013 (in billions)(a)
Trading assets
Loans
Other(c)
Total
assets
(d)
 
Beneficial interests in
VIE assets
(e)
Other(f)
Total
liabilities
VIE program type
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Firm-sponsored credit card trusts
$

$
46.9

$
1.1

$
48.0

 
$
26.6

$

$
26.6

Firm-administered multi-seller conduits

19.0

0.1

19.1

 
14.9


14.9

Municipal bond vehicles
3.4



3.4

 
2.9


2.9

Mortgage securitization entities(b)
2.3

1.7


4.0

 
2.9

0.9

3.8

Student loan securitization entities

2.4

0.1

2.5

 
2.2


2.2

Other
0.7

0.1

0.9

1.7

 
0.1

0.2

0.3

Total
$
6.4

$
70.1

$
2.2

$
78.7

 
$
49.6

$
1.1

$
50.7

(a)
Excludes intercompany transactions, which were eliminated in consolidation.
(b)
Includes residential and commercial mortgage securitizations as well as re-securitizations.
(c)
Includes assets classified as cash, derivative receivables, AFS securities, and other assets within the Consolidated balance sheets.
(d)
The assets of the consolidated VIEs included in the program types above are used to settle the liabilities of those entities. The difference between total assets and total liabilities recognized for consolidated VIEs represents the Firm’s interest in the consolidated VIEs for each program type.
(e)
The interest-bearing beneficial interest liabilities issued by consolidated VIEs are classified in the line item on the Consolidated balance sheets titled, “Beneficial interests issued by consolidated variable interest entities.” The holders of these beneficial interests do not have recourse to the general credit of JPMorgan Chase. Included in beneficial interests in VIE assets are long-term beneficial interests of $35.4 billion and $31.8 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The maturities of the long-term beneficial interests as of December 31, 2014, were as follows: $10.9 billion under one year, $19.0 billion between one and five years, and $5.5 billion over five years, all respectively.
(f)
Includes liabilities classified as accounts payable and other liabilities in the Consolidated balance sheets.

268
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Loan securitizations
The Firm has securitized and sold a variety of loans, including residential mortgage, credit card, automobile, student and commercial (primarily related to real estate) loans, as well as debt securities. The primary purposes of these securitization transactions were to satisfy investor demand and to generate liquidity for the Firm.
For loan securitizations in which the Firm is not required to consolidate the trust, the Firm records the transfer of the loan receivable to the trust as a sale when the accounting criteria for a sale are met. Those criteria are: (1) the transferred financial assets are legally isolated from the Firm’s creditors; (2) the transferee or beneficial interest
 
holder can pledge or exchange the transferred financial assets; and (3) the Firm does not maintain effective control over the transferred financial assets (e.g., the Firm cannot repurchase the transferred assets before their maturity and it does not have the ability to unilaterally cause the holder to return the transferred assets).
For loan securitizations accounted for as a sale, the Firm recognizes a gain or loss based on the difference between the value of proceeds received (including cash, beneficial interests, or servicing assets received) and the carrying value of the assets sold. Gains and losses on securitizations are reported in noninterest revenue.


Securitization activity
The following table provides information related to the Firm’s securitization activities for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, related to assets held in JPMorgan Chase-sponsored securitization entities that were not consolidated by the Firm, and where sale accounting was achieved based on the accounting rules in effect at the time of the securitization.
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Year ended December 31,
(in millions, except rates)(a)
Residential mortgage(d)(e)
Commercial and other(e)(f)
 
Residential mortgage(d)(e)
Commercial and other(e)(f)
 
Residential mortgage(d)(e)
Commercial and other(e)(f)
 
Principal securitized
$
2,558

$
11,911

 
$
1,404

$
11,318

 
$

$
5,421

 
All cash flows during the period:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from new securitizations(b)
$
2,569

$
12,079

 
$
1,410

$
11,507

 
$

$
5,705

 
Servicing fees collected
557

4

 
576

5

 
662

4

 
Purchases of previously transferred financial assets (or the underlying collateral)(c)
121


 
294


 
222


 
Cash flows received on interests
179

578

 
156

325

 
185

163

 
(a)
Excludes re-securitization transactions.
(b)
Proceeds from residential mortgage securitizations were received in the form of securities. During 2014, $2.4 billion of residential mortgage securitizations were received as securities and classified in level 2, and $185 million were in level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. During 2013, $1.4 billion of residential mortgage securitizations were received as securities and classified in level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Proceeds from commercial mortgage securitizations were received as securities and cash. During 2014, $11.4 billion of proceeds from commercial mortgage securitizations were received as securities and classified in level 2, and $130 million of proceeds were classified as level 3 of the fair value hierarchy; and $568 million of proceeds from commercial mortgage securitizations were received as cash. During 2013, $11.3 billion of commercial mortgage securitizations were classified in level 2 of the fair value hierarchy, and $207 million of proceeds from commercial mortgage securitizations were received as cash. During 2012, $5.7 billion of commercial mortgage securitizations were classified in level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.
(c)
Includes cash paid by the Firm to reacquire assets from off–balance sheet, nonconsolidated entities – for example, loan repurchases due to representation and warranties and servicer clean-up calls.
(d)
Includes prime, Alt-A, subprime, and option ARMs. Excludes certain loan securitization transactions entered into with Ginnie Mae, Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac.
(e)
Key assumptions used to measure residential mortgage retained interests originated during the year included weighted-average life (in years) of
5.9 and 3.9 for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, and weighted-average discount rate of 3.4% and 2.5% for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. There were no residential mortgage securitizations during 2012. Key assumptions used to measure commercial and other retained interests originated during the year included weighted-average life (in years) of 6.5, 8.3 and 8.8 for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, respectively, and weighted-average discount rate of 4.8%, 3.2% and 3.6% for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
(f) Includes commercial and student loan securitizations.


Loans and excess MSRs sold to the GSEs, loans in securitization transactions pursuant to Ginnie Mae guidelines, and other third-party-sponsored securitization entities
In addition to the amounts reported in the securitization activity tables above, the Firm, in the normal course of business, sells originated and purchased mortgage loans and certain originated excess MSRs on a nonrecourse basis, predominantly to Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac (the “GSEs”). These loans and excess MSRs are sold primarily for the purpose of securitization by the GSEs, who provide certain
 
guarantee provisions (e.g., credit enhancement of the loans). The Firm also sells loans into securitization transactions pursuant to Ginnie Mae guidelines; these loans are typically insured or guaranteed by another U.S. government agency. The Firm does not consolidate the securitization vehicles underlying these transactions as it is not the primary beneficiary. For a limited number of loan sales, the Firm is obligated to share a portion of the credit risk associated with the sold loans with the purchaser. See Note 29 for additional information about the Firm’s loan sales- and securitization-related indemnifications.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
269

Notes to consolidated financial statements

See Note 17 for additional information about the impact of the Firm’s sale of certain excess mortgage servicing rights.
The following table summarizes the activities related to loans sold to the GSEs, loans in securitization transactions pursuant to Ginnie Mae guidelines, and other third-party-sponsored securitization entities.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
2014
2013
2012
Carrying value of loans sold(a)
$
55,802

$
166,028

$
179,008

Proceeds received from loan sales as cash
$
260

$
782

$
195

Proceeds from loans sales as securities(b)
55,117

163,373

176,592

Total proceeds received from loan sales(c)
$
55,377

$
164,155

$
176,787

Gains on loan sales(d)
$
316

$
302

$
141

(a)
Predominantly to the GSEs and in securitization transactions pursuant to Ginnie Mae guidelines.
(b)
Predominantly includes securities from the GSEs and Ginnie Mae that are generally sold shortly after receipt.
(c)
Excludes the value of MSRs retained upon the sale of loans. Gains on loans sales include the value of MSRs.
(d)
The carrying value of the loans accounted for at fair value approximated the proceeds received upon loan sale.

 
Options to repurchase delinquent loans
In addition to the Firm’s obligation to repurchase certain loans due to material breaches of representations and warranties as discussed in Note 29, the Firm also has the option to repurchase delinquent loans that it services for Ginnie Mae loan pools, as well as for other U.S. government agencies under certain arrangements. The Firm typically elects to repurchase delinquent loans from Ginnie Mae loan pools as it continues to service them and/or manage the foreclosure process in accordance with the applicable requirements, and such loans continue to be insured or guaranteed. When the Firm’s repurchase option becomes exercisable, such loans must be reported on the Consolidated balance sheets as a loan with a corresponding liability. As of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm had recorded on its Consolidated balance sheets $12.4 billion and $14.3 billion, respectively, of loans that either had been repurchased or for which the Firm had an option to repurchase. Predominantly all of these amounts relate to loans that have been repurchased from Ginnie Mae loan pools. Additionally, real estate owned resulting from voluntary repurchases of loans was $464 million and $2.0 billion as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Substantially all of these loans and real estate owned are insured or guaranteed by U.S. government agencies. For additional information, refer to Note 14.


Loan delinquencies and liquidation losses
The table below includes information about components of nonconsolidated securitized financial assets, in which the Firm has continuing involvement, and delinquencies as of December 31, 2014 and 2013.
 
Securitized assets
 
90 days past due
 
Liquidation losses
As of or for the year ended December 31, (in millions)
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
 
2014
2013
Securitized loans(a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Residential mortgage:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Prime/ Alt-A & Option ARMs
$
78,294

$
90,381

 
$
11,363

$
14,882

 
$
2,166

$
4,688

Subprime mortgage
25,659

28,008

 
6,473

7,726

 
1,931

2,420

Commercial and other
94,438

98,018

 
1,522

2,350

 
1,267

1,003

Total loans securitized(b)
$
198,391

$
216,407

 
$
19,358

$
24,958

 
$
5,364

$
8,111

(a)
Total assets held in securitization-related SPEs were $254.3 billion and $271.7 billion, respectively, at December 31, 2014 and 2013. The $198.4 billion and $216.4 billion, respectively, of loans securitized at December 31, 2014 and 2013, excludes: $52.2 billion and $50.8 billion, respectively, of securitized loans in which the Firm has no continuing involvement, and $3.7 billion and $4.5 billion, respectively, of loan securitizations consolidated on the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets at December 31, 2014 and 2013.
(b)
Includes securitized loans that were previously recorded at fair value and classified as trading assets.

270
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Note 17 – Goodwill and other intangible assets
Goodwill
Goodwill is recorded upon completion of a business combination as the difference between the purchase price and the fair value of the net assets acquired. Subsequent to initial recognition, goodwill is not amortized but is tested for impairment during the fourth quarter of each fiscal year, or more often if events or circumstances, such as adverse changes in the business climate, indicate there may be impairment.
The goodwill associated with each business combination is allocated to the related reporting units, which are determined based on how the Firm’s businesses are managed and how they are reviewed by the Firm’s Operating Committee. The following table presents goodwill attributed to the business segments.
December 31, (in millions)
2014
2013
2012
Consumer & Community Banking
$
30,941

$
30,985

$
31,048

Corporate & Investment Bank
6,780

6,888

6,895

Commercial Banking
2,861

2,862

2,863

Asset Management
6,964

6,969

6,992

Corporate(a)
101

377

377

Total goodwill
$
47,647

$
48,081

$
48,175

(a)
The remaining $101 million of Private Equity goodwill was disposed of as part of the Private Equity sale completed in January 2015. For further information on the Private Equity sale, see Note 2.
The following table presents changes in the carrying amount of goodwill.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Balance at beginning of period
$
48,081

 
$
48,175

 
$
48,188

Changes during the period from:
 
 
 
 
 

Business combinations
43

 
64

 
43

Dispositions
(80
)
 
(5
)
 
(4
)
Other(a)
(397
)
 
(153
)
 
(52
)
Balance at December 31,
$
47,647

 
$
48,081

 
$
48,175

(a)
Includes foreign currency translation adjustments, other tax-related adjustments, and, during 2014, goodwill impairment associated with the Firm’s Private Equity business of $276 million.
Impairment testing
During 2014, the Firm recognized impairments of the Private Equity business’ goodwill totaling $276 million.
The Firm’s remaining goodwill was not impaired at December 31, 2014. Further, the Firm’s goodwill was not impaired at December 31, 2013 nor was any goodwill written off due to impairment during 2013 or 2012.
The goodwill impairment test is performed in two steps. In the first step, the current fair value of each reporting unit is compared with its carrying value, including goodwill. If the fair value is in excess of the carrying value (including goodwill), then the reporting unit’s goodwill is considered not to be impaired. If the fair value is less than the carrying value (including goodwill), then a second step is performed. In the second step, the implied current fair value of the reporting unit’s goodwill is determined by comparing the
 
fair value of the reporting unit (as determined in step one) to the fair value of the net assets of the reporting unit, as if the reporting unit were being acquired in a business combination. The resulting implied current fair value of goodwill is then compared with the carrying value of the reporting unit’s goodwill. If the carrying value of the goodwill exceeds its implied current fair value, then an impairment charge is recognized for the excess. If the carrying value of goodwill is less than its implied current fair value, then no goodwill impairment is recognized.
The Firm uses the reporting units’ allocated equity plus goodwill capital as a proxy for the carrying amounts of equity for the reporting units in the goodwill impairment testing. Reporting unit equity is determined on a similar basis as the allocation of equity to the Firm’s lines of business, which takes into consideration the capital the business segment would require if it were operating independently, incorporating sufficient capital to address regulatory capital requirements (including Basel III), economic risk measures and capital levels for similarly rated peers. Proposed line of business equity levels are incorporated into the Firm’s annual budget process, which is reviewed by the Firm’s Board of Directors. Allocated equity is further reviewed on a periodic basis and updated as needed.
The primary method the Firm uses to estimate the fair value of its reporting units is the income approach. The models project cash flows for the forecast period and use the perpetuity growth method to calculate terminal values. These cash flows and terminal values are then discounted using an appropriate discount rate. Projections of cash flows are based on the reporting units’ earnings forecasts, which include the estimated effects of regulatory and legislative changes (including, but not limited to the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”)), and which are reviewed with the senior management of the Firm. The discount rate used for each reporting unit represents an estimate of the cost of equity for that reporting unit and is determined considering the Firm’s overall estimated cost of equity (estimated using the Capital Asset Pricing Model), as adjusted for the risk characteristics specific to each reporting unit (for example, for higher levels of risk or uncertainty associated with the business or management’s forecasts and assumptions). To assess the reasonableness of the discount rates used for each reporting unit management compares the discount rate to the estimated cost of equity for publicly traded institutions with similar businesses and risk characteristics. In addition, the weighted average cost of equity (aggregating the various reporting units) is compared with the Firms’ overall estimated cost of equity to ensure reasonableness.
The valuations derived from the discounted cash flow models are then compared with market-based trading and transaction multiples for relevant competitors. Trading and transaction comparables are used as general indicators to assess the general reasonableness of the estimated fair


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
271

Notes to consolidated financial statements

values, although precise conclusions generally cannot be drawn due to the differences that naturally exist between the Firm’s businesses and competitor institutions. Management also takes into consideration a comparison between the aggregate fair value of the Firm’s reporting units and JPMorgan Chase’s market capitalization. In evaluating this comparison, management considers several factors, including (a) a control premium that would exist in a market transaction, (b) factors related to the level of execution risk that would exist at the firmwide level that do not exist at the reporting unit level and (c) short-term market volatility and other factors that do not directly affect the value of individual reporting units.
Deterioration in economic market conditions, increased estimates of the effects of regulatory or legislative changes, or additional regulatory or legislative changes may result in declines in projected business performance beyond management’s current expectations. For example, in the Firm’s Mortgage Banking business, such declines could result from increases in primary mortgage interest rates, lower mortgage origination volume, higher costs to resolve foreclosure-related matters or from deterioration in economic conditions, including decreases in home prices that result in increased credit losses. Declines in business performance, increases in equity capital requirements, or increases in the estimated cost of equity, could cause the estimated fair values of the Firm’s reporting units or their associated goodwill to decline in the future, which could result in a material impairment charge to earnings in a future period related to some portion of the associated goodwill.
 
Mortgage servicing rights
Mortgage servicing rights represent the fair value of expected future cash flows for performing servicing activities for others. The fair value considers estimated future servicing fees and ancillary revenue, offset by estimated costs to service the loans, and generally declines over time as net servicing cash flows are received, effectively amortizing the MSR asset against contractual servicing and ancillary fee income. MSRs are either purchased from third parties or recognized upon sale or securitization of mortgage loans if servicing is retained.
As permitted by U.S. GAAP, the Firm has elected to account for its MSRs at fair value. The Firm treats its MSRs as a single class of servicing assets based on the availability of market inputs used to measure the fair value of its MSR asset and its treatment of MSRs as one aggregate pool for risk management purposes. The Firm estimates the fair value of MSRs using an option-adjusted spread (“OAS”) model, which projects MSR cash flows over multiple interest rate scenarios in conjunction with the Firm’s prepayment model, and then discounts these cash flows at risk-adjusted rates. The model considers portfolio characteristics, contractually specified servicing fees, prepayment assumptions, delinquency rates, costs to service, late charges and other ancillary revenue, and other economic factors. The Firm compares fair value estimates and assumptions to observable market data where available, and also considers recent market activity and actual portfolio experience.


272
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The fair value of MSRs is sensitive to changes in interest rates, including their effect on prepayment speeds. MSRs typically decrease in value when interest rates decline because declining interest rates tend to increase prepayments and therefore reduce the expected life of the net servicing cash flows that comprise the MSR asset. Conversely, securities (e.g., mortgage-backed securities), principal-only certificates and certain derivatives (i.e.,
 
those for which the Firm receives fixed-rate interest payments) increase in value when interest rates decline. JPMorgan Chase uses combinations of derivatives and securities to manage changes in the fair value of MSRs. The intent is to offset any interest-rate related changes in the fair value of MSRs with changes in the fair value of the related risk management instruments.


The following table summarizes MSR activity for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012.
As of or for the year ended December 31, (in millions, except where otherwise noted)
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Fair value at beginning of period
$
9,614

 
$
7,614

 
$
7,223

MSR activity:
 
 
 
 
 
Originations of MSRs
757

 
2,214

 
2,376

Purchase of MSRs
11

 
1

 
457

Disposition of MSRs(a)
(209
)
 
(725
)
 
(579
)
Net additions
559

 
1,490

 
2,254

 
 
 
 
 
 
Changes due to collection/realization of expected cash flows(b)
(911
)
 
(1,102
)
 
(1,228
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Changes in valuation due to inputs and assumptions:
 
 
 
 
 
Changes due to market interest rates and other(c)
(1,608
)
 
2,122

 
(589
)
Changes in valuation due to other inputs and assumptions:
 
 
 
 
 
Projected cash flows (e.g., cost to service)(d)
133

 
109

 
(452
)
Discount rates
(459
)
(h) 
(78
)
 
(98
)
Prepayment model changes and other(e)
108

 
(541
)
 
504

Total changes in valuation due to other inputs and assumptions
(218
)
 
(510
)
 
(46
)
Total changes in valuation due to inputs and assumptions(b)
$
(1,826
)
 
$
1,612

 
$
(635
)
Fair value at December 31,(f)
$
7,436

 
$
9,614

 
$
7,614

Change in unrealized gains/(losses) included in income related to MSRs
held at December 31,
$
(1,826
)
 
$
1,612

 
$
(635
)
Contractual service fees, late fees and other ancillary fees included in income
$
2,884

 
$
3,309

 
$
3,783

Third-party mortgage loans serviced at December 31, (in billions)
$
756

 
$
822

 
$
867

Servicer advances, net of an allowance for uncollectible amounts, at December 31, (in billions)(g)
$
8.5

 
$
9.6

 
$
10.9

(a)
Predominantly represents excess mortgage servicing rights transferred to agency-sponsored trusts in exchange for stripped mortgage backed securities (“SMBS”). In each transaction, a portion of the SMBS was acquired by third parties at the transaction date; the Firm acquired and has retained the remaining balance of those SMBS as trading securities. Also includes sales of MSRs in 2013 and 2012.
(b)
Included changes related to commercial real estate of $(7) million, $(5) million and $(8) million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
(c)
Represents both the impact of changes in estimated future prepayments due to changes in market interest rates, and the difference between actual and expected prepayments.
(d)
For the year ended December 31, 2013, the increase was driven by the inclusion in the MSR valuation model of servicing fees receivable on certain delinquent loans.
(e)
Represents changes in prepayments other than those attributable to changes in market interest rates. For the year ended December 31, 2013, the decrease was driven by changes in the inputs and assumptions used to derive prepayment speeds, primarily increases in home prices.
(f)
Included $11 million, $18 million and $23 million related to commercial real estate at December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, respectively.
(g)
Represents amounts the Firm pays as the servicer (e.g., scheduled principal and interest to a trust, taxes and insurance), which will generally be reimbursed within a short period of time after the advance from future cash flows from the trust or the underlying loans. The Firm’s credit risk associated with these advances is minimal because reimbursement of the advances is typically senior to all cash payments to investors. In addition, the Firm maintains the right to stop payment to investors if the collateral is insufficient to cover the advance. However, certain of these servicer advances may not be recoverable if they were not made in accordance with applicable rules and agreements.
(h)
For the year ending December 31, 2014, the decrease was primarily related to higher capital allocated to the Mortgage Servicing business, which, in turn, resulted in an increase in the option adjusted spread (“OAS”). The resulting OAS assumption continues to be consistent with capital and return requirements that the Firm believes a market participant would consider, taking into account factors such as the current operating risk environment and regulatory and economic capital requirements.

JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
273

Notes to consolidated financial statements

The following table presents the components of mortgage fees and related income (including the impact of MSR risk management activities) for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
CCB mortgage fees and related income
 
 
 
 
 
Net production revenue:
 
 
 
 
 
Production revenue
$
732

 
$
2,673

 
$
5,783

Repurchase (losses)/benefits
458

 
331

 
(272
)
Net production revenue
1,190

 
3,004

 
5,511

Net mortgage servicing revenue
 
 
 
 
 

Operating revenue:
 
 
 
 
 

Loan servicing revenue
3,303

 
3,552

 
3,772

Changes in MSR asset fair value due to collection/realization of expected cash flows
(905
)
 
(1,094
)
 
(1,222
)
Total operating revenue
2,398

 
2,458

 
2,550

Risk management:
 
 
 
 
 

Changes in MSR asset fair value
  due to market interest rates and
  other(a)
(1,606
)
 
2,119

 
(587
)
Other changes in MSR asset fair value due to other inputs and assumptions in model(b)
(218
)
 
(511
)
 
(46
)
Change in derivative fair value and other
1,796

 
(1,875
)
 
1,252

Total risk management
(28
)
 
(267
)
 
619

Total CCB net mortgage servicing revenue
2,370

 
2,191

 
3,169

All other
3

 
10

 
7

Mortgage fees and related income
$
3,563

 
$
5,205

 
$
8,687

(a)
Represents both the impact of changes in estimated future prepayments due to changes in market interest rates, and the difference between actual and expected prepayments.
(b)
Represents the aggregate impact of changes in model inputs and assumptions such as projected cash flows (e.g., cost to service), discount rates and changes in prepayments other than those attributable to changes in market interest rates (e.g., changes in prepayments due to changes in home prices). For the year ended December 31, 2013, the decrease was driven by changes in the inputs and assumptions used to derive prepayment speeds, primarily increases in home prices.
 
The table below outlines the key economic assumptions used to determine the fair value of the Firm’s MSRs at December 31, 2014 and 2013, and outlines the sensitivities of those fair values to immediate adverse changes in those assumptions, as defined below.
December 31,
(in millions, except rates)
2014
 
2013
Weighted-average prepayment speed assumption (“CPR”)
9.80
%
 
8.07
%
Impact on fair value of 10% adverse change
$
(337
)
 
$
(362
)
Impact on fair value of 20% adverse change
(652
)
 
(705
)
Weighted-average option adjusted spread
9.43
%
 
7.77
%
Impact on fair value of 100 basis points adverse change
$
(300
)
 
$
(389
)
Impact on fair value of 200 basis points adverse change
(578
)
 
(750
)
CPR: Constant prepayment rate.
The sensitivity analysis in the preceding table is hypothetical and should be used with caution. Changes in fair value based on variation in assumptions generally cannot be easily extrapolated, because the relationship of the change in the assumptions to the change in fair value are often highly interrelated and may not be linear. In this table, the effect that a change in a particular assumption may have on the fair value is calculated without changing any other assumption. In reality, changes in one factor may result in changes in another, which would either magnify or counteract the impact of the initial change.
Other intangible assets
Other intangible assets are recorded at their fair value upon completion of a business combination or certain other transactions, and generally represent the value of customer relationships or arrangements. Subsequently, the Firm’s intangible assets with finite lives, including core deposit intangibles, purchased credit card relationships, and other intangible assets, are amortized over their useful lives in a manner that best reflects the economic benefits of the intangible asset. The $426 million decrease in other intangible assets during 2014 was predominantly due to $380 million in amortization.


274
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



The components of credit card relationships, core deposits and other intangible assets were as follows.
 
2014
 
2013
 
Gross amount(a)
Accumulated amortization(a)
Net
carrying value
Gross amount
Accumulated amortization
Net
carrying value
December 31, (in millions)
Purchased credit card relationships
$
200

$
166

$
34

 
$
3,540

$
3,409

$
131

Other credit card-related intangibles
497

378

$
119

 
542

369

$
173

Core deposit intangibles
814

757

$
57

 
4,133

3,974

$
159

Other intangibles(b)
1,880

898

$
982

 
2,374

1,219

$
1,155

Total other intangible assets
$
3,391

$
2,199

$
1,192

 
$
10,589

$
8,971

$
1,618

(a)
The decrease in the gross amount and accumulated amortization from December 31, 2013, was due to the removal of fully amortized assets, predominantly related to intangible assets acquired in the 2004 merger with Bank One Corporation (“Bank One”).
(b)
Includes intangible assets of approximately $600 million consisting primarily of asset management advisory contracts, which were determined to have an indefinite life and are not amortized.
Amortization expense
The following table presents amortization expense related to credit card relationships, core deposits and other intangible assets.
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Purchased credit card relationships
$
97

 
$
195

 
$
309

Other credit card-related intangibles
51

 
58

 
265

Core deposit intangibles
102

 
196

 
239

Other intangibles
130

 
188

 
144

Total amortization expense(a)
$
380

 
$
637

 
$
957

(a)
The decline in amortization expense during 2014 predominantly related to intangible assets acquired in the 2004 merger with Bank One, most of which became fully amortized during the second quarter of 2014.

Future amortization expense
The following table presents estimated future amortization expense related to credit card relationships, core deposits and other intangible assets at December 31, 2014.
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
Purchased credit card relationships
Other credit
card-related intangibles
Core deposit intangibles
Other
intangibles
Total
2015
$
13

$
38

$
26

$
89

$
166

2016
6

33

14

73

126

2017
5

28

7

70

110

2018
3

20

5

50

78

2019
2


3

37

42


Impairment testing
The Firm’s intangible assets are tested for impairment annually or more often if events or changes in circumstances indicate that the asset might be impaired.
The impairment test for a finite-lived intangible asset compares the undiscounted cash flows associated with the use or disposition of the intangible asset to its carrying value. If the sum of the undiscounted cash flows exceeds its carrying value, then no impairment charge is recorded. If the sum of the undiscounted cash flows is less than its carrying value, then an impairment charge is recognized in amortization expense to the extent the carrying amount of the asset exceeds its fair value.
 
The impairment test for indefinite-lived intangible assets compares the fair value of the intangible asset to its carrying amount. If the carrying value exceeds the fair value, then an impairment charge is recognized in amortization expense for the difference.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
275

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Note 18 – Premises and equipment
Premises and equipment, including leasehold improvements, are carried at cost less accumulated depreciation and amortization. JPMorgan Chase computes depreciation using the straight-line method over the estimated useful life of an asset. For leasehold improvements, the Firm uses the straight-line method computed over the lesser of the remaining term of the leased facility or the estimated useful life of the leased asset.
JPMorgan Chase capitalizes certain costs associated with the acquisition or development of internal-use software. Once the software is ready for its intended use, these costs are amortized on a straight-line basis over the software’s expected useful life and reviewed for impairment on an ongoing basis.
Note 19 – Deposits
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, noninterest-bearing and interest-bearing deposits were as follows.
December 31, (in millions)
2014

 
2013

U.S. offices
 
 
 
Noninterest-bearing
$
437,558

 
$
389,863

Interest-bearing
 
 
 
Demand(a) 
90,319

 
84,631

Savings(b)
466,730

 
450,405

Time (included $7,501 and $5,995 at fair value)(c) 
86,301

 
91,356

Total interest-bearing deposits
643,350

 
626,392

Total deposits in U.S. offices
1,080,908

 
1,016,255

Non-U.S. offices
 
 
 
Noninterest-bearing
19,078

 
17,611

Interest-bearing
 
 
 
Demand
217,011

 
214,391

Savings
2,673

 
1,083

Time (included $1,306 and $629 at fair value)(c) 
43,757

 
38,425

Total interest-bearing deposits
263,441

 
253,899

Total deposits in non-U.S. offices
282,519

 
271,510

Total deposits
$
1,363,427

 
$
1,287,765

(a)
Includes Negotiable Order of Withdrawal (“NOW”) accounts, and certain trust accounts.
(b)
Includes Money Market Deposit Accounts (“MMDAs”).
(c)
Includes structured notes classified as deposits for which the fair value option has been elected. For further discussion, see Note 4.
 
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, time deposits in denominations of $100,000 or more were as follows.
December 31, (in millions)
 
2014

 
2013

U.S. offices
 
$
71,630

 
$
74,804

Non-U.S. offices
 
43,743

 
38,412

Total
 
$
115,373

 
$
113,216

At December 31, 2014, the maturities of interest-bearing time deposits were as follows.
December 31, 2014
 
 

 
 

 
 

(in millions)
 
U.S.
 
Non-U.S.
 
Total
2015
 
$
70,929

 
$
43,031

 
$
113,960

2016
 
6,511

 
424

 
6,935

2017
 
1,480

 
61

 
1,541

2018
 
1,750

 
75

 
1,825

2019
 
1,423

 
166

 
1,589

After 5 years
 
4,208

 

 
4,208

Total
 
$
86,301

 
$
43,757

 
$
130,058

Note 20 – Accounts payable and other liabilities
Accounts payable and other liabilities consist of payables to customers; payables to brokers, dealers and clearing organizations; payables from security purchases that did not settle; income taxes payables; accrued expense, including interest-bearing liabilities; and all other liabilities, including litigation reserves and obligations to return securities received as collateral.
The following table details the components of accounts payable and other liabilities.
December 31, (in millions)
 
2014

 
2013

Brokerage payables(a)
 
$
134,467

 
$
116,391

Accounts payable and other liabilities(b)
 
72,487

 
78,100

Total
 
$
206,954

 
$
194,491

(a)
Includes payables to customers, brokers, dealers and clearing organizations, and payables from security purchases that did not settle.
(b)
Includes $36 million and $25 million accounted for at fair value at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.


276
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Note 21 – Long-term debt
JPMorgan Chase issues long-term debt denominated in various currencies, although predominantly U.S. dollars, with both fixed and variable interest rates. Included in senior and subordinated debt below are various equity-linked or other indexed instruments, which the Firm has elected to measure at fair value. Changes in fair value are recorded in principal transactions revenue in the Consolidated statements of income. The following table is a summary of long-term debt carrying values (including unamortized original issue discount, valuation adjustments and fair value adjustments, where applicable) by remaining contractual maturity as of December 31, 2014.
By remaining maturity at
December 31,
 
2014
 
2013

(in millions, except rates)
 
Under 1 year

 
1-5 years

 
After 5 years

 
Total

 
Total

Parent company
 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

Senior debt:
Fixed rate
$
13,214

 
$
46,275

 
$
49,300

 
$
108,789

 
$
101,074

 
Variable rate
7,196

 
28,482

 
6,572

 
42,250

 
41,030

 
Interest rates(a)
0.33-6.75%

 
0.27-7.25%

 
0.18-6.40%

 
0.18-7.25%

 
0.19-7.25%

Subordinated debt:
Fixed rate
$
2,581

 
$
2,373

 
$
11,763

 
$
16,717

 
$
15,198

 
Variable rate
1,446

 
2,000

 
9

 
3,455

 
4,566

 
Interest rates(a)
0.48-5.25%

 
1.06-8.53%

 
3.38-8.00%

 
0.48-8.53%

 
0.63-8.53%

 
Subtotal
$
24,437

 
$
79,130

 
$
67,644

 
$
171,211

 
$
161,868

Subsidiaries
 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Federal Home Loan Banks (“FHLB”) advances:
Fixed rate
$
2,006

 
$
32

 
$
166

 
$
2,204

 
$
3,236

 
Variable rate
7,800

 
53,490

 
1,500

 
62,790

 
58,640

 
Interest rates(a)
0.27-2.04%

 
0.11-0.43%

 
0.39
%
 
0.11-2.04%

 
0.16-2.04%

Senior debt:
Fixed rate
$
334

 
$
1,493

 
$
3,924

 
$
5,751

 
$
5,428

 
Variable rate
3,805

 
13,692

 
2,587

 
20,084

 
23,458

 
Interest rates(a)
0.36-0.48%

 
0.26-8.00%

 
1.30-7.28%

 
0.26-8.00%

 
0.12-8.00%

Subordinated debt:
Fixed rate
$

 
$
5,289

 
$
1,647

 
$
6,936

 
$
7,286

 
Variable rate

 
2,364

 

 
2,364

 
2,528

 
Interest rates(a)
%
 
0.57-6.00%

 
4.38-8.25%

 
0.57-8.25%

 
0.57-8.25%

 
Subtotal
$
13,945

 
$
76,360

 
$
9,824

 
$
100,129

 
$
100,576

Junior subordinated debt:
Fixed rate
$

 
$

 
$
2,226

 
$
2,226

 
$
2,176

 
Variable rate

 

 
3,270

 
3,270

 
3,269

 
Interest rates(a)
%
 
%
 
0.73-8.75%

 
0.73-8.75%

 
0.74-8.75%

 
Subtotal
$

 
$

 
$
5,496

 
$
5,496

 
$
5,445

Total long-term debt(b)(c)(d)
 
$
38,382

 
$
155,490

 
$
82,964

 
$
276,836

(f)(g) 
$
267,889

Long-term beneficial interests:
 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
Fixed rate
$
4,650

 
$
7,924

 
$
1,398

 
$
13,972

 
$
10,958

 
Variable rate
6,230

 
11,079

 
4,128

 
21,437

 
20,872

 
Interest rates
0.18-1.36%

 
0.20-5.23%

 
0.05-15.93%

 
0.05-15.93%

 
0.04-15.93%

Total long-term beneficial interests(e)
 
$
10,880

 
$
19,003

 
$
5,526

 
$
35,409

 
$
31,830

(a)
The interest rates shown are the range of contractual rates in effect at year-end, including non-U.S. dollar fixed- and variable-rate issuances, which excludes the effects of the associated derivative instruments used in hedge accounting relationships, if applicable. The use of these derivative instruments modifies the Firm’s exposure to the contractual interest rates disclosed in the table above. Including the effects of the hedge accounting derivatives, the range of modified rates in effect at December 31, 2014, for total long-term debt was (0.10)% to 8.55%, versus the contractual range of 0.11% to 8.75% presented in the table above. The interest rate ranges shown exclude structured notes accounted for at fair value.
(b)
Included long-term debt of $69.2 billion and $68.4 billion secured by assets totaling $156.7 billion and $131.3 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The amount of long-term debt secured by assets does not include amounts related to hybrid instruments.
(c)
Included $30.2 billion and $28.9 billion of long-term debt accounted for at fair value at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
(d)
Included $2.9 billion and $2.7 billion of outstanding zero-coupon notes at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The aggregate principal amount of these notes at their respective maturities is $7.5 billion and $4.5 billion, respectively.
(e)
Included on the Consolidated balance sheets in beneficial interests issued by consolidated VIEs. Also included $2.2 billion and $2.0 billion of outstanding structured notes accounted for at fair value at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Excluded short-term commercial paper and other short-term beneficial interests of $17.0 billion and $17.8 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
(f)
At December 31, 2014, long-term debt in the aggregate of $23.5 billion was redeemable at the option of JPMorgan Chase, in whole or in part, prior to maturity, based on the terms specified in the respective notes.
(g)
The aggregate carrying values of debt that matures in each of the five years subsequent to 2014 is $38.4 billion in 2015, $50.0 billion in 2016, $42.0 billion in 2017, $35.3 billion in 2018 and $28.2 billion in 2019.

JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
277

Notes to consolidated financial statements

The weighted-average contractual interest rates for total long-term debt excluding structured notes accounted for at fair value were 2.43% and 2.56% as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. In order to modify exposure to interest rate and currency exchange rate movements, JPMorgan Chase utilizes derivative instruments, primarily interest rate and cross-currency interest rate swaps, in conjunction with some of its debt issues. The use of these instruments modifies the Firm’s interest expense on the associated debt. The modified weighted-average interest rates for total long-term debt, including the effects of related derivative instruments, were 1.50% and 1.54% as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
The Parent Company has guaranteed certain long-term debt of its subsidiaries, including both long-term debt and structured notes sold as part of the Firm’s market-making activities. These guarantees rank on parity with all of the Firm’s other unsecured and unsubordinated indebtedness. Guaranteed liabilities were $352 million and $478 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
The Firm’s unsecured debt does not contain requirements that would call for an acceleration of payments, maturities or changes in the structure of the existing debt, provide any limitations on future borrowings or require additional collateral, based on unfavorable changes in the Firm’s credit ratings, financial ratios, earnings or stock price.
Junior subordinated deferrable interest debentures held by trusts that issued guaranteed capital debt securities
On May 8, 2013, the Firm redeemed approximately $5.0 billion, or 100% of the liquidation amount, of the following eight series of guaranteed capital debt securities (“trust preferred securities”): JPMorgan Chase Capital X, XI, XII, XIV, XVI, XIX and XXIV, and BANK ONE Capital VI. Other
 
income for the year ended December 31, 2013, reflected a modest loss related to the redemption of trust preferred securities. On July 12, 2012, the Firm redeemed $9.0 billion, or 100% of the liquidation amount, of the following nine series of trust preferred securities: JPMorgan Chase Capital XV, XVII, XVIII, XX, XXII, XXV, XXVI, XXVII and XXVIII. Other income for the year ended December 31, 2012, reflected $888 million of pretax extinguishment gains related to adjustments applied to the cost basis of the redeemed trust preferred securities during the period they were in a qualified hedge accounting relationship.
At December 31, 2014, the Firm had outstanding nine wholly owned Delaware statutory business trusts (“issuer trusts”) that had issued guaranteed capital debt securities.
The junior subordinated deferrable interest debentures issued by the Firm to the issuer trusts, totaling $5.5 billion and $5.4 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, were reflected on the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets in long-term debt, and in the table on the preceding page under the caption “Junior subordinated debt” (i.e., trust preferred securities). The Firm also records the common capital securities issued by the issuer trusts in other assets in its Consolidated balance sheets at December 31, 2014 and 2013. Beginning in 2014, the debentures issued to the issuer trusts by the Firm, less the common capital securities of the issuer trusts, began being phased out from inclusion as Tier 1 capital under Basel III. As of December 31, 2014, $2.7 billion of these debentures qualified as Tier 1 capital, while $2.7 billion qualified as Tier 2 capital. As of December 31, 2013, under Basel I, the entire balance of these debentures qualified as Tier 1 capital.


The following is a summary of the outstanding trust preferred securities, including unamortized original issue discount, issued by each trust, and the junior subordinated deferrable interest debenture issued to each trust, as of December 31, 2014.
December 31, 2014
(in millions)
 
Amount of trust preferred securities issued by trust(a)
 
Principal amount of debenture issued to trust(b)
 
Issue date
 
Stated maturity of trust preferred securities and debentures
 
Earliest redemption date
 
Interest rate of trust preferred securities and debentures
 
Interest payment/distribution dates
Bank One Capital III
 
$
474

 
$
726

 
2000
 
2030
 
Any time
 
8.75%
 
Semiannually
Chase Capital II
 
482

 
498

 
1997
 
2027
 
Any time
 
LIBOR + 0.50%
 
Quarterly
Chase Capital III
 
296

 
305

 
1997
 
2027
 
Any time
 
LIBOR + 0.55%
 
Quarterly
Chase Capital VI
 
242

 
249

 
1998
 
2028
 
Any time
 
LIBOR + 0.625%
 
Quarterly
First Chicago NBD Capital I
 
249

 
257

 
1997
 
2027
 
Any time
 
LIBOR + 0.55%
 
Quarterly
JPMorgan Chase Capital XIII
 
466

 
480

 
2004
 
2034
 
Any time
 
LIBOR + 0.95%
 
Quarterly
JPMorgan Chase Capital XXI
 
836

 
838

 
2007
 
2037
 
Any time
 
LIBOR + 0.95%
 
Quarterly
JPMorgan Chase Capital XXIII
 
643

 
643

 
2007
 
2047
 
Any time
 
LIBOR + 1.00%
 
Quarterly
JPMorgan Chase Capital XXIX
 
1,500

 
1,500

 
2010
 
2040
 
2015
 
6.70%
 
Quarterly
Total
 
$
5,188

 
$
5,496

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(a)
Represents the amount of trust preferred securities issued to the public by each trust, including unamortized original-issue discount.
(b)
Represents the principal amount of JPMorgan Chase debentures issued to each trust, including unamortized original-issue discount. The principal amount of debentures issued to the trusts includes the impact of hedging and purchase accounting fair value adjustments that were recorded on the Firm’s Consolidated Financial Statements.

278
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Note 22 – Preferred stock
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, JPMorgan Chase was authorized to issue 200 million shares of preferred stock, in one or more series, with a par value of $1.00 per share.

 

In the event of a liquidation or dissolution of the Firm, JPMorgan Chase’s preferred stock then outstanding takes precedence over the Firm’s common stock for the payment of dividends and the distribution of assets.

The following is a summary of JPMorgan Chase’s non-cumulative preferred stock outstanding as of December 31, 2014 and 2013.
 
 
Shares at December 31, (represented by
depositary shares)
(a)
 
Carrying value
(in millions)
at December 31,
 
Issue date
Contractual rate
in effect at
December 31,
2014
Earliest redemption date
Date at which dividend rate becomes floating
Floating annual
rate of
three-month LIBOR plus:
 
 
 
2014
2013
2014
2013
 
Fixed-rate:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Series O
125,750

125,750

 
$
1,258

$
1,258

 
8/27/2012
5.500
%
9/1/2017
NA
NA
 
 
Series P
90,000

90,000

 
900

900

 
2/5/2013
5.450

3/1/2018
NA
NA
 
 
Series T
92,500


 
925


 
1/30/2014
6.700

3/1/2019
NA
NA
 
 
Series W
88,000


 
880


 
6/23/2014
6.300

9/1/2019
NA
NA
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed-to-floating rate:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Series I
600,000

600,000

 
6,000

6,000

 
4/23/2008
7.900
%
4/30/2018
4/30/2018
LIBOR + 3.47
%
 
Series Q
150,000

150,000

 
1,500

1,500

 
4/23/2013
5.150

5/1/2023
5/1/2023
LIBOR + 3.25
 
 
Series R
150,000

150,000

 
1,500

1,500

 
7/29/2013
6.000

8/1/2023
8/1/2023
LIBOR + 3.30
 
 
Series S
200,000


 
2,000


 
1/22/2014
6.750

2/1/2024
2/1/2024
LIBOR + 3.78
 
 
Series U
100,000


 
1,000


 
3/10/2014
6.125

4/30/2024
4/30/2024
LIBOR + 3.33
 
 
Series V
250,000


 
2,500


 
6/9/2014
5.000

7/1/2019
7/1/2019
LIBOR + 3.32
 
 
Series X
160,000


 
1,600


 
9/23/2014
6.100

10/1/2024
10/1/2024
LIBOR + 3.33
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total preferred stock
2,006,250

1,115,750

 
$
20,063

$
11,158

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(a)
Represented by depositary shares.
Each series of preferred stock has a liquidation value and redemption price per share of $10,000, plus any accrued but unpaid dividends.
Dividends on fixed-rate preferred stock are payable quarterly. Dividends on fixed-to-floating rate preferred stock are payable semiannually while at a fixed rate, and will become payable quarterly after converting to a floating rate.
On September 1, 2013, the Firm redeemed all of the outstanding shares of its 8.625% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series J at their stated redemption value.
Redemption rights
Each series of the Firm’s preferred stock may be redeemed on any dividend payment date on or after the earliest redemption date for that series. All outstanding preferred stock series except Series I may also be redeemed following a capital treatment event, as described in the terms of each series. Any redemption of the Firm’s preferred stock is subject to non-objection from the Federal Reserve.
Subsequent events
Issuance of preferred stock
On February 12, 2015, the Firm issued $1.4 billion of noncumulative preferred stock.

 
Note 23 – Common stock
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, JPMorgan Chase was authorized to issue 9.0 billion shares of common stock with a par value of $1 per share.
Common shares issued (newly issued or distributed from treasury) by JPMorgan Chase during the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 were as follows.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
2014

2013

2012

Total issued – balance at January 1 and December 31
4,104.9

4,104.9

4,104.9

Treasury – balance at January 1
(348.8
)
(300.9
)
(332.2
)
Purchase of treasury stock
(82.3
)
(96.1
)
(33.5
)
Share repurchases related to employee stock-based awards(a)


(0.2
)
Issued from treasury:
 
 
 
Employee benefits and compensation plans
39.8

47.1

63.7

Employee stock purchase plans
1.2

1.1

1.3

Total issued from treasury
41.0

48.2

65.0

Total treasury – balance at December 31
(390.1
)
(348.8
)
(300.9
)
Outstanding
3,714.8

3,756.1

3,804.0

(a)
Participants in the Firm’s stock-based incentive plans may have shares withheld to cover income taxes.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
279

Notes to consolidated financial statements

At each of December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012, respectively, the Firm had 59.8 million warrants outstanding to purchase shares of common stock (the “Warrants”). The Warrants are currently traded on the New York Stock Exchange, and they are exercisable, in whole or in part, at any time and from time to time until October 28, 2018. The original warrant exercise price was $42.42 per share. The number of shares issuable upon the exercise of each warrant and the warrant exercise price is subject to adjustment upon the occurrence of certain events, including, but not limited to, the extent regular quarterly cash dividends exceed $0.38 per share. As a result of the increase in the Firm’s quarterly common stock dividend to $0.40 per share commencing with the second quarter of 2014, the exercise price of the Warrants was adjusted each subsequent quarter, and was $42.391 as of December 31, 2014. There has been no change in the number of shares issuable upon exercise.
On March 13, 2012, the Board of Directors authorized a $15.0 billion common equity (i.e., common stock and warrants) repurchase program. As of December 31, 2014, $3.8 billion (on a trade-date basis) of authorized repurchase capacity remained under the program. The amount of equity that may be repurchased by the Firm is also subject to the amount that is set forth in the Firm’s annual capital plan that is submitted to the Federal Reserve as part of the Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review (“CCAR”) process.
The following table sets forth the Firm’s repurchases of common equity for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, on a trade-date basis. There were no warrants repurchased during the years ended December 31, 2014, and 2013.
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Total number of shares of common stock repurchased
 
83.4

 
96.1

 
30.9

Aggregate purchase price of common stock repurchases
 
$
4,834

 
$
4,789

 
$
1,329

Total number of Warrants repurchased
 

 

 
18.5

Aggregate purchase price of Warrant repurchases
 
$

 
$

 
$
238

The Firm may, from time to time, enter into written trading plans under Rule 10b5-1 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 to facilitate repurchases in accordance with the common equity repurchase program. A Rule 10b5-1 repurchase plan allows the Firm to repurchase its equity during periods when it would not otherwise be repurchasing common equity — for example, during internal trading “blackout periods.” All purchases under a Rule 10b5-1 plan must be made according to a predefined plan established when the Firm is not aware of material nonpublic information. For additional information regarding repurchases of the Firm’s equity securities, see Part II, Item 5: Market for registrant’s common equity, related stockholder matters and issuer purchases of equity securities, on pages 18–19.
 
As of December 31, 2014, approximately 240 million unissued shares of common stock were reserved for issuance under various employee incentive, compensation, option and stock purchase plans, director compensation plans, and the Warrants, as discussed above.
Note 24 – Earnings per share
Earnings per share (“EPS”) is calculated under the two-class method under which all earnings (distributed and undistributed) are allocated to each class of common stock and participating securities based on their respective rights to receive dividends. JPMorgan Chase grants restricted stock and RSUs to certain employees under its stock-based compensation programs, which entitle recipients to receive nonforfeitable dividends during the vesting period on a basis equivalent to the dividends paid to holders of common stock; these unvested awards meet the definition of participating securities. Options issued under employee benefit plans that have an antidilutive effect are excluded from the computation of diluted EPS.
The following table presents the calculation of basic and diluted EPS for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions,
except per share amounts)
2014
2013
2012
Basic earnings per share
 
 
 
Net income
$
21,762

$
17,923

$
21,284

Less: Preferred stock dividends
1,125

805

653

Net income applicable to common equity
20,637

17,118

20,631

Less: Dividends and undistributed earnings allocated to participating securities
544

525

754

Net income applicable to common stockholders
$
20,093

$
16,593

$
19,877

 
 
 
 
Total weighted-average basic shares outstanding
3,763.5

3,782.4

3,809.4

Net income per share
$
5.34

$
4.39

$
5.22

 
 
 
 
Diluted earnings per share
 
 
 
Net income applicable to common stockholders
$
20,093

$
16,593

$
19,877

Total weighted-average basic shares outstanding
3,763.5

3,782.4

3,809.4

Add: Employee stock options, SARs and warrants(a)
34.0

32.5

12.8

Total weighted-average diluted shares outstanding(b)
3,797.5

3,814.9

3,822.2

Net income per share
$
5.29

$
4.35

$
5.20

(a)
Excluded from the computation of diluted EPS (due to the antidilutive effect) were certain options issued under employee benefit plans and the Warrants. The aggregate number of shares issuable upon the exercise of such options and Warrants was 1 million, 6 million and 148 million for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
(b)
Participating securities were included in the calculation of diluted EPS using the two-class method, as this computation was more dilutive than the calculation using the treasury stock method.


280
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Note 25 – Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss)
AOCI includes the after-tax change in unrealized gains and losses on investment securities, foreign currency translation adjustments (including the impact of related derivatives), cash flow hedging activities, and net loss and prior service costs/(credit) related to the Firm’s defined benefit pension and OPEB plans.
Year ended December 31,
Unrealized gains/(losses) on investment securities(a)
 
Translation adjustments, net of hedges
 
Cash flow hedges
 
Defined benefit pension and OPEB plans
 
Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss)
(in millions)
Balance at December 31, 2011
 
$
3,565

(b) 
 
 
$
(26
)
 
 
 
$
51

 
 
 
$
(2,646
)
 
 
 
$
944

 
Net change
 
3,303

 
 
 
(69
)
 
 
 
69

 
 
 
(145
)
 
 
 
3,158

 
Balance at December 31, 2012
 
$
6,868

(b) 
 
 
$
(95
)
 
 
 
$
120

 
 
 
$
(2,791
)
 
 
 
$
4,102

 
Net change
 
(4,070
)
 
 
 
(41
)
 
 
 
(259
)
 
 
 
1,467

 
 
 
(2,903
)
 
Balance at December 31, 2013
 
$
2,798

(b) 
 
 
$
(136
)
 
 
 
$
(139
)
 
 
 
$
(1,324
)
 
 
 
$
1,199

 
Net change
 
1,975

 
 
 
(11
)
 
 
 
44

 
 
 
(1,018
)
 
 
 
990

 
Balance at December 31, 2014
 
$
4,773

(b) 
 
 
$
(147
)
 
 
 
$
(95
)
 
 
 
$
(2,342
)
 
 
 
$
2,189

 
(a)
Represents the after-tax difference between the fair value and amortized cost of securities accounted for as AFS including, as of the date of transfer during the first quarter of 2014, $9 million of net unrealized losses related to AFS securities that were transferred to HTM. Subsequent to transfer, includes any net unamortized unrealized gains and losses related to the transferred securities.
(b)
At December 31, 2011, included after-tax non-credit related unrealized losses of $56 million on debt securities for which credit losses have been recognized in income. There were no such losses for the other periods presented.

The following table presents the before- and after-tax changes in the components of other comprehensive income/(loss).
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
Pretax
 
Tax effect
 
After-tax
 
Pretax
 
Tax effect
 
After-tax
 
Pretax
 
Tax effect
 
After-tax
Unrealized gains/(losses) on investment securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net unrealized gains/(losses) arising during the period
$
3,193

 
$
(1,170
)
 
$
2,023

 
$
(5,987
)
 
$
2,323

 
$
(3,664
)
 
$
7,521

 
$
(2,930
)
 
$
4,591

Reclassification adjustment for realized (gains)/losses included in net income(a)
(77
)
 
29

 
(48
)
 
(667
)
 
261

 
(406
)
 
(2,110
)
 
822

 
(1,288
)
Net change
3,116

 
(1,141
)
 
1,975

 
(6,654
)
 
2,584

 
(4,070
)
 
5,411

 
(2,108
)
 
3,303

Translation adjustments:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Translation(b)
(1,638
)
 
588

 
(1,050
)
 
(807
)
 
295

 
(512
)
 
(26
)
 
8

 
(18
)
Hedges(b)
1,698

 
(659
)
 
1,039

 
773

 
(302
)
 
471

 
(82
)
 
31

 
(51
)
Net change
60

 
(71
)
 
(11
)
 
(34
)
 
(7
)
 
(41
)
 
(108
)
 
39

 
(69
)
Cash flow hedges:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net unrealized gains/(losses) arising during the period
98

 
(39
)
 
59

 
(525
)
 
206

 
(319
)
 
141

 
(55
)
 
86

Reclassification adjustment for realized (gains)/losses included in net income(c)
(24
)
 
9

 
(15
)
 
101

 
(41
)
 
60

 
(28
)
 
11

 
(17
)
Net change
74

 
(30
)
 
44

 
(424
)
 
165

 
(259
)
 
113

 
(44
)
 
69

Defined benefit pension and OPEB plans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Prior service credits arising during the period
(53
)
 
21

 
(32
)
 

 

 

 
6

 
(2
)
 
4

Net gains/(losses) arising during the period
(1,697
)
 
688

 
(1,009
)
 
2,055

 
(750
)
 
1,305

 
(537
)
 
228

 
(309
)
Reclassification adjustments included in
net income(d):


 


 


 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Amortization of net loss
72

 
(29
)
 
43

 
321

 
(124
)
 
197

 
324

 
(126
)
 
198

Prior service costs/(credits)
(44
)
 
17

 
(27
)
 
(43
)
 
17

 
(26
)
 
(41
)
 
16

 
(25
)
Foreign exchange and other
39

 
(32
)
 
7

 
(14
)
 
5

 
(9
)
 
(21
)
 
8

 
(13
)
Net change
(1,683
)
 
665

 
(1,018
)
 
2,319

 
(852
)
 
1,467

 
(269
)
 
124

 
(145
)
Total other comprehensive income/(loss)
$
1,567

 
$
(577
)
 
$
990

 
$
(4,793
)
 
$
1,890

 
$
(2,903
)
 
$
5,147

 
$
(1,989
)
 
$
3,158

(a)
The pretax amount is reported in securities gains in the Consolidated statements of income.
(b)
Reclassifications of pretax realized gains/(losses) on translation adjustments and related hedges are reported in other income/expense in the Consolidated statements of income. The amounts were not material for the periods presented.
(c)
The pretax amount is reported in the same line as the hedged items, which are predominantly recorded in net interest income in the Consolidated statements of income.
(d)
The pretax amount is reported in compensation expense in the Consolidated statements of income.

JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
281

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Note 26 – Income taxes
JPMorgan Chase and its eligible subsidiaries file a consolidated U.S. federal income tax return. JPMorgan Chase uses the asset and liability method to provide income taxes on all transactions recorded in the Consolidated Financial Statements. This method requires that income taxes reflect the expected future tax consequences of temporary differences between the carrying amounts of assets or liabilities for book and tax purposes. Accordingly, a deferred tax asset or liability for each temporary difference is determined based on the tax rates that the Firm expects to be in effect when the underlying items of income and expense are realized. JPMorgan Chase’s expense for income taxes includes the current and deferred portions of that expense. A valuation allowance is established to reduce deferred tax assets to the amount the Firm expects to realize.
Due to the inherent complexities arising from the nature of the Firm’s businesses, and from conducting business and being taxed in a substantial number of jurisdictions, significant judgments and estimates are required to be made. Agreement of tax liabilities between JPMorgan Chase and the many tax jurisdictions in which the Firm files tax returns may not be finalized for several years. Thus, the Firm’s final tax-related assets and liabilities may ultimately be different from those currently reported.
A reconciliation of the applicable statutory U.S. income tax rate to the effective tax rate for each of the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, is presented in the following table.
Effective tax rate
Year ended December 31,
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Statutory U.S. federal tax rate
 
35.0
 %
 
35.0
 %
 
35.0
 %
Increase/(decrease) in tax rate resulting from:
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. state and local income taxes, net of U.S. federal income tax benefit
 
2.7

 
2.2

 
1.6

Tax-exempt income
 
(3.1
)
 
(3.1
)
 
(2.9
)
Non-U.S. subsidiary earnings(a)
 
(2.0
)
 
(4.9
)
 
(2.4
)
Business tax credits
 
(5.4
)
 
(5.4
)
 
(4.2
)
Nondeductible legal expense
 
2.4

 
8.0

 
(0.2
)
Other, net
 
(2.6
)
 
(1.0
)
 
(0.5
)
Effective tax rate
 
27.0
 %
 
30.8
 %
 
26.4
 %
(a)
Predominantly includes earnings of U.K. subsidiaries that are deemed to be reinvested indefinitely.
 
The components of income tax expense/(benefit) included in the Consolidated statements of income were as follows for each of the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013, and 2012.
Income tax expense/(benefit)
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Current income tax expense/(benefit)
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. federal
 
$
1,610

 
$
(1,316
)
 
$
3,225

Non-U.S.
 
1,353

 
1,308

 
1,782

U.S. state and local
 
857

 
(4
)
 
1,496

Total current income tax expense/(benefit)
 
3,820

 
(12
)
 
6,503

Deferred income tax expense/(benefit)
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. federal
 
3,738

 
7,080

 
2,238

Non-U.S.
 
71

 
10

 
(327
)
U.S. state and local
 
401

 
913

 
(781
)
Total deferred income tax expense/(benefit)
 
4,210

 
8,003

 
1,130

Total income tax expense
 
$
8,030

 
$
7,991

 
$
7,633

Total income tax expense includes $451 million, $531 million and $200 million of tax benefits recorded in 2014, 2013, and 2012, respectively, as a result of tax audit resolutions. In 2013, the relationship between current and deferred income tax expense was largely driven by the reversal of significant deferred tax assets as well as prior-year tax adjustments and audit resolutions.
The preceding table does not reflect the tax effect of certain items that are recorded each period directly in stockholders’ equity and certain tax benefits associated with the Firm’s employee stock-based compensation plans. The tax effect of all items recorded directly to stockholders’ equity resulted in a decrease of $140 million in 2014, an increase of $2.1 billion in 2013, and a decrease of $1.9 billion in 2012.
U.S. federal income taxes have not been provided on the undistributed earnings of certain non-U.S. subsidiaries, to the extent that such earnings have been reinvested abroad for an indefinite period of time. Based on JPMorgan Chase’s ongoing review of the business requirements and capital needs of its non-U.S. subsidiaries, combined with the formation of specific strategies and steps taken to fulfill these requirements and needs, the Firm has determined that the undistributed earnings of certain of its subsidiaries would be indefinitely reinvested to fund current and future growth of the related businesses. As management does not intend to use the earnings of these subsidiaries as a source of funding for its U.S. operations, such earnings will not be distributed to the U.S. in the foreseeable future. For 2014, pretax earnings of $2.6 billion were generated and will be indefinitely reinvested in these subsidiaries. At December 31, 2014, the cumulative amount of undistributed pretax earnings in these subsidiaries were $31.1 billion. If the Firm were to record a deferred tax liability associated with these undistributed earnings, the amount would be $7.0 billion at December 31, 2014.


282
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



These undistributed earnings are related to subsidiaries located predominantly in the U.K. where the 2014 statutory tax rate was 21.5%.
Tax expense applicable to securities gains and losses for the years 2014, 2013 and 2012 was $30 million, $261 million, and $822 million, respectively.
Deferred income tax expense/(benefit) results from differences between assets and liabilities measured for financial reporting purposes versus income tax return purposes. Deferred tax assets are recognized if, in management’s judgment, their realizability is determined to be more likely than not. If a deferred tax asset is determined to be unrealizable, a valuation allowance is established. The significant components of deferred tax assets and liabilities are reflected in the following table as of December 31, 2014 and 2013.
Deferred taxes
 
 
 
 
December 31, (in millions)
 
2014

 
2013

Deferred tax assets
 
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses
 
$
5,756

 
$
6,593

Employee benefits
 
3,378

 
4,468

Accrued expenses and other
 
8,637

 
9,179

Non-U.S. operations
 
5,106

 
5,493

Tax attribute carryforwards
 
570

 
748

Gross deferred tax assets
 
23,447

 
26,481

Valuation allowance
 
(820
)
 
(724
)
Deferred tax assets, net of valuation allowance
 
$
22,627

 
$
25,757

Deferred tax liabilities
 
 
 
 
Depreciation and amortization
 
$
3,073

 
$
3,196

Mortgage servicing rights, net of hedges
 
5,533

 
5,882

Leasing transactions
 
2,495

 
2,352

Non-U.S. operations
 
4,444

 
4,705

Other, net
 
4,891

 
3,459

Gross deferred tax liabilities
 
20,436

 
19,594

Net deferred tax assets
 
$
2,191

 
$
6,163

JPMorgan Chase has recorded deferred tax assets of $570 million at December 31, 2014, in connection with U.S. federal net operating loss (“NOL”) carryforwards. At December 31, 2014, total U.S. federal NOL carryforwards were approximately $1.6 billion. If not utilized, the U.S. federal NOL carryforwards will expire between 2025 and 2034.
The valuation allowance at December 31, 2014, was due to losses associated with non-U.S. subsidiaries.

 
At December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, JPMorgan Chase’s unrecognized tax benefits, excluding related interest expense and penalties, were $4.9 billion, $5.5 billion and $7.2 billion, respectively, of which $3.5 billion, $3.7 billion and $4.2 billion, respectively, if recognized, would reduce the annual effective tax rate. Included in the amount of unrecognized tax benefits are certain items that would not affect the effective tax rate if they were recognized in the Consolidated statements of income. These unrecognized items include the tax effect of certain temporary differences, the portion of gross state and local unrecognized tax benefits that would be offset by the benefit from associated U.S. federal income tax deductions, and the portion of gross non-U.S. unrecognized tax benefits that would have offsets in other jurisdictions. JPMorgan Chase is presently under audit by a number of taxing authorities, most notably by the Internal Revenue Service, New York State and City, and the State of California as summarized in the Tax examination status table below. Based upon the status of all of the tax examinations currently in process, it is reasonably possible that over the next 12 months the resolution of these examinations could result in a reduction in the gross balance of unrecognized tax benefits in the range of $0 to approximately $2 billion. Upon settlement of an audit, the gross unrecognized tax benefits would decline either because of tax payments or the recognition of tax benefits.
The following table presents a reconciliation of the beginning and ending amount of unrecognized tax benefits for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012.
Unrecognized tax benefits
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Balance at January 1,
 
$
5,535

 
$
7,158

 
$
7,189

Increases based on tax positions related to the current period
 
810

 
542

 
680

Increases based on tax positions related to prior periods
 
477

 
88

 
234

Decreases based on tax positions related to prior periods
 
(1,902
)
 
(2,200
)
 
(853
)
Decreases related to settlements with taxing authorities
 
(9
)
 
(53
)
 
(50
)
Decreases related to a lapse of applicable statute of limitations
 

 

 
(42
)
Balance at December 31,
 
$
4,911

 
$
5,535

 
$
7,158

After-tax interest expense/(benefit) and penalties related to income tax liabilities recognized in income tax expense were $17 million, $(184) million and $147 million in 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
At both December 31, 2014 and 2013, in addition to the liability for unrecognized tax benefits, the Firm had accrued $1.2 billion for income tax-related interest and penalties.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
283

Notes to consolidated financial statements

JPMorgan Chase is continually under examination by the Internal Revenue Service, by taxing authorities throughout the world, and by many states throughout the U.S. The following table summarizes the status of significant income tax examinations of JPMorgan Chase and its consolidated subsidiaries as of December 31, 2014.
Tax examination status
December 31, 2014
 
Periods under examination
 
Status
JPMorgan Chase – U.S.
 
2003 - 2005
 
Field examination completed; at Appellate level
JPMorgan Chase – U.S.
 
2006 - 2010
 
Field examination
JPMorgan Chase – U.K.
 
2006 – 2012
 
Field examination of certain select entities
JPMorgan Chase – New York State and City
 
2005 – 2007
 
Field examination
JPMorgan Chase – California
 
2006 – 2010
 
Field examination
The following table presents the U.S. and non-U.S. components of income before income tax expense for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012.
Income before income tax expense - U.S. and non-U.S.
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

U.S.
 
$
22,515

 
$
17,229

 
$
24,895

Non-U.S.(a)
 
7,277

 
8,685

 
4,022

Income before income tax expense
 
$
29,792

 
$
25,914

 
$
28,917

(a)
For purposes of this table, non-U.S. income is defined as income generated from operations located outside the U.S.

 
Note 27 – Restrictions on cash and intercompany funds transfers
The business of JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association (“JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.”) is subject to examination and regulation by the OCC. The Bank is a member of the U.S. Federal Reserve System, and its deposits in the U.S. are insured by the FDIC.
The Federal Reserve requires depository institutions to maintain cash reserves with a Federal Reserve Bank. The average amount of reserve balances deposited by the Firm’s bank subsidiaries with various Federal Reserve Banks was approximately $10.6 billion and $5.3 billion in 2014 and 2013, respectively.
Restrictions imposed by U.S. federal law prohibit JPMorgan Chase and certain of its affiliates from borrowing from banking subsidiaries unless the loans are secured in specified amounts. Such secured loans to the Firm or to other affiliates are generally limited to 10% of the banking subsidiary’s total capital, as determined by the risk-based capital guidelines; the aggregate amount of all such loans is limited to 20% of the banking subsidiary’s total capital.
The principal sources of JPMorgan Chase’s income (on a parent company-only basis) are dividends and interest from JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., and the other banking and nonbanking subsidiaries of JPMorgan Chase. In addition to dividend restrictions set forth in statutes and regulations, the Federal Reserve, the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (“OCC”) and the FDIC have authority under the Financial Institutions Supervisory Act to prohibit or to limit the payment of dividends by the banking organizations they supervise, including JPMorgan Chase and its subsidiaries that are banks or bank holding companies, if, in the banking regulator’s opinion, payment of a dividend would constitute an unsafe or unsound practice in light of the financial condition of the banking organization.
At January 1, 2015, JPMorgan Chase’s banking subsidiaries could pay, in the aggregate, approximately $31 billion in dividends to their respective bank holding companies without the prior approval of their relevant banking regulators. The capacity to pay dividends in 2015 will be supplemented by the banking subsidiaries’ earnings during the year.
In compliance with rules and regulations established by U.S. and non-U.S. regulators, as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, cash in the amount of $16.8 billion and $17.2 billion, respectively, and securities with a fair value of $10.1 billion and $1.5 billion, respectively, were segregated in special bank accounts for the benefit of securities and futures brokerage customers. In addition, as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm had other restricted cash of $3.3 billion and $3.9 billion, respectively, primarily representing cash reserves held at non-U.S. central banks and held for other general purposes.


284
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Note 28 – Regulatory capital
The Federal Reserve establishes capital requirements, including well-capitalized standards, for the consolidated financial holding company. The OCC establishes similar capital requirements and standards for the Firm’s national banks, including JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and Chase Bank USA, N.A.
Basel III rules under the transitional Standardized and Advanced Approaches (“Basel III Standardized Transitional” and “Basel III Advanced Transitional,” respectively) became effective on January 1, 2014; December 31, 2013 data is based on Basel I rules. Basel III establishes two comprehensive methodologies for calculating RWA (a Standardized approach and an Advanced approach) which include capital requirements for credit risk, market risk, and in the case of Basel III Advanced, also operational risk. Key differences in the calculation of credit risk RWA between the Standardized and Advanced approaches are that for Basel III Advanced, credit risk RWA is based on risk-sensitive approaches which largely rely on the use of internal credit models and parameters, whereas for Basel III Standardized, credit risk RWA is generally based on supervisory risk-weightings which vary primarily by counterparty type and asset class. Market risk RWA is calculated mostly consistent across Basel III Standardized and Basel III Advanced, both of which incorporate the requirements set forth in Basel 2.5. For 2014, Basel III Standardized Transitional requires the Firm to calculate its capital ratios using the Basel III definition of capital divided by the Basel I definition of RWA, inclusive of Basel 2.5 for market risk.
Beginning in 2014, there are three categories of risk-based capital under the Basel III Transitional rules: Common Equity Tier 1 capital (“CET1 capital”), as well as Tier 1 capital and Tier 2 capital. CET1 capital predominantly includes common stockholders’ equity (including capital for AOCI related to debt and equity securities classified as AFS as well as for defined benefit pension and OPEB plans), less certain deductions for goodwill, MSRs and deferred tax assets that arise from NOL and tax credit carryforwards. Tier 1 capital is predominantly comprised of CET1 capital as well as perpetual preferred stock. Tier 2 capital includes long-term debt qualifying as Tier 2 and qualifying allowance for credit losses. Total capital is Tier 1 capital plus Tier 2 capital.
On February 21, 2014, the Federal Reserve and the OCC informed the Firm and its national bank subsidiaries that they had satisfactorily completed the parallel run requirements and were approved to calculate capital under Basel III Advanced, in addition to Basel III Standardized, as of April 1, 2014. In conjunction with its exit from the parallel run, the capital adequacy of the Firm and its national bank subsidiaries is evaluated against the Basel III approach (Standardized or Advanced) which results, for each quarter beginning with the second quarter of 2014, in the lower ratio (the “Collins Floor”), as required by the Collins Amendment of the Dodd-Frank Act.
 
The following tables present the regulatory capital, assets and risk-based capital ratios for JPMorgan Chase and its significant national bank subsidiaries under both Basel III Standardized Transitional and Basel III Advanced Transitional at December 31, 2014, and under Basel I at December 31, 2013.
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co.(d)
 
Basel III Standardized Transitional
 
Basel III Advanced Transitional
 
Basel I
(in millions,
except ratios)
Dec 31,
2014
 
Dec 31,
2014
 
Dec 31,
2013
Regulatory capital
 
 
 
 
 
CET1 capital
$
164,764

 
$
164,764

 
NA
Tier 1 capital(a)
186,632

 
186,632

 
$
165,663

Total capital
221,563

 
211,022

 
199,286

 
 
 
 
 
 
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
Risk-weighted
1,472,602

 
1,608,240

 
1,387,863

Adjusted average(b)
2,465,414

 
2,465,414

 
2,343,713

 
 
 
 
 
 
Capital ratios(c)
 
 
 
 
 
CET1
11.2
%
 
10.2
%
 
NA
Tier 1(a)
12.7

 
11.6

 
11.9
%
Total
15.0

 
13.1

 
14.4

Tier 1 leverage
7.6

 
7.6

 
7.1

 
JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.(d)
 
Basel III Standardized Transitional
 
Basel III Advanced Transitional
 
Basel I
(in millions,
except ratios)
Dec 31,
2014
 
Dec 31,
2014
 
Dec 31,
2013
Regulatory capital
 
 
 
 
 
CET1 capital
$
156,898

 
$
156,898

 
NA
Tier 1 capital(a)
157,222

 
157,222

 
$
139,727

Total capital
173,659

 
166,662

 
165,496

 
 
 
 
 
 
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
Risk-weighted
1,230,358

 
1,330,175

 
1,171,574

Adjusted average(b)
1,968,131

 
1,968,131

 
1,900,770

 
 
 
 
 
 
Capital ratios(c)
 
 
 
 
 
CET1
12.8
%
 
11.8
%
 
NA
Tier 1(a)
12.8

 
11.8

 
11.9
%
Total
14.1

 
12.5

 
14.1

Tier 1 leverage
8.0

 
8.0

 
7.4



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
285

Notes to consolidated financial statements

 
Chase Bank USA, N.A.(d)
 
Basel III Standardized Transitional
 
Basel III Advanced Transitional
 
Basel I
(in millions,
except ratios)
Dec 31,
2014
 
Dec 31,
2014
 
Dec 31,
2013
Regulatory capital
 
 
 
 
 
CET1 capital
$
14,556

 
$
14,556

 
NA
Tier 1 capital(a)
14,556

 
14,556

 
$
12,956

Total capital
20,517

 
19,206

 
16,389

 
 
 
 
 
 
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
Risk-weighted
103,468

 
157,565

 
100,990

Adjusted average(b)
128,111

 
128,111

 
109,731

 
 
 
 
 
 
Capital ratios(c)
 
 
 
 
 
CET1
14.1
%
 
9.2
%
 
NA
Tier 1(a)
14.1

 
9.2

 
12.8
%
Total
19.8

 
12.2

 
16.2

Tier 1 leverage
11.4

 
11.4

 
11.8

(a)
At December 31, 2014, trust preferred securities included in Basel III Tier 1 capital were $2.7 billion and $300 million for JPMorgan Chase and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., respectively. At December 31, 2014, Chase Bank USA, N.A. had no trust preferred securities.
(b)
Adjusted average assets, for purposes of calculating the leverage ratio, includes total quarterly average assets adjusted for unrealized gains/(losses) on securities, less deductions for disallowed goodwill and other intangible assets, investments in certain subsidiaries, and the total adjusted carrying value of nonfinancial equity investments that are subject to deductions from Tier 1 capital.
(c)
For each of the risk-based capital ratios the lower of the Standardized Transitional or Advanced Transitional ratio represents the Collins Floor.
(d)
Asset and capital amounts for JPMorgan Chase’s banking subsidiaries reflect intercompany transactions; whereas the respective amounts for JPMorgan Chase reflect the elimination of intercompany transactions.
Note:
Rating agencies allow measures of capital to be adjusted upward for deferred tax liabilities, which have resulted from both non-taxable business combinations and from tax-deductible goodwill. The Firm had deferred tax liabilities resulting from non-taxable business combinations totaling $130 million and $192 million at December 31, 2014, and December 31, 2013, respectively; and deferred tax liabilities resulting from tax-deductible goodwill of $2.7 billion and $2.8 billion at December 31, 2014, and December 31, 2013, respectively.


 
Under the risk-based capital guidelines of the Federal Reserve, JPMorgan Chase is required to maintain minimum ratios of Tier 1 and Total capital to risk-weighted assets,
as well as minimum leverage ratios (which are defined as Tier 1 capital divided by adjusted quarterly average assets). Failure to meet these minimum requirements could cause the Federal Reserve to take action. Bank subsidiaries also are subject to these capital requirements by their respective primary regulators. The following table presents the minimum ratios to which the Firm and its national bank subsidiaries are subject as of December 31, 2014.
 
Minimum capital ratios(a)
 
Well-capitalized ratios(a)
 
Capital ratios
 
 
 
 
CET1
4.0
%
 
NA

 
Tier 1
5.5

 
6.0
%
 
Total
8.0

 
10.0

 
Tier 1 leverage
4.0

 
5.0

(b) 
(a)
As defined by the regulations issued by the Federal Reserve, OCC and FDIC. The CET1 capital ratio became a relevant measure of capital under the prompt corrective action requirements on January 1, 2015.
(b)
Represents requirements for bank subsidiaries pursuant to regulations issued under the FDIC Improvement Act. There is no Tier 1 leverage component in the definition of a well-capitalized bank holding company.

As of December 31, 2014, and 2013, JPMorgan Chase and all of its banking subsidiaries were well-capitalized and met all capital requirements to which each was subject.



286
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Note 29 – Off–balance sheet lending-related financial instruments, guarantees, and other commitments
JPMorgan Chase provides lending-related financial instruments (e.g., commitments and guarantees) to meet the financing needs of its customers. The contractual amount of these financial instruments represents the maximum possible credit risk to the Firm should the counterparty draw upon the commitment or the Firm be required to fulfill its obligation under the guarantee, and should the counterparty subsequently fail to perform according to the terms of the contract. Most of these commitments and guarantees expire without being drawn or a default occurring. As a result, the total contractual amount of these instruments is not, in the Firm’s view, representative of its actual future credit exposure or funding requirements.
To provide for probable credit losses inherent in consumer (excluding credit card) and wholesale lending commitments, an allowance for credit losses on lending-related
 
commitments is maintained. See Note 15 for further discussion regarding the allowance for credit losses on lending-related commitments. The following table summarizes the contractual amounts and carrying values of off-balance sheet lending-related financial instruments, guarantees and other commitments at December 31, 2014 and 2013. The amounts in the table below for credit card and home equity lending-related commitments represent the total available credit for these products. The Firm has not experienced, and does not anticipate, that all available lines of credit for these products will be utilized at the same time. The Firm can reduce or cancel credit card lines of credit by providing the borrower notice or, in some cases as permitted by law, without notice. The Firm may reduce or close home equity lines of credit when there are significant decreases in the value of the underlying property, or when there has been a demonstrable decline in the creditworthiness of the borrower. Also, the Firm typically closes credit card lines when the borrower is 60 days or more past due.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
287

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Off–balance sheet lending-related financial instruments, guarantees and other commitments
 
 
Contractual amount
 
Carrying value(i)
 
2014
 
2013
 
2014
2013
By remaining maturity at December 31,
(in millions)
Expires in 1 year or less
Expires after
1 year through
3 years
Expires after
3 years through
5 years
Expires after 5 years
Total
 
Total
 
 
 
Lending-related
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer, excluding credit card:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Home equity – senior lien
$
2,166

$
4,389

$
1,841

$
3,411

$
11,807

 
$
13,158

 
$

$

Home equity – junior lien
3,469

5,920

2,141

3,329

14,859

 
17,837

 


Prime mortgage(a)
8,579




8,579

 
4,817

 


Subprime mortgage





 

 


Auto
9,302

921

192

47

10,462

 
8,309

 
2

1

Business banking
10,557

807

117

413

11,894

 
11,251

 
11

7

Student and other
97

8


447

552

 
685

 


Total consumer, excluding credit card
34,170

12,045

4,291

7,647

58,153

 
56,057

 
13

8

Credit card
525,963




525,963

 
529,383

 


Total consumer(b)
560,133

12,045

4,291

7,647

584,116

 
585,440

 
13

8

Wholesale:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other unfunded commitments to extend credit(c)(d)
68,688

83,877

112,992

7,119

272,676

 
246,495

 
374

432

Standby letters of credit and other financial guarantees(c)(d)(e)
22,584

29,753

34,982

2,555

89,874

 
92,723

 
788

943

Unused advised lines of credit
90,816

13,702

519

138

105,175

 
101,994

 


Other letters of credit(c)
3,363

877

91


4,331

 
5,020

 
1

2

Total wholesale(f)
185,451

128,209

148,584

9,812

472,056

 
446,232

 
1,163

1,377

Total lending-related
$
745,584

$
140,254

$
152,875

$
17,459

$
1,056,172

 
$
1,031,672

 
$
1,176

$
1,385

Other guarantees and commitments
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities lending indemnification agreements and guarantees(g)
$
171,059

$

$

$

$
171,059

 
$
169,709

 
$

$

Derivatives qualifying as guarantees
3,009

167

12,313

38,100

53,589

 
56,274

 
80

72

Unsettled reverse repurchase and securities borrowing agreements
40,993




40,993

 
38,211

 


Loan sale and securitization-related indemnifications:










 
 
 


Mortgage repurchase liability
 NA

 NA

 NA

 NA

NA

 
NA

 
275

681

Loans sold with recourse
 NA

 NA

 NA

 NA

6,063

 
7,692

 
102

131

Other guarantees and commitments(h)
487

506

3,391

1,336

5,720

 
6,786

 
(121
)
(99
)
(a)
Includes certain commitments to purchase loans from correspondents.
(b)
Predominantly all consumer lending-related commitments are in the U.S.
(c)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, reflects the contractual amount net of risk participations totaling $243 million and $476 million, respectively, for other unfunded commitments to extend credit; $13.0 billion and $14.8 billion, respectively, for standby letters of credit and other financial guarantees; and $469 million and $622 million, respectively, for other letters of credit. In regulatory filings with the Federal Reserve these commitments are shown gross of risk participations.
(d)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, included credit enhancements and bond and commercial paper liquidity commitments to U.S. states and municipalities, hospitals and other non-profit entities of $14.8 billion and $18.9 billion, respectively, within other unfunded commitments to extend credit; and $13.3 billion and $17.2 billion, respectively, within standby letters of credit and other financial guarantees. Other unfunded commitments to extend credit also include liquidity facilities to nonconsolidated municipal bond VIEs; see Note 16.
(e)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, included unissued standby letters of credit commitments of $45.6 billion and $42.8 billion, respectively.
(f)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the U.S. portion of the contractual amount of total wholesale lending-related commitments was 65% and 68%, respectively.
(g)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, collateral held by the Firm in support of securities lending indemnification agreements was $177.1 billion and $176.4 billion, respectively. Securities lending collateral comprises primarily cash and securities issued by governments that are members of the Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development (“OECD”) and U.S. government agencies.
(h)
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, included unfunded commitments of $147 million and $215 million, respectively, to third-party private equity funds; and $961 million and $1.9 billion, respectively, to other equity investments. These commitments included $150 million and $184 million, respectively, related to investments that are generally fair valued at net asset value as discussed in Note 3. In addition, at both December 31, 2014 and 2013, included letters of credit hedged by derivative transactions and managed on a market risk basis of $4.5 billion.
(i)
For lending-related products, the carrying value represents the allowance for lending-related commitments and the guarantee liability; for derivative-related products, the carrying value represents the fair value.

288
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Other unfunded commitments to extend credit
Other unfunded commitments to extend credit generally comprise commitments for working capital and general corporate purposes, extensions of credit to support commercial paper facilities and bond financings in the event that those obligations cannot be remarketed to new investors, as well as committed liquidity facilities to clearing organizations.
Also included in other unfunded commitments to extend credit are commitments to noninvestment-grade counterparties in connection with leveraged finance activities, which were $23.7 billion and $18.3 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. For further information, see Note 3 and Note 4.
The Firm acts as a settlement and custody bank in the U.S. tri-party repurchase transaction market. In its role as settlement and custody bank, the Firm is exposed to the intra-day credit risk of its cash borrower clients, usually broker-dealers. This exposure is secured by collateral and typically extinguished by the end of the day. During 2014, the Firm extended secured clearance advance facilities to its clients (i.e. cash borrowers); these facilities contractually limit the Firm’s intra-day credit risk to the facility amount and must be repaid by the end of the day. Through these facilities, the Firm has reduced its intra-day credit risk substantially; the average daily tri-party repo balance was $253 billion during the year ended December 31, 2013, and as of December 31, 2014, the secured clearance advance facility maximum outstanding commitment amount was $12.6 billion.
Guarantees
U.S. GAAP requires that a guarantor recognize, at the inception of a guarantee, a liability in an amount equal to the fair value of the obligation undertaken in issuing the guarantee. U.S. GAAP defines a guarantee as a contract that contingently requires the guarantor to pay a guaranteed party based upon: (a) changes in an underlying asset, liability or equity security of the guaranteed party; or (b) a third party’s failure to perform under a specified agreement. The Firm considers the following off–balance sheet lending-related arrangements to be guarantees under U.S. GAAP: standby letters of credit and financial guarantees, securities lending indemnifications, certain indemnification agreements included within third-party contractual arrangements and certain derivative contracts.
 
As required by U.S. GAAP, the Firm initially records guarantees at the inception date fair value of the obligation assumed (e.g., the amount of consideration received or the net present value of the premium receivable). For certain types of guarantees, the Firm records this fair value amount in other liabilities with an offsetting entry recorded in cash (for premiums received), or other assets (for premiums receivable). Any premium receivable recorded in other assets is reduced as cash is received under the contract, and the fair value of the liability recorded at inception is amortized into income as lending and deposit-related fees over the life of the guarantee contract. For indemnifications provided in sales agreements, a portion of the sale proceeds is allocated to the guarantee, which adjusts the gain or loss that would otherwise result from the transaction. For these indemnifications, the initial liability is amortized to income as the Firm’s risk is reduced (i.e., over time or when the indemnification expires). Any contingent liability that exists as a result of issuing the guarantee or indemnification is recognized when it becomes probable and reasonably estimable. The contingent portion of the liability is not recognized if the estimated amount is less than the carrying amount of the liability recognized at inception (adjusted for any amortization). The recorded amounts of the liabilities related to guarantees and indemnifications at December 31, 2014 and 2013, excluding the allowance for credit losses on lending-related commitments, are discussed below.
Standby letters of credit and other financial guarantees
Standby letters of credit (“SBLC”) and other financial guarantees are conditional lending commitments issued by the Firm to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party under certain arrangements, such as commercial paper facilities, bond financings, acquisition financings, trade and similar transactions. The carrying values of standby and other letters of credit were $789 million and $945 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, which were classified in accounts payable and other liabilities on the Consolidated balance sheets; these carrying values included $235 million and $265 million, respectively, for the allowance for lending-related commitments, and $554 million and $680 million, respectively, for the guarantee liability and corresponding asset.



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
289

Notes to consolidated financial statements

The following table summarizes the types of facilities under which standby letters of credit and other letters of credit arrangements are outstanding by the ratings profiles of the Firm’s customers, as of December 31, 2014 and 2013.
Standby letters of credit, other financial guarantees and other letters of credit
 
2014
 
2013
December 31,
(in millions)
Standby letters of
credit and other financial guarantees
Other letters
of credit
 
Standby letters of
credit and other financial guarantees
Other letters
of credit
Investment-grade(a)
 
$
66,856

 
$
3,476

 
 
$
69,109

 
$
3,939

Noninvestment-grade(a)
 
23,018

 
855

 
 
23,614

 
1,081

Total contractual amount
 
$
89,874

 
$
4,331

 
 
$
92,723

 
$
5,020

Allowance for lending-related commitments
 
$
234

 
$
1

 
 
$
263

 
$
2

Commitments with collateral
 
39,726

 
1,509

 
 
40,410

 
1,473

(a)
The ratings scale is based on the Firm’s internal ratings, which generally correspond to ratings as defined by S&P and Moody’s.
Advised lines of credit
An advised line of credit is a revolving credit line which specifies the maximum amount the Firm may make available to an obligor, on a nonbinding basis. The borrower receives written or oral advice of this facility. The Firm may cancel this facility at any time by providing the borrower notice or, in some cases, without notice as permitted by law.
Securities lending indemnifications
Through the Firm’s securities lending program, customers’ securities, via custodial and non-custodial arrangements, may be lent to third parties. As part of this program, the Firm provides an indemnification in the lending agreements which protects the lender against the failure of the borrower to return the lent securities. To minimize its liability under these indemnification agreements, the Firm obtains cash or other highly liquid collateral with a market value exceeding 100% of the value of the securities on loan from the borrower. Collateral is marked to market daily to help assure that collateralization is adequate. Additional collateral is called from the borrower if a shortfall exists, or collateral may be released to the borrower in the event of overcollateralization. If a borrower defaults, the Firm would use the collateral held to purchase replacement securities in the market or to credit the lending customer with the cash equivalent thereof.
Derivatives qualifying as guarantees
In addition to the contracts described above, the Firm transacts certain derivative contracts that have the characteristics of a guarantee under U.S. GAAP. These contracts include written put options that require the Firm to purchase assets upon exercise by the option holder at a specified price by a specified date in the future. The Firm may enter into written put option contracts in order to meet client needs, or for other trading purposes. The terms of written put options are typically five years or less. Derivatives deemed to be guarantees also include contracts such as stable value derivatives that require the Firm to make a payment of the difference between the market value and the book value of a counterparty’s reference portfolio of assets in the event that market value is less than book value and certain other conditions have been met. Stable value derivatives, commonly referred to as
 
“stable value wraps”, are transacted in order to allow investors to realize investment returns with less volatility than an unprotected portfolio and are typically longer-term or may have no stated maturity, but allow the Firm to terminate the contract under certain conditions.
Derivatives deemed to be guarantees are recorded on the Consolidated balance sheets at fair value in trading assets and trading liabilities. The total notional value of the derivatives that the Firm deems to be guarantees was $53.6 billion and $56.3 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The notional amount generally represents the Firm’s maximum exposure to derivatives qualifying as guarantees. However, exposure to certain stable value contracts is contractually limited to a substantially lower percentage of the notional amount; the notional amount on these stable value contracts was $27.5 billion and $27.0 billion at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, and the maximum exposure to loss was $2.9 billion and $2.8 billion at both December 31, 2014 and 2013. The fair values of the contracts reflect the probability of whether the Firm will be required to perform under the contract. The fair value of derivatives that the Firm deems to be guarantees were derivative payables of $102 million and $109 million and derivative receivables of $22 million and $37 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The Firm reduces exposures to these contracts by entering into offsetting transactions, or by entering into contracts that hedge the market risk related to the derivative guarantees.
In addition to derivative contracts that meet the characteristics of a guarantee, the Firm is both a purchaser and seller of credit protection in the credit derivatives market. For a further discussion of credit derivatives, see Note 6.
Unsettled reverse repurchase and securities borrowing agreements
In the normal course of business, the Firm enters into reverse repurchase agreements and securities borrowing agreements that settle at a future date. At settlement, these commitments require that the Firm advance cash to and accept securities from the counterparty. These agreements generally do not meet the definition of a derivative, and


290
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



therefore, are not recorded on the Consolidated balance sheets until settlement date. The unsettled reverse repurchase agreements and securities borrowing agreements predominantly consist of agreements with regular-way settlement periods.
Loan sales- and securitization-related indemnifications
Mortgage repurchase liability
In connection with the Firm’s mortgage loan sale and securitization activities with the GSEs, as described in Note 16, the Firm has made representations and warranties that the loans sold meet certain requirements. The Firm has been, and may be, required to repurchase loans and/or indemnify the GSEs (e.g., with “make-whole” payments to reimburse the GSEs for their realized losses on liquidated loans). To the extent that repurchase demands that are received relate to loans that the Firm purchased from third parties that remain viable, the Firm typically will have the right to seek a recovery of related repurchase losses from the third party. Generally, the maximum amount of future payments the Firm would be required to make for breaches of these representations and warranties would be equal to the unpaid principal balance of such loans that are deemed to have defects that were sold to purchasers (including securitization-related SPEs) plus, in certain circumstances, accrued interest on such loans and certain expense.
The following table summarizes the change in the mortgage repurchase liability for each of the periods presented.
Summary of changes in mortgage repurchase liability(a)
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
 
Repurchase liability at beginning of period
$
681

 
$
2,811

 
$
3,557

 
Net realized gains/(losses)(b)
53

 
(1,561
)
 
(1,158
)
 
Reclassification to litigation reserve

 
(179
)
 

 
(Benefit)/provision for repurchase(c)
(459
)
 
(390
)
 
412

 
Repurchase liability at end of period
$
275

 
$
681

 
$
2,811

 
(a)
On October 25, 2013, the Firm announced that it had reached a $1.1 billion agreement with the FHFA to resolve, other than certain limited types of exposures, outstanding and future mortgage repurchase demands associated with loans sold to the GSEs from 2000 to 2008.
(b)
Presented net of third-party recoveries and included principal losses and accrued interest on repurchased loans, “make-whole” settlements, settlements with claimants, and certain related expense. Make-whole settlements were $11 million, $414 million and $524 million, for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.
(c)
Included a provision related to new loan sales of $4 million, $20 million and $112 million, for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

 
Private label securitizations
The liability related to repurchase demands associated with private label securitizations is separately evaluated by the Firm in establishing its litigation reserves.
On November 15, 2013, the Firm announced that it had reached a $4.5 billion agreement with 21 major institutional investors to make a binding offer to the trustees of 330 residential mortgage-backed securities trusts issued by J.P.Morgan, Chase, and Bear Stearns (“RMBS Trust Settlement”) to resolve all representation and warranty claims, as well as all servicing claims, on all trusts issued by J.P. Morgan, Chase, and Bear Stearns between 2005 and 2008. The seven trustees (or separate and successor trustees) for this group of 330 trusts have accepted the RMBS Trust Settlement for 319 trusts in whole or in part and excluded from the settlement 16 trusts in whole or in part. The trustees’ acceptance is subject to a judicial approval proceeding initiated by the trustees, which is pending in New York state court.
In addition, from 2005 to 2008, Washington Mutual made certain loan level representations and warranties in connection with approximately $165 billion of residential mortgage loans that were originally sold or deposited into private-label securitizations by Washington Mutual. Of the $165 billion, approximately $78 billion has been repaid. In addition, approximately $49 billion of the principal amount of such loans has liquidated with an average loss severity of 59%. Accordingly, the remaining outstanding principal balance of these loans as of December 31, 2014, was approximately $38 billion, of which $8 billion was 60 days or more past due. The Firm believes that any repurchase obligations related to these loans remain with the FDIC receivership.
For additional information regarding litigation, see Note 31.
Loans sold with recourse
The Firm provides servicing for mortgages and certain commercial lending products on both a recourse and nonrecourse basis. In nonrecourse servicing, the principal credit risk to the Firm is the cost of temporary servicing advances of funds (i.e., normal servicing advances). In recourse servicing, the servicer agrees to share credit risk with the owner of the mortgage loans, such as Fannie Mae or Freddie Mac or a private investor, insurer or guarantor. Losses on recourse servicing predominantly occur when foreclosure sales proceeds of the property underlying a defaulted loan are less than the sum of the outstanding principal balance, plus accrued interest on the loan and the cost of holding and disposing of the underlying property. The Firm’s securitizations are predominantly nonrecourse, thereby effectively transferring the risk of future credit losses to the purchaser of the mortgage-backed securities issued by the trust. At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the unpaid principal balance of loans sold with recourse totaled $6.1 billion and $7.7 billion, respectively. The carrying value of the related liability that the Firm has recorded, which is representative of the Firm’s view of the likelihood it


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
291

Notes to consolidated financial statements

will have to perform under its recourse obligations, was $102 million and $131 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
Other off-balance sheet arrangements
Indemnification agreements – general
In connection with issuing securities to investors, the Firm may enter into contractual arrangements with third parties that require the Firm to make a payment to them in the event of a change in tax law or an adverse interpretation of tax law. In certain cases, the contract also may include a termination clause, which would allow the Firm to settle the contract at its fair value in lieu of making a payment under the indemnification clause. The Firm may also enter into indemnification clauses in connection with the licensing of software to clients (“software licensees”) or when it sells a business or assets to a third party (“third-party purchasers”), pursuant to which it indemnifies software licensees for claims of liability or damages that may occur subsequent to the licensing of the software, or third-party purchasers for losses they may incur due to actions taken by the Firm prior to the sale of the business or assets. It is difficult to estimate the Firm’s maximum exposure under these indemnification arrangements, since this would require an assessment of future changes in tax law and future claims that may be made against the Firm that have not yet occurred. However, based on historical experience, management expects the risk of loss to be remote.
Credit card charge-backs
Chase Paymentech Solutions, Card’s merchant services business and a subsidiary of JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., is a global leader in payment processing and merchant acquiring.
Under the rules of Visa USA, Inc., and MasterCard International, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., is primarily liable for the amount of each processed credit card sales transaction that is the subject of a dispute between a cardmember and a merchant. If a dispute is resolved in the cardmember’s favor, Chase Paymentech will (through the cardmember’s issuing bank) credit or refund the amount to the cardmember and will charge back the transaction to the merchant. If Chase Paymentech is unable to collect the amount from the merchant, Chase Paymentech will bear the loss for the amount credited or refunded to the cardmember. Chase Paymentech mitigates this risk by withholding future settlements, retaining cash reserve accounts or by obtaining other security. However, in the unlikely event that: (1) a merchant ceases operations and is unable to deliver products, services or a refund; (2) Chase Paymentech does not have sufficient collateral from the merchant to provide customer refunds; and (3) Chase Paymentech does not have sufficient financial resources to provide customer refunds, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., would recognize the loss.
 
Chase Paymentech incurred aggregate losses of $10 million, $14 million, and $16 million on $847.9 billion, $750.1 billion, and $655.2 billion of aggregate volume processed for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Incurred losses from merchant charge-backs are charged to other expense, with the offset recorded in a valuation allowance against accrued interest and accounts receivable on the Consolidated balance sheets. The carrying value of the valuation allowance was $4 million and $5 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, which the Firm believes, based on historical experience and the collateral held by Chase Paymentech of $174 million and $208 million at December 31, 2014 and 2013, respectively, is representative of the payment or performance risk to the Firm related to charge-backs.
Clearing Services - Client Credit Risk
The Firm provides clearing services for clients entering into securities purchases and sales and derivative transactions, with central counterparties (“CCPs”), including exchange-traded derivatives (“ETDs”) such as futures and options, as well as OTC-cleared derivative contracts. As a clearing member, the Firm stands behind the performance of its clients, collects cash and securities collateral (margin) as well as any settlement amounts due from or to clients, and remits them to the relevant CCP or client in whole or part. There are two types of margin. Variation margin is posted on a daily basis based on the value of clients’ derivative contracts. Initial margin is posted at inception of a derivative contract, generally on the basis of the potential changes in the variation margin requirement for the contract.
As clearing member, the Firm is exposed to the risk of non-performance by its clients, but is not liable to clients for the performance of the CCPs. Where possible, the Firm seeks to mitigate its risk to the client through the collection of appropriate amounts of margin at inception and throughout the life of the transactions. The Firm can also cease provision of clearing services if clients do not adhere to their obligations under the clearing agreement. In the event of non-performance by a client, the Firm would close out the client’s positions and access available margin. The CCP would utilize any margin it holds to make itself whole, with any remaining shortfalls required to be paid by the Firm as clearing member.
The Firm reflects its exposure to non-performance risk of the client through the recognition of margin payables or receivables to clients and CCPs, but does not reflect the clients’ underlying securities or derivative contracts in its Consolidated Financial Statements.
It is difficult to estimate the Firm’s maximum possible exposure through its role as clearing member, as this would require an assessment of transactions that clients may execute in the future. However, based upon historical experience, and the credit risk mitigants available to the Firm, management believes it is unlikely that the Firm will


292
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



have to make any material payments under these arrangements and the risk of loss is expected to be remote.
For information on the derivatives that the Firm executes for its own account and records in its Consolidated Financial Statements, see Note 6.
Exchange & Clearing House Memberships
Through the provision of clearing services, the Firm is a member of several securities and derivative exchanges and clearinghouses, both in the U.S. and other countries. Membership in some of these organizations requires the Firm to pay a pro rata share of the losses incurred by the organization as a result of the default of another member. Such obligations vary with different organizations. These obligations may be limited to members who dealt with the defaulting member or to the amount (or a multiple of the amount) of the Firm’s contribution to the guarantee fund maintained by a clearing house or exchange as part of the resources available to cover any losses in the event of a member default. Alternatively, these obligations may be a full pro-rata share of the residual losses after applying the guarantee fund. Additionally, certain clearinghouses require the Firm as a member to pay a pro rata share of losses resulting from the clearinghouse’s investment of guarantee fund contributions and initial margin, unrelated to and independent of the default of another member. Generally a payment would only be required should such losses exceed the resources of the clearing house or exchange that are contractually required to absorb the losses in the first instance. It is difficult to estimate the Firm’s maximum possible exposure under these membership agreements, since this would require an assessment of future claims that may be made against the Firm that have not yet occurred. However, based on historical experience, management expects the risk of loss to be remote.
 
Guarantees of subsidiaries
In the normal course of business, JPMorgan Chase & Co. (“Parent Company”) may provide counterparties with guarantees of certain of the trading and other obligations of its subsidiaries on a contract-by-contract basis, as negotiated with the Firm’s counterparties. The obligations of the subsidiaries are included on the Firm’s Consolidated balance sheets or are reflected as off-balance sheet commitments; therefore, the Parent Company has not recognized a separate liability for these guarantees. The Firm believes that the occurrence of any event that would trigger payments by the Parent Company under these guarantees is remote.
The Parent Company has guaranteed certain debt of its subsidiaries, including both long-term debt and structured notes sold as part of the Firm’s market-making activities. These guarantees are not included in the table on page 288 of this Note. For additional information, see Note 21.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
293

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Note 30 – Commitments, pledged assets and collateral
Lease commitments
At December 31, 2014, JPMorgan Chase and its subsidiaries were obligated under a number of noncancelable operating leases for premises and equipment used primarily for banking purposes, and for energy-related tolling service agreements. Certain leases contain renewal options or escalation clauses providing for increased rental payments based on maintenance, utility and tax increases, or they require the Firm to perform restoration work on leased premises. No lease agreement imposes restrictions on the Firm’s ability to pay dividends, engage in debt or equity financing transactions or enter into further lease agreements.
The following table presents required future minimum rental payments under operating leases with noncancelable lease terms that expire after December 31, 2014.
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
 
2015
$
1,722

2016
1,682

2017
1,534

2018
1,281

2019
1,121

After 2019
5,101

Total minimum payments required(a)
12,441

Less: Sublease rentals under noncancelable subleases
(2,238
)
Net minimum payment required
$
10,203

(a)
Lease restoration obligations are accrued in accordance with U.S. GAAP, and are not reported as a required minimum lease payment.
Total rental expense was as follows.
Year ended December 31,
 
 
 
 
 
 
(in millions)
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Gross rental expense
 
$
2,255

 
$
2,187

 
$
2,212

Sublease rental income
 
(383
)
 
(341
)
 
(288
)
Net rental expense
 
$
1,872

 
$
1,846

 
$
1,924


 
Pledged assets
Financial assets are pledged to maintain potential borrowing capacity with central banks and for other purposes, including to secure borrowings and public deposits, and to collateralize repurchase and other securities financing agreements. Certain of these pledged assets may be sold or repledged by the secured parties and are identified as financial instruments owned (pledged to various parties) on the Consolidated balance sheets. At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm had pledged assets of $324.5 billion and $251.3 billion, respectively, at Federal Reserve Banks and FHLBs. In addition, as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm had pledged to third parties $60.1 billion and $68.4 billion, respectively, of financial instruments it owns that may not be sold or repledged by such secured parties. Total assets pledged do not include assets of consolidated VIEs; these assets are used to settle the liabilities of those entities. See Note 16 for additional information on assets and liabilities of consolidated VIEs. For additional information on the Firm’s securities financing activities and long-term debt, see Note 13 and Note 21, respectively. The significant components of the Firm’s pledged assets were as follows.
December 31, (in billions)
 
2014
 
2013
Securities
 
$
118.7

 
$
68.1

Loans
 
248.2

 
230.3

Trading assets and other
 
169.0

 
163.3

Total assets pledged
 
$
535.9

 
$
461.7

Collateral
At December 31, 2014 and 2013, the Firm had accepted assets as collateral that it could sell or repledge, deliver or otherwise use with a fair value of approximately $761.7 billion and $725.0 billion, respectively. This collateral was generally obtained under resale agreements, securities borrowing agreements, customer margin loans and derivative agreements. Of the collateral received, approximately $596.8 billion and $520.1 billion, respectively, were sold or repledged, generally as collateral under repurchase agreements, securities lending agreements or to cover short sales and to collateralize deposits and derivative agreements.
Certain prior period amounts for both collateral, as well as pledged assets (including the corresponding pledged assets parenthetical disclosure for trading assets on the Consolidated balance sheets) have been revised to conform with the current period presentation.


294
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Note 31 – Litigation
Contingencies
As of December 31, 2014, the Firm and its subsidiaries are defendants or putative defendants in numerous legal proceedings, including private, civil litigations and regulatory/government investigations. The litigations range from individual actions involving a single plaintiff to class action lawsuits with potentially millions of class members. Investigations involve both formal and informal proceedings, by both governmental agencies and self-regulatory organizations. These legal proceedings are at varying stages of adjudication, arbitration or investigation, and involve each of the Firm’s lines of business and geographies and a wide variety of claims (including common law tort and contract claims and statutory antitrust, securities and consumer protection claims), some of which present novel legal theories.
The Firm believes the estimate of the aggregate range of reasonably possible losses, in excess of reserves established, for its legal proceedings is from $0 to approximately $5.8 billion at December 31, 2014. This estimated aggregate range of reasonably possible losses is based upon currently available information for those proceedings in which the Firm is involved, taking into account the Firm’s best estimate of such losses for those cases for which such estimate can be made. For certain cases, the Firm does not believe that an estimate can currently be made. The Firm’s estimate involves significant judgment, given the varying stages of the proceedings (including the fact that many are currently in preliminary stages), the existence in many such proceedings of multiple defendants (including the Firm) whose share of liability has yet to be determined, the numerous yet-unresolved issues in many of the proceedings (including issues regarding class certification and the scope of many of the claims) and the attendant uncertainty of the various potential outcomes of such proceedings, particularly proceedings that could result from government investigations. Accordingly, the Firm’s estimate will change from time to time, and actual losses may vary.
Set forth below are descriptions of the Firm’s material legal proceedings.
Auto Dealer Regulatory Matter.  The Firm is engaged in discussions with the U.S. Department of Justice (“DOJ”) about potential statistical disparities in markups charged to different races and ethnicities by automobile dealers on loans originated by those dealers and purchased by the Firm.
CIO Litigation. The Firm has been sued in a consolidated shareholder putative class action, a consolidated putative class action brought under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act (“ERISA”) and seven shareholder derivative actions brought in Delaware state court and in New York federal and state courts relating to 2012 losses in the synthetic credit portfolio managed by the Firm’s Chief Investment Office (“CIO”). Four of the shareholder derivative actions have been dismissed, and plaintiffs in
 
three of those actions have appealed those dismissals. Motions to dismiss have also been filed in two other shareholder derivative actions.
Credit Default Swaps Investigations and Litigation. In July 2013, the European Commission (the “EC”) filed a Statement of Objections against the Firm (including various subsidiaries) and other industry members in connection with its ongoing investigation into the credit default swaps (“CDS”) marketplace. The EC asserts that between 2006 and 2009, a number of investment banks acted collectively through the International Swaps and Derivatives Association (“ISDA”) and Markit Group Limited (“Markit”) to foreclose exchanges from the potential market for exchange-traded credit derivatives. The Firm submitted a response to the Statement of Objections in January 2014, and the EC held a hearing in May 2014. DOJ also has an ongoing investigation into the CDS marketplace, which was initiated in July 2009.
Separately, the Firm and other industry members are defendants in a consolidated putative class action filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York on behalf of purchasers and sellers of CDS. The complaint refers to the ongoing investigations by the EC and DOJ into the CDS market, and alleges that the defendant investment banks and dealers, including the Firm, as well as Markit and/or ISDA, collectively prevented new entrants into the market for exchange-traded CDS products. Defendants moved to dismiss this action, and in September 2014, the Court granted defendants’ motion in part, dismissing claims for damages based on transactions effected before the Autumn of 2008, as well as certain other claims.
Foreign Exchange Investigations and Litigation. In November 2014, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. reached separate settlements with the U.K. Financial Conduct Authority (“FCA”), the U.S. Commodity Futures Trading Commission (“CFTC”) and the U.S. Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (“OCC”) to resolve the agencies’ respective civil enforcement claims relating to the Bank’s foreign exchange (“FX”) trading business (collectively, the “Settlement Agreements”). Under the Settlement Agreements, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. agreed to take certain remedial measures and paid penalties of £222 million to the FCA, $310 million to the CFTC and $350 million to the OCC.
In December 2014, the Hong Kong Monetary Authority (“HKMA”) announced the conclusion of its FX-related investigation regarding JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and several other banks. The HKMA required the banks, including JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., to take certain remedial measures.
Other FX-related regulatory investigations of the Firm are ongoing, including a criminal investigation by DOJ. These investigations are focused on the Firm’s spot FX trading and sales activities as well as controls applicable to those activities. The Firm continues to cooperate with these investigations. The Firm is also engaged in discussions regarding potential resolution with DOJ.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
295

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Since November 2013, a number of class actions have been filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York against a number of foreign exchange dealers, including the Firm, for alleged violations of federal and state antitrust laws and unjust enrichment based on an alleged conspiracy to manipulate foreign exchange rates reported on the WM/Reuters service. In March 2014, plaintiffs filed a consolidated amended U.S. class action complaint; two other class actions were brought by non-U.S.-based plaintiffs. The Court denied defendants’ motion to dismiss the U.S. class action and granted the motion to dismiss the two non-U.S. class actions. In January 2015, the Firm settled the U.S. class action, and this settlement is subject to court approval.
General Motors Litigation. JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. participated in, and was the Administrative Agent on behalf of a syndicate of lenders on, a $1.5 billion syndicated Term Loan facility (“Term Loan”) for General Motors Corporation (“GM”). In July 2009, in connection with the GM bankruptcy proceedings, the Official Committee of Unsecured Creditors of Motors Liquidation Company (“Creditors Committee”) filed a lawsuit against JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., in its individual capacity and as Administrative Agent for other lenders on the Term Loan, seeking to hold the underlying lien invalid. In March 2013, the Bankruptcy Court granted JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.’s motion for summary judgment and dismissed the Creditors Committee’s complaint on the grounds that JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. did not authorize the filing of the UCC-3 termination statement at issue. The Creditors Committee appealed the Bankruptcy Court’s dismissal of its claim to the United States Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit. In January 2015, the Court of Appeals reversed the Bankruptcy Court’s dismissal of the Creditors Committee’s claim and remanded the case to the Bankruptcy Court with instructions to enter partial summary judgment for the Creditors Committee as to the termination statement. JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. has filed a petition requesting that the full Court of Appeals rehear the case en banc. In the event that the request for rehearing is denied, continued proceedings in the Bankruptcy Court are anticipated with respect to, among other things, additional defenses asserted by JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and the value of additional collateral on the Term Loan, which was not the subject of the termination statement.
Interchange Litigation. A group of merchants and retail associations filed a series of class action complaints alleging that Visa and MasterCard, as well as certain banks, conspired to set the price of credit and debit card interchange fees, enacted respective rules in violation of antitrust laws, and engaged in tying/bundling and exclusive dealing. The parties have entered into an agreement to settle the cases for a cash payment of $6.1 billion to the class plaintiffs (of which the Firm’s share is approximately 20%) and an amount equal to ten basis points of credit card interchange for a period of eight months to be measured from a date within 60 days of the end of the opt-out period. The agreement also provides for modifications to each credit card network’s rules, including those that
 
prohibit surcharging credit card transactions. In December 2013, the Court issued a decision granting final approval of the settlement. A number of merchants have appealed. Certain merchants that opted out of the class settlement have filed actions against Visa and MasterCard, as well as against the Firm and other banks. Defendants’ motion to dismiss the actions was denied in July 2014.
Investment Management Litigation. The Firm is defending two pending cases that allege that investment portfolios managed by J.P. Morgan Investment Management (“JPMIM”) were inappropriately invested in securities backed by residential real estate collateral. Plaintiffs Assured Guaranty (U.K.) and Ambac Assurance UK Limited claim that JPMIM is liable for losses of more than $1 billion in market value of these securities. Discovery is proceeding.
Lehman Brothers Bankruptcy Proceedings. In May 2010, Lehman Brothers Holdings Inc. (“LBHI”) and its Official Committee of Unsecured Creditors (the “Committee”) filed a complaint (and later an amended complaint) against JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. in the United States Bankruptcy Court for the Southern District of New York that asserts both federal bankruptcy law and state common law claims, and seeks, among other relief, to recover $7.9 billion in collateral that was transferred to JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. in the weeks preceding LBHI’s bankruptcy. The amended complaint also seeks unspecified damages on the grounds that JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.’s collateral requests hastened LBHI’s bankruptcy. The Court dismissed the counts of the amended complaint that sought to void the allegedly constructively fraudulent and preferential transfers made to the Firm during the months of August and September 2008. The Firm has filed counterclaims against LBHI alleging that LBHI fraudulently induced the Firm to make large extensions of credit against inappropriate collateral in connection with the Firm’s role as the clearing bank for Lehman Brothers Inc. (“LBI”), LBHI’s broker-dealer subsidiary. These extensions of credit left the Firm with more than $25 billion in claims against the estate of LBI. The case has been transferred from the Bankruptcy Court to the District Court, and the Firm has moved for summary judgment seeking the dismissal of all of LBHI’s claims. LBHI has also moved for summary judgment on certain of its claims and seeking the dismissal of the Firm’s counterclaims.
In the Bankruptcy Court proceedings, LBHI and several of its subsidiaries that had been Chapter 11 debtors have filed a separate complaint and objection to derivatives claims asserted by the Firm alleging that the amount of the derivatives claims had been overstated and challenging certain set-offs taken by JPMorgan Chase entities to recover on the claims. The Firm responded to this separate complaint and objection in February 2013. LBHI and the Committee have also filed an objection to the claims asserted by JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. against LBHI with respect to clearing advances made to LBI, principally on the grounds that the Firm had not conducted the sale of the securities collateral held for its claims in a commercially reasonable manner. Discovery regarding both objections is


296
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



ongoing. In January 2015, LBHI filed additional objections relating to a variety of claims that the Firm had filed in the Bankruptcy Court proceedings. The bankruptcy claims and other claims of the Firm against Lehman entities have been paid in full, subject to potential adjustment depending on the outcome of the objections filed by LBHI and the Committee.
LIBOR and Other Benchmark Rate Investigations and Litigation. JPMorgan Chase has received subpoenas and requests for documents and, in some cases, interviews, from federal and state agencies and entities, including DOJ, the CFTC, the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”) and various state attorneys general, as well as the EC, the FCA, the Canadian Competition Bureau, the Swiss Competition Commission and other regulatory authorities and banking associations around the world relating primarily to the process by which interest rates were submitted to the British Bankers Association (“BBA”) in connection with the setting of the BBA’s London Interbank Offered Rate (“LIBOR”) for various currencies, principally in 2007 and 2008. Some of the inquiries also relate to similar processes by which information on rates is submitted to the European Banking Federation (“EBF”) in connection with the setting of the EBF’s Euro Interbank Offered Rates (“EURIBOR”) and to the Japanese Bankers’ Association for the setting of Tokyo Interbank Offered Rates (“TIBOR”) as well as to other processes for the setting of other reference rates in various parts of the world during similar time periods. The Firm is responding to and continuing to cooperate with these inquiries. In December 2013, JPMorgan Chase reached a settlement with the EC regarding its Japanese Yen LIBOR investigation and agreed to pay a fine of €80 million. In January 2014, the Canadian Competition Bureau announced that it has discontinued its investigation related to Yen LIBOR. In May 2014, the EC issued a Statement of Objections outlining its case against the Firm (and others) as to EURIBOR, to which the Firm has filed a response. In October 2014, JPMorgan Chase reached a settlement with the EC regarding the EC’s Swiss franc LIBOR investigation and agreed to pay a fine of €72 million. In January 2015, the FCA informed JPMorgan Chase that it has discontinued its investigation of the Firm concerning LIBOR and EURIBOR.
In addition, the Firm has been named as a defendant along with other banks in a series of individual and class actions filed in various United States District Courts, in which plaintiffs make varying allegations that in various periods, starting in 2000 or later, defendants either individually or collectively manipulated the U.S. dollar LIBOR, Yen LIBOR, Swiss franc LIBOR, Euroyen TIBOR and/or EURIBOR rates by submitting rates that were artificially low or high. Plaintiffs allege that they transacted in loans, derivatives or other financial instruments whose values are affected by changes in U.S. dollar LIBOR, Yen LIBOR, Swiss franc LIBOR, Euroyen TIBOR or EURIBOR and assert a variety of claims including antitrust claims seeking treble damages.
The U.S. dollar LIBOR-related putative class actions were consolidated for pre-trial purposes in the United States
 
District Court for the Southern District of New York. The Court stayed all related cases while motions to dismiss the three lead class actions were pending. In March 2013, the Court granted in part and denied in part the defendants’ motions to dismiss the claims in the three lead class actions, including dismissal with prejudice of the antitrust claims. In relation to the Firm, the Court has permitted certain claims under the Commodity Exchange Act and common law claims to proceed. In September 2013, class plaintiffs in two of the three lead class actions filed amended complaints, which defendants moved to dismiss. Plaintiffs in the third class action appealed the dismissal of the antitrust claims and the United States Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit dismissed the appeal for lack of jurisdiction. In January 2015, the United States Supreme Court reversed the decision of the Court of Appeals, holding that plaintiffs have the jurisdictional right to appeal and remanding the case to the Court of Appeals for further proceedings. In February 2015, the District Court entered a judgment on certain other plaintiffs’ antitrust claims so that those plaintiffs could also participate in the appeal. Motions to dismiss are pending in the remaining previously stayed individual actions and class actions.
The Firm is one of the defendants in a putative class action alleging manipulation of Euroyen TIBOR and Yen LIBOR which was filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York on behalf of plaintiffs who purchased or sold exchange-traded Euroyen futures and options contracts. In March 2014, the Court granted in part and denied in part the defendants’ motions to dismiss, including dismissal of plaintiff’s antitrust and unjust enrichment claims.
The Firm is one of the defendants in a putative class action filed in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York relating to the interest rate benchmark EURIBOR. The case is currently stayed.
The Firm is also one of the defendants in a number of putative class actions alleging that defendant banks and ICAP conspired to manipulate the U.S. dollar ISDAFIX rates. Plaintiffs primarily assert claims under the federal antitrust laws and Commodities Exchange Act. In December 2014, defendants filed a motion to dismiss.
Madoff Litigation. Various subsidiaries of the Firm, including J.P. Morgan Securities plc, have been named as defendants in lawsuits filed in Bankruptcy Court in New York arising out of the liquidation proceedings of Fairfield Sentry Limited and Fairfield Sigma Limited, so-called Madoff feeder funds. These actions seek to recover payments made by the funds to defendants totaling approximately $155 million. All but two of these actions have been dismissed.
In addition, a putative class action was brought by investors in certain feeder funds against JPMorgan Chase in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York, as was a motion by separate potential class plaintiffs to add claims against the Firm and certain subsidiaries to an already pending putative class action in the same court. The allegations in these complaints largely track those


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
297

Notes to consolidated financial statements

previously raised by the court-appointed trustee for Bernard L. Madoff Investment Securities LLC. The District Court dismissed these complaints and the United States Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit affirmed the District Court’s decision. Plaintiffs have petitioned the United States Supreme Court for a writ of certiorari.
The Firm is a defendant in five other Madoff-related individual investor actions pending in New York state court. The allegations in all of these actions are essentially identical, and involve claims against the Firm for, among other things, aiding and abetting breach of fiduciary duty, conversion and unjust enrichment. In August 2014, the Court dismissed all claims against the Firm. Plaintiffs have filed a notice of appeal.
A putative class action has been filed in the United States District Court for the District of New Jersey by investors who were net winners (i.e., Madoff customers who had taken more money out of their accounts than had been invested) in Madoff’s Ponzi scheme and were not included in the previous class action settlement. These plaintiffs allege violations of the federal securities law, federal and state racketeering statutes and multiple common law and statutory claims including breach of trust, aiding and abetting embezzlement, unjust enrichment, conversion and commercial bad faith. A similar action has been filed in the United States District Court for the Middle District of Florida, although it is not styled as a class action, and includes a claim pursuant to a Florida statute. The Firm has moved to transfer these cases to the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York.
Three shareholder derivative actions have also been filed in New York federal and state court against the Firm, as nominal defendant, and certain of its current and former Board members, alleging breach of fiduciary duty in connection with the Firm’s relationship with Bernard Madoff and the alleged failure to maintain effective internal controls to detect fraudulent transactions. The actions seek declaratory relief and damages. In July 2014, the federal court granted defendants’ motions to dismiss two of the actions. One plaintiff chose not to appeal and the other filed a motion for reconsideration which was denied in November 2014. The latter plaintiff has filed an appeal. In the remaining state court action, a hearing on defendants’ motion to dismiss was held in October 2014, and the court reserved decision.
MF Global. J.P. Morgan Securities LLC has been named as one of several defendants in a number of putative class actions filed by purchasers of MF Global’s publicly traded securities asserting violations of federal securities laws and alleging that the offering documents contained materially false and misleading statements and omissions regarding MF Global. These actions have been settled, subject to final approval by the court. The Firm also has responded to inquiries from the CFTC relating to the Firm’s banking and other business relationships with MF Global, including as a depository for MF Global’s customer segregated accounts.
 
Mortgage-Backed Securities and Repurchase Litigation and Related Regulatory Investigations. JPMorgan Chase and affiliates (together, “JPMC”), Bear Stearns and affiliates (together, “Bear Stearns”) and certain Washington Mutual affiliates (together, “Washington Mutual”) have been named as defendants in a number of cases in their various roles in offerings of mortgage-backed securities (“MBS”). These cases include class action suits on behalf of MBS purchasers, actions by individual MBS purchasers and actions by monoline insurance companies that guaranteed payments of principal and interest for particular tranches of MBS offerings. Following the settlements referred to under “Repurchase Litigation” and “Government Enforcement Investigations and Litigation” below, there are currently pending and tolled investor and monoline insurer claims involving MBS with an original principal balance of approximately $41 billion, of which $38 billion involves JPMC, Bear Stearns or Washington Mutual as issuer and $3 billion involves JPMC, Bear Stearns or Washington Mutual solely as underwriter. The Firm and certain of its current and former officers and Board members have also been sued in shareholder derivative actions relating to the Firm’s MBS activities, and trustees have asserted or have threatened to assert claims that loans in securitization trusts should be repurchased.
Issuer Litigation – Class Actions. Two class actions remain pending against JPMC and Bear Stearns as MBS issuers in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York. In the action concerning JPMC, plaintiffs’ motion for class certification has been granted with respect to liability but denied without prejudice as to damages. In the action concerning Bear Stearns, the parties have reached a settlement in principle, which is subject to court approval. The Firm is also defending a class action brought against Bear Stearns in the United States District Court for the District of Massachusetts, in which the court’s decision on defendants’ motion to dismiss is pending.
Issuer Litigation – Individual Purchaser Actions. In addition to class actions, the Firm is defending individual actions brought against JPMC, Bear Stearns and Washington Mutual as MBS issuers (and, in some cases, also as underwriters of their own MBS offerings). These actions are pending in federal and state courts across the U.S. and are in various stages of litigation.
Monoline Insurer Litigation. The Firm is defending two pending actions relating to the same monoline insurer’s guarantees of principal and interest on certain classes of 11 different Bear Stearns MBS offerings. These actions are pending in state court in New York and are in various stages of litigation.
Underwriter Actions. In actions against the Firm solely as an underwriter of other issuers’ MBS offerings, the Firm has contractual rights to indemnification from the issuers. However, those indemnity rights may prove effectively unenforceable in various situations, such as where the issuers are now defunct. There are currently actions of this type pending against the Firm in federal and state courts in


298
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



various stages of litigation. One such class action has been settled, subject to final approval by the court.
Repurchase Litigation. The Firm is defending a number of actions brought by trustees, securities administrators or master servicers of various MBS trusts and others on behalf of purchasers of securities issued by those trusts. These cases generally allege breaches of various representations and warranties regarding securitized loans and seek repurchase of those loans or equivalent monetary relief, as well as indemnification of attorneys’ fees and costs and other remedies. Deutsche Bank National Trust Company, acting as trustee for various MBS trusts, has filed such a suit against JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (the “FDIC”) in connection with a significant number of MBS issued by Washington Mutual; that case is described in the Washington Mutual Litigations section below. Other repurchase actions, each specific to one or more MBS transactions issued by JPMC and/or Bear Stearns, are in various stages of litigation.
In addition, the Firm and a group of 21 institutional MBS investors made a binding offer to the trustees of MBS issued by JPMC and Bear Stearns providing for the payment of $4.5 billion and the implementation of certain servicing changes by JPMC, to resolve all repurchase and servicing claims that have been asserted or could have been asserted with respect to the 330 MBS trusts issued between 2005 and 2008. The offer does not resolve claims relating to Washington Mutual MBS. The seven trustees (or separate and successor trustees) for this group of 330 trusts has accepted the settlement for 319 trusts in whole or in part and excluded from the settlement 16 trusts in whole or in part. The trustees’ acceptance is subject to a judicial approval proceeding initiated by the trustees and pending in New York state court. Certain investors in some of the trusts for which the settlement has been accepted have intervened in the judicial approval proceeding, challenging the trustees’ acceptance of the settlement.
Additional actions have been filed against third-party trustees that relate to loan repurchase and servicing claims involving trusts that the Firm sponsored.
Derivative Actions. Shareholder derivative actions relating to the Firm’s MBS activities have been filed against the Firm, as nominal defendant, and certain of its current and former officers and members of its Board of Directors, in New York state court and California federal court. Two of the New York actions have been dismissed and one is on appeal. A consolidated action in California federal court has been dismissed without prejudice for lack of personal jurisdiction and plaintiffs are pursuing discovery.
Government Enforcement Investigations and Litigation. The Firm is responding to an ongoing investigation being conducted by the Criminal Division of the United States Attorney’s Office for the Eastern District of California relating to MBS offerings securitized and sold by the Firm and its subsidiaries. The Firm has also received subpoenas and informal requests for information from state authorities concerning the issuance and underwriting of MBS-related
 
matters. The Firm continues to respond to these MBS-related regulatory inquiries.
In addition, the Firm continues to cooperate with investigations by DOJ, including the U.S. Attorney’s Office for the District of Connecticut, the SEC Division of Enforcement and the Office of the Special Inspector General for the Troubled Asset Relief Program, all of which relate to, among other matters, communications with counterparties in connection with certain secondary market trading in residential and commercial MBS.
The Firm has entered into agreements with a number of entities that purchased MBS that toll applicable limitations periods with respect to their claims, and has settled, and in the future may settle, tolled claims. There is no assurance that the Firm will not be named as a defendant in additional MBS-related litigation.
Mortgage-Related Investigations and Litigation. The Attorney General of Massachusetts filed an action against the Firm, other servicers and a mortgage recording company, asserting claims for various alleged wrongdoings relating to mortgage assignments and use of the industry’s electronic mortgage registry. In January 2015, the Firm entered into a settlement resolving this action.
The Firm entered into a settlement resolving a putative class action lawsuit relating to its filing of affidavits or other documents in connection with mortgage foreclosure proceedings, and the court granted final approval of the settlement in January 2015.
One shareholder derivative action has been filed in New York Supreme Court against the Firm’s Board of Directors alleging that the Board failed to exercise adequate oversight as to wrongful conduct by the Firm regarding mortgage servicing. In December 2014, the court granted defendants’ motion to dismiss the complaint.
The Civil Division of the United States Attorney’s Office for the Southern District of New York is conducting an investigation concerning the Firm’s compliance with the Fair Housing Act (“FHA”) and Equal Credit Opportunity Act (“ECOA”) in connection with its mortgage lending practices. In addition, three municipalities and a school district have commenced litigation against the Firm alleging violations of an unfair competition law and of the FHA and ECOA and seeking statutory damages for the unfair competition claim, and, for the FHA and ECOA claims, damages in the form of lost tax revenue and increased municipal costs associated with foreclosed properties. The court denied a motion to dismiss in one of the municipal actions, the school district action was dismissed with prejudice, another municipal action was recently served, and motions to dismiss are pending in the remaining actions.
JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. is responding to inquiries by the Executive Office of the U.S. Bankruptcy Trustee and various regional U.S. Bankruptcy Trustees relating to mortgage payment change notices and escrow statements in bankruptcy proceedings.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
299

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Municipal Derivatives Litigation. Several civil actions were commenced in New York and Alabama courts against the Firm relating to certain Jefferson County, Alabama (the “County”) warrant underwritings and swap transactions. The claims in the civil actions generally alleged that the Firm made payments to certain third parties in exchange for being chosen to underwrite more than $3 billion in warrants issued by the County and to act as the counterparty for certain swaps executed by the County. The County filed for bankruptcy in November 2011. In June 2013, the County filed a Chapter 9 Plan of Adjustment, as amended (the “Plan of Adjustment”), which provided that all the above-described actions against the Firm would be released and dismissed with prejudice. In November 2013, the Bankruptcy Court confirmed the Plan of Adjustment, and in December 2013, certain sewer rate payers filed an appeal challenging the confirmation of the Plan of Adjustment. All conditions to the Plan of Adjustment’s effectiveness, including the dismissal of the actions against the Firm, were satisfied or waived and the transactions contemplated by the Plan of Adjustment occurred in December 2013. Accordingly, all the above-described actions against the Firm have been dismissed pursuant to the terms of the Plan of Adjustment. The appeal of the Bankruptcy Court’s order confirming the Plan of Adjustment remains pending.
Parmalat. In 2003, following the bankruptcy of the Parmalat group of companies (“Parmalat”), criminal prosecutors in Italy investigated the activities of Parmalat, its directors and the financial institutions that had dealings with them following the collapse of the company. In March 2012, the criminal prosecutor served a notice indicating an intention to pursue criminal proceedings against four former employees of the Firm (but not against the Firm) on charges of conspiracy to cause Parmalat’s insolvency by underwriting bonds and continuing derivatives trading when Parmalat’s balance sheet was false. A preliminary hearing, in which the judge will determine whether to recommend that the matter go to a full trial, is ongoing. The final hearings have been scheduled for March 2015.
In addition, the administrator of Parmalat commenced five civil actions against JPMorgan Chase entities including: two claw-back actions; a claim relating to bonds issued by Parmalat in which it is alleged that JPMorgan Chase kept Parmalat “artificially” afloat and delayed the declaration of insolvency; and similar allegations in two claims relating to derivatives transactions.
Petters Bankruptcy and Related Matters. JPMorgan Chase and certain of its affiliates, including One Equity Partners (“OEP”), have been named as defendants in several actions filed in connection with the receivership and bankruptcy proceedings pertaining to Thomas J. Petters and certain affiliated entities (collectively, “Petters”) and the Polaroid Corporation. The principal actions against JPMorgan Chase and its affiliates have been brought by a court-appointed receiver for Petters and the trustees in bankruptcy proceedings for three Petters entities. These actions generally seek to avoid certain putative transfers in
 
connection with (i) the 2005 acquisition by Petters of Polaroid, which at the time was majority-owned by OEP; (ii) two credit facilities that JPMorgan Chase and other financial institutions entered into with Polaroid; and (iii) a credit line and investment accounts held by Petters. The actions collectively seek recovery of approximately $450 million. Defendants have moved to dismiss the complaints in the actions filed by the Petters bankruptcy trustees.
Power Matters. The United States Attorney’s Office for the Southern District of New York is investigating matters relating to the bidding activities that were the subject of the July 2013 settlement between J.P. Morgan Ventures Energy Corp. and the Federal Energy Regulatory Commission. The Firm is responding to and cooperating with the investigation.
Referral Hiring Practices Investigations. Various regulators are investigating, among other things, the Firm’s compliance with the Foreign Corrupt Practices Act and other laws with respect to the Firm’s hiring practices related to candidates referred by clients, potential clients and government officials, and its engagement of consultants in the Asia Pacific region. The Firm is responding to and continuing to cooperate with these investigations.
Sworn Documents, Debt Sales and Collection Litigation Practices. The Firm has been responding to formal and informal inquiries from various state and federal regulators regarding practices involving credit card collections litigation (including with respect to sworn documents), the sale of consumer credit card debt and securities backed by credit card receivables.
Separately, the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau and multiple state Attorneys General are conducting investigations into the Firm’s collection and sale of consumer credit card debt. The California and Mississippi Attorneys General have filed separate civil actions against JPMorgan Chase & Co., Chase Bank USA, N.A. and Chase BankCard Services, Inc. alleging violations of law relating to debt collection practices.
Washington Mutual Litigations. Proceedings related to Washington Mutual’s failure are pending before the United States District Court for the District of Columbia and include a lawsuit brought by Deutsche Bank National Trust Company, initially against the FDIC and amended to include JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. as a defendant, asserting an estimated $6 billion to $10 billion in damages based upon alleged breach of various mortgage securitization agreements and alleged violation of certain representations and warranties given by certain Washington Mutual affiliates in connection with those securitization agreements. The case includes assertions that JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. may have assumed liabilities for the alleged breaches of representations and warranties in the mortgage securitization agreements. The Firm and the FDIC have filed opposing motions, each seeking a ruling that the liabilities at issue are borne by the other.
Certain holders of Washington Mutual Bank debt filed an action against JPMorgan Chase which alleged that by


300
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



acquiring substantially all of the assets of Washington Mutual Bank from the FDIC, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. caused Washington Mutual Bank to default on its bond obligations. JPMorgan Chase and the FDIC moved to dismiss this action and the District Court dismissed the case except as to the plaintiffs’ claim that JPMorgan Chase tortiously interfered with the plaintiffs’ bond contracts with Washington Mutual Bank prior to its closure. Discovery is ongoing.
JPMorgan Chase has also filed a complaint in the United States District Court for the District of Columbia against the FDIC in its capacity as receiver for Washington Mutual Bank and in its corporate capacity asserting multiple claims for indemnification under the terms of the Purchase & Assumption Agreement between JPMorgan Chase and the FDIC relating to JPMorgan Chase’s purchase of most of the assets and certain liabilities of Washington Mutual Bank.
* * *
In addition to the various legal proceedings discussed above, JPMorgan Chase and its subsidiaries are named as defendants or are otherwise involved in a substantial number of other legal proceedings. The Firm believes it has meritorious defenses to the claims asserted against it in its currently outstanding legal proceedings and it intends to defend itself vigorously in all such matters. Additional legal proceedings may be initiated from time to time in the future.
The Firm has established reserves for several hundred of its currently outstanding legal proceedings. In accordance with the provisions of U.S. GAAP for contingencies, the Firm accrues for a litigation-related liability when it is probable that such a liability has been incurred and the amount of the loss can be reasonably estimated. The Firm evaluates its outstanding legal proceedings each quarter to assess its litigation reserves, and makes adjustments in such reserves, upwards or downward, as appropriate, based on management’s best judgment after consultation with counsel. During the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, the Firm incurred $2.9 billion, $11.1 billion and $5.0 billion, respectively, of legal expense. There is no assurance that the Firm’s litigation reserves will not need to be adjusted in the future.
In view of the inherent difficulty of predicting the outcome of legal proceedings, particularly where the claimants seek very large or indeterminate damages, or where the matters present novel legal theories, involve a large number of
 
parties or are in early stages of discovery, the Firm cannot state with confidence what will be the eventual outcomes of the currently pending matters, the timing of their ultimate resolution or the eventual losses, fines, penalties or impact related to those matters. JPMorgan Chase believes, based upon its current knowledge, after consultation with counsel and after taking into account its current litigation reserves, that the legal proceedings currently pending against it should not have a material adverse effect on the Firm’s consolidated financial condition. The Firm notes, however, that in light of the uncertainties involved in such proceedings, there is no assurance the ultimate resolution of these matters will not significantly exceed the reserves it has currently accrued; as a result, the outcome of a particular matter may be material to JPMorgan Chase’s operating results for a particular period, depending on, among other factors, the size of the loss or liability imposed and the level of JPMorgan Chase’s income for that period.






















JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
301

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Note 32 – International operations
The following table presents income statement-related and balance sheet-related information for JPMorgan Chase by major international geographic area. The Firm defines international activities for purposes of this footnote presentation as business transactions that involve clients residing outside of the U.S., and the information presented below is based predominantly on the domicile of the client, the location from which the client relationship is managed, or the location of the trading desk. However, many of the Firm’s U.S. operations serve international businesses.
 
As the Firm’s operations are highly integrated, estimates and subjective assumptions have been made to apportion revenue and expense between U.S. and international operations. These estimates and assumptions are consistent with the allocations used for the Firm’s segment reporting as set forth in Note 33.
The Firm’s long-lived assets for the periods presented are not considered by management to be significant in relation to total assets. The majority of the Firm’s long-lived assets are located in the U.S.

As of or for the year ended December 31, (in millions)
 
Revenue(b)
 
Expense(c)
 
Income before income tax
expense
 
Net income
 
Total assets
 
2014
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Europe/Middle East and Africa
 
$
16,013

 
$
10,123

 
$
5,890

 
$
3,935

 
$
481,328

(d) 
Asia and Pacific
 
6,083

 
4,478

 
1,605

 
1,051

 
147,357

 
Latin America and the Caribbean
 
2,047

 
1,626

 
421

 
269

 
44,567

 
Total international
 
24,143

 
16,227

 
7,916

 
5,255

 
673,252

 
North America(a)
 
70,062

 
48,186

 
21,876

 
16,507

 
1,899,874

 
Total
 
$
94,205

 
$
64,413

 
$
29,792

 
$
21,762

 
$
2,573,126

 
2013
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Europe/Middle East and Africa
 
$
15,585

 
$
9,069

 
$
6,516

 
$
4,842

 
$
514,747

(d) 
Asia and Pacific
 
6,168

 
4,248

 
1,920

 
1,254

 
145,999

 
Latin America and the Caribbean
 
2,251

 
1,626

 
625

 
381

 
41,473

 
Total international
 
24,004

 
14,943

 
9,061

 
6,477

 
702,219

 
North America(a)
 
72,602

 
55,749

 
16,853

 
11,446

 
1,713,470

 
Total
 
$
96,606

 
$
70,692

 
$
25,914

 
$
17,923

 
$
2,415,689

 
2012
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Europe/Middle East and Africa
 
$
10,522

 
$
9,326

 
$
1,196

 
$
1,508

 
$
553,147

(d) 
Asia and Pacific
 
5,605

 
3,952

 
1,653

 
1,048

 
167,955

 
Latin America and the Caribbean
 
2,328

 
1,580

 
748

 
454

 
53,984

 
Total international
 
18,455

 
14,858

 
3,597

 
3,010

 
775,086

 
North America(a)
 
78,576

 
53,256

 
25,320

 
18,274

 
1,584,055

 
Total
 
$
97,031

 
$
68,114

 
$
28,917

 
$
21,284

 
$
2,359,141

 
(a)
Substantially reflects the U.S.
(b)
Revenue is composed of net interest income and noninterest revenue.
(c)
Expense is composed of noninterest expense and the provision for credit losses.
(d)
Total assets for the U.K. were approximately $434 billion, $451 billion, and $498 billion at December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

302
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



Note 33 – Business segments
The Firm is managed on a line of business basis. There are four major reportable business segments – Consumer & Community Banking, Corporate & Investment Bank, Commercial Banking and Asset Management. In addition, there is a Corporate segment. The business segments are determined based on the products and services provided, or the type of customer served, and they reflect the manner in which financial information is currently evaluated by management. Results of these lines of business are presented on a managed basis. For a definition of managed basis, see Explanation and Reconciliation of the Firm’s use of non-GAAP financial measures, on pages 77–78. For a further discussion concerning JPMorgan Chase’s business segments, see Business Segment Results on pages 79–80.
The following is a description of each of the Firm’s business segments, and the products and services they provide to their respective client bases.
Consumer & Community Banking
Consumer & Community Banking (“CCB”) serves consumers and businesses through personal service at bank branches and through ATMs, online, mobile and telephone banking. CCB is organized into Consumer & Business Banking, Mortgage Banking (including Mortgage Production, Mortgage Servicing and Real Estate Portfolios) and Card, Merchant Services & Auto (“Card”). Consumer & Business Banking offers deposit and investment products and services to consumers, and lending, deposit, and cash management and payment solutions to small businesses. Mortgage Banking includes mortgage origination and servicing activities, as well as portfolios comprised of residential mortgages and home equity loans, including the PCI portfolio acquired in the Washington Mutual transaction. Card issues credit cards to consumers and small businesses, provides payment services to corporate and public sector clients through its commercial card products, offers payment processing services to merchants, and provides auto and student loan services.
Corporate & Investment Bank
The Corporate & Investment Bank (“CIB”), comprised of Banking and Markets & Investor Services, offers a broad suite of investment banking, market-making, prime brokerage, and treasury and securities products and services to a global client base of corporations, investors, financial institutions, government and municipal entities. Within Banking, the CIB offers a full range of investment banking products and services in all major capital markets, including advising on corporate strategy and structure, capital-raising in equity and debt markets, as well as loan origination and syndication. Also included in Banking is Treasury Services, which includes transaction services, comprised primarily of cash management and liquidity solutions, and trade finance products. The Markets & Investor Services segment of the CIB is a global market-maker in cash securities and derivative instruments, and also offers sophisticated risk management solutions, prime
 
brokerage, and research. Markets & Investor Services also includes the Securities Services business, a leading global custodian which includes custody, fund accounting and administration, and securities lending products sold principally to asset managers, insurance companies and public and private investment funds.
Commercial Banking
Commercial Banking (“CB”) delivers extensive industry knowledge, local expertise and dedicated service to U.S. and multinational clients, including corporations, municipalities, financial institutions and non-profit entities with annual revenue generally ranging from $20 million to $2 billion. CB provides financing to real estate investors and owners. Partnering with the Firm’s other businesses, CB provides comprehensive financial solutions, including lending, treasury services, investment banking and asset management to meet its clients’ domestic and international financial needs.
Asset Management
Asset Management (“AM”), with client assets of $2.4 trillion, is a global leader in investment and wealth management. AM clients include institutions, high-net-worth individuals and retail investors in every major market throughout the world. AM offers investment management across all major asset classes including equities, fixed income, alternatives and money market funds. AM also offers multi-asset investment management, providing solutions for a broad range of clients’ investment needs. For Global Wealth Management clients, AM also provides retirement products and services, brokerage and banking services including trusts and estates, loans, mortgages and deposits. The majority of AM’s client assets are in actively managed portfolios.
Corporate
The Corporate segment comprises Private Equity, Treasury and Chief Investment Office (“CIO”), and Other Corporate, which includes corporate staff units and expense that is centrally managed. Treasury and CIO are predominantly responsible for measuring, monitoring, reporting and managing the Firm’s liquidity, funding and structural interest rate and foreign exchange risks, as well as executing the Firm’s capital plan. The major Other Corporate units include Real Estate, Enterprise Technology, Legal, Compliance, Finance, Human Resources, Internal Audit, Risk Management, Oversight & Control, Corporate Responsibility and various Other Corporate groups. Other centrally managed expense includes the Firm’s occupancy and pension-related expense that are subject to allocation to the businesses.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
303

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Segment results
The following tables provide a summary of the Firm’s segment results as of or for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 on a managed basis. Total net revenue (noninterest revenue and net interest income) for each of the segments is presented on a fully taxable-equivalent (“FTE”) basis. Accordingly, revenue from investments that receive tax credits and tax-exempt securities is presented in the managed results on a basis comparable to taxable investments and securities. This non-GAAP financial measure allows management to assess the comparability of revenue arising from both taxable and tax-
 
exempt sources. The corresponding income tax impact related to tax-exempt items is recorded within income tax expense/(benefit).
Business segment capital allocation changes
Effective January 1, 2013, the Firm refined the capital allocation framework to align it with the revised line of business structure that became effective in the fourth quarter of 2012. The change in equity levels for the lines of businesses was largely driven by the evolving regulatory requirements and higher capital targets the Firm had established under the Basel III Advanced Approach.






Segment results and reconciliation
As of or the year ended
December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
Consumer & Community Banking
 
Corporate & Investment Bank
 
Commercial Banking
2014
2013
2012
 
2014
2013
2012
 
2014
2013
2012
Noninterest revenue
$
15,937

$
17,552

$
20,813

 
$
23,458

$
23,810

$
23,104

 
$
2,349

$
2,298

$
2,283

Net interest income
28,431

28,985

29,465

 
11,175

10,976

11,658

 
4,533

4,794

4,629

Total net revenue
44,368

46,537

50,278

 
34,633

34,786

34,762

 
6,882

7,092

6,912

Provision for credit losses
3,520

335

3,774

 
(161
)
(232
)
(479
)
 
(189
)
85

41

Noninterest expense
25,609

27,842

28,827

 
23,273

21,744

21,850

 
2,695

2,610

2,389

Income/(loss) before income tax expense/(benefit)
15,239

18,360

17,677

 
11,521

13,274

13,391

 
4,376

4,397

4,482

Income tax expense/(benefit)
6,054

7,299

6,886

 
4,596

4,387

4,719

 
1,741

1,749

1,783

Net income/(loss)
$
9,185

$
11,061

$
10,791

 
$
6,925

$
8,887

$
8,672

 
$
2,635

$
2,648

$
2,699

Average common equity
$
51,000

$
46,000

$
43,000

 
$
61,000

$
56,500

$
47,500

 
$
14,000

$
13,500

$
9,500

Total assets
455,634

452,929

467,282

 
861,819

843,577

876,107

 
195,267

190,782

181,502

Return on common equity
18
%
23
%
25
%
 
10
%
15
%
18
%
 
18
%
19
%
28
%
Overhead ratio
58

60

57

 
67

63

63

 
39

37

35

(a)
Segment managed results reflect revenue on a FTE basis with the corresponding income tax impact recorded within income tax expense/(benefit). These adjustments are eliminated in reconciling items to arrive at the Firm’s reported U.S. GAAP results.

304
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report



On at least an annual basis, the Firm assesses the level of capital required for each line of business as well as the assumptions and methodologies used to allocate capital to its lines of business and updates equity allocations to its lines of business as refinements are implemented.
Preferred stock dividend allocation reporting change
As part of its funds transfer pricing process, the Firm allocates substantially all of the cost of its outstanding preferred stock to its reportable business segments, while retaining the balance of the cost in Corporate. Prior to the fourth quarter of 2014, this cost was allocated to the Firm’s reportable business segments as interest expense, with an offset recorded as interest income in Corporate. Effective with the fourth quarter of 2014, this cost is no longer included in interest income and interest expense in the
 
segments, but rather is now included in net income applicable to common equity to be consistent with the presentation of firmwide results. As a result of this reporting change, net interest income and net income in the reportable business segments increases; however, there was no impact to the segments’ return on common equity (“ROE”). The Firm’s net interest income, net income, Consolidated balance sheets and consolidated results of operations were not impacted by this reporting change, as preferred stock dividends have been and continue to be distributed from retained earnings and, accordingly, were never reported as a component of the Firm’s consolidated net interest income or net income. Prior period segment amounts have been revised to conform with the current period presentation.




(table continued from previous page)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Asset Management
 
Corporate
 
Reconciling Items(a)
 
Total
2014
2013
2012
 
2014
2013
2012
 
2014
2013
2012
 
2014
2013
2012
$
9,588

$
9,029

$
7,847

 
$
1,972

$
3,093

$
190

 
$
(2,733
)
$
(2,495
)
$
(2,116
)
 
$
50,571

$
53,287

$
52,121

2,440

2,376

2,163

 
(1,960
)
(3,115
)
(2,262
)
 
(985
)
(697
)
(743
)
 
43,634

43,319

44,910

12,028

11,405

10,010

 
12

(22
)
(2,072
)
 
(3,718
)
(3,192
)
(2,859
)
 
94,205

96,606

97,031

4

65

86

 
(35
)
(28
)
(37
)
 



 
3,139

225

3,385

8,538

8,016

7,104

 
1,159

10,255

4,559

 



 
61,274

70,467

64,729

3,486

3,324

2,820

 
(1,112
)
(10,249
)
(6,594
)
 
(3,718
)
(3,192
)
(2,859
)
 
29,792

25,914

28,917

1,333

1,241

1,078

 
(1,976
)
(3,493
)
(3,974
)
 
(3,718
)
(3,192
)
(2,859
)
 
8,030

7,991

7,633

$
2,153

$
2,083

$
1,742

 
$
864

$
(6,756
)
$
(2,620
)
 
$

$

$

 
$
21,762

$
17,923

$
21,284

$
9,000

$
9,000

$
7,000

 
$
72,400

$
71,409

$
77,352

 
$

$

$

 
$
207,400

$
196,409

$
184,352

128,701

122,414

108,999

 
931,705

805,987

725,251

 
NA

NA

NA

 
2,573,126

2,415,689

2,359,141

23
%
23
%
24
%
 
NM

NM

NM

 
NM

NM

NM

 
10
%
9
%
11
%
71

70

71

 
NM

NM

NM

 
NM

NM

NM

 
65

73

67



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
305

Notes to consolidated financial statements

Note 34 – Parent company
Parent company – Statements of income and comprehensive income
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Income
 
 
 
 
 
 
Dividends from subsidiaries and affiliates:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Bank and bank holding company
 
$

 
$
1,175

 
$
4,828

Nonbank(a)
 
14,716

 
876

 
1,972

Interest income from subsidiaries
 
378

 
757

 
1,041

Other interest income
 
284

 
303

 
293

Other income from subsidiaries,
primarily fees:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Bank and bank holding company
 
779

 
318

 
939

Nonbank
 
52

 
2,065

 
1,207

Other income/(loss)
 
508

 
(1,380
)
 
579

Total income
 
16,717

 
4,114

 
10,859

Expense
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest expense to subsidiaries and affiliates(a)
 
169

 
309

 
836

Other interest expense
 
3,645

 
4,031

 
4,679

Other noninterest expense
 
827

 
9,597

 
2,399

Total expense
 
4,641

 
13,937

 
7,914

Income (loss) before income tax benefit and undistributed net income of subsidiaries
 
12,076

 
(9,823
)
 
2,945

Income tax benefit
 
1,430

 
4,301

 
1,665

Equity in undistributed net income of subsidiaries
 
8,256

 
23,445

 
16,674

Net income
 
$
21,762

 
$
17,923

 
$
21,284

Other comprehensive income, net
 
990

 
(2,903
)
 
3,158

Comprehensive income
 
$
22,752

 
$
15,020

 
$
24,442

Parent company – Balance sheets
 
 
 
 
December 31, (in millions)
 
2014

 
2013

Assets
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
 
$
211

 
$
264

Deposits with banking subsidiaries
 
95,884

 
64,843

Trading assets
 
18,222

 
13,727

Available-for-sale securities
 
3,321

 
15,228

Loans
 
2,260

 
2,829

Advances to, and receivables from, subsidiaries:
 
 
 
 
Bank and bank holding company
 
33,810

 
21,693

Nonbank
 
52,626

 
68,788

Investments (at equity) in subsidiaries and affiliates:
 
 
 
 
Bank and bank holding company
 
216,070

 
196,950

Nonbank(a)
 
41,173

 
50,996

Other assets
 
18,645

 
18,877

Total assets
 
$
482,222

 
$
454,195

Liabilities and stockholders’ equity
 
 
 
 
Borrowings from, and payables to, subsidiaries and affiliates(a)
 
$
17,442

 
$
14,328

Other borrowed funds, primarily commercial paper
 
49,586

 
55,454

Other liabilities
 
11,918

 
11,367

Long-term debt(b)(c)
 
171,211

 
161,868

Total liabilities(c)
 
250,157

 
243,017

Total stockholders’ equity
 
232,065

 
211,178

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
 
$
482,222

 
$
454,195

 
Parent company – Statements of cash flows
 
 
Year ended December 31,
(in millions)
 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

Operating activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income
 
$
21,762

 
$
17,923

 
$
21,284

Less: Net income of subsidiaries and affiliates(a)
 
22,972

 
25,496

 
23,474

Parent company net loss
 
(1,210
)
 
(7,573
)
 
(2,190
)
Cash dividends from subsidiaries and affiliates(a)
 
14,714

 
1,917

 
6,798

Other operating adjustments
 
(1,698
)
 
3,180

 
2,376

Net cash provided by/(used in) operating activities
 
11,806

 
(2,476
)
 
6,984

Investing activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits with banking subsidiaries
 
(31,040
)
 
10,679

 
16,100

Available-for-sale securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from paydowns and maturities
 
12,076

 
61

 
621

Purchases
 

 
(12,009
)
 
(364
)
Other changes in loans, net
 
(319
)
 
(713
)
 
(350
)
Advances to and investments in subsidiaries and affiliates, net
 
3,306

 
14,469

 
9,497

All other investing activities, net
 
32

 
22

 
25

Net cash provided by/(used in) investing activities
 
(15,945
)
 
12,509

 
25,529

Financing activities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Borrowings from subsidiaries and affiliates(a)
 
4,454

 
(2,715
)
 
(14,038
)
Other borrowed funds
 
(5,778
)
 
(7,297
)
 
3,736

Proceeds from the issuance of long-term debt
 
40,284

 
31,303

 
28,172

Payments of long-term debt
 
(31,050
)
 
(21,510
)
 
(44,240
)
Excess tax benefits related to stock-based compensation
 
407

 
137

 
255

Proceeds from issuance of preferred stock
 
8,847

 
3,873

 
1,234

Redemption of preferred stock
 

 
(1,800
)
 

Treasury stock and warrants repurchased
 
(4,760
)
 
(4,789
)
 
(1,653
)
Dividends paid
 
(6,990
)
 
(6,056
)
 
(5,194
)
All other financing activities, net
 
(1,328
)
 
(1,131
)
 
(701
)
Net cash provided by/(used in) financing activities
 
4,086

 
(9,985
)
 
(32,429
)
Net increase/(decrease) in cash and due from banks
 
(53
)
 
48

 
84

Cash and due from banks at the beginning of the year, primarily with bank subsidiaries
 
264

 
216

 
132

Cash and due from banks at the end of the year, primarily with bank subsidiaries
 
$
211

 
$
264

 
$
216

Cash interest paid
 
$
3,921

 
$
4,409

 
$
5,690

Cash income taxes paid, net
 
200

 
2,390

 
3,080

(a)
Affiliates include trusts that issued guaranteed capital debt securities (“issuer trusts”). The Parent received dividends of $2 million, $5 million and $12 million from the issuer trusts in 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. For further discussion on these issuer trusts, see Note 21.
(b)
At December 31, 2014, long-term debt that contractually matures in 2015 through 2019 totaled $24.4 billion, $25.5 billion, $23.0 billion, $19.3 billion and $11.3 billion, respectively.
(c)
For information regarding the Firm’s guarantees of its subsidiaries’ obligations, see Note 21 and Note 29.


306
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report

Supplementary information

Selected quarterly financial data (unaudited)
(Table continued on next page)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
As of or for the period ended
2014
 
2013
(in millions, except per share, ratio, headcount data and where otherwise noted)
4th quarter
3rd quarter
2nd quarter
1st quarter
 
4th quarter
3rd quarter
2nd quarter
1st quarter
Selected income statement data
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total net revenue
$
22,512

$
24,246

$
24,454

$
22,993

 
$
23,156

$
23,117

$
25,211

$
25,122

Total noninterest expense
15,409

15,798

15,431

14,636

 
15,552

23,626

15,866

15,423

Pre-provision profit/(loss)
7,103

8,448

9,023

8,357

 
7,604

(509
)
9,345

9,699

Provision for credit losses
840

757

692

850

 
104

(543
)
47

617

Income before income tax expense
6,263

7,691

8,331

7,507

 
7,500

34

9,298

9,082

Income tax expense
1,332

2,119

2,346

2,233

 
2,222

414

2,802

2,553

Net income/(loss)
$
4,931

$
5,572

$
5,985

$
5,274

 
$
5,278

$
(380
)
$
6,496

$
6,529

Per common share data
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income/(loss): Basic
$
1.20

$
1.37

$
1.47

$
1.29

 
$
1.31

$
(0.17
)
$
1.61

$
1.61

Diluted
1.19

1.36

1.46

1.28

 
1.30

(0.17
)
1.60

1.59

Average shares: Basic
3,730.9

3,755.4

3,780.6

3,787.2

 
3,762.1

3,767.0

3,782.4

3,818.2

Diluted
3,765.2

3,788.7

3,812.5

3,823.6

 
3,797.1

3,767.0

3,814.3

3,847.0

Market and per common share data
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Market capitalization
$
232,472

$
225,188

$
216,725

$
229,770

 
$
219,657

$
194,312

$
198,966

$
179,863

Common shares at period-end
3,714.8

3,738.2

3,761.3

3,784.7

 
3,756.1

3,759.2

3,769.0

3,789.8

Share price(a):
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
High
$
63.49

$
61.85

$
61.29

$
61.48

 
$
58.55

$
56.93

$
55.90

$
51.00

Low
54.26

54.96

52.97

54.20

 
50.25

50.06

46.05

44.20

Close
62.58

60.24

57.62

60.71

 
58.48

51.69

52.79

47.46

Book value per share
57.07

56.50

55.53

54.05

 
53.25

52.01

52.48

52.02

Tangible book value per share (“TBVPS”)(b)
44.69

44.13

43.17

41.73

 
40.81

39.51

39.97

39.54

Cash dividends declared per share
0.40

0.40

0.40

0.38

 
0.38

0.38

0.38

0.30

Selected ratios and metrics
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Return on common equity (“ROE”)
9
%
10
%
11
%
10
%
 
10
%
(1
)%
13
%
13
%
Return on tangible common equity (“ROTCE”)(b)
11

13

14

13

 
14

(2
)
17

17

Return on assets (“ROA”)
0.78

0.90

0.99

0.89

 
0.87

(0.06
)
1.09

1.14

Overhead ratio
68

65

63

64

 
67

102

63

61

Loans-to-deposits ratio
56

56

57

57

 
57

57

60

61

High quality liquid assets (“HQLA”)(in billions)(c)
$
600

$
572

$
576

$
538

 
$
522

$
538

$
454

$
413

Common equity tier 1 (“CET1”) capital ratio(d)
10.2
%
10.2
%
9.8
%
10.9
%
 
10.7
%
10.5
 %
10.4
%
10.2
%
Tier 1 capital ratio(d)
11.6

11.5

11.1

12.1

 
11.9

11.7

11.6

11.6

Total capital ratio(d)
13.1

12.8

12.5

14.5

 
14.3

14.3

14.1

14.1

Tier 1 leverage ratio
7.6

7.6

7.6

7.4

 
7.1

6.9

7.0

7.3

Selected balance sheet data (period-end)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trading assets
$
398,988

$
410,657

$
392,543

$
375,204

 
$
374,664

$
383,348

$
401,470

$
430,991

Securities(e)
348,004

366,358

361,918

351,850

 
354,003

356,556

354,725

365,744

Loans
757,336

743,257

746,983

730,971

 
738,418

728,679

725,586

728,886

Total assets
2,573,126

2,527,005

2,520,336

2,476,986

 
2,415,689

2,463,309

2,439,494

2,389,349

Deposits
1,363,427

1,334,534

1,319,751

1,282,705

 
1,287,765

1,281,102

1,202,950

1,202,507

Long-term debt(f)
276,836

268,721

269,929

274,512

 
267,889

263,372

266,212

268,361

Common stockholders’ equity
212,002

211,214

208,851

204,572

 
200,020

195,512

197,781

197,128

Total stockholders’ equity
232,065

231,277

227,314

219,655

 
211,178

206,670

209,239

207,086

Headcount
241,359

242,388

245,192

246,994

 
251,196

255,041

254,063

255,898



JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
307

Supplementary information

(Table continued from previous page)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
As of or for the period ended
2014
 
2013
(in millions, except ratio data)
4th quarter
3rd quarter
2nd quarter
1st quarter
 
4th quarter
3rd quarter
2nd quarter
1st quarter
Credit quality metrics
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for credit losses
$
14,807

$
15,526

$
15,974

$
16,485

 
$
16,969

$
18,248

$
20,137

$
21,496

Allowance for loan losses to total retained loans
1.90
%
2.02
%
2.08
%
2.20
%
 
2.25
%
2.43
%
2.69
%
2.88
%
Allowance for loan losses to retained loans excluding purchased credit-impaired loans(g)
1.55

1.63

1.69

1.75

 
1.80

1.89

2.06

2.27

Nonperforming assets
$
7,967

$
8,390

$
9,017

$
9,473

 
$
9,706

$
10,380

$
11,041

$
11,739

Net charge-offs
1,218

1,114

1,158

1,269

 
1,328

1,346

1,403

1,725

Net charge-off rate
0.65
%
0.60
%
0.64
%
0.71
%
 
0.73
%
0.74
%
0.78
%
0.97
%
(a)
Share prices shown for JPMorgan Chase’s common stock are from the New York Stock Exchange. JPMorgan Chase’s common stock is also listed and traded on the London Stock Exchange and the Tokyo Stock Exchange.
(b)
TBVPS and ROTCE are non-GAAP financial measures. TBVPS represents the Firm’s tangible common equity divided by common shares at period-end. ROTCE measures the Firm’s annualized earnings as a percentage of tangible common equity. For further discussion of these measures, see Explanation and Reconciliation of the Firm’s Use of Non-GAAP Financial Measures on pages 77–78.
(c)
HQLA represents the Firm’s estimate of the amount of assets that qualify for inclusion in the liquidity coverage ratio under the final U.S. rule (“U.S. LCR”) as of December 31, 2014, and under the Basel III liquidity coverage ratio (“Basel III LCR”) for prior periods. For additional information, see HQLA on page 157.
(d)
Basel III Transitional rules became effective on January 1, 2014; December 31, 2013 data is based on Basel I rules. As of December 31, 2014, September 30, 2014, and June 30, 2014, the ratios presented are calculated under the Basel III Advanced Transitional Approach. As of March 31, 2014, the ratios presented are calculated under the Basel III Standardized Transitional Approach. CET1 capital under Basel III replaced Tier 1 common capital under Basel I. Prior to Basel III becoming effective on January 1, 2014, Tier 1 common capital under Basel I was a non-GAAP financial measure. See Regulatory capital on pages 146–153 for additional information on Basel III and non-GAAP financial measures of regulatory capital.
(e)
Included held-to-maturity securities of $49.3 billion, $48.8 billion, $47.8 billion, $47.3 billion, $24.0 billion and $4.5 billion at December 31, 2014, September 30, 2014, June 30, 2014, March 31, 2014, December 31, 2013 and September 30, 2013, respectively. Held-to-maturity balances for the other periods were not material.
(f)
Included unsecured long-term debt of $207.5 billion, $204.7 billion, $205.6 billion, $206.1 billion, $199.4 billion, $199.2 billion, $199.1 billion and $206.1 billion, respectively, for the periods presented.
(g)
Excludes the impact of residential real estate PCI loans. For further discussion, see Allowance for credit losses on pages 128–130.


308
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report

Glossary of Terms

Active foreclosures: Loans referred to foreclosure where formal foreclosure proceedings are ongoing. Includes both judicial and non-judicial states.
Active online customers: Users of all internet browsers and mobile platforms who have logged in within the past 90 days.
Active mobile customers: Users of all mobile platforms, which include: SMS, mobile smartphone and tablet, who have logged in within the past 90 days.
Allowance for loan losses to total loans: Represents period-end allowance for loan losses divided by retained loans.
Alternative assets - The following types of assets constitute alternative investments - hedge funds, currency, real estate, private equity and other investment funds designed to focus on nontraditional strategies.
Assets under management: Represent assets actively managed by AM on behalf of its Private Banking, Institutional and Retail clients. Includes “Committed capital not Called,” on which AM earns fees.
Beneficial interests issued by consolidated VIEs: Represents the interest of third-party holders of debt, equity securities, or other obligations, issued by VIEs that JPMorgan Chase consolidates.
Benefit obligation: Refers to the projected benefit obligation for pension plans and the accumulated postretirement benefit obligation for OPEB plans.
Central counterparty (“CCP”): A CCP is a clearing house that interposes itself between counterparties to contracts traded in one or more financial markets, becoming the buyer to every seller and the seller to every buyer and thereby ensuring the future performance of open contracts. A CCP becomes counterparty to trades with market participants through novation, an open offer system, or another legally binding arrangement.
Chase LiquidSM cards: Refers to a prepaid, reloadable card product.
Client advisors: Investment product specialists, including private client advisors, financial advisors, financial advisor associates, senior financial advisors, independent financial advisors and financial advisor associate trainees, who advise clients on investment options, including annuities, mutual funds, stock trading services, etc., sold by the Firm or by third-party vendors through retail branches, Chase Private Client locations and other channels.
Client assets: Represent assets under management as well as custody, brokerage, administration and deposit accounts.
 
Client deposits and other third party liabilities: Deposits, as well as deposits that are swept to on-balance sheet liabilities (e.g., commercial paper, federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements) as part of client cash management programs.
Client investment managed accounts: Assets actively managed by Chase Wealth Management on behalf of clients. The percentage of managed accounts is calculated by dividing managed account assets by total client investment assets.
Credit cycle: A period of time over which credit quality improves, deteriorates and then improves again (or vice versa). The duration of a credit cycle can vary from a couple of years to several years.
Credit derivatives: Financial instruments whose value is derived from the credit risk associated with the debt of a third party issuer (the reference entity) which allow one party (the protection purchaser) to transfer that risk to another party (the protection seller). Upon the occurrence of a credit event by the reference entity, which may include, among other events, the bankruptcy or failure to pay its obligations, or certain restructurings of the debt of the reference entity, neither party has recourse to the reference entity. The protection purchaser has recourse to the protection seller for the difference between the face value of the CDS contract and the fair value at the time of settling the credit derivative contract. The determination as to whether a credit event has occurred is generally made by the relevant International Swaps and Derivatives Association (“ISDA”) Determinations Committee.
CUSIP number: A CUSIP (i.e., Committee on Uniform Securities Identification Procedures) number consists of nine characters (including letters and numbers) that uniquely identify a company or issuer and the type of security and is assigned by the American Bankers Association and operated by Standard & Poor’s. This system facilitates the clearing and settlement process of securities. A similar system is used to identify non-U.S. securities (CUSIP International Numbering System).
Deposit margin/deposit spread: Represents net interest income expressed as a percentage of average deposits.
Distributed denial-of-service attack: The use of a large number of remote computer systems to electronically send a high volume of traffic to a target website to create a service outage at the target. This is a form of cyberattack.
Exchange-traded derivatives: Derivative contracts that are executed on an exchange and settled via a central clearing house.
FICO score: A measure of consumer credit risk provided by credit bureaus, typically produced from statistical models by Fair Isaac Corporation utilizing data collected by the credit bureaus.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
309

Glossary of Terms

Forward points: Represents the interest rate differential between two currencies, which is either added to or subtracted from the current exchange rate (i.e., “spot rate”) to determine the forward exchange rate.
Group of Seven (“G7”) nations: Countries in the G7 are Canada, France, Germany, Italy, Japan, the U.K. and the U.S.
G7 government bonds: Bonds issued by the government of one of the G7 nations.
Headcount-related expense: Includes salary and benefits (excluding performance-based incentives), and other noncompensation costs related to employees.
Home equity - senior lien: Represents loans and commitments where JPMorgan Chase holds the first security interest on the property.
Home equity - junior lien: Represents loans and commitments where JPMorgan Chase holds a security interest that is subordinate in rank to other liens.
Impaired loan: Impaired loans are loans measured at amortized cost, for which it is probable that the Firm will be unable to collect all amounts due, including principal and interest, according to the contractual terms of the agreement. Impaired loans include the following:
All wholesale nonaccrual loans
All TDRs (both wholesale and consumer), including ones that have returned to accrual status
Interchange income: A fee paid to a credit card issuer in the clearing and settlement of a sales or cash advance transaction.
Investment-grade: An indication of credit quality based on JPMorgan Chase’s internal risk assessment system. “Investment grade” generally represents a risk profile similar to a rating of a “BBB-”/“Baa3” or better, as defined by independent rating agencies.
LLC: Limited Liability Company.
Loan-to-value (“LTV”) ratio: For residential real estate loans, the relationship, expressed as a percentage, between the principal amount of a loan and the appraised value of the collateral (i.e., residential real estate) securing the loan.
Origination date LTV ratio
The LTV ratio at the origination date of the loan. Origination date LTV ratios are calculated based on the actual appraised values of collateral (i.e., loan-level data) at the origination date.
Current estimated LTV ratio
An estimate of the LTV as of a certain date. The current estimated LTV ratios are calculated using estimated collateral values derived from a nationally recognized home
 
price index measured at the metropolitan statistical area (“MSA”) level. These MSA-level home price indices comprise actual data to the extent available and forecasted data where actual data is not available. As a result, the estimated collateral values used to calculate these ratios do not represent actual appraised loan-level collateral values; as such, the resulting LTV ratios are necessarily imprecise and should therefore be viewed as estimates.
Combined LTV ratio
The LTV ratio considering all available lien positions, as well as unused lines, related to the property. Combined LTV ratios are used for junior lien home equity products.
Managed basis: A non-GAAP presentation of financial results that includes reclassifications to present revenue on a fully taxable-equivalent basis. Management uses this non- GAAP financial measure at the segment level, because it believes this provides information to enable investors to understand the underlying operational performance and trends of the particular business segment and facilitates a comparison of the business segment with the performance of competitors.
Master netting agreement: An agreement between two counterparties who have multiple contracts with each other that provides for the net settlement of all contracts, as well as cash collateral, through a single payment, in a single currency, in the event of default on or termination of any one contract.
Mortgage origination channels:
Retail - Borrowers who buy or refinance a home through direct contact with a mortgage banker employed by the Firm using a branch office, the Internet or by phone. Borrowers are frequently referred to a mortgage banker by a banker in a Chase branch, real estate brokers, home builders or other third parties.
Correspondent - Banks, thrifts, other mortgage banks and other financial institutions that sell closed loans to the Firm.
Mortgage product types:
Alt-A
Alt-A loans are generally higher in credit quality than subprime loans but have characteristics that would disqualify the borrower from a traditional prime loan. Alt-A lending characteristics may include one or more of the following: (i) limited documentation; (ii) a high combined loan-to-value (“CLTV”) ratio; (iii) loans secured by non-owner occupied properties; or (iv) a debt-to-income ratio above normal limits. A substantial proportion of the Firm’s Alt-A loans are those where a borrower does not provide complete documentation of his or her assets or the amount or source of his or her income.


310
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report

Glossary of Terms

Option ARMs
The option ARM real estate loan product is an adjustable-rate mortgage loan that provides the borrower with the option each month to make a fully amortizing, interest-only or minimum payment. The minimum payment on an option ARM loan is based on the interest rate charged during the introductory period. This introductory rate is usually significantly below the fully indexed rate. The fully indexed rate is calculated using an index rate plus a margin. Once the introductory period ends, the contractual interest rate charged on the loan increases to the fully indexed rate and adjusts monthly to reflect movements in the index. The minimum payment is typically insufficient to cover interest accrued in the prior month, and any unpaid interest is deferred and added to the principal balance of the loan. Option ARM loans are subject to payment recast, which converts the loan to a variable-rate fully amortizing loan upon meeting specified loan balance and anniversary date triggers.
Prime
Prime mortgage loans are made to borrowers with good credit records and a monthly income at least three to four times greater than their monthly housing expense (mortgage payments plus taxes and other debt payments). These borrowers provide full documentation and generally have reliable payment histories.
Subprime
Subprime loans are loans to customers with one or more high risk characteristics, including but not limited to: (i) unreliable or poor payment histories; (ii) a high LTV ratio of greater than 80% (without borrower-paid mortgage insurance); (iii) a high debt-to-income ratio; (iv) an occupancy type for the loan is other than the borrower’s primary residence; or (v) a history of delinquencies or late payments on the loan.
Multi-asset: Any fund or account that allocates assets under management to more than one asset class.
N/A: Data is not applicable or available for the period presented.
Net charge-off/(recovery) rate: Represents net charge-offs/(recoveries) (annualized) divided by average retained loans for the reporting period.
Net production revenue: Includes net gains or losses on originations and sales of mortgage loans, other production-related fees and losses related to the repurchase of previously-sold loans.
 
Net mortgage servicing revenue includes the following components:
Operating revenue predominantly represents the return on Mortgage Servicing’s MSR asset and includes:
– Actual gross income earned from servicing third-party mortgage loans, such as contractually specified servicing fees and ancillary income; and
– The change in the fair value of the MSR asset due to the collection or realization of expected cash flows.
Risk management represents the components of
Mortgage Servicing’s MSR asset that are subject to ongoing risk management activities, together with derivatives and other instruments used in those risk management activities.
Net yield on interest-earning assets: The average rate for interest-earning assets less the average rate paid for all sources of funds.
NM: Not meaningful.
Nonaccrual loans: Loans for which interest income is not recognized on an accrual basis. Loans (other than credit card loans and certain consumer loans insured by U.S. government agencies) are placed on nonaccrual status when full payment of principal and interest is not expected or when principal and interest has been in default for a period of 90 days or more unless the loan is both well-secured and in the process of collection. Collateral-dependent loans are typically maintained on nonaccrual status.
Nonperforming assets: Nonperforming assets include nonaccrual loans, nonperforming derivatives and certain assets acquired in loan satisfaction, predominantly real estate owned and other commercial and personal property.
Over-the-counter (“OTC”) derivatives: Derivative contracts that are negotiated, executed and settled bilaterally between two derivative counterparties, where one or both counterparties is a derivatives dealer.
Over-the-counter cleared (“OTC-cleared”) derivatives: Derivative contracts that are negotiated and executed bilaterally, but subsequently settled via a central clearing house, such that each derivative counterparty is only exposed to the default of that clearing house.
Overhead ratio: Noninterest expense as a percentage of total net revenue.
Participating securities: Represents unvested stock-based compensation awards containing nonforfeitable rights to dividends or dividend equivalents (collectively, “dividends”), which are included in the earnings per share calculation using the two-class method. JPMorgan Chase grants restricted stock and RSUs to certain employees under its


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
311

Glossary of Terms

stock-based compensation programs, which entitle the recipients to receive nonforfeitable dividends during the vesting period on a basis equivalent to the dividends paid to holders of common stock. These unvested awards meet the definition of participating securities. Under the two-class method, all earnings (distributed and undistributed) are allocated to each class of common stock and participating securities, based on their respective rights to receive dividends.
Personal bankers: Retail branch office personnel who acquire, retain and expand new and existing customer relationships by assessing customer needs and recommending and selling appropriate banking products and services.
Portfolio activity: Describes changes to the risk profile of existing lending-related exposures and their impact on the allowance for credit losses from changes in customer profiles and inputs used to estimate the allowances.
Pre-provision profit/(loss): Represents total net revenue less noninterest expense. The Firm believes that this financial measure is useful in assessing the ability of a lending institution to generate income in excess of its provision for credit losses.
Pretax margin: Represents income before income tax expense divided by total net revenue, which is, in management’s view, a comprehensive measure of pretax performance derived by measuring earnings after all costs are taken into consideration. It is one basis upon which management evaluates the performance of AM against the performance of their respective competitors.
Principal transactions revenue: Principal transactions revenue includes realized and unrealized gains and losses recorded on derivatives, other financial instruments, private equity investments, and physical commodities used in market making and client-driven activities. In addition, Principal transactions revenue also includes certain realized and unrealized gains and losses related to hedge accounting and specified risk management activities including: (a) certain derivatives designated in qualifying hedge accounting relationships (primarily fair value hedges of commodity and foreign exchange risk), (b) certain derivatives used for specified risk management purposes, primarily to mitigate credit risk, foreign exchange risk and commodity risk, and (c) other derivatives.
Purchased credit-impaired (“PCI”) loans: Represents loans that were acquired in the Washington Mutual transaction and deemed to be credit-impaired on the acquisition date in accordance with the guidance of the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”). The guidance allows purchasers to aggregate credit-impaired loans acquired in the same fiscal quarter into one or more pools, provided that the loans have common risk characteristics (e.g., product type, LTV ratios, FICO scores, past due status, geographic location). A pool is then accounted for as a single asset with
 
a single composite interest rate and an aggregate expectation of cash flows.
Real assets: Real assets include investments in productive assets such as agriculture, energy rights, mining and timber properties and exclude raw land to be developed for real estate purposes.
Real estate investment trust (“REIT”): A special purpose investment vehicle that provides investors with the ability to participate directly in the ownership or financing of real-estate related assets by pooling their capital to purchase and manage income property (i.e., equity REIT) and/or mortgage loans (i.e., mortgage REIT). REITs can be publicly-or privately-held and they also qualify for certain favorable tax considerations.
Receivables from customers: Primarily represents margin loans to prime and retail brokerage customers which are included in accrued interest and accounts receivable on the Consolidated balance sheets.
Reported basis: Financial statements prepared under U.S. GAAP, which excludes the impact of taxable-equivalent adjustments.
Retained loans: Loans that are held-for-investment (i.e. excludes loans held-for-sale and loans at fair value).
Revenue wallet: Proportion of fee revenues based on estimates of investment banking fees generated across the industry (i.e. the revenue wallet) from investment banking transactions in M&A, equity and debt underwriting, and loan syndications. Source: Dealogic, a third party provider of investment banking competitive analysis and volume-based league tables for the above noted industry products.
Risk-weighted assets (“RWA”): Risk-weighted assets consist of on- and off-balance sheet assets that are assigned to one of several broad risk categories and weighted by factors representing their risk and potential for default. On-balance sheet assets are risk-weighted based on the perceived credit risk associated with the obligor or counterparty, the nature of any collateral, and the guarantor, if any. Off-balance sheet assets such as lending-related commitments, guarantees, derivatives and other applicable off-balance sheet positions are risk-weighted by multiplying the contractual amount by the appropriate credit conversion factor to determine the on-balance sheet credit equivalent amount, which is then risk-weighted based on the same factors used for on-balance sheet assets. Risk-weighted assets also incorporate a measure for market risk related to applicable trading assets-debt and equity instruments, and foreign exchange and commodity derivatives. The resulting risk-weighted values for each of the risk categories are then aggregated to determine total risk-weighted assets.
Sales specialists: Retail branch office and field personnel, including relationship managers and loan officers, who specialize in marketing and sales of various business


312
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report

Glossary of Terms

banking products (i.e., business loans, letters of credit, deposit accounts, Chase Paymentech, etc.) and mortgage products to existing and new clients.
Seed capital: Initial JPMorgan capital invested in products, such as mutual funds, with the intention of ensuring the fund is of sufficient size to represent a viable offering to clients, enabling pricing of its shares, and allowing the manager to develop a track record. After these goals are achieved, the intent is to remove the Firm’s capital from the investment.
Short sale: A short sale is a sale of real estate in which proceeds from selling the underlying property are less than the amount owed the Firm under the terms of the related mortgage and the related lien is released upon receipt of such proceeds.
Structured notes: Structured notes are predominantly financial instruments containing embedded derivatives. Where present, the embedded derivative is the primary driver of risk.
Suspended foreclosures: Loans referred to foreclosure where formal foreclosure proceedings have started but are currently on hold, which could be due to bankruptcy or loss mitigation. Includes both judicial and non-judicial states.
Taxable-equivalent basis: In presenting managed results, the total net revenue for each of the business segments and the Firm is presented on a tax-equivalent basis. Accordingly, revenue from investments that receive tax credits and tax-exempt securities is presented in the managed results on a basis comparable to taxable investments and securities; the corresponding income tax impact related to tax-exempt items is recorded within income tax expense.
Trade-date and settlement-date: For financial instruments, the trade-date is the date that an order to purchase, sell or otherwise acquire an instrument is executed in the market. The trade-date may differ from the settlement-date, which is the date on which the actual transfer of a financial instrument between two parties is executed. The amount of time that passes between the trade-date and the settlement-date differs depending on the financial instrument. For repurchases under the common equity repurchase program, except where the trade-date is specified, the amounts disclosed are presented on a settlement-date basis. In the Capital Management section on pages 146–155, and where otherwise specified, repurchases under the common equity repurchase program are presented on a trade-date basis because the trade-date is used to calculate the Firm’s regulatory capital.
 
Troubled debt restructuring (“TDR”): A TDR is deemed to occur when the Firm modifies the original terms of a loan agreement by granting a concession to a borrower that is experiencing financial difficulty.
Unaudited: Financial statements and information that have not been subjected to auditing procedures sufficient to permit an independent certified public accountant to express an opinion.
U.S. GAAP: Accounting principles generally accepted in the U.S.
U.S. government-sponsored enterprise obligations: Obligations of agencies originally established or chartered by the U.S. government to serve public purposes as specified by the U.S. Congress; these obligations are not explicitly guaranteed as to the timely payment of principal and interest by the full faith and credit of the U.S. government.
U.S. Treasury: U.S. Department of the Treasury.
Value-at-risk (“VaR”): A measure of the dollar amount of potential loss from adverse market moves in an ordinary market environment.
Warehouse loans: Consist of prime mortgages originated with the intent to sell that are accounted for at fair value and classified as trading assets.
Washington Mutual transaction: On September 25, 2008, JPMorgan Chase acquired certain of the assets of the banking operations of Washington Mutual Bank (“Washington Mutual”) from the FDIC.


JPMorgan Chase & Co./2014 Annual Report
 
313

Distribution of assets, liabilities and stockholders’ equity; interest rates and interest differentials

Consolidated average balance sheet, interest and rates
Provided below is a summary of JPMorgan Chase's consolidated average balances, interest rates and interest differentials on a taxable-equivalent basis for the years 2012 through 2014. Income computed on a taxable-equivalent basis is the income reported in the Consolidated statements of income, adjusted to present interest income
 
and average rates earned on assets exempt from income taxes (primarily federal taxes) on a basis comparable with other taxable investments. The incremental tax rate used for calculating the taxable-equivalent adjustment was approximately 38% in 2014, 2013 and 2012. A substantial portion of JPMorgan Chase’s securities are taxable.

(Table continued on next page)
2014
Year ended December 31,
(Taxable-equivalent interest and rates; in millions, except rates)
Average
balance
 
Interest(e)
 
Average
rate
Assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits with banks
$
358,072

 
$
1,157

 
0.32
%
 
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements
230,489

 
1,642

 
0.71

 
Securities borrowed
116,540

 
(501
)
(f) 
(0.43
)
 
Trading assets
210,609

 
7,386

 
3.51

 
Taxable securities
318,970

 
7,617

 
2.39

 
Non-taxable securities(a)
34,359

 
2,158

 
6.28

 
Total securities
353,329

 
9,775

 
2.77

(h) 
Loans
739,175

 
32,394

(g) 
4.38

 
Other assets(b)
40,879

 
663

 
1.62

 
Total interest-earning assets
2,049,093

 
52,516

 
2.56

 
Allowance for loan losses
(15,418
)
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and due from banks
25,650

 
 
 
 
 
Trading assets – equity instruments
116,650

 
 
 
 
 
Trading assets – derivative receivables
67,123

 
 
 
 
 
Goodwill
48,029

 
 
 
 
 
Mortgage servicing rights
8,387

 
 
 
 
 
Other intangible assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Purchased credit card relationships
62

 
 
 
 
 
Other intangibles
1,316

 
 
 
 
 
Other assets
146,841

 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
$
2,447,733

 
 
 
 
 
Liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing deposits
$
868,838

 
$
1,633

 
0.19
%
 
Federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements
208,560

 
604

 
0.29

 
Commercial paper
59,916

 
134

 
0.22

 
Trading liabilities – debt, short-term and other liabilities(c)
220,137

 
712

 
0.32

 
Beneficial interests issued by consolidated VIEs
48,017

 
405

 
0.84

 
Long-term debt
270,269

 
4,409

 
1.63

 
Total interest-bearing liabilities
1,675,737

 
7,897

 
0.47

 
Noninterest-bearing deposits
395,463

 
 
 
 
 
Trading liabilities – equity instruments
16,246

 
 
 
 
 
Trading liabilities – derivative payables
54,758

 
 
 
 
 
All other liabilities, including the allowance for lending-related commitments
81,111

 
 
 
 
 
Total liabilities
2,223,315

 
 
 
 
 
Stockholders’ equity
 
 
 
 
 
 
Preferred stock
17,018

 
 
 
 
 
Common stockholders’ equity
207,400

 
 
 
 
 
Total stockholders’ equity
224,418

(d) 
 
 
 
 
Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
$
2,447,733

 
 
 
 
 
Interest rate spread
 
 
 
 
2.09
%
 
Net interest income and net yield on interest-earning assets
 
 
$
44,619

 
2.18

 
(a)
Represents securities which are tax exempt for U.S. Federal Income Tax purposes.
(b)
Includes margin loans.
(c)
Includes brokerage customer payables.
(d)
The ratio of average stockholders’ equity to average assets was 9.2% for 2014, 8.7% for 2013, and 8.5% for 2012. The return on average stockholders’ equity, based on net income, was 9.7% for 2014, 8.6% for 2013, and 11.1% for 2012.
(e)
Interest includes the effect of related hedging derivatives. Taxable-equivalent amounts are used where applicable.
(f)
Negative interest income and yield for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012, is the result of increased client-driven demand for certain securities combined with the impact of low interest rates; the offset of this stock borrow activity is reflected as lower net interest expense reported within short-term and other liabilities.
(g)
Fees and commissions on loans included in loan interest amounted to $1.1 billion in 2014, $1.3 billion in 2013, and $1.3 billion in 2012.
(h)
The annualized rate for securities based on amortized cost was 2.82% in 2014, 2.37% in 2013, and 2.35% in 2012, and does not give effect to changes in fair value that are reflected in accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss).
(i)
Prior period amounts and have been reclassified to conform with the current period presentation.

314
 
 


Within the Consolidated average balance sheets, interest and rates summary, the principal amounts of nonaccrual loans have been included in the average loan balances used to determine the average interest rate earned on loans. For additional information on nonaccrual loans, including interest accrued, see Note 14.


 


(Table continued from previous page)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2013
 
2012
Average
balance
 
 
Interest(e)
 
Average
rate
 
Average
balance
 
Interest(e)
 
Average
rate
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
268,968

 
 
$
918

 
0.34
%
 
 
$
118,463

 
$
555

 
0.47
%
 
231,567

 
 
1,940

 
0.84

 
 
239,703

 
2,442

 
1.02

 
118,300

 
 
(127
)
(f) 
(0.11
)
 
 
131,446

 
(3
)
(f) 

 
227,769

 
 
8,191

(i) 
3.60

(i) 
 
234,224

 
9,175

(i) 
3.92

(i) 
333,285

 
 
6,916

 
2.07

 
 
345,238

 
7,231

 
2.09

 
23,558

 
 
1,369

 
5.81

 
 
17,992

 
1,091

 
6.06

 
356,843

 
 
8,285

 
2.32

(h) 
 
363,230

 
8,322

 
2.29

(h) 
726,450

 
 
33,621

(g) 
4.63

 
 
722,384

 
35,946

(g) 
4.98

 
40,334

 
 
538

 
1.33

 
 
32,967

 
259

 
0.79

 
1,970,231

 
 
53,366

(i) 
2.71

(i) 
 
1,842,417

 
56,696

(i) 
3.08

(i) 
(19,819
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(24,906
)
 
 
 
 
 
35,919

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
51,410

 
 
 
 
 
112,680

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
115,113

 
 
 
 
 
72,629

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
85,744

 
 
 
 
 
48,102

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
48,176

 
 
 
 
 
8,840

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
7,133

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
214

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
470

 
 
 
 
 
1,736

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2,363

 
 
 
 
 
149,572

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
144,061

 
 
 
 
 
$
2,380,104

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
2,271,981

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
822,781

 
 
$
2,067

 
0.25
%
 
 
$
751,098

 
$
2,655

 
0.35
%
 
238,551

 
 
582

 
0.24

 
 
248,561

 
535

 
0.22

 
53,717

 
 
112

 
0.21

 
 
50,780

 
91

 
0.18

 
202,894

 
 
1,104

(i) 
0.54

(i) 
 
193,459

 
1,052

(i) 
0.54

(i) 
54,832

 
 
478

 
0.87

 
 
60,234

 
648

 
1.08

 
264,083

 
 
5,007

 
1.90

 
 
245,662

 
6,062

 
2.47

 
1,636,858

 
 
9,350

(i) 
0.57

(i) 
 
1,549,794

 
11,043

(i) 
0.71

(i) 
366,361

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
354,785

 
 
 
 
 
14,218

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
14,172

 
 
 
 
 
64,553

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
76,162

 
 
 
 
 
90,745

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
84,480

 
 
 
 
 
2,172,735

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2,079,393

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
10,960

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
8,236

 
 
 
 
 
196,409

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
184,352

 
 
 
 
 
207,369

 
(d) 
 
 
 
 
 
192,588

(d) 
 
 
 
 
$
2,380,104

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
2,271,981

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2.14
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
2.37
%
 
 
 
 
$
44,016

 
2.23

 
 
 
 
$
45,653

 
2.48

 

 
 
315

Interest rates and interest differential analysis of net interest income – U.S. and non-U.S.


Presented below is a summary of interest rates and interest differentials segregated between U.S. and non-U.S. operations for the years 2012 through 2014. The segregation of U.S. and non-U.S. components is based on
 
the location of the office recording the transaction. Intracompany funding generally comprises dollar-denominated deposits originated in various locations that are centrally managed by JPMorgan Chase’s Treasury unit.

(Table continued on next page)
 
 
 
 
 
 
2014
Year ended December 31,
(Taxable-equivalent interest and rates; in millions, except rates)
Average balance
Interest
 
Average rate
Interest-earning assets
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits with banks:
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
$
328,145

$
825

 
0.25
%
 
Non-U.S.
29,927

332

 
1.11

 
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements:
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
125,812

719

 
0.57

 
Non-U.S.
104,677

923

 
0.88

 
Securities borrowed:
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
77,228

(573
)
(b) 
(0.74
)
 
Non-U.S.
39,312

72

 
0.18

 
Trading assets – debt instruments:
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
109,678

4,045

 
3.69

 
Non-U.S.
100,931

3,341

 
3.31

 
Securities:
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
193,856

6,586

 
3.40

 
Non-U.S.
159,473

3,189

 
2.00

 
Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
635,846

30,165

 
4.74

 
Non-U.S.
103,329

2,229

 
2.16

 
Other assets, predominantly U.S.
40,879

663

 
1.62

 
Total interest-earning assets
2,049,093

52,516

 
2.56

 
Interest-bearing liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing deposits:
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
620,708

813

 
0.13

 
Non-U.S.
248,130

820

 
0.33

 
Federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements:
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
146,025

130

(c) 
0.09

(c) 
Non-U.S.
62,535

474

 
0.76

 
Trading liabilities - debt, short-term and other liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
194,771

(284
)
(b) 
(0.15
)
 
Non-U.S.
85,282

1,130

 
1.33

 
Beneficial interests issued by consolidated VIEs, predominantly U.S.
48,017

405

 
0.84

 
Long-term debt:
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
257,181

4,366

 
1.70

 
Non-U.S.
13,088

43

 
0.33

 
Intracompany funding:
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
(122,467
)
(176
)
 

 
Non-U.S.
122,467

176

 

 
Total interest-bearing liabilities
1,675,737

7,897

 
0.47

 
Noninterest-bearing liabilities(a)
373,356

 
 
 
 
Total investable funds
$
2,049,093

$
7,897

 
0.39
%
 
Net interest income and net yield:
 
$
44,619

 
2.18
%
 
U.S.
 
37,018

 
2.46

 
Non-U.S.
 
7,601

 
1.39

 
Percentage of total assets and liabilities attributable to non-U.S. operations:
 
 
 
 
 
Assets
 
 
 
28.9

 
Liabilities
 
 
 
22.6

 
(a)
Represents the amount of noninterest-bearing liabilities funding interest-earning assets.
(b)
Negative interest income and yield, for the years ended December 31, 2014, 2013 and 2012 is a result of increased client-driven demand for certain securities combined with the impact of low interest rates; the offset of this stock borrow activity is reflected as lower net interest expense reported within trading liabilities - debt, short-term and other liabilities.
(c)
Reflects a benefit from the favorable market environments for dollar-roll financings.
(d)
Prior period amounts have been reclassified to conform with the current period presentation.

316
 
 


U.S. net interest income was $37.0 billion in 2014, a increase of $1.5 billion from the prior year. Net interest income from non-U.S. operations was $7.6 billion for 2014, a decrease of $902 million from $8.5 billion in 2013.
 
For further information, see the “Net interest income” discussion in Consolidated Results of Operations on pages 68–71.


(Table continued from previous page)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
2013
 
2012
 
Average balance
Interest
 
Average rate
 
 
Average balance
Interest
 
Average rate
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
$
233,850

$
572

 
0.24
%
 
 
$
79,992

$
168

 
0.21
%
 
35,118

346

 
0.99

 
 
38,471

387

 
1.01

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
129,600

793

 
0.61

 
 
137,874

872

 
0.63

 
101,967

1,147

 
1.13

 
 
101,829

1,570

 
1.54

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
69,377

(376
)
(b) 
(0.54
)
 
 
70,084

(407
)
(b) 
(0.58
)
 
48,923

249

 
0.51

 
 
61,362

404

 
0.66

 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
120,985

4,301

(d) 
3.56

(d) 
 
119,854

4,562

(d) 
3.81

(d) 
106,784

3,890

(d) 
3.64

(d) 
 
114,370

4,613

(d) 
4.03

(d) 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
170,473

4,795

 
2.81

 
 
161,727

3,991

 
2.47

 
186,370

3,490

 
1.87

 
 
201,503

4,331

 
2.15

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
617,043

31,235

 
5.06

 
 
620,615

33,167

 
5.34

 
109,407

2,386

 
2.18

 
 
101,769

2,779

 
2.73

 
40,334

538

 
1.33

 
 
32,967

259

 
0.79

 
1,970,231

53,366

(d) 
2.71

(d) 
 
1,842,417

56,696

(d) 
3.08

(d) 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
582,282

1,067

 
0.18

 
 
512,589

1,345

 
0.26

 
240,499

1,000

 
0.42

 
 
238,509

1,310

 
0.55

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
161,256

103

(c) 
0.06

(c) 
 
181,460

4

(c) 

(c) 
77,295

479

 
0.62

 
 
67,101

531

 
0.79

 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
176,870

5

(b)(d) 

(d) 
 
176,755

(150
)
(b)(d) 
(0.08
)
(d) 
79,741

1,211

(d) 
1.52

(d) 
 
67,484

1,293

(d) 
1.92

(d) 
54,832

478

 
0.87

 
 
60,234

648

 
1.08

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
250,957

4,949

 
1.97

 
 
230,101

5,998

 
2.61

 
13,126

58

 
0.45

 
 
15,561

64

 
0.41

 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(181,109
)
(339
)
 

 
 
(253,906
)
(551
)
 

 
181,109

339

 

 
 
253,906

551

 

 
1,636,858

9,350

(d) 
0.57

(d) 
 
1,549,794

11,043

(d) 
0.71

(d) 
333,373

 
 
 
 
 
292,623

 
 
 
 
$
1,970,231

$
9,350

(d) 
0.47
%
(d) 
 
$
1,842,417

$
11,043

(d) 
0.60
%
(d) 
 
44,016

 
2.23
%
 
 
 
45,653

 
2.48
%
 
 
35,492

 
2.59

 
 
 
35,353

 
2.91

 
 
8,524

 
1.42

 
 
 
10,300

 
1.65

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
32.6

 
 
 
 
 
36.2

 
 
 
 
23.5

 
 
 
 
 
23.4

 


 
 
317

Changes in net interest income, volume and rate analysis


The table below presents an analysis of the effect on net interest income of volume and rate changes for the periods 2014 versus 2013 and 2013 versus 2012. In this analysis, when the change cannot be isolated to either volume or rate, it has been allocated to volume.
 
2014 versus 2013
 
2013 versus 2012
 
 
Increase/(decrease) due to change in:
 
 
 
Increase/(decrease) due to change in:
 
 
 
Year ended December 31,
(On a taxable-equivalent basis: in millions)
Volume
 
Rate
 
Net
change
 
Volume
 
Rate
 
Net
change
 
Interest-earning assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Deposits with banks:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
$
230

 
$
23

 
$
253

 
$
380

 
$
24

 
$
404

 
Non-U.S.
(56
)
 
42

 
(14
)
 
(33
)
 
(8
)
 
(41
)
 
Federal funds sold and securities purchased under resale agreements:
 
 
 
 
 
 

 

 
 
 
U.S.
(22
)
 
(52
)
 
(74
)
 
(51
)
 
(28
)
 
(79
)
 
Non-U.S.
31

 
(255
)
 
(224
)
 
(6
)
 
(417
)
 
(423
)
 
Securities borrowed:
 
 
 
 
 
 

 

 
 
 
U.S.
(58
)
 
(139
)
 
(197
)
 
3

 
28

 
31

 
Non-U.S.
(16
)
 
(161
)
 
(177
)
 
(63
)
 
(92
)
 
(155
)
 
Trading assets – debt instruments:
 
 
 
 
 
 

 

 
 
 
U.S.
(413
)
 
157

 
(256
)
 
34

(a) 
(295
)
(a) 
(261
)
(a) 
Non-U.S.
(197
)
 
(352
)
 
(549
)
 
(273
)
(a) 
(450
)
(a) 
(723
)
(a) 
Securities:
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
785

 
1,006

 
1,791

 
254

 
550

 
804

 
Non-U.S.
(543
)
 
242

 
(301
)
 
(277
)
 
(564
)
 
(841
)
 
Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
U.S.
905

 
(1,975
)
 
(1,070
)
 
(194
)
 
(1,738
)
 
(1,932
)
 
Non-U.S.
(135
)
 
(22
)
 
(157
)
 
167

 
(560
)
 
(393
)
 
Other assets, predominantly U.S.
8

 
117

 
125

 
101

 
178

 
279

 
Change in interest income
519

 
(1,369
)
 
(850
)
 
42

(a) 
(3,372
)
(a) 
(3,330
)
(a) 
Interest-bearing liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing deposits:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
37

 
(291
)
 
(254
)
 
132

 
(410
)
 
(278
)
 
Non-U.S.
36

 
(216
)
 
(180
)
 

 
(310
)
 
(310
)
 
Federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements:
 
 
 
 
 
 

 

 
 
 
U.S.
(21
)
 
48

 
27

 
(10
)
 
109

 
99

 
Non-U.S.
(113
)
 
108

 
(5
)
 
62

 
(114
)
 
(52
)
 
Trading liabilities - debt, short-term and other liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
U.S.
(27
)
 
(262
)
 
(289
)
 
(5
)
(a) 
160

(a) 
155

(a) 
Non-U.S.
71

 
(152
)
 
(81
)
 
185

(a) 
(267
)
(a) 
(82
)
(a) 
Beneficial interests issued by consolidated VIEs, predominantly U.S.
(57
)
 
(16
)
 
(73
)
 
(44
)
 
(126
)
 
(170
)
 
Long-term debt:
 
 
 
 
 
 


 


 


 
U.S.
95

 
(678
)
 
(583
)
 
424

 
(1,473
)
 
(1,049
)
 
Non-U.S.
1

 
(16
)
 
(15
)
 
(12
)
 
6

 
(6
)
 
Intercompany funding:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
72

 
91

 
163

 
136

 
76

 
212

 
Non-U.S.
(72
)
 
(91
)
 
(163
)
 
(136
)
 
(76
)
 
(212
)
 
Change in interest expense
22

 
(1,475
)
 
(1,453
)
 
732

(a) 
(2,425
)
(a) 
(1,693
)
(a) 
Change in net interest income
$
497

 
$
106

 
$
603

 
$
(690
)
(a) 
$
(947
)
(a) 
$
(1,637
)
 
(a) Prior period amounts have been reclassified to conform with the current period presentation.


318
 
 

Securities portfolio


For information regarding the securities portfolio as of December 31, 2014 and 2013, and for the years ended December 31, 2014 and 2013, see Note 12. For the available–for–sale securities portfolio, at December 31, 2012, the fair value and amortized cost of U.S. Treasury and government agency obligations was $110.5 billion and $105.7 billion, respectively; the fair value and amortized cost of all other available–for–sale securities was $260.6 billion and $254.2 billion, respectively; and the total fair value and amortized cost of the total available–for–sale securities portfolio was $371.1 billion and $359.9 billion respectively.
At December 31, 2012, the fair value and amortized cost of U.S. Treasury and government agency obligations in the held-to-maturity securities portfolio was $8 million and $7 million, respectively. There were no other held-to-maturity securities at December 31, 2012.



 
 
319

Loan portfolio

The table below presents loans by portfolio segment and loan class that are presented in Credit Risk Management on page 112, pages 113–119 and page 120, and in Note 14, at the periods indicated.
December 31, (in millions)
2014
2013
2012
2011
2010
U.S. consumer, excluding credit card loans
 
 
 
 
 
Home equity
$
69,837

$
76,790

$
88,356

$
100,497

$
112,844

Mortgage
139,973

129,008

123,277

128,709

134,284

Auto
54,536

52,757

49,913

47,426

48,367

Other
31,028

30,508

31,074

31,795

32,123

Total U.S. consumer, excluding credit card loans
295,374

289,063

292,620

308,427

327,618

Credit card Loans
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. credit card loans
129,067

125,308

125,277

129,587

134,781

Non-U.S. credit card loans
1,981

2,483

2,716

2,690

2,895

Total credit card loans
131,048

127,791

127,993

132,277

137,676

Total consumer loans
426,422

416,854

420,613

440,704

465,294

U.S. wholesale loans
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
78,664

79,436

77,900

65,958

50,912

Real estate
77,022

67,815

59,369

53,230

51,734

Financial institutions
13,735

11,087

10,708

8,489

12,120

Government agencies
7,574

8,316

7,962

7,236

6,408

Other
49,846

48,158

50,948

52,126

38,298

Total U.S. wholesale loans
226,841

214,812

206,887

187,039

159,472

Non-U.S. wholesale loans
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
34,782

36,447

36,674

31,108

19,053

Real estate
2,224

1,621

1,757

1,748

1,973

Financial institutions
21,099

22,813

26,564

30,262

20,043

Government agencies
1,122

2,146

1,586

583

870

Other
44,846

43,725

39,715

32,276

26,222

Total non-U.S. wholesale loans
104,073

106,752

106,296

95,977

68,161

Total wholesale loans
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
113,446

115,883

114,574

97,066

69,965

Real estate
79,246

69,436

61,126

54,978

53,707

Financial institutions
34,834

33,900

37,272

38,751

32,163

Government agencies
8,696

10,462

9,548

7,819

7,278

Other
94,692

91,883

90,663

84,402

64,520

Total wholesale loans
330,914

321,564

313,183

283,016

227,633

Total loans(a)
$
757,336

$
738,418

$
733,796

$
723,720

$
692,927

Memo:
 
 
 
 
 
Loans held-for-sale
$
7,217

$
12,230

$
4,406

$
2,626

$
5,453

Loans at fair value
2,611

2,011

2,555

2,097

1,976

Total loans held-for-sale and loans at fair value
$
9,828

$
14,241

$
6,961

$
4,723

$
7,429

(a)
Loans (other than purchased credit-impaired loans and those for which the fair value option have been elected) are presented net of unearned income, unamortized discounts and premiums, and net deferred loan costs of $1.3 billion, $1.9 billion, $2.5 billion, $2.7 billion and $1.9 billion at December 31, 2014, 2013, 2012, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

320
 
 


Maturities and sensitivity to changes in interest rates
The table below sets forth, at December 31, 2014, wholesale loan maturity and distribution between fixed and floating interest rates based on the stated terms of the loan agreements. The table below also presents loans by loan class that are presented in Wholesale credit portfolio on pages 120–127 and Note 14. The table does not include the impact of derivative instruments.
December 31, 2014 (in millions)
Within
1 year (a)
1-5
years
After 5
years
Total
U.S.
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
$
13,106

$
52,053

$
13,505

$
78,664

Real estate
5,238

18,523

53,261

77,022

Financial institutions
7,015

6,229

491

13,735

Government agencies
970

2,411

4,193

7,574

Other
20,897

27,272

1,677

49,846

Total U.S.
47,226

106,488

73,127

226,841

Non-U.S.
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
12,329

16,644

5,809

34,782

Real estate
781

1,324

119

2,224

Financial institutions
16,805

3,947

347

21,099

Government agencies
29

320

773

1,122

Other
35,571

8,707

568

44,846

Total non-U.S.
65,515

30,942

7,616

104,073

Total wholesale loans
$
112,741

$
137,430

$
80,743

$
330,914

Loans at fixed interest rates
 
$
10,387

$
54,847

 
Loans at variable interest rates
 
127,043

25,896

 
Total wholesale loans
 
$
137,430

$
80,743

 
(a)
Includes demand loans and overdrafts.
Risk elements
The following tables set forth nonperforming assets, contractually past-due assets, and accruing restructured loans by portfolio segment and loan class that are presented in Credit Risk Management on page 112, pages 113–114 and page 120, at the periods indicated.
December 31, (in millions)
2014
2013
2012
2011
2010
Nonperforming assets
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. nonaccrual loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer, excluding credit card loans
$
6,509

$
7,496

$
9,174

$
7,411

$
8,833

Credit card loans


1

1

2

Total U.S. nonaccrual consumer loans
6,509

7,496

9,175

7,412

8,835

Wholesale:
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
184

317

702

936

1,745

Real estate
237

338

520

886

2,390

Financial institutions
12

19

60

76

111

Government agencies

1




Other
59

97

153

234

267

Total U.S. wholesale nonaccrual loans
492

772

1,435

2,132

4,513

Total U.S. nonaccrual loans
7,001

8,268

10,610

9,544

13,348

Non-U.S. nonaccrual loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer, excluding credit card loans





Credit card loans





Total non-U.S. nonaccrual consumer loans





Wholesale:
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
21

116

131

79

234

Real estate
23

88

89


585

Financial institutions
7

8



30

Government agencies


5

16

22

Other
81

60

57

354

622

Total non-U.S. wholesale nonaccrual loans
132

272

282

449

1,493

Total non-U.S. nonaccrual loans
132

272

282

449

1,493

Total nonaccrual loans
7,133

8,540

10,892

9,993

14,841

Derivative receivables
275

415

239

297

159

Assets acquired in loan satisfactions
559

751

775

1,025

1,682

Nonperforming assets
$
7,967

$
9,706

$
11,906

$
11,315

$
16,682

Memo:
 
 
 
 
 
Loans held-for-sale
$
95

$
26

$
18

$
110

$
341

Loans at fair value(a)
21

197

265

73

155

Total loans held-for-sale and loans at fair value
$
116

$
223

$
283

$
183

$
496

(a)
In 2013 certain loans that resulted from restructurings that were previously classified as performing were reclassified as nonperforming loans. Prior periods were revised to conform with the current presentation.


 
 
321


December 31, (in millions)
2014
2013
2012
2011
2010
Contractually past-due loans(a)
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer, excluding credit card loans
$
367

$
428

$
525

$
551

$
625

Credit card loans
893

997

1,268

1,867

3,015

Total U.S. consumer loans
1,260

1,425

1,793

2,418

3,640

Wholesale:
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
14

14

19


7

Real estate
33

14

69

84

109

Financial institutions


6

2

2

Government agencies





Other
26

16

30

6

171

Total U.S. wholesale loans
73

44

124

92

289

Total U.S. loans
1,333

1,469

1,917

2,510

3,929

Non-U.S. loans:
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer, excluding credit card loans





Credit card loans
2

25

34

36

38

Total non-U.S. consumer loans
2

25

34

36

38

Wholesale:
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial





Real estate





Financial institutions

6




Government agencies





Other
3


14

8

70

Total non-U.S. wholesale loans
3

6

14

8

70

Total non-U.S. loans
5

31

48

44

108

Total contractually past due loans
$
1,338

$
1,500

$
1,965

$
2,554

$
4,037

(a)
Represents accruing loans past-due 90 days or more as to principal and interest, which are not characterized as nonaccrual loans.


December 31, (in millions)
2014
2013
2012
2011
2010
Accruing restructured loans(a)
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.:
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer, excluding credit card loans
$
7,814

$
9,173

$
9,033

$
7,310

$
4,256

Credit card loans(b)
2,029

3,115

4,762

7,214

10,005

Total U.S. consumer loans
9,843

12,288

13,795

14,524

14,261

Wholesale:
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
10


29

68


Real estate
31

27

7

48

76

Financial institutions



2


Other
1

3


6


Total U.S. wholesale loans
42

30

36

124

76

Total U.S.
9,885

12,318

13,831

14,648

14,337

Non-U.S.:
 
 
 
 
 
Consumer, excluding credit card loans





Credit card loans(b)





Total non-U.S. consumer loans





Wholesale:
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial


24

48

49

Real estate





Other





Total non-U.S. wholesale loans


24

48

49

Total non-U.S.


24

48

49

Total accruing restructured notes
$
9,885

$
12,318

$
13,855

$
14,696

$
14,386

(a)
Represents performing loans modified in troubled debt restructurings in which an economic concession was granted by the Firm and the borrower has demonstrated its ability to repay the loans according to the terms of the restructuring. As defined in U.S. GAAP, concessions include the reduction of interest rates or the deferral of interest or principal payments, resulting from deterioration in the borrowers’ financial condition. Excludes nonaccrual assets and contractually past-due assets, which are included in the sections above.
(b)
Includes credit card loans that have been modified in a troubled debt restructuring.

For a discussion of nonaccrual loans, past-due loan accounting policies, and accruing restructured loans see Credit Risk Management on pages 110–111, and Note 14.

322
 
 


Impact of nonaccrual loans and accruing restructured loans on interest income
The negative impact on interest income from nonaccrual loans represents the difference between the amount of interest income that would have been recorded on such nonaccrual loans according to their original contractual terms had they been performing and the amount of interest that actually was recognized on a cash basis. The negative impact on interest income from accruing restructured loans represents the difference between the amount of interest income that would have been recorded on such loans according to their original contractual terms and the amount of interest that actually was recognized under the modified terms. The following table sets forth this data for the years specified. The change in foregone interest income from 2012 through 2014 was primarily driven by the change in the levels of nonaccrual loans.
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
2014
2013
2012
Nonaccrual loans
 
 
 
U.S.:
 
 
 
Consumer, excluding credit card:
 
 
 
Gross amount of interest that would have been recorded at the original terms
$
563

$
719

$
804

Interest that was recognized in income
(268
)
(298
)
(302
)
Total U.S. consumer, excluding credit card
295

421

502

Credit card:
 
 
 
Gross amount of interest that would have been recorded at the original terms



Interest that was recognized in income



Total U.S. credit card



Total U.S. consumer
295

421

502

Wholesale:
 
 
 
Gross amount of interest that would have been recorded at the original terms
28

29

54

Interest that was recognized in income
(9
)
(9
)
(4
)
Total U.S. wholesale
19

20

50

Negative impact - U.S.
314

441

552

Non-U.S.:
 
 
 
Consumer, excluding credit card:
 
 
 
Gross amount of interest that would have been recorded at the original terms



Interest that was recognized in income



Total non-U.S. consumer, excluding credit card



Credit card:
 
 
 
Gross amount of interest that would have been recorded at the original terms



Interest that was recognized in income



Total non-U.S. credit card



Total non-U.S. consumer



Wholesale: (a)
 
 
 
Gross amount of interest that would have been recorded at the original terms
7

36

14

Interest that was recognized in income



Total non-U.S. wholesale
7

36

14

Negative impact — non-U.S.
7

36

14

Total negative impact on interest income
$
321

$
477

$
566

(a)
During 2013, certain loans that resulted from restructurings that were previously classified as performing were reclassified as nonperforming loans. The gross amount of interest that would have been recorded at the original terms has been adjusted accordingly. Prior periods were revised to conform with the current presentation.

 
 
323


Year ended December 31, (in millions)
2014
2013
2012
Accruing restructured loans
 
 
 
U.S.:
 
 
 
Consumer, excluding credit card:
 
 
 
Gross amount of interest that would have been recorded at the original terms
$
629

$
758

$
729

Interest that was recognized in income
(339
)
(395
)
(417
)
Total U.S. consumer, excluding credit card
290

363

312

Credit card:
 
 
 
Gross amount of interest that would have been recorded at the original terms
377

602

805

Interest that was recognized in income
(123
)
(198
)
(308
)
Total U.S. credit card
254

404

497

Total U.S. consumer
544

767

809

Wholesale:(a)
 
 
 
Gross amount of interest that would have been recorded at the original terms

1

1

Interest that was recognized in income

(1
)
(2
)
Total U.S. wholesale


(1
)
Negative impact — U.S.
544

767

808

Non-U.S.:
 
 
 
Consumer, excluding credit card:
 
 
 
Gross amount of interest that would have been recorded at the original terms



Interest that was recognized in income



Total non-U.S. consumer, excluding credit card



Credit card:
 
 
 
Gross amount of interest that would have been recorded at the original terms



Interest that was recognized in income



Total non-U.S. credit card



Total non-U.S. consumer



Wholesale:(a)
 
 
 
Gross amount of interest that would have been recorded at the original terms


1

Interest that was recognized in income


(1
)
Total non-U.S. wholesale



Negative impact — non-U.S.



Total negative impact on interest income
$
544

$
767

$
808

(a)
Predominantly real estate-related.


324
 
 


Cross-border outstandings
Cross-border disclosure is based on the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council’s (“FFIEC”) guidelines governing the determination of cross-border risk.
The reporting of country exposure under the FFIEC bank regulatory requirements provides information on the distribution, by country and sector, of claims on, and liabilities to, foreign residents held by U.S. banks and bank holding companies and is used by the regulatory agencies to determine the presence of credit and related risks,
 
including transfer and country risk. Country location under the FFIEC bank regulatory reporting is based on where the entity or counterparty is legally established.
JPMorgan Chase’s total cross-border exposure tends to fluctuate greatly, and the amount of exposure at year-end tends to be a function of timing rather than representing a consistent trend. For a further discussion of JPMorgan Chase’s country risk exposure, see Country Risk Management on pages 137–138.


The following table lists all countries in which JPMorgan Chase’s cross-border outstandings exceed 0.75% of consolidated assets as of the dates specified.
Cross-border outstandings exceeding 0.75% of total assets(a)(b)
(in millions)
December 31,
Governments
Banks
Other(c)
Net local
country
assets
Total cross-border outstandings(d)
Commitments(e)
Total exposure
Cayman Islands
2014
$
2

$
199

$
67,810

$
115

$
68,126

$
25,886

$
94,012

 
2013
9

232

70,006


70,247

21,928

92,175

 
2012
234

35

68,588


68,857

2,645

71,502

France
2014
$
13,544

$
8,670

$
23,254

$
2,222

$
47,690

$
188,703

$
236,393

 
2013
10,512

12,448

38,415

2,486

63,861

235,173

299,034

 
2012
10,706

18,979

26,796

1,714

58,195

91,632

149,827

Japan
2014
$
522

$
11,211

$
3,922

$
24,257

$
39,912

$
67,480

$
107,392

 
2013
957

16,286

12,972

30,811

61,026

60,310

121,336

 
2012
2,016

30,616

7,708

23,680

64,020

57,023

121,043

Germany
2014
$
22,772

$
4,524

$
8,522

$

$
35,818

$
173,121

$
208,939

 
2013
25,514

4,078

7,057


36,649

214,375

251,024

 
2012
11,376

21,944

11,674

321

45,315

92,597

137,912

Netherlands
2014
$
1,551

$
3,157

$
24,792

$

$
29,500

$
86,039

$
115,539

 
2013
1,024

4,349

32,765


38,138

97,797

135,935

 
2012
48

5,947

36,625


42,620

41,481

84,101

Italy
2014
$
14,297

$
5,293

$
5,221

$
550

$
25,361

$
128,269

$
153,630

 
2013
10,302

4,440

5,643

1,524

21,909

135,711

157,620

 
2012
9,939

3,703

2,786

1,254

17,682

73,190

90,872

Brazil
2014
$
2,650

$
2,874

$
5,258

$
7,804

$
18,586

$
10,644

$
29,230

 
2013
2,332

3,521

4,899

4,384

15,136

10,148

25,284

 
2012
4,951

4,373

6,456

9,463

25,243

8,841

34,084

Ireland
2014
$
131

$
4,007

$
13,613

$

$
17,751

$
12,734

$
30,485

 
2013
99

4,175

13,878


18,152

11,709

29,861

 
2012
97

2,818

12,598


15,513

8,912

24,425

Spain
2014
$
1,887

$
6,290

$
4,458

$
79

$
12,714

$
71,501

$
84,215

 
2013
2,549

9,332

9,543

217

21,641

80,137

101,778

 
2012
1,204

8,458

6,643

129

16,434

46,299

62,733

Switzerland
2014
$
28

$
1,417

$
3,291

$
660

$
5,396

$
71,900

$
77,296

 
2013
73

1,419

4,657

11,587

17,736

88,530

106,266

 
2012
103

4,196

3,638

13,874

21,811

32,408

54,219

(a)
Prior periods were revised to conform with the current presentation.
(b)
Excluded from the table is $915.5 billion at December 31, 2012, substantially all of which represent notional amounts related to credit protection sold on indices representing baskets of exposures from multiple European countries, which had previously been reported within the U.K. Effective with the fourth quarter of 2013, these exposures are reported within individual countries as required by revised regulatory guidance.
(c)
Consists primarily of commercial and industrial.
(d)
Outstandings includes loans and accrued interest receivable, interest-bearing deposits with banks, acceptances, resale agreements, other monetary assets, cross-border trading debt and equity instruments, fair value of foreign exchange and derivative contracts, and local country assets, net of local country liabilities. The amounts associated with foreign exchange and derivative contracts are presented after taking into account the impact of legally enforceable master netting agreements.
(e)
Commitments include outstanding letters of credit, undrawn commitments to extend credit, and the gross notional value of credit derivatives where JPMorgan Chase is a protection seller.

 
 
325

Summary of loan and lending-related commitments loss experience

The tables below summarize the changes in the allowance for loan losses and the allowance for lending-related commitments during the periods indicated. For a further discussion, see Allowance for credit losses on pages 128–130, and Note 15.
Allowance for loan losses
 
 
 
 
 
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
2014
2013
2012
2011
2010
Balance at beginning of year
$
16,264

$
21,936

$
27,609

$
32,266

$
31,602

U.S. charge-offs
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. consumer, excluding credit card
2,132

2,754

4,805

5,419

8,383

U.S. credit card
3,682

4,358

5,624

8,017

15,247

Total U.S. consumer charge-offs
5,814

7,112

10,429

13,436

23,630

U.S. wholesale:
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
44

150

131

197

467

Real estate
14

51

114

221

698

Financial institutions
14

1

8

102

146

Government agencies
25

1



3

Other
22

9

56

149

102

Total U.S. wholesale charge-offs
119

212

309

669

1,416

Total U.S. charge-offs
5,933

7,324

10,738

14,105

25,046

Non-U.S. charge-offs
 
 
 
 
 
Non-U.S. consumer, excluding credit card





Non-U.S. credit card
149

114

131

151

163

Total non-U.S. consumer charge-offs
149

114

131

151

163

Non-U.S. wholesale:
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
27

5

8

1

23

Real estate
4

11

6

142

239

Financial institutions



6


Government agencies


4



Other
1

13

19

98

311

Total non-U.S. wholesale charge-offs
32

29

37

247

573

Total non-U.S. charge-offs
181

143

168

398

736

Total charge-offs
6,114

7,467

10,906

14,503

25,782

U.S. recoveries
 
 
 
 
 
U.S. consumer, excluding credit card
(814
)
(847
)
(508
)
(547
)
(474
)
U.S. credit card
(383
)
(568
)
(782
)
(1,211
)
(1,345
)
Total U.S. consumer recoveries
(1,197
)
(1,415
)
(1,290
)
(1,758
)
(1,819
)
U.S. wholesale:
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial
(49
)
(27
)
(335
)
(60
)
(86
)
Real estate
(27
)
(56
)
(64
)
(93
)
(75
)
Financial institutions
(12
)
(90
)
(37
)
(207
)
(74
)
Government agencies


(2
)

(1
)
Other
(36
)
(6
)
(21
)
(36
)
(25
)
Total U.S. Wholesale recoveries
(124
)
(179
)
(459
)
(396
)
(261
)
Total U.S. recoveries
(1,321
)
(1,594
)
(1,749
)
(2,154
)
(2,080
)
Non-U.S. recoveries
 
 
 
 
 
Non-U.S. consumer, excluding credit card





Non-U.S. credit card
(19
)
(25
)
(29
)
(32
)
(28
)
Total non-U.S. consumer recoveries
(19
)
(25
)
(29
)
(32
)
(28
)
Non-U.S. wholesale:
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial and industrial

(29
)
(16
)
(14
)
(1
)
Real estate


(2
)
(14
)

Financial institutions
(14
)
(10
)
(7
)
(38
)

Government agencies





Other
(1
)
(7
)
(40
)
(14
)

Total non-U.S. wholesale recoveries
(15
)
(46
)
(65
)
(80
)
(1
)
Total non-U.S. recoveries
(34
)
(71
)
(94
)
(112
)
(29
)
Total recoveries
(1,355
)
(1,665
)
(1,843
)
(2,266
)
(2,109
)
Net charge-offs
4,759

5,802

9,063

12,237

23,673

Write-offs of PCI loans(a)
533

53




Provision for loan losses
3,224

188

3,387

7,612

16,822

Change in accounting principles(b)




7,494

Other
(11
)
(5
)
3

(32
)
21

Balance at year-end
$
14,185

$
16,264

$
21,936

$
27,609

$
32,266

(a)
Write-offs of PCI loans are recorded against the allowance for loan losses when actual losses for a pool exceed estimated losses that were recorded as purchase accounting adjustments at the time of acquisition. A write-off of a PCI loan is recognized when the underlying loan is removed from a pool (e.g., upon liquidation). During the fourth quarter of 2014, the Firm recorded a $291 million adjustment to reduce the PCI allowance and the recorded investment in the Firm’s PCI loan portfolio, primarily reflecting the cumulative effect of interest forgiveness modifications. This adjustment had no impact to the Firm’s Consolidated statements of income.
(b)
Effective January 1, 2010, the Firm adopted accounting guidance related to variable interest entities (“VIEs”). Upon adoption of the guidance, the Firm consolidated its Firm-sponsored credit card securitization trusts, its Firm-administered multi-seller conduits and certain other consumer loan securitization entities, primarily mortgage-related. As a result, $7.4 billion, $14 million and $127 million, respectively, of allowance for loan losses were recorded on-balance sheet with the consolidation of these entities.

326
 
 


Allowance for lending-related commitments
Year ended December 31, (in millions)
2014
2013
2012
2011
2010
Balance at beginning of year
$
705

$
668

$
673

$
717

$
939

Provision for lending-related commitments
(85
)
37

(2
)
(38
)
(183
)
Net charge-offs





Change in accounting principles(a)




(18
)
Other
2


(3
)
(6
)
(21
)
Balance at year-end
$
622

$
705

$
668

$
673

$
717

(a)
Relates to the adoption of the new accounting guidance related to VIEs.

Loan loss analysis
 
 
 
 
 
As of or for the year ended December 31,
(in millions, except ratios)
2014
2013
2012
2011
2010
Balances
 
 
 
 
 
Loans – average
$
739,175

$
726,450

$
722,384

$
693,523

$
703,540

Loans – year-end
757,336

738,418

733,796

723,720

692,927

Net charge-offs(a)
4,759

5,802

9,063

12,237

23,673

Allowance for loan losses:
 
 
 
 
 
U.S.
$
13,472

$
15,382

$
20,946

$
26,621

$
31,111

Non-U.S.
713

882

990

988

1,155

Total allowance for loan losses
$
14,185

$
16,264

$
21,936

$
27,609

$
32,266

Nonaccrual loans
$
7,133

$
8,540

$
10,892

$
9,993

$
14,841

Ratios
 
 
 
 
 
Net charge-offs to:
 
 
 
 
 
Loans retained – average
0.65
%
0.81
%
1.26
%
1.78
%
3.39
%
Allowance for loan losses
33.55

35.67

41.32

44.32

73.37

Allowance for loan losses to:
 
 
 
 
 
Loans retained – year-end(b)
1.90

2.25

3.02

3.84

4.71

Nonaccrual loans retained
202

196

207

281

225

(a)
There were no net charge-offs/(recoveries) on lending-related commitments in 2014, 2013, 2012, 2011 or 2010.
(b)
The allowance for loan losses as a percentage of retained loans declined from 2010 to 2014, due to an improvement in credit quality of the consumer and wholesale credit portfolios. For a more detailed discussion of the 2012 through 2014 provision for credit losses, see Provision for credit losses on page 130.

 
 
327



Deposits
The following table provides a summary of the average balances and average interest rates of JPMorgan Chase’s various deposits for the years indicated.
Year ended December 31,
Average balances
 
Average interest rates
(in millions, except interest rates)
2014

 
2013

 
2012

 
2014

 
2013

 
2012

U.S. offices
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Noninterest-bearing
$
376,947

 
$
346,765

 
$
338,652

 
%
 
%
 
%
Interest-bearing
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Demand
75,553

 
63,045

 
43,124

 
0.10

 
0.09

 
0.08

Savings
459,186

 
429,289

 
383,777

 
0.10

 
0.13

 
0.18

Time
86,007

 
89,948

 
85,688

 
0.35

 
0.51

 
0.74

Total interest-bearing deposits
620,746

 
582,282

 
512,589

 
0.13

 
0.18

 
0.26

Total deposits in U.S. offices
997,693

 
929,047

 
851,241

 
0.08

 
0.11

 
0.16

Non-U.S. offices
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Noninterest-bearing
18,516

 
19,596

 
16,133

 

 

 

Interest-bearing
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Demand
208,364

 
196,300

 
184,366

 
0.22

 
0.22

 
0.35

Savings
2,179

 
1,374

 
846

 
0.13

 
0.11

 
0.23

Time
37,549

 
42,825

 
53,297

 
0.97

 
1.32

 
1.23

Total interest-bearing deposits
248,092

 
240,499

 
238,509

 
0.33

 
0.42

 
0.55

Total deposits in non-U.S. offices
266,608

 
260,095

 
254,642

 
0.31

 
0.38

 
0.51

Total deposits
$
1,264,301

 
$
1,189,142

 
$
1,105,883

 
0.13
%
 
0.17
%
 
0.24
%
At December 31, 2014, other U.S. time deposits in denominations of $100,000 or more totaled $45.7 billion, substantially all of which mature in three months or less. In addition, the table below presents the maturities for U.S. time certificates of deposit in denominations of $100,000 or more.
By remaining maturity at
December 31, 2014 (in millions)
Three months
or less
 
Over three months
but within six months
 
Over six months
 but within 12 months
 
Over 12 months
 
Total
U.S. time certificates of deposit ($100,000 or more)
$
12,460

 
$
4,865

 
$
2,442

 
$
6,163

 
$
25,930



328
 
 



Short-term and other borrowed funds
The following table provides a summary of JPMorgan Chase’s short-term and other borrowed funds for the years indicated.
As of or for the year ended December 31, (in millions, except rates)
2014
 
2013
 
2012
 
Federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at year-end
$
192,101

 
$
181,163

 
$
240,103

 
Average daily balance during the year
208,560

 
238,551

 
248,561

 
Maximum month-end balance
228,162

 
272,718

 
268,931

 
Weighted-average rate at December 31
0.27
%
 
0.31
%
 
0.23
%
 
Weighted-average rate during the year
0.29

 
0.24

 
0.22

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial paper:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at year-end
$
66,344

 
$
57,848

 
$
55,367

 
Average daily balance during the year
59,916

 
53,717

 
50,780

 
Maximum month-end balance
66,344

 
58,835

 
62,875

 
Weighted-average rate at December 31
0.22
%
 
0.22
%
 
0.21
%
 
Weighted-average rate during the year
0.22

 
0.21

 
0.18

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other borrowed funds:(a)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at year-end
$
96,455

 
$
92,774

 
$
79,258

 
Average daily balance during the year
100,189

 
93,937

 
79,003

 
Maximum month-end balance
107,950

 
103,526

 
87,815

 
Weighted-average rate at December 31
1.73
%
 
2.49
%
 
1.83
%
 
Weighted-average rate during the year
1.89

 
2.27

 
2.49

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Short-term beneficial interests:(b)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Commercial paper and other borrowed funds:
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance at year-end
$
16,953

 
$
17,786

 
$
28,219

 
Average daily balance during the year
14,073

 
22,245

 
25,653

 
Maximum month-end balance
17,026

 
28,559

 
30,043

 
Weighted-average rate at December 31
0.23
%
 
0.29
%
 
0.18
%
 
Weighted-average rate during the year
0.30

 
0.26

 
0.16

 
(a)
Includes interest-bearing securities sold but not yet purchased.
(b)
Included on the Consolidated balance sheets in beneficial interests issued by consolidated variable interest entities.
Federal funds purchased represent overnight funds. Securities loaned or sold under repurchase agreements generally mature between one day and three months. Commercial paper generally is issued in amounts not less than $100,000, and with maturities of 270 days or less. Other borrowed funds consist of demand notes, term federal funds purchased, and various other borrowings that generally have maturities of one year or less.



 
 
329



Signatures
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on behalf of the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
 
JPMorgan Chase & Co.
        (Registrant)
 
By: /s/ JAMES DIMON
 
 
(James Dimon
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer)
 
February 24, 2015
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacity and on the date indicated. JPMorgan Chase & Co. does not exercise the power of attorney to sign on behalf of any Director.
 
 
Capacity
 
Date
/s/ JAMES DIMON
 
Director, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer
 (Principal Executive Officer)
 
 
(James Dimon)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ LINDA B. BAMMANN
 
Director
 
 
(Linda B. Bammann)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ JAMES A. BELL
 
Director 
 
 
(James A. Bell)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ CRANDALL C. BOWLES
 
Director 
 
 
(Crandall C. Bowles)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ STEPHEN B. BURKE
 
Director 
 
 
(Stephen B. Burke)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ JAMES S. CROWN
 
Director 
 
February 24, 2015
(James S. Crown)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ TIMOTHY P. FLYNN
 
Director 
 
 
(Timothy P. Flynn)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ LABAN P. JACKSON, JR.
 
Director 
 
 
(Laban P. Jackson, Jr.)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ MICHAEL A. NEAL
 
Director
 
 
(Michael A. Neal)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ LEE R. RAYMOND
 
Director 
 
 
(Lee R. Raymond)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ WILLIAM C. WELDON
 
Director 
 
 
 (William C. Weldon)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ MARIANNE LAKE
 
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial Officer)
 
 
(Marianne Lake)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
/s/ MARK W. O’DONOVAN
 
Managing Director and Corporate Controller
(Principal Accounting Officer)
 
 
(Mark W. O’Donovan)
 
 
 


330